HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORP
S-1/A, 1996-08-15
ASSET-BACKED SECURITIES
Previous: KNOWLEDGEBROKER INC, NT 10-Q, 1996-08-15
Next: ATLAS ENERGY FOR THE NINETIES PUBLIC N0 4 LTD, 10QSB, 1996-08-15



<PAGE>   1
 
   
    AS FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION ON AUGUST 15, 1996
    
 
   
                            S-1 REGISTRATION NO. 333-6047
    
   
                               S-3 REGISTRATION NOS. 333-6047-01 AND 333-6047-02
    
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             Washington, D.C. 20549
                             ---------------------
   
                                AMENDMENT NO. 1
    
   
                                       TO
    
 
                             FORM S-1 AND FORM S-3
                             REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                     UNDER
                           THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                             ---------------------
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           I.R.S. EMPLOYER
       S-1 REGISTRANT                 STATE OF ORGANIZATION              IDENTIFICATION NO.
- -----------------------------     -----------------------------     -----------------------------
<S>                               <C>                               <C>
     HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER                     NEW YORK                         88-0345950
    LOAN DEPOSIT TRUST I
  (Registrant Issuer of the
Series 1996-2 Participation)
       S-3 REGISTRANTS                STATE OF ORGANIZATION              IDENTIFICATION NO.
- -----------------------------     -----------------------------     -----------------------------

HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST               DELAWARE                      TO BE APPLIED FOR
            1996-2
 (Registrant Issuer of Notes
  backed by the Series 1996-2
    Participation Interest)
   HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN                   NEVADA                          36-4038996
          CORPORATION
(Registrant Originator of the
     Deposit Trust and the
            Issuer)
</TABLE>
 
                             1111 Town Center Drive
                            Las Vegas, Nevada 89134
                    (Address of principal executive offices
                    of Household Consumer Loan Corporation)
 
                           PATRICK D. SCHWARTZ, ESQ.
     Associate General Counsel -- Corporate Finance and Assistant Secretary
                         HOUSEHOLD INTERNATIONAL, INC.
                               2700 Sanders Road
                        Prospect Heights, Illinois 60070
   
                                 (847) 564-6301
    
  (Name, Address, telephone number, including area code, of agent for service)
                             ---------------------
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                <C>
             REID A. MANDEL, ESQ.                               GAIL G. WATSON, ESQ.
            KATTEN MUCHIN & ZAVIS                                   BROWN & WOOD
            525 West Monroe Street                             One World Trade Center
           Chicago, Illinois 60661                            New York, New York 10048
                (312) 902-5200                                     (212) 839-5300
</TABLE>
 
                             ---------------------
 
APPROXIMATE DATE OF COMMENCEMENT OF PROPOSED SALE TO THE PUBLIC: As soon as
practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective.
                        CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
 
   
<TABLE>
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                   <C>                <C>                <C>                <C>
                                                          PROPOSED MAXIMUM   PROPOSED MAXIMUM
TITLE OF SECURITIES                      AMOUNT BEING      OFFERING PRICE        AGGREGATE          AMOUNT OF
BEING REGISTERED                          REGISTERED          PER UNIT        OFFERING PRICE   REGISTRATION FEE(1)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed
  Class A-1 Notes...................     $794,000,000           100%           $794,000,000        $273,793.11
Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed
  Class A-2 Notes...................      $52,240,000           100%            $52,240,000        $18,013.79
Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed
  Class A-3 Notes...................      $67,900,000           100%            $67,900,000        $23,413.79
Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed
  Class B Notes.....................      $49,370,000           100%            $49,370,000        $17,024.14
Series 1996-2 Participation.........          (2)                (2)                (2)            $100.00(3)
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>
    
 
   
(1) $789.66 of the Registration Fee was previously paid.
    
(2) Not applicable.
(3) As prescribed by Section 6(b) of the Securities Act of 1933.
                             ---------------------
 
     THE REGISTRANT HEREBY AMENDS THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON SUCH DATE OR
DATES AS MAY BE NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANT SHALL
FILE A FURTHER AMENDMENT WHICH SPECIFICALLY STATES THAT THIS REGISTRATION
STATEMENT SHALL THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 8(A) OF
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933 OR UNTIL THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL BECOME
EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE AS THE COMMISSION, ACTING PURSUANT TO SAID SECTION 8(A),
MAY DETERMINE.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>   2
 
                             CROSS REFERENCE SHEET
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
          NAME AND CAPTION IN FORM S-1                         CAPTION IN PROSPECTUS
- -------------------------------------------------   -------------------------------------------
<C>   <S>                                           <C>
 1.   Forepart of Registration Statement and
        Outside Front Cover Page of Prospectus...   Front Cover of Registration Statement;
                                                    Outside Front Cover Page of Prospectus
 2.   Inside Front and Outside Back Cover Pages
        of Prospectus............................   Inside Front Cover Page of Prospectus;
                                                    Outside Back Cover Page of Prospectus
 3.   Summary Information, Risk Factors and Ratio
        of Earnings to Fixed Charges.............   Prospectus Summary; Risk Factors; Deposit
                                                    Trust Risk Factors
 4.   Use of Proceeds                               Use of Proceeds
 5.   Determination of Offering Price............   *
 6.   Dilution...................................   *
 7.   Selling Security Holders...................   *
 8.   Plan of Distribution.......................   Underwriting; Risk Factors
 9.   Description of Securities to be
        Registered...............................   Prospectus Summary; The HFC Revolving
                                                      Consumer Credit Lines; The Series 1996-2
                                                      Participation; Maturity and Prepayment
                                                      Considerations; Description of the
                                                      Deposit Trust; Description of the
                                                      Securities
10.   Interests of Named Experts and Counsel.....   Legal Matters
11.   Information with Respect to the
        Registrant...............................   The HFC Revolving Consumer Credit Lines;
                                                    The Seller and Subservicers; Description of
                                                      the Deposit Trust
12.   Disclosure of Commission Position on
        Indemnification of Securities Act
        Liabilities..............................   *
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
* Not Applicable
<PAGE>   3
 
     INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO COMPLETION OR AMENDMENT. A
     REGISTRATION STATEMENT RELATING TO THESE SECURITIES HAS BEEN FILED WITH THE
     SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION. THESE SECURITIES MAY NOT BE SOLD NOR
     MAY OFFERS TO BUY BE ACCEPTED PRIOR TO THE TIME THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT
     BECOMES EFFECTIVE. THIS PROSPECTUS SHALL NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR
     THE SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY NOR SHALL THERE BE ANY SALE OF THESE
     SECURITIES IN ANY STATE IN WHICH SUCH OFFER, SOLICITATION OR SALE WOULD BE
     UNLAWFUL PRIOR TO REGISTRATION OR QUALIFICATION UNDER THE SECURITIES LAWS
     OF ANY SUCH STATE.
 
   
                  SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED AUGUST 15, 1996
    
PROSPECTUS
   
                          $794,000,000 CLASS A-1 NOTES
    
   
                           $52,240,000 CLASS A-2 NOTES
    
   
                           $67,900,000 CLASS A-3 NOTES
    
   
                           $49,370,000 CLASS B NOTES
    
                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2
           HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN ASSET BACKED NOTES, SERIES 1996-2
 
                         HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION
                                    SERVICER
                          ---------------------------
   
    The Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2 (the "Issuer") will be formed
pursuant to a Trust Agreement, to be dated as of August 1, 1996 (the "Trust
Agreement"), between Household Consumer Loan Corporation (the "Seller") and The
Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware, as owner trustee (the "Owner Trustee") and will
issue four classes of Consumer Loan Asset Backed Notes (collectively, the
"Notes") in the respective aggregate principal amounts set forth below pursuant
to an Indenture, to be dated as of August 1, 1996 (the "Indenture"), between the
Issuer and The Bank of New York, as indenture trustee (the "Indenture Trustee").
The Issuer will also issue $36,886,000 aggregate principal amount of Consumer
Loan Asset Backed Certificates, Series 1996-2 (the "Certificates"). The
Certificates will be sold privately to qualified institutional buyers or to
accredited investors. The Notes and the Certificates are collectively referred
to herein as the "Series 1996-2 Securities". Only the Notes are offered hereby.
The Class A-2, A-3 and B Notes are subordinated to the extent described herein.
    
 
   
    The Notes will be secured by a participation interest (the "Series 1996-2
Participation") in receivables held by Household Consumer Loan Deposit Trust I
(the "Deposit Trust") and originated under certain fixed and variable rate
revolving consumer credit lines (the "Credit Lines") and the collections
thereon. The Deposit Trust was formed pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing
Agreement dated as of September 1, 1995 among the Deposit Trust, Household
Finance Corporation, as Servicer (the "Servicer") and The Chase Manhattan Bank,
N.A., as trustee. Texas Commerce Bank National Association has succeeded The
Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A., as trustee under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement
and is referred to herein as the "Deposit Trustee".
    
 
   
    Interest will accrue on the Class A-1, Notes, Class A-2, Notes, Class A-3,
Notes and the Class B Notes at floating rates equal to LIBOR (as defined herein)
plus    %,    %,    % and    % per annum, respectively, in each case, subject to
certain limitations as described herein. See "Description of the Securities --
Distributions on the Securities" herein. Payments of interest and principal on
the Notes will be made on the fifteenth day of each month, or if any such day is
not a Business Day, on the next succeeding Business Day, commencing in September
1996 (each, a "Payment Date").
    
 
   
    There is currently no secondary market for the Notes. There can be no
assurance that a secondary market for the Notes will develop or, if it does
develop, that it will continue. Application will be made to list the Notes on
the Luxembourg Stock Exchange. See "Risk Factors -- Limited Liquidity" herein.
    
 
   
    FOR A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH AN INVESTMENT IN THE
NOTES, SEE "RISK FACTORS" ON PAGE 21 HEREIN.
    
                          ---------------------------
THE NOTES REPRESENT OBLIGATIONS OF THE ISSUER ONLY AND DO NOT REPRESENT
INTERESTS IN OR OBLIGATIONS OF HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORPORATION, HOUSEHOLD
 FINANCE CORPORATION, THE DEPOSIT TRUSTEE, THE OWNER TRUSTEE, THE INDENTURE
    TRUSTEE OR ANY AFFILIATE THEREOF, EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT DESCRIBED
     HEREIN. NONE OF THE NOTES, THE SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION, OR THE
     CREDIT LINES ARE INSURED OR GUARANTEED BY ANY GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY.
THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
     EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS ANY
     SUCH COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS
        PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL
          OFFENSE.
   
<TABLE>
<S>                                            <C>                 <C>                 <C>
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
<CAPTION>
                                                    PRICE TO          UNDERWRITING        PROCEEDS TO
                                                   PUBLIC(1)          DISCOUNT(2)         SELLER(2)(3)
<S>                                            <C>                 <C>                 <C>
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Per Class A-1 Note...........................          %                   %                   %
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Per Class A-2 Note...........................          %                   %                   %
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Per Class A-3 Note...........................          %                   %                   %
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Per Class B Note.............................          %                   %                   %
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total........................................          $                   $                   $
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>
    
 
(1) Plus accrued interest, if any, from            , 1996.
 
(2) The Seller and HFC have agreed to indemnify the Underwriters against certain
    liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933.
 
(3) Before deducting expenses, estimated to be $       .
                          ---------------------------
 
    The Notes are offered subject to prior sale and subject to the Underwriters'
right to reject orders in whole or in part. It is expected that delivery of such
Notes will be made in book-entry form only through the facilities of The
Depository Trust Company, Cedel Bank, societe anonyme and the Euroclear System
on or about            , 1996.
                          ---------------------------
MERRILL LYNCH & CO.
   
                    J.P. MORGAN & CO.
    
   
                                      LEHMAN BROTHERS
    
   
                                                    UBS SECURITIES INC.
    
                          ---------------------------
               The date of this Prospectus is            , 1996.
<PAGE>   4
 
     IN CONNECTION WITH THIS OFFERING, THE UNDERWRITERS MAY OVER-ALLOT OR EFFECT
TRANSACTIONS WHICH STABILIZE OR MAINTAIN THE MARKET PRICE OF THE NOTES AT LEVELS
ABOVE THOSE WHICH MIGHT OTHERWISE PREVAIL IN THE OPEN MARKET. SUCH STABILIZING,
IF COMMENCED, MAY BE DISCONTINUED AT ANY TIME.
 
   
     Until 90 days after the date of this Prospectus, all dealers effecting
transactions in the Notes, whether or not participating in this distribution,
may be required to deliver a Prospectus. This is in addition to the obligation
of dealers to deliver a Prospectus when acting as underwriters and with respect
to their unsold allotments or subscriptions. Upon receipt of a request by an
investor, or his or her representative, within the period during which there is
a Prospectus delivery obligation, the Underwriters will transmit or cause to be
transmitted promptly, without charge and in addition to any such delivery
requirements, a paper copy of a Prospectus or Prospectus in an electronic
format.
    
 
   
     The address and telephone number of the Seller, the originator of the
Deposit Trust, is 1111 Town Center Drive, Las Vegas, Nevada 89134, (702)
243-1347. The address and telephone number of the Owner Trustee to the Issuer is
1201 Market Street, Wilmington, Delaware 19801, (302) 428-3375.
    
 
                             AVAILABLE INFORMATION
 
   
     The Seller, has filed a Registration Statement under the Securities Act of
1933, as amended, with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission")
with respect to the Notes offered pursuant to this Prospectus. This Prospectus,
which forms a part of the Registration Statement, does not contain all of the
information included in the Registration Statement and the exhibits thereto. For
further information, reference is made to the Registration Statement and
amendments thereof and to exhibits thereto, which are available for inspection
without charge at the office of the Commission at 450 Fifth Street, N.W.,
Washington, D.C. 20549, and at the regional offices of the Commission at Seven
World Trade Center, New York, New York 10048 and at 500 W. Madison Street, Suite
1400, Chicago, Illinois 60661. Copies of the Registration Statement, the
amendments thereof and the exhibits thereto, may be obtained from the Public
Reference Section of the Commission's Washington Offices, at prescribed rates.
The Commission also maintains a Web site at http://www.sec.gov that contains
reports, proxy and information statements and other information regarding
registrants that file electronically with the Commission.
    
 
                INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE
 
     All documents filed with the Commission on behalf of the Issuer pursuant to
Sections 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended (the "1934 Act"), on or subsequent to the date of this Prospectus and
prior to the termination of the offering of the Notes made hereby shall be
deemed to be incorporated by reference herein and to be a part of this
Prospectus from the date of the filing of such documents. Any statement
contained in a document incorporated or deemed to be incorporated by reference
herein shall be deemed to be modified or superseded for all purposes of this
Prospectus to the extent that a statement contained herein or in any other
subsequently filed document which also is or is deemed to be incorporated by
reference herein modifies or replaces such statement. Any such statement so
modified or superseded shall not be deemed, except as modified or superseded, to
constitute a part of this Prospectus. The Seller will provide without charge to
each person to whom this Prospectus is delivered, on the request of such person,
a copy of any or all of the documents incorporated herein by reference (other
than exhibits to such documents unless the exhibits are specifically
incorporated by reference in such documents). Requests should be directed in
writing to Household Consumer Loan Corporation, 2700 Sanders Road, Prospect
Heights, Illinois 60070, Attention: Secretary.
 
                             FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
     The Seller has determined that its financial statements are not material to
the offering made hereby.
 
     The Issuer will be formed to hold the Series 1996-2 Participation and to
issue the Notes. The Issuer will have no assets or obligations prior to the
issuance of the Notes and will engage in no activities other than those
described herein. Accordingly, no financial statements with respect to the
Issuer are included in this Prospectus.
 
                           REPORTS TO THE NOTEHOLDERS
 
     Unless and until Replacement Notes (as defined herein) are issued, the
Issuer will provide to CEDE & Co., as nominee of The Depository Trust Company
("DTC") and registered holder of the Notes and, upon request, to Participants
(as defined herein), monthly and annual reports concerning the Noteholders
pursuant to the Indenture. See "Description of the Securities -- Reports to
Noteholders" and "Description of the Deposit Trust -- Evidence as to Compliance"
herein. Such reports may be made available to the owners of the Notes (the "Note
Owners") upon request to their Participants. Such reports will not constitute
financial statements prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting
principles. The Issuer does not intend to provide any financial information to
any holder of the Notes which has been examined and reported upon, with an
opinion expressed, by an independent public accountant. The Servicer will file
with the Commission such periodic reports with respect to the Issuer as are
required by the 1934 Act, and the rules, regulations or orders of the Commission
thereunder.
 
                                        2
<PAGE>   5
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                    CAPTION                       PAGE
- -----------------------------------------------   ----
<S>                                               <C>
Prospectus Summary.............................     4
Risk Factors...................................    21
  Limited Liquidity............................    21
  Difficulty in Pledging.......................    21
  Potential Delays in Receipt of
    Distributions..............................    21
  Nature of Underlying Assets..................    21
  Cash Flow Considerations.....................    21
  Prepayment Considerations....................    22
  Note Rating..................................    22
  Change in Loan Terms; Decrease in Finance
    Charges....................................    22
  Discounted Principal Receivables.............    22
  Sale of Assets; Insolvency Considerations....    23
  Legal Considerations.........................    24
  Generation of Additional Receivables;
    Dependency on Borrower Repayments..........    25
  Series 1996-2 Participation..................    25
  Social, Legal, Economic and Other Factors....    25
Deposit Trust Risk Factors.....................    26
  Issuance of Additional Series................    26
  Addition of Assets to the Deposit Trust......    26
The Seller and Subservicers....................    27
The Servicer...................................    28
Use of Proceeds................................    28
The HFC Revolving Consumer Credit Lines........    28
  General......................................    28
  Underwriting Procedures Relating to the
    Revolving Consumer Credit Lines............    29
  Revolving Consumer Credit Line Terms.........    30
  Servicing of Revolving Consumer Credit
    Lines......................................    31
Revolving Consumer Credit Line Delinquency
  Experience...................................    33
Revolving Consumer Credit Line Gross Charge-Off
  Experience...................................    34
Revolving Consumer Credit Line Revenue
  Experience for the Portfolio.................    34
The Revolving Consumer Credit Lines............    35
The Series 1996-2 Participation................    43
  General......................................    43
  Conveyance and Performance of the Series
    1996-2 Participation.......................    43
Maturity and Prepayment Considerations.........    44
Description of the Deposit Trust...............    49
  General......................................    50
  Assignment of Receivables....................    51
  Representations and Warranties...............    52
  Transfer of Seller's Interest; Additional
    Sellers and Originators....................    54
  Additions of Credit Lines....................    54
  Removal of Deposit Trust Assets..............    55
  Discount Option..............................    55
  Amendments to Credit Line Agreements.........    56
  Payments on Credit Lines; Deposits to
    Collection Account.........................    56
  Allocations and Collections..................    57
  Collection and Other Servicing Procedures....    58
  Servicing Compensation and Payment of
    Expenses...................................    58
  Evidence as to Compliance....................    59
  Certain Matters Regarding the Servicer and
    the Seller.................................    59
  Servicer Defaults............................    60
 
<CAPTION>
                    CAPTION                       PAGE
- -----------------------------------------------   ----
<S>                                               <C>
  Rights Upon a Servicer Default...............    60
  Amendment....................................    61
  Exercise of Rights by Holders of Series
    Participation Interests....................    62
  The Deposit Trustee..........................    62
  Certain Activities...........................    62
  Distributions on the Series 1996-2
    Participation..............................    62
Description of the Securities..................    63
  General......................................    63
  Distributions on the Securities..............    63
  Early Amortization Period....................    69
  Maturity.....................................    70
  Reports to Noteholders.......................    70
  Events of Default; Rights Upon Event of
    Default....................................    70
  Certain Covenants............................    72
  Annual Compliance Statement..................    72
  Satisfaction and Discharge of Indenture......    72
  Modification of Indenture....................    72
  Certain Matters Regarding the Indenture
    Trustee and the Issuer.....................    73
  Duties of the Indenture Trustee..............    73
  Actions in Respect of Series 1996-2
    Participation..............................    74
  Resignation of Indenture Trustee.............    74
  Registration of Notes........................    74
  Administration Agreement.....................    77
Description of the Receivables Purchase
  Agreement....................................    77
  Sale of Receivables..........................    77
  Representations and Warranties...............    78
  Certain Covenants............................    78
  Amendments...................................    79
  Sale of Credit Line Agreements...............    79
  Termination..................................    79
Certain Legal Aspects of the Receivables.......    79
  Transfer of Receivables......................    79
  Certain Matters Relating to Insolvency.......    80
  Consumer Protection Laws.....................    81
  Potential Legislation........................    82
  "Due-on-Sale" Clauses........................    82
  Environmental Legislation....................    83
Certain Federal and State Income Tax
  Consequences.................................    83
  General......................................    83
  Tax Characterization of The Deposit Trust and
    The Issuer.................................    83
  The Notes....................................    84
  State and Local Income and Franchise Tax
    Consequences...............................    86
ERISA Considerations...........................    86
  General......................................    86
  Prohibited Transactions and Fiduciary Duty...    86
  Plan Asset Regulation........................    87
  Review by Plan Fiduciaries...................    88
Underwriting...................................    88
Legal Matters..................................    88
Index of Defined Terms.........................    89
Global Clearance, Settlement and Tax
  Documentation Procedures.....................   A-1
  Initial Settlement...........................   A-1
  Secondary Market Trading.....................   A-1
  Certain U.S. Federal Income Tax Documentation
    Requirements...............................   A-3
</TABLE>
    
 
                                        3
<PAGE>   6
 
                               PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
 
     The following summary of certain pertinent information is qualified in its
entirety by reference to the detailed information appearing elsewhere in this
Prospectus. Reference is made to the Index of Defined Terms for the location
herein of the definitions of certain capitalized terms.
 
ISSUER...........................    The Household Consumer Loan Trust, Series
                                     1996-2 (the "Issuer"), a Delaware business
                                     trust to be formed by the Seller and the
                                     Owner Trustee pursuant to the Trust
                                     Agreement (the "Trust Agreement").
 
   
SECURITIES ISSUED BY THE
ISSUER...........................    The Class A-1 Notes, Class A-2 Notes, Class
                                     A-3 Notes and Class B Notes and the
                                     Certificates. The Notes will be issued
                                     pursuant to the Indenture and will be
                                     secured by the Trust Assets (as defined
                                     below). Pursuant to the terms of the
                                     Indenture the Class B Notes will be
                                     subordinate to the Class A Notes, the Class
                                     A-3 Notes will be subordinate to the Class
                                     A-2 and Class A-1 Notes and the Class A-2
                                     Notes will be subordinate to the Class A-1
                                     Notes. The Certificates will be issued by
                                     the Issuer pursuant to the Trust Agreement.
                                     The Certificates will be subordinate to the
                                     Notes pursuant to the terms of the
                                     Indenture.
    
 
                                     The Notes represent obligations solely of
                                     the Issuer and do not represent interests
                                     in or obligations of the Seller, the
                                     Servicer, the Deposit Trustee, the Owner
                                     Trustee, the Indenture Trustee or any
                                     affiliate thereof, except to the extent
                                     described herein. None of the Notes, the
                                     Series 1996-2 Participation or the Credit
                                     Lines are insured or guaranteed by any
                                     governmental agency or instrumentality.
                                     Only the Notes are offered hereby.
 
   
  A. THE CLASS A-1 NOTES.........    $794,000,000 Consumer Loan Asset Backed
                                     Notes, Series 1996-2 (the "Class A-1
                                     Notes").
    
 
   
     THE CLASS A-2 NOTES.........    $52,240,000 Consumer Loan Asset Backed
                                     Notes, Series 1996-2 (the "Class A-2
                                     Notes").
    
 
   
     THE CLASS A-3 NOTES.........    $67,900,000 Consumer Loan Asset Backed
                                     Notes, Series 1996-2 (the "Class A-3
                                     Notes").
    
 
   
                                     Collectively, the Class A-1 Notes, Class
                                     A-2 Notes and the Class A-3 Notes are
                                     referred to herein as the "Class A Notes".
                                     The Class A Notes will be issued pursuant
                                     to the Indenture (the "Indenture") between
                                     the Issuer and The Bank of New York, as
                                     indenture trustee (the "Indenture
                                     Trustee").
    
 
   
  B. THE CLASS B NOTES...........    $49,370,000 Consumer Loan Asset Backed
                                     Notes, Series 1996-2 (the "Class B Notes").
                                     The Class B Notes will be issued pursuant
                                     to the Indenture.
    
 
  C. THE CERTIFICATES............    Consumer Loan Asset Backed Certificates,
                                     Series 1996-2 (the "Certificates"). The
                                     Certificates will be issued pursuant to the
                                     Trust Agreement and will represent
                                     fractional undivided beneficial interests
                                     in the Issuer.
 
                                        4
<PAGE>   7
 
   
TRUST ASSETS.....................    The "Trust Assets" include (i) a
                                     participation interest (the "Series 1996-2
                                     Participation") in (x) the Receivables
                                     arising under the Credit Lines and the
                                     proceeds thereof, and (y) the preferred
                                     stock of the Seller held by the Deposit
                                     Trustee (the "Preferred Stock") and (ii)
                                     monies on deposit in certain accounts of
                                     the Issuer for the benefit of
                                     Securityholders. In addition to the Trust
                                     Assets, the Overcollateralization Amount,
                                     and the subordination of certain classes of
                                     Notes to other classes of Notes and of the
                                     Certificates to the Notes support payments
                                     to Noteholders, to the extent described
                                     herein. See "Description of the Deposit
                                     Trust" herein for a description of the
                                     Preferred Stock of the Seller held by the
                                     Deposit Trust.
    
 
SELLER...........................    Household Consumer Loan Corporation is a
                                     corporation organized under the laws of the
                                     State of Nevada and is a wholly-owned
                                     special purpose subsidiary of Household
                                     Finance Corporation ("HFC"). The Seller
                                     purchases Receivables from the Subservicers
                                     (as defined below). The Seller then sells
                                     the Receivables and all rights with respect
                                     thereto to the Deposit Trust. See
                                     "Description of the Deposit Trust --
                                     Assignment of Receivables" herein.
 
   
DEPOSIT TRUST....................    Household Consumer Loan Deposit Trust I
                                     (the "Deposit Trust") is a common law
                                     trust. Texas Commerce Bank National
                                     Association acts as trustee for the Deposit
                                     Trust. The Deposit Trust previously issued
                                     two participation interests in the pool of
                                     Receivables in connection with the issuance
                                     of two series of asset-backed securities, a
                                     participation interest to the Seller (the
                                     "Seller's Interest") and is expected to
                                     issue additional interests in the pool of
                                     Receivables from time to time (each such
                                     interest, a "Series Participation
                                     Interest"). See "Annex II: Prior Issuance
                                     of Series Participation Interests" for a
                                     summary of the Series Participation
                                     Interests previously issued by the Deposit
                                     Trust. Each Series Participation Interest
                                     will be issued in connection with the
                                     issuance of a series of securities (each, a
                                     "Series").
    
 
                                     The Series 1996-2 Participation will be the
                                     only Series Participation Interest held by
                                     the Issuer.
 
SERVICER.........................    HFC, a subsidiary of Household
                                     International, Inc., is the servicer of the
                                     Credit Lines pursuant to the Pooling and
                                     Servicing Agreement dated as of September
                                     1, 1995 (the "Pooling and Servicing
                                     Agreement") among the Seller, the Deposit
                                     Trustee and the Servicer. Each Credit Line
                                     is subserviced by the appropriate
                                     Subservicer (as defined below) on behalf of
                                     HFC as Servicer.
 
SUBSERVICERS.....................    Household Realty Corporation, Household
                                     Finance Corporation of California,
                                     Household Finance Corporation II, Household
                                     Finance Corporation III, Household Finance
                                     Industrial Loan Company, Household Finance
                                     Realty Corporation of New York, Household
                                     Financial Center Inc., Household Finance
                                     Corporation of Nevada, Household Finance
                                     Realty
 
                                        5
<PAGE>   8
 
                                     Corporation of Nevada, Household Industrial
                                     Loan Company of Kentucky, Household Finance
                                     Industrial Loan Company of Iowa, Household
                                     Finance Consumer Discount Company,
                                     Household Industrial Finance Company and
                                     Mortgage One Corporation (collectively, the
                                     "Subservicers" and each individually, a
                                     "Subservicer"), are wholly-owned
                                     subsidiaries of HFC, licensed to make and
                                     service consumer loans in the states in
                                     which the Credit Lines were originated. The
                                     Subservicers originated the Credit Lines or
                                     purchased them from third parties.
 
   
ADMINISTRATOR....................    HFC is the Administrator pursuant to an
                                     Administration Agreement dated as of August
                                     1, 1996 (the "Administration Agreement")
                                     among HFC, the Seller, the Issuer and the
                                     Owner Trustee. Pursuant to the
                                     Administration Agreement, HFC will perform
                                     certain duties of the Issuer, Owner Trustee
                                     and Seller under the Indenture and Trust
                                     Agreement. See "Description of the
                                     Securities -- Administration Agreement"
                                     herein.
    
 
   
THE CREDIT LINES.................    The Credit Lines which generate the
                                     Receivables held by the Deposit Trust
                                     consist of a portion of the total pool of
                                     revolving consumer credit lines originated
                                     or purchased by the Subservicers (and any
                                     other consumer lending affiliates of HFC
                                     that become Subservicers) from time to time
                                     (the "Portfolio"). The Credit Lines are
                                     designated to the Deposit Trust and are
                                     required to satisfy the criteria set forth
                                     in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement for
                                     Eligible Credit Lines (as defined herein).
                                     The Receivables arising under each Credit
                                     Line, whether existing on the applicable
                                     Cut-Off Date (as defined herein) for such
                                     Receivables or thereafter generated have
                                     been or will be sold by the Subservicers to
                                     the Seller, which has sold or will sell
                                     such Receivables to the Deposit Trust.
    
 
   
                                     The Credit Lines are not being sold or
                                     transferred to the Seller or to the Deposit
                                     Trust and will continue to be held and
                                     administered by the Subservicers. See "Risk
                                     Factors -- Change in Loan Terms; Decrease
                                     in Finance Charges", "Description of the
                                     Deposit Trust -- Assignment of
                                     Receivables"; "Description of the
                                     Receivables Purchase Agreement -- Sale of
                                     Receivables" herein.
    
 
   
                                     The Seller entered into a receivables
                                     purchase agreement dated as of September 1,
                                     1995 (the "Initial Cut-Off Date"), with
                                     each Subservicer (the "Receivables Purchase
                                     Agreement"), and may enter into a similar
                                     agreement with other affiliates of HFC. On
                                     September 28, 1995 (the "Initial Issuance
                                     Date"), pursuant to the Receivables
                                     Purchase Agreement, each of the
                                     Subservicers sold to the Seller all of
                                     their respective rights, title and interest
                                     in the Receivables existing under the
                                     Credit Lines designated to the Deposit
                                     Trust as of the Initial Cut-Off Date (the
                                     "Initial Credit Lines", and such
                                     Receivables outstanding under the Initial
                                     Credit Lines as of the Initial Cut-Off
                                     Date, the "Initial
    
 
                                        6
<PAGE>   9
 
                                     Receivables"). Each Subservicer has sold
                                     and will continue to sell to the Seller all
                                     of its right, title and interest in new
                                     Principal Receivables and Finance Charge
                                     and Administrative Receivables arising
                                     under the Initial Credit Lines from time to
                                     time.
 
   
                                     Pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing
                                     Agreement, all Receivables purchased by the
                                     Seller from the Subservicers will be sold
                                     to the Deposit Trust. Pursuant to the
                                     Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Seller
                                     expects (subject to certain limitations and
                                     conditions), to continue to add Receivables
                                     to the Deposit Trust. To do so, the Seller
                                     may designate additional Credit Lines, the
                                     Receivables of which will be purchased and
                                     assigned by the Seller to the Deposit
                                     Trust. Such additional Credit Lines may
                                     include New Credit Lines (as defined
                                     herein) and Additional Credit Lines (as
                                     defined herein). Since the Initial Cut-Off
                                     Date, the Seller has conveyed to the
                                     Deposit Trust the Receivables arising in
                                     certain Additional Credit Lines in
                                     accordance with the provisions of the
                                     Pooling and Servicing Agreement. All
                                     Receivables arising under Credit Lines
                                     designated to the Deposit Trust, whether
                                     existing at the time such Credit Lines are
                                     designated, or subsequently generated, will
                                     be conveyed to the Deposit Trust. The
                                     Seller will also have the right, in certain
                                     circumstances, to remove certain Credit
                                     Lines, in which case, no further interest
                                     in Receivables arising under such Credit
                                     Lines will be transferred to the Deposit
                                     Trust (the "Removed Credit Lines"). See
                                     "Description of the Deposit Trust --
                                     Additions of Credit Lines" and "-- Removal
                                     of Deposit Trust Assets".
    
 
THE RECEIVABLES..................    The Receivables include (a) all periodic
                                     finance charges, and other amounts as
                                     described in the Series 1996-2 Supplement
                                     (as defined herein) (as increased by any
                                     Principal Discount, the "Finance Charge
                                     Receivables") (b) all administrative fees
                                     and late charges and all other fees or
                                     charges billed to obligors on the Credit
                                     Lines (the "Administrative Receivables" and
                                     together with the Finance Charge
                                     Receivables, the "Finance Charge and
                                     Administrative Receivables") and (c) all
                                     amounts owed by obligors under the Credit
                                     Line Agreements (as defined herein) and
                                     other amounts in respect of principal as
                                     described in the Series 1996-2 Supplement
                                     (as decreased by any Principal Discount)
                                     (the "Principal Receivables").
 
                                     Recoveries (as defined below) attributed to
                                     Defaulted Credit Lines (as defined below)
                                     will be treated as collections of Finance
                                     Charge Receivables. Finance Charge and
                                     Administrative Receivables and Principal
                                     Receivables will be allocated to the Series
                                     1996-2 Participation in accordance with the
                                     applicable Allocation Percentage (as
                                     defined herein) for the related Collection
                                     Period. Finance charges are assessed on
                                     principal receivables and certain of the
                                     finance charge receivables at rates
                                     determined by the Subservicers with
 
                                        7
<PAGE>   10
 
   
                                     respect to the respective Credit Lines
                                     generated by each such party. As of the
                                     close of business on July 31, 1996 (the
                                     "Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date"), the interest
                                     rates on the Receivables ranged from 0.00%
                                     to 36.00% with a weighted average interest
                                     rate (by principal balance) of 19.64%. As
                                     of the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date, the
                                     average principal balance of the Credit
                                     Lines designated to the Deposit Trust was
                                     $5,087.18.
    
 
                                     Pursuant to the option to discount
                                     receivables contained in the Pooling and
                                     Servicing Agreement (see "Description of
                                     the Deposit Trust -- Discount Option"), the
                                     Seller has the option to designate or
                                     redesignate a fixed percentage of each
                                     Principal Receivable assigned to the
                                     Deposit Trust as a finance charge
                                     receivable (the "Principal Discount"). As
                                     of the date of this Prospectus, the Seller
                                     has not elected to exercise such option
                                     with respect to the Receivables; however,
                                     it may do so at any time in the future. In
                                     the event of such election, such percentage
                                     designated by the Seller is the "Discount
                                     Percentage." The Discount Percentage may be
                                     designated by the Seller at any time, and
                                     once designated, may be increased,
                                     decreased or withdrawn by the Seller. The
                                     Principal Discount may apply to Principal
                                     Receivables assigned to the Deposit Trust
                                     prior to, on or after the date the Seller
                                     makes such designation or redesignation.
                                     When the Discount Option has been elected,
                                     the Discount Percentage of Principal
                                     Receivables will instead be treated as
                                     Finance Charge and Administrative
                                     Receivables, and the Discount Percentage of
                                     all collections of Receivables that would
                                     otherwise be Principal Receivables will be
                                     applied as collections of Finance Charge
                                     and Administrative Receivables. The
                                     applicable Allocation Percentage of such
                                     discounted amount treated as Finance Charge
                                     and Administrative receivables will be
                                     available to make distributions of the
                                     Participation Pass-Through Rate and
                                     Defaulted Amounts allocated to the Series
                                     1996-2 Participation. See "Risk Factors --
                                     Discounted Principal Receivables" herein.
                                     If such election is made, as described in
                                     this Prospectus, all references herein to
                                     Principal Receivables or Finance Charge
                                     Receivables, or collections with respect
                                     thereto, are deemed in the case of
                                     Receivables assigned to the Deposit Trust
                                     to refer to such Receivables, or
                                     collections with respect thereto, as
                                     defined above, after application of the
                                     Principal Discount. In such event,
                                     references in this Prospectus to Principal
                                     Receivables or Finance Charge Receivables,
                                     or collections with respect thereto, are
                                     deemed in the case of Receivables assigned
                                     to the Deposit Trust prior to such election
                                     to refer to such Receivables, or
                                     collections with respect thereto, without
                                     application of a Discount Percentage. All
                                     historical and current data herein
                                     regarding credit lines and receivables is
                                     presented without adjustment for a
                                     Principal Discount.
 
                                     The amount of Receivables will fluctuate
                                     from day to day as new Receivables are
                                     generated and sold by the Subservicers
 
                                        8
<PAGE>   11
 
                                     to the Seller and then by the Seller to the
                                     Deposit Trust, and as existing Receivables
                                     are collected, charged-off as uncollectible
                                     or otherwise adjusted.
 
                                     The amount represented by the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation will not increase as a result
                                     of additional Principal Receivables being
                                     generated under any designated Credit Line
                                     ("Additional Balances"). Additional
                                     Balances and Receivables attributable to
                                     Aggregate Additional Credit Lines exceeding
                                     the amount of reinvested collections for
                                     the Series 1996-2 Participation and all
                                     other Series Participation Interests will
                                     be reflected in the principal balance of
                                     the Seller's Interest. However, the
                                     principal balance of the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation will be adjusted to reflect
                                     payments made on the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation.
 
   
                                     The aggregate amount of Receivables in the
                                     Deposit Trust on the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off
                                     Date was $2,989,342,714.28 of which
                                     $2,911,818,229.60 were Principal
                                     Receivables and $77,524,484.68 were Finance
                                     Charge and Administrative Receivables.
    
 
                                     With respect to any date, the "Pool
                                     Balance" will be equal to the aggregate of
                                     the Principal Balances of all Credit Lines
                                     as of such date. The "Principal Balance" of
                                     a Credit Line on any day is equal to its
                                     principal balance on the date the Credit
                                     Line is designated to the Deposit Trust
                                     (each such date, a "Cut-Off Date"), plus
                                     (i) any Additional Balance in respect of
                                     such Credit Line, minus (ii) all Principal
                                     Collections credited against the Principal
                                     Balance prior to such day, minus (iii) all
                                     related Defaulted Amounts, and plus or
                                     minus (iv) any correcting adjustments.
                                     Notwithstanding the above, the Principal
                                     Balance of Receivables for a Defaulted
                                     Credit Line shall be zero. With respect to
                                     any Distribution Date, a "Defaulted Credit
                                     Line" is a defaulted Credit Line as to
                                     which the Servicer has charged off all of
                                     the related Principal Balance during the
                                     related Collection Period. A "Defaulted
                                     Amount" is the amount equal to the
                                     Principal Balance of a Defaulted Credit
                                     Line that the Servicer has charged off on
                                     its servicing records in such Collection
                                     Period.
 
   
SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION......    Pursuant to the Series 1996-2 Supplement,
                                     the Seller will convey the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation to the Issuer. The Series
                                     1996-2 Participation shall initially be
                                     $1,044,800,000 (the "Initial Series 1996-2
                                     Participation Invested Amount").
                                     Thereafter, the "Series 1996-2
                                     Participation Invested Amount" with respect
                                     to any date will be an amount equal to the
                                     Initial Series 1996-2 Participation
                                     Invested Amount minus the sum of the Series
                                     1996-2 Participation Principal Distribution
                                     Amount (as defined herein) paid for all
                                     Distribution Dates and the Defaulted
                                     Amounts allocated to the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation during the related and all
                                     prior Collection Periods that have not been
                                     included in the Series 1996-2 Participation
                                     Principal Distribution Amount on the
                                     current or any prior Distribution Date.
    
 
                                        9
<PAGE>   12
 
                                     The Series 1996-2 Participation will be
                                     entitled to receive a percentage of the
                                     Interest Collections (which shall include
                                     Recoveries), Principal Collections or Net
                                     Principal Collections (as defined below)
                                     and Defaulted Amounts received or incurred
                                     during each Collection Period. With respect
                                     to any Collection Period prior to the
                                     occurrence of an Amortization Event,
                                     Interest Collections and Defaulted Amounts
                                     allocated to the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation will be based upon the
                                     Floating Allocation Percentage.
 
                                     With respect to any Collection Period
                                     during an Early Amortization Period,
                                     Interest Collections will be allocated to
                                     the Series 1996-2 Participation based upon
                                     the Fixed Allocation Percentage. However,
                                     Defaulted Amounts allocated to the Series
                                     1996-2 Participation with respect to any
                                     Collection Period after an Amortization
                                     Event shall continue to be made based upon
                                     the Floating Allocation Percentage.
                                     Interest Collections with respect to any
                                     Collection Period will be distributable to
                                     the Issuer as holder of the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation as described under
                                     "Remittance on the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation." Allocated Interest
                                     Collections not so distributed will be
                                     distributable to the Seller.
 
                                     With respect to any Collection Period prior
                                     to the Accelerated Amortization Date or the
                                     commencement of an Early Amortization
                                     Period, Principal Collections will be
                                     allocated to the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation based upon the greater of:
                                     (i) the Floating Allocation Percentage of
                                     Net Principal Collections (as defined
                                     below) or (ii) the Minimum Principal
                                     Amount. With respect to any Collection
                                     Period after the Accelerated Amortization
                                     Date or during the Early Amortization
                                     Period, the Series 1996-2 Participation
                                     will be entitled to Principal Collections
                                     based upon the Fixed Allocation Percentage.
 
                                     For any Distribution Date, the Fixed
                                     Allocation Percentage applicable to
                                     Principal Collections may be different than
                                     the Fixed Allocation Percentage applicable
                                     to Interest Collections if an Amortization
                                     Event occurs after the Accelerated
                                     Amortization Date.
 
                                     "Net Principal Collections" will equal the
                                     excess, if any, of Principal Collections
                                     for the related Collection Period, minus
                                     Additional Balances sold to the Deposit
                                     Trust during any Collection Period. If
                                     there is no excess, Net Principal
                                     Collections will equal zero.
 
                                     The Floating Allocation Percentage and the
                                     Fixed Allocation Percentage are defined
                                     herein under "Description of the Deposit
                                     Trust -- Allocations and Collections". The
                                     Minimum Principal Amount is defined herein
                                     under "Description of the Deposit
                                     Trust -- Distributions on the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation".
 
COLLECTIONS......................    All collections on the Receivables will be
                                     allocated by the Servicer as payments on
                                     Credit Lines in accordance with the
 
                                       10
<PAGE>   13
 
                                     terms of the Credit Line Agreements. See
                                     "Description of the Deposit
                                     Trust -- Allocations and Collections"
                                     herein.
 
   
                                     As to any Payment Date, "Interest
                                     Collections" will be equal to the sum of
                                     (i) the amounts collected during the
                                     related Collection Period in respect of
                                     Finance Charge and Administrative
                                     Receivables, including Recoveries and (ii)
                                     the interest portion of the Transfer Price
                                     received (as defined herein) in the event
                                     the Series 1996-2 Participation is
                                     reassigned to the Seller, reduced, if HFC
                                     is no longer the Servicer, by the Servicing
                                     Fee for such Collection Period.
    
 
   
                                     As to any Payment Date, "Principal
                                     Collections" will be equal to the sum of
                                     (i) the amounts collected during the
                                     related Collection Period in respect of
                                     Principal Receivables (other than the
                                     principal portion of any Recoveries), and
                                     (ii) the principal portion of the price
                                     received for any repurchased Receivable and
                                     the Transfer Price.
    
 
                                     As to any Payment Date, the "Collection
                                     Period" is the calendar month preceding the
                                     month of such Payment Date.
 
                                     On the Business Day prior to each Payment
                                     Date, the Servicer will deposit the
                                     remittances on the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation for such Payment Date into an
                                     account (the "Collection Account")
                                     established and maintained by the Deposit
                                     Trustee under the Pooling and Servicing
                                     Agreement.
 
                                     A "Defective Receivable" is any Receivable
                                     which is required to be repurchased or
                                     substituted for as a result of a defect in
                                     the related Credit Line Agreement or
                                     another breach of a representation and
                                     warranty.
 
   
ACCELERATED AMORTIZATION DATE....    The "Accelerated Amortization Date" is July
                                     31, 2001.
    
 
EARLY AMORTIZATION PERIOD........    An Early Amortization Period will begin
                                     with the first day of the Collection Period
                                     in which an Amortization Event has occurred
                                     and will continue until the unpaid
                                     principal balance of the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation is zero. "Amortization
                                     Events" will include, but are not limited
                                     to:
 
                                     (a) failure of the Seller to observe
                                     certain covenants;
 
                                     (b) certain breaches of representations and
                                     warranties;
 
                                     (c) the occurrence of certain events of
                                         bankruptcy, insolvency or receivership
                                         related to the Seller or the Servicer;
 
                                     (d) the Deposit Trust or the Issuer become
                                         an investment company under the
                                         Investment Company Act of 1940;
 
   
                                     (e) a Servicer Default occurs under the
                                         Pooling and Servicing Agreement;
    
 
   
                                     (f) the percentage (averaged over any three
                                         consecutive months) obtained by
                                         dividing i) the Overcollateralization
                                         Amount by ii) the outstanding unpaid
                                         principal balance of the Series 1996-2
                                         Participation, is reduced below 4.25%;
                                         and
    
 
                                       11
<PAGE>   14
 
                                     (g) the portion of the Seller's Trust
                                         Amount owned by Household Consumer
                                         Loan Corporation is reduced below
                                         1.01% of the aggregate invested
                                         amounts of all outstanding Series
                                         Participation Interests.
 
                                     See "Description of the Securities -- Early
                                     Amortization Period."
 
REMITTANCE ON THE SERIES 1996-2
  PARTICIPATION..................    On each Distribution Date the Deposit Trust
                                     will make the following remittances to the
                                     Indenture Trustee in respect of collections
                                     during the preceding Collection Period:
 
   
     INTEREST....................    An amount will be remitted to the Indenture
                                     Trustee on behalf of the Issuer from the
                                     applicable Allocation Percentage of
                                     Interest Collections for the preceding
                                     Collection Period equal to the amount
                                     accrued at the Participation Pass-Through
                                     Rate on the unpaid principal balance of the
                                     Series 1996-2 Participation. The
                                     "Participation Pass-Through Rate" for each
                                     Distribution Date is a per annum rate equal
                                     to Prime Rate (as defined herein), less
                                     1.50%, subject to a minimum rate equal to a
                                     per annum rate which will result in an
                                     amount which will be sufficient to pay the
                                     full amount of interest due on the Notes
                                     and to make a full distribution on the
                                     Certificates at the Certificate Rate, plus
                                     0.25% of the Series 1996-2 Participation
                                     Invested Amount in respect of the
                                     Accelerated Principal Payment Amount (the
                                     "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
                                     Distribution Amount").
    
 
     PRINCIPAL...................    An amount will be remitted to the Indenture
                                     Trustee on behalf of the Issuer equal to
                                     the sum of the applicable Allocation
                                     Percentage of Principal Collections, or
                                     during any Collection Period prior to the
                                     Accelerated Amortization Date or
                                     commencement of an Early Amortization
                                     Period, equal to the sum of (a) the greater
                                     of: (i) the Floating Allocation Percentage
                                     of Net Principal Collections or (ii) the
                                     Minimum Principal Amount, as defined
                                     herein, and (b) to the extent of the
                                     applicable Allocation Percentage of
                                     Interest Collections remaining after
                                     providing for the distribution of the
                                     Participation Pass-Through Rate on the
                                     Series 1996-2 Participation, Defaulted
                                     Amounts and the amount of any Defaulted
                                     Amounts previously allocated to the Series
                                     1996-2 Participation that have not been
                                     included in the Series 1996-2 Principal
                                     Distribution Amount on any prior
                                     Distribution Date (the "Series 1996-2
                                     Participation Principal Distribution
                                     Amount").
 
SECURITIES INTEREST..............    Interest on each Class of Notes will be
                                     payable monthly on the fifteenth day of
                                     each month or, if such day is not a
                                     Business Day (as defined herein), on the
                                     next succeeding Business Day (each, a
                                     "Payment Date"), commencing in September,
                                     1996, in an amount equal to interest
                                     accrued during the related Interest Period
                                     (as defined below) at the applicable Note
                                     Rate on the Security Balance for the
                                     related class of Notes. The applicable Note
                                     Rate for an Interest
 
                                       12
<PAGE>   15
 
   
                                     Period will be the per annum rate equal to
                                     the sum of (a) the London interbank offered
                                     rate for one-month United States dollar
                                     deposits ("LIBOR"), determined as specified
                                     herein, as of the second LIBOR Business Day
                                     (as defined herein) prior to the first day
                                     of such Interest Period (or as of two LIBOR
                                     Business Days prior to the Closing Date, in
                                     the case of the first Interest Period) and
                                     (b)    %,    %,    % and    % per annum in
                                     the case of the Class A-1 Notes, Class A-2
                                     Notes, Class A-3 Notes and Class B Notes,
                                     respectively, in each case, subject to a
                                     maximum rate for each class as described
                                     under "Description of the
                                     Securities -- Distributions on the
                                     Securities" herein. Interest on the Notes
                                     in respect of any Payment Date will accrue
                                     from (and including) the preceding Payment
                                     Date (or in the case of the first Payment
                                     Date, from the date of the initial issuance
                                     of the Notes (the "Closing Date")) through
                                     (and including) the day preceding such
                                     Payment Date (each such period, an
                                     "Interest Period") on the basis of a
                                     360-day year and the actual number of days
                                     in such interest period. See "Description
                                     of the Securities -- Distributions on the
                                     Securities". Interest for any Payment Date
                                     due but not paid on such Payment Date shall
                                     bear interest, to the extent permitted by
                                     applicable law, at the related Note Rate
                                     until paid. Failure to pay interest in full
                                     on any Payment Date after expiration of the
                                     applicable grace period is an Event of
                                     Default under the Indenture.
    
 
                                     Distributions on Certificates will be
                                     payable monthly on each Payment Date,
                                     commencing in September, 1996, at the
                                     Certificate Rate on the Security Balance of
                                     the Certificates for the related Interest
                                     Period. The "Certificate Rate" will
                                     generally equal the sum of (a) LIBOR
                                     (calculated in the manner described above
                                     for the Class A and Class B Notes for such
                                     Interest Period) and (b) the percentage
                                     specified in the Trust Agreement, subject
                                     to certain limitations as described herein
                                     under "Description of the Securities --
                                     Distributions on the Securities." The
                                     Certificate Rate will accrue on any amounts
                                     distributable in payment of the Certificate
                                     Rate, but not paid on any monthly Payment
                                     Date.
 
   
SECURITIES PRINCIPAL.............    On each Payment Date, to the extent funds
                                     are available therefore, other than the
                                     Payment Date in August 2006 (the "Final
                                     Payment Date"), principal payments will be
                                     due and payable on the Notes and
                                     distributions will be due on the
                                     Certificates in respective amounts
                                     described below under "Allocation of
                                     Remittances on the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation".
    
 
                                     On the Final Payment Date, principal will
                                     be due and payable on the Notes in an
                                     amount equal to the Security Balance
                                     thereof on such Payment Date.
 
                                     In addition, on any Payment Date, to the
                                     extent of funds available therefor,
                                     Noteholders will also be entitled to
                                     receive principal payments in respect of
                                     the Accelerated Principal
 
                                       13
<PAGE>   16
 
                                     Payment Amount as described in this
                                     Prospectus Summary under "Allocation of
                                     Remittances on the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation". In no event will principal
                                     payments on the Notes on any Payment Date
                                     exceed the Security Balance thereof on such
                                     date.
 
ALLOCATION OF REMITTANCES ON THE
SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION......    The majority of the defined terms used in
                                     this Allocation of Remittances on the
                                     Series 1996-2 Participation are defined
                                     beginning on page 62 under "Description of
                                     the Securities -- Distributions on the
                                     Securities -- Allocations of Remittances on
                                     the Series 1996-2 Participation".
 
                                     Except as provided below, on each Payment
                                     Date other than a Payment Date occurring
                                     after an Event of Default, remittances on
                                     the Series 1996-2 Participation will be
                                     allocated in the following order of
                                     priority:
 
   
                                          (i) sequentially, as payment for the
                                         amount of interest due on the Class A-1
                                         Notes, Class A-2 Notes, Class A-3 Notes
                                         and Class B Notes;
    
 
   
                                          (ii) except as otherwise specified
                                         below, to the Certificates on behalf of
                                         the Issuer, as payment of the amount
                                         distributable in respect of the
                                         Certificate Rate on the Security
                                         Balance of the Certificates and
                                         previously unpaid;
    
 
   
                                          (iii) sequentially, up to the Optimum
                                         Monthly Principal,
    
 
   
                                               (a) to the Class A-1 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-1 Notes would equal the Class A-1
                                            Targeted Principal Balance,
    
 
   
                                               (b) to the Class A-2 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-2 Notes would equal the Class A-2
                                            Targeted Principal Balance, to the
                                            extent the Adjusted Security Balance
                                            of the Class A-2 Notes would not be
                                            reduced below the Minimum Security
                                            Balance for the Class A-2 Notes,
    
 
   
                                               (c) to the Class A-3 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-3 Notes would equal the Class A-3
                                            Targeted Principal Balance, to the
                                            extent the Adjusted Security Balance
                                            of the Class A-3 Notes would not be
                                            reduced below the Minimum Security
                                            Balance for the Class A-3 Notes, and
    
 
   
                                               (d) to the Class B Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class B
                                            Notes would equal the Class B
                                            Targeted Principal Balance, to the
                                            extent the Adjusted Security Balance
                                            of the Class B Notes would not be
                                            reduced below the Minimum Security
                                            Balance for the Class B Notes;
    
 
   
                                          (iv) to the Certificates, up to the
                                         remaining Optimum Monthly Principal
                                         until the Security Balance of the
    
 
                                       14
<PAGE>   17
 
   
                                         Certificates would equal the
                                         Certificate Targeted Balance, to the
                                         extent the Adjusted Security Balance of
                                         the Certificates would not be reduced
                                         below $7,900,000;
    
 
   
                                          (v) to the Seller, up to the remaining
                                         Optimum Monthly Principal provided the
                                         Overcollateralization Amount is not
                                         less than $14,800,000;
    
 
   
                                          (vi) as principal on the Notes,
                                         sequentially, up to the Accelerated
                                         Principal Payment Amount for such
                                         Payment Date:
    
 
   
                                               (a) to the Class A-1 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-1 Notes would equal the Class A-1
                                            Targeted Principal Balance,
    
 
   
                                               (b) to the Class A-2 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-2 Notes would equal the Class A-2
                                            Targeted Principal Balance, to the
                                            extent the Adjusted Security Balance
                                            of the Class A-2 Notes would not be
                                            reduced below the Minimum Security
                                            Balance for the Class A-2 Notes,
    
 
   
                                               (c) to the Class A-3 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-3 Notes would equal the Class A-3
                                            Targeted Principal Balance, to the
                                            extent the Adjusted Security Balance
                                            of the Class A-3 Notes would not be
                                            reduced below the Minimum Security
                                            Balance for the Class A-3 Notes,
    
 
   
                                               (d) to the Class B Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class B
                                            Notes would equal the Class B
                                            Targeted Principal Balance, to the
                                            extent the Adjusted Security Balance
                                            of the Class B Notes would not be
                                            reduced below the Minimum Security
                                            Balance for the Class B Notes,
    
 
   
                                               (e) to the Class A-1 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-1 Notes would equal zero,
    
 
   
                                               (f) to the Class A-2 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-2 Notes would equal zero,
    
 
   
                                               (g) to the Class A-3 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-3 Notes would equal zero, and
    
 
   
                                               (h) to the Class B Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class B
                                            Notes would equal zero;
    
 
   
                                          (vii) as principal on the Notes,
                                         sequentially, up to the remaining
                                         Optimum Monthly Principal for such
                                         Payment Date:
    
 
   
                                               (a) to the Class A-1 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-1 Notes would equal zero,
    
 
   
                                               (b) to the Class A-2 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-2 Notes would equal zero,
    
 
                                       15
<PAGE>   18
 
   
                                               (c) to the Class A-3 Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class
                                            A-3 Notes would equal zero, and
    
 
   
                                               (d) to the Class B Notes until
                                            the Security Balance of the Class B
                                            Notes would equal zero;
    
 
   
                                          (viii) to the Certificates, up to the
                                         remaining Optimum Monthly Principal
                                         until the Security Balance of the
                                         Certificates would equal the
                                         Certificate Minimum Balance, or if the
                                         Series 1996-2 Participation Invested
                                         Amount is zero, then to the
                                         Certificates until the Security Balance
                                         of the Certificates would equal zero;
    
 
   
                                          (ix) to the Seller provided the
                                         Overcollateralization Amount is greater
                                         than zero, the remaining Optimum
                                         Monthly Principal; and
    
 
   
                                          (x) any remaining amounts to the
                                         Issuer or its designee.
    
 
   
                                     In the event (a) immediately prior to a
                                     Distribution Date the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation Invested Amount is less than
                                     the aggregate Security Balance of the Class
                                     A and Class B Notes immediately prior to
                                     the related Payment Date, or (b) the
                                     remittances on the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation for a Payment Date is less
                                     than the aggregate amount to be paid
                                     pursuant to clauses (i) and (ii) above, the
                                     amount to be paid pursuant to clause (ii)
                                     above will be paid only after payments are
                                     made on the Notes pursuant to clause (iii).
    
 
   
OVERCOLLATERALIZATION AMOUNT.....    As of the Closing Date, the
                                     Overcollateralization Amount is equal to
                                     $44,404,000 (the "Initial
                                     Overcollateralization Amount") or 4.25%
                                     (the "Initial Overcollateralization
                                     Percentage") of the Initial Series 1996-2
                                     Participation Invested Amount. For each
                                     Payment Date the "Overcollateralization
                                     Amount" equals the amount by which the
                                     Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount
                                     exceeds the aggregate Security Balance of
                                     the Series 1996-2 Securities, in each case
                                     after giving effect to distributions on
                                     such Payment Date. For each Payment Date,
                                     the "Accelerated Principal Payment Amount"
                                     is equal to the lesser of (i) the amount by
                                     which the remittance on the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation exceeds the sum of (a) the
                                     amount to be distributed on the Notes with
                                     respect to interest and the Certificates
                                     with respect to the Certificate Rate on
                                     such Payment Date and (b) the Optimum
                                     Monthly Principal for such Payment Date and
                                     (ii) one-twelfth of the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation Invested Amount, multiplied
                                     by 0.25%. The distribution of Accelerated
                                     Principal Payment Amounts, if any, to
                                     Noteholders will increase the
                                     Overcollateralization Amount. The
                                     Overcollateralization Amount will be
                                     available to absorb any Defaulted Amounts
                                     that are allocated to Noteholders and not
                                     covered by remittances on the Series 1996-2
                                     Securities. See "Description of the
                                     Securities -- Distributions on the
                                     Securities -- Overcollateralization Amount"
                                     herein.
    
 
                                       16
<PAGE>   19
 
   
ISSUANCE OF ADDITIONAL SERIES....    Two Series were previously issued through
                                     the sale of Series Participation Interests
                                     in the Receivables of the Deposit Trust.
                                     See "Annex II: Prior Issuance of Series
                                     Participation Interests" for a summary of
                                     the Series Participation Interests
                                     previously issued by the Deposit Trust.
                                     Additional Series are expected to be issued
                                     from time to time through the sale of
                                     additional Series Participation Interests
                                     to new issuers. It is anticipated that the
                                     securities of other Series will have
                                     expected final payment dates, rapid
                                     amortization dates, amortization periods,
                                     non-amortization periods, accelerated
                                     amortization periods and periods during
                                     which the principal amount of such
                                     securities is accumulated in a principal
                                     funding account or paid to holders of such
                                     securities which differ from those for the
                                     Series 1996-2 Securities.
    
 
                                     Accordingly, each Series may have entirely
                                     different methods for calculating the
                                     amount and timing of principal and interest
                                     distributions to securityholders and Series
                                     Enhancements (as defined below) for such
                                     series and may utilize other methods for
                                     determining the portion of collections of
                                     Receivables allocable to such
                                     securityholders and Series Enhancement. See
                                     "Deposit Trust Risk Factors."
 
                                     "Series Enhancement" means any letter of
                                     credit, surety bond, subordinated interest
                                     in the trust assets, collateral invested
                                     amount, collateral account, spread account,
                                     guaranteed rate agreement, maturity
                                     liquidity facility, tax protection
                                     agreement, interest rate swap agreement,
                                     interest rate cap agreement or other
                                     similar arrangement for the benefit of
                                     holders of interests in a Series.
 
DENOMINATIONS....................    The Class A and Class B Notes will be
                                     issued in the aggregate principal amounts
                                     set forth on the cover page hereof, in
                                     fully registered denominations of $100,000
                                     and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess
                                     thereof.
 
REGISTRATION OF NOTES............    The Notes will initially be issued in
                                     book-entry form. Persons acquiring
                                     beneficial ownership interests in the Notes
                                     ("Note Owners") may elect to hold their
                                     Notes through DTC, in the United States, or
                                     Cedel Bank, societe anonyme ("Cedel") or
                                     the Euroclear System ("Euroclear"), in
                                     Europe. Transfers within DTC, Cedel or
                                     Euroclear, as the case may be, will be in
                                     accordance with the usual rules and
                                     operating procedures of the relevant
                                     system.
 
   
                                     Cross-market transfers between persons
                                     holding directly or indirectly through DTC,
                                     on the one hand, and counterparties holding
                                     directly or indirectly through Cedel or
                                     Euroclear, on the other, will be effected
                                     in DTC through Citibank, N.A. or Chemical
                                     Bank, the relevant depositaries
                                     (collectively, the "Depositaries") of Cedel
                                     or Euroclear, respectively, and each a
                                     participating member of DTC. So long as the
                                     Notes are in book-entry form, such Notes
                                     will be evidenced by one or more Notes
                                     registered in the name of CEDE & Co., the
                                     nominee of DTC. The interests of the Note
                                     Owners will be
    
 
                                       17
<PAGE>   20
 
                                     represented by book-entries on the records
                                     of DTC and participating members thereof.
                                     Notes will be available in definitive form
                                     only under the limited circumstances
                                     described herein. All references in this
                                     Prospectus to "Holders" or "Noteholders"
                                     shall be deemed, unless the context clearly
                                     requires otherwise, to refer to CEDE & Co.,
                                     as nominee of DTC. See "Risk Factors" and
                                     "Description of the Securities --
                                     Registration of Notes" herein.
 
RECORD DATE......................    The last day preceding a Payment Date, or
                                     if the Notes are no longer book-entry
                                     securities, the last day of a month
                                     preceding a Payment Date.
 
SERVICING........................    The Servicer will be responsible for
                                     servicing and managing the Credit Lines and
                                     making collections on the Receivables. Each
                                     Credit Line will be subserviced by the
                                     appropriate Subservicer on behalf of HFC,
                                     as Servicer. The Servicer will cause
                                     Interest Collections and Principal
                                     Collections to be deposited into the
                                     Collection Account, except as described
                                     herein. On the fifth Business Day prior to
                                     any Payment Date (the "Determination
                                     Date"), the Servicer will calculate, and
                                     instruct the Deposit Trust, the Issuer and
                                     the Indenture Trustee regarding the amounts
                                     to be paid, as described herein, with
                                     respect to the related Collection Period to
                                     the Noteholders. See "Description of the
                                     Securities -- Distributions on the
                                     Securities."
 
                                     As long as HFC is the Servicer it will
                                     receive, or be entitled to retain on behalf
                                     of itself and the Subservicers, a portion
                                     of the Interest Collections remaining after
                                     distribution of the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation Interest Distribution Amount
                                     and the Series 1996-2 Participation
                                     Principal Distribution Amount a monthly
                                     servicing fee (the "Servicing Fee")
                                     attributable to the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation in the amount of 2.00% per
                                     annum of the Series 1996-2 Participation
                                     Invested Amount as of the end of the
                                     related Collection Period. See "Description
                                     of the Deposit Trust -- Servicing
                                     Compensation and Payment of Expenses." In
                                     certain limited circumstances, the Servicer
                                     may resign or be removed under the Pooling
                                     and Servicing Agreement, in which event
                                     either the Deposit Trustee or, so long as
                                     it meets certain eligibility standards as
                                     set forth in the Pooling and Servicing
                                     Agreement, a third-party servicer will be
                                     appointed as a successor Servicer. In such
                                     event, the Servicing Fee will be paid to
                                     the successor Servicer from Interest
                                     Collections prior to any distributions on
                                     the Series 1996-2 Participation. See
                                     "Description of the Deposit Trust --
                                     Certain Matters Regarding the Servicer and
                                     the Seller."
 
                                     If the Servicer fails to comply in all
                                     material respects with certain
                                     representations, warranties or covenants
                                     with respect to any Credit Line and such
                                     noncompliance is not cured within a
                                     specified period after the Servicer becomes
                                     aware or receives notice thereof and such
                                     noncompliance has a material adverse effect
                                     on the Noteholders, or certain events
 
                                       18
<PAGE>   21
 
                                     of insolvency occur with respect to the
                                     Servicer, the Deposit Trustee may appoint a
                                     successor Servicer. See "Description of the
                                     Deposit Trust -- Assignment of
                                     Receivables."
 
   
FINAL PAYMENT OF PRINCIPAL;
TERMINATION......................    The Notes will mature on the earlier of the
                                     date the Notes are paid in full or on the
                                     Payment Date occurring in August 2006. In
                                     addition, the Issuer of the Notes will pay
                                     the Notes in full upon the exercise by the
                                     Seller of its option to purchase the Series
                                     1996-2 Participation after the aggregate
                                     Security Balance of the Series 1996-2
                                     Securities is reduced to an amount less
                                     than or equal to $100,039,600 (10% of the
                                     initial aggregate Security Balance of the
                                     Series 1996-2 Securities). See "Description
                                     of the Securities" -- Maturity."
    
 
MANDATORY RETRANSFER OF CERTAIN
  RECEIVABLES....................    The Seller will make certain
                                     representations and warranties with respect
                                     to the Trust Assets, the Credit Lines and
                                     the Receivables. If the Seller breaches
                                     certain of its representations and
                                     warranties with respect to any Receivable,
                                     then depending upon the representation or
                                     warranty breached, if such breach has a
                                     material adverse effect on the interest of
                                     the Noteholders and the persons holding the
                                     Certificates ("Certificateholders") and is
                                     not cured within the specified period, such
                                     Receivable will be removed from the Deposit
                                     Trust and assigned to the Seller for
                                     reassignment to the related Subservicer. In
                                     the event of a breach of certain
                                     representations and warranties in the Trust
                                     Agreement with respect to the Series 1996-2
                                     Participation and such breach has a
                                     material adverse effect on the Noteholder's
                                     and Certificateholder's interests, the
                                     Series 1996-2 Participation will be
                                     assigned to the Deposit Trust.
 
TAX STATUS.......................    Special tax counsel to the Seller is of the
                                     opinion that under existing law, the Notes
                                     will be characterized as indebtedness, and
                                     neither the Deposit Trust nor the Issuer
                                     will be characterized as an association (or
                                     publicly traded partnership) taxable as a
                                     corporation. The Seller, the Indenture
                                     Trustee, the Owner Trustee and the
                                     Noteholders will agree to treat the Notes
                                     as indebtedness for all federal, state and
                                     local income and franchise tax purposes.
                                     See "Certain Federal and State Income Tax
                                     Consequences" for additional information
                                     concerning the application of federal
                                     income tax laws.
 
ERISA CONSIDERATIONS.............    Generally a pension or an employee benefit
                                     plan (a "Plan") subject to the requirements
                                     of the Employee Retirement Income Security
                                     Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA") and the
                                     Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended
                                     (the "Code") is permitted to purchase
                                     instruments like the Notes that are debt
                                     under applicable state law and have no
                                     "substantial equity features" without
                                     reference to the prohibited transaction
                                     requirements of ERISA and the Code, absent
                                     certain circumstances described in "ERISA
                                     Considerations" herein.
 
                                       19
<PAGE>   22
 
                                     In the opinion of ERISA Counsel (as defined
                                     herein), the Notes will be classified as
                                     indebtedness without substantial equity
                                     features for ERISA purposes. However, if
                                     the Notes are deemed to be equity interests
                                     and no statutory, regulatory or
                                     administrative exemption applies, the
                                     Issuer will hold plan assets by reason of a
                                     Plan's investment in the Notes. Any Plan
                                     fiduciary considering whether to purchase
                                     any Notes on behalf of a Plan should
                                     consult with its counsel regarding the
                                     applicability of the provisions of ERISA
                                     and the Code. See "ERISA Considerations"
                                     herein.
 
RISK FACTORS.....................    Certain risks related to the Notes, the
                                     Credit Lines, the Receivables, the Deposit
                                     Trust and the Issuer are set forth in "Risk
                                     Factors" and "Deposit Trust Risk Factors"
                                     herein. Among the factors described in such
                                     sections are considerations related to: the
                                     book-entry registration of the Notes, the
                                     amortization rate of outstanding
                                     Receivables, the maturity of the Credit
                                     Lines, the servicing and administration of
                                     the Credit Lines, the insolvency of the
                                     Seller and Servicer, the dilution in voting
                                     power upon issuance of additional Series
                                     Participation Interests in the Deposit
                                     Trust, and the effect of adding additional
                                     receivables to the Deposit Trust.
 
   
LISTING..........................    Application will be made to list the Notes
                                     on the Luxembourg Stock Exchange.
    
 
   
RATING...........................    It is a condition to the issuance of each
                                     class of Notes that they be rated in at
                                     least the rating category specified below
                                     (or its equivalent) by at least two
                                     nationally recognized statistical rating
                                     organizations:
    
 
   
<TABLE>
                                             <S>                                <C>
                                             Class A-1........................    "AAA"
                                             Class A-2........................    "AA-"
                                             Class A-3........................     "A"
                                             Class B..........................    "BBB"
</TABLE>
    
 
                                     The ratings of the Notes is based primarily
                                     on the value of the Receivables, the credit
                                     quality of HFC and the terms of the Notes.
                                     There is no assurance that the rating will
                                     remain in place for any given period of
                                     time or that the ratings will not be
                                     lowered or withdrawn by the Rating
                                     Agencies.
 
                                       20
<PAGE>   23
 
                                  RISK FACTORS
 
   
     LIMITED LIQUIDITY. Application will be made to list the Notes on the
Luxembourg Stock Exchange. There is currently no market for the Notes and while
the Underwriters currently intend to make a market in the Notes, they are under
no obligation to do so. There can be no assurance that a secondary market will
develop or, if a secondary market does develop, that it will provide holders of
the Notes with liquidity of investment or that it will continue while the Notes
remain outstanding.
    
 
     Issuance of the Notes in book-entry form may reduce the liquidity of such
Notes in the secondary trading market since investors may be unwilling to
purchase Notes for which they cannot obtain physical certificates. See
"Description of the Securities -- Registration of Notes" herein.
 
     DIFFICULTY IN PLEDGING. Since transactions in the Notes can be effected
only through DTC, Cedel, Euroclear, participating organizations, indirect
participants and certain banks, the ability of a Note Owner to pledge a Note to
persons or entities that do not participate in the DTC, Cedel or Euroclear
system, or otherwise to take actions in respect of such Notes, may be limited
due to lack of a physical certificate representing the Notes. See "Description
of the Securities -- Registration of Notes" herein.
 
     POTENTIAL DELAYS IN RECEIPT OF DISTRIBUTIONS. Note Owners may experience
some delay in their receipt of distributions of interest and principal on the
Notes since such distributions will be forwarded by the Indenture Trustee to DTC
and DTC will credit such distributions to the accounts of its Participants (as
defined herein) which will thereafter credit them to the accounts of Note Owners
either directly or indirectly through indirect participants. Such delays will
decrease the yield to the Note Owners from the Notes. See "Description of the
Securities -- Registration of Notes" herein.
 
   
     NATURE OF UNDERLYING ASSETS. Payment of the Minimum Monthly Payment with
respect to the Principal Balance of a Personal Unsecured Credit Line (as defined
herein) is not expected to fully amortize such Principal Balance during the life
of the borrower. The Principal Balances of such Credit Lines are due and payable
upon the death of any borrower with respect to such a Credit Line. With respect
to Personal Homeowner Credit Lines (as defined herein), the Minimum Monthly
Payment is not, in most instances, expected to be sufficient to fully amortize
the Principal Balance of a Personal Homeowner Credit Line prior to maturity. As
a result, a borrower under a Personal Homeowner Credit Line will generally be
required to pay the entire principal amount of the Credit Line at its maturity.
The ability of a borrower to make such a payment may be dependent on the ability
to obtain refinancing of the balance due on the Credit Line. An increase in
interest rates over the Loan Rate applicable at the time the Credit Line was
originated may have an adverse effect on the borrower's ability to pay the
required Minimum Monthly Payment. In addition, such an increase in interest
rates may reduce the borrower's ability to obtain refinancing and to pay the
balance of a Personal Homeowner Credit Line at its maturity. A borrower's
payments in any month may be as low as the interest payment for such month or as
high as the entire outstanding principal balance (plus accrued interest and any
outstanding Administrative Receivables).
    
 
     CASH FLOW CONSIDERATIONS. Collections on the Credit Lines may vary because,
among other things, borrowers may make payments during any month (other than the
month in which the Credit Line matures) as low as the interest payment for such
month or as high as the outstanding balance plus accrued interest thereon.
Collections on the Credit Lines may also vary due to seasonal purchasing and
payment habits of borrowers.
 
   
     General credit risk may also be greater to Noteholders than to holders of
instruments representing interests in level payment loans since, except where
the required Minimum Monthly Payment exceeds accrued interest on the Credit
Lines or, for certain fixed rate loans an even monthly payment (which includes
principal and interest), no payment of principal is required until final
maturity. Generally, Minimum Monthly Payments will at least equal and may exceed
accrued interest. In addition, although most borrowers under Personal Homeowner
Credit Lines originated by the Subservicers historically pay down all or part of
their outstanding principal balances prior to maturity, such borrowers are under
no obligation to do so and, in the event such balances have not been
substantially paid down prior to maturity, some borrowers may find themselves
unable to make the required final payment.
    
 
                                       21
<PAGE>   24
 
     Most of the Credit Lines will not mature prior to the maturity date of the
Notes. It has been HFC's experience and is expected to be the case that
borrowers will prepay the Receivables at a sufficient rate to retire the Notes
prior to their maturity date, but no assurance can be given in this respect.
 
     PREPAYMENT CONSIDERATIONS. All of the Credit Lines may be prepaid in whole
or in part at any time. Neither the Seller nor HFC is aware of any publicly
generated studies or statistics available on the rate of prepayment of such
consumer loans. Generally, consumer loans are not viewed by borrowers as
permanent financing. Accordingly, the Credit Lines can be expected to prepay
prior to any maturity of the Credit Lines. On the other hand, because the Credit
Lines are not fully amortizing, in the absence of voluntary borrower
prepayments, the Credit Lines could experience much slower rates of principal
payment than fully amortizing loans. Actual prepayment experience may be
affected by a wide variety of factors, including general economic conditions,
interest rates and the availability of alternative financing (including from HFC
or any of its affiliates).
 
   
     NOTE RATING. The ratings of the Notes will depend primarily on an
assessment by the Rating Agencies of the underlying Credit Lines, the continued
ability of the Subservicers to originate and assign the Receivables, the
subordination of certain classes of the Notes and the Certificates and the
Overcollateralization Amount. The ratings assigned by the Rating Agencies to the
Notes are not recommendations to purchase, hold or sell the Notes, inasmuch as
such ratings do not comment as to the market price or suitability for a
particular investor. There is no assurance that the ratings will remain in place
for any given period of time or that the ratings will not be lowered or
withdrawn by the Rating Agencies if in their judgment future circumstances so
warrant, including a change in the credit ratings of HFC, or the ability of the
Subservicers to originate and assign additional Receivables to the Seller.
    
 
     CHANGE IN LOAN TERMS; DECREASE IN FINANCE CHARGES. Pursuant to the
Receivables Purchase Agreement, the Subservicer will be transferring the
Receivables and not the Credit Lines to the Seller and, consequently, pursuant
to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Seller will not be transferring the
Credit Lines to the Deposit Trust but only the Receivables arising under the
Credit Lines. As holders of the Credit Lines, the Subservicers will have the
right to determine the annual percentage rates and the fees which will be
applicable from time to time to the Credit Lines, to alter the Minimum Monthly
Payment required under the Credit Lines and to change various other terms with
respect to the Credit Lines.
 
   
     There can be no assurances that changes in applicable law, changes in the
marketplace or prudent business practice might not result in a determination by
the Subservicers to change customer finance charges or otherwise take actions
which would change other Credit Line terms. Under the Subservicers' current
policies, a change in the finance charge rate on a Credit Line (other than a
change dictated by law) will not be made without underwriting the borrower at
the new rate. Under certain circumstances, the Deposit Trustee will have the
right and may be required from time to time to require the Seller and
correspondingly, the Seller may require the Subservicers to designate from time
to time Aggregate Additional Credit Lines for inclusion in the Deposit Trust.
However, such Aggregate Additional Credit Lines may not be of the same credit
quality or have the same characteristics as the Credit Lines, the Receivables of
which have been conveyed to the Deposit Trust. See "Description of the Deposit
Trust -- Additions of Credit Lines".
    
 
     DISCOUNTED PRINCIPAL RECEIVABLES. The Seller has the right under the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement at any time to designate or redesignate a fixed
percentage (the "Discount Percentage") of the amount of Principal Receivables
assigned to the Deposit Trust that would otherwise be treated as Principal
Receivables to be treated as Finance Charge and Administrative Receivables.
Subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions, such designation may be
increased, decreased or withdrawn with respect to such Receivables. Any
applicable designation will increase the percentage of collections on the
Receivables that are allocated to Finance Charge and Administrative Collections.
This designation should also decrease the likelihood of the occurrence of an
Amortization Event. However, a designation will also reduce the aggregate amount
of receivables the Seller is thereafter selling to the Deposit Trust, which may
increase the likelihood that the Seller will not be able to add Principal
Receivables to the Deposit Trust at the times required by the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.
 
                                       22
<PAGE>   25
 
     SALE OF ASSETS; INSOLVENCY CONSIDERATIONS. The Subservicers each warrant in
the Receivables Purchase Agreement that the transfers of all Receivables
pursuant thereto to the Seller are valid sales and assignments of such
Receivables from the Subservicers to the Seller. Subservicers will file
appropriate Uniform Commercial Code ("UCC") financing statements to evidence
such sales and perfect the Seller's right, title and interest to and in such
Receivables. The Seller warranted in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement that
the transfers of the Receivables by it to the Deposit Trust pursuant to such
agreement are either valid sales and assignments of such Receivables to the
Deposit Trust or the grant to the Deposit Trust of a security interest in all
such Receivables. The Seller has warranted that if the transfers by it to the
Deposit Trust are deemed to be a grant to the Deposit Trust of a security
interest in the Receivables, the Deposit Trust will have a first priority
perfected security interest therein. The Deposit Trust has warranted that the
Issuer will either be the owner of or have a first priority perfected security
interest in the Series 1996-2 Participation. The Issuer will pledge all its
rights in the Series 1996-2 Participation to the Indenture Trustee on behalf of
the Noteholders.
 
     Each of the Subservicers and the Seller believes that the transfers of the
Receivables pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreement are true sales of the
Receivables. The Seller believes that the transfers of the Receivables pursuant
to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement are either true sales of the Receivables
to the Deposit Trust or a grant to the Deposit Trust of a security interest in
all such Receivables. However, in the event of an insolvency of a Subservicer
and/or the Seller, it is possible that a receiver, conservator or trustee in
bankruptcy could, under the federal bankruptcy laws, challenge the Seller's
and/or the Deposit Trust's right to the Receivables, and the beneficial interest
of the Issuer in the Receivables. In such event, delays in payments on the Notes
and reductions in the amount of those payments could occur. See "Certain Legal
Aspects of the Receivables -- Certain Matters Relating to Insolvency".
 
     In the event of a Servicer Default relating to the bankruptcy or insolvency
of the Servicer, and if no Servicer Default other than such bankruptcy or
insolvency-related Servicer Default exists, the bankruptcy trustee or receiver
may have the power to prevent the Deposit Trustee from appointing a successor
Servicer. If a conservator, receiver or trustee in bankruptcy were appointed for
a Subservicer, or if certain other events occur relating to the bankruptcy,
receivership or insolvency of the Seller (each such event, an "Insolvency
Event"), new Receivables would not be transferred by the Seller to the Deposit
Trust. In the event of an Insolvency Event with respect to the Seller, the
Deposit Trustee would cause a liquidation of the Receivables held by the Deposit
Trust (unless holders of Series Participation Interests aggregating more than
50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Series Participation
Interests instruct otherwise and provided that a receiver, conservator or
trustee in bankruptcy for the Seller does not order a sale despite such
instructions not to sell), which would cause an early retirement of the Notes.
The entire proceeds of such sale or liquidation of Receivables will be treated
as collections of Receivables and allocated accordingly among the Series
Participation Interests. Proceeds from the sale of the Series 1996-2
Participation will be treated as a remittance on the Series 1996-2
Participation. The Receivables and the Series 1996-2 Participation may have
limited liquidity and there can be no assurance that any can be sold for an
amount which equals or exceeds the outstanding principal amounts thereof. In the
case of the Notes, such proceeds allocable to the Noteholders will be applied as
described in "Description of the Securities -- Distributions on the Securities".
See "Description of the Securities -- Early Amortization Period" for a
discussion of other events which might lead to the commencement of an Early
Amortization Period. Upon the occurrence of an Amortization Event, if a
receiver, conservator or trustee in bankruptcy is appointed for a Subservicer or
the Seller, and no Amortization Event other than such appointment or respective
insolvency of such Subservicer or Seller exists, the receiver, conservator or
trustee may have the power to prevent the early sale or disposition of the
Receivables or the Series 1996-2 Participation and the commencement of the Early
Amortization Period. See "Certain Legal Aspects of the Receivables -- Certain
Matters Relating to Insolvency".
 
     The Seller may, by agreement with the Deposit Trustee and the Owner
Trustee, amend the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Trust Agreement to
eliminate the provisions for dissolution of the trusts created thereby upon an
Insolvency Event of the Seller if it is determined, based upon an opinion of tax
counsel, that such provisions are no longer necessary to sustain the tax
treatment of those trusts. See "Description of the Deposit Trust -- Amendment."
 
                                       23
<PAGE>   26
 
   
     Two Series Participation Interests have been previously issued by the
Deposit Trust to issuers of asset backed securities, as is contemplated by this
Prospectus. In addition, it is anticipated that other Series Participation
Interests will be the basis for the issuance of additional Series of securities
in the future. The rights of such holders to direct the voting of the related
Series Participation Interest will be governed by the documents pursuant to
which such additional series are issued and may be different from such
provisions relating to the Series 1996-2 Participation. It is not expected that
the holders of the Series 1996-2 Securities will hold voting power sufficient to
direct any action with respect to the Deposit Trust. As additional Series
Participation Interests are issued and the Series 1996-2 Participation balance
is reduced, the relative interest of the Series 1996-2 Securities in the Deposit
Trust will be reduced, thereby further reducing the voting power of such
securities.
    
 
   
     While HFC is the Servicer, cash collections held by HFC may, subject to
certain conditions, be commingled and used for the benefit of HFC prior to each
Distribution Date. In the event of the insolvency or receivership of HFC or, in
certain circumstances, the lapse of certain time periods, the Deposit Trust and
the Issuer and Indenture Trustee may not have perfected security interests in
such collections. Unless otherwise agreed to by each nationally recognized
statistical rating organization selected by the Seller to rate the Notes of any
Series or class, as specified in the applicable prospectus (each, a "Rating
Agency"), if the commercial paper rating of HFC is reduced below A-1 or P-1 by
the applicable Rating Agency, HFC will, within five Business Days, be required
to commence the deposit of collections directly into the Collection Account
within two Business Days of the day of processing.
    
 
   
     The Seller will not engage in any activities except the transactions
described herein and as contemplated by the Receivables Purchase Agreement, the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Series 1996-2 Supplement and similar
transactions and activities incidental to, or necessary or convenient to
accomplish, the foregoing. The Seller does not have any current intention to
file a voluntary petition under the Bankruptcy Code of 1978, as amended (the
"Bankruptcy Code"), or any similar applicable state law.
    
 
   
     Application of federal and state bankruptcy and debtor relief laws to any
obligors could affect the ability of the Noteholders to recover their full
investment if such laws result in any Receivables being written off as
uncollectible and the total of the Defaulted Amounts exceeds funds available
from the Overcollateralization Amount and the amounts otherwise distributable on
the Certificates.
    
 
   
     LEGAL CONSIDERATIONS. The Credit Lines and Receivables are subject to
numerous federal and state consumer protection laws which impose requirements on
the solicitation, making, enforcement and collection of consumer loans. Such
laws, as well as any new laws which may be adopted and court rulings (including,
but not limited to, federal or state interest rate caps on consumer loans), may
adversely affect the Servicer's ability to collect on the Receivables. In
addition, failure by the Servicer to comply with such requirements could
adversely affect the Servicer's ability to enforce the Credit Lines or
Receivables.
    
 
     Pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, if the interest of the
Deposit Trust, and consequently the Noteholders, in a Receivable is materially
adversely affected by the failure of the related Credit Line to comply in all
material respects with applicable requirements of law, all Receivables in the
affected Credit Line will be reassigned to the Seller, or, in some
circumstances, to the Servicer. Pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement,
the Seller will make certain other representations and warranties relating to
the validity and enforceability of the Credit Lines and the Receivables.
However, it is not anticipated that the Deposit Trustee or Indenture Trustee
will make any examination of the Credit Line Agreements or the records relating
thereto for the purpose of establishing the presence or absence of defects,
compliance with such representations and warranties, or for any other purpose.
The sole remedy, if any such representation or warranty is breached and such
breach has a material adverse effect on the interest of Noteholders in any
Receivable and continues beyond the applicable cure period, is that the
Receivables affected thereby will be reassigned to the Seller or assigned to the
Servicer, as the case may be. In addition, in the event of the breach of certain
representations and warranties, the Seller may be obligated to accept the
reassignment of the entire Deposit Trust portfolio. See "Description of the
Deposit Trust -- Representations and Warranties".
 
                                       24
<PAGE>   27
 
     Applicable state laws generally regulate interest rates and other charges,
require certain disclosures, and may require licensing of the Subservicers. In
addition, many states have other laws, such as consumer protection laws, unfair
and deceptive practices acts and debt collection practices acts which may apply
to the origination or collection of the Credit Lines and Receivables. Depending
on the provisions of the applicable law, violations of these laws may limit the
ability of the Subservicers to collect all or part of the principal of or
interest on the Credit Lines, may entitle the borrower to a refund of amounts
previously paid and, in addition, could subject the Subservicers, Seller and
possibly the Deposit Trust to damages and administrative enforcement.
 
     The Credit Lines will also be subject to federal laws, including: (i) the
Federal Truth-in-Lending Act and Regulation Z promulgated thereunder, which
require certain disclosures to the borrowers regarding the terms of the Credit
Lines and related Credit Line Agreements; (ii) the Equal Credit Opportunity Act
and Regulation B promulgated thereunder, which prohibit discrimination on the
basis of age, race, color, sex, religion, marital status, national origin,
receipt of public assistance or the exercise of any right under the Consumer
Credit Protection Act, in the extension of credit; and (iii) the Fair Credit
Reporting Act, which regulates the use and reporting of information related to
the borrower's credit experience.
 
     Violations of certain provisions of these federal laws may limit the
ability of the Subservicers and the Deposit Trust to collect all or part of the
principal of or interest on the Credit Lines and in addition could subject the
Subservicers to damages and administrative enforcement and possibly the Seller
or the Deposit Trust.
 
   
     GENERATION OF ADDITIONAL RECEIVABLES; DEPENDENCY ON BORROWER
REPAYMENTS. The full payment of the Security Balance of each class of Notes is
dependent on borrower repayments. A decrease in the effective yield on the
Receivables due to, among other things, an increase in the level of
delinquencies could result in decreased protection to Noteholders against
defaults under the Credit Lines. Further, the Receivables may be paid at any
time by the obligors thereof and there is no assurance that there will be
additional Receivables created under the Credit Lines, that Receivables will be
added to the Deposit Trust or that any particular pattern of borrower repayments
will occur.
    
 
   
     SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION. The Trust Assets consist primarily of the
Series 1996-2 Participation, which is an undivided beneficial interest in the
Receivables held by the Deposit Trust. As a beneficial interest, it does not
grant the Owner Trustee, the Indenture Trustee or the Noteholders any direct
rights with respect to the Receivables. Rather, it grants the Issuer, on behalf
of the Certificateholders, rights against the Deposit Trust which the Issuer has
pledged to the Indenture Trustee on behalf of the Noteholders. The Deposit
Trustee has covenanted that it will enforce its rights and perform its covenants
under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and will cause the Seller to enforce
its rights and perform its covenants under the Receivables Purchase Agreement.
In the event the Issuer lacks sufficient funds to make payments due Noteholders,
and such lack of funds does not result from a default by the Servicer, Seller,
Owner Trustee or Deposit Trustee, there will be no recourse under the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement other than to rely upon the Servicer to pursue the
remedies available under the Credit Lines against obligors. Although it is
expected that the payment in final reduction of the Series 1996-2 Participation
will occur prior to the Distribution Date in August 2006, no assurance can be
given in this respect, and failure to receive final payment by such date will
not by itself create any additional rights or remedies under the Series 1996-2
Participation. In the event final payment in reduction of the Series 1996-2
Participation is not made by such date, an Event of Default will occur under the
Indenture. See "Description of the Securities -- Events of Default" herein.
Further, in the event of a bankruptcy of the Seller or the Deposit Trust, delays
or reductions in payments on the Series 1996-2 Participation and other adverse
consequences could result. See "Certain Legal Aspects of the Receivables --
Certain Matters Relating to Insolvency."
    
 
   
     SOCIAL, LEGAL, ECONOMIC AND OTHER FACTORS. Changes in borrowing and payment
patterns by borrowers result from a variety of social, legal and economic
factors. Economic factors include the rate of inflation, unemployment levels,
tax law changes and relative interest rates. The Seller and the Subservicers are
unable to determine and have no basis to predict whether or to what extent tax
law changes or other economic or social factors will affect credit line use or
repayment patterns. See "The Revolving Consumer Credit Lines."
    
 
                                       25
<PAGE>   28
 
   
As of the date of this Prospectus, 21.54% (by Principal Balance) of the
Receivables were generated under Credit Lines originated by subservicer branch
offices located in California. In the event economic conditions in a geographic
area representing a higher portion of the Pool Balance (such as California) are
weaker than other areas of the country, a higher rate of delinquency and/or
charge-off may result.
    
 
                           DEPOSIT TRUST RISK FACTORS
 
     ISSUANCE OF ADDITIONAL SERIES. The Issuer's principal asset will be the
Series 1996-2 Participation in the cash flows on the Receivables held by the
Deposit Trust. The Series 1996-2 Participation represents an undivided
beneficial interest in the Interest Collections (which include Recoveries) and
Principal Collections received during each Collection Period.
 
   
     In September 1995 and March 1996, the Seller caused trusts to be formed and
Series Participation Interests in the Deposit Trust were issued and sold to such
trusts to support Series of asset-backed securities. The Seller is expected to
cause additional trusts to be formed from time to time to issue additional
Series of Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Notes or other securities. Series
Participation Interests in the assets of the Deposit Trust are expected to be
the primary or sole assets of those trusts. The terms of each Series
Participation Interest, and therefore, the terms of any additional Series, will
not be subject to the prior review or consent of holders of any other Series,
including the Series 1996-2 Securityholders. Such terms may include methods for
determining applicable participation percentages and allocating collections and
provisions creating different or additional security or other credit
enhancements. The obligation of the Deposit Trustee to issue any Series
Participation Interest supporting a new trust and Series is subject to the
following conditions, among others: (a) such issuance will not result in any
Rating Agency reducing or withdrawing its then existing rating of the Notes of
any outstanding Series or class with respect to which it is a Rating Agency (the
notification in writing by each Rating Agency to the Seller, the Servicer and
the Deposit Trustee that any action will not result in such a reduction or
withdrawal is referred to herein as the "Rating Agency Condition") and (b) the
Seller shall have delivered to the Deposit Trustee a certificate of any
authorized officer to the effect that, in the reasonable belief of the Seller,
such issuance will not have an Adverse Effect. The issuance of such Series
Participation Interests will reduce the voting power of the Securityholders and
may reduce such power to the point that the Securityholders will not be able to
direct action with respect to the Deposit Trust.
    
 
     ADDITION OF ASSETS TO THE DEPOSIT TRUST. Under certain circumstances, as
more fully described below, the Seller is permitted in its discretion to
designate certain additional Credit Lines to the Deposit Trust. When a Credit
Line is designated, the respective Subservicer's records are revised to reflect
the designation and effective with such designation all outstanding receivables
under the Credit Line as of the date of designation are assigned by the
applicable Subservicer to the Seller and by the Seller to the Deposit Trust. All
receivables subsequently arising under a designated Credit Line will also be
assigned to the Seller and in turn, to the Deposit Trust. The Seller may
designate Credit Lines to the Deposit Trust in two ways. As required by the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement, New Credit Lines (as defined below) are
expected to be substantially similar to the Credit Lines currently designated to
the Deposit Trust. New Credit Lines may be designated to the Deposit Trust
without regard to the satisfaction of the Rating Agency Condition; however, the
number of Credit Lines that may be so designated is limited, as described below.
Subject to the Rating Agency Condition and certain other requirements, the
Seller is permitted to designate other credit lines (other than New Credit
Lines) as Credit Lines, the receivables from which will be conveyed to the
Deposit Trust. Such other credit lines are referred to herein as "Additional
Credit Lines." New Credit Lines and Additional Credit Lines are collectively
referred to herein as "Aggregate Additional Credit Lines." The Seller expects to
convey from time to time to the Deposit Trust the receivables arising under
certain Aggregate Additional Credit Lines in accordance with the provisions of
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.
 
     The Receivables which arise under Aggregate Additional Credit Lines
assigned to the Deposit Trust may have different characteristics than the
Receivables currently assigned to the Deposit Trust. The Credit Lines which are
subsequently assigned to the Deposit Trust will be Eligible Credit Lines, but
may be subject to different origination criteria than the Credit Lines
designated to the Deposit Trust on the date of this
 
                                       26
<PAGE>   29
 
Prospectus because they were originated at a later date or were acquired from
another originator of consumer loans. In addition, Aggregate Additional Credit
Lines may have different terms than the existing Credit Lines, including lower
periodic finance charges, which may have the effect of reducing the average
yield on the Credit Lines currently designated to the Deposit Trust.
 
   
     "New Credit Lines" may be designated in accordance with the following
limitations and conditions. First, a New Credit Line must be an Eligible Credit
Line of a type which (i) was designated to the Deposit Trust as an Initial
Credit Line or (ii) was previously designated to the Deposit Trust as an
Additional Credit Line provided that in the assignment related to such addition
of Credit Lines, the Seller warranted that such type of revolving credit lines
are permitted to be designated as New Credit Lines. Second, unless each
applicable Rating Agency otherwise consents, the number and balance of New
Credit Lines designated as Credit Lines with respect to any of the three
consecutive Collection Periods shall not exceed 15% of the number and balance of
the Credit Lines as of the first day of such three month period and the number
and balance of New Credit Lines designated during any consecutive twelve month
period shall not exceed 20% of the number and balance of the Credit Lines as of
the first day of such twelve consecutive month period. Third, the Seller shall
deliver to the Trustee, at least semi-annually, an opinion of counsel with
respect to the New Credit Lines included as Credit Lines confirming the validity
and perfection of each transfer of such New Credit Lines. If such opinion of
counsel with respect to any New Credit Lines is not so received, all Receivables
arising in the New Credit Lines to which such failure relates will be removed
from the Deposit Trust. Fourth, the Seller will designate New Credit Lines
subject to the conditions, among others, that (i) the conveyance of the
Receivables therein will not result in the occurrence of any Amortization Event
and (ii) such conveyance shall not have been made in contemplation of an
Insolvency Event with respect to the Seller or the applicable Subservicer.
    
 
     "Eligible Credit Line" means (a) a revolving consumer credit line owned by
(i) a Subservicer and its respective successors and assigns and/or any
transferee of the credit lines from any such entity or any other originator of
credit lines which enters into a receivables purchase agreement with the Seller
or any additional Seller and (ii) which, as of the respective date of
designation, is in existence and maintained by a Subservicer or such successors,
transferees or originator, is payable in United States dollars, has an obligor
whose address is in the United States, has an obligor who has not been
identified as being involved in any voluntary or involuntary bankruptcy
proceeding, has not been sold or pledged to any other party except for any
transferee referred to above and does not have receivables which have been sold
or pledged to any other party and has not been charged-off; or (b) any other
credit line acceptable to the Rating Agency.
 
     The Seller will also be permitted to designate Eligible Credit Lines as
Additional Credit Lines under the following conditions, among others. First,
except in the limited circumstances described below, Additional Credit Lines
must be revolving consumer credit lines established pursuant to a credit line
agreement between a Subservicer or any additional seller and the person or
persons obligated to make payments thereunder, which are designated by the
Seller to be included as Additional Credit Lines. Second, such addition must
satisfy the Rating Agency Condition. Third, the Seller must deliver to the
Deposit Trustee a certificate of an authorized officer to the effect that, in
the reasonable belief of the Seller, such addition will not have any Adverse
Effect.
 
                          THE SELLER AND SUBSERVICERS
 
     The Seller was incorporated under the laws of the State of Nevada on July
27, 1995 and is a wholly-owned special purpose subsidiary of HFC. The Seller was
organized for the limited purposes of engaging in the type of transactions
described herein and other similar transactions and any activities incidental to
and necessary or convenient for the accomplishment of such purposes. Neither
HFC's nor the Seller's board of directors intends to change the business purpose
of the Seller. The Seller's principal executive office is located at 1111 Town
Center Road, Las Vegas, Nevada 89134.
 
   
     The Subservicers are wholly-owned subsidiaries of HFC that are licensed,
where required, to make revolving consumer credit line loans in the states in
which the Credit Lines are originated. These companies originate revolving
consumer credit line loans and, in some cases, other types of secured and
unsecured
    
 
                                       27
<PAGE>   30
 
consumer loans from branch offices located in the states in which they are
licensed to do business and with respect to telemarketing and direct mail
solicitations, from a centralized facility.
 
     Each Receivable will be sold to the Deposit Trust by the Seller at a price
equal to its balance as of the date it is assigned to the Deposit Trust plus the
excess spread for such Credit Line less the Principal Discount applicable
thereto, if any, and will be subserviced by the appropriate Subservicer on
behalf of HFC as Servicer. The Servicer will be entitled to retain, on behalf of
itself and the Subservicers, the Servicing Fee.
 
                                  THE SERVICER
 
     HFC was incorporated in Delaware in 1925, as successor to an enterprise
which traces its origin through the same ownership to an office established in
1878. HFC will be responsible for acting as the Servicer for the Credit Lines.
HFC is a subsidiary of Household International, Inc. The address of its
principal executive office is 2700 Sanders Road, Prospect Heights, Illinois
60070. Its telephone number is (847) 564-5000.
 
   
     HFC and its subsidiaries offer a diversified range of financial services.
Their principal business is the making of cash loans, including secured and
unsecured consumer loans and home equity loans secured by first and second
mortgages, directly to consumers in the United States. Loans are made through
branch lending offices and by direct mail or telemarketing. HFC, through banking
subsidiaries, also offers both VISA* and MasterCard* credit cards to residents
throughout the United States.
    
 
     In conjunction with its consumer finance operations and where applicable
laws permit, HFC makes available to customers credit life, credit accident and
health, and household contents insurance. Credit life and credit accident and
health insurance are generally directly written by or reinsured with HFC's
insurance subsidiary, Household Life Insurance Company.
 
     Through a subsidiary, HFC is also engaged in commercial finance, including
leveraged leases, privately-placed limited-term preferred stocks, equipment
loans and leases and corporate and acquisition finance.
 
   
     As of June 30, 1996, HFC had approximately $20.1 billion in total assets,
approximately $17.8 billion in total liabilities and approximately $2.3 billion
in shareholder's equity.
    
 
                                USE OF PROCEEDS
 
     The net proceeds to be received from the sale of the Notes and the
Certificates will be used by the Seller for general corporate purposes.
 
   
                    THE HFC REVOLVING CONSUMER CREDIT LINES
    
 
GENERAL
 
   
     HFC and its subsidiaries originate various consumer loan products which are
of two basic types. "Personal Unsecured Credit Lines" are fixed or variable rate
revolving unsecured lines of credit which are accessed through personalized
checks issued to borrowers. "Personal Homeowner Credit Lines" are fixed or
variable rate revolving lines of credit which are also accessed through
personalized checks issued to borrowers. Personal Homeowner Credit Lines are
secured by a security interest filed against the borrower's home; however,
generally no independent appraisal of property value or title search is
performed and no title insurance is obtained to insure HFC's interest in the
property. Because an appraisal or title insurance is not generally required to
be obtained with respect to Personal Homeowner Credit Lines and applications for
such credit lines are underwritten using guidelines for unsecured lines, HFC
services such loans as an unsecured product. Because such Credit Lines are
serviced as unsecured, under the Servicing Guidelines (as defined herein), as
requested by a borrower, Subservicers will subordinate any lien to any
subsequent lien on the property.
    
 
- ---------------
 
* VISA and MasterCard are registered trademarks of VISA USA, Inc. and MasterCard
International
 Incorporated, respectively.
 
                                       28
<PAGE>   31
 
   
     Unsecured consumer loans, such as the Personal Unsecured Credit Lines, have
been originated by HFC and its subsidiaries for in excess of 100 years and
Personal Homeowner Credit Lines have been originated by HFC and its subsidiaries
since 1989. As of June 30, 1996, HFC and its subsidiaries had approximately $4.5
billion aggregate amount of such outstanding credit line receivables, including
receivables sold with servicing performed by HFC and its subsidiaries.
    
 
   
     Prospective applicants for HFC's and its subsidiaries' consumer credit line
products are solicited in a variety of methods including branch office sales
efforts and direct mail and telemarketing solicitations. The direct mailings
include pre-approved credit lines to consumers who may or may not be current or
former customers of HFC or its affiliates.
    
 
   
UNDERWRITING PROCEDURES RELATING TO THE REVOLVING CONSUMER CREDIT LINES
    
 
   
     With respect to consumer credit line applications received by HFC or its
subsidiaries, each application is subjected to a direct credit investigation by
the related Subservicer prior to the extension of credit. This investigation
generally includes (i) obtaining and reviewing an independent credit bureau
report, (ii) verifying ownership of the property and any senior mortgage balance
(in the case of a Personal Homeowner Credit Line), (iii) verifying payment
history, which may be obtained from credit bureau information, provided it has
been updated within two months of the application or, in the case of a Personal
Homeowner Credit Line, if the credit bureau information has not been updated
within two months of the application, it may be obtained in writing or by
telephone from the holder of any senior lien, and (iv) verification of
employment, which may include obtaining a W-2 form or paystub, a minimum of two
years of tax returns for self-employed individuals or other written or telephone
verification with employers.
    
 
   
     After this investigation is conducted, a decision is made to accept or
reject the application. A limit on the amount of credit to be extended to the
borrower is assigned based on the borrower's ability to pay (a "Credit Limit").
Under current policies, the maximum Credit Limits which may be assigned to
Personal Homeowner Credit Lines and to Personal Unsecured Credit Lines are
$25,000 and $15,000, respectively. However, within certain parameters
established by the Subservicers, borrowers may exceed their Credit Limits by the
lesser of $1,000 or 10% of their Credit Limit. Generally, all prospective
borrowers must have a debt-to-income ratio of no greater than 45% but such
limitation may be waived by management. In no event, may the debt to income
ratio exceed 60%. For purposes of calculating the debt to income ratio, debt is
defined as the sum of any mortgage payment, including escrow payments for the
hazard insurance premium, real estate taxes, mortgage insurance premium, owners
association dues and ground rents, plus payments on installment and revolving
debt (including payments on the consumer credit line computed based on the
Credit Limit applied for at the then current Loan Rate) that extends beyond 10
months, and alimony, child support or maintenance payments, and income is
defined as stable monthly gross income from the borrower's primary source of
employment, plus acceptable secondary income.
    
 
     With respect to solicitations of prospective customers for a pre-approved
credit line who have no existing credit relationship with HFC or its affiliates,
selection is made based upon certain information obtained through proprietary
and acquired databases, which information includes credit history and income
levels. The Credit Limit for a pre-approved credit line to a borrower with no
existing credit relationship with HFC is initially established at an amount not
in excess of $5,000 and may be increased following a complete evaluation by HFC
or its subsidiary of an updated credit bureau report and verification of certain
other information, as discussed above with respect to consumer generated credit
line applications.
 
   
     Existing customers of HFC and its affiliates, and prospective customers
with no existing relationship with HFC or its affiliates, may receive
pre-approved credit lines which may be activated by cashing a check enclosed in
the notice of pre-approval sent to the borrower. The determination as to which
existing and prospective customers will receive a pre-approved line of credit
and the amount of the Credit Limit are made based upon available credit
information using the same criteria discussed above with respect to consumer
generated applications and, in the case of existing customers, consideration of
prior payment history with HFC and its affiliates.
    
 
                                       29
<PAGE>   32
 
   
REVOLVING CONSUMER CREDIT LINE TERMS
    
 
     The borrower may access the revolving line of credit by writing a check or
by cashing a check issued by the Subservicer to the borrower. The "Minimum
Monthly Payment" for each Credit Line is the greatest of (i) a specified
percentage (which generally ranges between 1.43% and 3.40% of the Principal
Balance depending upon the state in which the loan was originated, the related
interest rate and the actual loan product) of the principal balance of the
Credit Line, plus late charge fees, bad check fees and other fees (the
"Administrative Charges") and credit insurance charges, (ii) a designated
minimum dollar amount, which is generally $25 plus Administrative Charges and
credit insurance charges, (iii) the amount of accrued interest during the
related billing cycle plus Administrative Charges and credit insurance charges
and (iv) the amount of the annual fee assessed on the credit line. However, in
some instances, the Minimum Monthly Payment may exceed the formula set forth
above. A borrower's minimum monthly payment is due on a fixed date each month
which is between 22 and 25 days after the Cycle Date for the borrower's
particular Credit Line. "Cycle Dates" for the Credit Lines are the 4th, 5th,
6th, 8th, 10th, 11th, 12th, 16th, 17th, 18th, 19th, 20th, 25th and 26th of every
month. For example, if the Cycle Date for a Credit Line is on the 5th day of the
month, an update of the Credit Line is completed at the close of business on the
5th. A detailed listing of all debits and credits along with the Minimum Monthly
Payment and available line of credit is listed on the borrower's billing
statement. The billing statement would be sent to the borrower on the 5th and
payment would be due on the 27th of the month.
 
   
     "Variable Rate Credit Lines" bear interest at rates which may change from
month to month subject to maximum and minimum per annum rates, if any, specified
in the Credit Line Agreement. The monthly periodic rate (the "Loan Rate") for a
Variable Rate Credit Line is one-twelfth of the sum of the Index Rate (as
defined below) plus a certain spread (the "Margin"), generally ranging from 9.9%
to 17.9%. The Loan Rate assigned to each "Fixed Rate Credit Line" is a fixed
rate generally ranging from 18.0% to 27.9%. The variable or fixed rates of
interest charged on a revolving consumer line of credit are determined by the
overall qualification of the borrower and market conditions. Interest on the
revolving consumer lines of credit is payable at the Loan Rate monthly in
arrears on the average daily outstanding principal balance.
    
 
     For Variable Rate Credit Lines, the "Index Rate" during a billing cycle is
the "prime rate" published by The Wall Street Journal on the first publication
date of the month in which the related billing cycle begins. If a prime rate
range is published, then the average of that range will be used for Credit Lines
established prior to October 1, 1991 and for most other Credit Lines established
after October 1, 1991 the highest rate in such range will be used. When a change
in the prime rate is published, a change in the Loan Rate will take effect on
the first day of the billing cycle following the date of the published change
and the new Loan Rate will apply to new loans and charges, as well as to the
existing Loan Balance. The Credit Line Agreements further provide that in the
event of a change in law or any court ruling that prohibits a Subservicer from
using the Index Rate, or if the publication of the Index Rate is discontinued,
the related Subservicer will change the Index Rate upon notification of such
event in accordance with the Credit Line Agreement.
 
     Principal amounts may be drawn upon (up to the Credit Limit of the Credit
Line, and in certain cases in excess of the Credit Limit) from time to time.
Except for any amortization of principal which may occur as a result of the
required Minimum Monthly Payments, there are no required payments of principal,
except that the outstanding principal amount of Personal Homeowner Credit Lines
will be due fifteen years from origination. Other than Personal Unsecured Credit
Lines originated in Arizona which have a maximum maturity of 20 years, assuming
no further draws and payment of the Minimum Monthly Payment, Personal Unsecured
Credit Lines will not be fully amortized during the life of the borrowers. The
Principal Balances of such Credit Lines will be due upon the death of any
borrower with respect to such a Credit Line. However, based upon the
Subservicers' experience it is expected that borrowers will generally pay off
all balances during their lifetime. See "Risk Factors -- Cash Flow
Considerations" herein. The Loan Rate for a Variable Rate Credit Line will in no
event exceed the maximum rate permitted under applicable state law. With the
exception of Credit Lines originated to Arizona borrowers, the Variable Rate
Credit Lines have no periodic interest rate adjustment caps. The Loan Rate for
Arizona Variable Rate Credit Lines may not increase or decrease in excess of
three percentage points during any 12 month period or more than seven percentage
points over the life of the Credit Line.
 
                                       30
<PAGE>   33
 
     The Subservicers will have the right under each Credit Line, on prior
notice, to change its terms, subject to complying with applicable law. Changes
may apply to both new and outstanding balances unless prohibited by applicable
law. However, termination of a borrower's Credit Limit generally will occur only
as provided below. The Deposit Trust will not have the right to amend or require
amendments to the Credit Lines.
 
   
     The Subservicers will also have the right to employ certain promotions with
respect to the Credit Lines. These promotions will be offered to certain
preferred customers who meet payment and credit history criteria established by
the Subservicers from time to time. These promotions may be offered periodically
but are not expected to be offered more than twice a year to the qualifying
borrowers. The promotions may include programs under which the applicable
Subservicer will make Minimum Monthly Payments on behalf of the borrowers or
will permit the borrowers to not make Minimum Monthly Payments without being
accessed a late charge or considered delinquent. In the event a borrower is not
required to make a Minimum Monthly Payment and no Subservicer payment is made on
behalf of the borrower, interest will accrue on the Credit Line during such
month and will be added to the Principal Balance of the Credit Line. The effect
of this promotion will be to increase the accrued yield on the Receivables and
to decrease collections during the month in which the holiday is in effect. It
is not expected that any promotional programs offered by the Subservicers will
have an adverse impact on Securityholders.
    
 
     The Subservicers will have the right to require the borrower to pay the
entire balance plus all other accrued but unpaid charges immediately and to
cancel any credit privileges under the Credit Line Agreement if, among other
things, the borrower fails to make one or more payments when due under a
Personal Unsecured Credit Line, or two or more payments when due under a
Personal Homeowner Credit Line, the borrower has provided false, misleading or
incorrect material information to the Subservicer, frequent advances are
requested by the borrower over the Credit Limit, the borrower dies, a bankruptcy
petition is filed by or against the borrower or the borrower defaults under the
Credit Line Agreement. In addition, with respect to Personal Homeowner Credit
Lines, Subservicers may accelerate the entire balance and all other charges and
cancel credit privileges if the borrower sells any interest in the property
securing a Personal Homeowner Credit Line (including the creation of a
subordinate lien), foreclosure or condemnation proceedings are instituted on the
property by any lien holder or governmental agency, the borrower incurs any lien
on the property which adversely affect the property or the Subservicer's rights
in the property or the borrower fails to maintain the property, fails to pay the
real estate taxes on the property, fails to keep the property insured, or
abandons the property. Additionally, with respect to Personal Homeowner Credit
Lines, the Subservicers will have the right to reduce the Credit Limit or
prohibit additional advances under the Credit Line Agreement if, among other
things, a material change in the financial condition of the borrower has
occurred, the maximum annual percentage rate under the Credit Line Agreement is
attained, or any borrower under the Credit Line Agreement so requests.
 
     In the event of a default on a mortgage that is senior to any Personal
Homeowner Credit Line, the related Subservicer will have the right in many
states to satisfy the defaulted senior mortgage in full or cure such default and
bring the defaulted senior mortgage current, in either event adding any amounts
expended in connection with such satisfaction or cure to the then current loan
balance for such Credit Line. However, it is not expected that the Subservicers
will take such action with respect to any Personal Homeowner Credit Line, and
the Deposit Trustee does not have the right to require the Subservicers to do
so.
 
   
SERVICING OF REVOLVING CONSUMER CREDIT LINES
    
 
   
     HFC will be responsible for servicing the Credit Lines for the Deposit
Trust. The Subservicers will perform the servicing activities on behalf of HFC
in accordance with HFC's policies and procedures for servicing revolving
consumer credit lines.
    
 
     Servicing activities, including collection on delinquent credit lines, is
performed by or on behalf of the Subservicers from facilities in California,
Illinois, and Maryland. Following charge-off of a delinquent credit line,
collection efforts are performed by a subsidiary of the Servicer located in
Virginia. In the effort to collect upon delinquent credit lines, attempts are
made to contact the borrower to determine both ability and intent to
 
                                       31
<PAGE>   34
 
   
pay. In accordance with the policies and procedures of HFC and the Subservicers
regarding the servicing of credit lines (the "Servicing Guidelines") and
reasonable commercial practice, appropriate action may be taken in the
discretion of the Subservicer, including, but not limited to, extended payment
arrangements, forbearance, deferment pending a change in circumstances, referral
for legal action and account restructuring. A credit line is considered
contractually delinquent if less than 50% of any Minimum Monthly Payment due
from a borrower has not been received by the Subservicer or if the borrower has
submitted three consecutive payments each of which are greater than 50% but less
than 100% of the Minimum Monthly Payment then due. Generally, credit lines that
are in excess of 31 days delinquent may be restructured once during a six month
period after the borrower makes, in one or more payments, at least 95% of one
Minimum Monthly Payment in either the current or prior month. If partial
payments are aggregated, all such payments must be made within a 30 day period.
When a credit line is restructured, it is no longer considered delinquent. Under
the Subservicers' current Servicing Guidelines, effective January 1, 1996, a
credit line is generally charged off when it becomes 300 days contractually
delinquent and the aggregate of all payments made in any two consecutive months
during the last six calendar months was not greater than or equal to 50% of a
Minimum Monthly Payment, or in any event, when it becomes 570 days contractually
delinquent, regardless of any partial payments received in prior months (the
"Recency Charge-off Policy"). Prior to implementation of the Recency Charge-off
Policy on January 1, 1996, in all states other than California, Colorado,
Illinois and Missouri, a credit line was generally charged-off when it became
300 days contractually delinquent. During various periods in 1995, the
Subservicers tested alternative charge-off policies in the four states listed
above in anticipation of employing a revised uniform policy. From April 1, 1995
to September 1, 1995, for all credit lines originated in Colorado and Illinois
and from May 1, 1995 to September 1, 1995 for credit lines originated in
Missouri, a charge-off policy was employed under which a credit line was
charged-off if it became contractually delinquent and when all payments received
during the prior 180 days did not aggregate to at least 50% of one Minimum
Monthly Payment. From September 1, 1995 to December 31, 1995, for credit lines
originated in California, Colorado, Illinois and Missouri, the Recency
Charge-off Policy was employed.
    
 
     The Servicer has the option to repurchase from the Deposit Trust all
Receivables which are delinquent prior to the date such Receivables would be
charged-off. Such repurchase will be accomplished by deducting the balance
thereof from the Seller's Trust Amount, provided that the Seller's Trust Amount
would not be reduced below 1.01% of the aggregate invested amounts of all Series
Participation Interests.
 
     Once a credit line has been charged-off, it is deemed removed from the
Deposit Trust by the Seller. In such case, the Subservicer may assign the credit
line to a collection agency or initiate legal action for collection. Amounts
collected or received with respect to Defaulted Credit Lines, net of costs and
expenses of recovery ("Recoveries") will be deposited into the Collection
Account.
 
   
     The delinquency and charge-off policies and collection practices discussed
herein may change over time in accordance with the Servicer's business judgment,
changes in the Subservicers' revolving consumer credit line agreements,
applicable laws and regulations, and other considerations.
    
 
   
     The information in the tables below has not been adjusted to eliminate the
effect of the significant growth in the size of HFC's and its subsidiaries'
revolving consumer credit line portfolio during the periods shown. Accordingly,
loss and delinquency as percentages of Receivables serviced for each period
would be higher than those shown if a group of Credit Lines were artificially
isolated at a point in time and the information showed the activity only in that
isolated group. The tables below present revolving consumer credit line data
applicable to substantially all of the United States operations of HFC,
including loans managed in states which are not represented in the pool
consisting of the Credit Lines and include loans sold with servicing performed
by HFC and its subsidiaries. It should be noted that if the charge-off policy
currently employed had been applied during the periods shown below, the
historical delinquency rates reported would be higher, while the historical
    
 
                                       32
<PAGE>   35
 
charge-off rates reported would be reduced without any improvement of the actual
payment experience in the related Credit Lines.
 
   
                         REVOLVING CONSUMER CREDIT LINE
    
                             DELINQUENCY EXPERIENCE
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                       FIVE MONTHS
                                                         YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,                          ENDED
                                      --------------------------------------------------------------     MAY 31,
                                         1991         1992         1993         1994       1995(1)      1996(1)(2)
                                      ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ----------   ------------
                                                                 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                   <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>
Number of credit lines managed(3)...     612,490      572,346      559,880      669,687      713,802       724,139
Aggregate receivable balance of
  credit lines managed..............  $2,179,968   $2,190,537   $2,356,840   $3,067,112   $3,790,410    $4,193,009
Receivable balance of credit lines
  2-3 payments past due.............  $   80,751   $   71,233   $   65,929   $   76,756   $  110,447    $  101,965
Receivable balance of credit lines
  3+ payments past due..............  $  162,911   $  149,526   $  132,913   $  137,899   $  192,347    $  228,175
Receivable balance of credit lines
  2+ payments past due..............  $  211,534   $  193,182   $  173,849   $  185,028   $  258,089    $  290,205
Receivable balance of credit lines
  2+ payments past due as a
  percentage of aggregate receivable
  balance of credit lines managed...        9.70%        8.82%        7.38%        6.03%        6.81%        6.92%
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) Based upon the contractual delinquency and the charge-off policies employed
    by the Subservicers as described on pages 31-32.
    
 
(2) Percentage annualized.
 
(3) "Credit lines managed" includes credit lines owned and credit lines serviced
    with limited recourse.
 
                                       33
<PAGE>   36
 
   
                         REVOLVING CONSUMER CREDIT LINE
    
                          GROSS CHARGE-OFF EXPERIENCE
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                      FIVE MONTHS
                                                     YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,                             ENDED
                                ------------------------------------------------------------------      MAY 31,
                                   1991          1992          1993          1994        1995(1)      1996(1)(2)
                                ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    -----------
                                                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                             <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
Number of credit lines
  managed(3)..................     612,490       572,346       559,880       669,687       713,802       724,139
Gross charge-offs.............  $  137,329    $  182,563    $  162,654    $  145,481    $  168,337    $   90,709
Average receivable
  balance(4)..................  $2,083,028    $2,174,470    $2,241,992    $2,587,639    $3,467,095    $4,004,587
Gross charge-offs
  percentage(5)...............        6.59%         8.40%         7.25%         5.62%         4.86%         5.44 %
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) Based upon the contractual delinquency and the charge-off policies employed
    by the Subservicers as described on pages 31-32.
    
 
(2) Percentage annualized.
 
(3) "Credit lines managed" includes credit lines owned and credit lines serviced
with limited recourse.
 
(4) Average receivable balance is the average of the monthly average receivable
balances.
 
(5) Gross charge-offs as a percentage of the average receivable balance.
 
   
     The revenues for HFC's and its subsidiaries' consumer credit line portfolio
from finance charges and fees collected from borrowers are set forth in the
following table for each of the periods shown.
    
 
     The historical revenue figures in the table include interest and fees
collected during the cycle. Cash collections on the Receivables may not reflect
the historical experience in the table.
 
   
                         REVOLVING CONSUMER CREDIT LINE
    
                      REVENUE EXPERIENCE FOR THE PORTFOLIO
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                      FIVE MONTHS
                                                     YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,                             ENDED
                                ------------------------------------------------------------------      MAY 31,
                                   1991          1992          1993          1994          1995         1996(1)
                                ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    ----------    -----------
<S>                             <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>
                                                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
Average receivable
  balance(2).................   $2,083,028    $2,174,470    $2,241,992    $2,587,639    $3,467,095    $4,004,587
Total Finance Charges and
  Fees collected.............   $  395,279    $  395,979    $  392,569    $  443,115    $  617,422    $  291,526
Total Finance Charges and
  Fees collected as a
  percentage of average
  receivables balance(3).....        18.98%        18.21%        17.51%        17.12%        17.81%        17.47 %
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
(1) Percentage annualized.
 
(2) Average receivable balance is the average of the monthly average receivable
    balance.
 
(3) Represents finance charges and fees collected divided by average receivable
    outstanding.
 
   
     The revenues for the HFC consumer credit line portfolio shown in the tables
above are related to finance charges, together with fees, collected from
borrowers. Charges accrued and billed generally would be higher, if shown, than
amounts collected. Revenues related to finance charges and fees also depend on
the types of charges and fees assessed on the credit lines in the Portfolio.
Accordingly, revenues will be affected by future changes in the types of charges
and fees assessed on the credit lines. Revenues could be adversely affected by
future changes in the charges and fees assessed by the Subservicers and other
factors. See "Certain Legal Aspects of the Receivables -- Potential
Legislation". Neither the Servicer nor any of its affiliates has any basis to
predict how any future changes in the usage of credit lines by borrowers or in
the terms of credit lines may affect the revenue for the Portfolio.
    
 
                                       34
<PAGE>   37
 
   
                      THE REVOLVING CONSUMER CREDIT LINES
    
 
     The Receivables are evidenced by loan agreements (each, a "Credit Line
Agreement") originated in 40 states. The term to maturity of the Personal
Homeowner Credit Lines at origination will be fifteen years. Other than Personal
Unsecured Credit Lines originated in Arizona which have a maximum maturity of 20
years, assuming no further draws and payment of the Minimum Monthly Payment,
Personal Unsecured Credit Lines will not be fully amortized during the life of
the borrowers. The Principal Balances of such Credit Lines will be due upon the
death of any borrower under such Credit Lines.
 
   
     Each of the Receivables originated under Credit Lines owned by each
Subservicer as of its Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date had a current principal balance
outstanding that was less than 570 days contractually delinquent at the time of
the borrower's billing date immediately preceding the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off
Date. Each Variable Rate Credit Line, had an Index Rate equal to the prime rate.
Each Credit Line was originated between August 1979 and May 1996 in the ordinary
course of the related Subservicer's revolving consumer credit line program. As
of the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date, the average principal balance of the
Receivables was approximately $5,087.18. As of the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date
the weighted average loan utilization rate (computed by dividing the Principal
Balance for each Credit Line as of the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date by the related
Credit Limit, which, in cases where credit privileges have been terminated, may
be the Principal Balance as of the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date) was approximately
86.85%.
    
 
   
     The Fixed Rate Credit Lines will have Loan Rates ranging from 0.00% to
36.00% per annum, with a weighted average loan rate as of the Series 1996-2
Cut-Off Date of 19.41% per annum. The Variable Rate Credit Lines will have loan
margins ranging from 0.00% to 25.00% per annum, with a weighted average loan
margin as of the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date of 11.65% per annum.
    
 
     Set forth below is a description of certain characteristics of the
Receivables and Credit Lines as of the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date:
 
                    COMPOSITION OF CREDIT LINES BY LOAN TYPE
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                       NUMBER OF         % OF           PRINCIPAL           % OF POOL BY
             LOAN TYPE                CREDIT LINES   CREDIT LINES      OUTSTANDING      PRINCIPAL OUTSTANDING
- ------------------------------------  ------------   ------------   -----------------   ---------------------
<S>                                   <C>            <C>            <C>                 <C>
Personal Unsecured Credit Line......     509,936         89.09%     $2,225,548,871.71            76.43%
Personal Homeowner Credit Line......      62,448         10.91         686,269,387.89            23.57
                                      ------------   ------------   -----------------          -------
     Total..........................     572,384        100.00%     $2,911,818,229.60           100.00%
                                       =========     =========        ===============   ===============
</TABLE>
    
 
                                       35
<PAGE>   38
 
                COMPOSITION OF CREDIT LINES BY PRINCIPAL BALANCE
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
            CREDIT LINE                NUMBER OF         % OF           PRINCIPAL           % OF POOL BY
              BALANCE                 CREDIT LINES   CREDIT LINES      OUTSTANDING      PRINCIPAL OUTSTANDING
- ------------------------------------  ------------   ------------   -----------------   ---------------------
<S>                                   <C>            <C>            <C>                 <C>
$     0 and below...................      73,983         12.93%     $     (625,942.86)           (0.02)%
      1 to  1,000...................      34,139          5.96          15,114,236.58             0.52
  1,001 to  2,000...................      52,111          9.10          83,772,773.97             2.88
  2,001 to  3,000...................      69,816         12.20         176,587,748.73             6.06
  3,001 to  4,000...................      60,436         10.56         213,050,936.05             7.32
  4,001 to  5,000...................      55,076          9.62         250,748,088.69             8.61
  5,001 to  6,000...................      42,262          7.38         232,927,596.61             8.00
  6,001 to  7,000...................      32,271          5.64         210,315,849.34             7.22
  7,001 to  8,000...................      28,570          4.99         214,881,532.85             7.38
  8,001 to  9,000...................      20,367          3.56         173,153,785.10             5.95
  9,001 to 10,000...................      28,098          4.92         269,227,654.58             9.27
 10,001 to 11,000...................      13,869          2.42         145,439,699.12             4.99
 11,001 to 12,000...................      10,813          1.89         124,428,214.66             4.27
 12,001 to 13,000...................       8,620          1.51         107,964,393.16             3.71
 13,001 to 14,000...................       8,414          1.47         113,877,888.85             3.91
 14,001 to 15,000...................      17,246          3.01         251,340,802.84             8.63
 15,001 to 16,000...................       3,835          0.67          59,202,134.65             2.03
 16,001 to 17,000...................       1,093          0.19          18,076,344.92             0.62
 17,001 to 18,000...................         979          0.17          17,164,002.64             0.59
 18,001 to 19,000...................         840          0.15          15,555,778.66             0.53
 19,001 to 20,000...................       1,877          0.33          36,761,704.14             1.26
 20,001 to 21,000...................       1,030          0.18          21,062,699.60             0.72
 21,001 to 22,000...................         409          0.07           8,810,257.64             0.30
 22,001 to 23,000...................         479          0.08          10,789,370.52             0.37
 23,001 to 24,000...................         718          0.13          16,941,642.60             0.58
 24,001 to 25,000...................       3,233          0.56          79,548,217.20             2.73
 25,000 and over....................       1,800          0.31          45,700,818.76             1.57
                                         -------        ------      -----------------           ------
     Total..........................     572,384        100.00%     $2,911,818,229.60           100.00%
                                         =======        ======      =================           ======
</TABLE>
    
 
                                       36
<PAGE>   39
 
           COMPOSITION OF CREDIT LINES BY GEOGRAPHIC DISTRIBUTION(1)
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                     NUMBER OF          % OF            PRINCIPAL             % OF POOL BY
              STATE                 CREDIT LINES    CREDIT LINES       OUTSTANDING        PRINCIPAL OUTSTANDING
- ---------------------------------   ------------    ------------    -----------------    -----------------------
<S>                                 <C>             <C>             <C>                  <C>
Arizona..........................        8,115           1.42%      $   37,875,683.56               1.30%
California.......................      107,465          18.77          626,468,825.59              21.54
Colorado.........................        9,255           1.62           41,990,667.32               1.44
Connecticut......................        8,904           1.56           43,364,145.00               1.49
Delaware.........................        3,375           0.59           18,048,361.84               0.62
Florida..........................       36,739           6.42          184,453,183.92               6.33
Georgia..........................       11,220           1.96           69,856,963.73               2.40
Idaho............................          733           0.13            3,121,199.53               0.11
Illinois.........................       26,588           4.65          117,216,683.29               4.03
Indiana..........................       10,392           1.82           54,557,791.90               1.87
Iowa.............................        1,302           0.23            5,428,944.02               0.19
Kansas...........................        6,824           1.19           40,202,922.86               1.38
Kentucky.........................          311           0.05            2,666,813.32               0.09
Louisiana........................        1,303           0.23            4,037,955.30               0.14
Maryland.........................       22,845           3.99          124,419,085.58               4.27
Massachusetts....................        4,589           0.80           45,567,594.69               1.56
Michigan.........................       46,859           8.19          222,528,055.23               7.64
Minnesota........................        6,366           1.11           27,223,566.04               0.93
Mississippi......................        1,488           0.26            5,431,947.67               0.19
Missouri.........................       16,983           2.97           80,649,842.40               2.77
Nebraska.........................          253           0.04            2,202,846.98               0.08
Nevada...........................        4,496           0.79           21,088,665.60               0.72
New Hampshire....................        2,202           0.38           12,325,215.44               0.42
New Jersey.......................        6,483           1.13           39,236,690.90               1.35
New Mexico.......................        2,867           0.50           12,419,468.27               0.43
New York.........................       48,471           8.47          222,005,723.48               7.62
North Carolina...................       16,423           2.87           97,627,746.98               3.35
Ohio.............................       33,010           5.77          153,488,206.30               5.27
Oklahoma.........................        4,859           0.85           25,997,877.40               0.89
Oregon...........................        5,748           1.00           26,542,922.22               0.91
Pennsylvania.....................       40,533           7.08          189,404,812.82               6.50
Rhode Island.....................        1,879           0.33            9,660,743.96               0.33
South Carolina...................        6,427           1.12           32,280,569.48               1.11
South Dakota.....................          195           0.03              443,877.61               0.02
Tennessee........................        8,077           1.41           35,918,349.17               1.23
Texas............................       11,458           2.00           35,970,651.49               1.24
Utah.............................        1,425           0.25            4,411,576.15               0.15
Virginia.........................       22,020           3.85          118,555,682.18               4.07
Washington.......................       18,687           3.26           89,769,051.54               3.08
Wisconsin........................        5,215           0.91           27,357,318.84               0.94
                                    ------------    ------------    -----------------            -------
     Total.......................      572,384         100.00%      $2,911,818,229.60             100.00%
                                     =========      =========         ===============    =================
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
(1) Location is determined by the location of the applicable Subservicer's
    branch office which originated the loan.
 
                                       37
<PAGE>   40
 
                  COMPOSITION OF CREDIT LINES BY CREDIT LIMIT
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                       NUMBER OF         % OF           PRINCIPAL           % OF POOL BY
            CREDIT LIMIT              CREDIT LINES   CREDIT LINES      OUTSTANDING      PRINCIPAL OUTSTANDING
- ------------------------------------  ------------   ------------   -----------------   ---------------------
<S>                                   <C>            <C>            <C>                 <C>
$     0.............................      80,871         14.13%     $  262,507,889.85             9.02%
      1 to  1,000...................       3,733          0.65           1,281,949.72             0.04
  1,001 to  2,000...................      10,182          1.78          11,877,382.48             0.41
  2,001 to  3,000...................      52,048          9.09          94,180,532.13             3.23
  3,001 to  4,000...................      52,846          9.23         124,395,905.19             4.27
  4,001 to  5,000...................      67,144         11.73         197,696,405.80             6.79
  5,001 to  6,000...................      44,360          7.75         168,220,685.08             5.78
  6,001 to  7,000...................      32,731          5.72         141,807,703.57             4.87
  7,001 to  8,000...................      34,298          5.99         170,982,357.79             5.87
  8,001 to  9,000...................      23,403          4.09         128,982,189.59             4.43
  9,001 to 10,000...................      49,349          8.64         331,376,119.44            11.39
 10,001 to 11,000...................      12,500          2.18          87,352,968.59             3.00
 11,001 to 12,000...................      17,077          2.98         136,162,825.68             4.68
 12,001 to 13,000...................      13,120          2.29          94,158,949.14             3.23
 13,001 to 14,000...................      10,471          1.83          96,188,740.12             3.30
 14,001 to 15,000...................      53,982          9.43         577,116,133.62            19.82
 15,001 to 16,000...................       1,058          0.18          15,711,323.50             0.54
 16,001 to 17,000...................       1,128          0.20          17,272,562.00             0.59
 17,001 to 18,000...................       1,044          0.18          16,848,074.78             0.58
 18,001 to 19,000...................         480          0.08           8,588,876.73             0.29
 19,001 to 20,000...................       2,957          0.52          54,835,818.72             1.88
 20,001 to 21,000...................         325          0.06           6,559,256.87             0.23
 21,001 to 22,000...................         329          0.06           6,880,355.20             0.24
 22,001 to 23,000...................         296          0.05           6,483,014.55             0.22
 23,001 to 24,000...................         241          0.04           5,435,020.58             0.19
 24,001 to 25,000...................       6,411          1.12         148,915,188.88             5.11
                                         -------        ------                   ----   ------- ----------
     Total..........................     572,384        100.00%     $2,911,818,229.60           100.00%
                                         =======        ======                   ====   =================
</TABLE>
    
 
                                       38
<PAGE>   41
 
              COMPOSITION OF VARIABLE RATE CREDIT LINES BY MARGIN
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
            CUT-OFF DATE               NUMBER OF         % OF           PRINCIPAL           % OF POOL BY
               MARGIN                 CREDIT LINES   CREDIT LINES      OUTSTANDING      PRINCIPAL OUTSTANDING
- ------------------------------------  ------------   ------------   -----------------   ---------------------
<S>                                   <C>            <C>            <C>                 <C>
 0.00% to  6.99%....................         536          0.13%     $    1,998,686.91             0.10%
 7.00% to  7.99%....................      12,578          3.12          66,422,569.78             3.27
 8.00% to  8.99%....................       6,654          1.65          46,701,725.05             2.30
 9.00% to  9.99%....................      67,668         16.79         459,850,062.29            22.68
10.00% to 10.99%....................      71,096         17.63         427,046,314.44            21.05
11.00% to 11.99%....................      52,008         12.90         223,946,870.68            11.04
12.00% to 12.99%....................      97,539         24.19         387,052,126.98            19.08
13.00% to 13.99%....................      34,454          8.55         138,570,006.19             6.83
14.00% to 14.99%....................      27,990          6.94         104,687,675.27             5.16
15.00% to 15.99%....................      27,631          6.85         149,491,659.81             7.37
16.00% to 16.99%....................       4,378          1.09          19,124,816.77             0.94
17.00% to 17.99%....................         405          0.10           1,555,595.27             0.08
18.00% and above....................         250          0.06           2,102,476.47             0.10
                                         -------        ------      -----------------           ------
     Total..........................     403,187        100.00%     $2,028,550,585.91           100.00%
                                         =======        ======      =================           ======
</TABLE>
    
 
               COMPOSITION OF CREDIT LINES BY TYPE OF CREDIT LINE
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
            TYPE OF LOAN               NUMBER OF         % OF           PRINCIPAL           % OF POOL BY
               RATES                  CREDIT LINES   CREDIT LINES      OUTSTANDING      PRINCIPAL OUTSTANDING
- ------------------------------------  ------------   ------------   -----------------   ---------------------
<S>                                   <C>            <C>            <C>                 <C>
Variable............................     403,187         70.44%     $2,028,550,585.91            69.67%
Fixed...............................     169,197         29.56         883,267,643.69            30.33
                                         -------        ------      -----------------           ------
     Total..........................     572,384        100.00%     $2,911,818,229.60           100.00%
                                         =======        ======      =================           ======
</TABLE>
    
 
                                       39
<PAGE>   42
 
         COMPOSITION OF CREDIT LINES BY CREDIT LIMIT UTILIZATION RATES
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                  % OF POOL
                                           NUMBER OF          % OF            PRINCIPAL         BY PRINCIPAL
RANGE OF CREDIT LIMIT UTILIZATION RATES   CREDIT LINES    CREDIT LINES       OUTSTANDING         OUTSTANDING
- ---------------------------------------   ------------    ------------    -----------------    ---------------
<S>                                       <C>             <C>             <C>                  <C>
  0.00% to   4.99%.....................       74,819          13.07%      $      536,417.71           0.01%
  5.00% to   9.99%.....................        3,887           0.68            1,994,689.48           0.07
 10.00% to  14.99%.....................        4,202           0.73            3,714,108.40           0.13
 15.00% to  19.99%.....................        4,668           0.82            5,817,379.60           0.20
 20.00% to  24.99%.....................        5,467           0.96            8,932,318.79           0.31
 25.00% to  29.99%.....................        7,257           1.27           15,024,974.14           0.52
 30.00% to  34.99%.....................       12,790           2.23           33,118,015.93           1.14
 35.00% to  39.99%.....................       13,636           2.38           41,403,173.04           1.42
 40.00% to  44.99%.....................       11,677           2.04           40,439,025.35           1.39
 45.00% to  49.99%.....................       11,136           1.95           43,802,618.70           1.50
 50.00% to  54.99%.....................       12,587           2.20           54,028,167.46           1.86
 55.00% to  59.99%.....................       13,611           2.38           63,455,467.35           2.18
 60.00% to  64.99%.....................       14,993           2.62           73,939,471.92           2.54
 65.00% to  69.99%.....................       17,313           3.02           88,985,667.46           3.06
 70.00% to  74.99%.....................       17,341           3.03           98,515,775.23           3.38
 75.00% to  79.99%.....................       22,721           3.97          129,854,602.21           4.46
 80.00% to  84.99%.....................       33,580           5.87          198,772,738.62           6.83
 85.00% to  89.99%.....................       25,707           4.49          172,401,951.58           5.92
 90.00% to  94.99%.....................       37,832           6.61          262,736,430.21           9.02
 95.00% to  99.99%.....................      111,856          19.53          920,576,939.71          31.60
100.00%................................       85,665          14.97          386,286,445.58          13.27
100.01% to 104.99%.....................       17,079           2.98          177,077,884.89           6.08
105.00% to 109.99%.....................       11,719           2.05           85,236,772.98           2.93
110.00% and above(1)...................          841           0.15            5,167,193.26           0.18
                                             -------         ------       -----------------         ------
  Total................................      572,384         100.00%      $2,911,818,229.60         100.00%
                                             =======         ======       =================         ======
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
(1) Within certain parameters established by the Subservicers from time to time,
     borrowers may exceed their Credit Limits. Under the Subservicer's current
     policies, borrowers may exceed their Credit Limits by the lesser of $1,000
     or 10% of their Credit Limit.
 
                                       40
<PAGE>   43
 
                  COMPOSITION OF CREDIT LINES BY LOAN RATES(1)
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                 % OF POOL
                                              NUMBER OF         % OF            PRINCIPAL       BY PRINCIPAL
                 LOAN RATES                  CREDIT LINES   CREDIT LINES       OUTSTANDING      OUTSTANDING
- -------------------------------------------- ------------   ------------    -----------------   ------------
<S>                                          <C>            <C>             <C>                 <C>
 0.00% to  7.99%............................      6,554          1.14%      $   22,874,024.60        0.79%
 8.00% to  8.99%............................         61          0.01              106,343.03        0.00
 9.00% to  9.99%............................        365          0.06            1,103,077.57        0.04
10.00% to 10.99%............................        200          0.03              623,387.55        0.02
11.00% to 11.99%............................        101          0.02              400,904.89        0.01
12.00% to 12.99%............................        120          0.02              516,660.46        0.02
13.00% to 13.99%............................        137          0.02              283,169.06        0.01
14.00% to 14.99%............................        289          0.05            2,302,957.55        0.08
15.00% to 15.99%............................      6,024          1.05           32,594,201.03        1.12
16.00% to 16.99%............................     13,361          2.33           91,666,605.16        3.15
17.00% to 17.99%............................     15,530          2.71          105,290,897.32        3.62
18.00% to 18.99%............................    158,611         27.74        1,026,767,341.13       35.26
19.00% to 19.99%............................    101,593         17.75          551,754,807.56       18.95
20.00% to 20.99%............................     63,320         11.06          272,103,550.10        9.34
21.00% to 21.99%............................     99,552         17.39          383,773,633.92       13.18
22.00% to 22.99%............................     35,247          6.16          134,007,434.10        4.60
23.00% to 23.99%............................     52,072          9.10          198,277,649.61        6.81
24.00% to 24.99%............................     15,685          2.74           71,650,853.03        2.46
25.00% to 25.99%............................      3,096          0.54           13,782,136.06        0.47
26.00% to 26.99%............................        277          0.05            1,062,721.92        0.04
Over 27.00%.................................        189          0.03              875,873.95        0.03
                                                                                                  -------
                                                                                                 ----------
                                                -------        ------
  Total.....................................    572,384        100.00%      $2,911,818,229.60      100.00%
                                                =======        ======                           =================
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) The Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date Loan Rates for Credit Lines with an Index
     Rate based on the prime rate are based on the prime rate as of July 1,
     1996, which was 8.25%.
    
 
                                       41
<PAGE>   44
 
                       COMPOSITION OF CREDIT LINES BY AGE
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                     % OF POOL
                                            NUMBER OF            % OF             PRINCIPAL        BY PRINCIPAL
           AGE (IN MONTHS)                CREDIT LINES       CREDIT LINES        OUTSTANDING        OUTSTANDING
- -------------------------------------   -----------------    -------------    -----------------    -------------
<S>                                     <C>                  <C>              <C>                  <C>
 0 to  5.............................         38,307               6.69%      $  294,132,132.99         10.10%
 6 to 11.............................         87,280              15.25          455,073,439.86         15.64
12 to 17.............................         61,349              10.72          347,482,977.67         11.93
18 to 23.............................        108,643              18.98          503,901,056.33         17.31
24 to 29.............................         51,781               9.05          280,907,708.27          9.65
30 to 35.............................         42,199               7.37          186,591,121.27          6.41
36 to 41.............................         26,354               4.60          136,069,832.54          4.67
42 to 47.............................         16,189               2.83           78,675,495.89          2.70
48 to 53.............................         12,356               2.16           57,546,490.96          1.98
54 to 59.............................         12,154               2.12           55,146,065.13          1.89
60 to 65.............................         10,848               1.90           48,392,068.96          1.66
66 to 71.............................         18,623               3.25           74,968,251.10          2.57
72 to 77.............................         21,090               3.68           93,023,440.08          3.19
78 to 83.............................         17,955               3.14           79,672,449.07          2.74
84 to 89.............................         10,635               1.86           45,252,711.91          1.55
90 to 95.............................          7,539               1.32           32,429,430.23          1.11
96 to 101............................          8,398               1.47           39,553,902.83          1.36
102 to 107...........................          6,533               1.14           29,280,890.95          1.01
Over 108 months......................         14,151               2.47           73,718,763.56          2.53
                                             -------             ------       -----------------        ------
  Total..............................        572,384             100.00%      $2,911,818,229.60        100.00%
                                             =======             ======       =================        ======
</TABLE>
    
 
   
         COMPOSITION OF CREDIT LINES BY CONTRACTUAL DAYS DELINQUENT(1)
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                  % OF POOL
                                            NUMBER OF           % OF           PRINCIPAL        BY PRINCIPAL
           DAYS DELINQUENT                CREDIT LINES      CREDIT LINES      OUTSTANDING        OUTSTANDING
- --------------------------------------  -----------------   ------------   -----------------    -------------
<S>                                     <C>                 <C>            <C>                  <C>
  0 to  29............................       514,180            89.83%     $2,604,724,854.62         89.47%
 30 to  59............................        22,813             3.99         124,357,211.29          4.27
 60 to  89............................         9,619             1.68          49,529,297.65          1.70
 90 to 119............................         5,977             1.04          30,554,218.05          1.05
120 to 149............................         4,057             0.71          21,086,617.99          0.72
150 to 179............................         3,545             0.62          18,336,038.73          0.63
180 to 209............................         3,079             0.54          16,665,663.16          0.57
210 to 239............................         2,902             0.51          15,271,625.61          0.52
240 to 269............................         2,737             0.48          14,051,615.30          0.48
270 to 299............................         2,598             0.45          13,209,131.71          0.45
Over 299..............................           877             0.15           4,031,955.49          0.14
                                             -------           ------      -----------------        ------
Total.................................       572,384           100.00%     $2,911,818,229.60        100.00%
                                             =======           ======      =================        ======
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) See the discussion on pages 31-32 as to the Subservicers' delinquency and
    charge-off policies.
    
 
     The Subservicers have sold and assigned to the Seller, and the Seller has
sold and assigned to the Deposit Trust, all right, title and interest in the
balance of the Initial Receivables as of the Initial Cut-Off Date. Additional
Credit Lines were designated to the Deposit Trust and Receivables thereunder
were conveyed to the Deposit Trust in February and June 1996. In addition, from
time to time, Aggregate Additional Credit Lines may be designated to the Deposit
Trust and the Cut-Off Date Balance of each such Credit Line and Additional
Balances generated under all Credit Lines during the life of the Deposit Trust
will be funded by the appropriate Subservicer and sold to the Seller pursuant to
the Receivables Purchase Agreement. Such Receivables will then be transferred by
the Seller to the Deposit Trust pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing
 
                                       42
<PAGE>   45
 
Agreement. The Subservicers will continue to service, and the Servicer will
service, the Credit Lines, pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, and
the Servicer will receive a monthly servicing fee for such services. See
"Description of the Deposit Trust -- Assignment of Receivables" and "--
Servicing Compensation and Payment of Expenses" herein.
 
                        THE SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION
 
GENERAL
 
     The Series 1996-2 Participation constitutes an undivided beneficial
interest in the Receivables held in the Deposit Trust. Generally, the Series
1996-2 Participation will produce cash flows and incur defaults in the same
manner as if the Receivables were held directly by the Issuer, subject to the
distribution of excess spread to the Seller.
 
CONVEYANCE AND PERFORMANCE OF THE SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION
 
   
     The Seller will convey the Series 1996-2 Participation to the Issuer on the
Closing Date. Pursuant to the Series 1996-2 Supplement, the Issuer, as holder of
the Series 1996-2 Participation, shares on the basis of a specified percentage
of the Pool Balance in the cash flows on the Receivables held as assets of the
Deposit Trust. The Series 1996-2 Participation shall initially represent a
principal balance of $1,044,800,000 (the "Initial Series 1996-2 Participation
Invested Amount"). Thereafter, the "Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount"
with respect to any date will be an amount equal to the Initial Series 1996-2
Participation Invested Amount minus the sum of the Series 1996-2 Participation
Principal Distribution Amount paid for all Distribution Dates and the Defaulted
Amounts allocated to the Series 1996-2 Participation during the related and all
prior Collection Periods that have not been included in the Series 1996-2
Participation Principal Distribution Amount on the current or any prior
Distribution Date.
    
 
     The Series 1996-2 Participation will be entitled to the applicable
percentage (the "Allocation Percentage") of the Interest Collections (which
shall include Recoveries), Principal Collections or Net Principal Collections
and Defaulted Amounts received or incurred during a Collection Period.
 
     With respect to any Collection Period prior to the Early Amortization
Period, Interest Collections and Defaulted Amounts allocated to the Series
1996-2 Participation will be based upon the Floating Allocation Percentage (as
defined herein).
 
     During an Early Amortization Period, Interest Collections will be allocated
to the Series 1996-2 Participation based upon the Fixed Allocation Percentage
(as defined herein). However, Defaulted Amounts allocated to the Series 1996-2
Participation with respect to any Collection Period during an Early Amortization
Period shall continue to be made based upon the Floating Allocation Percentage.
Interest Collections with respect to any Collection Period will be distributable
to the Issuer as holder of the Series 1996-2 Participation as described under
"Description of the Deposit Trust -- Distributions on the Series 1996-2
Participation". Allocated Interest Collections not so distributed will be
distributable to the Seller.
 
     With respect to any Collection Period prior to the Accelerated Amortization
Date or the commencement of an Early Amortization Period, Principal Collections
will be allocated to the Series 1996-2 Participation based upon the greater of:
(i) the Floating Allocation Percentage of Net Principal Collections or (ii) the
Minimum Principal Amount. With respect to any Collection Period after the
Accelerated Amortization Date or during an Early Amortization Period, the Series
1996-2 Participation will be entitled to Principal Collections based upon the
Fixed Allocation Percentage.
 
     "Net Principal Collections" will equal the excess, if any, of Principal
Collections for the related Collection Period, minus Additional Balances sold to
the Deposit Trust during the Collection Period. If there is no excess, Net
Principal Collections will equal zero.
 
     On the Closing Date, the Issuer will pledge all of its interest in the
Series 1996-2 Participation to the Indenture Trustee for the benefit of the
Noteholders. The Indenture Trustee will have the right to enforce certain terms
of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Series 1996-2 Supplement upon the
Issuer's failure to enforce such terms.
 
                                       43
<PAGE>   46
 
                     MATURITY AND PREPAYMENT CONSIDERATIONS
 
   
     The Indenture, except as otherwise described herein, provides that the
Noteholders of each Class will be entitled to receive on each Payment Date
distributions of Principal Collections, in the amounts described herein, until
the Security Balance of the Class is reduced to zero. All amounts distributable
as principal to Noteholders will be allocated to each class of Notes as
described under "Description of the Securities -- Distributions on the
Securities." Prior to the commencement of the Early Amortization Period,
Noteholders will receive, to the extent of the availability thereof, amounts
from Net Principal Collections based upon the Floating Allocation Percentage so
long as such amount is not less than the Minimum Principal Amount. Upon the
commencement of the Early Amortization Period or during any Collection Period
after the occurrence of the Accelerated Amortization Date, Noteholders will
receive amounts from Principal Collections based upon the Fixed Allocation
Percentage.
    
 
     To the extent obligors make more draws than principal payments, the
Seller's Interest may grow. During the Early Amortization Period or after the
Accelerated Amortization Date, when the Series 1996-2 Participation's share of
Principal Collections is based upon the Fixed Allocation Percentage and does not
reflect any subsequent reductions in the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested
Amount, an increase in the Seller's Interest due to additional draws may also
result in the Series 1996-2 Participation receiving principal at a greater rate.
This is the case because (a) Principal Collections are not reinvested in
additional Receivables after the Early Amortization Period or the Accelerated
Amortization Date, but instead are distributed on the Series 1996-2
Participation, and (b) the Series 1996-2 Participation is entitled to Principal
Collections based on the Fixed Allocation Percentage, which gives the Series
1996-2 Participation a greater share of Principal Collections each month.
 
     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement permits the Seller, at its option, but
subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions specified in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement, to remove certain Receivables from the Deposit Trust at any
time during the life of the Deposit Trust, so long as the Rating Agency
Condition is satisfied. Such removals may affect the rate at which principal is
distributed to Noteholders by reducing the overall Pool Balance and thus the
amount of Principal Collections. See "Description of the Deposit Trust --
Removal of Deposit Trust Assets."
 
   
     As described herein, the actual maturity of each class of Notes will depend
in part on the availability of Additional Balances and on the timing of the
acquisition of the Additional Balances and the receipt of principal on the
Credit Lines or the extent of Defaulted Credit Lines. All of the Credit Lines
may be prepaid in full or in part at any time. The prepayment experience with
respect to the Credit Lines will affect the actual maturity of each of the Class
A and the Class B Notes.
    
 
   
     HFC is not aware of any publicly generated studies or statistics available
on the rate of prepayment or additional draws with respect to revolving consumer
loans. Generally, consumer loans are not viewed by borrowers as permanent
financing. Accordingly, the Credit Lines may experience a higher rate of
prepayment than traditional mortgage loans. On the other hand, because most of
the Credit Lines are not fully amortizing, in the absence of voluntary borrower
prepayments they could experience slower rates of principal payment than
traditional fully amortizing first mortgages. The Deposit Trust's prepayment
experience may be affected by a wide variety of factors, including general
economic conditions, interest rates, the availability of alternative financing,
as well as homeowner mobility, in the case of a Personal Homeowner Credit Line.
    
 
   
     In addition, the Deposit Trust's prepayment experience and the rate at
which the principal amount of each class of Notes amortizes will be affected by
any repurchases of Receivables by the Servicer or the Subservicers pursuant to
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement. Only the Personal Homeowner Credit Lines
contain due-on-sale provisions, and to the extent a Subservicer learns of a sale
of an interest in a property securing such a Credit Line, the applicable
Subservicer will generally attempt to open a new line of credit with such
borrower, which would be used to pay off the balance of the Personal Homeowner
Credit Line. In the event a new line is not established, the Subservicer will
enforce the due-on-sale provision unless such enforcement is not permitted by
applicable law. The enforcement of a due-on-sale provision will have the same
effect as a prepayment of the related Receivables. See "Description of the
Deposit Trust -- Collection and Other Servicing Procedures" and "Certain Legal
Aspects of the Credit Lines -- 'Due-on-Sale' Clauses"
    
 
                                       44
<PAGE>   47
 
   
for a description of certain provisions of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement
referred to below that may affect the prepayment experience on the Credit Lines.
The yield to an investor in any Note who purchased such Note in the secondary
market at a price that is different from par will be different if the rate of
prepayment on the Credit Lines is actually different than the rate anticipated
by such investor at the time such Note was purchased.
    
 
     Collections on the Credit Lines may vary because, among other things,
borrowers may make payments during any month as low as the Minimum Monthly
Payment for such month or as high as the entire outstanding principal balance
plus accrued interest and the fees and charges thereon and, in addition,
borrowers may borrow additional amounts under their respective Credit Line
Agreements. It is possible that borrowers may fail to make Minimum Monthly
Payments. In addition, collections on the Credit Lines may also vary due to
seasonal purchasing and payment habits of borrowers.
 
     No assurance can be given as to the level of prepayments that will be
experienced by the Deposit Trust and it can be expected that a portion of
borrowers will not prepay their Credit Lines to any significant degree.
 
     Most of the Credit Lines will not mature prior to the maturity date of the
Notes. It has been HFC's experience and is expected to be the case that
borrowers will prepay the Receivables at a sufficient rate to retire the Notes
prior to their maturity date, but no assurance can be given in this respect.
 
   
     The tables below set forth balances, payment windows and average lives
based on certain constant prepayment rates, constant charge-off rates and
constant draw rates. Increases in constant prepayment rates will have the effect
of reducing average lives and payment windows, and speeding up reductions in
principal balances. Prior to an Accelerated Amortization Date or Early
Amortization Event, draws will have the effect of reducing principal payments to
the Notes (but will not decrease payments below 1.8% of the Series 1996-2
Participation Invested Amount per month). For Collection Periods after the
Accelerated Amortization Date or during an Early Amortization Period, draws will
no longer have the effect of reducing principal payments.
    
 
   
     The following tables set forth below are based on a constant prepayment
rate, constant draw rate (which for purposes of these assumptions is the amount
of Additional Balances on the Credit Lines drawn each month expressed as an
annualized percentage of the total principal of the pool of Receivables
outstanding at the beginning of such month), and optional termination
assumptions as indicated in the tables below. The following tables assume that
the Receivables have been aggregated into a pool with a principal balance of
$1,044,800,000, and that the Credit Lines have an interest rate of 17.00%, an
annual charge-off rate of 6.00%, a 0% recovery rate and no Credit Lines have
been added to the Deposit Trust. In addition, such tables assume that (i) the
distributions are made in accordance with the description set forth under
"Description of the Securities -- Distributions on the Securities," (ii)
distributions of principal and interest on the Notes will be made on the 15th
day of each calendar month regardless of the day on which the Payment Date
actually occurs, (iii) monthly payments on the Credit Lines are comprised of
interest only payments and the only principal payments on the Credit Lines are
those represented by prepayments calculated under each of the prepayment
assumptions as set forth in the tables below before giving effect to draws and
charge-offs, (iv) monthly draws are calculated under each of the assumptions as
set forth in the tables below before giving effect to prepayments and
charge-offs, (v) the scheduled due date for each of the Credit Lines is the
first day of each month, (vi) monthly charge-offs are calculated under each of
the assumptions set forth above before giving effect to prepayments and draws,
(vii) the closing date is August 28, 1996, and (viii) Interest Collections
allocated to the Series 1996-2 Participation are sufficient to pay interest on
the Notes and the Certificate Rate on the Certificates, Defaulted Amounts and
Accelerated Principal Payment Amounts on the Series 1996-2 Securities.
    
 
                                       45
<PAGE>   48
 
   
 PERCENTAGE OF ORIGINAL SECURITY BALANCE OF THE CLASS A-1 NOTES -- AMORTIZATION
                                SCHEDULE (1)(2)
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        CONSTANT PREPAYMENT RATE (% CPR)
                                                      -------------------------------------
                       PAYMENT DATE                   20%        30%        43%        50%
        -------------------------------------------   ----       ----       ----       ----
        <S>                                           <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
        The Closing Date...........................    100%       100%       100%       100%
        December 1996..............................     91         91         89         84
        December 1997..............................     66         66         60         46
        December 1998..............................     47         47         38         27
        December 1999..............................     33         33         28         18
        December 2000..............................     27         27         21         12
        December 2001..............................     21         20         15          4
        December 2002..............................     16         13          3          0
        December 2003..............................     12          0          0          0
        December 2004..............................      4          0          0          0
        December 2005..............................      0          0          0          0
        December 2006..............................      0          0          0          0
          Weighted Average Life (yrs)(3)...........   3.01       2.82       2.39       1.75
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) Assumes that (i) an optional termination is exercised when the aggregate
    Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates has been reduced to 10% or
    less of the aggregate Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates as of
    the Closing Date and 30 days notice has been given and (ii) a monthly
    constant draw rate of 2.37%.
    
 
(2) All percentages are rounded to the nearest 1%.
 
   
(3) The weighted average life of each of the Notes is determined by (i)
    multiplying the amount of each principal payment by the number of years from
    August 28, 1996 to the related Payment Date (on a 30/360 basis), (ii) adding
    the results, and (iii) dividing by the sum of all principal payments
    received since issuance.
    
 
                 WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE(1) AND PAYMENT WINDOW(2)
   
            SENSITIVITY OF THE CLASS A-1 NOTES TO PAYMENTS AND DRAWS
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                   CONSTANT PREPAYMENT RATE (% CPR)(3)
                                        -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                20%                     30%                    43%                    50%
                                        --------------------    -------------------    -------------------    -------------------
      MONTHLY CONSTANT DRAW RATE          WAL        WINDOW       WAL       WINDOW       WAL       WINDOW       WAL       WINDOW
- --------------------------------------  --------    --------    --------    -------    --------    -------    --------    -------
<S>                                     <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>
1.00%.................................  3.01yrs.    1 to 102    2.75yrs.    1 to 91    1.60yrs.    1 to 62    1.24yrs.    1 to 48
2.37%.................................  3.01yrs.    1 to 102    2.82yrs.    1 to 86    2.39yrs.    1 to 77    1.75yrs.    1 to 65
3.00%.................................  3.01yrs.    1 to 102    2.82yrs.    1 to 86    2.71yrs.    1 to 77    2.09yrs.    1 to 71
4.00%.................................  3.01yrs.    1 to 102    2.82yrs.    1 to 86    2.71yrs.    1 to 77    2.68yrs.    1 to 74
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) The weighted average life of each of the Notes is determined by (i)
    multiplying the amount of each principal payment by the number of years from
    August 28, 1996 to the related Payment Date (on a 30/360 basis), (ii) adding
    the results, and (iii) dividing by the sum of all principal payments
    received since issuance.
    
 
   
(2) The payment window is expressed in months and begins on the Payment Date in
    which Noteholders first receive principal payments and ends on the Payment
    Date in which the Security Balance of such Class of Notes is paid in full,
    assuming the first Payment Date is September 15, 1996.
    
 
(3) Assumes that an optional termination is exercised when the aggregate
    Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates has been reduced to 10% or
    less of the aggregate Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates as of
    the Closing Date and 30 days notice has been given.
 
                                       46
<PAGE>   49
 
   
 PERCENTAGE OF ORIGINAL SECURITY BALANCE OF THE CLASS A-2 NOTES -- AMORTIZATION
                                SCHEDULE (1)(2)
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        CONSTANT PREPAYMENT RATE (% CPR)
                                                      -------------------------------------
                       PAYMENT DATE                   20%        30%        43%        50%
        -------------------------------------------   ----       ----       ----       ----
        <S>                                           <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
        The Closing Date...........................    100%       100%       100%       100%
        December 1996..............................    100        100        100        100
        December 1997..............................    100        100        100        100
        December 1998..............................    100        100        100         86
        December 1999..............................    100        100         88         58
        December 2000..............................     84         84         68         39
        December 2001..............................     67         64         47         36
        December 2002..............................     52         40         36          0
        December 2003..............................     38          0          0          0
        December 2004..............................     36          0          0          0
        December 2005..............................      0          0          0          0
        December 2006..............................      0          0          0          0
          Weighted Average Life (yrs)(3)...........   6.47       5.83       5.07       3.87
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) Assumes that (i) an optional termination is exercised when the aggregate
    Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates has been reduced to 10% or
    less of the aggregate Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates as of
    the Closing Date and 30 days notice has been given and (ii) a monthly
    constant draw rate of 2.37%.
    
 
(2) All percentages are rounded to the nearest 1%.
 
   
(3) The weighted average life of each of the Notes is determined by (i)
    multiplying the amount of each principal payment by the number of years from
    August 28, 1996 to the related Payment Date (on a 30/360 basis), (ii) adding
    the results, and (iii) dividing by the sum of all principal payments
    received since issuance.
    
 
                 WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE(1) AND PAYMENT WINDOW(2)
   
            SENSITIVITY OF THE CLASS A-2 NOTES TO PAYMENTS AND DRAWS
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 CONSTANT PREPAYMENT RATE (% CPR)(3)
                                    ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                             20%                     30%                     43%                     50%
                                    ---------------------    --------------------    --------------------    --------------------
MONTHLY CONSTANT DRAW RATE            WAL        WINDOW        WAL        WINDOW       WAL        WINDOW       WAL        WINDOW
- ----------------------------------  --------    ---------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
<S>                                 <C>         <C>          <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>
1.00%.............................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102    5.85yrs.    40 to 91    3.60yrs.    22 to 62    2.78yrs.    17 to 48
2.37%.............................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102    5.83yrs.    43 to 86    5.07yrs.    35 to 77    3.87yrs.    24 to 65
3.00%.............................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102    5.83yrs.    43 to 86    5.46yrs.    43 to 77    4.51yrs.    30 to 71
4.00%.............................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102    5.83yrs.    43 to 86    5.46yrs.    43 to 77    5.34yrs.    43 to 74
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) The weighted average life of each of the Notes is determined by (i)
    multiplying the amount of each principal payment by the number of years from
    August 28, 1996 to the related Payment Date (on a 30/360 basis), (ii) adding
    the results, and (iii) dividing by the sum of all principal payments
    received since issuance.
    
 
   
(2) The payment window is expressed in months and begins on the Payment Date in
    which Noteholders first receive principal payments and ends on the Payment
    Date in which the Security Balance of such Class of Notes is paid in full,
    assuming the first Payment Date is September 15, 1996.
    
 
(3) Assumes that an optional termination is exercised when the aggregate
    Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates has been reduced to 10% or
    less of the aggregate Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates as of
    the Closing Date and 30 days notice has been given.
 
                                       47
<PAGE>   50
 
   
 PERCENTAGE OF ORIGINAL SECURITY BALANCE OF THE CLASS A-3 NOTES -- AMORTIZATION
                                SCHEDULE (1)(2)
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        CONSTANT PREPAYMENT RATE (% CPR)
                                                      -------------------------------------
                       PAYMENT DATE                   20%        30%        43%        50%
        -------------------------------------------   ----       ----       ----       ----
        <S>                                           <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
        The Closing Date...........................    100%       100%       100%       100%
        December 1996..............................    100        100        100        100
        December 1997..............................    100        100        100        100
        December 1998..............................    100        100        100         86
        December 1999..............................    100        100         88         58
        December 2000..............................     84         84         68         39
        December 2001..............................     67         64         47         36
        December 2002..............................     52         40         36          0
        December 2003..............................     38          0          0          0
        December 2004..............................     36          0          0          0
        December 2005..............................      0          0          0          0
        December 2006..............................      0          0          0          0
          Weighted Average Life (yrs)(3)...........   6.47       5.83       5.07       3.87
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) Assumes that (i) an optional termination is exercised when the aggregate
    Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates has been reduced to 10% or
    less of the aggregate Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates as of
    the Closing Date and 30 days notice has been given and (ii) a monthly
    constant draw rate of 2.37%.
    
 
(2) All percentages are rounded to the nearest 1%.
 
   
(3) The weighted average life of each of the Notes is determined by (i)
    multiplying the amount of each principal payment by the number of years from
    August 28, 1996 to the related Payment Date (on a 30/360 basis), (ii) adding
    the results, and (iii) dividing by the sum of all principal payments
    received since issuance.
    
 
                 WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE(1) AND PAYMENT WINDOW(2)
   
            SENSITIVITY OF THE CLASS A-3 NOTES TO PAYMENTS AND DRAWS
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  CONSTANT PREPAYMENT RATE (% CPR)(3)
                                       ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                20%                    30%                    43%                    50%
                                       ---------------------   --------------------   --------------------   --------------------
     MONTHLY CONSTANT DRAW RATE          WAL        WINDOW       WAL        WINDOW      WAL        WINDOW      WAL        WINDOW
- -------------------------------------  --------    ---------   --------    --------   --------    --------   --------    --------
<S>                                    <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>
1.00%................................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102   5.85yrs.    40 to 91   3.60yrs.    22 to 62   2.78yrs.    17 to 48
2.37%................................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102   5.83yrs.    43 to 86   5.07yrs.    35 to 77   3.87yrs.    24 to 65
3.00%................................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102   5.83yrs.    43 to 86   5.46yrs.    43 to 77   4.51yrs.    30 to 71
4.00%................................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102   5.83yrs.    43 to 86   5.46yrs.    43 to 77   5.34yrs.    43 to 74
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) The weighted average life of each of the Notes is determined by (i)
    multiplying the amount of each principal payment by the number of years from
    August 28, 1996 to the related Payment Date (on a 30/360 basis), (ii) adding
    the results, and (iii) dividing by the sum of all principal payments
    received since issuance.
    
 
   
(2) The payment window is expressed in months and begins on the Payment Date in
    which Noteholders first receive principal payments and ends on the Payment
    Date in which the Security Balance of such Class of Notes is paid in full,
    assuming the first Payment Date is September 15, 1996.
    
 
(3) Assumes that an optional termination is exercised when the aggregate
    Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates has been reduced to 10% or
    less of the aggregate Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates as of
    the Closing Date and 30 days notice has been given.
 
                                       48
<PAGE>   51
 
  PERCENTAGE OF ORIGINAL SECURITY BALANCE OF THE CLASS B NOTES -- AMORTIZATION
                                SCHEDULE (1)(2)
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                          CONSTANT PREPAYMENT RATE (% CPR)
                                                        -------------------------------------
                       PAYMENT DATE                     20%        30%        43%        50%
    --------------------------------------------------  ----       ----       ----       ----
    <S>                                                 <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
    The Closing Date..................................   100%       100%       100%       100%
    December 1996.....................................   100        100        100        100
    December 1997.....................................   100        100        100        100
    December 1998.....................................   100        100        100         86
    December 1999.....................................   100        100         88         58
    December 2000.....................................    84         84         68         39
    December 2001.....................................    67         64         47         36
    December 2002.....................................    52         40         36          0
    December 2003.....................................    38          0          0          0
    December 2004.....................................    36          0          0          0
    December 2005.....................................     0          0          0          0
    December 2006.....................................     0          0          0          0
      Weighted Average Life (yrs)(3)..................  6.47       5.83       5.07       3.87
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) Assumes that (i) an optional termination is exercised when the aggregate
    Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates has been reduced to 10% or
    less of the aggregate Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates as of
    the Closing Date and 30 days notice has been given and (ii) a monthly
    constant draw rate of 2.37%.
    
 
(2) All percentages are rounded to the nearest 1%.
 
   
(3) The weighted average life of each of the Notes is determined by (i)
    multiplying the amount of each principal payment by the number of years from
    August 28, 1996 to the related Payment Date (on a 30/360 basis), (ii) adding
    the results, and (iii) dividing by the sum of all principal payments
    received since issuance.
    
 
                 WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE(1) AND PAYMENT WINDOW(2)
             SENSITIVITY OF THE CLASS B NOTES TO PAYMENTS AND DRAWS
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 CONSTANT PREPAYMENT RATE (% CPR)(3)
                                    ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                             20%                     30%                     43%                     50%
                                    ---------------------    --------------------    --------------------    --------------------
    MONTHLY CONSTANT DRAW RATE        WAL        WINDOW        WAL        WINDOW       WAL        WINDOW       WAL        WINDOW
- ----------------------------------  --------    ---------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------    --------
<S>                                 <C>         <C>          <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>
1.00%.............................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102    5.85yrs.    40 to 91    3.60yrs.    22 to 62    2.78yrs.    17 to 48
2.37%.............................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102    5.83yrs.    43 to 86    5.07yrs.    35 to 77    3.87yrs.    24 to 65
3.00%.............................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102    5.83yrs.    43 to 86    5.46yrs.    43 to 77    4.51yrs.    30 to 71
4.00%.............................  6.47yrs.    43 to 102    5.83yrs.    43 to 86    5.46yrs.    43 to 77    5.34yrs.    43 to 74
</TABLE>
    
 
- -------------------------
   
(1) The weighted average life of each of the Notes is determined by (i)
    multiplying the amount of each principal payment by the number of years from
    August 28, 1996 to the related Payment Date (on a 30/360 basis), (ii) adding
    the results, and (iii) dividing by the sum of all principal payments
    received since issuance.
    
 
   
(2) The payment window is expressed in months and begins on the Payment Date in
    which Noteholders first receive principal payments and ends on the Payment
    Date in which the Security Balance of such Class of Notes is paid in full,
    assuming the first Payment Date is September 15, 1996.
    
 
(3) Assumes that an optional termination is exercised when the aggregate
    Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates has been reduced to 10% or
    less of the aggregate Security Balance of the Notes and Certificates as of
    the Closing Date and 30 days notice has been given.
 
                        DESCRIPTION OF THE DEPOSIT TRUST
 
   
     Household Consumer Loan Deposit Trust I (the "Deposit Trust") was
established pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September
1, 1995 among The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A. as deposit trustee, the Servicer
and the Seller. In July 1996, The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A. merged into
Chemical Bank, a New York state chartered commercial bank. Following that
merger, The Chase Manhattan Bank,
    
 
                                       49
<PAGE>   52
 
   
N.A. resigned as deposit trustee and the Seller appointed Texas Commerce Bank
National Association as successor deposit trustee (the "Deposit Trustee"). The
Deposit Trustee is an affiliate of The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A. An affiliate
of the Deposit Trustee is also acting as Owner Trustee.
    
 
   
     The Deposit Trust operates as a master trust to acquire assets from the
Seller and to issue participation interests in the assets of the Deposit Trust
from time to time, such as the Series 1996-2 Participation and the Seller's
Interest. As of the date of this Prospectus, two Series Participation Interests
in the assets of the Deposit Trust have been issued and sold to trusts, each of
which issued Series backed by one of the Series Participation Interests. The
Deposit Trust is expected to continue as a trust after the Final Payment Date
with respect to the Series 1996-2 Securities. The assets of the Deposit Trust
are expected to change over the life of the Deposit Trust and the Series 1996-2
Securities, as certain interests and receivables in revolving consumer credit
lines and related assets are included in the Deposit Trust and as certain
interests and receivables subject to the Deposit Trust are collected,
charged-off or removed.
    
 
     The Series 1996-2 Participation will be issued pursuant to the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement and a supplement thereto containing specific provisions
relating to the Series 1996-2 Participation (the "Series 1996-2 Supplement").
The Pooling and Servicing Agreement and a form of the Series 1996-2 Supplement
have been filed as exhibits to the Registration Statement of which this
Prospectus is a part. The following summaries describe certain provisions of the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Series 1996-2 Supplement. The summaries
do not purport to be complete and are subject to and are qualified in their
entirety by reference to, all of the provisions of the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement and the Series 1996-2 Supplement, as applicable. Additionally,
capitalized terms used herein that are not defined herein shall have the
meanings ascribed to them in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Series
1996-2 Supplement.
 
     The Trust Assets include one share of preferred stock of the Seller (the
"Preferred Stock"). The Preferred Stock has a par value of $1.00 and is
designated the "Class SV Preferred Stock". On the Initial Issuance Date, the
Preferred Stock was issued directly to the Deposit Trustee. The share of
Preferred Stock held by the Deposit Trustee is the only issued and outstanding
share of the Seller's Preferred Stock. Pursuant to the Articles of Incorporation
of the Seller (incorporated by reference as an exhibit to the Registration
Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part), the sole rights of the Deposit
Trustee as holder of the Preferred Stock are to (a) vote in the event the Seller
desires to: institute proceedings to be adjudicated insolvent, consent to the
institution of any bankruptcy or insolvency case or petition, make an assignment
for the benefit of creditors, or admit in writing its inability to pay its debts
as they become due (collectively, the "Seller's Bankruptcy Initiatives"), and
(b) receive $1.00 upon liquidation of the Seller. The unanimous affirmative vote
of the holders of the Preferred Stock is required to approve any of the Seller's
Bankruptcy Initiatives. Holders of the Preferred Stock of the Seller have no
other rights, including the right to receive dividends or to vote on any other
matter.
 
   
     Although a majority of the holders of Series Participation Interests is
required to direct the action of the Deposit Trustee with respect to any vote,
pursuant to the Issuer's pledge of its interest in the Series 1996-2
Participation, the Indenture Trustee has the authority to vote the interest of
the Series 1996-2 Participation. In the Indenture, the Indenture Trustee
covenants that it will not consent to any of the Seller's Bankruptcy
Initiatives. As trustee under indentures substantially identical to the
Indenture, the Indenture Trustee also holds the voting power with respect to the
two other outstanding Series Participation Interest in the Deposit Trust, and
accordingly the authority to vote to direct the Deposit Trustee with respect to
the Seller's Bankruptcy Initiatives. Such indentures also obligate the Indenture
Trustee to refuse to consent to any of the Seller's Bankruptcy Initiatives.
    
 
GENERAL
 
     The Series 1996-2 Participation will evidence a specified percentage
undivided beneficial interest in the Receivables held by the Deposit Trust and
collections thereon. The Receivables held by the Deposit Trust will consist of
the Receivables existing under the Initial Credit Lines as of the close of
business on the Initial Cut-Off Date, and Additional Balances arising under such
Credit Lines thereafter. In addition, the Seller has
 
                                       50
<PAGE>   53
 
conveyed and may convey from time to time to the Deposit Trust, without
recourse, its interest in all Receivables existing in certain Aggregate
Additional Credit Lines.
 
   
     The balance in the Deposit Trust represented by the Series 1996-2
Participation on the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date will equal $1,044,800,000 (the
"Initial Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount"). Thereafter, the "Series
1996-2 Participation Invested Amount" with respect to any date will be an amount
equal to the Initial Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount minus the sum
of the Series 1996-2 Participation Principal Distribution Amount paid for all
Distribution Dates and the Defaulted Amounts allocated to the Series 1996-2
Participation during the related and all prior Collection Periods that have not
been included in the Series 1996-2 Participation Principal Distribution Amount
on the current or any prior Distribution Date. The "Series 1996-2 Participation
Principal Distribution Amount" on a Distribution Date is equal to the sum of (a)
either (i) for Collection Periods occurring prior to the Accelerated
Amortization Date or the commencement of an Early Amortization Period an amount
equal to the greater of: (x) the Floating Allocation Percentage of Net Principal
Collections or (y) the Minimum Principal Amount, or (ii) the Fixed Allocation
Percentage of Principal Collections for Collection Periods occurring after the
Accelerated Amortization Date or during an Early Amortization Period, and (b) to
the extent of the applicable Allocation Percentage of Interest Collections
remaining after the distribution of the Participation Pass-Through Rate on the
Series 1996-2 Participation, the Defaulted Amounts allocated to the Series
1996-2 Participation during the related Collection Period and the amount of any
Defaulted Amounts previously allocated to the Series 1996-2 Participation that
have not been included in the Series 1996-2 Participation Principal Distribution
Amount on any prior Distribution Date. The Seller will own the entire remaining
undivided beneficial interest in the Receivables held by the Deposit Trust (the
"Seller's Interest") not represented by the Series 1996-2 Participation and any
other Series Participation Interests issued by the Deposit Trust.
    
 
ASSIGNMENT OF RECEIVABLES
 
     On the Initial Issuance Date, each of the Subservicers transferred to the
Seller and the Seller transferred to the Deposit Trust all of its right, title
and interest in (i) all Receivables under the Initial Credit Lines existing as
of the Initial Cut-Off Date, (ii) Additional Balances arising under such Credit
Lines thereafter, (iii) all Recoveries allocable to the Initial Credit Lines,
and (iv) the proceeds of all of the foregoing. The Seller has also sold and
assigned to the Deposit Trust and may hereafter sell and assign to the Deposit
Trust from time to time (a) Receivables in designated Aggregate Additional
Credit Lines (whether existing at the time the Credit Lines were designated or
arising under such Credit Lines thereafter), (b) all Recoveries allocable to
such Aggregate Additional Credit Lines, and (c) the proceeds of all of the
foregoing. The Deposit Trustee, concurrently with the transfer of the Initial
Receivables, delivered the Seller's Interest to the Seller. On each issuance
date for any Series, including the Closing Date, the Deposit Trustee will
authenticate and deliver one or more certificates representing a Series
Participation Interest, in each case against payment to the Seller of the net
proceeds of the sale of such Series Participation Interest. At the direction of
the Seller and the Issuer, the Deposit Trustee will deliver the Series 1996-2
Participation to the Indenture Trustee.
 
     In connection with the transfer of Receivables to the Deposit Trust, each
Subservicer will indicate in its respective computer records that the
Receivables have been conveyed to the Seller and from the Seller to the Deposit
Trust. In addition, the Seller will provide to the Deposit Trustee a computer
file or a microfiche list from the Subservicers containing a true and complete
list showing for each Credit Line, as of the applicable date of designation (i)
its account number, (ii) the aggregate amount outstanding in such Credit Line
and (iii) the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables in such Credit Line. The
Subservicers will retain and will not deliver to the Deposit Trustee any other
records or agreements relating to the Credit Lines or the Receivables. Except as
set forth above, the records and agreements relating to the Credit Lines and the
Receivables will not be segregated from those relating to other consumer loans
and receivables, and the physical documentation relating to the Credit Lines or
Receivables will not be stamped or marked to reflect the transfer of Receivables
to the Seller or to the Deposit Trust. The Subservicers and the Seller will file
UCC financing statements with respect to the sale of the Receivables from each
of the Subservicers to the Seller and from the Seller to the Deposit Trust,
respectively, meeting the requirements of applicable state law. See "Risk
Factors" and "Certain Legal Aspects of the Receivables".
 
                                       51
<PAGE>   54
 
     As described below under "-- Additions of Credit Lines", the Seller will
have the right (subject to certain limitations and conditions) to require
Subservicers to designate from time to time New Credit Lines and Additional
Credit Lines (together, the "Aggregate Additional Credit Lines") to be included
as Credit Lines and to convey to the Seller (for conveyance by the Seller to the
Deposit Trust) all Receivables in such Aggregate Additional Credit Lines,
whether such receivables are then existing or thereafter created. Each such
Aggregate Additional Credit Line must be an Eligible Credit Line. In respect of
any designation of Aggregate Additional Credit Lines, the Seller will follow the
procedures set forth in the preceding paragraph, except the list will show
information of such Aggregate Additional Credit Lines as of the date such
Aggregate Additional Credit Lines are identified and designated. Aggregate
Additional Credit Lines will be selected by the respective Subservicer, in a
manner which it reasonably believes will not be materially adverse to the
holders of interests in the Deposit Trust. In addition, the Seller may (under
certain circumstances and subject to certain limitations and conditions) remove
the Receivables under certain Credit Lines as described under "Description of
the Deposit Trust -- Removal of Deposit Trust Assets".
 
REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES
 
   
     In the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Seller makes representations
and warranties to the Deposit Trust relating to the Credit Lines and the
Receivables as of the closing date for each Series (and as of the date Aggregate
Additional Credit Lines are designated to the Deposit Trust) to the effect among
other things, that as of each applicable date of designation, (a) each Credit
Line was an Eligible Credit Line, (b) each of the Receivables then existing in
the Credit Lines was an Eligible Receivable and (c) thereafter, on the date of
creation of any new Receivable, such Receivable was an Eligible Receivable. If
the Seller breaches any representation and warranty described in this paragraph
and such breach remains uncured for 60 days after the earlier of the discovery
of such breach by the Seller or receipt of written notice of such breach by the
Seller and such breach has a material adverse effect on the holder of an
interest in such Receivable, all Receivables with respect to the Credit Line
affected ("Ineligible Receivables") will be reassigned to the Seller on the
terms and conditions set forth below and such account shall no longer be
included as a Credit Line. The Deposit Trustee and the Servicer may agree to
extend the cure period for any such breach.
    
 
     "Eligible Receivable" means each receivable (a) which has arisen under an
Eligible Credit Line (b) which was created in compliance in all material
respects with all requirements of law and pursuant to any agreement under which
such receivable was originated and which complies in all material respects with
all requirements of law applicable to the respective Subservicer or other
originator of the receivable, as applicable, (c) with respect to which all
material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of, or registrations or
declarations with, any governmental authority required to be obtained, effected
or given in connection with the creation of such receivable or the execution,
delivery, creation and performance by the applicable Subservicer, or by the
originator of the receivable, if not a Subservicer, of the related agreements
pursuant to which such receivable was created have been duly obtained or given
and are in full force and effect, (d) as to which at the time of its transfer to
the Deposit Trust, the Seller or the Deposit Trust will have good and marketable
title, free and clear of all liens, encumbrances, charges and security
interests, (e) which has been the subject of either a valid transfer and
assignment from the Seller to the Deposit Trust of all the Seller's right, title
and interest therein (and in the proceeds thereof), or the grant of a first
priority perfected security interest therein (and in the proceeds thereof),
effective until the termination of the Deposit Trust, (f) which at the time of
transfer to the Deposit Trust, will be the legal, valid and binding payment
obligation of the obligor thereof enforceable against such obligor in accordance
with its terms, subject to certain bankruptcy or insolvency related exceptions,
(g) which at the time of its transfer to the Deposit Trust, has not been waived
or modified except as permitted in accordance with the Servicing Guidelines, (h)
which is not at the time of its transfer to the Deposit Trust subject to any
right of rescission, set off, counterclaim or defense (including the defense of
usury), (i) as to which the applicable Subservicer or other originator of the
Receivable, as applicable, and the Seller have satisfied all obligations to be
fulfilled at the time it is transferred to the Deposit Trust, (j) as to which,
at the time of its transfer to the Deposit Trust, none of the applicable
Subservicer or such other originator of the receivable, as applicable, nor the
Seller has taken any action which would impair or failed to take any action the
result of which would impair the rights of the Deposit Trust or
 
                                       52
<PAGE>   55
 
the holders of interests therein and (k) which constitutes either an "account"
or a "general intangible" under the applicable UCC as then in effect.
 
   
     An Ineligible Receivable shall be reassigned to the Seller on or before the
end of the Collection Period in which such reassignment obligation arises by the
Seller directing the Servicer to deduct the portion of such Ineligible
Receivable which is a Principal Receivable from the aggregate amount of the
Principal Receivables used to calculate the Seller's Trust Amount (as defined
herein). In the event that the exclusion of the principal portion of an
Ineligible Receivable from the calculation of the Seller's Trust Amount would
cause the portion of the Seller's Trust Amount owned by Household Consumer Loan
Corporation to be reduced below 1.01% of the aggregate invested amounts of all
outstanding Series Participation Interests on the Distribution Date following
the Collection Period in which such reassignment obligation arises, the Seller
will make a deposit into the Collection Account in immediately available funds
in an amount equal to the amount by which the Seller's Trust Amount would be
reduced below 1.01% of the aggregate invested amounts of all outstanding Series
Participation Interests. The reassignment of any Ineligible Receivable to the
Seller, and the obligation of the Seller to make any deposits into the
Collection Account as described in this paragraph, is the sole remedy respecting
any breach of the representations and warranties described in the preceding
paragraph with respect to such Receivable available to the holders of interests
in the Deposit Trust or the Deposit Trustee on behalf of holders of interests in
the Deposit Trust. The Subservicers have each agreed with respect to Receivables
conveyed by such institution to repurchase from the Seller any Ineligible
Receivables reassigned to the Seller and to provide the Seller any amounts
necessary to enable the Seller to make the deposit referred to above. The term
"Seller's Trust Amount" means at any time of determination, an amount equal to
the total aggregate amount of Principal Receivables, minus the aggregate
invested amount of all outstanding Series Participation Interests in the Deposit
Trust (including the Series 1996-2 Participation) at such time.
    
 
     The Seller will also make representations and warranties to the Deposit
Trust to the effect, among other things, that as of the Closing Date it is a
corporation validly existing under the laws of the State of Nevada, it has the
authority to consummate the transactions contemplated by the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement and the Series 1996-2 Supplement and further represents to
the Deposit Trust on the Closing Date and, with respect to the Aggregate
Additional Credit Lines, as of each addition date (a) the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement and the Series 1996-2 Supplement constitutes a valid, binding and
enforceable agreement of the Seller and (b) the Pooling and Servicing Agreement
and the Series 1996-2 Supplement constitutes either a valid sale, transfer and
assignment to the Deposit Trust of all right, title and interest of the Seller
in the Receivables, whether then existing or thereafter created and the proceeds
thereof (including proceeds in any of the accounts established for the benefit
of the holders of interests in the Deposit Trust), and in Recoveries, or the
grant of a first priority perfected security interest under the applicable UCC
in such Receivables and the proceeds thereof, which is effective as to each
receivable then existing on such date. In the event of a material breach of any
of the representations and warranties described in this paragraph that has a
material adverse effect on the interest in the Receivables of any holder of an
interest in the Deposit Trust or the availability of the proceeds thereof to the
Deposit Trust (which determination will be made without regard to whether funds
are then available pursuant to any Series Enhancement), either the Deposit
Trustee, holders of Series Participation Interests entitled to vote thereon
evidencing not less than 51% of the principal portion of such interests, or any
other person entitled pursuant to a Series Supplement to deliver such notice, by
written notice to the Seller and the Servicer (and to the Deposit Trustee if
given by the holders of interests in the Deposit Trust or any such other
person), may direct the Seller to accept the reassignment of the Receivables in
the Deposit Trust within 60 days of such notice, or within such longer period
specified in such notice. The Seller will be obligated to accept the
reassignment of such Receivables on the Distribution Date following the
Collection Period in which such reassignment obligation arises. Such
reassignment will not be required to be made, however, if at the end of such
applicable period, the representations and warranties shall then be true and
correct in all material respects and any material adverse effect caused by such
breach shall have been cured. The price for such reassignment with respect to
the Series 1996-2 Participation will be equal to the unpaid principal balance of
the Series 1996-2 Participation on such Distribution Date on which the purchase
is scheduled to be made plus accrued and unpaid amounts at the Participation
Pass-Through Rate on the unpaid principal balance of the Series 1996-2
Participation and certain amounts that were distributable but not paid
 
                                       53
<PAGE>   56
 
on a prior Distribution Date at the Participation Pass-Through Rate, through the
day preceding such Distribution Date (the "Transfer Price"). The payment of the
Transfer Price in immediately available funds will be considered a payment in
full of the unpaid principal balance of the Series 1996-2 Participation and such
funds will be distributed upon presentation and surrender of the Series 1996-2
Participation. If the Deposit Trustee or holders of interests in the Deposit
Trust give a notice as provided above, the obligation of the Seller to make any
such deposit will constitute the sole remedy respecting a breach of the
representations and warranties available to holders of interests in the Deposit
Trust or the Deposit Trustee on behalf of holders of interests in the Deposit
Trust. Under the Receivables Purchase Agreement, the applicable Subservicer will
repurchase the Receivables purchased by the Seller in accordance with this
paragraph.
 
     It is not required or anticipated that the Deposit Trustee, the Owner
Trustee or the Indenture Trustee will make any initial or periodic examination
of the Receivables or any records relating to the Receivables for the purpose of
establishing the presence or absence of defects, compliance with the
Subservicers' and the Seller's representations and warranties or for any other
purpose. In addition, it is not anticipated or required that the Deposit
Trustee, the Owner Trustee or the Indenture Trustee will make any initial or
periodic general examination of the Servicer or Subservicers for the purpose of
establishing the compliance by the Servicer with its representations or
warranties or the performance by the Servicer of its obligations under the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Series 1996-2 Supplement or for any other
purpose. The Servicer, however, will deliver to the Deposit Trustee on or before
March 31 of each calendar year an opinion of counsel with respect to the
validity of the interest of the Deposit Trust in and to the Receivables and
certain other components of the Deposit Trust.
 
TRANSFER OF SELLER'S INTEREST; ADDITIONAL SELLERS AND ORIGINATORS
 
     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement allows the Seller to designate
affiliates of the Seller as additional sellers. Each such additional seller
would be a "Seller" under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, and the term
"Seller" as used herein and therein would thereupon include such additional
seller, except that each person that is a Seller shall be severally and not
jointly, liable for all obligations, covenants, representations and warranties
specifically undertaken by such person in its capacity as a Seller. Such
additional seller would be transferred a "Supplemental Certificate",
representing a portion of the Seller's Interest subject to the following
conditions, among others: (a) the Rating Agency Condition shall have been
satisfied; and (b) the Seller shall have delivered to the Deposit Trustee a
certificate of any authorized officer to the effect that, in the reasonable
belief of the Seller, such transfer will not have an Adverse Effect.
 
   
     Except for transfers to additional sellers as described above, as otherwise
set forth in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Seller may not transfer
the Seller's Interest or its obligations under the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement and any Series Supplement, unless the Seller and the Deposit Trustee
have been advised that the Rating Agency Condition has been satisfied.
    
 
     Upon satisfaction of the Rating Agency Condition and certification by the
Seller that it reasonably believes that no Adverse Effect will result, the
Seller is also permitted to acquire Receivables from originators other than the
Subservicers. Each such additional originator would sell Receivables to the
Seller pursuant to a receivables purchase agreement substantially similar to the
Receivables Purchase Agreement, which receivables purchase agreement would
subject such additional originator to the same obligations described herein to
which the Subservicers are subject, and references herein to the Subservicers in
their capacities as originators shall be deemed to include a reference to each
such additional originator.
 
ADDITIONS OF CREDIT LINES
 
   
     The Seller will have the right, but not an obligation, to require the
Subservicers to designate from time to time Aggregate Additional Credit Lines to
be included as Credit Lines in order to avoid the occurrence of an Amortization
Event. Should the Seller fail to exercise this right, an Amortization Event may
occur. In the event the Seller does exercise such right, in each case, the
applicable Subservicer will convey to the Seller, which in turn will convey to
the Deposit Trust, its interest in all receivables arising from such Aggregate
Additional Credit Lines, whether such Receivables are then existing or
thereafter created, subject to the
    
 
                                       54
<PAGE>   57
 
following conditions, among others: (i) each such Aggregate Additional Credit
Line must be an Eligible Credit Line and (ii) except for the addition of New
Credit Lines (a) the selection of the Additional Credit Lines is done in a
manner which the Seller reasonably believes will not result in an Adverse
Effect; and (b) the Rating Agency Condition shall have been satisfied. "Adverse
Effect" means any action that will result in the occurrence of an Amortization
Event with respect to any Series Participation Interest or adversely affect the
amount or timing of distributions to holders of any Series Participation
Interest.
 
   
     Each Aggregate Additional Credit Line must be an Eligible Credit Line at
the time of its designation. However, since Aggregate Additional Credit Lines
which may be originated after the Closing Date may not have been a part of the
Portfolio as of the close of business on the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date, they
may not be of the same credit quality as the Credit Lines existing as of such
date. Such Aggregate Additional Credit Lines may have been originated using
credit criteria different from those which were applied to the Credit Lines as
of the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date or may have been acquired from another
consumer credit lender or entity which utilized different credit criteria.
Consequently, the performance of such Aggregate Additional Credit Lines may be
better or worse than the performance of the credit lines in HFC's portfolio as
of the Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date.
    
 
REMOVAL OF DEPOSIT TRUST ASSETS
 
     Subject to the conditions set forth in the next succeeding sentence, the
Seller may on any day of a Collection Period, but shall not be obligated to,
acquire all Receivables and proceeds thereof with respect to Removed Credit
Lines. The Seller is permitted to designate and require reassignment to it of
the Receivables from Removed Credit Lines only upon satisfaction of the
following conditions: (i) the Seller shall have delivered to the Deposit Trustee
a computer file or microfiche list containing a true and complete list of all
Removed Credit Lines, such Credit Lines to be identified by, among other things,
account number and their aggregate amount of Principal Receivables; (ii) the
Seller shall have delivered an officer's certificate to the Deposit Trustee to
the effect that: (a) no selection procedure reasonably believed by the Seller to
be materially adverse to the interests of holders of interests in the Deposit
Trust was utilized in removing the Removed Credit Lines from among any pool of
Credit Lines of a similar type; (b) in the reasonable belief of the Seller, such
removal will not result in the occurrence of an Amortization Event; and (c) such
removal will not have an Adverse Effect; (iii) the Seller shall have delivered
prior written notice (the "Removal Notice") of the removal to each Rating
Agency, the Deposit Trustee and the Servicer; and (iv) except with respect to a
removal of less than 5% of the Principal Receivables in the Deposit Trust, prior
to the date on which such Receivables are to be removed, the Rating Agency
Condition shall have been satisfied with respect to such removal.
 
     Notwithstanding the foregoing, on the date a Credit Line becomes a
Defaulted Credit Line such Credit Line will be deemed removed from the Deposit
Trust and assigned to the Seller. All Recoveries attributable to such Credit
Lines will be deposited in the Collection Account and applied as Finance Charge
Receivables as provided herein.
 
   
     In addition, the Servicer has the option to repurchase Receivables which
are delinquent prior to the date such Receivables would be charged-off. Such
repurchase will be accomplished by deducting the balance thereof from the
Seller's Trust Amount, provided that the portion of the Seller's Trust Amount
owned by Household Consumer Loan Corporation would not be reduced below 1.01% of
the aggregate invested amounts of all outstanding Series Participation
Interests.
    
 
DISCOUNT OPTION
 
     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement provides that the Seller may at any
time designate, or redesignate a fixed percentage (the "Discount Percentage"),
of the Principal Receivables assigned to the Deposit Trust to be treated as
Finance Charge and Administrative Receivables. The Principal Discount may apply
to such Principal Receivables assigned to the Deposit Trust prior to, on or
after the date the Seller makes such designation or redesignation. The Seller
must provide 30 days' prior written notice to the Servicer, the Deposit
 
                                       55
<PAGE>   58
 
Trustee, and each Rating Agency of any increase, decrease or withdrawal of such
designation or redesignation, and such designation will become effective on the
date specified therein only if (i) an officer's certificate is delivered to the
effect that in the reasonable belief of the Seller such designation or
redesignation would not have an Adverse Effect and (ii) the Rating Agency
Condition is satisfied. No such election has been exercised as of the date of
this Prospectus.
 
AMENDMENTS TO CREDIT LINE AGREEMENTS
 
     Subject to applicable law, the applicable Subservicer may change the terms
of the Credit Line Agreements at any time. Upon a determination by a Subservicer
that prudent business practice requires such Subservicer to make changes in the
terms of the Credit Line Agreements as well as all comparable loans in its
respective portfolio, then, provided that such Subservicer and the Servicer
reasonably believe such changes will not have an Adverse Effect, such changes
may be made.
 
PAYMENTS ON CREDIT LINES; DEPOSITS TO COLLECTION ACCOUNT
 
   
     The Servicer has established and will maintain with the Deposit Trustee a
single separate trust account (the "Collection Account") for the benefit of the
holders of interests in the Deposit Trust, as their interests may appear. The
Collection Account will be an Eligible Account (as defined herein). Except as
otherwise described herein and subject to the investment provision described in
the following paragraphs, within two Business Days following receipt by the
Servicer or a Subservicer of amounts in respect of the Receivables, excluding
amounts representing taxes, assessments, credit insurance charges, or similar
items, the Servicer or Subservicer will deposit such amounts in the Collection
Account. Notwithstanding the foregoing, for as long as HFC remains the Servicer
under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and maintains a commercial paper
rating of at least P-1 from Moody's Investors Service, Inc. and A-1 from
Standard & Poor's Corporation, which is currently the case, the Servicer need
not deposit collections into the Collection Account on the day indicated in the
preceding sentence but may use for its own benefit all such collections until
the related Distribution Date at which time the Servicer will make such deposits
in an amount equal to the net amount of such deposits and withdrawals which
would have been made had the conditions of this sentence not applied. Amounts
deposited in the Collection Account may be invested in Permitted Investments (as
described in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement) maturing no later than the
related Distribution Date. On the fourth Business Day prior to each Distribution
Date, the Servicer will notify the Deposit Trustee and the Indenture Trustee of
the amount of such deposit to be included in funds available for the related
Distribution Date. On or prior to each Distribution Date, the Servicer will
deposit to the Collection Account amounts which are to be included in the funds
available for the related Distribution Date.
    
 
     At any time that the commercial paper issued by HFC does not satisfy the
rating requirements specified above, HFC may continue to hold collections prior
to distribution as described above so long as HFC causes to be maintained an
irrevocable letter of credit or surety bond or other credit enhancement
instrument in form and substance satisfactory to each Rating Agency (a "Servicer
Credit Facility"), issued by a depository institution or insurance company
having a rating on its (A) short-term obligations of at least P-1 and long-term
obligations of at least A2 by Moody's and (B) short-term obligations of A-1 and
long-term obligations of A by Standard & Poor's or other ratings if approved by
the Rating Agencies and providing that the Deposit Trustee may draw thereon in
the event that HFC, as Servicer, fails to make any deposit or payment required
under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.
 
     An "Eligible Account" is an account that is either (i) a segregated account
with a depository institution organized under the laws of the United States or
any of the states thereof, which depository at the time of any deposit therein
has a long-term debt rating acceptable to the Rating Agencies or a certificate
of deposit rating acceptable to the Rating Agencies, or (ii) a segregated trust
account with the corporate trust department of a depository organized under the
laws of the United States or any one of the states thereof, and acting as a
trustee for funds deposited in such account, so long as any of the unsecured,
unguaranteed senior debt securities of such depository shall have a credit
rating signifying investment grade from the Rating Agencies.
 
                                       56
<PAGE>   59
 
     Permitted Investments are specified in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement
and are limited to investments which meet the criteria of the Rating Agencies
from time to time as being consistent with their then-current ratings of the
Notes. Any earnings (net of losses and investment expenses) on funds in the
Collection Account will be paid to the Seller. The Servicer will have the
revocable power to withdraw funds from the Collection Account and to instruct
the Deposit Trustee to make withdrawals and payments from the Collection Account
for the purpose of carrying out its duties under the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement and the Series 1996-2 Supplement.
 
ALLOCATIONS AND COLLECTIONS
 
   
     All collections on the Credit Lines will be allocated in accordance with
the Credit Line Agreements between amounts collected in respect of interest (the
"Interest Collections") and amounts collected in respect of principal, including
amounts constituting the principal portion of any repurchase of a Receivable
(the "Principal Collections"). Notwithstanding the requirements of the Credit
Line Agreements, however, for purposes hereof, all Recoveries (whether interest
or principal) shall be treated as Interest Collections and not Principal
Collections.
    
 
     Prior to an Early Amortization Period, the portion of Interest Collections
allocable to the Series 1996-2 Participation will equal the Floating Allocation
Percentage of such Interest Collections. The remaining amount of Interest
Collections shall be allocated to the Seller's Interest or other Series
Participation Interests, as applicable. During an Early Amortization Period,
Interest Collections allocated to the Series 1996-2 Participation will equal the
Fixed Allocation Percentage of such Interest Collections. However, during an
Early Amortization Period, Defaulted Amounts allocated to the Series 1996-2
Participation shall continue to be made based upon the Floating Allocation
Percentage.
 
     For any Collection Period prior to the Accelerated Amortization Date or the
commencement of an Early Amortization Period, Principal Collections will be
allocated to the Series 1996-2 Participation based upon the greater of: (i) the
Floating Allocation of Net Principal Collections or (ii) the Minimum Principal
Amount. For any Collection Period after the Accelerated Amortization Date or
during an Early Amortization Period, the Series 1996-2 Participation will be
entitled to Principal Collections based upon the Fixed Allocation Percentage. As
of any Determination Date, "Net Principal Collections" equal the excess, if any,
of Principal Collections for the related Collection Period, less Additional
Balances sold to the Deposit Trust during such Collection Period.
 
   
     As of any Determination Date, the "Floating Allocation Percentage" is
calculated as a fraction, the numerator of which is the Series 1996-2
Participation Invested Amount as of the last day of the related Collection
Period and the denominator of which is the greater of (a) the Pool Balance as of
the first day of the related Collection Period and (b) the sum of the numerators
used to calculate the Allocation Percentage of Finance Charge and Administrative
Receivables, Principal Receivables and Defaulted Amounts, as applicable, for all
outstanding Series Participation Interests for the related Distribution Date.
    
 
     As of any Determination Date, the "Fixed Allocation Percentage" is
calculated as a fraction, the numerator of which is the Series 1996-2
Participation Invested Amount as of the last day immediately preceding the
commencement of an Early Amortization Period or the Accelerated Amortization
Date, as applicable, and the denominator of which is the greater of (a) the Pool
Balance as of the first day of the related Collection Period and (b) the sum of
the numerators used to calculate the Allocation Percentage of Finance Charges
and Administrative Receivables, Principal Receivables and Defaulted Amounts, as
applicable, for all outstanding Series Participation Interests for the related
Distribution Date.
 
     For any Distribution Date, the Fixed Allocation Percentage applicable to
Principal Collections may be different than the Fixed Allocation Percentage
applicable to Interest Collections if an Amortization Event occurs after the
Accelerated Amortization Date.
 
                                       57
<PAGE>   60
 
     "Recoveries" means amounts collected or received with respect to Defaulted
Credit Lines, net of costs and expenses of recovery.
 
     With respect to any date, the "Pool Balance" will be equal to the aggregate
of the Principal Balances of all Credit Lines as of such date. The "Principal
Balance" of a Credit Line (other than a Defaulted Credit Line) on any day is
equal to its Principal Balance on the respective Cut-Off Date, plus (i) any
Additional Balance in respect of such Credit Line, minus (ii) all Principal
Collections credited against the Principal Balance prior to such day, minus
(iii) all related Defaulted Amounts, and plus or minus (iv) any correcting
adjustments. The Principal Balance of a Defaulted Credit Line shall be zero.
With respect to any Distribution Date, a "Defaulted Amount" is the amount equal
to the Principal Balance of a Defaulted Credit Line that the Servicer has
charged off on its servicing records in the related Collection Period. A
"Defaulted Credit Line" is a Credit Line as to which the Servicer has charged
off all of the related Principal Balance.
 
COLLECTION AND OTHER SERVICING PROCEDURES
 
   
     The Servicer will make reasonable efforts to collect all payments called
for under the Credit Lines and will, consistent with the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement, follow such collection procedures as it follows from time to time
with respect to the consumer loans in its servicing portfolio which are
comparable to the Credit Lines. Consistent with the above, the Servicer may in
its discretion waive any late payment charge or any assumption or other fee or
charge that may be collected in the ordinary course of servicing the Credit
Lines.
    
 
     The Servicer may arrange with a borrower a schedule for the payment of
interest due and unpaid for a period, provided that any such arrangement is
consistent with the Servicer's policies with respect to comparable consumer
loans held in its portfolio. In accordance with the terms of the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement, the Servicer may consent under certain circumstances to the
placing of a subsequent senior lien in respect of a Personal Homeowner Credit
Line.
 
   
     In any case in which a property against which a lien was filed in
connection with a Personal Homeowner Credit Line is being conveyed by the
borrower, the Servicer is not obligated to exercise its rights to accelerate the
maturity of such Credit Line under any due-on-sale clause applicable thereto. To
the extent the Servicer becomes aware of such a conveyance, it will generally
attempt to open a new secured or unsecured line of credit with the borrower,
thereby paying off the balance of the Personal Homeowner Credit Line. In the
event a new credit line is not established, the Servicer will enforce the
due-on-sale clause unless prohibited by applicable law from doing so. See
"Certain Legal Aspects of Receivables -- 'Due-on-Sale' Clauses" herein.
    
 
SERVICING COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES
 
   
     As long as HFC is the Servicer it will receive, or be entitled to retain on
behalf of itself and the Subservicers, a portion of the Interest Collections
remaining after distribution of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Distribution Amount and the Series 1996-2 Participation Principal Distribution
Amount as a servicing fee. Such fee attributable to the Series 1996-2
Participation will be paid monthly in arrears in the amount of 2.00% per annum
of the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount as of the end of the related
Collection Period (the "Servicing Fee"). If HFC is no longer the Servicer, the
Servicing Fee will be paid to the successor Servicer from Interest Collections
prior to any distributions on the Series 1996-2 Participation.
    
 
     The Servicer will pay certain ongoing expenses associated with the Deposit
Trust and incurred by it in connection with its responsibilities under the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement, including, without limitation, payment of the
fees and disbursements of the Deposit Trustee, and any Paying Agent. In
addition, the Servicer will be entitled to reimbursement for certain expenses
incurred by it in connection with defaulted Credit Lines, such right of
reimbursement being prior to the rights of holders of any Series Participation
Interests, including the Series 1996-2 Participation, to receive any related
Recoveries.
 
                                       58
<PAGE>   61
 
EVIDENCE AS TO COMPLIANCE
 
     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement provides for delivery on or before
March 31 in each year, to the Deposit Trustee, the Owner Trustee, the Indenture
Trustee and the Rating Agencies of an annual statement signed by an officer of
the Servicer to the effect that the Servicer has fulfilled its material
obligations under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement throughout the preceding
calendar year, except as specified in such statement.
 
     On or before March 31 of each year, the Servicer will furnish a report
prepared by a firm of independent public accountants to the Deposit Trustee, the
Owner Trustee, the Indenture Trustee and the Rating Agencies to the effect that
such accountants have examined certain documents and the records relating to
servicing of credit lines under agreements (including the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement), and compared mathematical calculations for each monthly servicing
report with the Servicer's computer reports, and such examinations disclosed no
items of non-compliance with the provision of the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement or variations in the results of such calculations which, in the
opinion of the firm, are material, except for such items of non-compliance as
shall be referred to in the report.
 
CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE SERVICER AND THE SELLER
 
     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement provides that the Servicer may not
resign from its obligations and duties thereunder, except in connection with a
permitted transfer of servicing, unless (i) such duties and obligations are no
longer permissible under applicable law or are in conflict by reason of
applicable law with any other activities of a type and nature presently carried
on by it or (ii) upon the satisfaction of the following conditions: (a) the
Servicer has delivered an executed assumption agreement in form satisfactory to
the Deposit Trustee, assigning its obligations and duties to a wholly owned
subsidiary of Household International, Inc. or to another entity as to which the
Rating Agency Condition shall have been satisfied; and (b) the successor meets
the eligibility requirements specified in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.
No such resignation will become effective until the Deposit Trustee or a
successor servicer has assumed the Servicer's obligations and duties under the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement.
 
     The Servicer may perform any of its duties and obligations under the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement through one or more subservicers or delegates,
which may be affiliates of the Servicer. Notwithstanding any such arrangement,
the Servicer will remain liable and obligated to the Deposit Trustee, the
Indenture Trustee, and the holders of interests in the Deposit Trust for the
Servicer's duties and obligations under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement,
without any diminution of such duties and obligations and as if the Servicer
itself were performing such duties and obligations.
 
     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement provides that neither the Servicer, the
Seller, nor any director, officer, employee or agent of the Servicer or the
Seller will be under any liability to the Deposit Trust, the Indenture Trustee
or the holders of any Series Participation Interest and any Noteholders or
Certificateholders (together, "Securityholders") for any action taken or for
refraining from the taking of any action in good faith pursuant to the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement, or for errors in judgment; provided, however, that
neither the Servicer, the Seller nor any such person will be protected against
any liability which would otherwise be imposed by reason of willful misfeasance,
bad faith or gross negligence in the performance of duties or by reason of
reckless disregard of obligations and duties thereunder. The Pooling and
Servicing Agreement further provides that the Servicer, the Seller and any
director, officer, employee or agent of the Servicer or the Seller is entitled
to indemnification by the Deposit Trust and will be held harmless against any
loss, liability or expense incurred in connection with any legal action relating
to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or any interest in the Deposit Trust,
other than any loss, liability or expense related to any specific Credit Line
(except any such loss, liability or expense otherwise reimbursable pursuant to
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement) and any loss, liability or expense incurred
by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence in the
performance of duties thereunder or by reason of reckless disregard of
obligations and duties thereunder. In addition, the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement provides that neither the Servicer nor the Seller will be under any
obligation to appear in, prosecute or defend any legal action which is not
incidental to its respective duties under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement
and which in its opinion may involve it in any
 
                                       59
<PAGE>   62
 
expense or liability. The Servicer or the Seller may, however, in its or their
discretion undertake any such action which it or they may deem necessary or
desirable with respect to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the rights and
duties of the parties thereto and the interests of the holders of interest
thereunder. In such event, the legal expenses and costs of such action and any
liability resulting therefrom and any claims by the Servicer or the Seller for
indemnification will be expenses, costs and liabilities of the Deposit Trust and
the Servicer or the Seller, as the case may be, will be entitled to be
reimbursed therefor and indemnified pursuant to the terms of the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement out of funds otherwise distributable to holders of interests
in the Deposit Trust. The Servicer's right to such indemnity or reimbursement
shall survive any resignation or termination of the Servicer with respect to any
losses, expenses, costs or liabilities arising prior to such resignation or
termination (or arising from events that occurred prior to such resignation or
termination).
 
     Any corporation into which the Servicer or the Seller may be merged or
consolidated, or any corporation resulting from any merger, conversion or
consolidation to which the Servicer or the Seller shall be a party, or any
corporation succeeding to the business of the Servicer or the Seller shall be
the successor of the Servicer or the Seller under the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement.
 
SERVICER DEFAULTS
 
     "Servicer Defaults" will consist of: (i) any failure by the Servicer to
deposit in the Collection Account any deposit, or to give instructions to the
Deposit Trustee to make a payment, transfer or deposit required to be made under
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement which failure continues unremedied for five
Business Days after the date such payment, transfer or deposit was required to
be made or given; (ii) any failure by the Servicer duly to observe or perform in
any material respect any other of its covenants or agreements in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement which has an Adverse Effect and continues unremedied for 60
days after the giving of written notice of such failure to the Servicer by the
Deposit Trustee, or to the Servicer and the Deposit Trustee by holders of
interests in the Deposit Trust evidencing not less than 10% of the then
outstanding principal amount of each such affected interest; (iii) any breach of
a representation or warranty or untrue certification by the Servicer which has
an Adverse Effect and continues unremedied for 60 days after the giving of
written notice of such failure to the Servicer by the Deposit Trustee, or to the
Servicer and the Deposit Trustee by holders of interests in the Deposit Trust
evidencing not less than 10% of the then outstanding principal amount of each
such affected interest; or (iv) the occurrence of certain events of bankruptcy,
insolvency or receivership relating to the Servicer as set forth in the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement which, in the case of the occurrence of such events
without the consent of the Servicer, continue unremedied for 60 days.
 
     Notwithstanding the foregoing, a delay in or failure of performance
referred to under clauses (ii) or (iii) above, if applicable, for a period of 60
days after the applicable grace period, shall not constitute a Servicer Default
if such delay or failure could not be prevented by the exercise of reasonable
diligence by the Servicer and such delay or failure was caused by an act of God
or other similar occurrence. Upon the occurrence of any such event the Servicer
shall not be relieved from using its best efforts to perform its obligations in
a timely manner in accordance with the terms of the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement and the Servicer shall provide the Deposit Trustee, the Seller, and
the holders of interests in the Deposit Trust prompt notice of such failure or
delay by it, together with a description of its efforts to so perform its
obligations.
 
RIGHTS UPON A SERVICER DEFAULT
 
     So long as a Servicer Default remains unremedied, either (a) the Deposit
Trustee or (b) the holders of Series Participation Interests in the Deposit
Trust evidencing more than 50% of the then aggregate outstanding principal
amount of each such interest may terminate all of the rights and obligations of
the Servicer under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and in and to the Credit
Lines, whereupon a successor Servicer, appointed by the Deposit Trustee, or if
no successor has been appointed by the date the Servicer's rights and
obligations are terminated, the Deposit Trustee, will succeed to all the
responsibilities, duties and liabilities of the Servicer under such Agreement
and will be entitled to similar compensation arrangements. In addition, if the
Deposit Trustee has not received any bids from potential successor Servicers
within 60 days of
 
                                       60
<PAGE>   63
 
the date notice of termination has been delivered to the Servicer and the
Servicer Default cannot be cured, the Seller shall have the right, but not an
obligation, to repurchase the outstanding Series Participation Interests on the
following Distribution Date for an amount equal to the Transfer Price. In the
event that the Deposit Trustee would be obligated to succeed the Servicer but is
unwilling or unable so to act, it may appoint, or petition a court of competent
jurisdiction for the appointment of, a consumer loan servicer with all licenses
and permits required to perform its obligations under the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement and having a net worth of at least $50,000,000 and reasonably
acceptable to the Rating Agencies to act as successor to the Servicer under the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement. Pending such appointment, the Deposit Trustee
will be obligated to act in such capacity unless prohibited by law. Such
successor will be entitled to receive the same compensation that the Servicer
would otherwise have received (or such lesser compensation as the Deposit
Trustee and such successor may agree). A receiver or conservator for the
Servicer may be empowered to prevent the termination and replacement of the
Servicer where the only Servicer Default that has occurred is an Insolvency
Event (as defined in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement).
 
     No holder of a Series Participation Interest in the Deposit Trust will have
any right under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement to direct the time, method
and place of exercising any remedy, trust or power of the Deposit Trustee unless
such holders of Series Participation Interests in the Deposit Trust evidencing
more than 50% of the then aggregate outstanding principal amount of each such
interest have made written request upon the Deposit Trustee to take such action;
provided, however, under certain circumstances described in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement, upon the advice of counsel, the Deposit Trustee may refuse
to take such action. However, the Deposit Trustee will be under no obligation to
exercise any of the trusts or powers vested in it by the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement or to make any investigation of matters arising thereunder or to
institute, conduct or defend any litigation thereunder or in relation thereto at
the request, order or direction of any of the holders of Series Participation
Interest covered by such Agreement, unless such holders have offered to the
Deposit Trustee reasonable security or indemnity against the costs, expenses and
liabilities which may be incurred therein or thereby.
 
AMENDMENT
 
   
     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement and any supplement thereto may be
amended by the Seller, the Servicer and the Deposit Trustee, without consent of
the holders of the Series 1996-2 Participation, any other Series Participation
Interest or the Series 1996-2 Securities, to (a) add an additional Seller under
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, (b) modify or eliminate certain provisions
for (i) the dissolution of the trusts created thereby upon an Insolvency Event
of the Seller, or (ii) the imposition of certain expenses of such trust upon the
Seller, provided, in either case, an opinion of tax counsel is delivered to the
Deposit Trustee stating that such provisions are no longer necessary to sustain
the tax treatment of the trusts or (c) accomplish any other purpose other than
as set forth in the following paragraph. However, no amendment may be made
without the consent of holders of the Series 1996-2 Participation or any other
Participation Interest unless the Seller certifies to the Deposit Trustee and
the Rating Agencies that it does not believe such amendment will have an Adverse
Effect.
    
 
   
     The Pooling and Servicing Agreement or any supplement thereto may be
amended by the Seller, the Servicer and the Deposit Trustee with the consent of
the holders of Series Participation Interests evidencing not less than 66 2/3%
of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Series Participation Interests
of all affected Series for which the Seller has not delivered an officer's
certificate stating that there is no Adverse Effect, for the purpose of adding
any provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions
of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or any supplement thereto or of modifying
in any manner the rights of holders of Series Participation Interests. No such
amendment, however, may (a) reduce in any manner the amount of, or delay the
timing of, deposits or distributions on any Series Participation Interests
without the consent of each holder of Series Participation Interests affected
thereby, (b)(i) change the definition or the manner of calculating the interest
of any Series Participation Interests or (ii) reduce the aforesaid percentage of
the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Series Participation Interests the
holders of which are required to consent to any such amendment, in each case
without the consent of each holder of a Series Participation Interest, or (d)
adversely affect the rating of any series or class of securities without the
consent of the holders of Series Participation Interests evidencing not less
than 66 2/3% of the aggregate unpaid
    
 
                                       61
<PAGE>   64
 
principal amount of the Series Participation Interests affected thereby.
Promptly following the execution of any amendment to the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement (other than an amendment described in the preceding paragraph), the
Deposit Trustee will furnish written notice of the substance of such amendment
to holders of Series Participation Interests. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any
supplement executed in connection with the issuance of one or more subsequent
Series will not be considered an amendment to the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement. Any designation of additional Sellers in accordance with the terms of
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement will also not be considered an amendment of
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement unless the supplement designating such
additional Seller expressly amends the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.
 
EXERCISE OF RIGHTS BY HOLDERS OF SERIES PARTICIPATION INTERESTS
 
   
     The Series 1996-2 Participation will be the third Series Participation
Interest issued by the Deposit Trust. It is anticipated that additional Series
Participation Interests will be issued and held by issuers such as the Issuer
and will be the basis for the issuance of additional series of securities. The
rights of such holders to direct the voting of the related Series Participation
Interest will be governed by the documents pursuant to which such additional
series are issued and may be different from such provisions relating to the
Series 1996-2 Participation. It is not expected that holders of the Series
1996-2 Securities will hold voting power sufficient to unilaterally direct any
action with respect to the Deposit Trust. As additional Series Participation
Interests are issued and the Series 1996-2 Participation is reduced, the
relative interest of the Series 1996-2 Securities in the Deposit Trust will be
reduced, thereby further reducing the voting power of such securities.
    
 
THE DEPOSIT TRUSTEE
 
   
     The commercial bank or trust company serving as Deposit Trustee may have
other banking relationships with the Seller and/or its affiliates, including the
Servicer.
    
 
     The Deposit Trustee may resign at any time, in which event the Seller will
be obligated to appoint a successor Deposit Trustee. The Seller may also remove
the Deposit Trustee if the Deposit Trustee ceases to be eligible to continue as
such under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or if the Deposit Trustee becomes
insolvent. Upon becoming aware of such circumstances, the Seller will be
obligated to appoint a successor Deposit Trustee. Any resignation or removal of
the Deposit Trustee and appointment of a successor Deposit Trustee will not
become effective until acceptance of the appointment by the successor Deposit
Trustee.
 
   
CERTAIN ACTIVITIES
    
 
   
     The Deposit Trust will not: (i) borrow money; (ii) make loans; (iii) invest
in securities for the purpose of exercising control; (iv) underwrite securities;
(v) except as provided in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, engage in the
purchase and sale (or turnover) of investments; (vi) offer securities or other
interests in exchange for property (except Series Participation Interests); or
(vii) repurchase or otherwise reacquire its securities. See "Description of the
Deposit Trust -- Evidence as to Compliance" for information regarding reports as
to the compliance by the Servicer with the terms of the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement.
    
 
DISTRIBUTIONS ON THE SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION
 
     Beginning with the Distribution Date occurring in September 1996,
distributions on the Series 1996-2 Participation will be made by the Deposit
Trustee or the Paying Agent on each Distribution Date to the Indenture Trustee.
The term "Distribution Date" means the Business Day prior to the Payment Date in
each month. Distributions will be made by wire transfer to the Payment Account
maintained by the Indenture Trustee.
 
     Interest Distributions. On each Distribution Date, the Deposit Trustee or
the Paying Agent will distribute to the Indenture Trustee from the applicable
Allocation Percentage of Interest Collections for the preceding Collection
Period an amount equal to the amount accrued at the Participation Pass-Through
Rate on the unpaid Principal Balance of the Series 1996-2 Participation,
calculated on the basis of the actual number of days elapsed, from and
including, the preceding Distribution Date (or in the case of the first
Distribution Date,
 
                                       62
<PAGE>   65
 
   
the Closing Date), to but excluding, the current Distribution Date and a 360 day
year. The "Participation Pass-Through Rate" for each Distribution Date is a per
annum rate equal to the Prime Rate as published by the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System in Statistical Release H.15(519), Selected Interest
Rates, or any successor publication ("Prime Rate") as of the first day of the
related Interest Period, less 1.50%, subject to a minimum rate equal to a per
annum rate which will result in an amount which will be sufficient to pay the
full amount of interest due on the Notes and to make a full distribution on the
Certificates at the Certificate Rate, plus 0.25% of the Series 1996-2
Participation Invested Amount in respect of the Accelerated Principal Payment
Amount. See "Description of the Securities -- Distributions on the Securities"
herein.
    
 
     Principal Distributions. On each Distribution Date, the Deposit Trustee or
the Paying Agent will distribute to the Indenture Trustee on behalf of the
Issuer, the Floating or Fixed Allocation Percentage (as applicable) of Principal
Collections or Net Principal Collections (as applicable); provided that prior to
an Early Amortization Period or the Accelerated Amortization Date, if the
Floating Allocation Percentage of Net Principal Collections is less than the
Minimum Principal Amount, the amount of Principal Collections distributable on
the Series 1996-2 Participation shall be the Minimum Principal Amount.
 
   
     The "Minimum Principal Amount" for any Distribution Date prior to the
Accelerated Amortization Date and the occurrence of an Early Amortization Event
is the lesser of (a) the Floating Allocation Percentage of Principal Collections
for such Distribution Date and (b) the amount by which 1.8% of the Series 1996-2
Participation Invested Amount exceeds the portion of the amount of the Defaulted
Amount allocated to the Series 1996-2 Participation that is covered by the
applicable Allocation Percentage of Finance Charges and Administrative
Receivables in excess of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Distribution
Amount distributed on the Series 1996-2 Participation on such Distribution Date.
    
 
                         DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES
 
     The Notes will be issued pursuant to the Indenture. The Certificates will
be issued pursuant to the Trust Agreement. Forms of the Indenture and Trust
Agreement have been filed as exhibits to the Registration Statement of which
this Prospectus is a part. The following summaries describe certain provisions
of the Indenture and Trust Agreement. The summaries do not purport to be
complete and are subject to, and are qualified in their entirety by reference
to, all of the provisions of the Indenture and Trust Agreement. Wherever defined
terms of the Indenture and Trust Agreement (not otherwise defined herein) are
referred to, such defined terms are hereby incorporated herein by reference.
Additionally, capitalized terms used herein that are not defined herein shall
have the meanings ascribed to them in the Indenture and Trust Agreement.
 
GENERAL
 
     The Notes will be issued only in fully registered form, in denominations of
$100,000 and integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof. The Notes will be
secured by the Trust Assets pledged by the Issuer to the Indenture Trustee
pursuant to the Indenture which will consist of: (i) the Series 1996-2
Participation (ii) collections in respect of the Series 1996-2 Participation;
(iii) amounts on deposit in the Payment Account (excluding net earnings thereon)
and (iv) an assignment of the Issuer's rights under the Series 1996-2
Supplement. Definitive Notes, if issued, will be transferable and exchangeable
at the corporate trust office of the Indenture Trustee, which will initially act
as Note Registrar. See "Registration of Notes" below. No service charge will be
made for any registration, exchange or transfer of Notes, but the Indenture
Trustee may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other
governmental charge.
 
   
     Application will be made to list the Notes on the Luxembourg Stock
Exchange.
    
 
DISTRIBUTIONS ON THE SECURITIES
 
     Beginning with the Payment Date occurring in September, 1996, distributions
on the Notes will be made by the Indenture Trustee or the Paying Agent on each
Payment Date to the persons in whose names such Notes are registered
("Noteholders") at the close of business on the day prior to each Payment Date
(the
 
                                       63
<PAGE>   66
 
"Record Date"), except as provided in "Registration of Notes" below. The term
"Payment Date" means the fifteenth day of each month (or if such day is not a
Business Day, the next succeeding Business Day). Distributions will be made by
check or money order mailed (or upon the request of a Noteholder owning Notes
having denominations aggregating at least $5,000,000, by wire transfer or
otherwise) to the address of the person entitled thereto (which, in the case of
book-entry certificates, will be DTC or its nominee) as it appears on the Note
Register in amounts calculated as described herein on the fifth Business Day
prior to the related Payment Date (the "Determination Date"). However, the final
distribution in respect of the Notes will be made only upon presentation and
surrender thereof at the office or the agency of the Indenture Trustee specified
in the notice to Noteholders of such final distribution. A "Business Day" is any
day other than (i) a Saturday or Sunday or (ii) a day on which banking
institutions in the States of New York or Illinois are required or authorized by
law to be closed.
 
     Allocation of Remittances on the Series 1996-2 Participation. The Indenture
Trustee will establish and maintain an account (the "Payment Account") into
which the Deposit Trustee will wire the remittances on the Series 1996-2
Participation for the related Collection Period. Each Distribution Date with
respect to the Series 1996-2 Participation will be the Business Day prior to
each Payment Date on the Securities. The Payment Account will be an Eligible
Account. Amounts on deposit in the Payment Account will be invested in certain
investments acceptable to the Rating Agencies on or before the Business Day
prior to the related Payment Date.
 
     Except as provided below, on each Payment Date other than a Payment Date
occurring after an Event of Default, remittances on the Series 1996-2
Participation will be allocated in the following order of priority:
 
   
          (i) sequentially, as payment for the amount of interest due on the
     Class A-1 Notes, Class A-2 Notes, Class A-3 Notes and Class B Notes;
    
 
   
          (ii) except as otherwise specified below, to the Certificates on
     behalf of the Issuer, as payment of the amount distributable in respect of
     the Certificate Rate on the Security Balance of the Certificates and
     previously unpaid;
    
 
   
          (iii) sequentially, up to the Optimum Monthly Principal,
    
 
   
             (a) to the Class A-1 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-1 Notes would equal the Class A-1 Targeted Principal Balance,
    
 
   
             (b) to the Class A-2 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-2 Notes would equal the Class A-2 Targeted Principal Balance, to the
        extent the Adjusted Security Balance of the Class A-2 Notes would not be
        reduced below the Minimum Security Balance for the Class A-2 Notes,
    
 
   
             (c) to the Class A-3 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-3 Notes would equal the Class A-3 Targeted Principal Balance, to the
        extent the Adjusted Security Balance of the Class A-3 Notes would not be
        reduced below the Minimum Security Balance for the Class A-3 Notes, and
    
 
   
             (d) to the Class B Notes until the Security Balance of the Class B
        Notes would equal the Class B Targeted Principal Balance, to the extent
        the Adjusted Security Balance of the Class B Notes would not be reduced
        below the Minimum Security Balance for the Class B Notes;
    
 
   
          (iv) to the Certificates, up to the remaining Optimum Monthly
     Principal until the Security Balance of the Certificates would equal the
     Certificate Targeted Balance, to the extent the Adjusted Security Balance
     of the Certificates would not be reduced below $7,900,000;
    
 
   
          (v) to the Seller, up to the remaining Optimum Monthly Principal
     provided the Overcollateralization Amount is not less than $14,800,000;
    
 
                                       64
<PAGE>   67
 
   
          (vi) as principal on the Notes, sequentially, up to the Accelerated
     Principal Payment Amount for such Payment Date:
    
 
   
             (a) to the Class A-1 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-1 Notes would equal the Class A-1 Targeted Principal Balance,
    
 
   
             (b) to the Class A-2 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-2 Notes would equal the Class A-2 Targeted Principal Balance, to the
        extent the Adjusted Security Balance of the Class A-2 Notes would not be
        reduced below the Minimum Security Balance for the Class A-2 Notes,
    
 
   
             (c) to the Class A-3 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-3 Notes would equal the Class A-3 Targeted Principal Balance, to the
        extent the Adjusted Security Balance of the Class A-3 Notes would not be
        reduced below the Minimum Security Balance for the Class A-3 Notes,
    
 
   
             (d) to the Class B Notes until the Security Balance of the Class B
        Notes would equal the Class B Targeted Principal Balance, to the extent
        the Adjusted Security Balance of the Class B Notes would not be reduced
        below the Minimum Security Balance for the Class B Notes,
    
 
   
             (e) to the Class A-1 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-1 Notes would equal zero,
    
 
   
             (f) to the Class A-2 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-2 Notes would equal zero,
    
 
   
             (g) to the Class A-3 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-3 Notes would equal zero, and
    
 
   
             (h) to the Class B Notes until the Security Balance of the Class B
        Notes would equal zero;
    
 
   
          (vii) as principal on the Notes, sequentially, up to the remaining
     Optimum Monthly Principal for such Payment Date;
    
 
   
             (a) to the Class A-1 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-1 Notes would equal zero,
    
 
   
             (b) to the Class A-2 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-2 Notes would equal zero,
    
 
   
             (c) to the Class A-3 Notes until the Security Balance of the Class
        A-3 Notes would equal zero, and
    
 
   
             (d) to the Class B Notes until the Security Balance of the Class B
        Notes would equal zero;
    
 
   
          (viii) to the Certificates, up to the remaining Optimum Monthly
     Principal until the Security Balance of the Certificates would equal the
     Certificate Minimum Balance, or if the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested
     Amount is zero, then to the Certificates until the Security Balance of the
     Certificates would equal zero;
    
 
   
          (ix) to the Seller provided the Overcollateralization Amount is
     greater than zero, the remaining Optimum Monthly Principal; and
    
 
   
          (x) any remaining amounts to the Issuer or its designee.
    
 
   
     In the event (a) immediately prior to a Distribution Date the Series 1996-2
Participation Invested Amount is less than the aggregate Security Balance of the
Class A and Class B Notes immediately prior to the related Payment Date, or (b)
the remittances on the Series 1996-2 Participation for a Payment Date is less
than the aggregate amount to be paid pursuant to clauses (i) and (ii) above, the
amount to be paid pursuant to clause (ii) above will be paid only after payments
are made on the Notes pursuant to clause (iii).
    
 
                                       65
<PAGE>   68
 
     The defined terms used in this description of Allocation of Remittances on
the Series 1996-2 Participation are defined as follows:
 
   
     For each Payment Date, the "Accelerated Principal Payment Amount" is equal
to the lesser of (i) the amount by which the remittance on the Series 1996-2
Participation exceeds the sum of (a) the amount to be distributed on the Notes
with respect to interest and the Certificates in respect of the Certificate Rate
on such Payment Date and (b) the Optimum Monthly Principal for such Payment Date
and (ii) one-twelfth of the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount,
multiplied by 0.25%.
    
 
     With respect to any Payment Date, the "Adjusted Security Balance" of a
Class of Notes or of the Certificates shall equal the related Security Balance
on the Closing Date after giving effect to distributions thereon in respect of
principal on all Payment Dates (including the current Payment Date), less any
Net Charge-Off allocated to such Security on such Payment Date.
 
   
     With respect to any Payment Date, the "Certificate Minimum Balance" shall
equal the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount after giving effect to the
distribution made on the Series 1996-2 Participation on such Payment Date,
multiplied by 3.0304%.
    
 
   
     With respect to any Payment Date, the "Certificate Targeted Balance" shall
equal (i) the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amounts, multiplied by 91.5%,
less (ii) the Adjusted Security Balance of each Class of Notes immediately prior
to such Payment Date and after giving effect to payments of principal on the
Class A Notes and Class B Notes pursuant to clause (iii) above, respectively, on
such Payment Date.
    
 
   
     With respect to any Payment Date, "Class A-1 Targeted Principal Balance"
shall equal the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount multiplied by
52.0000%.
    
 
   
     With respect to any Payment Date, "Class A-2 Targeted Principal Balance"
shall equal the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount multiplied by
62.7864%, less the Adjusted Security Balance of the Class A-1 Notes immediately
prior to such Payment Date after giving effect to payments of principal on the
Class A-1 Notes pursuant to clause (iii)(a) above, on such Payment Date.
    
 
   
     With respect to any Payment Date, "Class A-3 Targeted Principal Balance"
shall equal the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount multiplied by
76.8062%, less the aggregate of the Adjusted Security Balances of the Class A-1
and Class A-2 Notes immediately prior to such Payment Date after giving effect
to payments of principal on the Class A-1 and Class A-2 Notes pursuant to
clauses (iii)(a) and (iii)(b) above, on such Payment Date.
    
 
   
     With respect to any Payment Date, the "Class B Targeted Principal Balance"
shall equal the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount multiplied by
87.0000%, less the aggregate Adjusted Security Balance for the Class A Notes
immediately prior to such Payment Date after giving effect to payments of
principal on the Class A Notes pursuant to clauses (iii)(a), (iii)(b) and
(iii)(c) above, on such Payment Date.
    
 
   
     With respect to any Payment Date, the "Minimum Security Balance" shall
equal with respect to the Class A-2 Notes, Class A-3 Notes and the Class B
Notes, $18,800,000, $24,500,000 and $17,800,000, respectively.
    
 
     As to any Payment Date, "Net Charge-Off" shall equal the aggregate Optimum
Monthly Principal not distributed for this and all prior Payment Dates and
reduced by aggregate Reversals distributed on this and all prior Payment Dates.
The Net Charge-Off will be allocated to the Series 1996-2 Securities in the
manner as set forth herein under "Allocations of Defaulted Amounts and
Reversals".
 
     As to each Payment Date, "Optimum Monthly Principal" shall mean the amount
equal to the sum of (a) the Series 1996-2 Participation Principal Distribution
Amount, (b) the amount of the reduction in the Series 1996-2 Participation
Invested Amount during the preceding Collection Period that was not included in
the Series 1996-2 Participation Principal Distribution Amount, and (c) the
lesser of (i) the amount, if any, by which the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest Distribution Amount exceeds the sum of (x) the amounts to be
distributed on such Payment Date pursuant to clauses (i)-(iii) above, and (y)
the amount referred to in clause (b) above, and (ii) the Net Charge-Off as of
the preceding Payment Date.
 
                                       66
<PAGE>   69
 
   
     With respect to any Payment Date, the "Overcollateralization Amount" shall
equal the amount by which the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount
exceeds the aggregate of the Security Balances, in each case after giving effect
to distributions on such Payment Date. As of the Closing Date, the
Overcollateralization Amount will be $44,404,000 or 4.25% of the balance of the
Series 1996-2 Participation.
    
 
     The "Security Balance" of any Note on any day is the respective initial
principal balance as of the Closing Date, reduced by all payments of principal
thereon as of such day.
 
   
     Allocations of Defaulted Amounts and Reversals. On each Payment Date with
respect to which the Series 1996-2 Participation is reduced due to Defaulted
Amounts during the related Collection Period and less than the Optimum Monthly
Principal is distributed in respect of principal on such Payment Date, the
amount that was not distributed shall be allocated in the following order of
priority:
    
 
          (i) if the Overcollateralization Amount is zero, to the Adjusted
     Security Balance of the Certificates until such balance equals zero;
 
   
          (ii) to the Adjusted Security Balance of the Class B Notes until such
     balance equals zero;
    
 
   
          (iii) to the Adjusted Security Balance of the Class A-3 Notes until
     such balance equals zero;
    
 
   
          (iv) to the Adjusted Security Balance of the Class A-2 Notes until
     such balance equals zero; and
    
 
   
          (v) to the Adjusted Security Balance of the Class A-1 Notes until such
     balance equals zero.
    
 
     On each Payment Date with respect to which a Reversal exists, such Reversal
shall be allocated in the following order of priority:
 
   
          (1) to the Adjusted Security Balance for the Class A-1 Notes until
     such balance equals the Security Balance for the Class A-1 Notes;
    
 
   
          (2) to the Adjusted Security Balance for the Class A-2 Notes until
     such balance equals the Security Balance for the Class A-2 Notes;
    
 
   
          (3) to the Adjusted Security Balance for the Class A-3 Notes until
     such balance equals the Security Balance for the Class A-3 Notes;
    
 
   
          (4) to the Adjusted Security Balance for the Class B Notes until such
     balance equals the Security Balance for the Class B Notes; and
    
 
   
          (5) to the Adjusted Security Balance for the Certificates until such
     balance equals the Security Balance for the Certificates.
    
 
     As to any Payment Date, "Reversals" is the sum of (a) the lesser of (i) the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Distribution Amount, reduced by the sum of
amounts to be distributed pursuant to clauses (i)-(iii) of Allocation of
Remittances on the Series 1996-2 Participation and the amount of the reduction
in the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount during the preceding
Collection Period that was not included in the Series 1996-2 Participation
Principal Distribution Amount for the related Distribution Date, and (ii) the
Net Charge-Off, and (b) the portion of the Defaulted Amounts allocated to the
Series 1996-2 Participation on prior Distribution Dates for which payments on
the Series 1996-2 Participation Principal Distribution Amount in respect thereof
have been made on the related Distribution Date. On any Payment Date, Reversals
for such date may not exceed the amount of the Net Charge-Off on the preceding
Payment Date.
 
   
     Interest. On each Payment Date, interest payments will be made on the Notes
and distributions on the Certificates at the respective Note Rates and
Certificate Rate for the related Interest Period. The Note Rate for an Interest
Period will generally be the per annum rate equal to the sum of (a) LIBOR,
determined as specified herein, as of the second LIBOR Business Day prior to the
first day of such Interest Period (or as of two LIBOR Business Days prior to the
Closing Date, in the case of the first Interest Period) plus (b)    % per annum
with respect to the Class A-1 Notes,    % per annum in the case of the Class A-2
Notes,    % per annum in the case of the Class A-3 Notes and    % per annum with
respect to the Class B Notes. The Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3 and Class B
Note Rates are subject to maximum rates equal to 13.0% per
    
 
                                       67
<PAGE>   70
 
   
annum, 15.0% per annum, 15.0% per annum and 15.0% per annum, respectively. The
"Certificate Rate" will generally be the per annum rate equal to the sum of (a)
LIBOR, determined as specified herein, as of the second LIBOR Business Day prior
to the first day of such Interest Period (or as of two LIBOR Business Days prior
to the Closing Date, in the case of the first Interest Period) plus (b) a rate
specified in the Trust Agreement.
    
 
     Interest on the Notes and the Certificate Rate on the Certificates in
respect of any Payment Date will accrue on the applicable Security Balance from
(and including) the preceding Payment Date (or in the case of the first Payment
Date, from (and including) the date of the initial issuance of the Series 1996-2
Securities (the "Closing Date")) through (and including) the day preceding such
Payment Date (each such period, an "Interest Period") on the basis of the actual
number of days in the Interest Period and a 360-day year. Interest for any
Payment Date due but not paid on such Payment Date shall bear interest, to the
extent permitted by applicable law, at the related Note Rate until paid.
 
     On each Payment Date, LIBOR shall be established by the Indenture Trustee
and as to any Interest Period, "LIBOR" will equal the rate for United States
dollar deposits for one month which appears on the Telerate Screen Page 3750 as
of 11:00 A.M., London time, on the second LIBOR Business Day prior to the first
day of such Interest Period. "Telerate Screen Page 3750" means the display
designated as page 3750 on the Telerate Service (or such other page as may
replace page 3750 on that service for the purpose of displaying London interbank
offered rates of major banks). If such rate does not appear on such page (or
such other page as may replace that page on that service, or if such service is
no longer offered, such other service for displaying LIBOR or comparable rates
as may be selected by the Indenture Trustee after consultation with the
Servicer), the rate will be the Reference Bank Rate. The "Reference Bank Rate"
will be determined on the basis of the rates at which deposits in U.S. Dollars
are offered by the reference banks (which shall be three major banks that are
engaged in transactions in the London interbank market, selected by the
Indenture Trustee after consultation with the Servicer) as of 11:00 A.M., London
time, on the day that is two LIBOR Business Days prior to the immediately
preceding Payment Date to prime banks in the London interbank market for a
period of one month in amounts approximately equal to the Security Balance then
outstanding. The Indenture Trustee will request the principal London office of
each of the reference banks to provide a quotation of its rate. If at least two
such quotations are provided, the rate will be the arithmetic mean of the
quotations. If on such date fewer than two quotations are provided as requested,
the rate will be the arithmetic mean of the rates quoted by one or more major
banks in New York City, selected by the Indenture Trustee after consultation
with the Servicer, as of 11:00 A.M., New York City time, on such date for loans
in U.S. Dollars to leading European banks for a period of one month in amounts
approximately equal to the Security Balance then outstanding. If no such
quotations can be obtained, the rate will be LIBOR for the prior Payment Date.
"LIBOR Business Day" means any day other than (i) a Saturday or a Sunday or (ii)
a day on which banking institutions in the State of New York or Illinois or in
the City of London, England are required or authorized by law to be closed.
 
   
     Principal. On each Payment Date, to the extent funds are available
therefore, other than the Payment Date in August 2006, principal payments except
as provided below will be due and payable on the Notes in the respective amounts
described under Allocation of Remittances on the Series 1996-2 Participation. On
the Payment Date in August 2006, principal will be due and payable on the Notes
in amounts equal to the Security Balance for each such Class on such Payment
Date. In addition, on any Payment Date, to the extent of funds available
therefor, each Class of Notes will also be entitled to receive principal
payments in respect of the Accelerated Principal Payment Amount, as further
described above under Allocation of Remittances on the Series 1996-2
Participation. In no event will principal payments on the Notes on any Payment
Date exceed the Security Balance thereof on such date.
    
 
   
     Overcollateralization Amount. The payment of the Accelerated Principal
Payment Amounts, if any, to Noteholders will increase the Overcollateralization
Amount. The Overcollateralization Amount will be available to absorb any
Defaulted Amounts that are allocated to the Noteholders or to the
Certificateholders and not covered by remittances on the Series 1996-2
Participation. The "Initial Overcollateralization Amount" is equal to
$44,404,000 or 4.25% (the "Initial Overcollateralization Percentage") of the
Initial Series 1996-2 Participation as of the Closing Date. On each Payment
Date, the "Overcollateralization
    
 
                                       68
<PAGE>   71
 
Amount" is the amount by which the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount
as of the end of the related Collection Period exceeds the sum of the Security
Balance of each Class of Notes and the Security Balance of Certificates on such
day (after giving effect to all amounts distributable and allocable to principal
on the Securities on such Payment Date).
 
EARLY AMORTIZATION PERIOD
 
     An "Early Amortization Period" will begin with the first day of the
Collection Period in which an Amortization Event has occurred. Upon commencement
of an Early Amortization Period, Interest Collections and Principal Collections
will be allocated to the Series 1996-2 Participation based upon the Fixed
Allocation Percentage which gives the Series 1996-2 Participation a greater
share of such collections each month. See "Maturity and Prepayment
Considerations" above.
 
     An "Amortization Event" will be deemed to occur:
 
          (a) upon failure on the part of the Seller (i) to make any payment or
     deposit required under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement within five
     Business Days after the date such payment or deposit is required to be
     made; or (ii) to observe or perform in any material respect any other
     covenants or agreements of the Seller set forth in the Pooling and
     Servicing Agreement as a result of which the interests of holders of
     interest in the Deposit Trust are materially and adversely affected, which
     failure continues unremedied for a period of 60 days after written notice;
 
          (b) if any representation or warranty made by the Seller in the
     Pooling and Servicing Agreement proves to have been incorrect in any
     material respect when made, as a result of which the interests of holders
     of interest in the Deposit Trust are materially and adversely affected, and
     which continues to be incorrect in any material respect and continues to
     materially and adversely affect the interests of holders of interest in the
     Deposit Trust for a period of 60 days after written notice; provided,
     however, that an Amortization Event shall not be deemed to occur if the
     Seller has repurchased the related Receivables, during such period (or
     within an additional 60 days with the consent of the Deposit Trustee) in
     accordance with the provisions of the Agreement;
 
          (c) upon the occurrence of certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or
     receivership relating to the Seller;
 
          (d) if the Deposit Trust or the Issuer becomes subject to regulation
     by the Commission as an investment company within the meaning of the
     Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended;
 
          (e) if a Servicer Default relating to the Servicer occurs under the
     Pooling and Servicing Agreement;
 
   
          (f) the percentage (averaged over any three consecutive months)
     obtained by dividing (i) the Overcollateralization Amount by (ii) the
     outstanding principal balance of the Series 1996-2 Participation is reduced
     below 4.25%; and
    
 
          (g) the portion of the Seller's Trust Amount owned by Household
     Consumer Loan Corporation is reduced below 1.01% of the aggregate invested
     amounts of all outstanding Series Participation Interests.
 
     In the case of any event described in (a), (b) or (e), an Amortization
Event will be deemed to have occurred only if, after any applicable grace period
described in such clauses, either the Deposit Trustee, or, holders of Series
Participation Interests in the Deposit Trust evidencing more than 50% of each
Series Participation Interest, by written notice to the Seller and the Servicer
(and to the Trustee, if given by the holders of interest in the Deposit Trust)
declare that an Amortization Event has occurred as of the date of such notice.
In the case of any event described in clauses (c), (d), (f) or (g), an
Amortization Event will be deemed to have immediately occurred without any
notice or other action on the part of the Deposit Trustee or the holders of
Series Participation Interests in the Deposit Trust.
 
     Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a conservator, receiver or
trustee-in-bankruptcy is appointed for the Seller and no Amortization Event
exists other than such conservatorship, receivership or insolvency of the
Seller, the conservator, receiver or trustee-in-bankruptcy may have the power to
prevent the commencement of the Early Amortization Period.
 
                                       69
<PAGE>   72
 
MATURITY
 
   
     The Notes will mature on the earlier of the date the Notes are paid in full
or on the Payment Date occurring in August, 2006. In the event there are
insufficient funds to retire the Notes on the Payment Date occurring in August,
2006, an Event of Default will occur. See "-- Events of Default; Rights Upon
Event of Default" below. In addition, the Issuer will pay the Notes in full on
the Payment Date following exercise by the Seller of its option to purchase the
Series 1996-2 Participation after the aggregate Security Balance of the Series
1996-2 Securities is reduced to an amount less than or equal to $100,039,600
(10% of the initial aggregate Security Balance of the Series 1996-2 Securities).
The purchase price will be equal to the sum of the unpaid principal balance of
the Series 1996-2 Participation and accrued and unpaid interest thereon at the
weighted average of the Note Rates and the Certificate Rate through the day
preceding the call date. Under certain circumstances in the event of a Servicer
Default, the Seller may repurchase each outstanding Series Participation
Interest, including the Series 1996-2 Participation, at a price equal to the
outstanding principal balance of each Series Participation Interest, plus
accrued and unpaid interest at the applicable pass-through rates. In such event,
the Series 1996-2 Securities will be paid in full.
    
 
     The Paying Agent. The Paying Agent shall initially be the Indenture
Trustee, together with any successor thereto in such capacity (the "Paying
Agent"). The Paying Agent shall have the revocable power to withdraw funds from
the Payment Account for the purpose of making payments to the Securityholders.
 
REPORTS TO NOTEHOLDERS
 
     Concurrently with each distribution to the Noteholders, the Indenture
Trustee will prepare and forward to each Noteholder a statement setting forth
certain information, including the following:
 
          (i) remittances on the Series 1996-2 Participation for the related
     Collection Period;
 
          (ii) the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount;
 
          (iii) the aggregate Principal Balance of the Receivables as of the
     last day of the related Collection Period;
 
   
          (iv) the Adjusted Security Balance of each class of Notes and of the
     Certificates after giving effect to the distribution of principal on such
     Payment Date;
    
 
          (v) the Overcollateralization Amount after giving effect to the
     payments to be made on the Notes and the Certificates on such Payment Date;
 
          (vi) the amount of principal distributable on such Payment Date to
     Noteholders separately stating the portion thereof in respect of Defaulted
     Amounts allocated to the Notes that was not included in the Principal
     Distribution Amount for the Distribution Date related to the period in
     which such Defaulted Amount was incurred and the Accelerated Principal
     Payment Amount and stating the amount of any remaining Defaulted Amounts
     not previously distributed;
 
          (vii) the amount of interest distributable on such Payment Date to
     Noteholders separately stating the portion thereof in respect of overdue
     accrued interest and stating the amount of remaining overdue accrued
     interest; and
 
          (viii) the Seller's Trust Amount after giving effect to the payments
     made on the Notes and the Certificates on such Payment Date.
 
     In the case of information furnished pursuant to clauses (vi) and (vii)
above, the amounts shall be expressed as a dollar amount per $1,000 in face
amount of Notes.
 
EVENTS OF DEFAULT; RIGHTS UPON EVENT OF DEFAULT
 
     With respect to the Notes, an "Event of Default" under the Indenture exists
at any time when any one of the following events occurs: (i) a default in the
payment of any interest on any Note when the same becomes due and payable, and
such default continues for a period of five days; (ii) a default in the payment
of the principal of or any installment of the principal of any Note when the
same becomes due and payable; (iii) default in the observance or performance of
any covenant or agreement of the Issuer made in the Indenture, or any
representation or warranty of the Issuer made in the Indenture or in any
certificate or other
 
                                       70
<PAGE>   73
 
writing delivered pursuant hereto or in connection herewith proving to have been
incorrect in any material respect as of the time when the same shall have been
made and has a material adverse effect on Noteholders, and such default shall
continue or not be cured, or the circumstance or condition in respect of which
such representation or warranty was incorrect shall not have been eliminated or
otherwise cured, for a period of 30 days after there shall have been given, by
registered or certified mail, to the Issuer by the Indenture Trustee or to the
Issuer and the Indenture Trustee by the Holders of at least 25% in principal
amount of the Notes then outstanding, a written notice specifying such default
or incorrect representation or warranty and requiring it to be remedied and
stating that such notice is a notice of default hereunder; (iv) the filing of a
decree or order for relief by a court having jurisdiction in the premises in
respect of the Issuer or any substantial part of the Trust Assets in an
involuntary case under any applicable federal or state bankruptcy, insolvency or
other similar law now or hereafter in effect, or appointing a receiver,
liquidator, assignee, custodian, trustee, sequestrator or similar official of
the Issuer or for any substantial part of the Trust Assets, or ordering the
winding-up or liquidation of the Issuer's affairs, and such decree or order
shall remain unstayed and in effect for a period of 60 consecutive days; or (v)
the commencement by the Issuer of a voluntary case under any applicable federal
or state bankruptcy, insolvency or other similar law now or hereafter in effect,
or the consent by the Issuer to the entry of an order for relief in an
involuntary case under any such law, or the consent by the Issuer to the
appointment or taking possession by a receiver, liquidator, assignee, custodian,
trustee, sequestrator or similar official of the Issuer or for any substantial
part of the Trust Assets, or the making by the Issuer of any general assignment
for the benefit of creditors, or the failure by the Issuer generally to pay its
debts as such debts become due, or the taking of any action by the Issuer in
furtherance of any of the foregoing. If there is an Event of Default due to late
payment or nonpayment of interest or principal on a Note, interest will continue
to accrue on such principal at the Note Rate until such principal is paid. If an
Event of Default should occur and be continuing with respect to the Notes, the
Indenture Trustee or holders of a majority in principal amount of Notes then
outstanding may declare the principal of such Notes to be immediately due and
payable. Such declaration may, under certain circumstances, be rescinded by the
holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding.
 
   
     If the Notes are due and payable following an Event of Default with respect
thereto, the Indenture Trustee may institute proceedings to collect amounts due
or foreclose on property comprising Trust Assets or exercise remedies as a
secured party. Unless the Indenture Trustee determines that the Series 1996-2
Participation will not provide sufficient funds for the payment of principal and
interest on the Notes as such payments would become due, any sale, liquidation
or other disposition of the Trust Assets for an amount less than the amounts due
on the Notes will not occur without the consent of all of the Noteholders. If
the Indenture Trustee makes such a determination, it may sell, liquidate or
otherwise dispose of the Trust Assets for less than the amount due on the Notes
provided that the consent of Noteholders of not less than 66 2/3% of the
Security Balance of the Notes is obtained. After payment of the amounts due and
owing the Indenture Trustee, the proceeds of any sale, liquidation or other
deposition of the Trust Assets will be applied sequentially to pay all amounts
due and owing on the Class A-1 Notes, Class A-2 Notes, Class A-3 Notes, and
Class B Notes, and to pay all amounts distributable on the Certificates.
    
 
     If an Event of Default occurs and is continuing with respect to the Notes,
the Indenture Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of the rights
or powers under the Indenture at the request or direction of any of the holders
of the Notes, if the Indenture Trustee reasonably believes it will not be
adequately indemnified against the costs, expenses and liabilities which might
be incurred by it in complying with such request. Subject to the provisions for
indemnification and certain limitations contained in the Indenture, the holders
of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes will have the right
to direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding or any remedy
available to the Indenture Trustee, and the holders of a majority in principal
amount of the Notes then outstanding may, in certain cases, waive any default
with respect thereto, except a default in the payment of principal or interest
or a default in respect of a covenant or provision of the Indenture that cannot
be modified without the waiver or consent of all the holders of the outstanding
Notes. No holder of a Note will have the right to institute any proceeding with
respect to the Indenture, unless (i) such holder previously has given the
Indenture Trustee written notice of a continuing Event of Default, (ii) the
holders of not less than 25% of the aggregate Security Balance of all
outstanding Notes have made written request to the Indenture Trustee to
institute such proceeding in its own name as
 
                                       71
<PAGE>   74
 
Indenture Trustee, (iii) such holder or holders have offered the Indenture
Trustee reasonable indemnity, (iv) the Indenture Trustee has for 60 days failed
to institute such proceeding and (v) no direction inconsistent with such written
request has been given to the Indenture Trustee during the 60-day period by the
holders of a majority of the aggregate Security Balance of all outstanding
Notes. In addition, the Indenture Trustee and the Noteholders, by accepting the
Notes, will covenant that they will not at any time institute against the Issuer
or the Seller any bankruptcy, reorganization or other proceeding under any
federal or state bankruptcy or similar law. With respect to the Issuer, neither
the Indenture Trustee nor the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, nor any
holder representing an ownership interest in the Issuer nor any of their
respective owners, beneficiaries, agents, officers, directors, employees,
affiliates, successors or assigns will, in the absence of an express agreement
to the contrary, be personally liable for the payment of the principal of or
interest on the Notes or for the agreements of the Issuer contained in the
Indenture.
 
CERTAIN COVENANTS
 
     The Indenture will provide that the Issuer may not consolidate with or
merge into any other entity, unless (i) the entity formed by or surviving such
consolidation or merger is organized under the laws of the United States, any
state or the District of Columbia, (ii) such entity expressly assumes the
Issuer's obligation to make due and punctual payments upon the Notes and the
performance or observance of any agreement and covenant of the Issuer under the
Indenture, (iii) no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing
immediately after such merger or consolidation, (iv) the Issuer has been advised
that the ratings of the Notes then in effect would not be reduced or withdrawn
by any Rating Agency as a result of such merger or consolidation, (v) any action
that is necessary to maintain the lien and security interest created by the
Indenture is taken and (vi) the Issuer has received an opinion of counsel to the
effect that such consolidation or merger would have no material adverse tax
consequence to the Issuer or to any Noteholder or Certificateholder. The Issuer
may not, among other things, (i) except as expressly permitted by the Indenture,
sell, transfer, exchange or otherwise dispose of any of the assets of the
Issuer, (ii) claim any credit on or make any deduction from the principal and
interest payable in respect of the Notes (other than amounts withheld under the
Code or applicable state law) or assert any claim against any present or former
Holder of Notes because of the payment of taxes levied or assessed upon the
Issuer, (iii) permit the validity or effectiveness of the Indenture to be
impaired or permit any person to be released from any covenants or obligations
with respect to the Notes under the Indenture except as may be expressly
permitted thereby or (iv) permit any lien, charge excise, claim, security
interest, mortgage or other encumbrance to be created on or extend to or
otherwise arise upon or burden the assets of the Issuer or any part thereof, or
any interest therein or the proceeds thereof. The Issuer may not engage in any
activity other than as specified under the Trust Agreement.
 
ANNUAL COMPLIANCE STATEMENT
 
     The Issuer will be required to file annually with the Indenture Trustee a
written statement as to the fulfillment of its obligations under the Indenture.
 
SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE OF INDENTURE
 
     The Indenture will be discharged with respect to the collateral securing
the Notes upon the delivery to the Indenture Trustee for cancellation of all the
Notes or, with certain limitations, upon deposit with the Indenture Trustee of
funds sufficient for the payment in full of all the Notes.
 
MODIFICATION OF INDENTURE
 
     With the consent of the holders of a majority of the Security Balance of
each Class of Notes affected thereby, the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee may
execute a supplemental indenture to add provisions to, change in any manner or
eliminate any provisions of, the Indenture, or modify (except as provided below)
in any manner the rights of the Noteholders. Without the consent of the holder
of each outstanding Note affected thereby, however, no supplemental indenture
will: (i) change the due date of any installment of principal of or interest on
any Note or reduce the principal amount thereof, the interest rate specified
thereon
 
                                       72
<PAGE>   75
 
or the redemption price with respect thereto or change any place of payment
where or the coin or currency in which any Note or any interest thereon is
payable; (ii) impair the right to institute suit for the enforcement of certain
provisions of the Indenture regarding payment; (iii) reduce the percentage of
the aggregate Security Balance of the outstanding Notes, which is required to
approve any supplemental indenture, waive compliance with certain provisions of
the Indenture or waive certain defaults thereunder and their consequences as
provided for in the Indenture; (iv) modify or alter the provisions of the
Indenture regarding the voting of Notes held by the Issuer, the Seller or an
affiliate of any of them; (v) decrease the percentage of the aggregate Security
Balance of Notes required to amend the sections of the Indenture which specify
the applicable percentage of the aggregate Security Balance of the Notes
necessary to amend the Indenture or certain other related agreements; (vi)
modify any of the provisions of the Indenture in such manner as to affect the
calculation of the amount of any payment of interest of principal due on any
Note (including the calculation of any of the individual components of such
calculation); or (vii) permit the creation of any lien ranking prior to or,
except as otherwise contemplated by the Indenture, on a parity with the lien of
the Indenture with respect to any of the Trust Assets or, except when the full
amount required to pay the Notes in full has been deposited or is held in trust,
terminate the lien of the Indenture on any such collateral or deprive the holder
of any Note of the security afforded by the lien of the Indenture.
 
     The Issuer and the Indenture Trustee may also enter into supplemental
indentures without obtaining the consent of the Noteholders, for the purpose of,
among other things, to cure any ambiguity or to correct or supplement any
provision in the Indenture that may be inconsistent with any other provision
therein.
 
CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE INDENTURE TRUSTEE AND THE ISSUER
 
     Neither the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee nor any director, officer or
employee of the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee will be under any liability to
the Issuer or the related Noteholders for any action taken or for refraining
from the taking of any action in good faith pursuant to the Indenture or for
errors in judgment; provided, however, that none of the Indenture Trustee, the
Issuer and any director, officer or employee thereof will be protected against
any liability which would otherwise be imposed by reason of willful malfeasance,
bad faith or negligence in the performance of duties or by reason of reckless
disregard of obligations and duties under the Indenture. Subject to certain
limitations set forth in the Indenture, the Indenture Trustee and any director,
officer, employee or agent of the Indenture Trustee shall be indemnified by the
Issuer and held harmless against any loss, liability or expense incurred in
connection with investigating, preparing to defend or defending any legal
action, commenced or threatened, relating to the Indenture other than any loss,
liability or expense incurred by reason of willful malfeasance, bad faith or
negligence in the performance of its duties under such Indenture or by reason of
reckless disregard of its obligations and duties under the Indenture. All
persons into which the Indenture Trustee may be merged or with which it may be
consolidated or any person resulting from such merger or consolidation shall be
the successor of the Indenture Trustee under each Indenture.
 
DUTIES OF THE INDENTURE TRUSTEE
 
     The Indenture Trustee makes no representations as to the validity or
sufficiency of the Indenture, the Series 1996-2 Securities or of the Trust
Assets or related documents. If no Event of Default has occurred, the Indenture
Trustee is required to perform only those duties specifically required of it
under the Indenture. Upon receipt of the various certificates, statements,
reports or other instruments required to be furnished to it, the Trustee is
required to examine them to determine whether they are in the form required by
the Indenture; however, the Indenture Trustee will not be responsible for the
accuracy or content of any such documents furnished by it or the Holders to the
Servicer under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.
 
     The Indenture Trustee may be held liable for its own negligent action or
failure to act, or for its own misconduct; provided, however, the Indenture
Trustee will not be personally liable with respect to any action taken, suffered
or omitted to be taken by it in good faith in accordance with the direction of
the Holders in an Event of Default. The Indenture Trustee is not required to
expend or risk its own funds or otherwise incur any financial liability in the
performance of any of its duties under the Indenture, or in the exercise of any
of its
 
                                       73
<PAGE>   76
 
rights or powers, if it has reasonable grounds for believing that repayment of
such funds or adequate indemnity against such risk or liability is not
reasonably assured to it.
 
ACTIONS IN RESPECT OF SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION
 
     If at any time the Indenture Trustee, as the pledgee of the Series 1996-2
Participation is requested in such capacity to take any action or to give any
approval or waiver, including, without limitation, in connection with an
amendment of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, or if any Servicer Default
occurs, the Indenture provides that, so long as any Notes are outstanding, the
Indenture Trustee may either take any action in connection with the enforcement
of any rights and remedies available to it, in its capacity as pledgee of the
Series 1996-2 Participation, as it deems in the best interests of the
Noteholders, or the Indenture Trustee may notify all of the Noteholders of the
substance of any such amendment, consent, approval, and will act only in
accordance with the written direction of Noteholders evidencing at least a
majority of the aggregate of the Security Balances of all Notes.
 
RESIGNATION OF INDENTURE TRUSTEE
 
     The Indenture Trustee may, upon written notice to the Seller and the
Issuer, resign at any time, in which event the Issuer will be obligated to use
its best efforts to appoint a successor Indenture Trustee. If no successor
Indenture Trustee has been appointed and has accepted the appointment within 30
days after giving such notice of resignation, the resigning Indenture Trustee,
the Issuer or the Noteholders evidencing at least a majority of the Security
Balance of the Notes may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for
appointment of a successor Indenture Trustee. The Indenture Trustee may also be
removed at any time (i) if the Indenture Trustee ceases to be eligible to
continue as such under the Indenture, (ii) if the Indenture Trustee becomes
insolvent or (iii) by the holders of a majority of the aggregate Security
Balance of the Notes upon written notice to the Indenture Trustee and to the
Seller. Any resignation or removal of the Indenture Trustee and appointment of a
successor Indenture Trustee will not become effective until acceptance of the
appointment by the successor Indenture Trustee.
 
REGISTRATION OF NOTES
 
     Notes Owners may hold their Notes through DTC (in the United States) or
Cedel or Euroclear (in Europe) if they are participants of such systems, or
indirectly through organizations which are participants in such systems.
 
   
     The Notes will initially be registered in the name of CEDE & Co., the
nominee of DTC. Cedel and Euroclear will hold omnibus positions on behalf of
their participants through customers' securities accounts in Cedel's and
Euroclear's names on the books of their respective depositaries which in turn
will hold such positions in customers' securities accounts in the depositaries'
names on the books of DTC. Citibank, N.A. will act as depositary for Cedel and
Chemical Bank will act as depositary for Euroclear (in such capacities,
individually the "Depositary" and collectively the "Depositaries").
    
 
     Transfers between Participants will occur in accordance with DTC rules.
Transfers between Cedel Participants and Euroclear Participants will occur in
accordance with their respective rules and operating procedures.
 
     Cross-market transfers between persons holding directly or indirectly
through DTC, on the one hand, and directly or indirectly through Cedel
Participants or Euroclear Participants, on the other, will be effected in DTC in
accordance with DTC rules on behalf of the relevant European international
clearing system by its Depositary; however, such cross-market transactions will
require delivery of instructions to the relevant European international clearing
system by the counterparty in such system in accordance with its rules and
procedures and within its established deadlines (European time). The relevant
European international clearing system will, if the transaction meets its
settlement requirements, deliver instructions to its Depositary to take action
to effect final settlement on its behalf by delivering or receiving securities
in DTC, and making or receiving payment in accordance with normal procedures for
same-day funds settlement applicable to DTC. Cedel Participants and Euroclear
Participants may not deliver instructions directly to the Depositaries.
 
                                       74
<PAGE>   77
 
     Because of time-zone differences, credits of securities received in Cedel
or Euroclear as a result of a transaction with a Participant will be made during
subsequent securities settlement processing and dated the business day following
the DTC settlement date. Such credits or any transactions in such securities
settled during such processing will be reported to the relevant Euroclear or
Cedel Participants on such business day. Cash received in Cedel or Euroclear as
a result of sales of securities by or through a Cedel Participant or Euroclear
Participant to a Participant will be received with value on the DTC settlement
date but will be available in the relevant Cedel or Euroclear cash account only
as of the business day following settlement in DTC. For information with respect
to tax documentation procedures relating to the Notes, see "Certain Federal and
State Income Tax Consequences" and "Global Clearance, Settlement and Tax
Documentation Procedures" in Annex I hereto.
 
     Note Owners who are not Participants but desire to purchase, sell or
otherwise transfer ownership of Notes may do so only through Participants or
indirect participants (unless and until Replacement Notes, as defined below, are
issued). In addition, Note Owners will receive all distributions of principal
of, and interest on, the Notes from the Indenture Trustee through DTC and
Participants. Note Owners will not receive or be entitled to receive
certificates representing their respective interests in the Notes, except under
the limited circumstances described below.
 
     Unless and until Replacement Notes are issued, it is anticipated that the
only Noteholder of the Notes will be CEDE & Co., as nominee of DTC. Note Owners
will not be Noteholders as that term is used in the Indenture. Note Owners are
only permitted to exercise the rights of Noteholders indirectly through
Participants and DTC.
 
     While the Notes are outstanding (except under the circumstances described
below), under the rules, regulations and procedures creating and affecting DTC
and its operations (the "Rules"), DTC is required to make book-entry transfers
among Participants on whose behalf it acts with respect to the Notes and is
required to receive and transmit distributions of principal of, and interest on,
the Notes. Participants and indirect participants with whom Note Owners have
accounts with respect to Notes are similarly required to make book-entry
transfers and receive and transmit such distributions on behalf of their
respective Note Owners. Accordingly, although Note Owners will not possess
certificates, the Rules provide a mechanism by which Note Owners will receive
distributions and will be able to transfer their interests.
 
     Unless and until Replacement Notes are issued, Note Owners who are not
Participants may transfer ownership of Notes only through Participants and
indirect participants by instructing such Participants and indirect participants
to transfer Notes, by book-entry transfer, through DTC for the account of the
purchasers of such Notes, which account is maintained with their respective
Participants. Under the Rules and in accordance with DTC's normal procedures,
transfers of ownership of Notes will be executed through DTC and the accounts of
the respective Participants at DTC will be debited and credited. Similarly, the
Participants and indirect participants will make debits or credits, as the case
may be, on their records on behalf of the selling and purchasing Note Owners.
 
     DTC is a limited-purpose trust company organized under the laws of the
State of New York, a member of the Federal Reserve System, a "clearing
corporation" within the meaning of the New York Uniform Commercial Code, and a
"clearing agency" registered pursuant to the provisions of Section 17A of the
1934 Act. DTC accepts securities for deposit from its participating
organizations ("Participants") and facilitates the clearance and settlement of
securities transactions between Participants in such securities through
electronic book-entry changes in accounts of Participants, thereby eliminating
the need for physical movement of certificates. Participants include securities
brokers and dealers, banks and trust companies and clearing corporations and may
include certain other organizations. Indirect access to the DTC system is also
available to others such as banks, brokers, dealers and trust companies that
clear through or maintain a custodial relationship with a Participant, either
directly or indirectly ("indirect participants").
 
     Cedel is incorporated under the laws of Luxembourg as a professional
depository. Cedel holds securities for its participating organizations ("Cedel
Participants") and facilities the clearance and settlement of securities
transactions between Cedel Participants through electronic book-entry changes in
accounts of Cedel Participants, thereby eliminating the need for physical
movement of certificates. Transactions may be settled
 
                                       75
<PAGE>   78
 
in Cedel in any of 28 currencies, including United States dollars. Cedel
provides to its Cedel Participants, among other things, services for
safekeeping, administration, clearance and settlement of internationally traded
securities and securities lending and borrowing. Cedel interfaces with domestic
markets in several countries. As a professional depository, Cedel is subject to
regulation by the Luxembourg Monetary Institute. Cedel Participants are
recognized financial institutions around the world, including underwriters,
securities brokers and dealers, banks, trust companies, clearing corporations
and certain other organizations. Indirect access to Cedel is also available to
others, such as banks, brokers dealers and trust companies that clear through or
maintain a custodial relationship with a Cedel Participant, either directly or
indirectly.
 
     Euroclear was created in 1968 to hold securities for participants of
Euroclear ("Euroclear Participants") and to clear and settle transactions
between Euroclear Participants through simultaneous electronic book-entry
delivery against payment, thereby eliminating the need for physical movement of
certificates and any risk from lack of simultaneous transfers of securities and
cash. Transactions may now be settled in any of 32 currencies, including United
States dollars. Euroclear includes various other services, including securities
lending and borrowing and interfaces with domestic markets in several countries
generally similar to the arrangements for cross-market transfers with DTC
described above. Euroclear is operated by the Brussels, Belgium office of Morgan
Guaranty Trust Company of New York (the "Euroclear Operator"), under contract
with Euroclear Clearance Systems S.C., a Belgian cooperative corporation (the
"Cooperative"). All operations are conducted by the Euroclear Operator, and all
Euroclear securities clearance accounts and Euroclear cash accounts are accounts
with the Euroclear Operator, not the Cooperative. The Cooperative establishes
policy for Euroclear on behalf of Euroclear Participants. Euroclear Participants
include banks (including central banks), securities brokers and dealers and
other professional financial intermediaries. Indirect access to Euroclear is
also available to other firms that clear through or maintain a custodial
relationship with a Euroclear Participant, either directly or indirectly.
 
     The Euroclear Operator is the Belgian branch of a New York banking
corporation which is a member bank of the Federal Reserve System. As such, it is
regulated and examined by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System
and the New York State Banking Department, as well as the Belgian Banking
Commission.
 
     Securities clearance accounts and cash accounts with the Euroclear Operator
are governed by the Terms and Conditions Governing Use of Euroclear and the
related Operating Procedures of the Euroclear System and applicable Belgian law
(collectively, the "Terms and Conditions"). The Terms and Conditions govern
transfers of securities and cash within Euroclear, withdrawals of securities and
cash from Euroclear, and receipts of payments with respect to securities in
Euroclear. All securities in Euroclear are held on a fungible basis without
attribution of specific certificates to specific securities clearance accounts.
The Euroclear Operator acts under the Terms and Conditions only on behalf of
Euroclear Participants, and has no record of or relationship with persons
holding through Euroclear Participants.
 
     Distributions with respect to Notes held through Cedel or Euroclear will be
credited to the cash accounts of Cedel Participants or Euroclear Participants in
accordance with the relevant system's rules and procedures, to the extent
received by its Depositary. Such distributions will be subject to tax reporting
in accordance with relevant United States tax laws and regulations. See "Certain
Federal and State Income Tax Consequences". Cedel or the Euroclear Operator, as
the case may be, will take any other action permitted to be taken by a
Noteholder under the Indenture on behalf of a Cedel Participant or Euroclear
Participant only in accordance with its relevant rules and procedures and
subject to its Depositary's ability to effect such actions on its behalf through
DTC.
 
     Notes will be issued in registered form to Note Owners, or their nominees,
rather than to DTC (such Notes being referred to herein as "Replacement Notes"),
only if (i) DTC or HFC advises the Indenture Trustee in writing that DTC is no
longer willing or able to discharge properly its responsibilities as nominee and
depository with respect to the Notes and HFC or the Indenture Trustee is unable
to locate a qualified successor, (ii) HFC, at its sole option, elects to
terminate the book-entry system through DTC or (iii) after the occurrence of an
Event of Default, DTC, at the direction of Class A and Class B Note Owners
evidencing at least a majority of the then outstanding Security Balance of each
such Class, advises DTC in writing that
 
                                       76
<PAGE>   79
 
the continuation of a book-entry system through DTC (or a successor thereto) is
no longer in the best interests of Note Owners. Upon issuance of Replacement
Notes to Note Owners, such Notes will be transferable directly (and not
exclusively on a book-entry basis) and registered holders will deal directly
with the Indenture Trustee with respect to transfers, notices and distributions.
 
     DTC has advised HFC and the Indenture Trustee that, unless and until
Replacement Notes are issued, DTC will take any action permitted to be taken by
a Noteholder under the Indenture only at the direction of one or more
Participants to whose DTC accounts the Notes are credited. DTC may take actions,
at the direction of the related Participants, with respect to some Notes which
conflict with actions taken with respect to other Notes.
 
     Because DTC can only act on behalf of Participants, who in turn act on
behalf of indirect participants and certain banks, the ability of holders of
beneficial interests in the Notes to pledge such Notes to persons or entities
that do not participate in the DTC system, or otherwise take actions in respect
of such Notes, may be limited due to the lack of a definitive certificate for
such Notes.
 
     Although DTC, Cedel and Euroclear have agreed to the foregoing procedures
in order to facilitate transfers of Notes among participants of DTC, Cedel and
Euroclear, they are under no obligation to perform or continue to perform such
procedures and such procedures may be discontinued at any time.
 
   
ADMINISTRATION AGREEMENT
    
 
   
     Pursuant to the Administration Agreement, the Administrator will perform
certain duties of the Issuer, Owner Trustee and Seller under the Indenture and
the Trust Agreement. Such duties include, but are not limited to, the
preparation, delivery and/or filing of required reports, notices, certificates,
tax returns, opinions and other documents as required under the Indenture or the
Trust Agreement. The Administrator will also monitor and advise the Owner
Trustee when action is required to comply with the Issuer's duties under such
agreements. Subject to certain limitations contained in the Administration
Agreement, the Administrator will indemnify the Indenture Trustee, Owner Trustee
and Seller, and each of their respective agents, for any loss, liability or
expense incurred by reason of the willful misconduct, gross negligence or bad
faith of the Administrator in the performance of its obligations under the
Administration Agreement. A form of the Administration Agreement is filed as an
exhibit to the registration statement of which this Prospectus is a part.
    
 
               DESCRIPTION OF THE RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT
 
     The Receivables transferred to the Deposit Trust by the Seller have been
and will be acquired by the Seller from the Subservicers pursuant to the
Receivables Purchase Agreement entered into by and between the Seller, as
purchaser of the Receivables, and the Subservicers, as owners of the Credit Line
Agreements and sellers of the Receivables. The Receivables Purchase Agreement is
incorporated by reference as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which
this Prospectus is a part. Under the Receivables Purchase Agreement, the
Subservicers agreed to sell or transfer the Receivables to the Seller in
accordance with the terms set forth therein. Pursuant to the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement, such balances have been and will be immediately transferred
by the Seller to the Deposit Trust, and the Seller assigned its rights in, to
and under the Receivables Purchase Agreement with respect to such balances to
the Deposit Trust. The following summary describes certain terms of the
Receivables Purchase Agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to
the Receivables Purchase Agreement.
 
SALE OF RECEIVABLES
 
   
     Pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreement, the Subservicers have sold
or will sell to the Seller all their right, title and interest in and to all of
the Receivables, consisting of the Initial Receivables arising under the Credit
Line Agreements, all Additional Balances thereafter arising under such Credit
Line Agreements and the Receivables arising under each Aggregate Additional
Credit Line designated to the Deposit Trust, whether existing on the date a
Credit Line is designated or arising under such Credit Line thereafter. The
purchase price of the purchased Receivables will not be less than the principal
amount thereof as of the time of sale plus the present value of anticipated
excess spread.
    
 
                                       77
<PAGE>   80
 
     In connection with such sale of the Receivables to the Seller, the
Subservicers have or will indicate in their computer files that the Receivables
have been sold to the Seller by the Subservicers and that such Receivables have
been sold or transferred by the Seller to the Deposit Trust. In addition, the
Subservicers have or will provide to the Seller a computer file or a microfiche
list containing a true and complete list showing each Credit Line, identified by
account number and by total outstanding balance on the applicable date of
designation. The records and agreements relating to the Credit Lines and
Receivables are not segregated by the Subservicers from other documents and
agreements relating to other credit line accounts and receivables and are not
stamped or marked to reflect the sale or transfer of the Receivables to the
Seller, but the computer records of the Subservicers are or will be marked to
evidence such sale or transfer. The Subservicers have filed or will file a UCC
financing statement meeting the requirements of applicable state law and in each
of the jurisdictions in which such filings are required in order to maintain the
lien priority with respect to the Receivables in the Credit Lines. See "Risk
Factors -- Sale of Assets; Insolvency Considerations" and "Certain Legal Aspects
of the Receivables".
 
     Pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreement, the Subservicers may agree
from time to time with the Seller to designate Aggregate Additional Credit
Lines. See "Description of Deposit Trust -- Additions of Credit Lines". The
purchase price for Credit Lines so designated will not be less than an amount
equal to the Principal Receivables conveyed by the Subservicers to the Seller
plus the present value of anticipated excess spread.
 
REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES
 
   
     In the Receivables Purchase Agreement, each Subservicer severally, and not
jointly, represents and warrants to the Seller to the effect, among other
things, that as of the Initial Issuance Date and each date when Aggregate
Additional Credit Lines are designated to the Seller, that (a) the Receivables
Purchase Agreement constitutes a legal, valid and binding obligation of the
Subservicer and (b) as of each date of designation with respect to Aggregate
Additional Credit Lines, each Aggregate Additional Credit Line will be an
Eligible Credit Line, (c) as of each date of designation with respect to
Aggregate Additional Credit Lines, each Receivable generated thereunder is, on
the applicable date of designation, an Eligible Receivable, and (d) the
Receivables Purchase Agreement constitutes a valid sale to the Seller of all
right, title and interest of the Subservicers in and to the Receivables,
existing and thereafter created in the Credit Lines and in the proceeds thereof
or, if held not to constitute a sale, constitutes a grant of a security interest
in the Receivables. If the breach of any of the representations and warranties
described in this paragraph results in the obligation of the Seller under the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement to accept retransfer of the Receivables,
whichever of the Subservicers maintains the Credit Line to which such
Receivables relate will repurchase the Receivables from the Seller for an amount
equal to the unpaid principal balance thereof, plus accrued and unpaid finance
charges from the last date billed through the end of the current Collection
Period.
    
 
CERTAIN COVENANTS
 
   
     In the Receivables Purchase Agreement, the Subservicers covenant to perform
their obligations under the Credit Line Agreements and the Subservicers'
policies and procedures relating to the Credit Line Agreements, as they may be
amended from time to time. In that regard, the Subservicers may change the terms
and provisions of such Credit Line Agreements or policies and procedures in any
respect (including, without limitation, the calculation of the amount or timing
of charge-offs and changes in the Loan Rates), so long as the Subservicers
reasonably believe such action will not have an Adverse Effect on the
Securityholders and such changes are made in accordance with all applicable
laws.
    
 
   
     In addition, the Subservicers expressly acknowledge and consent to the
Seller's assignment of its rights relating to the Receivables under the
Receivables Purchase Agreement to the Deposit Trustee for the benefit of the
holders of interests in the Deposit Trust. The Subservicers also agree, for the
benefit of the Deposit Trust, that any collections or Recoveries on the
Receivables received by the Subservicers will be paid to the Seller, or at the
request of the Seller, to the Servicer, as soon as practicable after receipt
thereof.
    
 
                                       78
<PAGE>   81
 
AMENDMENTS
 
     The Receivables Purchase Agreement may be amended by the Seller and the
Subservicers without the consent of the holders or beneficiaries of any Series
Participation Interest, including the Securityholders. However, as certified by
the Seller, no such amendment may have an Adverse Effect on the Securityholders.
 
SALE OF CREDIT LINE AGREEMENTS
 
     The Subservicers have the right to transfer their respective interests in
the Credit Line Agreements provided that (i) if such transferee is not an
affiliate of the Servicer, the Rating Agencies have notified the Seller and the
Subservicers that such transfer will not result in a reduction or withdrawal of
the rating of the Series 1996-2 Securities, and (ii) the purchaser agrees in
writing to assume all obligations of the applicable Subservicer as contained in
the Receivables Purchase Agreement.
 
TERMINATION
 
     The Receivables Purchase Agreement will terminate immediately after the
Deposit Trust terminates. In addition, if a conservator, trustee or receiver is
appointed for the Subservicers, the Subservicers will immediately cease to sell
or transfer Receivables and Additional Balances to the Seller and promptly give
notice of such event to the Seller and to the Deposit Trustee.
 
                    CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF THE RECEIVABLES
 
TRANSFER OF RECEIVABLES
 
     Each of the Subservicers will sell the Receivables to the Seller and the
Seller, in turn, will transfer all Receivables to the Deposit Trust. Each of the
Subservicers will represent and warrant that its respective transfers to the
Seller constitute valid sales and assignments of all of its respective right,
title and interest in and to the Receivables. The Seller will represent and
warrant that its transfer constitutes either a valid sale and assignment to the
Deposit Trust of all of its right, title and interest in and to the Receivables,
subject to its interest as holder of the Seller's Interest, or a grant of a
security interest to the Deposit Trust in and to the Receivables, in which case,
the Seller will also represent and warrant that there will exist a valid,
subsisting and enforceable first priority perfected security interest in the
Receivables in existence at the time of the formation of the Deposit Trust or at
the date of addition of any Aggregate Additional Credit Lines, in favor of the
Deposit Trust and a valid, subsisting and enforceable first priority perfected
security interest in the Receivables created thereafter in favor of the Deposit
Trust on and after their creation, in each case, until termination of the
Deposit Trust. For a discussion of the Deposit Trust's rights arising from these
representations and warranties not being satisfied, see "Description of the
Deposit Trust -- Representations and Warranties".
 
     Each of the Subservicers and the Seller will represent that the Receivables
are either "accounts" or "general intangibles" for purposes of the UCC. If a
transfer of the Receivables by a Subservicer or the Seller is deemed to be
either a sale of accounts or a transfer of accounts or general intangibles as
security for an obligation, such transfer will be treated under the UCC as
creating a security interest in such Receivables. In such case, the Deposit
Trust will have perfected its security interest in such Receivables by its and
the Seller's filing of the appropriate financing statements under the UCC. If
any transfer of the Receivables is deemed to be a sale of general intangibles,
then the UCC is not applicable and no further action under the UCC is required
to protect the Deposit Trust's interest in the Receivables from third parties.
 
     There are certain limited circumstances under the UCC in which prior or
subsequent transferees of Receivables coming into existence after the Closing
Date could have an interest in such Receivables with priority over the Deposit
Trust's interest. A tax or other government lien on property of the Seller, or a
Subservicer may also have priority over the interest of the Deposit Trust in
such Receivables. Under the Receivables Purchase Agreement, however, each of the
Subservicers will warrant that it has transferred the Receivables to the Seller
free and clear of the lien of any third party. In addition, each of the
Subservicers will
 
                                       79
<PAGE>   82
 
covenant that it will not sell, pledge, assign, transfer or grant any lien on
any Receivable (or any interest therein) other than to the Seller.
 
CERTAIN MATTERS RELATING TO INSOLVENCY
 
   
     Each of the Subservicers and the Seller believes that the transfers of the
Receivables pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreement are true sales of the
Receivables. The Seller believes that the transfers of the Receivables pursuant
to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement are either true sales of the Receivables
to the Deposit Trust or a grant to the Deposit Trust of a security interest in
all such Receivables. However, in the event of an insolvency of a Subservicer
and/or the Seller, it is possible that a receiver, conservator or trustee in
bankruptcy could, under the federal bankruptcy laws, challenge the Seller's
and/or the Deposit Trust's right to payments from, and ownership of, the
Receivables, and the Issuer's beneficial interest therein, under one or more of
the theories set forth below, or otherwise. Similarly, while the Seller believes
its assignment of the Series 1996-2 Participation to the Issuer is either a true
sale of, or a grant of a security interest in, such asset or the Receivables, in
the event of the insolvency of the Seller or the Deposit Trust, a receiver,
conservator or trustee in bankruptcy possibly could challenge the Issuer's right
to remittances on the Series 1996-2 Participation. In such event, delays in
payments on the Series 1996-2 Securities and reductions in the amount of those
payments could occur.
    
 
     A receiver, conservator or trustee in bankruptcy could attempt to
recharacterize any of the transactions between the Subservicers, the Seller and
the Deposit Trust as a loan of the purchase price from the purchaser of the
Receivables in conjunction with a pledge by the seller of the Receivables to
secure repayment of such loan. Based upon an opinion of Katten Muchin & Zavis,
special counsel to the Seller, that the conveyance of the Receivables by the
Subservicers to the Seller would be deemed a true sale of such assets, which
opinion is subject to various assumptions and qualifications set forth therein,
the Subservicers and the Seller believe that a trustee-in-bankruptcy or receiver
would be unable to successfully challenge the transfer of the Receivables from
the Subservicers to the Seller and the subsequent transfer to the Deposit Trust
or to interfere with the timely transfer to the Deposit Trustee of payments
received with respect to the Receivables. Moreover, even if a receiver,
conservator or trustee in bankruptcy were to so recharacterize any transfer of
the Receivables, if the security interest granted by a Subservicer or the
Seller, as the case may be, in the Receivables was validly perfected prior to
such party's insolvency, and was not taken in contemplation of such party's
insolvency, such security interest should not be subject to avoidance, and
payments to the Seller or the Deposit Trust, as the case may be, with respect to
the Receivables should not be subject to recovery by a receiver, conservator or
trustee in bankruptcy. Nonetheless, a conservator, receiver or trustee in
bankruptcy could assert a contrary position.
 
     Even accepting a transfer of the Receivables as a "true sale," a receiver,
conservator or trustee in bankruptcy could still attempt to avoid any such
transfer by employing the argument, developed by the Tenth Circuit in Octagon
Gas Systems, Inc. v. Rimmer, that accounts transferred in a "true sale" by a
seller to a buyer may nonetheless constitute property of the seller's bankruptcy
estate. Each of the Subservicers and the Seller believes that Octagon is
unlikely to be binding precedent as applied to any transfers of the Receivables
given that the Tenth Circuit's reasoning in the Octagon decision has not been
widely followed outside the Tenth Circuit and the transfers of the Receivables
do not have any particular link with the Tenth Circuit.
 
     In addition, a receiver, conservator or trustee in bankruptcy could
challenge the validity or otherwise impair the benefits of a transfer of the
Receivables under federal bankruptcy laws on grounds including the following:
the transfer was made pursuant to an executory contract; the transfer was a
preferential payment made within certain periods prior to the filing of a
bankruptcy case; and/or the transfer was made between parties that should be
substantively consolidated.
 
     Upon the appointment of a receiver, conservator or trustee in bankruptcy or
upon a voluntary liquidation with respect to the Seller, notice thereof will
promptly be provided to the Deposit Trustee and the Indenture Trustee, which
will result in the occurrence of an Amortization Event. Pursuant to the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement, thereafter newly created Receivables will not be
transferred to the Deposit Trust. The Indenture Trustee will proceed to sell,
dispose of or otherwise liquidate the Series 1996-2 Participation in a
commercially
 
                                       80
<PAGE>   83
 
reasonable manner and on commercially reasonable terms, unless within a
specified period of time holders of Series Participation Interests evidencing
more than 50% of each such interests instruct otherwise (assuming that the
receiver, conservator or trustee in bankruptcy does not order such a sale
despite such instructions). In such event, the proceeds from the sale of the
Series 1996-2 Participation will be treated as collections of the Receivables
and deposited into the Collection Account. This procedure could be delayed, as
described above. In addition, upon the occurrence of an Amortization Event, if a
receiver, conservator or trustee in bankruptcy, is appointed for the Seller and
no Amortization Event other than such appointment or insolvency of the Seller
exists, the receiver, conservator or trustee in bankruptcy may have the power to
prevent the early sale, liquidation or disposition of the Series 1996-2
Participation and the commencement of the Early Amortization Period. See
"Description of the Securities -- Early Amortization Period".
 
     In addition, application of federal bankruptcy and state debtor relief laws
to any borrower could affect the interests of the Deposit Trust in any related
Receivables if the enforcement of such laws result in such Receivables conveyed
to the Deposit Trust being written off as uncollectible by the Servicer. Whether
or not any such Receivables are written off as uncollectible, delays in payments
due on such Receivables could result. See "Description of the Deposit Trust --
Representations and Warranties".
 
   
     While HFC is the Servicer, cash collections held by HFC may, subject to
certain conditions, be commingled and used for the benefit of HFC prior to each
Distribution Date and, in the event of the insolvency or receivership of HFC or,
in certain circumstances, the lapse of certain time periods, the Deposit Trust
may not have a perfected interest in such collections. However, unless otherwise
agreed to by the applicable Rating Agency, if the commercial paper rating of HFC
is reduced below A-1 or P-1 by the applicable Rating Agency, HFC will, within
five business days, be required to commence the deposit of collections directly
into the Collection Account within two business days of the day of processing.
See "Description of the Deposit Trust -- Payments on Credit Lines; Deposits to
Collection Account".
    
 
     The Seller will not engage in any activities except purchasing Receivables
from the Subservicers or other originators, forming the Deposit Trust or trusts
similar thereto, transferring Receivables to such trusts, causing the formation
of trusts such as the Issuer, causing such trusts to issue securities and
engaging in activities incident to, or necessary or convenient to accomplish,
the foregoing. The Seller has no current intention of filing a voluntary
petition under the Bankruptcy Code or any similar applicable state law.
 
     In the event of a Servicer Default relating to the bankruptcy or insolvency
of the Servicer, and no Servicer Default other than such bankruptcy or
insolvency related Servicer Default exists, the trustee in bankruptcy may have
the power to prevent either the Deposit Trustee or the holders of Series
Participation Interests from appointing a successor Servicer. See "Description
of the Deposit Trust -- Servicer Defaults" and "-- Rights Upon a Servicer
Default".
 
CONSUMER PROTECTION LAWS
 
     The relationship of the borrower and the issuer of a credit line is
extensively regulated by federal and state consumer protection laws and
regulations. With respect to credit lines issued by the Subservicers, the most
significant federal laws include the Federal Truth-in-Lending, Equal Credit
Opportunity, Fair Credit Reporting, Fair Debt Collection Practices and Real
Estate Settlement Procedures Acts. These statutes and the regulations thereunder
impose various disclosure requirements prior to, and at the time a credit line
is opened, and at the end of monthly billing cycles. In addition, these statutes
and regulations prohibit certain discriminatory practices in extending credit,
and regulate practices followed in collections. Congress and the states may
enact new laws and amendments to existing laws to regulate further the consumer
credit industry.
 
     The Deposit Trust may be liable for certain violations of consumer
protection laws that apply to the Receivables, either as assignee from the
Seller (as a Subservicer's assignee) with respect to obligations arising before
transfer of the Receivables to the Deposit Trust or as the party directly
responsible for obligations arising after the transfer. In addition, a borrower
may be entitled to assert such violations by way of set-off against the
obligation to pay the amount of Receivables owing. All Receivables that were not
created in compliance in all material respects with the requirements of such
laws (if such noncompliance has a material adverse effect on the holders of
interests therein) will be reassigned to the Seller. The Servicer has also
agreed
 
                                       81
<PAGE>   84
 
in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement to accept assignment from the Deposit
Trust of Receivables existing under Credit Lines with respect to which the
Servicer has breached certain representations and warranties. See "Description
of the Deposit Trust -- Representations and Warranties".
 
POTENTIAL LEGISLATION
 
     Legislation proposing new laws and amendments to existing laws can be
expected to be introduced in Congress and certain state and local legislatures
from time to time that, if enacted, would further regulate the consumer credit
industry. In particular, the issue of federal regulation of interest rates on
consumer loans continues to be debated, and there can be no assurance that such
a bill will not become law in the future. Congress and the states may also
propose and enact new laws and amendments to existing laws to regulate further
the consumer credit industry or to reduce finance charges or other fees or
charges applicable to consumer credit accounts. The potential effect of any such
legislation (which could affect the Subservicers) could be to reduce the yield
on the Credit Lines. If such yield is reduced, an Amortization Event could
occur, and the Early Amortization Period would commence. See "Description of the
Securities -- Early Amortization Period".
 
"DUE-ON-SALE" CLAUSES
 
     All of the Personal Homeowner Credit Line Agreements contain due-on-sale
clauses. These clauses permit the related Subservicer to accelerate the maturity
of the loan on notice, which is usually thirty days, if the borrower sells,
transfers or conveys an interest in the property. The enforceability of these
clauses has been the subject of legislation or litigation in many states, and in
some cases the enforceability of these clauses was limited or denied. However,
sec. 341 of the Garn-St Germain Depository Institutions Act of 1982 (the
"Garn-St Germain Act") preempts state constitutional, statutory and case law
that prohibit the enforcement of many due-on-sale clauses and permits lenders to
enforce most of these clauses in accordance with their terms, subject to certain
limited exceptions.
 
     Exempted from the general rule of enforceability of due-on-sale clauses are
mortgage loans (originated other than by federal savings and loan associations
and federal savings banks) that were made during the period beginning on the
date a state, by statute or final appellate court decision having statewide
effect, prohibited the exercise of due-on-sale clauses and ending October 15,
1982 ("Window Period Loans"). However, this exception applies only to transfers
of property which secure Window Period Loans occurring between October 15, 1982
and October 15, 1985 and does not restrict enforcement of a due-on-sale clause
in connection with transfers of property which secure Window Period Loans
occurring after October 15, 1985 unless the property which secures such Window
Period Loans is located in one of the five states identified below.
 
     Therefore, most standard due-on-sale clauses have become generally
enforceable except in those states whose legislatures exercised their authority
after October 15, 1982 to restrict the enforceability of such clauses with
respect to mortgage loans that were (i) originated or assumed after the date a
state prohibited enforcement of due-on-sale clauses and before October 15, 1982,
and (ii) originated by lenders other than national banks, federal savings
institutions and federal credit unions. The Federal Home Loan Mortgage
Corporation has taken the position in its published mortgaged servicing
standards that five states (Arizona, Michigan, Minnesota, New Mexico and Utah)
have enacted statutes extending, on various terms and for varying periods, the
prohibition on enforcement of due-on-sale clauses with respect to certain
categories of Window Period Loans.
 
     The Garn-St Germain Act also sets forth nine specific instances in which a
mortgage lender covered by the Garn-St Germain Act may not exercise a
due-on-sale clause, notwithstanding the fact that a transfer of the property may
have occurred. These include intrafamily transfers, certain transfers by
operation of law, leases of fewer than three years with no option to purchase,
and the creation of a junior encumbrance.
 
   
     To the extent a Subservicer becomes aware of a conveyance of a borrower's
interest in a property securing a Personal Homeowner Credit Line, if the
Subservicer is unable to establish a new credit line with the
    
 
                                       82
<PAGE>   85
 
   
borrower to prepay the Personal Homeowner Credit Line, the Subservicer generally
will enforce the due-on-sale clause to the extent permissible by law.
    
 
ENVIRONMENTAL LEGISLATION
 
     Certain states impose a statutory lien for associated costs on property
that is the subject of a cleanup action by the state on account of hazardous
wastes or hazardous substances released or disposed of on the property. Such a
lien will generally have the priority over all subsequent liens on the property
and, in certain of these states, will have priority over prior recorded liens
including the lien of a mortgage. In addition, under federal environmental
legislation and possibly under state law in a number of states, a secured party
which takes a deed in lieu of foreclosure or acquires a mortgaged property at a
foreclosure sale may be liable for the costs of cleaning up a contaminated site.
Although such costs could be substantial, it is uncertain whether they would be
imposed on a secured lender (such as the Deposit Trust). In the event that title
to a property securing a Personal Homeowner Credit Line was acquired on behalf
of the Deposit Trust and cleanup costs were incurred in respect of the property,
the Securityholders may incur a loss if such costs were required to be paid by
the Deposit Trust.
 
               CERTAIN FEDERAL AND STATE INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES
 
GENERAL
 
     Set forth below is a discussion of the anticipated material United States
federal and state income tax consequences of the purchase, ownership and
disposition of the Notes offered hereunder. This discussion is based upon
current provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the
"Code"), existing and proposed Treasury regulations thereunder, the laws of
various states, current administrative rulings, judicial decisions and other
applicable authorities. There are no cases or Internal Revenue Service ("IRS")
rulings on similar transactions involving both debt and equity interests issued
by a trust with terms similar to those of the Series 1996-2 Securities. As a
result, there can be no assurance that the IRS will not challenge the
conclusions reached herein, and no ruling from the IRS has been or will be
sought on any of the issues discussed below. Furthermore, legislative, judicial
or administrative changes may occur, perhaps with retroactive effect, which
could affect the accuracy of the statements and conclusions set forth herein as
well as the tax consequences to Noteholders.
 
     This discussion is directed to prospective purchasers who purchase Notes in
the initial distribution thereof, including corporations and partnerships, and
who hold the Notes as "capital assets" within the meaning of Section 1221 of the
Code. It does not purport to deal with all aspects of federal income taxation
that may be relevant to the Noteholders in light of their personal investment
circumstances nor, except for certain limited discussion of particular topics,
to certain types of holders subject to special treatment under the federal
income tax laws (e.g., financial institutions, broker-dealers, life insurance
companies and tax-exempt organizations). ACCORDINGLY, PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS
SHOULD CONSULT WITH THEIR OWN TAX ADVISORS AS TO THE FEDERAL, STATE, LOCAL,
FOREIGN AND ANY OTHER TAX CONSEQUENCES TO THEM OF THE PURCHASE, OWNERSHIP AND
DISPOSITION OF SECURITIES.
 
TAX CHARACTERIZATION OF THE DEPOSIT TRUST AND THE ISSUER
 
     With respect to each series of Notes, Katten Muchin & Zavis, special
counsel to the Seller ("Tax Counsel"), has opined that neither the Deposit Trust
nor the Issuer will be (i) classified as an association taxable as a corporation
or (ii) subject to corporate taxation under the rules governing publicly traded
partnerships. This opinion is based upon, among other things, the assumption
that the terms of the trust agreements for the Deposit Trust and the Issuer and
related agreements will be complied with in all material respects, and special
counsel's conclusions that each of the Deposit Trust and the Issuer will lack
certain characteristics necessary for a business trust to be classified as an
association taxable as a corporation or as a publicly traded partnership.
 
                                       83
<PAGE>   86
 
     Tax Counsel's opinions are not binding upon the IRS. If the Deposit Trust
were taxable as a corporation for income tax purposes, the income from the
Receivables would be subject to federal and state taxation at the highest
marginal rates for corporations, probably with no offset for distributions to
the Seller or the Issuer. If the Issuer were also to be taxable as a
corporation, it might be able to reduce its taxable income on distributions of
earnings from the Deposit Trust by its interest expense on the Notes and the
dividend received deduction. However, the overall effect of such
recharacterization of the Deposit Trust and the Issuer would be to reduce
materially the cash available to make payments due on the Notes.
 
     Under Code Section 7704, a "publicly traded partnership" is subject to
taxation as a corporation unless substantially all its income falls within
certain categories. In 1988, the Treasury issued Notice 88-75 containing
guidelines for the disposition of partnership interests which, if followed,
prevent the IRS from characterizing a partnership as "publicly traded" and
thereby subjecting it to taxation as a corporation. At the end of last year, the
Treasury promulgated regulations under Section 7704 which supersede Notice 88-75
with respect to the Issuer immediately, and with respect to the Deposit Trust
after 2005. The trust agreements for the Deposit Trust and the Issuer contain
restrictions on the conditions for investing in and disposing of beneficial
interests that meet the applicable guidelines and regulations. The trust
agreements also further authorize the Seller to modify the terms for the
disposition of beneficial interests in the Deposit Trust and the Issuer if
necessary or advisable for compliance with any subsequent governmental
regulations, rulings or notices, and any judicial decisions, affecting the
characterization of a partnership as "publicly traded."
 
   
     When asset-backed securities are issued in two or more classes by any
entity substantially all of whose assets consist of debt obligations, the entity
will be subject to the "taxable mortgage pool" rules of Code Section 7701(i) if,
among other factors, more than 50% of the debt obligations it holds at the time
of issuance of the asset-backed securities consist of loans secured by interests
in real estate. A taxable mortgage pool is subject to taxation as a corporation.
The Pooling and Servicing Agreement prohibits the Deposit Trust from acquiring
Receivables secured by liens on real estate if such acquisition would cause the
tax basis of such Receivables to amount to 45% or more of the aggregate tax
bases of all Receivables held directly and beneficially by the Deposit Trust and
to obtain an opinion of tax counsel prior to the issuance of any new Series
Participation or other asset-backed securities that such action will not cause
the Deposit Trust, the Issuer or any portion of either to be a taxable mortgage
pool.
    
 
   
     The IRS has proposed so-called "check-the-box" regulations which, if
adopted, would permit the Deposit Trust and the Issuer to be treated as a
partnership, even though such trusts have the characteristics of an association
taxable as a corporation under current law, such as (i) limited liability for
the Seller and (ii) continuity of life notwithstanding an Insolvency Event
affecting the Seller. In the event such regulations or their equivalent are
adopted at both federal and state levels, the Pooling and Servicing Agreement
and the Trust Agreement may be amended by the Seller and the Trustee thereof to
permit those corporate attributes.
    
 
THE NOTES
 
   
     Characterization as Debt. With respect to each class of Notes, Tax Counsel
has opined that, although no specific authority exists with respect to the
characterization for federal income tax purposes of securities having the same
terms as the Notes, the Notes will be treated as debt for federal income tax
purposes. The Issuer, the Seller and each Noteholder, by acquiring an interest
in a Note, will agree to treat the Notes as indebtedness for federal, state and
local income and franchise tax purposes.
    
 
     Interest Income to Noteholders. If the Notes are treated as indebtedness
for Federal income tax purposes, then interest on the Notes will be taxable as
ordinary income for Federal income tax purposes when received by Noteholders
utilizing the cash method of accounting and when accrued by Noteholders
utilizing the accrual method of accounting. Interest received on the Notes may
constitute "investment income" for purposes of certain limitations of the Code
concerning the deductibility of investment interest expense.
 
     Original Issue Discount, Market Discount and Premium. It is not anticipated
that any series of Notes will be issued at a greater than de minimis discount (a
yield to the stated or expected maturity of less than .25% per year). However,
even if a Note has OID falling within the de minimis exception, the holder must
include such OID in income proportionately as principal payments are made on
such Note. A holder who purchases a
 
                                       84
<PAGE>   87
 
Note after the initial distribution thereof at a discount that exceeds a
statutorily defined de minimis amount will be subject to the "market discount"
rules of the Code, and a holder who purchases a Note at a premium will be
subject to the bond premium amortization rules of the Code.
 
     Disposition of Notes. If a Noteholder sells a Note, the holder will
recognize gain or loss in an amount equal to the difference between the amount
realized on the sale and the holder's adjusted tax basis in the Note. The
adjusted tax basis of the Note to a particular Noteholder will equal the
holder's cost for the Note, increased by any market discount and gain previously
included by such Noteholder in income with respect to the Note and decreased by
any bond premium previously amortized and any principal payments previously
received by such Noteholder with respect to such Note. Subject to the market
discount rules of the Code, any such gain or loss will be capital gain or loss
if the Note was held as a capital asset. Capital gain or loss will be long-term
if the Note was held by the holder for more than one year and otherwise will be
short-term. Any capital losses realized generally may be used by a corporate
taxpayer only to offset capital gains, and by an individual taxpayer only to the
extent of capital gains plus $3,000 of other income.
 
   
     Tax Consequences to Foreign Noteholders. Notes will be issued in registered
form. If interest paid (or accrued) to a Noteholder who is a nonresident alien,
foreign corporation or other non-United States person (a "foreign person") is
not effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business within the
United States by the foreign person, the interest generally will be considered
"portfolio interest," and generally will not be subject to United States federal
income tax and withholding tax, as long as the foreign person (i) is not
actually or constructively a "10 percent shareholder" of the Issuer (including a
direct or indirect holder of 10% or more of the applicable outstanding
Certificates or of the Seller's stock) or a "controlled foreign corporation"
with respect to which the Issuer is a "related person" within the meaning of the
Code, and (ii) provides to the Issuer or its paying agent an appropriate
statement on IRS Form W-8 or its substantial equivalent, signed under penalties
of perjury, certifying that the beneficial owner of the Note is a foreign person
and providing that foreign person's name and address. (Investors who hold their
Notes through Participants, indirect participants or other nominees must provide
their certifications to such nominee.) If the information provided in this
statement changes, the foreign person must so inform the Issuer within 30 days
of such change. The statement generally must be provided in the year a payment
occurs or in either of the two preceding years, and therefore must be renewed
triennially. If such interest were not portfolio interest, then it would be
subject to United States federal income and withholding tax at a rate of 30
percent unless such tax is reduced or eliminated pursuant to an applicable tax
treaty.
    
 
     Any capital gain realized on the sale, redemption, retirement or other
taxable disposition of a Note by a foreign person will be exempt from United
States federal income and withholding tax, provided that (i) the gain is not
effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United
States by the foreign person, and (ii) in the case of an individual, the foreign
person is not present in the United States for 183 days or more in the taxable
year.
 
     If the interest, gain or income on a Note held by a foreign person is
effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United
States by the foreign person, the holder (although exempt from the withholding
tax previously discussed if an appropriate statement is furnished) generally
will be subject to United States federal income tax on the interest, gain or
income at regular federal income tax rates. In addition, if the foreign person
is a foreign corporation, it may be subject to a branch profits tax equal to 30
percent of its "effectively connected earnings and profits" within the meaning
of the Code for the taxable year, as adjusted for certain items, unless it
qualifies for a lower rate under an applicable tax treaty.
 
     Information Reporting and Backup Withholding. The Issuer will be required
to report annually to the IRS, and to each related Noteholder of record, the
amount of interest paid on the Notes (and the amount of interest withheld for
federal income taxes, if any) for each calendar year, except as to exempt
holders (generally, corporations, tax-exempt organizations, qualified pension
and profit-sharing trusts, and individual retirement accounts). Each holder
(other than holders who are not subject to the reporting requirements, or
foreign persons who provide certification as to their status as described above)
will be required to provide to the Issuer, under penalties of perjury, a
certificate on IRS Form W-9 or its equivalent containing the holder's name,
address, correct federal taxpayer identification number and a statement that the
holder is not subject to
 
                                       85
<PAGE>   88
 
backup withholding. Should a nonexempt Noteholder fail to provide the required
certification, the Issuer will be required to withhold, from interest and OID
otherwise payable to the holder, 31% of such amounts and remit the withheld
amounts to the IRS as a credit against the holder's federal income tax
liability. If the holder of record of Notes is CEDE, as nominee for DTC,
Noteholders and the IRS will receive tax and other information only from
Participants and indirect participants rather than from the Issuer. Similarly,
investors who hold their Notes through a Participant, indirect participant or
other nominee must provide their certifications to such nominee.
 
STATE AND LOCAL INCOME AND FRANCHISE TAX CONSEQUENCES
 
     Taxation of the Deposit Trust and the Issuer. Some states in which obligors
are located or the Deposit Trust conducts its collection activities may impose
an income or franchise tax on the Deposit Trust or on the Issuer,
notwithstanding their avoidance of taxation as a corporation for federal income
tax purposes. Such taxes are not now material, but are subject to change at any
time. As to the consequences under state law of the Deposit Trust or the Issuer
being taxable as a corporation, see "Tax Characterization of The Deposit Trust
and The Issuer", above.
 
     Taxation of Note Owners. If, in accordance with the opinion of Tax Counsel,
the Notes are characterized as indebtedness for federal income tax purposes,
Note Owners that are subject to taxation generally will be taxed on the income
and gain realized from their Notes in the locality of their commercial domicile
or residence, as applicable. Prospective investors should consult with their own
tax advisors as to the state and local income and franchise tax consequences of
an investment in the Notes.
 
                              ERISA CONSIDERATIONS
 
GENERAL
 
     The Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA")
and Code Section 4975 impose certain restrictions on employee benefit plans
subject to ERISA or plans or arrangements subject to Code Section 4975 (a
"Plan") and on persons who are parties in interest or disqualified persons
("party in interest") with respect to such a Plan. In addition, ERISA imposes a
fiduciary duty on any person who is considered to be a fiduciary (as defined in
ERISA) with respect to a Plan ("fiduciary"). Certain employee benefit plans,
such as governmental plans and church plans (if no election has been made under
Code Section 410(d)), are not subject to the restrictions of ERISA, and assets
of such plans may be invested in the Notes without regard to the ERISA
considerations described below, subject to other applicable federal and state
law. However, any such governmental or church plan which is qualified under Code
Section 401(a) and exempt from taxation under Code Section 501(a) is subject to
the prohibited transaction rules set forth in Code Section 503. Investments by a
Plan are also subject to ERISA's general fiduciary requirements, including the
requirement of investment prudence and diversification and the requirement that
a Plan's investments be made in accordance with the documents governing the
Plan. ANY PLAN FIDUCIARY WHICH PROPOSES TO CAUSE A PLAN TO ACQUIRE ANY OF THE
NOTES SHOULD CONSULT WITH ITS COUNSEL WITH RESPECT TO THE POTENTIAL CONSEQUENCES
UNDER ERISA, AND THE CODE, OF THE PLAN'S ACQUISITION AND OWNERSHIP OF THE NOTES.
 
PROHIBITED TRANSACTIONS AND FIDUCIARY DUTY
 
     Section 406 of ERISA prohibits parties in interest with respect to a Plan
from engaging in certain direct or indirect transactions (including loans) or
self-dealing transactions ("prohibited transaction") involving a Plan and its
assets unless a statutory or administrative exemption applies to the
transaction. Code Section 4975 imposes certain excise taxes (or, in some cases,
a civil penalty may be assessed against a fiduciary pursuant to Section 502(i)
and 502(l) of ERISA) on parties in interest which engage in similar non-exempt
prohibited transactions. Section 409 of ERISA imposes personal liability upon a
fiduciary who breaches a fiduciary duty with respect to a Plan. With respect to
the assets of the Issuer, it is not anticipated that there will be any
transaction which is a prohibited transaction with a party in interest with
respect to a Noteholder who is a Plan for the reasons discussed below under the
"Plan Asset Regulation."
 
                                       86
<PAGE>   89
 
   
     In addition, the acquisition or holding of Notes by or on behalf of a Plan
would in some circumstances be considered to give rise to a prohibited
transaction or a breach of a fiduciary duty (1) if the Seller, the Issuer, the
applicable Trustee, the Servicer, the Underwriter, or any of their respective
affiliates is or becomes a fiduciary or party in interest with respect to such
Plan; or (2) if the sponsor of such Plan is a Certificateholder or intends to
purchase any Certificate. Certain exemptions from the prohibited transaction
rules granted by the U.S. Department of Labor could be applicable to the
purchase and holding of Notes by a Plan depending on the type and circumstances
of the plan fiduciary making the decision to acquire such Notes. Included among
these exemptions are: Prohibited Transaction Class Exemption ("PTCE") 90-1,
regarding investments by insurance company pooled separate accounts; PTCE 91-38,
regarding investments by bank collective investment funds; PTCE 84-14, regarding
transactions effected by "qualified professional asset managers;" PTCE 75-1,
regarding investments in principal transactions and during underwritings, PTCE
95-60, regarding transactions involving insurance company general accounts; and
PTCE 96-23, regarding transactions effected by an "in-house asset manager."
Neither the Issuer nor Katten Muchin & Zavis ("ERISA Counsel") expresses any
opinion as to the applicability of any of the above exemptions to the
acquisition of or holding of Notes by a Plan.
    
 
PLAN ASSET REGULATION
 
     The United States Department of Labor ("Labor") has issued final
regulations concerning the definition of what constitutes the assets of a Plan
for purposes of ERISA and the prohibited transaction provisions (the "Plan Asset
Regulation"). The Plan Asset Regulation describes the circumstances under which
the assets of an entity in which a Plan invests will be considered to be subject
to regulation by ERISA ("plan assets") such that any person who exercises
control over such plan assets would be subject to ERISA's fiduciary standards
and transactions involving such assets would be subject to the prohibited
transaction rules. Under the Plan Asset Regulation, generally when a Plan
invests in another entity, the Plan's assets do not include, solely by reason of
such investment, any of the underlying assets of the entity. However, the Plan
Asset Regulation provides that, if a Plan acquires an "equity interest" in an
entity that is neither a "publicly-offered security" (as defined therein) nor a
security issued by an investment company registered under the Investment Company
Act of 1940, the assets of the entity will be treated as assets of the Plan
investor and thus plan assets unless certain exceptions apply. If the Notes were
deemed to be equity interests and no statutory, regulatory or administrative
exemption applies, the Issuer could be considered to hold plan assets by reason
of a Plan's investment in the Notes. Such plan assets would include an undivided
interest in any assets held by the Issuer. In such an event, the Trustee,
Seller, Servicer, underwriter and other persons, in providing services with
respect to the Issuer's assets, may be a fiduciary or a party in interest with
respect to such Plan, subject to the fiduciary responsibility provisions of
ERISA, and the prohibited transaction provisions of Section 406 of ERISA and the
Code, with respect to transactions involving the Issuer's assets. Under the Plan
Asset Regulation, the term "equity interest" is defined as any interest in an
entity other than an instrument that is treated as indebtedness under
"applicable local law" and which has no "substantial equity features." Although
the Plan Assets Regulation is silent with respect to the question of which law
constitutes "applicable local law" for this purpose, Labor has stated that these
determinations should be made under the state law governing interpretation of
the instrument in question. In the preamble to the Plan Assets Regulation, Labor
declined to provide a precise definition of what features are equity features or
the circumstances under which such features would be considered "substantial,"
noting that the question of whether a plan's interest has substantial equity
features is an inherently factual one, but that in making a determination it
would be appropriate to take into account whether the equity features are such
that a Plan's investment would be a practical vehicle for the indirect provision
of investment management services. ERISA Counsel has rendered its opinion that
the Notes, based upon the plain language of the Plan Assets Regulation, will be
classified as indebtedness, under the laws of the State of New York governing
indebtedness, without substantial equity features for ERISA purposes. ERISA
Counsel's opinion is based upon the terms of the Notes, its opinion as Tax
Counsel that the Notes will be classified as debt instruments for federal income
tax purposes, the ratings which have been assigned to the Notes, and the
collateral securing the Notes. However, if contrary to ERISA Counsel's opinion
the Notes are not deemed to be indebtedness without substantial equity features
and no statutory, regulatory or administrative exemption applies, the Issuer
could be considered to hold plan assets by reason of a Plan's investment in the
Notes.
 
                                       87
<PAGE>   90
 
REVIEW BY PLAN FIDUCIARIES
 
     Any Plan fiduciary considering whether to purchase any Notes on behalf of a
Plan should consult with its counsel regarding the applicability of the
fiduciary responsibility and prohibited transaction provisions of ERISA and the
Code to such investment. Among other things, before purchasing any Notes, a
fiduciary of a Plan should make its own determination as to whether (i) the
Seller, the Issuer, the applicable Trustee, the Servicer, the Underwriters or
any of their respective affiliates, is a party in interest with respect to the
Plan, (ii) the Plan's sponsor is a Certificateholder, (iii) the availability of
the exemptive relief provided in the Plan Asset Regulations and (iv) the
availability of any other prohibited transaction exemptions.
 
                                  UNDERWRITING
 
     Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the Underwriting Agreement
dated             , 1996 (the "Underwriting Agreement") among the Seller, the
Subservicers, HFC and the Underwriters named below (the "Underwriters"), the
Seller has agreed to sell to the Underwriters and each of the Underwriters has
agreed to purchase, the principal amount of the Notes set forth opposite its
name below.
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           PRINCIPAL      PRINCIPAL      PRINCIPAL      PRINCIPAL
                                           AMOUNT OF      AMOUNT OF      AMOUNT OF      AMOUNT OF
                                           CLASS A-1      CLASS A-2      CLASS A-3       CLASS B
              UNDERWRITERS                   NOTES          NOTES          NOTES          NOTES
- ----------------------------------------- ------------   ------------   ------------   ------------
<S>                                       <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
             Incorporated................ $              $              $              $
J.P. Morgan Securities Inc. .............
Lehman Brothers Inc. ....................
UBS Securities Inc. .....................
                                          ------------   ------------   ------------   ------------
     Total............................... $              $              $              $
                                           ===========    ===========    ===========    ===========
</TABLE>
    
 
   
     The Underwriters propose to offer the Class A and Class B Notes in part
directly to purchasers at the initial public offering prices set forth on the
cover page of this Prospectus and in part to certain securities dealers at such
prices less concessions not to exceed        %,        %,        % and        %
of the respective Security Balance of the Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3 and
Class B Notes. The Underwriters may allow, and such dealers may reallow,
concessions not to exceed      %,        %,        % and        % of the
respective Security Balance of the Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3 and Class B
Notes, to certain brokers and dealers. After the Notes are released for sale to
the public, the offering price and other selling terms may be varied by the
Underwriters.
    
 
     The Seller and HFC have agreed to indemnify the Underwriters against
certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended.
 
                                 LEGAL MATTERS
 
     Certain legal matters relating to the Notes will be passed upon for the
Seller by John W. Blenke, Vice President -- Corporate Law and Assistant
Secretary of Household International, Inc., the parent company of HFC and the
Seller, and by Katten Muchin & Zavis, Chicago, Illinois, special counsel to the
Seller. Certain legal matters will be passed upon for the Underwriters by Brown
& Wood, New York, New York. As of the date of this Prospectus, Mr. Blenke is a
full-time employee and an officer of Household International, Inc. and
beneficially owns, and holds options to purchase, shares of Common Stock of
Household International, Inc.
 
                                       88
<PAGE>   91
 
                             INDEX OF DEFINED TERMS
 
   
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                              <C>
1934 Act......................................................................                2
Accelerated Amortization Date.................................................               11
Accelerated Principal Payment Amount..........................................           16, 66
Additional Balances...........................................................                9
Additional Credit Lines.......................................................               26
Adjusted Security Balance.....................................................               66
Administration Agreement......................................................                6
Administrative Charges........................................................               30
Administrative Receivables....................................................                7
Administrator.................................................................                6
Adverse Effect................................................................               55
Aggregate Additional Credit Lines.............................................           26, 52
Allocation Percentage.........................................................               43
Amortization Event............................................................           11, 68
Bankruptcy Code...............................................................               24
Business Day..................................................................               64
Cedel.........................................................................               17
Certificateholders............................................................               19
Certificate Minimum Balance...................................................               66
Certificate Rate..............................................................           13, 68
Certificate Targeted Balance..................................................               66
Certificates..................................................................             1, 4
Class A Note Rate.............................................................               13
Class A Notes.................................................................                4
Class A-1 Notes...............................................................                4
Class A-2 Notes...............................................................                4
Class A-3 Notes...............................................................                4
Class A-1 Targeted Principal Balance..........................................               66
Class A-2 Targeted Principal Balance..........................................               66
Class A-3 Targeted Principal Balance..........................................               66
Class B Note Rate.............................................................               13
Class B Notes.................................................................                4
Class B Targeted Principal Balance............................................               66
Closing Date..................................................................           13, 68
Code..........................................................................           19, 83
Collection Account............................................................           11, 56
Collection Period.............................................................               11
Commission....................................................................                2
Credit Limit..................................................................               29
Credit Line Agreement.........................................................               35
Credit Lines..................................................................             1, 6
Cut-Off Date..................................................................                9
Cycle Date....................................................................               30
Defaulted Amount..............................................................            9, 58
Defaulted Credit Line.........................................................            9, 58
Defective Receivable..........................................................               11
Deposit Trust.................................................................         1, 5, 49
Deposit Trustee...............................................................            1, 50
Depositaries..................................................................           17, 74
Determination Date............................................................           17, 64
Discount Percentage...........................................................        8, 22, 55
Distribution Date.............................................................               62
DTC...........................................................................           2, A-1
Early Amortization Period.....................................................           11, 68
Eligible Account..............................................................               56
Eligible Credit Line..........................................................               27
</TABLE>
    
 
                                       89
<PAGE>   92
 
   
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                              <C>
Eligible Receivable...........................................................               52
ERISA.........................................................................           19, 86
ERISA Counsel.................................................................               87
Euroclear.....................................................................               17
Events of Default.............................................................               70
Final Payment Date............................................................               13
Finance Charge and Administrative Receivables.................................                7
Finance Charge Receivables....................................................                7
Fixed Allocation Percentage...................................................               57
Fixed Rate Credit Line........................................................               30
Floating Allocation Percentage................................................               57
Global Securities.............................................................              A-1
HFC...........................................................................                5
Holders.......................................................................               18
Indenture.....................................................................             1, 4
Indenture Trustee.............................................................             1, 4
Index Rate....................................................................               30
indirect participants.........................................................               75
Ineligible Receivables........................................................               52
Initial Credit Lines..........................................................                6
Initial Cut-Off Date..........................................................                6
Initial Issuance Date.........................................................                6
Initial Overcollateralization Amount..........................................           16, 68
Initial Overcollateralization Percentage......................................           16, 68
Initial Receivables...........................................................                6
Initial Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount...........................        9, 43, 51
IRS...........................................................................               83
Insolvency Event..............................................................               23
Interest Collections..........................................................           11, 57
Interest Period...............................................................           13, 68
Issuer........................................................................             1, 4
Labor.........................................................................               87
LIBOR.........................................................................           13, 68
LIBOR Business Day............................................................               68
Loan Rate.....................................................................               30
Margin........................................................................               30
Minimum Security Balance......................................................               66
Minimum Monthly Payment.......................................................               30
Minimum Principal Amount......................................................               63
Net Charge-Off................................................................               66
Net Principal Collections.....................................................       10, 43, 57
New Credit Lines..............................................................               27
Note Owners...................................................................            2, 17
Note Rate.....................................................................           12, 67
Noteholders...................................................................           18, 63
Notes.........................................................................                1
Optimum Monthly Principal.....................................................               66
Overcollateralization Amount..................................................       16, 67, 68
Owner Trustee.................................................................                1
Participants..................................................................               75
Participation Pass-Through Rate...............................................           12, 63
Paying Agent..................................................................               70
Payment Account...............................................................               64
Payment Date..................................................................        1, 12, 64
Personal Homeowner Credit Line................................................               28
Personal Unsecured Credit Line................................................               28
Plan..........................................................................           19, 86
</TABLE>
    
 
                                       90
<PAGE>   93
 
   
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                              <C>
Pool Balance..................................................................            9, 58
Pooling and Servicing Agreement...............................................                5
Portfolio.....................................................................                6
Preferred Stock...............................................................            5, 50
Prime Rate....................................................................               63
Principal Balance.............................................................            9, 58
Principal Collections.........................................................           11, 57
Principal Discount............................................................                8
Principal Receivables.........................................................                7
Rating Agency.................................................................               24
Rating Agency Condition.......................................................               26
Receivables...................................................................                7
Receivables Purchase Agreement................................................                6
Recency Charge-off Policy.....................................................               32
Record Date...................................................................           18, 64
Recoveries....................................................................           32, 58
Reference Bank Rate...........................................................               68
Removal Notice................................................................               55
Removed Credit Lines..........................................................                7
Replacement Notes.............................................................               76
Reversals.....................................................................               67
Security Balance..............................................................               67
Securityholders...............................................................               59
Seller........................................................................     1, 5, 27, 54
Seller's Bankruptcy Initiatives...............................................               50
Seller's Interest.............................................................            5, 51
Seller's Trust Amount.........................................................               53
Series........................................................................                5
Series Enhancement............................................................               17
Series Participation Interest.................................................                5
Series 1996-2 Cut-Off Date....................................................                8
Series 1996-2 Participation...................................................             1, 5
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Distribution Amount......................               12
Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount...................................        9, 43, 51
Series 1996-2 Participation Principal Distribution Amount.....................           12, 51
Series 1996-2 Securities......................................................                1
Series 1996-2 Supplement......................................................               50
Servicer......................................................................         1, 5, 28
Servicer Credit Facility......................................................               56
Servicing Fee.................................................................           18, 58
Servicing Guidelines..........................................................               32
Servicer Default..............................................................               60
Subservicer...................................................................            6, 27
Supplemental Certificate......................................................               54
Tax Counsel...................................................................               83
Telerate Screen Page 3750.....................................................               68
Transfer Price................................................................               54
Trust Agreement...............................................................             1, 4
Trust Assets..................................................................                5
UCC...........................................................................               23
Underwriters..................................................................               88
Underwriting Agreement........................................................               88
Variable Rate Credit Line.....................................................               30
</TABLE>
    
 
                                       91
<PAGE>   94
 
                                    ANNEX I
         GLOBAL CLEARANCE, SETTLEMENT AND TAX DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURES
 
     Except in certain limited circumstances, the globally offered Household
Consumer Loan Asset Backed Notes, Series 1996-2 (the "Global Securities") will
be available only in book-entry form. Investors in the Global Securities may
hold such Global Securities through any of The Depository Trust Company ("DTC"),
Cedel or Euroclear. The Global Securities will be tradeable as home market
instruments in both the European and U.S. domestic markets. Initial settlement
and all secondary trades will settle in same-day funds.
 
     Secondary market trading between investors holding Global Securities
through Cedel and Euroclear will be conducted in the ordinary way in accordance
with their normal rules and operating procedures and in accordance with
conventional eurobond practice (i.e., seven calendar day settlement).
 
     Secondary market trading between investors holding Global Securities
through DTC will be conducted according to the rules and procedures applicable
to U.S. corporate debt obligations and prior asset backed issues.
 
     Secondary cross-market trading between Cedel or Euroclear and DTC
Participants holding Certificates will be effected on a delivery-against-payment
basis through the respective Depositaries of Cedel and Euroclear (in such
capacity) and as DTC Participants.
 
     Non-U.S. holders (as described below) of Global Securities will be subject
to U.S. withholding taxes unless such holders meet certain requirements and
deliver appropriate U.S. tax documents to the securities clearing organizations
or their participants.
 
INITIAL SETTLEMENT
 
     All Global Securities will be held in book-entry form by DTC in the name of
CEDE & Co. as nominee of DTC. Investors' interests in the Global Securities will
be represented through financial institutions acting on their behalf as direct
and indirect Participants in DTC. As a result, Cedel and Euroclear will hold
positions on behalf of their participants through their respective Depositaries,
which in turn will hold such positions in accounts as DTC Participants.
 
     Investors electing to hold their Global Securities through DTC will follow
the settlement practices applicable to prior asset backed issues. Investor
securities custody accounts will be credited with their holdings against payment
in same-day funds on the settlement date.
 
     Investors electing to hold their Global Securities through Cedel or
Euroclear accounts will follow the settlement procedures applicable to
conventional eurobonds, except that there will be no temporary global security
and no "lock-up" or restricted period. Global Securities will be credited to the
securities custody accounts on the settlement date against payment in same-day
funds.
 
SECONDARY MARKET TRADING
 
     Since the purchaser determines the place of delivery, it is important to
establish at the time of the trade where both the purchaser's and seller's
accounts are located to ensure that settlement can be made on the desired value
date.
 
     Trading between DTC Participants. Secondary market trading between DTC
Participants will be settled using the procedures applicable to prior asset
backed securities issues in same-day funds.
 
     Trading between Cedel and/or Euroclear Participants. Secondary market
trading between Cedel Participants or Euroclear Participants will be settled
using the procedures applicable to conventional eurobonds in same-day funds.
 
     Trading between DTC seller and Cedel or Euroclear purchaser. When Global
Securities are to be transferred from the account of a DTC Participant to the
account of a Cedel Participant or a Euroclear Participant, the purchaser will
send instructions to Cedel or Euroclear through a Cedel Participant or Euroclear
Participant at least one business day prior to settlement. Cedel or Euroclear
will instruct the
 
                                       A-1
<PAGE>   95
 
respective Depositary, as the case may be, to receive the Global Securities
against payment. Payment will include interest accrued on the Global Securities
from and including the last coupon payment date to and excluding the settlement
date, on the basis of (i) the actual number of days in such accrual period and a
year assumed to consist of 360 days. For transactions settling on the 31st of
the month, payment will include interest accrued to and excluding the first day
of the following month. Payment will then be made by the respective Depositary
of the DTC Participant's account against delivery of the Global Securities.
After settlement has been completed, the Global Securities will be credited to
the respective clearing system and by the clearing system, in accordance with
its usual procedures, to the Cedel Participant's or Euroclear Participant's
account. The securities credit will appear the next day (European time) and the
cash debt will be back-valued to, and the interest on the Global Securities will
accrue from, the value date (which would be the preceding day when settlement
occurred in New York). If settlement is not completed on the intended value date
(i.e., the trade fails), the Cedel or Euroclear cash debt will be valued instead
as of the actual settlement date.
 
     Cedel Participants and Euroclear Participants will need to make available
to the respective clearing systems the funds necessary to process same-day funds
settlement. The most direct means of doing so is to preposition funds for
settlement, either from cash on hand or existing lines of credit, as they would
for any settlement occurring within Cedel or Euroclear. Under this approach,
they may take on credit exposure to Cedel or Euroclear until the Global
Securities are credited to their accounts one day later.
 
     As an alternative, if Cedel or Euroclear has extended a line of credit to
them, Cedel Participants or Euroclear Participants can elect not to preposition
funds and allow that credit line to be drawn upon the finance settlement. Under
this procedure, Cedel Participants or Euroclear Participants purchasing Global
Securities would incur overdraft charges for one day, assuming they cleared the
overdraft when the Global Securities were credited to their accounts. However,
interest on the Global Securities would accrue from the value date. Therefore,
in many cases the investment income on the Global Securities earned during that
one-day period may substantially reduce or offset the amount of such overdraft
charges, although this result will depend on each Cedel Participant's or
Euroclear Participant's particular cost of funds.
 
     Since the settlement is taking place during New York business hours, DTC
Participants can employ their usual procedures for sending Global Securities to
the respective Depositary for the benefit of Cedel Participants or Euroclear
Participants. The sale proceeds will be available to the DTC seller on the
settlement date. Thus, to the DTC Participant a cross-market transaction will
settle no differently than a trade between two DTC Participants.
 
     Trading between Cedel or Euroclear seller and DTC purchaser. Due to time
zone differences in their favor, Cedel Participants and Euroclear Participants
may employ their customary procedures for transactions in which Global
Securities are to be transferred by the respective clearing system, through the
respective Depositary, to a DTC Participant. The seller will send instructions
to Cedel or Euroclear through a Cedel Participant or Euroclear Participant at
least one business day prior to settlement. In these cases, Cedel or Euroclear
will instruct the respective Depositary, as appropriate, to deliver the Global
Securities to the DTC Participant's account against payment. Payment will
include interest accrued on the Global Securities from and including the last
coupon payment to and excluding the settlement date on the basis of (i) the
actual number of days in such accrual period and a year assumed to consist of
360 days. For transactions settling on the 31st of the month, payment will
include interest accrued to and excluding the first day of the following month.
The payment will then be reflected in the account of the Cedel Participant or
Euroclear Participant the following day, and receipt of the cash proceeds in the
Cedel Participant's or Euroclear Participant's account would be backed-valued to
the value date (which would be the preceding day, when settlement occurred in
New York). Should the Cedel Participant or Euroclear Participant have a line of
credit with its respective clearing system and elect to be in debt in
anticipation of receipt of the sale proceeds in its account, the back-valuation
will extinguish any overdraft incurred over that one-day period. If settlement
is not completed on the intended value date (i.e., the trade fails), receipt of
the cash proceeds in the Cedel Participant's or Euroclear Participant's account
would instead be valued as of the actual settlement date.
 
                                       A-2
<PAGE>   96
 
     Finally, day traders that use Cedel or Euroclear and that purchase Global
Securities from DTC Participants for delivery to Cedel Participants or Euroclear
Participants should note that these trades would automatically fail on the sale
side unless affirmative action were taken. At least three techniques should be
readily available to eliminate this potential problem:
 
          (a) borrowing through Cedel or Euroclear for one day (until the
     purchase side of the day trade is reflected in their Cedel or Euroclear
     accounts) in accordance with the clearing system's customary procedures;
 
          (b) borrowing the Global Securities in the U.S. from a DTC Participant
     no later than one day prior to settlement, which would give the Global
     Securities sufficient time to be reflected in their Cedel or Euroclear
     account in order to settle the sale side of the trade; or
 
          (c) staggering the value dates for the buy and sell sides of the trade
     so that the value date for the purchase from the DTC Participant is at
     least one day prior to the value date for the sale to the Cedel Participant
     or Euroclear Participant.
 
CERTAIN U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX DOCUMENTATION REQUIREMENTS
 
     A beneficial owner of Global Securities holding securities through Cedel or
Euroclear (or through DTC if the holder has an address outside the U.S.) will be
subject to the 30% U.S. withholding tax that generally applies to payments of
interest (including original issue discount) on registered debt issued by U.S.
Persons, unless (i) each clearing system, bank or other financial institution
that holds customers' securities in the ordinary course of its trade or business
in the chain of intermediaries between such beneficial owner and the U.S. entity
required to withhold tax complies with applicable certification requirements and
(ii) such beneficial owner takes one of the following steps to obtain an
exemption or reduced tax rate:
 
     Exemption for non-U.S. Persons (Form W-8). Beneficial owners of Global
Securities that are non-U.S. Persons can obtain a complete exemption from the
withholding tax by filing a signed Form W-8 (Certificate of Foreign Status). If
the information shown on Form W-8 changes, a new Form W-8 must be filed within
30 days of such change.
 
     Exemption for non-U.S. Persons with effectively connected income (Form
4224). A non-U.S. Person, including a non-U.S. corporation or bank with a U.S.
branch, for which the interest income is effectively connected with its conduct
of a trade or business in the United States, can obtain an exemption from the
withholding tax by filing Form 4224 (Exemption from Withholding of Tax on Income
Effectively Connected with the Conduct of a Trade or Business in the United
States).
 
     Exemption or reduced rate for non-U.S. Persons resident in treaty countries
(Form 1001). Non-U.S. Persons that are Certificate Owners residing in a country
that has a tax treaty with the United States can obtain an exemption or reduced
tax rate (depending on the treaty terms) by filing Form 1001 (Ownership,
Exemption or Reduced Rate Certificate). If the treaty provides only for a
reduced rate, withholding tax will be imposed at that rate unless the filer
alternatively files Form W-8. Form 1001 may be filed by the Certificate Owners
or his agent.
 
     Exemption for U.S. Persons (Form W-9). U.S. Persons can obtain a complete
exemption from the withholding tax by filing Form W-9 (Payer's Request for
Taxpayer Identification Number and Certification).
 
     U.S. Federal Income Tax Reporting Procedure. The Certificate Owners of a
Global Security or, in the case of a Form 1001 or a Form 4224 filer, his agent,
files by submitting the appropriate form to the person through whom it holds
(the clearing agency, in the case of persons holding directly on the books of
the clearing agency). Form W-8 and Form 1001 are effective for three calendar
years and Form 4224 is effective for one calendar year.
 
     The term "U.S. Person" means (i) a citizen or resident of the United
States, (ii) a corporation or partnership organized in or under the laws of the
United States or any political subdivision thereof or (iii) an estate or trust
the income of which is includible in gross income for United States tax
purposes, regardless of its source. This summary does not deal with all aspects
of U.S. Federal income tax withholding that may be relevant to foreign holders
of the Global Securities. Investors are advised to consult their own tax
advisors for specific tax advice concerning their holding and disposing of the
Global Securities.
 
                                       A-3
<PAGE>   97
 
                                    ANNEX II
 
                PRIOR ISSUANCE OF SERIES PARTICIPATION INTERESTS
 
     The Deposit Trust has previously issued two Series Participation Interests,
the Series 1995-1 Participation and the Series 1996-1 Participation. The table
below sets forth the characteristics of each of these Participations. For more
specific information with respect to these Series Participation Interests,
prospective investors should contact the Servicer.
 
SERIES 1995-1 PARTICIPATION
 
Issuance Date: September 28, 1995
Initial Series 1995-1 Participation Invested Amount: $1,000,000,000
Minimum Participation Pass-Through Rate: Prime Rate, less 1.50%
 
SERIES 1996-1 PARTICIPATION
 
Issuance Date: March 26, 1996
Initial Series 1996-1 Participation Invested Amount: $840,000,000
Minimum Participation Pass-Through Rate: Prime Rate, less 1.50%
 
                                       A-4
<PAGE>   98
 
             ------------------------------------------------------
             ------------------------------------------------------
 
     NO DEALER, SALESMAN OR OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY
INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATION NOT CONTAINED IN THIS PROSPECTUS AND,
IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATION MUST NOT BE RELIED UPON AS
HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED BY THE SELLER, HFC OR THE UNDERWRITERS. THIS PROSPECTUS
DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR A SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY ANY OF
THE SECURITIES OFFERED HEREBY IN ANY JURISDICTION TO ANY PERSON TO WHOM IT IS
UNLAWFUL TO MAKE SUCH OFFER IN SUCH JURISDICTION. NEITHER THE DELIVERY OF THIS
PROSPECTUS NOR ANY SALE MADE HEREUNDER, SHALL, UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES, CREATE
ANY IMPLICATION THAT THE INFORMATION HEREIN IS CORRECT AS OF ANY TIME SUBSEQUENT
TO THE DATE HEREOF OR THAT THERE HAS BEEN NO CHANGE IN THE AFFAIRS OF THE
SELLER, HFC OR THE TRUST SINCE SUCH DATE.
 
                          ---------------------------
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                         PAGE
                                         ----
<S>                                      <C>
Available Information...................   2
Incorporation of Certain Documents by
  Reference.............................   2
Financial Information...................   2
Reports to the Noteholders..............   2
Table of Contents.......................   3
Prospectus Summary......................   4
Risk Factors............................  21
Deposit Trust Risk Factors..............  26
The Seller and Subservicers.............  27
The Servicer............................  28
Use of Proceeds.........................  28
The HFC Revolving Consumer Credit
  Lines.................................  28
The Revolving Consumer Credit Lines.....  35
The Series 1996-2 Participation.........  43
Maturity and Prepayment
  Considerations........................  44
Description of the Deposit Trust........  49
Description of the Securities...........  63
Description of the Receivables Purchase
  Agreement.............................  77
Certain Legal Aspects of the
  Receivables...........................  79
Certain Federal and State Income Tax
  Consequences..........................  83
ERISA Considerations....................  86
Underwriting............................  88
Legal Matters...........................  88
Index of Defined Terms..................  89
Global Clearance, Settlement and Tax
  Documentation Procedures.............. A-1
</TABLE>
    
 
   
     UNTIL 90 DAYS AFTER THE DATE OF THIS PROSPECTUS, ALL DEALERS EFFECTING
TRANSACTIONS IN THE NOTES, WHETHER OR NOT PARTICIPATING IN THIS DISTRIBUTION,
MAY BE REQUIRED TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS. THIS IS IN ADDITION TO THE OBLIGATION
OF DEALERS TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS WHEN ACTING AS UNDERWRITERS AND WITH RESPECT
TO THEIR UNSOLD ALLOTMENTS OR SUBSCRIPTIONS.
    
             ------------------------------------------------------
             ------------------------------------------------------
             ------------------------------------------------------
             ------------------------------------------------------
 
   
                                  $794,000,000
    
   
                                CLASS A-1 NOTES
    
 
   
                                  $52,240,000
    
   
                                CLASS A-2 NOTES
    
 
   
                                  $67,900,000
    
   
                                CLASS A-3 NOTES
    
 
   
                                  $49,370,000
    
                                 CLASS B NOTES
   
                               HOUSEHOLD FINANCE
    
   
                                  CORPORATION
    
   
                                    SERVICER
    
 
                               HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER
                               LOAN TRUST 1996-2
                            HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN
                              ASSET BACKED NOTES,
                                 SERIES 1996-2
                              --------------------
   
                                   PROSPECTUS
    
                              --------------------
   
                              MERRILL LYNCH & CO.
    
   
                               J.P. MORGAN & CO.
    
   
                                LEHMAN BROTHERS
    
   
                              UBS SECURITIES INC.
    
                                           , 1996
 
             ------------------------------------------------------
             ------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>   99
 
                                    PART II
 
                     INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
 
   
ITEM 13 OF FORM S-1 AND ITEM 14 OF FORM S-3. OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND
DISTRIBUTION.
    
 
   
     Set forth below is an estimate of the amount of fees and expenses (other
than underwriting discounts and commissions) to be incurred by Household
Consumer Loan Corporation in connection with the issuance and distribution of
the Certificates.
    
 
   
<TABLE>
          <S>                                                           <C>
          SEC Filing Fee..............................................  $332,344.83
          Trustee's Fees and Expenses.................................    16,500.00
          Legal Fees and Expenses.....................................    62,500.00
          Accounting Fees and Expenses................................    60,000.00
          Printing and Engraving Expenses.............................    50,000.00
          Blue Sky Qualification and Legal Investment Fees and
            Expenses..................................................    16,000.00
          Rating Agency Fees..........................................   420,000.00
          Miscellaneous...............................................     2,655.17
                                                                        -----------
                    Total.............................................  $960,000.00
                                                                        ===========
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------------
 
   
* Actual.
    
 
   
ITEM 14 OF FORM S-1 AND ITEM 15 OF FORM S-3. INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND
OFFICERS.
    
 
   
     A. Indemnification.  The General Corporation Law of Delaware (Section 145)
gives Delaware corporations broad powers to indemnify their present and former
directors and officers and those of affiliated corporations against expenses
incurred in the defense of any lawsuit to which they are made parties by reason
of being or having been such directors or officers, subject to specified
conditions and exclusions; gives a director or officer who successfully defends
an action the right to be so indemnified; and authorizes said corporation to buy
directors' and officers' liability insurance. Such indemnification is not
exclusive of any other right to which those indemnified may be entitled under
any bylaw, agreement, vote of stockholders or otherwise.
    
 
   
     The General Corporation Law of Nevada (Section 78.751) permits Nevada
corporations to indemnify their present and former directors and officers and
those serving at the request of the corporation against expenses reasonably
incurred in connection with: 1) an action other than one by or in the right of
the corporation, and 2) an action by or in the right of the corporation if a
court determines that such indemnification is proper; gives a director or
officer who successfully defends an action the right to be so indemnified; and
authorizes said corporation to buy directors' and officers' liability insurance.
Such indemnification: 1) must be authorized in the specific case upon a
determination by the stockholders, disinterested directors, or independent
counsel that it is proper, and 2) is not exclusive of any other right to which
those indemnified may be entitled under any bylaw, agreement, vote of
stockholders or otherwise, so long as the defendant's acts or conduct did not
involve intentional misconduct, fraud or a knowing violation of the law.
    
 
   
     A bylaw adopted by Household Finance Corporation, a Delaware corporation
("HFC"), and the immediate parent of the Seller states and makes mandatory the
indemnification expressly authorized under the General Corporation Law of
Delaware, in the absence of other indemnification by contract, vote of
stockholders or otherwise except that the bylaw makes no distinction between
litigation brought by third parties and litigation brought by or in the right of
HFC as regards the required standard of conduct imposed upon the individual in
order to be entitled to indemnification. The bylaw standard applicable in all
cases (excepting indemnification in connection with the successful defense of
any proceeding or matter therein, which is mandatory under the General
Corporation Law of Delaware and the bylaw without reference to any such
standard) is that the individual shall have acted in good faith and in a manner
he reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of HFC,
and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause
to believe his conduct was unlawful. Further, the bylaw would protect directors,
officers,
    
 
                                      II-1
<PAGE>   100
 
   
employees and agents against any and all expenses and liability with respect to
actions brought against them by or in the right of HFC if the required standard
of conduct is met. The bylaw is qualified in its entirety in that no
indemnification will be made if prohibited by applicable law. The bylaw is
applicable only to claims, actions, suits or proceedings made or commenced after
its adoption, whether arising from prior or subsequent acts or omissions to act.
The bylaw is applicable to directors, officers, employees or agents of HFC and
also to persons who are serving at the request of HFC as directors, officers,
employees or agents or other corporations (including subsidiaries such as the
Seller).
    
 
   
     Article VII of Household International, Inc.'s Certificate of Incorporation
provides for indemnification to the fullest extent permitted by Section 145 of
the General Corporation of Delaware for directors, officers and employees of
Household International, Inc., and also to persons who are serving at the
request of Household International, Inc. as directors, officers or employees of
other corporations (including subsidiaries such as the Seller). Household
International, Inc. has also purchased liability policies which indemnify the
Seller, officers and directors against loss arising from claims by reason of
their legal liability for acts as officers and directors, subject to limitations
and conditions as set forth in the policies.
    
 
   
     Articles Ninth and Tenth of the Seller's charter also provides for
indemnification as permitted by the Nevada Revised Statutes.
    
 
   
     Pursuant to agreements which Seller may enter into with underwriters or
agents (forms of which are included as exhibits to this Registration Statement),
officers and directors of the Seller, and affiliates thereof, may be entitled to
indemnification by such underwriters or agents against certain liabilities,
including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, arising from information
which has been furnished to the Seller by such underwriters or agents that
appears in the Registration Statement or any Prospectus.
    
 
   
     B. Pooling and Servicing Agreement.  The Pooling and Servicing Agreement
provides that no director, officer, employee or agent of HFC, as Servicer, or
the Seller is liable to any holder of the Securities or to the Deposit Trustee
on behalf of the holders of Series Participation Interests, except for such
person's own willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless
disregard of duty. The Pooling and Servicing Agreement further provides that,
with the exceptions stated above, a director, officer, employee or agent of HFC
or the Seller is entitled to be indemnified against all liability in connection
with the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or the issuance of Series Participation
Interests in the Deposit Trust.
    
 
   
ITEM 15 OF FORM S-1. RECENT SALES OF UNREGISTERED SECURITIES.
    
 
   
     None.
    
 
ITEM 16 OF FORM S-1. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES AND ITEM 16 OF
FORM S-3. EXHIBITS.
 
     (a) EXHIBITS
 
   
<TABLE>
<C>     <C>    <S>
   1     --    Form of Underwriting Agreement
 3.1     --    Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, of Seller. (Incorporated by reference
               to Exhibit 3.1 of the Registration Statement on Forms S-1 and S-3 (No.
               33-95220)).
 3.2     --    By-Laws of Seller. (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Registration
               Statement on Forms S-1 and S-3 (No. 33-95220)).
 4.1     --    Form of Trust Agreement between the Owner Trustee and the Seller.
 4.2     --    Form of Indenture between the Owner Trustee and the Indenture Trustee.
   5     --    Opinion of John W. Blenke, Esq., Vice President -- Corporate Law and Assistant
               Secretary of Household International, Inc.
   8     --    Opinion of Katten Muchin & Zavis with respect to tax matters.
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      II-2
<PAGE>   101
 
   
<TABLE>
<C>     <C>    <S>
10.1     --    Receivables Purchase Agreement between the Seller as purchaser, and Household
               Realty Corporation, Household Finance Corporation II, Household Finance
               Corporation III, Household Finance Realty Corporation of New York, Household
               Finance Corporation of California, Household Finance Corporation of Alabama,
               Household Finance Industrial Loan Company, Household Financial Center, Inc.,
               Household Finance Corporation of Nevada, Household Finance Realty Corporation of
               Nevada, Household Industrial Loan Company of Kentucky, Household Finance
               Industrial Loan Company of Iowa, Household Finance Consumer Discount Company,
               Household Industrial Finance Company and Mortgage One Corporation, as sellers
               (the "Subservicers"). (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Current
               Report on Form 8-K for September 28, 1995 of Household Consumer Loan Trust 1995-1
               (File No. 33-95220)).
10.2     --    Pooling and Servicing Agreement among the Seller, the Servicer and the Deposit
               Trustee, including exhibits thereto. (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2
               to the Current Report on Form 8-K for September 28, 1995 of Household Consumer
               Loan Trust 1995-1 (File No. 33-95220)).
10.3     --    Form of Series 1996-2 Supplement.
10.4     --    Form of Administration Agreement between the Owner Trustee and the Seller.
23.1     --    Consent of John W. Blenke is included in the opinion filed as Exhibit 5 hereto.
23.2     --    Consent of Katten Muchin & Zavis is included in the opinion filed as Exhibit 8
               hereto.
  24     --    Powers of Attorney (included on pages II-4 through II-6).
25.1     --    Statement of eligibility and qualification of the Indenture Trustee.
</TABLE>
    
 
- ---------------
 
     (b) Financial statements filed as part of the Registration Statement: Not
applicable with respect to the Seller.
 
   
ITEM 17 OF FORMS S-1 AND S-3. UNDERTAKINGS.
    
 
   
     The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:
    
 
   
          (1) for purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act
     of 1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part
     of a registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in the
     form of prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or
     (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this
     registration statement as of the time it was declared effective; and
    
 
   
          (2) for the purposes of determining any liability under the Securities
     Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of
     prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to
     the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that
     time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.
    
 
   
     For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933,
each filing of the Issuer's annual report pursuant to section 13(a) or section
15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 that is incorporated by reference
in this Registration Statement shall be deemed to be a new registration
statement relating to the securities offered herein, and the offering of such
securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering
thereof.
    
 
   
     Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act
of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the
registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant
has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission
such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is,
therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against
such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred
or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the
successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such
director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being
registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter
has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate
jurisdiction the question of whether such indemnification by it is against
public policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final
adjudication of such issue.
    
 
                                      II-3
<PAGE>   102
 
                                   SIGNATURES
 
   
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Household
Consumer Loan Corporation certifies that it has duly caused this Amendment to
the Registration Statement on Form S-1 to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereto duly authorized, in the City of Prospect Heights, State of
Illinois, on the        day of August, 1996.
    
 
                                            HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN
                                            CORPORATION, as originator of
                                            the Deposit Trust
 
                                            By:         /s/ R. F. ELLIOTT
 
                                            ------------------------------------
                                                         R. F. Elliott,
                                                            President
 
   
     Each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints J.W.
Blenke, L.S. Mattenson and P.D. Schwartz and each or any of them (with full
power to act alone), as his/her true and lawful attorney-in-fact and agent, with
full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him/her in his/her name,
place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign and file with the Securities
and Exchange Commission, any and all amendments (including post-effective
amendments) to the Registration Statement, granting unto each such
attorney-in-fact and agent full power and authority to do and perform each and
every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done, as fully to all intents
and purposes as he/she might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and
confirming all that such attorney-in-fact and agent or their substitutes may
lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.
    
 
   
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Amendment
to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 has been signed below by the following
persons in the capacities indicated on the        day of August, 1996.
    
 
   
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                  SIGNATURE                                          TITLE
- ---------------------------------------------    ---------------------------------------------
<C>                                              <S>
              /s/ R. F. ELLIOTT                  President (Principal Executive Officer)
- ---------------------------------------------    and Director
               (R. F. Elliott)
                /s/ E. ANCONA                    Senior Vice President and Treasurer
- ---------------------------------------------    (Principal Financial Officer)
                 (E. Ancona)
              /s/ J. W. BLENKE                   Vice President, Secretary and Director
- ---------------------------------------------
               (J. W. BLENKE)
               /s/ S. H. SMITH                   Vice President, Assistant Treasurer and
- ---------------------------------------------    Director
                (S. H. SMITH)
               /s/ R. J. KOLB                    Vice President and Controller
- ---------------------------------------------    (Principal Accounting Officer)
                (R. J. KOLB)
</TABLE>
    
 
                                      II-4
<PAGE>   103
 
                                   SIGNATURES
 
   
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Household
Consumer Loan Corporation certifies that it has reasonable grounds to believe
that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form S-3 and has duly caused
this Amendment to the Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereto duly authorized, in the City of Prospect Heights, State of
Illinois, on the        day of August, 1996.
    
 
                                            HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN
                                            CORPORATION
 
                                            By:         /s/ R. F. ELLIOTT
 
                                            ------------------------------------
                                                         R. F. Elliott,
                                                            President
 
   
     Each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints J.W.
Blenke, L.S. Mattenson and P.D. Schwartz and each or any of them (with full
power to act alone), as his/her true and lawful attorney-in-fact and agent, with
full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him/her in his/her name,
place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign and file with the Securities
and Exchange Commission, any and all amendments (including post-effective
amendments) to the Registration Statement, granting unto each such
attorney-in-fact and agent full power and authority to do and perform each and
every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done, as fully to all intents
and purposes as he/she might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and
confirming all that such attorney-in-fact and agent or their substitutes may
lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.
    
 
   
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Amendment
to the Registration Statement on Form S-3 has been signed below by the following
persons in the capacities indicated on the        day of August, 1996.
    
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                  SIGNATURE                                          TITLE
- ---------------------------------------------    ---------------------------------------------
<C>                                              <S>
              /s/ R. F. ELLIOTT                  President (Principal Executive Officer)
- ---------------------------------------------    and Director
               (R. F. Elliott)
                /s/ E. ANCONA                    Senior Vice President and Treasurer
- ---------------------------------------------    (Principal Financial Officer)
                 (E. Ancona)
              /s/ J. W. BLENKE                   Vice President, Secretary and Director
- ---------------------------------------------
               (J. W. Blenke)
               /s/ S. H. SMITH                   Vice President, Assistant Treasurer and
- ---------------------------------------------    Director
                (S. H. Smith)
               /s/ R. J. KOLB                    Vice President and Controller
- ---------------------------------------------    (Principal Accounting Officer)
                (R. J. Kolb)
</TABLE>
 
     The Registrant reasonably believes that the security ratings to be assigned
to the securities registered hereunder will make the securities "investment
grade securities" pursuant to Transaction Requirement B.2 of Form S-3, prior to
the sale of such securities.
 
                                      II-5
<PAGE>   104
 
                                   SIGNATURES
 
   
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Household
Consumer Loan Corporation certifies that it has reasonable grounds to believe
that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form S-3 and has duly caused
this Amendment to the Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereto duly authorized, in the City of Prospect Heights, State of
Illinois, on the        day of August, 1996.
    
 
                                            HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN
                                            CORPORATION, as originator of
                                            the Issuer
 
                                            By:         /s/ R.F. ELLIOTT
 
                                            ------------------------------------
                                                         R. F. Elliott,
                                                            President
 
   
     Each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints J.W.
Blenke, L.S. Mattenson and P.D. Schwartz and each or any of them (with full
power to act alone), as his/her true and lawful attorney-in-fact and agent, with
full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him/her in his/her name,
place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign and file with the Securities
and Exchange Commission, any and all amendments (including post-effective
amendments) to the Registration Statement, granting unto each such
attorney-in-fact and agent full power and authority to do and perform each and
every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done, as fully to all intents
and purposes as he/she might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and
confirming all that such attorney-in-fact and agent or their substitutes may
lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.
    
 
   
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Amendment
to the Registration Statement on Form S-3 has been signed below by the following
persons in the capacities indicated on the        day of August, 1996.
    
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                  SIGNATURE                                          TITLE
- ---------------------------------------------    ---------------------------------------------
<C>                                              <S>
                           /s/ R.F.              President (Principal Executive Officer)
                    ELLIOTT                      and Director
- ---------------------------------------------
               (R. F. Elliott)
                            /s/ E.               Senior Vice President and Treasurer
                    ANCONA                       (Principal Financial Officer)
- ---------------------------------------------
                 (E. Ancona)
                           /s/ J.W.              Vice President, Secretary and Director
                    BLENKE
- ---------------------------------------------
               (J. W. Blenke)
                           /s/ S.H.              Vice President, Assistant Treasurer and
                     SMITH                       Director
- ---------------------------------------------
                (S. H. Smith)
                            /s/ R.J.             Vice President and Controller
                     KOLB                        (Principal Accounting Officer)
- ---------------------------------------------
                (R. J. Kolb)
</TABLE>
 
     The Registrant reasonably believes that the security ratings to be assigned
to the securities registered hereunder will make the securities "investment
grade securities" pursuant to Transaction Requirement B.2 of Form S-3, prior to
the sale of such securities.
 
                                      II-6
<PAGE>   105
 
                                 EXHIBIT INDEX
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        SEQUENTIALLY
                                                                                          NUMBERED
EXHIBIT NO.                                                                                PAGES
- -----------                                                                             ------------
<C>            <S>                                                                      <C>
</TABLE>
 
   
<TABLE>
<C>            <S>                                                                      <C>
       1       Form of Underwriting Agreement........................................
     3.1       Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, of Seller (Incorporated by
               reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Registration Statement on Forms S-1
               and S-3 (No. 33-95220))...............................................
     3.2       By-Laws of Seller (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the
               Registration Statement on Forms S-1 and S-3 (No. 33-95220))...........
     4.1       Form of Trust Agreement between the Owner Trustee and the Seller......
     4.2       Form of Indenture between the Owner Trustee and the Indenture
               Trustee...............................................................
       5       Opinion of John W. Blenke, Esq., Vice President-Corporate Law and
               Assistant Secretary of Household International, Inc. .................
       8       Opinion of Katten Muchin & Zavis with respect to tax matters..........
    10.1       Receivables Purchase Agreement between the Seller as purchaser, and
               Household Realty Corporation, Household Finance Corporation II,
               Household Finance Corporation III, Household Finance Realty
               Corporation of New York, Household Finance Corporation of California,
               Household Finance Corporation of Alabama, Household Finance Industrial
               Loan Company, Household Financial Center, Inc., Household Finance
               Corporation of Nevada, Household Finance Realty Corporation of Nevada,
               Household Industrial Loan Company of Kentucky Household Finance
               Industrial Loan Company of Iowa, Household Finance Consumer Discount
               Company, Household Industrial Finance Company and Mortgage One
               Corporation, as sellers (the "Subservicers"). (Incorporated by
               reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for
               September 28, 1995 of Household Consumer Loan Trust 1995-1 (File No.
               33-95220))............................................................
    10.2       Pooling and Servicing Agreement among the Seller, the Servicer and the
               Deposit Trustee, including exhibits thereto (Incorporated by reference
               to Exhibit 10.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for September 28,
               1995 of Household Consumer Loan Trust 1995-1 (File No. 33-95220)).....
    10.3       Form of Series 1996-2 Supplement......................................
    10.4       Form of Administration Agreement between the Owner Trustee and the
               Seller................................................................
    23.1       Consent of John W. Blenke is included in the opinion filed as Exhibit
               5 hereto..............................................................
    23.2       Consent of Katten Muchin & Zavis is included in the opinion filed as
               Exhibit 8 hereto......................................................
      24       Powers of Attorney (included on pages II-4 through II-6)..............
    25.1       Statement of eligibility and qualification of the Indenture Trustee...
</TABLE>
    

<PAGE>   1
                                                                      EXHIBIT 1



                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2

                  HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN ASSET BACKED NOTES,
           Series 1996-2, Class A-1, Class A-2 Class A-3 and Class B

                         HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION
                                   (Servicer)

                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORPORATION
                                    (Seller)


                        [FORM OF UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT]

                                                               August [__], 1996



MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH
     INCORPORATED
MERRILL LYNCH & CO.,
     as Representative of the Underwriters
c/o Merrill Lynch & Co.
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
     Incorporated
World Financial Center
North Tower
New York, New York 10281

Ladies and Gentlemen:

        Household Consumer Loan Corporation, a Nevada corporation (the 
"Seller") and a wholly-owned, special purpose subsidiary of Household Finance 
Corporation ("HFC") has entered into a Trust Agreement dated as of August 1, 
1996 (the "Trust Agreement") with Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware (the "Owner 
Trustee"), creating Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2 (the "Issuer"), a 
statutory business trust established under the laws of the State of Delaware. 
The Seller proposes to direct the Owner Trustee pursuant to the Trust Agreement
to cause the Issuer to issue Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Notes, Series
1996-2, Class A-1 Notes, Class A-2 Notes, Class A-3 Notes and Class B Notes
(collectively, the "Notes") and Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed
Certificates, Series 1996-2 (the "Certificates" and, together with the Notes,
the "Securities").  Only the Notes are being purchased by the underwriters
named in Schedule A hereto (the "Underwriters") for whom Merrill Lynch, Pierce,
Fenner & Smith Incorporated is acting as representative (the "Representative").
The Seller and HFC understand that the Underwriters propose to make a public
offering





                                      1
<PAGE>   2

of the Notes as soon as the Underwriters deem advisable after the date hereof.

        The Notes will be issued pursuant to an Indenture dated as of August 1,
1996 (the "Indenture") between the Issuer and The Bank of New York (the 
"Indenture Trustee") and will represent indebtedness of the Issuer.  The 
Certificates will be issued pursuant to the Trust Agreement.  The Notes will be
secured by (i) a participation interest (the "Series 1996-2 Participation 
Interest") in (a) receivables held in Household Consumer Loan Deposit Trust I 
(the "Deposit Trust") originated under certain fixed and variable rate 
revolving unsecured consumer credit lines (the "Credit Lines") and (b) certain
other participation interests,  (ii) amounts on deposit in certain accounts of
the Issuer held for the benefit of the holders of the Securities and (iii) an 
assignment of the Issuer's rights under the Series 1996-2 Supplement (as 
defined below) (collectively, the "Trust Assets").  The Deposit Trust was 
formed pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 1,
1995 (the "Base Pooling and Servicing Agreement") among the Seller, HFC, as
Servicer (the "Servicer") and Texas Commerce Bank National Association as
successor trustee to The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A., as Deposit Trustee (the
"Deposit Trustee"). The Series 1996-2 Participation Interest was issued
pursuant to the Supplement for Series 1996-2 dated as of August 1, 1996 among
the Seller, the Servicer and the Deposit Trustee (the "Supplement" and together
with the Base Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the "Pooling and Servicing
Agreement").  The Pooling and Servicing Agreement together with the Trust
Agreement, Certificate of Trust thereto, the Indenture, the Receivables
Purchase Agreement, the Administration Agreement and this Underwriting
Agreement constitute the "Basic Documents" herein.  Capitalized terms used but
not defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to such terms in the
Indenture.

        The Notes are more fully described in the Registration Statement (as 
defined below) which the Seller has furnished to the Underwriters.

        SECTION 1.     Representations and Warranties of the Seller and the
Credit Line Owners.  Each of the Credit Line Owners (as defined in the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement) and the Seller, each as to itself, represents and
warrants to, and agrees with the Underwriters that:

        (a)  A registration statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-[     ]) in respect
of the Notes and a registration statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-[ ]) in respect
of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest, including a prospectus and such
amendments thereto as may have been required on the date hereof, relating to
the Notes and the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest, have been filed with
the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission").  The conditions to
the use of a registration statement on Form S-3 and





                                      2
<PAGE>   3

Form S-1 under the Act, as set forth in the General Instructions to Form S-3
and Form S-1, as applicable, have been, or will prior to the effective date of
the Registration Statement (defined herein) be, satisfied in all material
respects with respect to the Seller and each Registration Statement.  The
Commission has not issued any order preventing or suspending the use of the
Preliminary Prospectus.  There are no contracts or documents of the Seller
which are required to be filed as exhibits to either Registration Statement
pursuant to the Act or the Rules and Regulations (defined herein) which have
not been so filed or incorporated by reference therein on or prior to the
Effective Date of either Registration Statement, assuming compliance by each
Underwriter with Section 2(a) hereof.

        To the extent that any Underwriter (i) has provided to the Seller 
Collateral term sheets (as hereinafter defined) that such Underwriter has       
provided to a prospective investor, the Seller has filed such Collateral term
sheets as an exhibit to a report on Form 8-K within two business days of its
receipt thereof, or (ii) has provided to the Seller Structural term sheets or
Computational Materials (each as hereinafter defined) that such Underwriter has
provided to a prospective investor, the Seller will file or cause to be filed
with the Commission a report on Form 8- K containing such Structural term sheet
and Computational Materials, as soon as reasonably practicable after the date
of this Agreement, but in any event, not later than the date on which the
Prospectus is filed with the Commission pursuant to Rule 424 or 430A of the
Rules and Regulations.

  (b)   The Seller will next file with the Commission either, (i) prior to the
effectiveness of the Registration Statements, a further amendment thereto
(including the form of final prospectus) or (ii) after effectiveness of the
Registration Statements, a final prospectus in accordance with Rules 430A and
424(b)(1) or (4).  In the case of clause (ii), the Seller has included in such
Registration Statements, as amended at the Effective Date (defined herein), all
information (other than Rule 430A Information (defined herein)) required by the
Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Act"), and the rules and regulations
thereunder (the "Rules and Regulations") to be included in the Registration
Statement (defined herein) with respect to the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest and the Notes and the offering of the Notes.  As filed, such amendment
and form of final prospectus, or such final prospectus, shall include all Rule
430A Information and, except to the extent the Underwriters shall agree in
writing to a modification, shall be in all substantive respects in the form
furnished to the Underwriters prior to the Execution Time (defined herein) or,
to the extent not completed at the Execution Time, shall contain only such
specific additional information and other changes (beyond that contained in the
Preliminary Prospectus which has previously been furnished to the Underwriters)
as the Seller has advised the Underwriters, prior to the Execution Time, will
be included or made therein.





                                      3
<PAGE>   4


          The terms which follow, when used in this Underwriting Agreement, 
shall have  the meanings indicated.  The term "Effective Date" shall mean 
each date that the Registration Statement and any post-effective amendment
or amendments thereto became or become effective under the Act.  "Execution
Time" shall mean the date and time that this Underwriting Agreement is executed
and delivered by the parties hereto.  "Preliminary Prospectus" shall mean any
preliminary prospectus included in the Registration Statements, or amendments
thereof, which, as completed, is proposed to be used in connection with the
sale of the Notes and any prospectus subsequently filed with the Commission by
the Seller with the consent of the Underwriters pursuant to Rule 424(a) of the
Rules and Regulations. "Prospectus" shall mean the prospectus relating to the
Notes that is first filed with the Commission pursuant to Rule 424(b) and any
prospectus subsequently filed pursuant to Rule 424 or, if no filing pursuant to
Rule 424(b) is required, shall mean the form of final prospectus included in
the Registration Statement at the Effective Date.  Reference made herein to the
Preliminary Prospectus or the Prospectus shall be deemed to refer to and
include any documents incorporated by reference therein pursuant to Item 12 of
Form S-3 under the Act, as of the date of the Preliminary Prospectus or the
Prospectus, as the case may be, and any reference to any amendment or
supplement to the Preliminary Prospectus or the Prospectus shall be deemed to
refer to and include any document filed under the Securities Exchange Act of
1934 (the "Exchange Act") after the date of the Preliminary Prospectus or the
Prospectus and incorporated by reference in the Preliminary Prospectus or the
Prospectus; and any reference to any amendment to the Registration Statement
shall be deemed to include any report of the Seller filed with the Commission
pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act after the Effective Time
that is incorporated by reference in the Registration Statement.  "Registration
Statement" shall mean both registration statements referred to in the preceding
paragraph and any registration statements required to be filed under the Act or
the Rules and Regulations, including incorporated documents, exhibits and
financial statements, in the form in which it has or shall become effective
and, in the event of any post effective amendment thereto which becomes
effective prior to the Closing Date (defined herein), shall also mean such
Registration Statement as so amended and including the Rule 430A Information
deemed to be included therein at the Effective Date as provided by Rule 430A.
"Rule 424" and "Rule 430A" refer to such rules and regulations under the Act.
"Rule 430A Information" means information with respect to the  Notes and the
offering thereof permitted to be omitted from the Registration Statement when
it becomes effective pursuant to Rule 430A.

        (c)  On the Effective Date, the Registration Statement did or will 
comply in all material respects with the applicable requirements of the Act 
and the Rules and Regulations; assuming compliance by each Underwriter with 
Section 2(a), 2(b) and 2(c)





                                      4
<PAGE>   5

hereof when the Prospectus is first filed (if required) in accordance with Rule
424(b), as of its date and on the Closing Date, the Prospectus (and any
supplements thereto) will comply in all material respects with the applicable
requirements of the Act and the Rules and Regulations; on the Effective Date,
the Registration Statement, did or will not contain any untrue statement of a
material fact or omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or
necessary to make the statements therein not misleading; and, the Prospectus as
of its date and on the date of any filing pursuant to Rule 424(b) (if required)
and on the Closing Date, the Prospectus (together with any supplement thereto)
will not, include any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a
material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the light
of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading; provided,
however, that the Seller makes no representations or warranties as to (i) the
information contained in or omitted from the Registration Statement or the
Prospectus (or any supplements thereto) in reliance upon and in conformity with
information furnished in writing to the Seller by or on behalf of the
Underwriter specifically for use in connection with the preparation of the
Registration Statement or the Prospectus (or any supplements thereto) or (ii)
any Derived Information (as defined below).

        (d)  Since the respective dates as of which information is given in the
Prospectus, or the Prospectus, as amended and supplemented at the Closing Time,
there has not been any material adverse change in the general affairs,
management, financial condition, or results of operations of any of the Credit
Line Owners or the Seller or of their subsidiaries, otherwise than as set forth
or contemplated in the Prospectus or the Prospectus as amended and supplemented
at the Closing Time.

        (e)  Each of the Credit Line Owners and the Seller has been duly 
incorporated and is validly existing as a corporation in good standing under 
the laws of its respective jurisdiction of incorporation, with the full right,
power and authority (corporate and other) to own, lease and operate its 
properties and conduct its business as described in the Prospectus and to 
enter into and perform its obligations under the Basic Documents to which each 
is a party, and with respect to the Seller, to authorize the execution, 
delivery and performance of the Indenture and the issuance of the Notes and the
Certificates, respectively, by the Issuer; each of the Credit Line Owners and
the Seller is duly qualified as a foreign corporation to transact business and
is in good standing in each jurisdiction which requires such qualification,
except where failure to be so qualified would not have a material adverse
effect on the business or financial condition of any such Credit Line Owner or
the Seller; and each Credit Line Owner is duly authorized under the statutes
which regulate the business of making loans or of financing the sale of goods
(commonly called "small loan laws," "consumer finance laws,"





                                      5
<PAGE>   6

or "sales finance laws"), or is permitted under the general interest statutes
and related laws and court decisions, to conduct in the various jurisdictions
in which any of them do business the businesses as currently conducted therein
by any of them.

        (f)  There are no legal or governmental proceedings pending to which any
Credit Line Owner or the Seller is a party or of which any property of any
Credit Line Owner or the Seller is the subject, which if determined adversely
to any Credit Line Owner or the Seller would individually or in the aggregate
have a material adverse effect on the financial position, shareholders' equity
or results of operations of such Credit Line Owner or the Seller; and to the
best knowledge of the Credit Line Owners and the Seller, no such proceedings
are threatened or contemplated by governmental authorities or threatened by
others.

        (g)  Each of the Basic Documents to which the Seller or the Credit Line
Owners are a party, when executed and delivered as contemplated thereby, will
have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by the Seller and the Credit
Line Owners as applicable, and the Basic Documents to which the Seller or the
Credit Line Owners are a party when executed and delivered as contemplated
herein will constitute, legal, valid and binding instruments enforceable
against the Seller or the Credit Line Owners, as applicable, in accordance with
their respective terms, subject as to enforceability (i) to applicable
bankruptcy, reorganization, insolvency, moratorium or other similar laws
affecting creditors' rights generally, (ii) to general principles of equity
(regardless of whether enforcement is sought in a proceeding in equity or at
law) and (iii) with respect to rights of indemnity under this Agreement, to
limitations of public policy under applicable securities laws.

        (h)  The issuance and delivery of the Securities, the consummation of 
any other of the transactions contemplated herein or in the Basic Documents, or
the fulfillment of the terms of the Basic Documents, do not and will not 
conflict with or violate any term or provision of the Certificate or Articles of
Incorporation or Bylaws of any of the Credit Line Owners or the Seller, any
statute, order or regulation applicable to any of the Credit Line Owners or the
Seller of any court, regulatory body, administrative agency or governmental
body having jurisdiction over any of the Credit Line Owners or the Seller and
do not and will not conflict with, result in a breach or violation or the
acceleration of or constitute a default under or result in the creation or
imposition of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any of the property or
assets of any of the Credit Line Owners or the Seller pursuant to the terms of,
any indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan agreement or other agreement or
instrument to which any of the Credit Line Owners or the Seller is a party or
by which any of the Credit Line Owners or the Seller may be bound or to which
any of the property or assets of any of the Credit Line Owners or the





                                      6
<PAGE>   7

Seller may be subject except for conflicts, violations, breaches, accelerations
and defaults which would not, individually or in the aggregate, be materially
adverse to any of the Credit Line Owners or the Seller or materially adverse to
the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

        (i)  Arthur Andersen LLP is an independent public accountant with 
respect to the Credit Line Owners and the Seller as required by the 1933 Act 
and the Rules and Regulations.

        (j)  The direction by the Seller to the Deposit Trustee to execute,
countersign, issue and deliver the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest has
been duly authorized by the Seller, and assuming the Deposit Trustee has been
duly authorized to do so, when executed, countersigned, issued and delivered by
the Deposit Trustee in accordance with Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest will be validly issued and outstanding and
will be entitled to the benefits provided by the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement.

        (k)  The Seller has directed the Issuer to execute, issue and deliver 
the Notes and the Issuer has directed the Indenture Trustee to authenticate the
Notes and assuming such direction has been duly authorized by the Issuer, and
assuming the Indenture Trustee has been duly authorized to do so, when
executed, countersigned, issued and delivered in accordance with the Indenture,
the Notes will be validly issued and outstanding and will be entitled to the
benefits provided by the Indenture.

        (l)  No consent, approval, authorization, order, registration or
qualification of or with any court or governmental agency or body of the United
States is required for the issue and sale of the Notes to the Underwriter, or
the consummation by any of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller or the Issuer of
the other transactions contemplated by the Basic Documents, except the
registration under the 1933 Act of the Notes and such consents, approvals,
authorizations, registrations or qualifications as may be required under State
securities or Blue Sky laws in connection with the purchase and distribution of
the Notes by the Underwriter or as have been obtained.

        (m)  Each of the Credit Line Owners and the Seller possesses all 
material licenses, certificates, authorities or permits issued by the 
appropriate state, federal or foreign regulatory agencies or bodies necessary 
to conduct the business now conducted by it and as described in the Prospectus 
and none of the Credit Line Owners or the Seller has received notice of 
proceedings relating to the revocation or modification of any such license, 
certificate, authority or permit which, singly or in the aggregate, if the 
subject of an unfavorable decision, ruling or finding, would materially and 
adversely affect the conduct of its business, operations or financial condition.





                                      7
<PAGE>   8


        (n)  As of the date any Receivables are transferred to the Deposit 
Trustee, (i) each Credit Line Owner will have good and marketable title to the
Receivables being transferred by it to the Seller free and clear of any lien,
mortgage, pledge, charge, encumbrance, adverse claim or other security interest
(collectively "Liens"), (ii) each Credit Line Owner will not have assigned to
any person any of its right, title or interest in such Receivables or in the
Receivables Purchase Agreement and (iii) each Credit Line Owner will have the
power and authority to sell such Receivables to the Seller; and upon the
consummation of the sale and the assignment provided for pursuant to the terms
of the Receivables Purchase Agreement, the Seller will have acquired all the
related Credit Line Owners' right, title and interest in and to the
Receivables.

        (o)  As of the date any Receivables are transferred to the Deposit 
Trustee, the Seller (i) will have good and marketable title to the Receivables
being transferred by it to the Deposit Trustee pursuant to the Pooling and 
Servicing Agreement, free and clear of Liens, (ii) will not have assigned to 
any person any of its right, title or interest in such Receivables or in the 
Receivables Purchase Agreement, and (iii) will have the power and authority to
sell such Receivables to the Deposit Trustee and assuming due execution and 
delivery of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and any Assignment of 
Receivables in Credit Lines by the Deposit Trustee, the Deposit Trustee will 
have acquired all of the Seller's right, title and interest in and to the 
Receivables.  As of the Closing Date, the Seller, (i) will not have assigned to
any person other than the Issuer any of its right, title or interest in the 
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest being issued pursuant to the Pooling and 
Servicing Agreement, and (ii) will have the power and authority to convey the 
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest to the Issuer pursuant to the Trust 
Agreement.

        (p)  At the Closing Time, the Seller will: (i) have good and marketable
title to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest, free and clear of any Lien;
and (ii) have the power and authority to sell the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest to the Issuer and to authorize the Issuer to issue the Securities.
Upon execution and delivery of the Trust Agreement by the Seller and the
conveyance of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest from the Seller to the
Issuer, the Issuer will have acquired ownership of all of the Seller's right,
title and interest in and to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest.

        (q)  As of the Closing Time, each of the Initial Receivables will meet 
the eligibility criteria described in the Prospectus and Pooling and Servicing
Agreement.

        (r)  None of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller, the Deposit Trust or 
the Issuer will conduct their operations while any of the Securities are
outstanding in a manner that would require any





                                      8
<PAGE>   9

Credit Line Owner, the Seller, the Deposit Trust or the Issuer to be registered
as an "investment company" under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended
(the "1940 Act") as in effect on the date hereof.

        (s)  At the Closing Time, the Securities and the Basic Documents that 
are described in the Prospectus will conform in all material respects to the
descriptions thereof.

        (t)  At the Closing Time, the Class A Notes shall have been rated "Aaa"
and "AAA" and the Class B Notes shall have been rated "Baa" and "BBB" by Moody's
and Standard & Poor's, respectively.

        (u)  Any taxes, fees and other governmental charges in connection with 
the execution, delivery and issuance of the Basic Documents and the Securities
have been paid or will be paid at or prior to the Closing Time.

        (v)  At the Closing Time, each of the representations and warranties of
the Seller and the Credit Line Owners set forth in this Agreement will be true 
and correct in all material respects.

        Any certificate signed by an officer of any Credit Line Owner or the 
Seller and delivered to the Underwriter or counsel for the Underwriter in 
connection with an offering of the Securities shall be deemed, and shall state 
that it is, a representation and warranty as to the matters covered thereby to 
each person to whom the representations and warranties in this Section 1 are 
made.

        SECTION 2.    Representations and Warranties of the Underwriters.  Each
Underwriter severally, and not jointly, represents and warrants to, and agrees
with the other Underwriters, the Credit Line Owners, the Seller, the Servicer
and HFC that:

        (a)  Prior to the Effective Date of the Registration Statement, such
Underwriter has not and will not furnish, in writing or by electronic
transmission, Derived Information relating to the Notes to any prospective
investor.

        (b)  Such Underwriter shall provide the Seller no later than two 
Business Days after which the Prospectus is required to be filed pursuant to 
Rule 424, nine copies of any Derived Information delivered to a prospective 
investor by it during the period commencing on the effective date of the 
Registration Statement and ending on the date the Prospectus is filed with the
Commission.

        (c)  Assuming the accuracy of the Seller-Provided Information used in 
the preparation of Derived Information, the Derived Information, delivered by 
such Underwriter, as of the date thereof, is accurate in all material respects,
taking into account the assumptions set forth in such Derived Information, but
without





                                      9
<PAGE>   10

making any representations as to the appropriateness of such assumptions.

        (d)  Each Underwriter acknowledges that the Credit Line Owners, the 
Seller or HFC will not be deemed to have breached any representation and 
warranty or to have failed to satisfy any other agreement contained herein as 
a result of an Underwriter's breach of a representation and warranty set forth 
in clause (a), (b) or (c) above; provided, however, that the rights and 
obligations otherwise available pursuant to Sections 9 and 10 hereof are not 
limited solely as a result of an Underwriter's breach of a representation and 
warranty set forth in clause (a), (b), or (c) above.

        SECTION 3.    Purchase and Sale.  The commitment of the Underwriters to
purchase and of the Seller to sell the Notes pursuant to this Agreement shall
be deemed to have been made on the basis of the respective representations and
warranties of each of the parties herein contained and shall be subject to the
terms and conditions herein set forth.  The Seller agrees to instruct the
Issuer to issue and agrees to sell to the Underwriters, and the Underwriters
agree, severally and not jointly (except as provided in Section 12 hereof), to
purchase from the Seller, at a purchase price for each Class of the Notes set
forth on Schedule A hereto, the respective principal amount of each Class of
the Notes set forth opposite the name of such Underwriter on Schedule A hereto.

        SECTION 4.    Delivery and Payment.  Payment of the purchase price for,
and delivery of, any Notes to be purchased by the Underwriter shall be made at
the office of Katten Muchin & Zavis, of Chicago, Illinois or at such other
place as shall be agreed upon by the Underwriters, the Seller and HFC at 10:00
A.M. eastern time on August [28], 1996 or at such other time or date as shall
be agreed upon in writing by the Underwriters, the Seller and HFC (the "Closing
Time").  The Notes will be delivered in book-entry form through the facilities
of the Depository Trust Company, Cedel Bank Societe Anonyme and the Euroclear
System.  Payment shall be made to the Seller by wire transfer of same day funds
payable to the account of the Seller.  Delivery of the Notes shall be made to
the Underwriters for the respective accounts of the Underwriters against
payment of the purchase price thereof.  Such Notes shall be in such
denominations and registered in such names as the Underwriters may request in
writing at least one business day prior to the applicable Closing Time.  Such
Notes, which may be in temporary form, will be made available for examination
and packaging by the Underwriters no later than 3:00 p.m. central time on the
first business day prior to the Closing Time.

        SECTION 5.    Offering by the Underwriters.  It is understood that the
Underwriters propose to offer the Notes for sale to the public as set forth in
the Prospectus.





                                     10
<PAGE>   11

        SECTION  6.   Covenants of the Seller and HFC.  The Seller and HFC
covenant with each of the Underwriters as follows:

        (a)  If at any time when the Prospectus as amended or supplemented is
required by the 1933 Act to be delivered in connection with sales of the Notes
by the Underwriters, any event shall occur or condition exist as a result of
which it is necessary, in the opinion of counsel to the Underwriters or counsel
for the Seller, to further amend or supplement the Prospectus as then amended
or supplemented in order that the Prospectus as amended or supplemented will
not include an untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state any
material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of
circumstances under which they were made, not misleading or if it shall be
necessary, in the opinion of any such counsel, at any such time to amend or
supplement the Registration Statement or the Prospectus as then amended or
supplemented in order to comply with the requirements of the 1933 Act or the
Rules and Regulations thereunder, or if required by such Rules and Regulations,
including Rule 430A thereunder, to file a post-effective amendment to such
Registration Statement (including an amended Prospectus), the Seller will
promptly prepare and file with the Commission such amendment or supplement as
may be necessary to correct such untrue statement or omission or to make the
Registration Statement comply with such requirements, and within two business
days will furnish to the Underwriters as many copies of the Prospectus, as
amended or supplemented, as the Underwriters shall reasonably request.

        (b)  The Seller will give the Underwriters reasonable notice of its
intention to file any amendment to the Registration Statement, the Prospectus
or the Prospectus as amended or supplemented, pursuant to the 1933 Act, will
furnish the Underwriters with copies of any such amendment or supplement
proposed to be filed a reasonable time in advance of filing, and will not file
any such amendment or supplement to which the Underwriters or counsel to the
Underwriters shall object.

        (c)  The Seller will notify the Underwriters immediately, and confirm 
the notice in writing, (i) of the effectiveness of any amendment to the
Registration Statement, (ii) of the mailing or the delivery to the Commission
for filing of any supplement to the Prospectus or the Prospectus as amended or
supplemented, (iii) of the receipt of any comments from the Commission with
respect to the Registration Statement or the Prospectus or the Prospectus as
amended or supplemented, (iv) of any request by the Commission for any
amendment to the Registration Statement or any amendment or supplement to the
Prospectus or for additional information and (v) of the issuance by the
Commission of any stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration
Statement or the initiation of any proceedings for that purpose.  The Seller
will make every reasonable effort to prevent the issuance of any stop order
and, if





                                     11
<PAGE>   12

any stop order is issued, to obtain the lifting thereof at the earliest
possible moment.

        (d)  The Seller will deliver to the Underwriters as many signed and as
many conformed copies of the Registration Statement (as originally filed) and of
each amendment thereto (including exhibits filed therewith or incorporated by
reference therein and documents incorporated by reference in the Prospectus) as
you may reasonably request.

        (e)  The Seller will make generally available to holders of the Notes as
soon as practicable, but in any event not later than 120 days after the close
of the period covered thereby, an earning statement of the Issuer (which need
not be audited) complying with Section 11(a) of the 1933 Act and the Rules and
Regulations (including, at the option of the Seller, Rule 158) and covering a
period of at least twelve consecutive months beginning not later than the first
day of the first fiscal quarter following the Closing Time.

        (f)  The Seller will endeavor, in cooperation with you, to qualify the
Notes for offering and sale under the applicable securities laws of such states
and other jurisdictions of the United States as you may designate, and will
maintain or cause to be maintained such qualifications in effect for as long as
may be required for the distribution of the Notes.  The Seller will file or
cause the filing of such statements and reports as may be required by the laws
of each jurisdiction in which the Notes have been qualified as above provided.

        (g)  Neither the Seller nor HFC will, without your prior written 
consent, publicly offer or sell or contract to sell any asset-backed securities
or participation interests or other similar securities representing interests in
or secured by other consumer loan-related assets originated or owned by the
Seller or HFC for a period of 5 days following the commencement of the offering
of the Notes to the public.

        (h)  So long as the Notes shall be outstanding, the Seller will cause 
the Issuer to deliver to the Underwriters the annual statement as to compliance
delivered to the Indenture Trustee pursuant to Section 3.10 of Indenture and
each monthly report delivered pursuant to Section 3.23 of the Indenture.  So
long as the Notes are outstanding, the Servicer will deliver to the 
Underwriters the annual statement of a firm of independent public accountants
furnished to the Deposit Trustee pursuant to Section 3.06 of the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement and the monthly servicing report delivered pursuant to
Article V of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

        (i)  The Seller will apply the net proceeds from the sale of the Notes
in the manner set forth in the Prospectus.





                                     12
<PAGE>   13


        (j)  If, between the date hereof and the Closing Time, to the 
knowledge of HFC or the Seller there are any legal or governmental proceedings 
instituted or threatened against HFC or the Seller which, if determined 
adversely to HFC or the Seller would individually or in the aggregate have a 
material adverse effect on the financial condition, shareholders' equity or 
results of operations of HFC or the Seller, and HFC and the Seller, as 
applicable, will give prompt written notice thereof to the Underwriters.

        SECTION  7.   Conditions to Underwriters' Obligations.  The respective
obligations of the Underwriters to purchase and of the Seller to sell the Notes
pursuant to this Agreement are subject to the accuracy on and as of the Closing
Time of the representations and warranties on the part of the Credit Line
Owners and the Seller on the one hand and the Underwriters on the other, each
as herein contained, and to the material accuracy of the statements of officers
of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller and HFC, respectively, made pursuant
hereto, to the performance by the Credit Line Owners, the Seller and HFC of all
of their respective obligations hereunder and to the following conditions at
the Closing Time:

        (a)  If the Registration Statement has not become effective prior to the
date of this Underwriting Agreement, unless the Underwriter agrees in writing
to a later time, the Registration Statement shall have become effective not
later than (i) 6:00 p.m. New York City time on the date of determination of the
public offering price, if such determination occurred at or prior to 10:00 a.m.
New York City time on such date, or (ii) 3:00 p.m. on the business day
following the day on which the public offering price was determined, if such
determination occurred after 10:00 a.m. New York City time on such date; if
filing of the Prospectus, or any supplement thereto, is required pursuant to
Rule 424(b), the Prospectus shall be filed in the manner and within the time
period required by Rule 424(b); and no stop order suspending the effectiveness
of the Registration Statement shall have been issued and no proceedings for
that purpose shall have been instituted or threatened.

        (b)  There shall not have come to the Underwriters' attention any facts
that would cause the Underwriters to believe that the Prospectus, at the time 
it was required to be delivered to a purchaser of the Notes, contained an untrue
statement of a material fact or omitted to state a material fact necessary in
order to make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under
which they were made, not misleading.

        (c)  The Underwriters shall have received the favorable opinion, dated 
the date of the Closing Time, of John W. Blenke, Esq., Vice President--Corporate
Law of Household International,





                                     13
<PAGE>   14

Inc., the parent company of HFC, in the form attached hereto as Exhibit A.

        (d)  The Underwriters shall have received the favorable opinion, dated 
the date of the Closing Time, of John W. Blenke, Esq., Vice President--Corporate
Law of Household International, Inc., the parent company of HFC, in form and
substance satisfactory to the Underwriters, to the effect that:

                 (i)   HFC has been duly incorporated and is validly existing
        as a corporation in good standing under the laws of the State of
        Delaware, with corporate power to own its properties, to conduct
        its business as described in the Prospectus and to enter into and
        perform its obligations under the Basic Documents to which it is a
        party.
        
                (ii)  The Seller has been duly incorporated and is validly
        existing as a corporation in good standing under the laws of the State
        of Delaware, with corporate power to own its properties, to conduct
        its business as described in the Prospectus and to enter into and
        perform its obligations under the Basic Documents to which it is a
        party.
        
               (iii)  Each of the Credit Line Owners has been duly
        incorporated and is validly existing as a corporation in good standing
        under the laws of its jurisdiction of incorporation, with corporate
        power to own its properties, to conduct its business as described in
        the Prospectus and to enter into and perform its obligations under the
        Basic Documents to which it is a party.
        
                (iv)  HFC has full corporate power and authority to serve
        in the capacity of servicer of the Receivables as contemplated in the
        Pooling and Servicing Agreement.
        
                 (v)  Each of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller and HFC
        is duly authorized under related statutes, laws and court decisions,
        to conduct in the various jurisdictions in which they do business the
        respective businesses therein currently conducted by them, except
        where failure to be so permitted or failure to be so authorized will
        not have a material adverse effect on the business or financial
        condition of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller or HFC, and the Credit
        Line Owners are duly authorized under the statutes which regulate the
        business of making loans or of financing the sale of goods (commonly
        called "small loan laws," "consumer finance laws," or "sales finance
        laws"), or are permitted under the general interest statutes and
        related laws and court decisions, to conduct in the various
        jurisdictions in which any of them do business the businesses as
        currently conducted therein by any of them.
        



                                     14
<PAGE>   15

                     (vi)  None of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller or HFC is
         in violation of its Certificate or Articles of Incorporation or Bylaws
         or, to the best of such counsel's knowledge, in default in the
         performance or observance of any material obligation, agreement,
         covenant or condition contained in any contract, indenture, mortgage,
         loan agreement, note, lease or other instrument known to such counsel
         to which any of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller or HFC is a party
         or by which it or its properties may be bound, which default might
         result in any material adverse changes in the financial condition,
         earnings, affairs or business of any of the Credit Line Owners, the
         Seller or HFC or which might materially and adversely affect the
         properties or assets, taken as a whole, of any of the Credit Line
         Owners, the Seller or of HFC.

                    (vii)  Each of the Basic Documents to which HFC, the Seller
         and the Credit Line Owners are a party has been duly authorized,
         executed and delivered by HFC, the Seller and the Credit Line Owners
         as applicable, and, assuming the due authorization, execution and
         delivery of such agreements by the other parties thereto, such
         agreements constitute the valid and binding obligation of each of the
         Seller, HFC and the Credit Line Owners, enforceable against each of
         the Seller, HFC and the Credit Line Owners, in accordance with its
         terms, except that in each case as to enforceability (A) such
         enforcement may be subject to bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization,
         moratorium or other similar laws now or hereafter in effect relating
         to creditors' rights generally, (B) the remedy of specific performance
         and injunctive and other forms of equitable relief may be subject to
         equitable defenses and to the discretion of the court before which any
         proceeding therefor may be brought and (C) the enforceability as to
         rights to indemnification under this Agreement (to the extent
         indemnification under such Agreements relates to liability under the
         1933 Act) may be subject to limitations of public policy under
         applicable securities laws.

                   (viii)  The issuance and delivery of the Securities and the
         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest, the consummation of any other of
         the transactions contemplated herein or in the Basic Documents, or the
         fulfillment of the terms of such agreements do not and will not
         conflict with or violate any term or provision of the Certificate or
         Articles of Incorporation or Bylaws of the Seller or, to the best of
         such counsel's knowledge, any statute, order or regulation applicable
         to the Seller of any court, regulatory body, administrative agency or
         governmental body having jurisdiction over the Seller and do not and
         will not conflict with, result in a breach or violation or the
         acceleration of or constitute a default under or result in the
         creation or imposition of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any of
         the property or assets of the Seller





                                     15
<PAGE>   16

         pursuant to the terms of any indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan
         agreement or other agreement or instrument known to such counsel to
         which the Seller is a party or by which the Seller may be bound or to
         which any of the property or assets of the Seller may be subject
         except for conflicts, violations, breaches, accelerations and defaults
         which would not, individually or in the aggregate, be materially
         adverse to the Seller or materially adverse to the transactions
         contemplated by this Agreement.

                     (ix)  The consummation of any of the transactions
         contemplated by the Basic Documents to which the Credit Line Owners
         are a party and the fulfillment of the terms of such documents, do not
         and will not conflict with or violate any terms or provision of the
         Certificate or Articles of Incorporation or Bylaws of any of the
         Credit Line Owners or, to the best of such counsel's knowledge, any
         statute, order or regulation applicable to any of the Credit Line
         Owners or, to the best of such counsel's knowledge, any statute, order
         or regulation applicable to any of the Credit Line Owners and do not
         and will not conflict with, result in a breach or violation or the
         acceleration of or constitute a default under or result in the
         creation or imposition of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any of
         the property or assets of any of the Credit Line Owners pursuant to
         the terms of, any indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan agreement
         or other agreement or instrument known to such counsel to which any of
         the Credit Line Owners may be bound or to which any of the property or
         assets of any of the Credit Line Owners may be subject except for
         conflicts, violations, breaches, accelerations and defaults which
         would not, individually or in the aggregate, be materially adverse to
         the applicable Credit Line Owners or materially adverse to the
         transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

                      (x)  The consummation of any of the transactions
         contemplated herein or the fulfillment of the terms of the Basic
         Documents do not and will not conflict with or violate any term or
         provision of the Certificate or Articles of Incorporation or By-laws
         of HFC or, to the best of such counsel's knowledge, any statute, order
         or regulation applicable to HFC and do not and will not conflict with,
         result in a breach or violation or the acceleration of or constitute a
         default under or result in the creation or imposition of any lien,
         charge or encumbrance upon any of the property or assets of HFC
         pursuant to the terms of, any indenture, mortgage, deed of trust, loan
         agreement or other agreement or instrument known to such counsel to
         which HFC is a party or by which HFC may be bound or to which any of
         the property or assets of HFC may be subject except for conflicts,
         violations, breaches, accelerations and defaults which would not,
         individually or in the aggregate, be materially adverse





                                     16
<PAGE>   17

         to HFC or materially adverse to the transactions contemplated by this
         Agreement.

                     (xi)  The direction by the Seller to the Deposit Trustee
         to execute, issue, countersign and deliver the Series 1996-2
         Participation Interest has been duly authorized by the Seller and,
         assuming that the Deposit Trustee has been duly authorized to do so
         and when executed and countersigned and delivered by the Deposit
         Trustee in accordance with the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the
         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest will be validly issued and
         outstanding and will be entitled to the benefits of the Pooling and
         Servicing Agreement.

                    (xii)  The direction by the Seller to the Owner Trustee to
         execute, issue, countersign and deliver the Certificates on behalf of
         the Issuer has been duly authorized by the Seller and, assuming that
         the Owner Trustee has been duly authorized to do so and when executed
         and countersigned and delivered by the Owner Trustee in accordance
         with the Trust Agreement, the Certificates will be validly issued and
         outstanding and will be entitled to the benefits of the Trust
         Agreement.

                   (xiii)  To the best of such counsel's knowledge, no consent,
         approval, authorization, order, registration or qualification of or
         with any court or governmental agency or body of the United States is
         required for the issuance of the Securities and the sale of the
         Securities to the Underwriters, or the consummation by the Credit Line
         Owners, the Seller and HFC of the other transactions contemplated by
         the Basic Documents, except the registration under the 1933 Act of the
         Securities and such consents, approvals, authorizations, registrations
         or qualifications as may be required under State securities or Blue
         Sky laws in connection with the purchase and distribution of the
         Securities by the Underwriters or as have been obtained.

                    (xiv)  The Registration Statement is effective under the
         1933 Act and to the best of such counsel's knowledge and information,
         no stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration
         Statement has been issued under the 1933 Act or proceedings therefor
         initiated or threatened by the Commission.

                     (xv)  The conditions to the use by the Seller of a
         registration statement on Form S-3 and Form S-1 under the 1933 Act, as
         set forth in the General Instructions to Form S-3 and S-1, have been
         satisfied with respect to the Registration Statement and the
         Prospectus.  To the best of such counsel's knowledge, there are no
         contracts or documents of the Seller which are required to be filed as
         exhibits to the Registration Statement pursuant to the 1933 Act or the
         Rules and





                                     17
<PAGE>   18

         Regulations thereunder which have not been so filed.  The statements
         in the Prospectus under the caption "Risk Factors--Legal
         Considerations" and under the caption "Certain Legal Aspects of the
         Receivables", to the extent that statements in such sections
         constitute matters of law or legal conclusions with respect thereto,
         have been reviewed by attorneys under such counsel's supervision and
         are complete and correct in all material respects.

                    (xvi)  There are no actions, proceedings or investigations
         pending before or, to the best knowledge of such counsel, threatened
         by any court, administrative agency or other tribunal to which any of
         the Credit Line Owners, HFC or the Seller is a party or of which any
         of their respective properties is the subject (A) which if determined
         adversely to any of the Credit Line Owners, HFC or the Seller would
         have a material adverse effect on the business or financial condition
         of any of the Credit Line Owners, HFC or the Seller, (B) asserting the
         invalidity of any of the Basic Documents, or the Securities, (C)
         seeking to prevent the issuance of the Securities or the consummation
         by any of the Credit Line Owners, HFC or the Seller of any of the
         transactions contemplated by any of the Basic Documents, as the case
         may be, or (D) which might materially and adversely affect the
         performance by any of the Credit Line Owners, HFC or the Seller of
         their respective obligations under, or the validity or enforceability
         of any of the Basic Documents or the Securities.

                   (xvii)  The Registration Statement at the time it became
         effective, and any amendment thereto at the time such amendment
         becomes effective, complied as to form in all material respects with
         the applicable requirements of the 1933 Act and the Rules and
         Regulations thereunder.

                  (xviii)  Such counsel has no reason to believe that (A) the
         Registration Statement and the Prospectus, as of the date the
         Registration Statement became effective, or the Registration Statement
         (excluding the exhibits thereto) as of the date that the most recent
         post-effective amendment thereto became effective, contained or
         contains any untrue statement of a material fact or omitted or omits
         to state any material fact required to be stated therein or necessary
         in order to make the statements therein not misleading or (B) assuming
         compliance by each of the Underwriters with Section 2(a) and (b)
         hereof, the Prospectus, as of its date and the date of such opinion,
         contained or contains any untrue statement of a material fact or
         omitted or omits to state any material fact necessary in order to make
         the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which
         they were made, not misleading (it being understood that such counsel
         need express no opinion as to information set forth in the financial





                                     18
<PAGE>   19

         statements or other financial and statistical data contained or
         incorporated by reference in the Registration Statement).

         Such opinion may express its reliance as to factual matters on the
representations and warranties made by the parties hereto, and on certificates
or other documents furnished by officers of such parties to the instruments and
documents referred to therein.  Such opinion may be qualified, insofar as it
concerns the enforceability of the documents referred to therein, to the extent
that such enforceability may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency,
reorganization or other similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors'
rights in general, or by general principles of equity (regardless of whether
such enforcement is considered in a proceeding in equity or at law) and no
opinion need be given as to the enforceability of Section 9 of this Agreement.

         (e)     The Underwriters shall have received the favorable opinion of
counsel to the Indenture Trustee, dated the date of the Closing Time, addressed
to the Underwriters and in form and scope satisfactory to counsel to the
Underwriters, to the effect that:

                      (i)  The Indenture Trustee has duly authorized, executed
         and delivered the Indenture which constitute the valid and legally
         binding agreements of the Indenture Trustee, are enforceable against
         the Trustee in accordance with its terms, subject, as to enforcement
         of remedies, (A) to applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization,
         and other similar laws affecting the rights of creditors generally and
         (B) to general principles of equity (regardless of whether such
         enforceability is considered in a proceeding in equity or at law).

                     (ii)  The Indenture Trustee has duly countersigned the 
         Notes issued on the date hereof on behalf of the Issuer.

                    (iii)  The execution and delivery by the Indenture Trustee
         of the Indenture and the performance by the Indenture Trustee of its
         obligations thereunder do not conflict with or result in a violation
         of the organizational charter or Bylaws of the Indenture Trustee.

                     (iv)  The Indenture Trustee has full power and authority
         to execute and deliver the Indenture and to perform its obligations
         thereunder.

                      (v)  To the best of such counsel's knowledge, there are
         no actions, proceedings or investigations pending or threatened
         against or affecting the Trustee before or by any court, arbitrator,
         administrative agency or other governmental authority which, if
         adversely decided, would materially and adversely affect the ability
         of the Indenture Trustee to carry out the transactions contemplated in
         the Indenture.





                                     19
<PAGE>   20


                     (vi)  No consent, approval or authorization of, or
         registration, declaration or filing with, any court or governmental
         agency or body of the United States of America or any state thereof is
         required for the execution, delivery or performance by the Indenture
         Trustee of the Indenture.

         (f)     The Underwriters shall have received the favorable opinion of
counsel to the Owner Trustee, dated the Closing Date, addressed to the
Underwriters, satisfactory to counsel to the Underwriters, to the effect that:

                        (i)       The Owner Trustee is duly incorporated and
                 validly existing as a banking corporation under the laws of
                 the State of Delaware and has the power and authority to
                 execute and deliver the Basic Documents to which it is a
                 party;

                       (ii)       The Basic Documents to which it is a party
                 have been duly authorized, executed and delivered to the Owner
                 Trustee and constitutes the legal, valid and binding
                 agreements of the Owner Trustee, enforceable against the Owner
                 Trustee in accordance with its respective terms;

                      (iii)       The Securities have been duly authorized,
                 executed and delivered by Owner Trustee on behalf of the 
                 Issuer;

                       (iv)       No consent, approval or other authorization
                 of, or registration, declaration or filing with, any court or
                 governmental agency or commission of the State of Delaware is
                 required by or with respect to the Owner Trustee or the Issuer
                 for the issuance and sale of the Securities or the valid
                 execution and delivery of the Trust Agreement, or for the
                 validity and enforceability thereof, or for the payment of any
                 amounts by the Trust thereunder;

                        (v)       Neither the execution and delivery by the
                 Owner Trustee of the Basic Documents to which it is a party,
                 nor the issuance, execution and delivery by the Issuer of the
                 Securities, nor the consummation of the transactions
                 contemplated thereby, nor compliance with the terms thereof,
                 (i) conflicts with or results in a breach of, or constitutes a
                 default under, the provisions of the Trust Agreement or the
                 certificate of incorporation of the Owner Trustee or any law,
                 rule or regulation of the State of Delaware applicable to the
                 Owner Trustee or, to such counsel's knowledge, any judgment or
                 order applicable to the Owner Trustee or their respective
                 properties or, to such counsel's knowledge, any indenture,
                 mortgage, contract or other agreement or instrument to which
                 the Owner Trustee is a party or by which it is bound or (ii)





                                     20
<PAGE>   21

                 to such counsel's knowledge, results in the creation or
                 imposition or any lien, charge or encumbrance upon the Owner
                 Trustee's properties or the Owner Trust Estate (except as
                 permitted by the Trust Agreement);

                       (vi)       To such counsel's knowledge, there are no
                 pending or threatened actions, suits or proceedings affecting
                 the Issuer or the Owner Trustee before any court or other
                 governmental authority which, if adversely decided, would
                 materially and adversely affect the ability of the Issuer or
                 the Owner Trustee, as the case may be, to carry out the
                 transactions contemplated in the Trust Agreement;

                      (vii)       The Trust has been duly formed and is validly
                 existing as a business trust under the Delaware Business Trust
                 Act 12 Del. C. Section  3801 et seq.

         (g)     The Underwriters shall have received the favorable opinion of
counsel to the Deposit Trustee, dated the Closing Date, addressed to the
Underwriters, satisfactory to counsel to the Underwriters, to the effect that:

                        (i)       The Deposit Trustee is duly incorporated and
                 validly existing as a banking corporation under the laws of
                 the United States and has the power and authority to execute
                 and deliver the Pooling and Servicing Agreement;

                       (ii)       The Pooling and Servicing Agreement has been
                 duly authorized, executed and delivered to the Deposit Trustee
                 and constitutes the legal, valid and binding agreements of the
                 Deposit Trustee, enforceable against the Deposit Trustee in
                 accordance with its respective terms;

                      (iii)       The Series 1996-2 Participation Interests
                 have been duly authorized, executed and delivered by the
                 Deposit Trust, and, when authenticated in accordance with the
                 provisions of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, and when
                 delivered to and paid for by the Seller, will be entitled to
                 the benefits and security afforded by the Pooling and
                 Servicing Agreement, and will constitute legal, valid and
                 binding obligations of the Deposit Trust, enforceable against
                 the Deposit Trust in accordance with the terms of the Pooling
                 and Servicing Agreement;

                       (iv)       No consent, approval or other authorization
                 of, or registration, declaration or filing with, any court or
                 governmental agency or commission is required by or with
                 respect to the Deposit Trustee or the Deposit Trust for the
                 issuance and sale of the Series 1996-2 Participation





                                     21
<PAGE>   22

                 Interest or the valid execution and delivery of the Pooling
                 and Servicing Agreement, or for the validity and       
                 enforceability thereof, or for the payment of any amounts by
                 the Deposit Trust thereunder;

                        (v)       Neither the execution and delivery by the
                 Deposit Trustee of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, nor
                 the issuance, execution and delivery by the Deposit Trustee of
                 the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest, nor the consummation
                 of the transactions contemplated thereby, nor compliance with
                 the terms thereof, (i) conflicts with or results in a breach
                 of, or constitutes a default under, the provisions of the
                 Pooling and Servicing Agreement or the certificate of
                 incorporation of the Deposit Trustee or any law, rule or
                 regulation of the United States applicable to the Deposit
                 Trustee or, to such counsel's knowledge, any judgment or order
                 applicable to the Deposit Trustee or their respective
                 properties or, to such counsel's knowledge, any indenture,
                 mortgage, contract or other agreement or instrument to which
                 the Deposit Trustee is a party or by which it is bound or (ii)
                 to such counsel's knowledge, results in the creation or
                 imposition or any lien, charge or encumbrance upon the Deposit
                 Trustee's properties or the Deposit Trust's properties (except
                 as permitted by the Pooling and Servicing Agreement); and

                       (vi)       To such counsel's knowledge, there are no
                 pending or threatened actions, suits or proceedings affecting
                 the Deposit Trust or the Deposit Trustee before any court or
                 other governmental authority which, if adversely decided,
                 would materially and adversely affect the ability of the
                 Deposit Trust or the Deposit Trustee, as the case may be, to
                 carry out the transactions contemplated in the Basic
                 Documents.

         (h)     The Underwriters shall have received the favorable opinion or
opinions, dated the date of the Closing Time, of Brown & Wood LLP, as counsel
for the Underwriters, with respect to the issue and sale of the Notes, the
Registration Statement, this Agreement, the Prospectus and such other related
matters as the Underwriters may require.

         (i)     The Underwriters shall have received opinions, dated the date
of the Closing Time, of Katten Muchin & Zavis, as special counsel to the Seller
and HFC, addressed to the Indenture Trustee, the Seller and the Underwriter
relating to certain matters specified in Section 2.03 (iii) of the Indenture.

         (j)     The Underwriters shall have received an opinion, dated the
date of the Closing Time, of Katten Muchin & Zavis as special counsel to the
Seller and HFC addressed to the Seller and





                                     22
<PAGE>   23

satisfactory to the Rating Agencies relating to (i) the sale of the Receivables
to the Seller, (ii) the transfer of the Receivables to the Deposit Trustee and
(iii) the transfer of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest from the Seller
to the Issuer and such counsel shall have consented to reliance by the Rating
Agencies and the Underwriter on such opinion as though such opinion had been
addressed to each such party.

         (k)     Each of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller and HFC shall have
furnished to the Underwriters a certificate signed on behalf of the Credit Line
Owners, the Seller and HFC by the respective principal accounting or principal
financial officer thereof, dated the date of the Closing Time, as to (i) the
accuracy of the representations and warranties (except for the representations
made in Section 1(f) herein) of the Credit Line Owners and the Seller herein at
and as of the Closing Time, (ii) there being no legal or governmental
proceedings pending, other than those, if any, referred to in the Prospectus to
which any of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller or HFC is a party or of which
any property of any of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller or HFC is the
subject, which, in the judgment of any of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller or
HFC, as applicable, have a reasonable likelihood of resulting in a material
adverse change in the financial condition, shareholders' equity or results of
operations of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller or HFC; and to the best
knowledge of each of the Credit Line Owners, the Seller or HFC, as applicable,
no such proceedings are threatened or contemplated by governmental authorities
or threatened by others, (iii) the performance by the Credit Line Owners, the
Seller and HFC of all of their respective obligations hereunder to be performed
at or prior to the Closing Time, and (iv) such other matters as the
Underwriters may reasonably request.

         (l)     The Indenture Trustee shall have furnished to the Underwriters
a certificate of the Indenture Trustee, signed by one or more duly authorized
officers of the Indenture Trustee, dated the Closing Date, as to the due
authorization, execution and delivery of the Indenture by the Indenture Trustee
and the acceptance by the Indenture Trustee of the trusts created by the
Indenture and the due execution and delivery of the Notes by the Indenture
Trustee thereunder and such other matters as the Underwriters shall reasonably
request.

         (m)     The Owner Trustee shall have furnished to the Underwriters a
certificate of the Owner Trustee, signed by one or more duly authorized
officers of the Owner Trustee, dated the Closing Date, as to the due
authorization, execution and delivery of the Trust Agreement by the Owner
Trustee and the acceptance by the Owner Trustee of the trusts created by the
Trust Agreement and the due execution and delivery of the Notes by the Issuer
under the Indenture and such other matters as the Underwriter shall reasonably
request.





                                     23
<PAGE>   24

         (n)     The Deposit Trustee shall have furnished to the Underwriters a
certificate of the Deposit Trustee, signed by one or more duly authorized
officers of the Deposit Trustee, dated the Closing Time, as to the due
authorization, execution and delivery of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement by
the Deposit Trustee and the acceptance by the Deposit Trustee of the trusts
created by the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the due execution and
delivery of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest by the Deposit Trustee
thereunder and such other matters as the Underwriters shall reasonably request.

         (o)     The Class A-1 Notes, the Class A-2 Notes, the Class A-3 Notes
and the Class B Notes shall have been rated at least "AAA", "AA- ", "A" and
"BBB", respectively, by at least two nationally recognized rating
organizations, Standard & Poor's and Moody's, respectively.

         (p)     Counsel and special counsel to HFC and the Seller shall have
furnished to the Underwriters any opinions supplied to the Rating Agencies
relating to certain matters with respect to the Notes.

         (q)     The Underwriters shall have received from Arthur Andersen LLP,
or other independent certified public accountants acceptable to the
Underwriters, a letter, dated as of the date of this Agreement in the form
heretofore agreed to.

         (r)     Prior to the Closing Time, Brown & Wood LLP, as counsel for
the Underwriters, shall have been furnished with such documents and opinions as
they may reasonably require for the purpose of enabling them to pass upon the
issuance and sale of the Notes as herein contemplated and related proceedings
or in order to evidence the accuracy and completeness of any of the
representations and warranties, or the fulfillment of any of the conditions,
herein contained; and all proceedings taken by the Seller and HFC in connection
with the issuance and sale of the Notes as herein contemplated shall be
satisfactory in form and substance to the Underwriters and Brown & Wood LLP.

         (s)     Since the respective dates as of which information is given in
the Prospectus, there shall not have been any change, or any development
involving a prospective change, in or affecting the general affairs,
management, financial condition, stockholders' equity or results of operations
of the Seller, any of the Credit Line Owners or HFC otherwise than as set forth
or contemplated in the Prospectus, the effect of which is in the judgment of
the Underwriters so material and adverse as to make it impracticable or
inadvisable to proceed with the public offering or the delivery of the Notes on
the terms and in the manner contemplated in the Prospectus.





                                     24
<PAGE>   25

         (t)     Prior to the Closing Time, the Credit Line Owners, the Seller
and HFC shall have furnished to the Underwriters such further information,
certificates and documents as the Underwriters may reasonably request.

         If any condition specified in this Section 7 shall not have been
fulfilled when and as required to be fulfilled, this Agreement may be
terminated by the Underwriters by notice to the Seller at any time at or prior
to the Closing Time, and such termination shall be without liability of any
party to any other party except as provided in Section 7.

         SECTION 8.   Payment of Expenses.  The Seller, the Credit Line
Owners and HFC jointly and severally agree to pay all expenses incident to the
performance of their obligations under this Agreement, including without
limitation those related to (i) the filing of the Registration Statement and
all amendments thereto, (ii) the preparation, issuance and delivery of the
Notes, (iii) the fees and disbursements of Katten Muchin & Zavis, as special
counsel for the Seller and HFC, and Arthur Andersen LLP, accountants of the
Seller and HFC, (iv) the qualification of the Notes under securities and Blue
Sky laws and the determination of the eligibility of the Notes for investment
in accordance with the provisions of subsection 6(f) including filing fees, and
the fees and disbursements of Brown & Wood LLP, as counsel for the Underwriters
(not to exceed $28,000), in connection therewith and in connection with the
preparation of any Blue Sky Survey, (v) the printing and delivery to the
Underwriters, in such quantities as the Underwriters may reasonably request, of
copies of the Registration Statement and Prospectus and all amendments and
supplements thereto, and of any Blue Sky Survey, (vi) the delivery to the
Underwriters, in such quantities as the Underwriters may reasonably request, of
copies of the Basic Documents and (vii) the fees charged by nationally
recognized statistical rating agencies for rating the Notes, and (viii) the
fees and expenses of the Deposit Trustee, the Indenture Trustee and the Owner
Trustee and their counsels respectively.

         If this Agreement is terminated by the Underwriters in accordance with
the provisions of Section 7, the Seller, the Credit Line Owners and HFC shall
reimburse the Underwriters for all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses, including
the fees and disbursements of Brown & Wood LLP, as counsel for the
Underwriters.

         SECTION 9.   Indemnification.  (aa)  HFC and the Seller jointly
and severally agree to indemnify and hold harmless the Underwriters and each
person, if any, who controls the Underwriters within the meaning of Section 15
of the 1933 Act as follows:

                      (i)  against any and all loss, liability, claim, damage
         and expense whatsoever, as incurred, arising out of any untrue
         statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact





                                     25
<PAGE>   26

         contained in the Registration Statement (or any amendment thereto),
         including the information deemed to be a part of the Registration
         Statement pursuant to Rule 430A under the 1933 Act, if applicable, or
         the omission or alleged omission therefrom of a material fact required
         to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not
         misleading or arising out of any untrue statement or alleged untrue
         statement of a material fact contained in the Prospectus (or any
         amendment or supplement thereto) or the omission or alleged omission
         therefrom of a material fact necessary in order to make the statements
         therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not
         misleading, unless (a) such untrue statement or omission or alleged
         untrue statement or omission was made in reliance upon and in
         conformity with written information furnished to the Seller, or
         information electronically transmitted to the Seller by the
         Underwriters expressly for use in the Registration Statement (or any
         amendment thereto) or (b) such loss, liability, claim, damage or
         expense is incurred by an Underwriter solely as a result of the
         dissemination by it of Derived Information in violation of Section
         2(a), 2(b) or 2(c) hereof;

                     (ii)  against any and all loss, liability, claim, damage
         and expense whatsoever, as incurred, to the extent of the aggregate
         amount paid in settlement of any litigation, or investigation or
         proceeding by any governmental agency or body, commenced or
         threatened, or of any claim whatsoever based upon any such untrue
         statement or omission, or any such alleged untrue statement or
         omission, if such settlement is effected with the written consent of
         the Seller; and

                    (iii)  against any and all expense whatsoever (including
         the fees and disbursements of counsel chosen by the Underwriters) as
         reasonably incurred in investigating, preparing to defend or defending
         against or appearing as a third party witness with respect to any
         litigation, or investigation or proceeding by any governmental agency
         or body, commenced or threatened, or any claim whatsoever based upon
         any such untrue statement or omission, as such expense is incurred and
         to the extent that any such expense is not paid under (i) or (ii)
         above.

         This indemnity agreement will be in addition to any liability which 
the Seller may otherwise have.

         (b)     Each of the Underwriters severally agree to indemnify and hold
harmless the Seller, each of its directors, each of its officers who signed the
Registration Statement, and each person, if any, who controls the Seller within
the meaning of Section 15 of the 1933 Act (each, an "Indemnified Party")
against any and all loss, liability, claim, damage and expense, as incurred,
described in the indemnity contained in subsection (a) of this Section 9,





                                     26
<PAGE>   27

arising out of (i) any untrue statements or omissions, or alleged untrue
statements or omissions, made in the Registration Statement (or any amendment
thereto) or the Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto) in reliance
upon and in conformity with written information furnished to the Seller by such
Underwriter expressly for use in the Registration Statement (or any amendment
thereto) or the Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto).  The
parties hereto acknowledge that the only information supplied to the Seller by
the Underwriter expressly for use in the Registration Statement or the
Prospectus is limited to the information set forth in the last paragraph on the
cover, the first paragraph on page 2 and the second paragraph under the caption
"Underwriting" in the Prospectus,  and (ii) and the Derived Information
described below.  This indemnity agreement will be in addition to any liability
which the Underwriters may otherwise have.

         (c)  Each Underwriter agrees to provide the Seller, not later than two
Business Days after which the Prospectus is required to be filed pursuant to
Rule 424, with nine copies of its Derived Information for filing with the
Commission on Form 8-K.  Each Underwriter severally and not jointly agrees,
assuming all Seller-Provided Information (as defined below) is accurate and
complete in all material respects, to indemnify and hold harmless the Seller,
each of the Seller's officers and directors and each person who controls the
Seller within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act against all
losses, claims, damages or liabilities, joint or several, to which they may
become subject under the Securities Act or otherwise, insofar as such losses,
claims, damages or liabilities (or actions in respect thereof) arise out of or
are based upon any untrue statement of a material fact contained in the Derived
Information provided by such Underwriter, or arise out of or are based upon the
omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact required to be
stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein, in light of the
circumstances under which they were made, not misleading, and agrees to
reimburse each such indemnified party for any legal or other expenses
reasonably incurred by him, her or it in connection with investigating or
defending or preparing to investigate or defend any such loss, claim, damage,
liability or action as such expenses are incurred.  The obligations of an
Underwriter under this Section 9(c) are in addition to any liability which such
Underwriter may otherwise have.  The procedures set forth in Section 9(d) shall
be equally applicable to this Section 9(c).

         "Derived Information" means such portion, if any, of the information
delivered to the Seller pursuant to Section 2(b) for filing with the Commission
on Form 8-K as:

                 (i)  is not contained in the Prospectus without taking into
         account information incorporated therein by reference; and





                                     27
<PAGE>   28

             (ii)  does not constitute Seller-Provided Information.

            (iii)  is of the type of information defined as Collateral Term
         Sheets, Structural Term Sheets or Computational Materials (as such
         terms are interpreted in the No-Action Letters (as defined below)).

"Seller-Provided Information" means the information contained on any computer
tape furnished to the Underwriters by the Seller concerning the assets
comprising the Trust.

         The terms "Collateral Term Sheet" and "Structural Term Sheet" shall
have the respective meanings assigned to them in the February 13, 1995 letter
(the "PSA Letter") of Cleary, Gottlieb, Steen & Hamilton on behalf of the
Public Securities Association (which letter, and the SEC staff's response
thereto, were publicly available February 17, 1995).  The term "Collateral Term
Sheet" as used herein includes any subsequent Collateral Term Sheet that
reflects a substantive change in the information presented.  The term
"Computational Materials" has the meaning assigned to it in the May 17, 1994
letter (the "Kidder Letter" and together with the PSA Letter, the "No-Action
Letters") of Brown & Wood on behalf of Kidder, Peabody & Co., Inc. (which
letter, and the SEC staff's response thereto, were publicly available May 20,
1994).

         (d)     Each indemnified party shall give prompt notice to each
indemnifying party of any action commenced against it with respect to which
indemnity may be sought hereunder but failure to so notify an indemnifying
party shall not relieve it from any liability which it may have hereunder
unless it has been materially prejudiced by such failure to notify or from any
liability which it may have otherwise than on account of this indemnity
agreement.  An indemnifying party may participate at its own expense in the
defense of such action.  In no event shall the indemnifying parties be liable
for the fees and expenses of more than one counsel for all indemnified parties
in connection with any one action or separate but similar or related actions in
the same jurisdiction arising out of the same general allegations or
circumstances, unless (i) if the defendants in any such action include one or
more of the indemnified parties and the indemnifying party, one or more of the
indemnified parties shall have employed separate counsel after having
reasonably concluded that there may be legal defenses available to it or them
that are different from or additional to those available to the indemnifying
party or to one or more of the other indemnified parties or (ii) the
indemnifying party shall not have employed counsel reasonably satisfactory to
the indemnified party to represent the indemnified party within a reasonable
time after notice of the commencement of the action.

         SECTION 10.  Contribution.  In order to provide for just and equitable
contribution in circumstances in which the indemnity agreement provided for in
Section 9 is for any reason held to be





                                     28
<PAGE>   29

unenforceable by the indemnified parties although applicable in accordance with
its terms, HFC and the Seller on the one hand, and the Underwriters (or
Underwriter, if such loss, liability, claim, damage or expense arises solely as
a result of such Underwriter's breach of a representation and warranty set
forth in Section 2(a), 2(b) or 2(c) hereof), on the other, shall contribute to
the aggregate losses, liabilities, claims, damages and expenses of the nature
contemplated by said indemnity agreement incurred by the Seller and one or more
of the Underwriters (i) except for any Underwriter's indemnification arising
solely from a breach of its representation and warranty set forth in Section
2(a), 2(b) or 2(c) hereof, in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect the
relative benefits to HFC and the Seller on the one hand and the Underwriters or
such Underwriter in the case of a breach of a representation or warranty set
forth in Section 2(a), 2(b) or 2(c) hereof on the other in connection with the
matter to which the indemnification relates, which relative benefits shall be
deemed to be in such proportions that the Underwriters are responsible for that
portion represented by the percentage that the underwriting discount on the
cover of the Prospectus as amended or supplemented bears to the initial public
offering price as set forth thereon, and HFC and the Seller shall be jointly
and severally responsible for the balance or (ii) if the allocation provided by
clause (i) above is not permitted by applicable law or otherwise prohibited
hereby, in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect not only the relative
benefits referred to in clause (i) above but also the relative fault of HFC and
the Seller on the one hand and the Underwriters or Underwriter, as applicable,
on the other in connection with the statements or omissions that resulted in
such losses, claims, damages or liabilities, or actions in respect thereof, as
well as any other relevant equitable considerations; provided, however, that no
person guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section
11(f) of the 1933 Act) shall be entitled to contribution from any person who
was not guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation.  Relative fault shall be
determined by reference to, among other things, whether the untrue or alleged
untrue statement of a material fact or the omission or alleged omission to
state a material fact relates to information supplied by HFC or the Seller, on
the one hand, or the Underwriters, on the other hand, and the parties' relative
intent, knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent
such untrue statement or omission.  HFC, the Seller and the Underwriters agree
that it would not be just and equitable if contributions pursuant to this
Section 10 were to be determined by pro rata allocation (even if the
Underwriters were treated as one entity for such purpose) or by any other
method of allocation which does not take into account the equitable
considerations referred to in the first sentence of this Section 10.  The
amount paid by an indemnified party as a result of the losses, claims, damages
or liabilities (or actions in respect thereof) referred to in the first
sentence of this Section 10 shall be deemed to include any legal or other
expenses reasonably incurred by such indemnified





                                     29
<PAGE>   30

party in connection with investigating, preparing to defend or defending
against any action or claim which is the subject of this Section 10.
Notwithstanding the provisions of this Section 10, except for any loss, claim,
damage, liability or expense resulting solely from a breach of any
Underwriter's breach of the representation and warranty set forth in Section
2(a) or 2(b) hereof, no Underwriter shall be required to contribute any amount
in excess of the amount by which the total price at which the Notes
underwritten by such Underwriter and distributed to the public were offered to
the public exceeds the amount of any damages which such Underwriter has
otherwise been required to pay in respect of such losses, liabilities, claims,
damages and expenses.  The Underwriters' obligations in this Section 10 to
contribute are several in proportion to their respective underwriting
obligations and not joint and no Underwriter shall be required to contribute to
any loss, liability, claim, damage or expense as a result of another
Underwriter's breach of the representation and warranty set forth in Section
2(a) or 2(b) hereof.  Each party entitled to contribution agrees that upon the
service of a summons or other initial legal process upon it in any action
instituted against it in respect to which contribution may be sought, it shall
promptly give written notice of such service to the party or parties from whom
contribution may be sought, but the omission so to notify such party or parties
of any such service shall not relieve the party from whom contribution may be
sought for any obligation it may have hereunder or otherwise (except as
specifically provided in Section 9 hereof).  For purposes of this Section 10,
each person, if any, who controls any Underwriter within the meaning of Section
15 of the 1933 Act shall have the same rights to contribution as such
Underwriter and each respective director of the Seller, each respective officer
of the Seller who signed the Registration Statement, and each person, if any,
who controls the Seller within the meaning of Section 15 of the 1933 Act shall
have the same rights to contribution as the Seller.

         SECTION 11.  Representations, Warranties and Agreements to Survive
Delivery.  All representations, warranties and agreements contained in this
Agreement or contained in certificates of officers of the Credit Line Owners,
the Seller or HFC submitted pursuant hereto shall remain operative and in full
force and effect, regardless of any investigation made by or on behalf of the
Underwriters or controlling person thereof, or by or on behalf of the Credit
Line Owners, the Seller or HFC and shall survive delivery of any Notes to the
Underwriters.

         SECTION 12.  Termination of Agreement.  You, as representative of the
Underwriters, may terminate this Agreement, immediately upon notice to the
Seller, at any time at or prior to the Closing Time (i) if there has been an
outbreak or material escalation of hostilities involving the United States of
America where armed conflict appears imminent, or the declaration by the United
States of America of a national emergency or war, if the effect of any





                                     30
<PAGE>   31

such event in the Underwriter's reasonable judgment makes it impracticable or
inadvisable to proceed with the public offering of the Notes or (ii) if trading
generally on the New York Stock Exchange has been suspended, or minimum prices
have been established by the exchange or by order of the Commission or any
other governmental authority, or if a banking moratorium has been declared by
either federal or New York State authorities.  In the event of any such
termination, the covenant set forth in subsection 6(b), the provisions of
Section 8, the indemnity agreement set forth in Section 9, and the provisions
of Sections 10 and 15 shall remain in effect.

         SECTION 13.  Default by One or More of the Underwriters.  If one or
more of the Underwriters participating in the public offering of the Notes
shall fail at the Closing Time to purchase the Notes which it is (or they are)
obligated to purchase hereunder (the "Defaulted Certificates"), then such of
the non-defaulting Underwriters shall have the right, within 24 hours
thereafter, to make arrangements for one or more of the non-defaulting
Underwriters, or any other underwriters, to purchase all, but not less than
all, of the Defaulted Certificates in such amounts as may be agreed upon and
upon the terms herein set forth.  If, however, the Underwriters have not
completed such arrangements within such 24-hour period, then:

                      (i)  if the aggregate principal amount of Defaulted
         Certificates does not exceed 10% of the aggregate principal amount of
         the Notes to be purchased pursuant to this Agreement, the
         non-defaulting Underwriters named in this Agreement shall be obligated
         to purchase the full amount thereof in the proportions that their
         respective underwriting obligations hereunder bear to the underwriting
         obligations of all such non-defaulting Underwriters, or

                     (ii)  if the aggregate principal amount of Defaulted
         Certificates exceeds 10% of the aggregate principal amount of the
         Notes to be purchased pursuant to this Agreement, this Agreement shall
         terminate, without any liability on the part of any non- defaulting
         Underwriters.

         No action taken pursuant to this Section 13 shall relieve any
defaulting Underwriter from the liability with respect to any default of such
Underwriter under this Agreement.

         In the event of a default by the Underwriters as set forth in this
Section 13, either the Underwriters or the Seller shall have the right to
postpone the Closing Time for a period not exceeding five Business Days in
order that any required changes in the Registration Statement or Prospectus or
in any other documents or arrangements may be effected.





                                     31
<PAGE>   32

         SECTION 14.  Notices.  All notices and other communications hereunder
shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given if mailed or
transmitted by any standard form of telecommunication.  Notices to the
Underwriters shall be directed to them at the address set forth on the first
page hereof.  Notices to the Seller or HFC shall be directed to Household
Finance Corporation, 2700 Sanders Road, Prospect Heights, Illinois 60070, to
the attention of the Secretary, with a copy to the Treasurer.

         SECTION 15.  Parties.  This Agreement shall inure to the benefit of
and be binding upon the Underwriter, the Credit Line Owners, the Seller and
HFC, and their respective successors.  Nothing expressed or mentioned in this
Agreement is intended nor shall it be construed to give any person, firm or
corporation, other than the parties hereto or thereto and their respective
successors and the controlling persons and officers and directors referred to
in Sections 9 and 10 and their heirs and legal representatives any legal or
equitable right, remedy or claim under or with respect to this Agreement or any
provision herein contained.  This Agreement and all conditions and provisions
hereof are intended to be for the sole and exclusive benefit of the parties and
their respective successors and said controlling persons and officers and
directors and their heirs and legal representatives (to the extent of their
rights as specified herein and therein) and except as provided above for the
benefit of no other person, firm or corporation.  No purchaser of Notes from
the Underwriter shall be deemed to be a successor by reason merely of such
purchase.

         SECTION 16.  Governing Law and Time.  This Agreement shall be governed
by the law of the State of New York and shall be construed in accordance with
such law.  Specified times of day refer to New York City time.

         SECTION 17.  Counterparts.  This Agreement may be executed in
counterparts, each of which shall constitute an original of any party whose
signature appears on it, and all of which shall together constitute a single
instrument.





                                     32
<PAGE>   33

         If the foregoing is in accordance with the Underwriters' understanding
of our agreement, please sign and return to us a counterpart hereof, whereupon
this instrument along with all counterparts will become a binding agreement
among the Underwriters, the Seller, HFC and the Credit Line Owners in
accordance with its terms.

                                           Very truly yours,

                                           HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORPORATION



                                           By: 
                                               -------------------------------
                                           Name:  Steve H. Smith
                                           Title:  VP & Asst. Treasurer


                                           HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION



                                           By: 
                                               -------------------------------
                                           Name:
                                           Title:

<PAGE>   34

                                             HOUSEHOLD REALTY CORPORATION,
                                             HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION OF
                                               CALIFORNIA,
                                             HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION II,
                                             HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION III,
                                             HOUSEHOLD FINANCE INDUSTRIAL LOAN
                                               COMPANY,
                                             HOUSEHOLD FINANCE REALTY CORPORA-
                                               TION OF NEW YORK,
                                             HOUSEHOLD FINANCIAL CENTER, INC.,
                                             HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION OF
                                               NEVADA,
                                             HOUSEHOLD FINANCE REALTY CORPORA-
                                                TION OF NEVADA,
                                             HOUSEHOLD INDUSTRIAL LOAN COMPANY
                                                OF KENTUCKY,
                                             HOUSEHOLD FINANCE INDUSTRIAL LOAN
                                               COMPANY OF IOWA,
                                             HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CONSUMER DISCOUNT
                                               COMPANY,
                                             HOUSEHOLD INDUSTRIAL FINANCE
                                               COMPANY, AND
                                             MORTGAGE ONE CORPORATION



                                           By: 
                                               --------------------------------
                                           Name:
                                           Title:
                                           



CONFIRMED AND ACCEPTED, as of
the date first above written:


MERRILL LYNCH & CO.,
MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH
         INCORPORATED, as Representative of the Underwriters



By: 
    ----------------------------------------------
      Name:
      Title:

<PAGE>   35

                                   Schedule A
                                  Underwriting


CLASS A NOTES


                                                               Principal Amounts


 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $[] 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $[] 

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
  Incorporated  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $[] 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $[]

         Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $[]


CLASS B NOTES

                                                               Principal Amounts


 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $[] 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $[] 

Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
  Incorporated  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $[] 
 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $[]

         Total  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  $[]





<PAGE>   36

                                   EXHIBIT A

                             [Needs to be Updated]

                        Opinion of John W. Blenke, Esq.
                   Section 7(c) of the Underwriting Agreement



                                                                 August ___ 1996

MERRILL LYNCH & CO.
MERRILL LYNCH, PIERCE, FENNER & SMITH
                   INCORPORATED
as Representative of the Underwriters
c/o Merrill Lynch & Co.
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                   Incorporated
World Financial Center
North Tower
New York, New York 10281

         Re:     Household Consumer Loan
                 Asset Backed Notes and Certificates,
                 Series 1996-2                       

Ladies and Gentlemen:

         I address this opinion to the Underwriters pursuant to Section 7(c) of
the Underwriting Agreement dated __________ ___, 1996 (the "Underwriting
Agreement") among Household Consumer Loan Corporation (the "Seller"), Household
Finance Corporation, a Delaware corporation (the "Company"), Household Realty
Corporation, Household Finance Corporation of California, Household Finance
Corporation II, Household Finance Corporation III, Household Finance Industrial
Loan Company, Household Finance Realty Corporation of New York, Household
Financial Center, Inc., Household Finance Corporation of Nevada, Household
Finance Realty Corporation of Nevada, Household Industrial Loan Company of
Kentucky, Household Finance Industrial Loan Company of Iowa, Household Finance
Consumer Discount Company, Household Industrial Finance Company, and Mortgage
One Corporation (collectively, the "Credit Line Owners" and each individually,
a "Credit Line Owner") and the underwriters referred to therein (together, the
"Underwriters").  The Seller has entered into a Trust Agreement dated as of
__________ 1, 1996 (the "Trust Agreement") with Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware
(the "Owner Trustee"), creating Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2 (the
"Issuer"), a statutory business trust established under the laws of the State
of Delaware.  The Seller proposes to direct the Owner Trustee pursuant to the
Trust Agreement to cause the Issuer to issue Household Consumer Loan Asset
Backed Notes, Series 1996-2 Class A and Class B (the "Notes")





                                     A-1
<PAGE>   37

and Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Certificates, Series 1996-2 (the
"Certificates" and, together with the Notes, the "Securities").  Only the Notes
are being purchased by the Underwriters
[____________________________________________].

         The Notes will be issued pursuant to an Indenture dated as of
__________ 1, 1996 (the "Indenture") between the Issuer and The Bank of New
York (the "Indenture Trustee") and will represent indebtedness of the Issuer.
The Certificates will be issued pursuant to the Trust Agreement.  The Notes
will be secured by (i) a participation interest (the "Series 1996-2
Participation Interest") in (a) receivables held in Household Consumer Loan
Deposit Trust (the "Deposit Trust") originated under certain fixed and variable
rate revolving secured and unsecured consumer credit lines (the "Credit Lines")
and (b) certain other participation interests,  (ii) amounts on deposit in
certain accounts of the Issuer held for the benefit of the holders of the
Securities, and (iii) an assignment of the Issuer's rights under the Series
1996-2 Supplement (as defined below) (collectively, the "Trust Assets").  The
Deposit Trust was formed pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as
of September 1, 1995 (the "Base Pooling and Servicing Agreement") among the
Seller, HFC, as Servicer (the "Servicer") and Texas Commerce Bank National
Association as successor trustee to The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A., as Deposit
Trustee (the "Deposit Trustee").  The Series 1996-2 Participation Interest was
issued pursuant to the Supplement for Series 1996-2 dated as of __________ 1,
1996 among the Seller, the Servicer and the Deposit Trustee (the "Supplement"
and together with the Base Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the "Pooling and
Servicing Agreement").  The Pooling and Servicing Agreement together with the
Trust Agreement, Certificate of Trust thereto, the Indenture, the Receivables
Purchase Agreement, the Administration Agreement and the Underwriting Agreement
constitute the "Basic Documents" herein.  Capitalized terms used herein shall
have the meanings ascribed to them in the Underwriting Agreement unless herein
otherwise defined.

         As Vice President--Corporate Law and the Secretary of Household
International, Inc., a Delaware corporation, the ultimate parent corporation of
the Company, the Seller and each of the Credit Line Owners, I, or the attorneys
under my supervision have, among other things (i) participated in the
preparation of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and (ii) cooperated with
officers of the Seller and the Company, representatives of the Underwriters and
independent accountants in the preparation of the Registration Statement on
Form S-3 and S-1 (Registration No. 33-_________  and 33-_________ ) filed with
the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") under the Securities
Act of 1933, as amended (the "Act"), and the Prospectus dated ___________ ___,
1996 in the form in which it was transmitted for filing with the Commission
pursuant to Rule 424(b) of the Rules and Regulations under the Act (the "Final
Prospectus").





                                     A-2
<PAGE>   38

         I advise you that in my opinion:

              (i)        The Pooling and Servicing Agreement is not required to
be qualified and the Indenture has been duly qualified under the Trust
Indenture Act;

             (ii)        None of the Seller, the Deposit Trust or the Owner
Trust is an "investment company" or under the "control" of an "investment
company" as such terms are defined in the Investment Company Act of 1940;

            (iii)        The Notes and the Basic Documents that are described
in the Final Prospectus conform in all material respects to the respective
descriptions thereof in the Final Prospectus; and

             (iv)        The statements in the Final Prospectus under the
captions "Prospectus Summary--Tax Status", "--Income Tax Withholding" and
"--ERISA Considerations" and "Certain Income Tax Consequences" and "ERISA
Considerations"  to the extent that they constitute matters of law or legal
conclusions with respect thereto, have been prepared or reviewed by me and are
factually correct or correctly represent my opinion.

         The opinions set forth herein are subject to the following
qualifications:

         No opinion is expressed as to the effect of the compliance or
noncompliance of the Seller, Credit Line Owners, Servicer, Deposit Trustee,
Owner Trustee or Indenture Trustee with any state or federal laws or
regulations applicable to them because of their legal or regulatory status or
the nature of their respective businesses and to the extent that the opinions
set forth herein relate to the due authorization, execution and delivery of the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Certificates.

         I, or the attorneys under my supervision, have examined originals, or
copies of originals certified to my satisfaction, of such agreements,
documents, certificates and other statements of public officials and
responsible officers of each of the Sellers, the Company and the Trustee and
other papers and matters of fact and law as I have deemed relevant and
necessary as a basis for the opinions I expressed herein.  I have relied, with
respect to factual matters, on representations and warranties made by, and on
certificates and other documents furnished by responsible officers of each of
the Trustee, the Seller and the Company.  In expressing the foregoing opinions,
I have assumed, with the Underwriters' permission, (i) the authenticity of all
documents submitted to me as originals and the conformity with the original
documents of any copies of such documents submitted to me for my examination,
(ii) that each of the Sellers and the Trustee has been duly organized and is
validly existing and in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of
incorporation and (iii) the due execution and





                                     A-3
<PAGE>   39

delivery, pursuant to due authorization, of the agreements and documents
referred to above by the Trustee.

         The opinions expressed herein are only with respect to federal laws of
the United States and the laws of the State of Illinois.  I consent to the
reliance on this opinion by Standard & Poor's Ratings Services, a Division of
The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., and Moody's Investors Service, Inc.  Subject
to the foregoing sentence, this opinion is solely for the Underwriters' benefit
and may not be relied upon by, nor copies be delivered to, any other person
without my prior written consent.

                                           Very truly yours,





                                     A-4

<PAGE>   1





                                                                     EXHIBIT 4.1





        ===============================================================



                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORPORATION,

                                 as Seller and

                                 Holder of the
                             Designated Certificate

                                      and

                         CHASE MANHATTAN BANK DELAWARE,

                                as Owner Trustee


                   _________________________________________


                           [FORM OF TRUST AGREEMENT]

                         Dated as of ___________, 1996

                   __________________________________________



                    Consumer Loan Asset Backed Certificates,
                                 Series 1996-2




        ===============================================================
<PAGE>   2

                               Table of Contents

Section                                                                Page
- -------                                                                ----
                                  ARTICLE I                         
                                                                    
                                 Definitions                        
                                                                    
     1.01.   Definitions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    1
     1.02.   Other Definitional Provisions  . . . . . . . . . . . . .    1
                                                                    
                                  ARTICLE II                        
                                                                    
                                 Organization                       
                                                                    
     2.01.   Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    3
     2.02.   Office . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    3
     2.03.   Purposes and Powers  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    3
     2.04.   Appointment of Owner Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    4
     2.05.   Initial Capital Contribution of Owner Trust            
                      Estate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    4
     2.06.   Declaration of Trust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    4
     2.07.   Liability of the Holder of the Designated              
                      Certificate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    5
     2.08.   Title to Trust Property  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    5
     2.09.   Location of Corporate Trust Office . . . . . . . . . . .    5
     2.10.   Representations and Warranties and Covenants           
                      of HCLC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    6
                                                                    
                                 ARTICLE III                        
                                                                    
           Conveyance of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest;  
                                 Certificates                       
                                                                    
     3.01.   Conveyance of the Series 1996-2 Participation          
                      Interest  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    8
     3.02.   Initial Ownership  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    8
     3.03.   The Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    8
     3.04.   Authentication of Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . .    9
     3.05.   Registration of and Limitations on Transfer            
                      and Exchange of Certificates  . . . . . . . . .    9
     3.06.   Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen                   
                      Certificates  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   12
     3.07.   Persons Deemed Certificateholders  . . . . . . . . . . .   12
     3.08.   Access to List of Certificateholders' Names            
                      and Addresses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   13
     3.09.   Maintenance of Office or Agency  . . . . . . . . . . . .   13
     3.10.   Certificate Paying Agent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   13
     3.11.   Ownership by HCLC  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   14
     3.12.   RESERVED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   15
     3.13.   Optional Repurchase of the Series 1996-2               
                      Participation Interest  . . . . . . . . . . . .   15
                                                                    
                                                                    
                                                                    
                                                                    
                                                                    
                                       i                            
<PAGE>   3
                                                                    
Section                                                                Page
- -------                                                                ----
                                  ARTICLE IV                        
                                                                    
                           Actions by Owner Trustee                 
                                                                    
     4.01.   Prior Notice to Certificateholders with                
                      Respect to Certain Matters  . . . . . . . . . .   16
     4.02.   Action by Certificateholders with Respect to           
                      Certain Matters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   17
     4.03.   Action by Certificateholders with Respect to           
                      Bankruptcy  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   17
     4.04.   Restrictions on Certificateholders' Power  . . . . . . .   17
     4.05.   Majority Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   17
                                                                    
                                  ARTICLE V                         
                                                                    
                          Application of Trust Funds                
                                                                    
     5.01.   Distributions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   18
     5.02.   Method of Payment  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   18
     5.03.   Signature on Returns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   19
     5.04.   Statements to Certificateholders . . . . . . . . . . . .   19
     5.05.   Tax Reporting; Tax Elections . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   19
     5.06.   Capital Accounts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   19
                                                                    
                                  ARTICLE VI                        
                                                                    
                    Authority and Duties of Owner Trustee           
                                                                    
     6.01.   General Authority  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   22
     6.02.   General Duties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   22
     6.03.   Action upon Instruction  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   22
     6.04.   No Duties Except as Specified in this Trust            
                      Agreement or in Instructions  . . . . . . . . .   23
     6.05.   No Action Except Under Specified Documents or          
                      Instructions  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   24
     6.06.   Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   24
                                                                    
                                 ARTICLE VII                        
                                                                    
                         Concerning the Owner Trustee               
                                                                    
     7.01.   Acceptance of Trusts and Duties  . . . . . . . . . . . .   25
     7.02.   Furnishing of Documents  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   26
     7.03.   Representations and Warranties . . . . . . . . . . . . .   26
     7.04.   Reliance; Advice of Counsel  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   27
     7.05.   Not Acting in Individual Capacity  . . . . . . . . . . .   27
     7.06.   Owner Trustee Not Liable for Certificates  . . . . . . .   28
     7.07.   Owner Trustee May Own Certificates and Notes . . . . . .   28
                                                                    
                                                                    
                                                                    
                                                                    
                                                                    
                                       ii                           
<PAGE>   4
                                                                    
Section                                                               Page
- -------                                                               ----
                                 ARTICLE VIII                       
                                                                    
                        Compensation of Owner Trustee               
                                                                    
     8.01.   Owner Trustee's Fees and Expenses  . . . . . . . . . . .   29
     8.02.   Indemnification  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   29
                                                                    
                                  ARTICLE IX                        
                                                                    
                        Termination of Trust Agreement              
                                                                    
     9.01.   Termination of Trust Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . .   31
     9.02.   Dissolution upon Bankruptcy of the Holder of           
                      the Designated Certificate  . . . . . . . . . .   32
                                                                    
                                  ARTICLE X                         
                                                                    
            Successor Owner Trustees and Additional Owner Trustees  
                                                                    
     10.01.  Eligibility Requirements for Owner Trustee . . . . . . .   34
     10.02.  Resignation or Removal of Owner Trustee  . . . . . . . .   34
     10.03.  Successor Owner Trustee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   35
     10.04.  Merger or Consolidation of Owner Trustee . . . . . . . .   35
     10.05.  Appointment of Co-Trustee or Separate                  
                      Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   36
                                                                    
                                  ARTICLE XI                        
                                                                    
                                Miscellaneous                       
                                                                    
     11.01.  Amendments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   38
     11.02.  No Legal Title to Owner Trust Estate in                
                      Certificateholders  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   39
     11.03.  Limitations on Rights of Others  . . . . . . . . . . . .   39
     11.04.  Notices  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   39
     11.05.  Severability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   40
     11.06.  Separate Counterparts  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   40
     11.07.  Successors and Assigns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   40
     11.08.  Covenants of the Seller  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   40
     11.09.  No Petition  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   40
     11.10.  No Recourse  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   41
     11.11.  Headings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   41
     11.12.  GOVERNING LAW  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   41
     11.13.  Integration  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   41
                                                                    
Signatures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   40





                                      iii
<PAGE>   5

EXHIBIT
- -------
Exhibit A - Form of Certificate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  A-1
Exhibit B - RESERVED  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  B-1
Exhibit C - Certificate of Trust of Household             
                   Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2 . . . . . . . . . . .  C-1
Exhibit D - Form of 144A Investment Letter  . . . . . . . . . . . .  D-1
Exhibit E - Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  E-1
Exhibit F - Form of Certificate of Non-Foreign Status . . . . . . .  F-1
Exhibit G - Form of Investment Letter                     
                   for Accredited Investors . . . . . . . . . . . .  G-1





                                       iv
<PAGE>   6

         This Trust Agreement, dated as of _____________, 1996 (as amended from
time to time, this "Trust Agreement"), between HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN
CORPORATION, a Nevada corporation, as Seller and as Holder of the Designated
Certificate ("HCLC", the "Seller", and the "Designated Certificateholder" as
the context requires) and CHASE MANHATTAN BANK DELAWARE, a Delaware banking
corporation, as Owner Trustee (the "Owner Trustee"),

                                WITNESSETH THAT:

         In consideration of the mutual agreements herein contained, HCLC and
the Owner Trustee agree as follows:


                                   ARTICLE I

                                  Definitions

         Section 1.01.  Definitions.  For all purposes of this Trust Agreement,
except as otherwise expressly provided herein or unless the context otherwise
requires, capitalized terms not otherwise defined herein shall have the
meanings assigned to such terms in the Definitions attached hereto as Exhibit
E, which is incorporated by reference herein.  All other capitalized terms used
herein shall have the meanings specified herein.

         SECTION 1.02.    Other Definitional Provisions.

         (a)  All terms defined in this Trust Agreement shall have the defined
meanings when used in any certificate or other document made or delivered
pursuant hereto unless otherwise defined therein.

         (b)     As used in this Trust Agreement and in any certificate or
other document made or delivered pursuant hereto or thereto, accounting terms
not defined in this Trust Agreement or in any such certificate or other
document, and accounting terms partly defined in this Trust Agreement or in any
such certificate or other document to the extent not defined, shall have the
respective meanings given to them under generally accepted accounting
principles.  To the extent that the definitions of accounting terms in this
Trust Agreement or in any such certificate or other document are inconsistent
with the meanings of such terms under generally accepted accounting principles,
the definitions contained in this Trust Agreement or in any such certificate or
other document shall control.

         (c)     The words "hereof," "herein," "hereunder" and words of similar
import when used in this Trust Agreement shall refer to this Trust Agreement as
a whole and not to any particular provision of this Trust Agreement; Section
and Exhibit references contained in this Trust Agreement are references to
Sections and Exhibits in or to this Trust Agreement unless otherwise speci-
<PAGE>   7

fied; and the term "including" shall mean "including without limitation".

         (d)     The definitions contained in this Trust Agreement are
applicable to the singular as well as the plural forms of such terms and to the
masculine as well as to the feminine and neuter genders of such terms.

         (e)     Any agreement, instrument or statute defined or referred to
herein or in any instrument or certificate delivered in connection herewith
means such agreement, instrument or statute as from time to time amended,
modified or supplemented and includes (in the case of agreements or
instruments) references to all attachments thereto and instruments incorporated
therein; references to a Person are also to its permitted successors and
assigns.





                                       2
<PAGE>   8

                                   ARTICLE II

                                  Organization

         Section 2.01.    Name.  The trust created hereby (the "Issuer") shall
be known as "Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2," in which name the Owner
Trustee may conduct the business of the Issuer, make and execute contracts and
other instruments on behalf of the Issuer and sue and be sued.

         Section 2.02.    Office.  An office of the Issuer shall be in care of
the Owner Trustee at the Corporate Trust Office or at such other address in
Delaware as the Owner Trustee may designate by written notice to the
Certificateholders and the Seller.

         Section 2.03.    Purposes and Powers.  The purpose of the Issuer is to
engage in the following activities:

              (i)         to issue the Notes pursuant to the Indenture and the
         Certificates pursuant to this Trust Agreement and to sell the Notes
         and the Certificates;

             (ii)         to purchase the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
         and to pay or cause to be paid its organizational, start-up and
         transactional expenses;

            (iii)         to assign, grant, transfer, pledge, mortgage and
         convey the Indenture Trust Estate pursuant to the Indenture and to
         hold, manage and distribute to the Certificateholders pursuant to
         Section 5.01 any portion of the Indenture Trust Estate released from
         the Lien of, and remitted to the Issuer pursuant to the Indenture;

             (iv)         to enter into and perform its obligations under the
         Basic Documents to which it is to be a party;

              (v)         to engage in those activities, including entering
         into agreements, that are necessary, suitable or convenient to
         accomplish the foregoing or are incidental thereto or connected
         therewith, including, without limitation, to accept additional
         contributions of equity that are not subject to the Lien of the
         Indenture; and

             (vi)         subject to compliance with the Basic Documents, to
         engage in such other activities as may be required in connection with
         conservation of the Owner Trust Estate and the making of distributions
         to the Certificateholders and the Noteholders.

The Issuer is hereby authorized to engage in the foregoing activities.  The
Issuer shall not engage in any activity other than in connection with the
foregoing or other than as required or autho-





                                       3
<PAGE>   9

rized by the terms of this Trust Agreement or the Basic Documents.

         Section 2.04.    Appointment of Owner Trustee.  The Seller hereby
appoints the Owner Trustee as trustee of the Issuer effective as of the date
hereof, to have all the rights, powers and duties set forth herein.

         Section 2.05.    Initial Capital Contribution of Owner Trust Estate.
The Seller hereby sells, assigns, transfers, conveys and sets over to the
Issuer, as of the date hereof, the sum of $1.  The Owner Trustee hereby
acknowledges on behalf of the Issuer, receipt in trust from the Seller, as of
the date hereof, of the foregoing contribution, which shall constitute the
initial corpus of the Issuer and shall be deposited in the Payment Account.
The Owner Trustee also acknowledges on behalf of the trust receipt of the other
property transferred and assigned to the Trust pursuant to Section 3.01, which
shall constitute the Owner Trust Estate.  The Seller shall pay or cause to be
paid organizational expenses of the Issuer as they may arise or shall, upon the
request of the Owner Trustee, promptly reimburse the Owner Trustee for any such
expenses paid by the Owner Trustee.  The Seller shall execute and deliver any
necessary state or federal securities law filings on behalf of the Issuer.

         Section 2.06.    Declaration of Trust.  The Owner Trustee hereby
declares that it will hold the Owner Trust Estate on behalf of the Issuer in
trust upon and subject to the conditions set forth herein for the use and
benefit of the Certificateholders, subject to the obligations of the Issuer
under the Basic Documents.  It is the intention of the parties hereto that the
Issuer constitute a business trust under the Business Trust Statute and that
this Trust Agreement constitute the governing instrument of such business
trust.  It is the intention of the parties hereto that, for income and
franchise tax purposes, the Issuer shall be treated as a partnership, with the
assets of the partnership being the Owner Trust Estate, the partners of the
partnership being the Certificateholders, and the Notes being debt of the
partnership.  Except as otherwise provided in this Trust Agreement, the rights
of the Certificateholders (other than the Holder of the Designated Certificate)
will be those of limited partners and the rights of the Holder of the
Designated Certificate, subject to Section 6.03 hereof, will be those of a
general partner in a partnership formed under the Delaware Revised Uniform
Limited Partnership Act.  The parties agree that, unless otherwise required by
appropriate tax authorities, the Issuer will file or cause to be filed annual
or other necessary returns, reports and other forms consistent with the
characterization of the Issuer as a partnership for such tax purposes.
Effective as of the date hereof, the Owner Trustee shall have all rights,
powers and duties set forth herein and in the Business Trust Statute with
respect to accomplishing the purposes of the Issuer.  The Owner Trustee has
filed with the





                                       4
<PAGE>   10

Secretary of State of the State of Delaware a Certificate of Trust of the
Issuer.

         Section 2.07.    Liability of the Holder of the Designated
Certificate.  (a)  The Holder of the Designated Certificate shall be liable
directly to and will indemnify any injured party for all losses, claims,
damages, liabilities and expenses of the Issuer (including Expenses, to the
extent not paid out of the Owner Trust Estate) to the extent that the Holder of
the Designated Certificate would be liable if the Issuer were a partnership
under the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act in which the Holder
of the Designated Certificate were a general partner; provided, however, that
the Holder of the Designated Certificate shall not be liable for payments
required to be made on the Notes or the Certificates, or for any losses
incurred by a Certificateholder in the capacity of an investor in the
Certificates or a Noteholder in the capacity of an investor in the Notes.  In
addition, any third party creditors of the Issuer (other than in connection
with the obligations described in the preceding sentence for which the Holder
of the Designated Certificate shall not be liable) shall be deemed third party
beneficiaries of this paragraph.  The obligations of the Holder of the
Designated Certificate under this paragraph shall be evidenced by the
Designated Certificate.

         (b)     Subject to subsection (a) above, the Certificateholders shall
be entitled to the same limitation of personal liability extended to
stockholders of private corporations for profit organized under the General
Corporation Law of the State of Delaware.

         Section 2.08.    Title to Trust Property.  Legal title to the Owner
Trust Estate shall be vested at all times in the Issuer as a separate legal
entity except where applicable law in any jurisdiction requires title to any
part of the Owner Trust Estate to be vested in a trustee or trustees, in which
case title shall be deemed to be vested in the Owner Trustee, a co-trustee
and/or a separate trustee, as the case may be.

         Section 2.09.    Location of Corporate Trust Office.  All bank
accounts maintained by the Owner Trustee on behalf of the Issuer shall be
located in the State of Delaware or the State of New York.  The Issuer shall
not have any employees; provided, however, that nothing herein shall restrict
or prohibit the Owner Trustee from having employees within or without the State
of Delaware or taking actions outside the State of Delaware in order to comply
with Section 2.03.  Payments will be received by the Issuer only in Delaware or
New York, and payments will be made by the Issuer only from Delaware or New
York.  The Owner Trustee shall maintain its Corporate Trust Office in the State
of Delaware.





                                       5
<PAGE>   11

         Section 2.10.    Representations and Warranties and Covenants of HCLC.
(a)  The Seller hereby represents and warrants to the Owner Trustee that:

                    (i)   The Seller is duly organized and validly existing as
         a corporation in good standing under the laws of the State of Nevada,
         with power and authority to own its properties and to conduct its
         business as such properties are currently owned and such business is
         presently conducted.

                    (ii)  The Seller is duly qualified to do business as a
         foreign corporation in good standing and has obtained all necessary
         licenses and approvals in all jurisdictions in which the ownership or
         lease of its property or the conduct of its business shall require
         such qualifications and in which the failure to so qualify would have
         a material adverse effect on the business, properties, assets or
         condition (financial or other) of the Seller.

                   (iii)  The Seller has the power and authority to execute and
         deliver this Trust Agreement and to carry out its terms; the Seller
         has full power and authority to sell and assign the property to be
         sold and assigned to and deposited with the Issuer and the Seller has
         duly authorized such sale and assignment and deposit to the Issuer by
         all necessary corporate action; and the execution, delivery and
         performance of this Trust Agreement have been duly authorized by the
         Seller by all necessary corporate action.

                    (iv)  The consummation of the transactions contemplated by
         this Trust Agreement and the fulfillment of the terms hereof do not
         conflict with, result in any breach of any of the terms and provisions
         of, or constitute (with or without notice or lapse of time) a default
         under, the articles of incorporation or bylaws of the Seller, or any
         indenture, agreement or other instrument to which the Seller is a
         party or by which it is bound; nor result in the creation or
         imposition of any Lien upon any of its properties pursuant to the
         terms of any such indenture, agreement or other instrument (other than
         pursuant to the Basic Documents); nor violate any law or, to the best
         of the Seller's knowledge, any order, rule or regulation applicable to
         the Seller of any court or of any federal or state regulatory body,
         administrative agency or other governmental instrumentality having
         jurisdiction over the Seller or its properties.

                    (v)   To the Seller's best knowledge, there are no
         proceedings or investigations pending or threatened before any court,
         regulatory body, administrative agency or other governmental
         instrumentality having jurisdiction over the Seller or its properties:
         (A) asserting the invalidity of this Trust Agreement, (B) seeking to
         prevent the consum-





                                       6
<PAGE>   12

         mation of any of the transactions contemplated by this Trust Agreement
         or (C) seeking any determination or ruling that might materially and
         adversely affect the performance by the Seller of its obligations
         under, or the validity or enforceability of, this Trust Agreement.

                   (vi)   Immediately prior to the conveyance by the Seller to
         the Issuer of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest as contemplated
         by Section 3.01 hereof, the Seller owned the Series 1996-2
         Participation Interest free and clear of any Lien.





                                       7
<PAGE>   13

                                  ARTICLE III

            Conveyance of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest;
                                  Certificates

         Section 3.01.  Conveyance of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest.
The Seller, concurrently with the execution and delivery hereof, does hereby
transfer, convey, sell and assign to the Issuer, on behalf of the Holders of
the Notes and the Certificates, without recourse, all its right, title and
interest in and to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest free and clear of
any Liens, and all monies and the collections and proceeds due thereon and any
part thereof which consists of general intangibles (as defined in the UCC) (the
"Owner Trust Estate").  Simultaneous therewith and in consideration thereof,
the Seller shall receive from the Issuer the Securities, including the
Designated Certificate, and the obligation of the Issuer to pay an amount equal
to a deferred stream of payments represented by the Holdback Amount in
accordance with Section 3.05 of the Indenture.

         The parties hereto intend that the transaction set forth herein be a
sale by the Seller to the Issuer of all of its right, title and interest in and
to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest and the other property described
above.  In the event that the transaction set forth herein is not deemed to be
a sale, the Seller hereby grants to the Issuer a security interest in all of
its right, title and interest in, to and under the Owner Trust Estate, all
distributions thereon and all proceeds thereof; and this Trust Agreement shall
constitute a security agreement under applicable law.

         Section 3.02.    Initial Ownership.  Upon the formation of the Issuer
by the contribution by the Seller pursuant to Section 2.05 and until the
conveyance of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest pursuant to Section 3.01
and the issuance of the Certificates, the Seller shall be the sole beneficiary
of the Issuer.

         Section 3.03.    The Certificates.  The Certificates shall be issued
in minimum denominations of $1,000,000 and in integral multiples of $100,000 in
excess thereof; except for one Certificate that may not be in an integral
multiple of $100,000; provided, however, that the Designated Certificate issued
pursuant to Section 3.11 may be issued in the amount of $[           ].  The
Certificates may not be subdivided for resale into units that had a Security
Balance of less than $1,000,000 upon the Closing Date.  The Certificates shall
be executed on behalf of the Issuer by manual or facsimile signature of an
authorized officer of the Owner Trustee and authenticated in the manner
provided in Section 3.04.  Certificates bearing the manual or facsimile
signatures of individuals who were, at the time when such signatures shall have
been affixed, authorized to sign on





                                       8
<PAGE>   14

behalf of the Issuer, shall be validly issued and entitled to the benefit of
this Trust Agreement, notwithstanding that such individuals or any of them
shall have ceased to be so authorized prior to the authentication and delivery
of such Certificates or did not hold such offices at the date of authentication
and delivery of such Certificates.  A Person shall become a Certificateholder
and shall be entitled to the rights and subject to the obligations of a
Certificateholder hereunder upon such Person's acceptance of a Certificate duly
registered in such Person's name, pursuant to Section 3.05.  Each Person who
shall become a Certificateholder shall establish its non-foreign status by
submitting to the Certificate Paying Agent an IRS Form W-9 and the Certificate
of Non-Foreign Status set forth in Exhibit F hereto.

         A transferee of a Certificate shall become a Certificateholder and
shall be entitled to the rights and subject to the obligations of a
Certificateholder hereunder upon such transferee's acceptance of a Certificate
duly registered in such transferee's name pursuant to and upon satisfaction of
the conditions set forth in Section 3.05.

         Section 3.04.    Authentication of Certificates.  Concurrently with
the acquisition of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest by the Issuer, the
Owner Trustee shall cause the Certificates in an aggregate principal amount
equal to the Initial Principal Balance of the Certificates to be executed on
behalf of the Issuer, authenticated and delivered to or upon the written order
of the Seller, signed by its chairman of the board, its president, any vice
president, secretary, treasurer or any assistant treasurer, without further
corporate action by the Seller, in authorized denominations.  No Certificate
shall entitle its holder to any benefit under this Trust Agreement or be valid
for any purpose unless there shall appear on such Certificate a certificate of
authentication substantially in the form set forth in Exhibit A, executed by
the Owner Trustee or The Bank of New York, as the Issuer's authenticating
agent, by manual signature; such authentication shall constitute conclusive
evidence that such Certificate shall have been duly authenticated and delivered
hereunder.  All Certificates shall be dated the date of their authentication.

         Section 3.05.    Registration of and Limitations on Transfer and
Exchange of Certificates.  The Certificate Registrar shall keep or cause to be
kept, at the office or agency maintained pursuant to Section 3.09, a
Certificate Register in which, subject to such reasonable regulations as it may
prescribe, the Issuer shall provide for the registration of Certificates and of
transfers and exchanges of Certificates as herein provided.  The Bank of New
York shall be the initial Certificate Registrar.

         Subject to satisfaction of the conditions set forth below and to the
provisions of Section 3.11 with respect to the Desig-





                                       9
<PAGE>   15

nated Certificate, upon surrender for registration of transfer of any
Certificate at the office or agency maintained pursuant to Section 3.09, the
Issuer shall execute, authenticate and deliver (or shall cause The Bank of New
York as its authenticating agent to authenticate and deliver) in the name of
the designated transferee or transferees, one or more new Certificates in
authorized denominations of a like aggregate amount dated the date of
authentication by the Owner Trustee or any authenticating agent.  At the option
of a Holder, Certificates may be exchanged for other Certificates of authorized
denominations of a like aggregate amount upon surrender of the Certificates to
be exchanged at the office or agency maintained pursuant to Section 3.09.

         Every Certificate presented or surrendered for registration of
transfer or exchange shall be accompanied by a written instrument of transfer
in form satisfactory to the Certificate Registrar duly executed by the Holder
or such Holder's attorney duly authorized in writing.  Each Certificate
surrendered for registration of transfer or exchange shall be cancelled and
subsequently disposed of by the Certificate Registrar in accordance with its
customary practice.

         No service charge shall be made for any registration of transfer or
exchange of Certificates, but the Owner Trustee or the Certificate Registrar
may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or governmental charge
that may be imposed in connection with any transfer or exchange of
Certificates.

         No transfer of a Certificate shall be made unless such transfer is
exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act and any
applicable state securities laws or is made in accordance with said Act and
laws.  In the event of any such transfer, the Certificate Registrar or the
Seller shall require the transferee to execute (i) (a) an investment letter (in
substantially the form attached hereto as Exhibit D) in form and substance
reasonably satisfactory to the Certificate Registrar and the Seller certifying
to the Issuer, the Owner Trustee, the Certificate Registrar and the Seller that
such transferee is a "qualified institutional buyer" under Rule 144A under the
Securities Act, or (b) an investment letter (in substantially the form attached
hereto as Exhibit G), acceptable to and in form and substance reasonably
satisfactory to the Certificate Registrar, which investment letters shall not
be an expense of the Issuer, the Owner Trustee, the Certificate Registrar, the
Servicer or the Seller and (ii) the Certificate of Non-Foreign Status (in
substantially the form attached hereto as Exhibit F) acceptable to and in form
and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Certificate Registrar, which
certificate shall not be an expense of the Issuer, the Owner Trustee, the
Certificate Registrar, the Servicer, the Administrator or the Seller.  The
Holder of a Certificate desiring to effect such transfer shall, and does hereby
agree to, indemnify the Issuer, the Owner Trustee, the





                                       10
<PAGE>   16

Certificate Registrar, the Servicer and the Seller against any liability that
may result if the transfer is not so exempt or is not made in accordance with
such federal and state laws.

         No transfer of a Certificate shall be made unless the Certificate
Registrar shall have received either (i) a representation letter from the
proposed transferee of such Certificate to the effect that such proposed
transferee is not an employee benefit plan subject to the fiduciary
responsibility provisions of ERISA, or Section 4975 of the Code, or a Person
acting on behalf of any such plan or using the assets of any such plan, or if
the proposed transferee is an insurance company, a representation that the
proposed transferee is an insurance company which is purchasing such
certificates with funds contained in an "insurance company general account" (as
such term is defined in section v(e) of prohibited transaction class exemption
95-60 ("ptce 95-60")) and that the purchase and holding of such certificates
are covered under ptce 95- 60, which representation letter shall not be an
expense of the Issuer, Owner Trustee, the Certificate Registrar, the Servicer
or the Seller or (ii) in the case of any such certificate presented for
registration in the name of an employee benefit plan subject to the fiduciary
responsibility provisions of ERISA, or Section 4975 of the Code (or comparable
provisions of any subsequent enactments), or a trustee of any such plan, or any
other Person who is using the assets of any such plan to effect such
acquisition, an Opinion of Counsel, in form and substance reasonably
satisfactory to, and addressed and delivered to, the Issuer, the Certificate
Registrar and the Seller, to the effect that the purchase or holding of such
Certificate will not result in the assets of the Owner Trust Estate being
deemed to be "plan assets" and subject to the fiduciary responsibility
provisions of ERISA or the prohibited transaction provisions of the Code, will
not constitute or result in a prohibited transaction within the meaning of
Section 406 or Section 407 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code, and will not
subject the Issuer, the Owner Trustee, the Certificate Registrar, the Servicer
or the Seller to any obligation or liability (including obligations or
liabilities under ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code) in addition to those
explicitly undertaken in this Trust Agreement which Opinion of Counsel shall
not be an expense of the Issuer, the Owner Trustee, the Certificate Registrar,
the Servicer or Seller.

         The Certificates shall not be listed for trading on an established
securities market, nor be readily tradeable on a secondary market, nor be
transferrable through the substantial equivalent of a secondary market, nor
shall the Issuer be permitted to have more than 100 partners, for income tax
purposes, all within the meaning of Code Section 7704, and its attendant
regulations, as applicable.  If requested, in the discretion of the Seller,
transfer of a Certificate shall be made only if accompanied by an Opinion of
Counsel satisfactory to the Owner Trustee, which Opinion of Counsel shall not
be an expense





                                       11
<PAGE>   17

of the Issuer, the Owner Trustee, the Servicer or the Seller, to the effect
such transfer will not cause the Issuer to be a publicly traded partnership
taxable as a corporation and will not cause the termination of the Issuer under
the federal income tax rules applicable to partnerships.

         Each Certificateholder agrees to provide information to the
Administrator when so requested concerning the beneficial ownership of its
Certificates as necessary for the Issuer to assure its compliance with the
requirements for avoiding taxation at the entity level as a publicly traded
partnership or otherwise.  Each Certificateholder agrees to restrict the
transfer of record ownership and beneficial ownership of its Certificates as
requested by the Administrator based upon applicable governmental regulation,
rulings or notices and any judicial decisions as may exist from time to time,
as necessary or advisable for avoiding the Issuer's treatment as a
publicly-traded partnership taxable as a corporation, or its termination for
federal income tax purposes under Code Section 708.

         Section 3.06.    Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen Certificates.
If (a) any mutilated Certificate shall be surrendered to the Certificate
Registrar, or if the Certificate Registrar shall receive evidence to its
satisfaction of the destruction, loss or theft of any Certificate and (b) there
shall be delivered to the Issuer, the Certificate Registrar and the Owner
Trustee such security or indemnity as may be required by them to save each of
them harmless, then in the absence of notice that such Certificate has been
acquired by a bona fide purchaser, the Owner Trustee on behalf of the Issuer
shall execute and the Owner Trustee or The Bank of New York, as the Issuer's
authenticating agent, shall authenticate and deliver, in exchange for or in
lieu of any such mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Certificate, a new
Certificate of like tenor and denomination.  In connection with the issuance of
any new Certificate under this Section 3.06, the Owner Trustee or the
Certificate Registrar may require the payment of a sum sufficient to cover any
tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in connection therewith.
Any duplicate Certificate issued pursuant to this Section 3.06 shall constitute
conclusive evidence of ownership in the Issuer, as if originally issued,
whether or not the lost, stolen or destroyed Certificate shall be found at any
time.

         Section 3.07.    Persons Deemed Certificateholders.  Prior to due
presentation of a Certificate for registration of transfer, the Owner Trustee,
the Certificate Registrar or any Certificate Paying Agent may treat the Person
in whose name any Certificate is registered in the Certificate Register as the
owner of such Certificate for the purpose of receiving distributions pursuant
to Section 5.02 and for all other purposes whatsoever, and none of the Issuer,
the Owner Trustee, the Certificate Registrar or any Paying Agent shall be bound
by any notice to the contrary.





                                       12
<PAGE>   18

         Section 3.08.    Access to List of Certificateholders' Names and
Addresses.  The Certificate Registrar shall furnish or cause to be furnished to
the Seller or the Owner Trustee, within 15 days after receipt by the
Certificate Registrar of a written request therefor from the Seller or the
Owner Trustee, a list, in such form as the Seller or the Owner Trustee, as the
case may be, may reasonably require, of the names and addresses of the
Certificateholders as of the most recent Record Date.  If three or more
Certificateholders or one or more Holders of Certificates representing not less
than 25% of the Security Balance of the Certificates apply in writing to the
Certificate Registrar, and such application states that the applicants desire
to communicate with other Certificateholders with respect to their rights under
the Basic Documents or under the Certificates and such application is
accompanied by a copy of the communication that such applicants propose to
transmit, then the Certificate Registrar shall, within five Business Days after
the receipt of such application, afford such applicants access during normal
business hours to the current list of Certificateholders.  Each Holder, by
receiving and holding a Certificate, shall be deemed to have agreed not to hold
any of the Issuer, the Seller, the Holder of the Designated Certificate, the
holder of the Holdback Amount, the Certificate Registrar or the Owner Trustee
accountable by reason of the disclosure of its name and address, regardless of
the source from which such information was derived.

         Section 3.09.    Maintenance of Office or Agency.  The Certificate
Registrar, on behalf of the Issuer, shall maintain in the city of New York, an
office or offices or agency or agencies where Certificates may be surrendered
for registration of transfer or exchange and where notices and demands to or
upon the Owner Trustee in respect of the Certificates and the Basic Documents
may be served.  The Issuer initially designates the Corporate Trust Office of
the Indenture Trustee as its office for such purposes.  The Certificate
Registrar shall give prompt written notice to the Seller, the Owner Trustee,
the Holder of the Designated Certificate and the Certificateholders of any
change in the location of the Certificate Register or any such office or
agency.  The Certificate Registrar shall immediately furnish to the Owner
Trustee any notices or demands to the Owner Trustee received by the Certificate
Registrar at the office maintained by it pursuant to this Section.

         Section 3.10.    Certificate Paying Agent.  The Certificate Paying
Agent shall make distributions to Certificateholders from the Payment Account
pursuant to Section 3.05 of the Indenture.  The Issuer may revoke such power
and remove the Certificate Paying Agent if the Administrator determines in its
sole discretion that the Certificate Paying Agent shall have failed to perform
its obligations under this Trust Agreement or as set forth in Section 3.03 of
the Indenture in any material respect; provided, at the time of such removal,
the Paying Agent shall also be removed by the Issuer under the Indenture.  The
Bank of





                                       13
<PAGE>   19

New York shall be permitted to resign as Certificate Paying Agent upon 30 days
written notice to the Owner Trustee; provided The Bank of New York is also
resigning as Paying Agent under the Indenture at such time.  In the event that
The Bank of New York shall no longer be the Certificate Paying Agent and Paying
Agent under the Indenture, the Administrator shall appoint a successor to act
as Certificate Paying Agent (which shall be a bank or trust company) and which
shall also be the successor Paying Agent under the Indenture.  The
Administrator shall cause such successor Certificate Paying Agent or any
additional Certificate Paying Agent appointed by the Administrator to execute
and deliver to the Owner Trustee an instrument to the effect set forth in
Section 3.03 of the Indenture as it relates to the Certificate Paying Agent.
The Certificate Paying Agent shall return all unclaimed funds to the Issuer and
upon removal of a Certificate Paying Agent such Certificate Paying Agent shall
also return all funds in its possession to the Issuer.  The provisions of
Sections 7.01, 7.03, 7.04 and 8.01 shall apply to the Certificate Paying Agent
to the extent applicable.  Any reference in this Agreement to the Certificate
Paying Agent shall include any co-paying agent unless the context requires
otherwise.

         Section 3.11.    Ownership by HCLC.  (a)  HCLC shall receive on the
Closing Date, in partial consideration for the transfer of the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest, a Certificate representing at least 1% of the Initial
Principal Balance of the Certificates (the "Designated Certificate") and the
right to the entire payment stream represented by the Holdback Amount.  The
Owner Trustee shall cause the Designated Certificate and any Successor
Designated Certificate created pursuant to Section 9.02 to contain a legend
stating "THIS CERTIFICATE IS NOT TRANSFERABLE EXCEPT UPON SATISFACTION OF THE
CONDITIONS IN SECTION 3.11(b) OF THE TRUST AGREEMENT."  For purposes of the
Business Trust Statute, the Designated Certificate and any Successor Designated
Certificate shall be deemed to be a separate class of Certificates from all
other Certificates issued by the Issuer; provided that the rights and
obligations evidenced by all Certificates, regardless of class, shall, except
as provided in this Section, be identical.

         (b)     The Designated Certificate and Holdback Amount shall, for
income and franchise tax purposes, be treated as the general partnership
interest of the Issuer.  The Designated Certificate shall at all times
represent an investment in the Issuer of not less than 1.00% of the capital
represented by all Certificates.  The Designated Certificate and Holdback
Amount shall not be separately transferable.  HCLC may transfer the Designated
Certificate to an Affiliate of HCLC if, (a) the applicable provisions of
Section 3.05 are satisfied and (b) the Certificate Registrar receives an
Opinion of Counsel to the effect that the transfer of the Designated
Certificate shall not cause the Issuer to be subject to an entity level tax.
Otherwise, HCLC may transfer the Designated Certificate if, (a) the conditions
in





                                       14
<PAGE>   20

clauses (a) and (b) in the preceding sentence are satisfied, (b) a majority in
interest by Security Balance of the Certificates (exclusive of the Designated
Certificate) approves such transfer, which will not be unreasonably withheld,
and (c) the Rating Agencies shall consent to such transfer.

         Section 3.12.    RESERVED

         Section 3.13.  Optional Repurchase of the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest.  (a)  The Seller may, with 10 days prior written notice to the Owner
Trustee, Servicer and the Indenture Trustee, purchase the entire Series 1996-2
Participation Interest, on any Payment Date in which the Aggregate Security
Balance is equal to or less than ten percent of the initial Aggregate Security
Balance.  The Seller shall deposit into the Payment Account on the Business Day
prior to the Payment Date on which such purchase is to occur, an amount equal
to the principal balance of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest and the
amount of interest and Certificate Yield to be distributed to the Security
holders pursuant to Section 3.05(a) of the Indenture as of such Payment Date.





                                       15
<PAGE>   21

                                   ARTICLE IV

                            Actions by Owner Trustee

         Section 4.01.    Prior Notice to Certificateholders with Respect to
Certain Matters.  With respect to the following matters, the Owner Trustee
shall not take action unless at least 30 days before the taking of such action,
the Owner Trustee shall have notified the Certificateholders in writing of the
proposed action and the Certificateholders shall not have notified the Owner
Trustee in writing prior to the 30th day after such notice is given that such
Certificateholders have withheld consent or provided alternative direction:

         (a)     the initiation of any claim or lawsuit by the Issuer (except
claims or lawsuits brought in connection with the collection of the Series
1996-2 Participation Interest) and the compromise of any action, claim or
lawsuit brought by or against the Issuer (except with respect to the
aforementioned claims or lawsuits for collection of the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest);

         (b)     the election by the Issuer to file an amendment to the
Certificate of Trust (unless such amendment is required to be filed under the
Business Trust Statute);

         (c)     the amendment of the Indenture by a supplemental indenture in
circumstances where the consent of any Noteholder is required;

         (d)     (i) the amendment of the Indenture by a supplemental indenture
in circumstances where the consent of any Noteholder is not required and such
amendment materially adversely affects the interest of the Certificateholders
or (ii) the amendment of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement under
circumstances where the consent of the holder of Series Participation Interests
is required;

         (e)     the amendment, change or modification of the Administration
Agreement, except to cure any ambiguity or to amend or supplement any provision
in a manner or add any provision that would not materially adversely affect the
interests of the Certificateholders; or

         (f)     the appointment pursuant to the Indenture of a successor Note
Registrar, Paying Agent or Indenture Trustee or pursuant to this Trust
Agreement of a successor Certificate Registrar, Certificate Paying Agent or
Administrator or the consent to the assignment by the Note Registrar, Paying
Agent, Indenture Trustee, Certificate Registrar, Certificate Paying Agent or
Administrator of its obligations under the Indenture or this Trust Agreement,
as applicable.





                                       16
<PAGE>   22

         Section 4.02.    Action by Certificateholders with Respect to Certain
Matters.  The Owner Trustee shall not have the power, except upon the direction
of the Certificateholders, to (a) remove the Administrator under the
Administration Agreement pursuant to Section 8 thereof, (b) appoint a successor
Administrator pursuant to Section 8 of the Administration Agreement, (c) remove
the Servicer under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement pursuant to Article X
thereof or (d) except as expressly provided in the Basic Documents, sell the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest after the termination of the Indenture.
The Owner Trustee shall take the actions referred to in the preceding sentence
only upon written instructions signed by the Certificateholders.

         Section 4.03.    Action by Certificateholders with Respect to
Bankruptcy.  The Owner Trustee shall not have the power to commence a voluntary
proceeding in bankruptcy relating to the Issuer without the unanimous prior
approval of all Certificateholders and the delivery to the Owner Trustee by
each such Certificateholder of a certificate certifying that such
Certificateholder reasonably believes that the Issuer is insolvent.

         Section 4.04.    Restrictions on Certificateholders' Power.  The
Certificateholders shall not direct the Owner Trustee to take or to refrain
from taking any action if such action or inaction would be contrary to any
obligation of the Issuer or the Owner Trustee under this Trust Agreement or any
of the Basic Documents or would be contrary to Section 2.03, nor shall the
Owner Trustee be obligated to follow any such direction, if given.

         Section 4.05.    Majority Control.  Except as expressly provided
herein, any action that may be taken by the Certificateholders under this Trust
Agreement may be taken by the Holders of Certificates evidencing not less than
a majority of the outstanding Security Balance of the Certificates.  Except as
expressly provided herein, any written notice of the Certificateholders
delivered pursuant to this Trust Agreement shall be effective if signed by
Holders of Certificates evidencing not less than a majority of the outstanding
Security Balance of the Certificates at the time of the delivery of such
notice.





                                       17
<PAGE>   23

                                   ARTICLE V

                           Application of Trust Funds

         Section 5.01.  Distributions.  (a)  On each Payment Date, the
Certificate Paying Agent shall distribute out of the Payment Account to the
extent of funds on deposit therein and available therefor, distributions on the
Certificates and in payment of the Holdback Amount as provided in Section 3.05
of the Indenture.

         (b)     In the event that any withholding tax is imposed on the
distributions (or allocations of income) to a Certificateholder, such tax shall
reduce the amount otherwise distributable to the Certificateholder in
accordance with Section 3.05 of the Indenture.  The Certificate Paying Agent is
hereby authorized and directed to retain or cause to be retained from amounts
otherwise distributable to the Certificateholders sufficient funds for the
payment of any tax that is legally owed by the Issuer (but such authorization
shall not prevent the Issuer or the effected Certificateholder with the consent
of the Designated Certificateholder), from contesting any such tax in
appropriate proceedings, and withholding payment of such tax, if permitted by
law, pending the outcome of such proceedings).  The amount of any withholding
tax imposed with respect to a Certificateholder shall be treated as cash
distributed to such Certificateholder at the time it is withheld by the
Certificate Paying Agent and remitted to the appropriate taxing authority.  If
there is a possibility that withholding tax is payable with respect to a
distribution (such as a distribution to a non-U.S. Certificateholder), the
Certificate Paying Agent may in its sole discretion withhold such amounts in
accordance with this paragraph (b).

         (c)     All calculations of the Certificate Yield on the Certificates
shall be made on the basis of the actual number of days in an Interest Period
and a year assumed to consist of 360 days.

         Section 5.02.    Method of Payment.  Subject to Section 9.01(c),
distributions required to be made to Certificateholders on any Payment Date as
provided in Section 3.05 of the Indenture shall be made to each
Certificateholder of record on the preceding Record Date either by, in the case
of any Certificateholder owning Certificates, other than the Designated
Certificate, having denominations aggregating at least $1,000,000, wire
transfer, in immediately available funds, to the account of such Holder at a
bank or other entity having appropriate facilities therefor, if such
Certificateholder shall have provided to the Certificate Registrar appropriate
written instructions at least five Business Days prior to such Payment Date or,
if not, by check mailed to such Certificateholder at the address of such Holder
appearing in the Certificate Register.  All distributions in respect of the
initial Designated Certificate and the Holdback Amount shall be made to HCLC,
the initial Holder of the Designated Certificate or





                                       18
<PAGE>   24

its permitted transferee, as the case may be, by wire transfer, in immediately
available funds, to the account of such entity at a bank or other entity having
appropriate facilities therefor, as specified in written instructions to the
Certificate Paying Agent on the fifth Business Day prior to the first Payment
Date.

         Section 5.03.  Signature on Returns.  The Holder of the Designated
Certificate shall sign on behalf of the Issuer the tax returns of the Issuer.

         Section 5.04.  Statements to Certificateholders.  No later than the
second Business Day prior to each Payment Date, the Owner Trustee on behalf of
the Issuer shall deliver to the Certificate Paying Agent and the Indenture
Trustee the Monthly Security Report for such Payment Date prepared by the
Administrator substantially in the form set forth on Exhibit B to the
Indenture.  On each Payment Date, the Certificate Paying Agent shall send to
each Certificateholder the statement or statements provided to the Owner
Trustee, the Certificate Paying Agent and the Indenture Trustee by the Servicer
pursuant to Article V of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement with respect to
such Payment Date.

         Section 5.05.  Tax Reporting; Tax Elections.  The Holder of the
Designated Certificate shall cause the Issuer to file federal and state income
tax returns and information statements as a partnership for each of its taxable
years.  Within 90 days after the end of each calendar year, the Holder of the
Designated Certificate shall cause the Issuer to provide to each
Certificateholder an Internal Revenue Service form "K- 1" or any successor
schedule and supplemental information, if required by law, to enable each
Certificateholder to file its federal and state income tax returns.  The Holder
of the Designated Certificate may from time to time make and revoke such tax
elections with respect to the Issuer as it deems necessary or desirable in its
sole discretion to carry out the business of the Issuer or the purposes of this
Trust Agreement if permitted by applicable law.  Notwithstanding the foregoing,
an election under Section 754 of the Code shall not be made without the written
consent of the Holder of the Designated Certificate, which consent shall be
given in the sole discretion of the Holder of the Designated Certificate.  The
Holder of the Designated Certificate shall serve as tax matters partner for the
Issuer.

         Section 5.06.    Capital Accounts.  Separate capital accounts shall be
maintained for each Certificateholder in accordance with tax accounting
principles.  Each such account shall initially equal the amount paid to the
Issuer by the Certificateholder for its Certificate and shall be (i) increased
by the distributive share of profits and capital gains of such
Certificateholder, and (ii) decreased by the amount of any cash and the fair
market value of any non-cash assets distributed to such Certificate-





                                       19
<PAGE>   25

holder by the Issuer pursuant to this Agreement, and by such
Certificateholder's distributive share of losses.

         The fiscal year of the Issuer shall end on the 31st day of December in
each year, unless otherwise required by the Code.  For each fiscal year of the
Issuer, net profits shall be allocated among the Certificateholders (including
the holder of the Designated Certificate to which the payments in respect of
the Holdback Amount will be made to the extent possible) in such manner as to
cause their ending capital accounts (prior to any reduction for distributions
for such year and to the extent possible) to reflect their respective rights to
current and future distributions with respect to income and the return of their
investment.  Such allocation shall be made to the Certificateholders in the
order of their right to such distributions and proportionately among
Certificateholders having equal priority.  For each fiscal year of the Issuer,
net losses shall be allocated among the Certificateholders in such manner as to
reflect the order and amount in which they would respectively bear the economic
burden of such losses, and then in accordance with their relative Percentage
Interests.

         The partnership tax returns of the Issuer shall be prepared in such a
manner as to fairly reflect the respective interest in the Issuer of each
Certificateholder in accordance with the principles of the regulations under
Code Section 704(b).  Items of income and gain shall be allocated in proportion
to the overall allocation of income to each Certificateholder, and items of
loss, expense and deduction shall be allocated in proportion to the overall
allocation of loss to each Certificateholder.  Any unexpected adjustments,
allocations or distributions shall be offset by allocations of items of income
and gain as quickly as possible in accordance with the qualified income offset
provisions of the Code Section 704(b) regulations.

         If during any fiscal year of the Issuer there is a change in any
Certificateholder's interest as a result of the issuance, transfer or
redemption of any Certificates, profits and losses shall be allocated among the
Certificateholders so as to reflect their varying interest in the Issuer during
the period.  The allocation shall be made using the "interim closing of the
books" method or any other method permissible under Code Section 706 selected
by the Administrator.  The Administrator shall determine when any transferee of
a Certificate shall be deemed admitted to the "partnership" for federal income
tax purposes.  Any transferee shall succeed to that portion of the assignor's
capital account attributable to the interest so transferred.

         The maintenance of capital accounts by the Issuer is solely for the
preparation of its income tax returns, and is not intended to confer rights
upon any third parties.  No Certificateholder shall have, by reason of its
capital account, any right to demand or receive any property or cash from the
Issuer





                                       20
<PAGE>   26

or any obligation to contribute such items to the Issuer.  No creditor of the
Issuer shall be deemed a third party beneficiary of any obligation of any
Certificateholder by reason of its capital account to contribute capital or
make loans or advances to the Issuer.





                                       21
<PAGE>   27

                                   ARTICLE VI

                     Authority and Duties of Owner Trustee

         Section 6.01.    General Authority.  The Owner Trustee is authorized
and directed to execute and deliver the Basic Documents to which the Issuer is
to be a party and each certificate or other document attached as an exhibit to
or contemplated by the Basic Documents to which the Issuer is to be a party and
any amendment or other agreement or instrument described herein, in each case,
in such form as the Administrator shall approve, as evidenced conclusively by
the Owner Trustee's execution thereof.  In addition to the foregoing, the Owner
Trustee is authorized, but shall not be obligated, to take all actions required
of the Issuer pursuant to the Basic Documents.  The Owner Trustee is further
authorized from time to time to take such action as the Administrator directs
with respect to the Basic Documents.

         Section 6.02.    General Duties.  It shall be the duty of the Owner
Trustee to discharge (or cause to be discharged) all of its responsibilities
pursuant to the terms of this Trust Agreement and the Basic Documents to which
the Issuer is a party and to administer the Issuer in the interest of the
Certificateholders, subject to the Basic Documents and in accordance with the
provisions of this Trust Agreement.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Owner
Trustee shall be deemed to have discharged its duties and responsibilities
hereunder and under the Basic Documents to the extent the Administrator has
agreed in the Administration Agreement to perform such acts or to discharge
such duties of the Owner Trustee or the Issuer hereunder or under any Basic
Document, and the Owner Trustee shall not be held liable for the default or
failure of the Administrator to carry out its obligations under the
Administration Agreement.  The Designated Certificateholder may delegate its
duties hereunder, provided, however, that such delegation of duties shall not
relieve the Designated Certificateholder of its obligations hereunder.

         Section 6.03.    Action upon Instruction.  (a)     Unless the Owner
Trustee has actual knowledge that an Insolvency Event or breach of
representation or violation of any material obligation under the Basic
Documents has occurred in respect of the Designated Certificateholder or of any
Affiliate thereof, the Designated Certificateholder may by written instruction
direct the Owner Trustee in the management of the Issuer.  In the event the
Owner Trustee has actual knowledge that an Insolvency Event or breach of
representation or violation of any material obligation under the Basic
Documents has occurred in respect of the Designated Certificateholder or any
Affiliate thereof, the Certificateholders may by written instruction direct the
Owner Trustee in the management of the Issuer.  Such direction may be exercised
at any time by written instruction of the Designated Certificateholder or the
Certificateholders as the case may be pursuant to Article IV.





                                       22
<PAGE>   28


         (b)     The Owner Trustee shall not be required to take any action
hereunder or under any Basic Document if the Owner Trustee shall have
reasonably determined, or shall have been advised by counsel, that such action
is likely to result in liability on the part of the Owner Trustee or is
contrary to the terms hereof or of any Basic Document or is otherwise contrary
to law.

         (c)     Whenever the Owner Trustee is unable to decide between
alternative courses of action permitted or required by the terms of this Trust
Agreement or under any Basic Document, the Owner Trustee shall promptly give
notice (in such form as shall be appropriate under the circumstances) to the
Certificateholders requesting instruction as to the course of action to be
adopted, and to the extent the Owner Trustee acts in good faith in accordance
with any written instruction of the Certificateholders received, the Owner
Trustee shall not be liable on account of such action to any Person.  If the
Owner Trustee shall not have received appropriate instruction within 10 days of
such notice (or within such shorter period of time as reasonably may be
specified in such notice or may be necessary under the circumstances) it may,
but shall be under no duty to, take or refrain from taking such action not
inconsistent with this Trust Agreement or the Basic Documents, as it shall deem
to be in the best interests of the Certificateholders, and shall have no
liability to any Person for such action or inaction.

         (d)     In the event that the Owner Trustee is unsure as to the
application of any provision of this Trust Agreement or any Basic Document or
any such provision is ambiguous as to its application, or is, or appears to be,
in conflict with any other applicable provision, or in the event that this
Trust Agreement permits any determination by the Owner Trustee or is silent or
is incomplete as to the course of action that the Owner Trustee is required to
take with respect to a particular set of facts, the Owner Trustee may give
notice (in such form as shall be appropriate under the circumstances) to the
Certificateholders requesting instruction and, to the extent that the Owner
Trustee acts or refrains from acting in good faith in accordance with any such
instruction received, the Owner Trustee shall not be liable, on account of such
action or inaction, to any Person.  If the Owner Trustee shall not have
received appropriate instruction within 10 days of such notice (or within such
shorter period of time as reasonably may be specified in such notice or may be
necessary under the circumstances) it may, but shall be under no duty to, take
or refrain from taking such action not inconsistent with this Trust Agreement
or the Basic Documents, as it shall deem to be in the best interests of the
Certificateholders, and shall have no liability to any Person for such action
or inaction.

         Section 6.04.    No Duties Except as Specified in this Trust Agreement
or in Instructions.  The Owner Trustee shall not have any duty or obligation to
manage, make any payment with respect





                                       23
<PAGE>   29

to, register, record, sell, dispose of, or otherwise deal with the Owner Trust
Estate, or to otherwise take or refrain from taking any action under, or in
connection with, any document contemplated hereby to which the Owner Trustee is
a party, except as expressly provided by the terms of this Trust Agreement or
in any document or written instruction received by the Owner Trustee pursuant
to Section 6.03; and no implied duties or obligations shall be read into this
Trust Agreement or any Basic Document against the Owner Trustee.  The Owner
Trustee shall have no responsibility for filing any financing or continuation
statement in any public office at any time or to otherwise perfect or maintain
the perfection of any security interest or lien granted to it hereunder or to
prepare or file any Securities and Exchange Commission filing for the Trust or
to record this Trust Agreement or any Basic Document.  The Owner Trustee
nevertheless agrees that it will, at its own cost and expense, promptly take
all action as may be necessary to discharge any liens on any part of the Owner
Trust Estate that result from actions by, or claims against, the Owner Trustee
that are not related to the ownership or the administration of the Owner Trust
Estate.

         Section 6.05.    No Action Except Under Specified Documents or
Instructions.  The Owner Trustee shall not manage, control, use, sell, dispose
of or otherwise deal with any part of the Owner Trust Estate except (1) in
accordance with the powers granted to and the authority conferred upon the
Owner Trustee pursuant to this Trust Agreement, (2) in accordance with the
Basic Documents and (3) in accordance with any document or instruction
delivered to the Owner Trustee pursuant to Section 6.03.

         Section 6.06.    Restrictions.  The Owner Trustee shall not take any
action (i) that is inconsistent with the purposes of the Issuer set forth in
Section 2.03 or (ii) that, to the actual knowledge of the Owner Trustee, would
result in the Issuer becoming taxable as a corporation for federal income tax
purposes.  The Certificateholders shall not direct the Owner Trustee to take
action that would violate the provisions of this Section 6.06.





                                       24
<PAGE>   30

                                  ARTICLE VII

                          Concerning the Owner Trustee

         Section 7.01.    Acceptance of Trusts and Duties.  The Owner Trustee
accepts the trust hereby created and agrees to perform its duties hereunder
with respect to such trusts but only upon the terms of this Trust Agreement.
The Owner Trustee and the Certificate Paying Agent also agree to disburse all
moneys actually received by it constituting part of the Owner Trust Estate upon
the terms of the Basic Documents and this Trust Agreement.  The Owner Trustee
shall not be answerable or accountable hereunder or under any Basic Document
under any circumstances, except (i) for its own willful misconduct, negligence
or bad faith or (ii) in the case of the inaccuracy of any representation or
warranty contained in Section 7.03 expressly made by the Owner Trustee.  In
particular, but not by way of limitation (and subject to the exceptions set
forth in the preceding sentence):

         (a)     The Owner Trustee shall not be liable for any error of
judgment made by a responsible officer of the Owner Trustee;

         (b)     The Owner Trustee shall not be liable with respect to any
action taken or omitted to be taken by it in accordance with the instructions
of the Administrator, Holder of the Designated Certificate or the
Certificateholders;

         (c)     No provision of this Trust Agreement or any Basic Document
shall require the Owner Trustee to expend or risk funds or otherwise incur any
financial liability in the performance of any of its rights, duties or powers
hereunder or under any Basic Document if the Owner Trustee shall have
reasonable grounds for believing that repayment of such funds or adequate
indemnity against such risk or liability is not reasonably assured or provided
to it;

         (d)     Under no circumstances shall the Owner Trustee be liable for
indebtedness evidenced by or arising under any of the Basic Documents,
including the principal of and interest on the Notes;

         (e)     The Owner Trustee shall not be responsible for or in respect
of the validity or sufficiency of this Trust Agreement or for the due execution
hereof by the Seller or the Holder of the Designated Certificate or for the
form, character, genuineness, sufficiency, value or validity of any of the
Owner Trust Estate, or for or in respect of the validity or sufficiency of the
Basic Documents, other than the certificate of authentication on the
Certificates, if executed by the Owner Trustee and the Owner Trustee shall in
no event assume or incur any liability, duty, or obligation to any Noteholder
or to any Certificateholder, other





                                       25
<PAGE>   31

than as expressly provided for herein or expressly agreed to in the Basic
Documents;

         (f)     The Owner Trustee shall not be liable for the default or
misconduct of the Administrator, the Certificate Paying Agent, the Certificate
Registrar, the Holder of the Designated Certificate, the Seller, Indenture
Trustee or the Servicer under any of the Basic Documents or otherwise and the
Owner Trustee shall have no obligation or liability to perform the obligations
of the Issuer under this Trust Agreement or the Basic Documents that are
required to be performed by the Administrator under the Administration
Agreement, the Indenture Trustee, the Certificate Paying Agent, the Certificate
Registrar under the Trust Agreement or the Indenture or the Seller under the
Receivables Purchase Agreement; and

         (g)     The Owner Trustee shall be under no obligation to exercise any
of the rights or powers vested in it or duties imposed by this Trust Agreement,
or to institute, conduct or defend any litigation under this Trust Agreement or
otherwise or in relation to this Trust Agreement or any Basic Document, at the
request, order or direction of any of the Certificateholders, unless such
Certificateholders have offered to the Owner Trustee security or indemnity
satisfactory to it against the costs, expenses and liabilities that may be
incurred by the Owner Trustee therein or thereby.  The right of the Owner
Trustee to perform any discretionary act enumerated in this Trust Agreement or
in any Basic Document shall not be construed as a duty, and the Owner Trustee
shall not be answerable for other than its negligence or willful misconduct in
the performance of any such act.

         Section 7.02.    Furnishing of Documents.  The Issuer shall furnish to
the Certificateholders promptly upon receipt of a written reasonable request
therefor, duplicates or copies of all reports, notices, requests, demands,
certificates, financial statements and any other instruments furnished to the
Issuer under the Basic Documents.

         Section 7.03.    Representations and Warranties.  The Owner Trustee
hereby represents and warrants to the Seller, for the benefit of the
Certificateholders, that:

         (a)     It is a banking corporation duly organized and validly
existing in good standing under the laws of the State of Delaware.  It has all
requisite corporate power and authority to execute, deliver and perform its
obligations under this Trust Agreement.

         (b)     It has taken all corporate action necessary to authorize the
execution and delivery by it of this Trust Agreement, and this Trust Agreement
will be executed and delivered by one of its officers who is duly authorized to
execute and deliver this Trust Agreement on its behalf.





                                       26
<PAGE>   32


         (c)     Neither the execution nor the delivery by it of this Trust
Agreement, nor the consummation by it of the transactions contemplated hereby
nor compliance by it with any of the terms or provisions hereof will contravene
any federal or Delaware law, governmental rule or regulation governing the
banking or trust powers of the Owner Trustee or any judgment or order binding
on it, or constitute any default under its charter documents or bylaws or any
indenture, mortgage, contract, agreement or instrument to which it is a party
or by which any of its properties may be bound.

         Section 7.04.    Reliance; Advice of Counsel.  (a)  The Owner Trustee
shall incur no liability to anyone in acting upon any signature, instrument,
notice, resolution, request, consent, order, certificate, report, opinion,
bond, or other document or paper believed by it to be genuine and believed by
it to be signed by the proper party or parties. The Owner Trustee may accept a
certified copy of a resolution of the board of directors or other governing
body of any corporate party as conclusive evidence that such resolution has
been duly adopted by such body and that the same is in full force and effect.
As to any fact or matter the method of determination of which is not
specifically prescribed herein, the Owner Trustee may for all purposes hereof
rely on a certificate, signed by the president or any vice president or by the
treasurer or any assistant treasurer or other authorized officers of the
relevant party, as to such fact or matter and such certificate shall constitute
full protection to the Owner Trustee for any action taken or omitted to be
taken by it in good faith in reliance thereon.

         (b)     In the exercise or administration of the trusts hereunder and
in the performance of its duties and obligations under this Trust Agreement or
the Basic Documents, the Owner Trustee (1) may act directly or through its
agents, attorneys or administrators pursuant to agreements entered into with
any of them, and the Owner Trustee shall not be liable for the conduct or
misconduct of such agents or attorneys if such agents or attorneys shall have
been selected by the Owner Trustee with reasonable care, and (2) may consult
with counsel, accountants and other skilled persons to be selected with
reasonable care and employed by it.  The Owner Trustee shall not be liable for
anything done, suffered or omitted in good faith by it in accordance with the
written opinion or advice of any such counsel, accountants or other such
Persons and not contrary to this Trust Agreement or any Basic Document.

         Section 7.05.    Not Acting in Individual Capacity.  Except as
provided in this Article VII, in accepting the trusts hereby created Chase
Manhattan Bank Delaware acts solely as Owner Trustee hereunder and not in its
individual capacity, and all Persons having any claim against the Owner Trustee
by reason of the transactions contemplated by this Trust Agreement or any Basic





                                       27
<PAGE>   33

Document shall look only to the Owner Trust Estate for payment or satisfaction
thereof.

         Section 7.06.    Owner Trustee Not Liable for Certificates.  The
recitals contained herein and in the Certificates (other than the signatures of
the Owner Trustee on the Certificates) shall be taken as the statements of the
Seller, and the Owner Trustee assumes no responsibility for the correctness
thereof.  The Owner Trustee makes no representations as to the validity or
sufficiency of this Trust Agreement, of any Basic Document or of the
Certificates (other than the signatures of the Owner Trustee on the
Certificates) or the Notes.  The Owner Trustee shall at no time have any
responsibility or liability for or with respect to the sufficiency of the Owner
Trust Estate or its ability to generate the payments to be distributed to
Certificateholders under this Trust Agreement or the Noteholders under the
Indenture, including, the compliance by the Seller with any warranty or
representation made under any Basic Document or in any related document or the
accuracy of any such warranty or representation, or any action of the
Administrator, the Certificate Paying Agent, the Certificate Registrar or the
Indenture Trustee taken in the name of the Owner Trustee.

         Section 7.07.    Owner Trustee May Own Certificates and Notes.  The
Owner Trustee in its individual or any other capacity may become the owner or
pledgee of Certificates or Notes and may deal with the Seller, the Certificate
Paying Agent, the Certificate Registrar, the Administrator and the Indenture
Trustee in banking transactions with the same rights as it would have if it
were not Owner Trustee.





                                       28
<PAGE>   34

                                  ARTICLE VIII

                         Compensation of Owner Trustee

         Section 8.01.    Owner Trustee's Fees and Expenses.  The Owner Trustee
shall receive as compensation for its services hereunder such fees as have been
separately agreed upon before the date hereof, and the Owner Trustee shall be
reimbursed by HCLC, the initial Holder of the Designated Certificate for its
reasonable expenses hereunder and under the Basic Documents, including the
reasonable compensation, expenses and disbursements of such agents,
representatives, experts and outside counsel as the Owner Trustee may
reasonably employ in connection with the exercise and performance of its rights
and its duties hereunder and under the Basic Documents.

         Section 8.02.    Indemnification.  The Holder of the Designated
Certificate shall be liable as primary obligor for, and shall indemnify the
Owner Trustee and its successors, assigns, agents and servants (collectively,
the "Indemnified Parties") from and against, any and all liabilities,
obligations, losses, damages, taxes, claims, actions and suits, and any and all
reasonable costs, expenses and disbursements (including reasonable legal fees
and expenses) of any kind and nature whatsoever (collectively, "Expenses")
which may at any time be imposed on, incurred by, or asserted against the Owner
Trustee or any Indemnified Party in any way relating to or arising out of this
Trust Agreement, the Basic Documents, the Owner Trust Estate, the
administration of the Owner Trust Estate or the action or inaction of the Owner
Trustee hereunder, provided, that:

              (i)  the Holder of the Designated Certificate shall not be
         liable for or required to indemnify an Indemnified Party from and
         against Expenses arising or resulting from the Owner Trustee's willful
         misconduct, negligence or bad faith or as a result of any inaccuracy
         of a representation or warranty contained in Section 7.03 expressly
         made by the Owner Trustee;

             (ii)  with respect to any such claim, the Indemnified Party shall
         have given the Holder of the Designated Certificate written notice
         thereof promptly after the Indemnified Party shall have actual
         knowledge thereof;

            (iii)  while maintaining control over its own defense, the Holder
         of the Designated Certificate shall consult with the Indemnified Party
         in preparing such defense; and

             (iv)  notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary,
         the Holder of the Designated Certificate shall not be liable for
         settlement of any claim by an Indemnified Party entered into without
         the prior consent of the Holder





                                       29
<PAGE>   35

         of the Designated Certificate which consent shall not be unreasonably
         withheld.

         The indemnities contained in this Section shall survive the
resignation or termination of the Owner Trustee or the termination of this
Trust Agreement.  In the event of any claim, action or proceeding for which
indemnity will be sought pursuant to this Section, the Owner Trustee's choice
of legal counsel, if other than the legal counsel retained by the Owner Trustee
in connection with the execution and delivery of this Trust Agreement, shall be
subject to the approval of the Holder of the Designated Certificate, which
approval shall not be unreasonably withheld.  In addition, upon written notice
to the Owner Trustee and with the consent of the Owner Trustee which consent
shall not be unreasonably withheld, the Holder of the Designated Certificate
has the right to assume the defense of any claim, action or proceeding against
the Owner Trustee.





                                       30
<PAGE>   36

                                   ARTICLE IX

                         Termination of Trust Agreement

         Section 9.01.    Termination of Trust Agreement.  (a)  This Trust
Agreement (other than Article VIII) and the Issuer shall terminate and be of no
further force or effect upon the earliest of (i) upon the final distribution of
all moneys or other property or proceeds of the Owner Trust Estate in
accordance with the terms of the Indenture and this Trust Agreement, (ii) the
Payment Date in August 2006 or (iii) at the time provided for in Section 9.02.
The bankruptcy, liquidation, dissolution, death or incapacity of any
Certificateholder, other than the Holder of the Designated Certificate, shall
not (x) operate to terminate this Trust Agreement or the Issuer or (y) entitle
such Certificateholder's legal representatives or heirs to claim an accounting
or to take any action or proceeding in any court for a partition or winding up
of all or any part of the Issuer or the Owner Trust Estate or (z) otherwise
affect the rights, obligations and liabilities of the parties hereto.

         (b)     Except as provided in Section 9.01(a), none of the Seller, the
Holder of the Designated Certificate or any other Certificateholder shall be
entitled to revoke or terminate the Trust.

         (c)     Notice of any termination of the Issuer, specifying the
Payment Date upon which Certificateholders shall surrender their Certificates
to the Certificate Paying Agent for payment of the final distribution and
cancellation, shall be given by the Certificate Paying Agent by letter to
Certificateholders mailed within five Business Days of receipt of notice of
such termination from the Administrator, stating (i) the Payment Date upon or
with respect to which final payment of the Certificates shall be made upon
presentation and surrender of the Certificates at the office of the Certificate
Paying Agent therein designated, (ii) the amount of any such final payment and
(iii) that the Record Date otherwise applicable to such Payment Date is not
applicable, payments being made only upon presentation and surrender of the
Certificates at the office of the Certificate Payment Agent therein specified.
The Certificate Paying Agent shall give such notice to the Owner Trustee and
the Certificate Registrar at the time such notice is given to
Certificateholders.  Upon presentation and surrender of the Certificates, the
Certificate Paying Agent shall cause to be distributed to Certificateholders
amounts distributable on such Payment Date pursuant to Section 5.01.

         In the event that all of the Certificateholders shall not surrender
their Certificates for cancellation within six months after the date specified
in the above mentioned written notice, the Certificate Paying Agent shall give
a second written notice to the remaining Certificateholders to surrender their
Certifi-





                                       31
<PAGE>   37

cates for cancellation and receive the final distribution with respect thereto.
Subject to applicable laws with respect to escheat of funds, if within two
years following the Payment Date on which final payment of the Certificates was
to have been made all the Certificates shall not have been surrendered for
cancellation, the Certificate Paying Agent may take appropriate steps, or may
appoint an agent to take appropriate steps, to contact the remaining
Certificateholders concerning surrender of their Certificates, and the cost
thereof shall be paid out of the funds and other assets that shall remain
subject to this Trust Agreement.  Any funds remaining in the Payment Account
after exhaustion of such remedies shall be distributed by the Certificate
Paying Agent to the Holder of the Designated Certificate.

         (d)     Upon the winding up of the Issuer and its termination, the
Owner Trustee shall cause the Certificate of Trust to be cancelled by filing a
certificate of cancellation with the Secretary of State in accordance with the
provisions of Section 3810(c) of the Business Trust Statute.

         Section 9.02.    Dissolution upon Bankruptcy of the Holder of the
Designated Certificate.  In the event that an Insolvency Event shall occur with
respect to the Holder of the Designated Certificate, this Agreement shall be
terminated in accordance with Section 9.01, 90 days after the date of such
Insolvency Event, unless, before the end of such 90-day period, the Owner
Trustee shall have received written instructions from Holders of Certificates
(other than the Holder of the Designated Certificate) representing more than
50% of the Security Balance of the Certificates (not including the Security
Balance of the Designated Certificate or any other Certificates held by HCLC or
any Affiliate thereof), to the effect that such Holders disapprove of the
termination of the Issuer and have elected or appointed any one of such Holders
or a transferee of Certificates meeting the requisite conditions set forth in
an Opinion of Counsel delivered to the Owner Trustee as a new Designated
Certificateholder (the "Successor Designated Certificateholder") for the
continuation of the tax treatment of the Issuer.  Such Successor Designated
Certificate shall represent at least 1% of the Initial Principal Balance of the
Certificates.  The appointment of a Successor Designated Certificateholder will
not deprive HCLC or its transferee of its economic interest in the Designated
Certificate or Holdback Amount, its Certificates or otherwise in the Owner
Trust Estate.  Promptly after the occurrence of any Insolvency Event with
respect to any Holder of the Designated Certificate (A) the Holder of such
Designated Certificate or Successor Designated Certificate shall give the
Indenture Trustee and the Owner Trustee written notice of such Insolvency
Event, (B) the Owner Trustee shall, upon the receipt of such written notice
from the Holder of such Designated Certificate, give prompt written notice to
the Certificateholders of the occurrence of such event and (C) the Indenture
Trustee shall give prompt written notice of such event to the Noteholders;
provided, however, that any





                                       32
<PAGE>   38

failure to give a notice required by this sentence shall not prevent or delay,
in any manner, a termination of the Issuer pursuant to the first sentence of
this Section 9.02.  Upon a termination pursuant to this Section, the Owner
Trustee shall direct the Indenture Trustee promptly to sell the assets of the
Issuer (other than the Payment Account) in a commercially reasonable manner and
on commercially reasonable terms.  The proceeds of such a sale of the assets of
the Issuer shall be deposited to the Payment Account for distribution in
accordance with Section 5.03(a) of the Indenture.





                                       33
<PAGE>   39

                                   ARTICLE X

             Successor Owner Trustees and Additional Owner Trustees

         Section 10.01.   Eligibility Requirements for Owner Trustee.  The
Owner Trustee shall at all times be a corporation satisfying the provisions of
Section 3807(a) of the Business Trust Statute; authorized to exercise corporate
trust powers; having a combined capital and surplus of at least $50,000,000 and
subject to supervision or examination by federal or state authorities; and
having (or having a parent that has) a rating of at least Baa3 by Moody's (or a
rating otherwise acceptable to Moody's).  If such corporation shall publish
reports of condition at least annually pursuant to law or to the requirements
of the aforesaid supervising or examining authority, then for the purpose of
this Section, the combined capital and surplus of such corporation shall be
deemed to be its combined capital and surplus as set forth in its most recent
report of condition so published.  In case at any time the Owner Trustee shall
cease to be eligible in accordance with the provisions of this Section 10.01,
the Owner Trustee shall resign immediately in the manner and with the effect
specified in Section 10.02.

         Section 10.02.  Resignation or Removal of Owner Trustee.  The Owner
Trustee may at any time resign and be discharged from the trusts hereby created
by giving written notice thereof to the Administrator and the Designated
Certificateholder.  Upon receiving such notice of resignation, the Designated
Certificateholder shall promptly appoint a successor Owner Trustee, by written
instrument, in duplicate, one copy of which instrument shall be delivered to
the resigning Owner Trustee and one copy to the successor Owner Trustee.  If no
successor Owner Trustee shall have been so appointed and have accepted
appointment within 30 days after the giving of such notice of resignation, the
resigning Owner Trustee may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for
the appointment of a successor Owner Trustee.

         If at any time the Owner Trustee shall cease to be eligible in
accordance with the provisions of Section 10.01 and shall fail to resign after
written request therefor by the Designated Certificateholder or if at any time
the Owner Trustee shall be legally unable to act, or shall be adjudged bankrupt
or insolvent, or a receiver of the Owner Trustee or of its property shall be
appointed, or any public officer shall take charge or control of the Owner
Trustee or of its property or affairs for the purpose of rehabilitation,
conservation or liquidation, then the Designated Certificateholder may remove
the Owner Trustee.  If the Designated Certificateholder shall remove the Owner
Trustee under the authority of the immediately preceding sentence, the
Designated Certificateholder shall promptly appoint a successor Owner Trustee
by written instrument, in duplicate, one copy of which instrument shall be
delivered to the outgoing





                                       34
<PAGE>   40

Owner Trustee so removed and one copy to the successor Owner Trustee, and shall
pay all fees owed to the outgoing Owner Trustee.

         Any resignation or removal of the Owner Trustee and appointment of a
successor Owner Trustee pursuant to any of the provisions of this Section shall
not become effective until acceptance of appointment by the successor Owner
Trustee pursuant to Section 10.03 and payment of all fees and expenses owed to
the outgoing Owner Trustee.  The Administrator shall provide notice of such
resignation or removal of the Owner Trustee to each of the Rating Agencies.

         Section 10.03.  Successor Owner Trustee.  Any successor Owner Trustee
appointed pursuant to Section 10.02 shall execute, acknowledge and deliver to
the Designated Certificateholder and to its predecessor Owner Trustee an
instrument accepting such appointment under this Trust Agreement, and thereupon
the resignation or removal of the predecessor Owner Trustee shall become
effective, and such successor Owner Trustee, without any further act, deed or
conveyance, shall become fully vested with all the rights, powers, duties and
obligations of its predecessor under this Trust Agreement, with like effect as
if originally named as Owner Trustee.  The predecessor Owner Trustee shall upon
payment of its fees and expenses deliver to the successor Owner Trustee all
documents and statements and monies held by it under this Trust Agreement; and
the Designated Certificateholder and the predecessor Owner Trustee shall
execute and deliver such instruments and do such other things as may reasonably
be required for fully and certainly vesting and confirming in the successor
Owner Trustee all such rights, powers, duties and obligations.

         No successor Owner Trustee shall accept appointment as provided in
this Section 10.03 unless at the time of such acceptance such successor Owner
Trustee shall be eligible pursuant to Section 10.01.

         Upon acceptance of appointment by a successor Owner Trustee pursuant
to this Section 10.03, the Administrator shall mail notice thereof to all
Certificateholders, the Indenture Trustee, the Noteholders and the Rating
Agencies.  If the Administrator shall fail to mail such notice within 10 days
after acceptance of such appointment by the successor Owner Trustee, the
successor Owner Trustee shall cause such notice to be mailed at the expense of
the Administrator.

         Section 10.04.   Merger or Consolidation of Owner Trustee.  Any Person
into which the Owner Trustee may be merged or converted or with which it may be
consolidated, or any Person resulting from any merger, conversion or
consolidation to which the Owner Trustee shall be a party, or any Person
succeeding to all or substantially all of the corporate trust business of the
Owner





                                       35
<PAGE>   41

Trustee, shall be the successor of the Owner Trustee hereunder, without the
execution or filing of any instrument or any further act on the part of any of
the parties hereto, anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding; provided,
that such Person shall be eligible pursuant to Section 10.01 and, provided,
further, that the Owner Trustee shall mail notice of such merger or
consolidation to the Rating Agencies.

         Section 10.05.   Appointment of Co-Trustee or Separate Trustee.
Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Agreement, at any time, for the
purpose of meeting any legal requirements of any jurisdiction in which any part
of the Owner Trust Estate may at the time be located, the Designated
Certificateholder and the Owner Trustee acting jointly shall have the power and
shall execute and deliver all instruments to appoint one or more Persons
approved by the Designated Certificateholder and Owner Trustee to act as
co-trustee, jointly with the Owner Trustee, or as separate trustee or separate
trustees, of all or any part of the Owner Trust Estate, and to vest in such
Person, in such capacity, such title to the Owner Trust Estate or any part
thereof and, subject to the other provisions of this Section, such powers,
duties, obligations, rights and trusts as the Designated Certificateholder and
the Owner Trustee may consider necessary or desirable.  If the Designated
Certificateholder shall not have joined in such appointment within 15 days
after the receipt by it of a request so to do, the Owner Trustee alone shall
have the power to make such appointment.  No co-trustee or separate trustee
under this Trust Agreement shall be required to meet the terms of eligibility
as a successor Owner Trustee pursuant to Section 10.01 and no notice of the
appointment of any co-trustee or separate trustee shall be required pursuant to
Section 10.03.

         Each separate trustee and co-trustee shall, to the extent permitted by
law, be appointed and act subject to the following provisions and conditions:

         (a)     All rights, powers, duties and obligations conferred or
imposed upon the Owner Trustee shall be conferred upon and exercised or
performed by the Owner Trustee and such separate trustee or co-trustee jointly
(it being understood that such separate trustee or co-trustee is not authorized
to act separately without the Owner Trustee joining in such act), except to the
extent that under any law of any jurisdiction in which any particular act or
acts are to be performed, the Owner Trustee shall be incompetent or unqualified
to perform such act or acts, in which event such rights, powers, duties and
obligations (including the holding of title to the Owner Trust Estate or any
portion thereof in any such jurisdiction) shall be exercised and performed
singly by such separate trustee or co-trustee, but solely at the direction of
the Owner Trustee;





                                       36
<PAGE>   42

         (b)     No trustee under this Trust Agreement shall be personally
liable by reason of any act or omission of any other trustee under this Trust
Agreement; and

         (c)     The Designated Certificateholder and the Owner Trustee acting
jointly may at any time accept the resignation of or remove any separate
trustee or co-trustee.

         Any notice, request or other writing given to the Owner Trustee shall
be deemed to have been given to each of the then separate trustees and
co-trustees, as effectively as if given to each of them.  Every instrument
appointing any separate trustee or co-trustee shall refer to this Trust
Agreement and the conditions of this Article.  Each separate trustee and
co-trustee, upon its acceptance of the trusts conferred, shall be vested with
the estates or property specified in its instrument of appointment, either
jointly with the Owner Trustee or separately, as may be provided therein,
subject to all the provisions of this Trust Agreement, specifically including
every provision of this Trust Agreement relating to the conduct of, affecting
the liability of, or affording protection to, the Owner Trustee.  Each such
instrument shall be filed with the Owner Trustee and a copy thereof given to
the Administrator.

         Any separate trustee or co-trustee may at any time appoint the Owner
Trustee as its agent or attorney-in-fact with full power and authority, to the
extent not prohibited by law, to do any lawful act under or in respect of this
Trust Agreement on its behalf and in its name.  If any separate trustee or
co-trustee shall die, become incapable of acting, resign or be removed, all of
its estates, properties, rights, remedies and trusts shall vest in and be
exercised by the Owner Trustee, to the extent permitted by law, without the
appointment of a new or successor co-trustee or separate trustee.





                                       37
<PAGE>   43

                                   ARTICLE XI

                                 Miscellaneous

         Section 11.01.   Amendments.  (a)  This Trust Agreement may be amended
from time to time by the parties hereto, by a written instrument signed by each
of them, without the consent of any of the Securityholders, provided that an
Opinion of Counsel for the Seller (which Opinion of Counsel may, as to factual
matters, rely upon Officer's Certificates of the Seller) is addressed and
delivered to the Owner Trustee, dated the date of any such amendment, to the
effect that the conditions precedent to any such amendment have been satisfied
and the Seller shall have delivered to the Owner Trustee an Officer's
Certificate, dated the date of any such Amendment, stating that the Seller
reasonably believes that such amendment will not have a material adverse effect
on the Securityholders.

         (b)  This Agreement may also be amended from time to time with the
consent of the Holders of the Certificates evidencing not less than 66-2/3% of
the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Security Balance of all affected
Certificateholders for which the Seller has not delivered an Officer's
Certificate stating that there is no material adverse effect, for the purpose
of adding any provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the
provisions of this Agreement or of modifying in any manner the rights of the
Certificateholders; provided, however, that no such amendment shall (i) reduce
in any manner the amount of, or delay the timing of, payments received that are
required to be distributed on any Certificate without the consent of the
related Certificateholder, or (ii) reduce the aforesaid percentage of
Certificates the Holders of which are required to consent to any such
amendment, without the consent of the Holders of all such Certificates then
outstanding or cause any material adverse tax consequences to any
Certificateholders or Noteholders.

         (c)     If the purpose of the amendment is to (i) prevent the
imposition of any federal or state taxes at any time that any Security is
outstanding (i.e., technical in nature), or (ii) eliminate the provisions for
termination of this Trust Agreement and replacement of the Holder of the
Designated Certificate upon an Insolvency Event with respect to the Holder, and
eliminate Section 2.07(a) so that Section 2.07(b) applies as well to the Holder
of the Designated Certificate, or (iii) to permit the election or qualification
of the Issuer as a "FASIT" or other similar form of entity for federal income
tax purposes pursuant to legislation which may be enacted subsequent to the
date of this Agreement it shall not be necessary to obtain the consent of any
Holder, but the Owner Trustee shall be furnished with an Opinion of Counsel
that in the case of (i) above such amendment is necessary or helpful to prevent
the imposition of such taxes,





                                       38
<PAGE>   44

or in the case of (ii) or (iii) above such amendment will not cause the Issuer
to be subject to an entity level tax.

         (d)  Promptly after the execution of any such amendment or consent
(other than an amendment pursuant to paragraph (a)), the Owner Trustee shall
furnish notification of the substance of such amendment to each
Certificateholder, and to each Rating Agency.

         (e)  It shall not be necessary for the consent of Certificateholders
under this Section to approve the particular form of any proposed amendment,
but it shall be sufficient if such consent shall approve the substance thereof.
The manner of obtaining such consents and of evidencing the authorization of
the execution thereof by Certificateholders shall be subject to such reasonable
requirements as the Owner Trustee may prescribe.

         Promptly after the execution of any amendment to the Certificate of
Trust, the Owner Trustee shall cause the filing of such amendment with the
Secretary of State of the State of Delaware.

         Section 11.02.   No Legal Title to Owner Trust Estate in
Certificateholders.  The Certificateholders shall not have legal title to any
part of the Owner Trust Estate.  The Certificateholders shall be entitled to
receive distributions with respect to their undivided beneficial interest
therein only in accordance with Articles V and IX.  No transfer, by operation
of law or otherwise, of any right, title or interest of the Certificateholders
to and in their ownership interest in the Owner Trust Estate shall operate to
terminate this Trust Agreement or the trusts hereunder or entitle any
transferee to an accounting or to the transfer to it of legal title to any part
of the Owner Trust Estate.

         Section 11.03.   Limitations on Rights of Others.  Except for Section
2.07, the provisions of this Trust Agreement are solely for the benefit of the
Owner Trustee, the Seller, the Holder of the Designated Certificate, the
Certificateholders, the Administrator and, to the extent expressly provided
herein, the Indenture Trustee and the Noteholders, and nothing in this Trust
Agreement (other than Section 2.07), whether express or implied, shall be
construed to give to any other Person any legal or equitable right, remedy or
claim in the Owner Trust Estate or under or in respect of this Trust Agreement
or any covenants, conditions or provisions contained herein.

         Section 11.04.   Notices.  (a)  Unless otherwise expressly specified
or permitted by the terms hereof, all notices shall be in writing and shall be
deemed given upon receipt by the intended recipient or three Business Days
after mailing if mailed by certified mail, postage prepaid (except that notice
to the Owner Trustee shall be deemed given only upon actual receipt by the
Owner Trustee), if to the Owner Trustee, addressed to the Corporate Trust
Office; if to the Seller, addressed to Household





                                       39
<PAGE>   45

Consumer Loan Corporation, 1111 Town Center Drive, Las Vegas, Nevada 89134,
Attn: Compliance Officer, with a copy to Household Finance Corporation, 2700
Sanders Road, Prospect Heights, Illinois 60070, Attn: Treasurer; or, as to each
party, at such other address as shall be designated by such party in a written
notice to each other party.

         (b)     Any notice required or permitted to be given to a
Certificateholder shall be given by first-class mail, postage prepaid, at the
address of such Holder as shown in the Certificate Register.  Any notice so
mailed within the time prescribed in this Trust Agreement shall be conclusively
presumed to have been duly given, whether or not the Certificateholder receives
such notice.

         (c)     A copy of any notice delivered to the Owner Trustee or the
Issuer shall also be delivered to the Seller, the Administrator and The Chase
Manhattan Bank, 450 West 33rd Street, 15th Floor, New York, New York 10001,
Attn: Global Trust Services.

         Section 11.05.   Severability.  Any provision of this Trust Agreement
that is prohibited or unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall, as to such
jurisdiction, be ineffective to the extent of such prohibition or
unenforceability without invalidating the remaining provisions hereof, and any
such prohibition or unenforceability in any jurisdiction shall not invalidate
or render unenforceable such provision in any other jurisdiction.

         Section 11.06.  Separate Counterparts.  This Trust Agreement may be
executed by the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so
executed and delivered shall be an original, but all such counterparts shall
together constitute but one and the same instrument.

         Section 11.07.  Successors and Assigns.  All representations,
warranties, covenants and agreements contained herein shall be binding upon,
and inure to the benefit of, each of the Seller, the Owner Trustee and its
successors and each Certificateholder and its successors and permitted assigns.
Any request, notice, direction, consent, waiver or other instrument or action
by a Certificateholder shall bind the successors and assigns of such
Certificateholder.

         Section 11.08.  Covenants of the Seller.  Neither the Seller nor the
Holder of the Designated Certificate will at any time institute against the
Issuer any bankruptcy proceedings under any United States federal or state
bankruptcy or similar law in connection with any obligations relating to the
Certificates, the Notes, the Trust Agreement or any of the Basic Documents.

         Section 11.09.  No Petition.  The Owner Trustee, by entering into this
Trust Agreement and each Certificateholder and, by





                                       40
<PAGE>   46

accepting a Certificate, hereby covenant and agree that they will not at any
time institute against the Seller or the Issuer, or join in any institution
against the Seller or the Issuer of, any bankruptcy proceedings under any
United States federal or state bankruptcy or similar law in connection with any
obligations to the Certificates, the Notes, this Trust Agreement or any of the
Basic Documents.

         Section 11.10.   No Recourse.  Each Certificateholder by accepting a
Certificate acknowledges that such Certificateholder's Certificates represent
beneficial interests in the Issuer only and do not represent interests in or
obligations of the Seller, the Holder of the Designated Certificate, the
Administrator, the Owner Trustee, the Indenture Trustee or any Affiliate
thereof and no recourse may be had against such parties or their assets, except
as may be expressly set forth or contemplated in this Trust Agreement, the
Certificates or the Basic Documents.

         Section 11.11.  Headings.  The headings of the various Articles and
Sections herein are for convenience of reference only and shall not define or
limit any of the terms or provisions hereof.

         Section 11.12.   GOVERNING LAW.  THIS TRUST AGREEMENT SHALL BE
CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF DELAWARE, WITHOUT
REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND
REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH
LAWS.

         Section 11.13.  Integration.  This Trust Agreement constitutes the
entire agreement among the parties hereto pertaining to the subject matter
hereof and supersedes all prior agreements and understanding pertaining
thereto.





                                       41
<PAGE>   47

         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Seller, and the Owner Trustee have caused
their names to be signed hereto by their respective officers thereunto duly
authorized, all as of the day and year first above written.

                          HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORPORATION,
                                  as Seller and Holder of the 
                                  Designated Certificate


                          By:________________________________
                             Name:  Steve H. Smith
                             Title: VP & Asst. Treasurer




                          CHASE MANHATTAN BANK DELAWARE, not in 
                                  its individual capacity but solely 
                                  as Owner Trustee,


                          By:________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:


Acknowledged and Agreed:
THE BANK OF NEW YORK, as Certificate
         Registrar and Certificate
         Paying Agent



By:_________________________
   Name:
   Title:
         
<PAGE>   48

                                                                       EXHIBIT A

                             [FORM OF CERTIFICATE]
                                     [Face]

THIS CERTIFICATE HAS NOT BEEN AND WILL NOT BE REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES
ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED, OR THE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY STATE AND MAY NOT BE
RESOLD OR TRANSFERRED UNLESS IT IS REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SUCH ACT AND LAWS OR
IS SOLD OR TRANSFERRED IN TRANSACTIONS WHICH ARE EXEMPT FROM REGISTRATION UNDER
SUCH ACT AND UNDER APPLICABLE STATE LAW AND IS TRANSFERRED IN ACCORDANCE WITH
THE PROVISIONS OF SECTION 3.05 OF THE TRUST AGREEMENT REFERRED TO HEREIN.

NO TRANSFER OF THIS CERTIFICATE SHALL BE MADE UNLESS THE CERTIFICATE REGISTRAR
SHALL HAVE RECEIVED (I) A REPRESENTATION LETTER FROM THE TRANSFEREE OF THIS
CERTIFICATE TO THE EFFECT THAT SUCH TRANSFEREE IS NOT AN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLAN
SUBJECT TO THE FIDUCIARY RESPONSIBILITY PROVISIONS OF THE EMPLOYEE RETIREMENT
INCOME SECURITY ACT OF 1974, AS AMENDED ("ERISA"), OR SECTION 4975 OF THE
INTERNAL REVENUE CODE OF 1986, AS AMENDED (THE "CODE"), OR A PERSON ACTING ON
BEHALF OF ANY SUCH PLAN OR USING THE ASSETS OF ANY SUCH PLAN, (II) IF THIS
CERTIFICATE IS PRESENTED FOR REGISTRATION IN THE NAME OF A PLAN SUBJECT TO THE
FIDUCIARY RESPONSIBILITY PROVISIONS OF ERISA, OR SECTION 4975 OF THE CODE (OR
COMPARABLE PROVISIONS OF ANY SUBSEQUENT ENACTMENTS), OR A TRUSTEE OF ANY SUCH
PLAN, OR ANY OTHER PERSON WHO IS USING THE ASSETS OF ANY SUCH PLAN TO EFFECT
SUCH ACQUISITION, AN OPINION OF COUNSEL TO THE EFFECT THAT THE PURCHASE OR
HOLDING OF THIS CERTIFICATE WILL NOT RESULT IN THE ASSETS OF THE OWNER TRUST
ESTATE BEING DEEMED TO BE "PLAN ASSETS" AND SUBJECT TO THE FIDUCIARY
RESPONSIBILITY PROVISIONS OF ERISA OR THE PROHIBITED TRANSACTION PROVISIONS OF
THE CODE, WILL NOT CONSTITUTE OR RESULT IN A PROHIBITED TRANSACTION WITHIN THE
MEANING OF SECTION 406 OR SECTION 407 OF ERISA OR SECTION 4975 OF THE CODE, AND
WILL NOT SUBJECT THE OWNER TRUSTEE OR THE SELLER TO ANY OBLIGATION OR
LIABILITY, (III) OR IF THE PURCHASER IS AN INSURANCE COMPANY, A REPRESENTATION
THAT THE PURCHASER IS AN INSURANCE COMPANY WHICH IS PURCHASING SUCH
CERTIFICATES WITH FUNDS CONTAINED IN AN "INSURANCE COMPANY GENERAL ACCOUNT" (AS
SUCH TERM IS DEFINED IN SECTION V(e) OF PROHIBITED TRANSACTION CLASS EXEMPTION
95-60 ("PTCE 95-60")) AND THAT THE PURCHASE AND HOLDING OF SUCH CERTIFICATES
ARE COVERED UNDER PTCE 95-60, OR (IV) IN THE CASE OF ANY SUCH PROPOSED
TRANSFEREE WHICH IS A PLAN, AN OPINION OF COUNSEL SATISFACTORY TO THE OWNER
TRUSTEE AND THE SELLER TO THE EFFECT SET FORTH IN THE AGREEMENT.

NO TRANSFER OF THIS CERTIFICATE SHALL BE MADE UNLESS THE CERTIFICATE REGISTRAR
SHALL HAVE RECEIVED A CERTIFICATE OF NON-FOREIGN STATUS CERTIFYING AS TO THE
TRANSFEREE'S STATUS AS U.S. PERSONS OR CORPORATION OR PARTNERSHIP UNDER U.S.
LAW.

THIS CERTIFICATE DOES NOT REPRESENT AN INTEREST IN OR OBLIGATION OF THE SELLER,
THE SERVICER, THE INDENTURE TRUSTEE, OR THE OWNER TRUSTEE OR ANY OF THEIR
RESPECTIVE AFFILIATES, EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY PROVIDED IN THE TRUST AGREEMENT OR
THE BASIC DOCUMENTS.





                                      A-1
<PAGE>   49

                                   Certificate No.

                                   Original principal amount ("Denomination")
                                   of this Certificate:  $_________

                                   Aggregate Denominations of all Certificates:
                                   $[        ]

                                   Certificate Rate:  Floating

                                   Closing Date:  August [], 1996

                                   First Payment Date
                                   [September __, 1996]

                                   CUSIP NO. [_________]


                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2


         Evidencing a fractional undivided interest in the Owner Trust Estate,
the property of which consists primarily of the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest in Receivables, sold by

                 HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORPORATION, AS SELLER

         This certifies that [name of Holder] is the registered owner of the
Percentage Interest represented hereby in the Household Consumer Loan Trust
1996-2 (the "Issuer").

         The Issuer was created pursuant to an Trust Agreement dated as of
August 1, 1996 (as amended and supplemented from time to time, the "Trust
Agreement") among the Seller as seller and as holder of the Designated
Certificate, and Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware, as owner trustee (the "Owner
Trustee"), a summary of certain of the pertinent provisions of which is set
forth hereinafter.  This Certificate is issued under and is subject to the
terms, provisions and conditions of the Trust Agreement, to which Trust
Agreement the Holder of this Certificate by virtue of the acceptance hereof
assents and by which such Holder is bound.

         This Certificate is one of a duly authorized issue of Consumer Loan
Asset Backed Certificates, Series 1996-2 (herein called the "Certificates")
issued under the Trust Agreement to which reference is hereby made for a
statement of the respective rights thereunder of the Seller, Designated
Certificateholder, the Owner Trustee and the Holders of the Certificates and
the terms upon which the Certificates are executed and delivered.  All terms
used in this Certificate which are defined in the Trust Agreement shall have
the meanings assigned to them in the Trust Agreement.  The Owner Trust Estate
consists of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest and all monies and the
collections and





                                      A-2
<PAGE>   50

proceeds due thereon and any part thereof which consists of general intangibles
(as defined in the UCC).  The rights of the Holders of the Certificates are
subordinated to the rights of the Holders of the Notes, as set forth in the
Indenture.

         There will be distributed on the fifteenth day of each month or, if
such fifteenth day is not a Business Day, the next Business Day (each, a
"Payment Date"), commencing in September 1996, to the Person in whose name this
Certificate is registered at the close of business on the last Business Day of
the month preceding the month of such Payment Date (the "Record Date"), such
Certificateholder's Percentage Interest (obtained by dividing the Denomination
of this Certificate by the aggregate Denominations of all Certificates) in the
amount to be distributed to Certificateholders on such Payment Date.

         The Certificateholder, by its acceptance of this Certificate, agrees
that it will look solely to the funds on deposit in the Payment Account that
have been released from the Lien of the Indenture for payment hereunder and
that neither the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity nor the Seller is
personally liable to the Certificateholders for any amount payable under this
Certificate or the Trust Agreement or, except as expressly provided in the
Trust Agreement, subject to any liability under the Trust Agreement.

         The Holder of this Certificate acknowledges and agrees that its rights
to receive distributions in respect of this Certificate are subordinated to the
rights of the Noteholders as described in the Indenture, dated as of August 1,
1996, between the Issuer and The Bank of New York, as Indenture Trustee (the
"Indenture").

         It is the intent of the Seller and the Certificateholders that, for
purposes of federal income, state and local income and single business tax and
any other income taxes, the Issuer will be treated as a partnership.  The
Seller and the other Certificateholders, by acceptance of a Certificate, agree
to treat, and to take no action inconsistent with the treatment of, the
Certificates for such tax purposes as an equity interest in a partnership.

         Each Certificateholder, by its acceptance of a Certificate, covenants
and agrees that such Certificateholder will not at any time institute against
the Seller, or join in any institution against the Seller or the Issuer of, any
bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or liquidation proceedings,
or other proceedings under any United States federal or state bankruptcy or
similar law in connection with any obligations relating to the Certificates,
the Notes, the Trust Agreement or any of the Basic Documents.





                                      A-3
<PAGE>   51

         Distributions on this Certificate will be made as provided in the
Trust Agreement by the Certificate Paying Agent to each Certificateholder of
record on the preceding Record Date either by, in the case of any
Certificateholder owning Certificates having denominations aggregating at least
$1,000,000, wire transfer, in immediately available funds, to the account of
such Holder at a bank or other entity having appropriate facilities therefor,
if such Certificateholder shall have provided to the Certificate Registrar
appropriate written instructions at least five Business Days prior to such
Payment Date or, if not, by check mailed to such Certificateholder at the
address of such Holder appearing in the Certificate Register.  Except as
otherwise provided in the Trust Agreement and notwithstanding the above, the
final distribution on this Certificate will be made after due notice by the
Certificate Paying Agent of the pendency of such distribution and only upon
presentation and surrender of this Certificate at the office or agency
maintained by the Certificate Registrar for that purpose by the Issuer in the
Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York.

         Reference is hereby made to the further provisions of this Certificate
set forth on the reverse hereof, which further provisions shall for all
purposes have the same effect as if set forth at this place.

         Unless the certificate of authentication hereon shall have been
executed by an authorized officer of the Owner Trustee, or an authenticating
agent by manual signature, this Certificate shall not entitle the Holder hereof
to any benefit under the Trust Agreement or be valid for any purpose.

         THIS CERTIFICATE SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH  THE LAWS OF
THE STATE OF DELAWARE, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND
THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE
DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.





                                      A-4
<PAGE>   52


         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Owner Trustee, on behalf of the Issuer and not
in its individual capacity, has caused this Certificate to be duly executed.



                                  HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST
                                    1996-2

                                  by    Chase Manhattan Bank 
                                        Delaware, not in its 
                                        individual capacity but 
                                        solely as Owner Trustee



Dated:  __________________, 1996        _______________________________
                                        Name:
                                        Title

                         Certificate of Authentication

This is one of the Certificates referred to in the within mentioned Trust
Agreement.


Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware,
not in its individual capacity
but solely as Owner Trustee


By:______________________________
Name:
Title



or The Bank of New York,
    as Authenticating Agent of the Issuer


By:______________________________
Name:
Title:
<PAGE>   53

                            [REVERSE OF CERTIFICATE]


         The Certificates do not represent an obligation of, or an interest in,
the Seller, the Servicer, the Indenture Trustee, the Owner Trustee or any
Affiliates of any of them and no recourse may be had against such parties or
their assets, except as expressly set forth or contemplated herein or in the
Trust Agreement or the Basic Documents.  In addition, this Certificate is not
guaranteed by any governmental agency or instrumentality and is limited in
right of payment to certain collections and recoveries with respect to the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest (and certain other amounts), all as more
specifically set forth herein.  A copy of the Trust Agreement may be examined
by any Certificateholder upon written request during normal business hours at
the principal office of the Seller and at such other places, if any, designated
by the Seller.

         The Trust Agreement permits the amendment thereof as specified below,
provided that any amendment be accompanied by an Opinion of Counsel for the
Seller (which Opinion of Counsel may, as to factual matters, rely upon
Officer's Certificates of the Seller) addressed and delivered to the Owner
Trustee, to the effect that the conditions precedent in the Trust Agreement to
any such amendment have been satisfied and the Seller shall have delivered to
the Owner Trustee an Officer's Certificate, stating that the Seller reasonably
believes that such amendment will not have a material adverse effect on the
Securityholders.  If the purpose of the amendment is to (i) prevent the
imposition of any federal or state taxes at any time that any Security is
outstanding (i.e., technical in nature), or (ii) eliminate or modify certain
provisions relating to the Designated Certificate or to permit the election or
qualification of the Issuer as a "FASIT" or other similar form of entity for
federal income tax purposes pursuant to legislation which may be enacted
subsequent to the date of this Agreement it shall not be necessary to obtain
the consent of any Holder, but the Owner Trustee shall be furnished with an
Opinion of Counsel that in the case of (i) above such amendment is necessary or
helpful to prevent the imposition of such taxes, or in the case of (ii) above
such amendment will not cause the Issuer to be subject to an entity level tax.
If the purpose of the amendment is to add or eliminate or change any provision
of the Trust Agreement, other than as specified in the preceding two sentences,
the amendment shall require the consent of the Holders of the Certificates
evidencing not less than 66-2/3% of the aggregate unpaid Security Balance of
all affected Certificateholders; provided, however, that no such amendment
shall (i) reduce in any manner the amount of, or delay the timing of, payments
received that are required to be distributed on any Certificate without the
consent of the related Certificateholder, or (ii) reduce the aforesaid
percentage of Certificates the Holders of which are required to consent to any
such amendment, without the consent of the Holders





                                      A-6
<PAGE>   54

of all such Certificates then outstanding or cause any material adverse tax
consequences to any Certificateholders or Noteholders.

         As provided in the Trust Agreement and subject to certain limitations
therein set forth, the transfer of this Certificate is registerable in the
Certificate Register upon surrender of this Certificate for registration of
transfer at the offices or agencies of the Certificate Registrar maintained by
the Issuer in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York, accompanied by a
written instrument of transfer in form satisfactory to the Certificate
Registrar duly executed by the Holder hereof or such Holder's attorney duly
authorized in writing, and thereupon one or more new Certificates of authorized
denominations evidencing the same aggregate interest in the Issuer will be
issued to the designated transferee.  The initial Certificate Registrar
appointed under the Trust Agreement is The Bank of New York.

         Except as provided in the Trust Agreement, the Certificates are
issuable only in minimum denominations of $1,000,000 and in integral multiples
of $100,000 in excess thereof, except for one Certificate issued in a
denomination of $[    ] which will be held by the Seller and one other
Certificate that may not be in an integral multiple of $100,000.  As provided
in the Trust Agreement and subject to certain limitations therein set forth,
Certificates are exchangeable for new Certificates of authorized denominations
evidencing the same aggregate denomination, as requested by the Holder
surrendering the same.  No service charge will be made for any such
registration of transfer or exchange, but the Owner Trustee or the Certificate
Registrar may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or
governmental charge payable in connection therewith.

         The Owner Trustee, the Certificate Paying Agent, the Certificate
Registrar and any agent of the Owner Trustee, the Certificate Paying Agent, or
the Certificate Registrar may treat the Person in whose name this Certificate
is registered as the owner hereof for all purposes, and none of the Owner
Trustee, the Certificate Paying Agent, the Certificate Registrar or any such
agent shall be affected by any notice to the contrary.

         The obligations and responsibilities created by the Trust Agreement
and the Issuer created thereby shall terminate (i) upon the final distribution
of all moneys or other property or proceeds of the Owner Trust Estate in
accordance with the terms of the Indenture and the Trust Agreement, (ii) the
Payment Date in August 2006, or (iii) upon the bankruptcy or insolvency of the
Holder of the Designated Certificate and the satisfaction of other conditions
specified in Section 9.01 of the Trust Agreement.





                                      A-7
<PAGE>   55

                                   ASSIGNMENT


     FOR VALUE RECEIVED the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and transfers unto

PLEASE INSERT SOCIAL SECURITY OR
OTHER IDENTIFYING NUMBER OF ASSIGNEE



________________________________________________________________________________
(Please print or type name and address, including postal zip code, of assignee)


________________________________________________________________________________
the within Certificate, and all rights thereunder, hereby irrevocably 
constituting and appointing


________________________________________________________________________________
to transfer said Certificate on the books of the Certificate Registrar, with
full power of substitution in the premises.


Dated:

___________________________________________*/

                                         Signature Guaranteed:


                                               ____________________________*/


_________________

*/  NOTICE:  The signature to this assignment must correspond with the name as
it appears upon the face of the within Certificate in every particular, without
alteration, enlargement or any change whatever.  Such signature must be
guaranteed by a member firm of the New York Stock Exchange or a commercial bank
or trust company.





                                      A-8
<PAGE>   56


                           DISTRIBUTION INSTRUCTIONS


         The assignee should include the following for the information of the
Certificate Paying Agent:

         Distribution shall be made by wire transfer in immediately available
funds to _______________________________________________________________________
________________________________________________________________________________
_______________________________________________________________ for the account
of _____________________________________________________________________________
_____________________________, account number ________________________, or, if 
mailed by check, to ___________________________________________________________.

         Applicable statements should be mailed to _____________________________
_______________________________________________________________________________.



                                             ______________________________
                                             Signature of assignee or agent
                                             (for authorization of wire
                                              transfer only)






                                      A-9
<PAGE>   57

                                                                       EXHIBIT B



                                   [RESERVED]





                                      B-1
<PAGE>   58

                                                                       EXHIBIT C


                            CERTIFICATE OF TRUST OF
                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2


                 This Certificate of Trust of HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST
1996-2 (the "Trust"), dated August __, 1996, is being duly executed and filed
by Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware, a Delaware banking corporation, as trustee,
to form a business trust under the Delaware Business Trust Act (12 Del. Code,
Section  3801 et seq.).
                 1.  Name.  The name of the business trust formed hereby is
HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2.
                 2.  Delaware Trustee.  The name and business address of the
trustee of the Trust in the State of Delaware is Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware,
1201 Market Street, Wilmington, Delaware  19801, Attention:  Corporate Trustee
Administration.
                 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned, being the sole trustee of
the Trust, has executed this Certificate of Trust as of the date first above
written.

                             Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware,
                             not in its individual capacity but 
                             solely as owner trustee under a 
                             Trust Agreement dated as of August 1,1996


                             By:                                
                                --------------------------------
                                Name:
                                Title:






                                      C-1
<PAGE>   59

                                                                       EXHIBIT D

                 [FORM OF RULE 144A INVESTMENT REPRESENTATION]


            Description of Rule 144A Securities, including numbers:
                _______________________________________________
                _______________________________________________
                _______________________________________________
                _______________________________________________


                 The undersigned  seller, as registered holder (the "Seller"),
intends to transfer the Rule 144A Securities described above to the undersigned
buyer (the "Buyer").

                 1.  In connection with such transfer and in accordance with
the agreements pursuant to which the Rule 144A Securities were issued, the
Seller hereby certifies the following facts:  Neither the Seller nor anyone
acting on its behalf has offered, transferred, pledged, sold or otherwise
disposed of the Rule 144A Securities, any interest in the Rule 144A Securities
or any other similar security to, or solicited any offer to buy or accept a
transfer, pledge or other disposition of the Rule 144A Securities, any interest
in the Rule 144A Securities or any other similar security from, or otherwise
approached or negotiated with respect to the Rule 144A Securities, any interest
in the Rule 144A Securities or any other similar security with, any person in
any manner, or made any general solicitation by means of general advertising or
in any other manner, or taken any other action, that would constitute a
distribution of the Rule 144A Securities under the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended (the "1933 Act"), or that would render the disposition of the Rule 144A
Securities a violation of Section 5 of the 1933 Act or require registration
pursuant thereto, and that the Seller has not offered the Rule 144A Securities
to any person other than the Buyer or another "qualified institutional buyer"
as defined in Rule 144A under the 1933 Act.

                 2.  The Buyer warrants and represents to, and covenants with,
the Owner Trustee, and the Seller (as defined in the Trust Agreement (the
"Agreement"), dated as of August 1, 1996 among Household Consumer Loan
Corporation, as Seller, and as Holder of the Designated Certificate and Chase
Manhattan Bank Delaware, as Owner Trustee pursuant to Section 3.05 of the
Agreement and The Bank of New York as Indenture Trustee, as follows:

                          a.  The Buyer understands that the Rule 144A
         Securities have not been registered under the 1933 Act or the
         securities laws of any state.

                          b.  The Buyer considers itself a substantial,
         sophisticated institutional investor having such knowledge and
         experience in financial and business matters that it is





                                      D-1
<PAGE>   60

         capable of evaluating the merits and risks of investment in the Rule
         144A Securities.

                          c.  The Buyer has been furnished with all information
         regarding the Rule 144A Securities that it has requested from the
         Seller, the Indenture Trustee, the Owner Trustee or the Servicer.

                          d.  Neither the Buyer nor anyone acting on its behalf
         has offered, transferred, pledged, sold or otherwise disposed of the
         Rule 144A Securities, any interest in the Rule 144A Securities or any
         other similar security to, or solicited any offer to buy or accept a
         transfer, pledge or other disposition of the Rule 144A Securities, any
         interest in the Rule 144A Securities or any other similar security
         from, or otherwise approached or negotiated with respect to the Rule
         144A Securities, any interest in the Rule 144A Securities or any other
         similar security with, any person in any manner, or made any general
         solicitation by means of general advertising or in any other manner,
         or taken any other action, that would constitute a distribution of the
         Rule 144A Securities under the 1933 Act or that would render the
         disposition of the Rule 144A Securities a violation of Section 5 of
         the 1933 Act or require registration pursuant thereto, nor will it
         act, nor has it authorized or will it authorize any person to act, in
         such manner with respect to the Rule 144A Securities.

                          e.  The Buyer is a "qualified institutional buyer" as
         that term is defined in Rule 144A under the 1933 Act and has completed
         either of the forms of certification to that effect attached hereto as
         Annex 1 or Annex 2.  The Buyer is aware that the sale to it is being
         made in reliance on Rule 144A.  The Buyer is acquiring the Rule 144A
         Securities for its own account or the accounts of other qualified
         institutional buyers, understands that such Rule 144A Securities may
         be resold, pledged or transferred only (i) to a person reasonably
         believed to be a qualified institutional buyer that purchases for its
         own account or for the account of a qualified institutional buyer to
         whom notice is given that the resale, pledge or transfer is being made
         in reliance on Rule 144A, or (ii) pursuant to another exemption from
         registration under the 1933 Act.

                 [3.  The Buyer warrants and represents to, and covenants with,
the Seller, the Indenture Trustee, Owner Trustee, Servicer and the Seller that
either (1) the Buyer is (A) not an employee benefit plan (within the meaning of
Section 3(3) of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended
("ERISA")), or a plan (within the meaning of Section 4975(e)(1) of the Internal
Revenue Code of 1986 ("Code")), which (in either case) is subject to ERISA or
Section 4975 of the Code (both a "Plan"), and (B) is not directly or indirectly
purchasing the Rule 144A Securities on behalf of, as investment manager of, as
named fiduciary of, as trustee of, or with "plan assets" of a





                                      D-2
<PAGE>   61

Plan, or (2) the Buyer understands that registration of transfer of any Rule
144A Securities to any Plan, or to any Person acting on behalf of any Plan,
will not be made unless such Plan delivers an opinion of its counsel, addressed
and satisfactory to the Certificate Registrar and the Seller, to the effect
that the purchase and holding of the Rule 144A Securities by, on behalf of or
with "plan assets" of any Plan would not constitute or result in a prohibited
transaction under Section 406 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code, and would
not subject the Seller, the Servicer, the Indenture Trustee or the Issuer to
any obligation or liability (including liabilities under ERISA or Section 4975
of the Code) in addition to those undertaken in the Agreement or any other
liability.]

                 4.  This document may be executed in one or more counterparts
and by the different parties hereto on separate counterparts, each of which,
when so executed, shall be deemed to be an original; such counterparts,
together, shall constitute one and the same document.

                 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, each of the parties has executed this
document as of the date set forth below.


- ----------------------------                 ------------------------------
Print Name of Seller                         Print Name of Buyer           
                                                                           
By:                                          By:                           
   -------------------------                    ---------------------------
    Name:                                       Name:                         
    Title:                                      Title:                        
                                                                           
Taxpayer Identification:                     Taxpayer Identification:      
                                                                           
No.                                          No.                           
   -------------------------                    ---------------------------
                                                                           
Date:                                        Date:                         
     -----------------------                      -------------------------





                                      D-3
<PAGE>   62

                                                            Annex 1 to Exhibit D


            QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER STATUS UNDER SEC RULE 144A

            [For Buyers Other Than Registered Investment Companies]

           The undersigned hereby certifies as follows in connection with the
Rule 144A Investment Representation to which this Certification is attached:

            1. As indicated below, the undersigned is the President, Chief
Financial Officer, Senior Vice President or other executive officer of the
Buyer.

            2. In connection with purchases by the Buyer, the Buyer is a
"qualified institutional buyer" as that term is defined in Rule 144A under the
Securities Act of 1933 ("Rule 144A") because (i) the Buyer owned and/or
invested on a discretionary basis $______________________(1) in securities
(except for the excluded securities referred to below) as of the end of the
Buyer's most recent fiscal year (such amount being calculated in accordance
with Rule 144A) and (ii) the Buyer satisfies the criteria in the category
marked below.

    ___     Corporation, etc.  The Buyer is a corporation (other than a bank,
            savings and loan association or similar institution), Massachusetts
            or similar business trust, partnership, or charitable organization
            described in Section 501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code.

    ___     Bank.  The Buyer (a) is a national bank or banking institution
            organized under the laws of any State, territory or the District of
            Columbia, the business of which is substantially confined to
            banking and is supervised by the State or territorial banking
            commission or similar official or is a foreign bank or equivalent
            institution, and (b) has an audited net worth of at least
            $25,000,000 as demonstrated in its latest annual financial
            statements, a copy of which is attached hereto.





____________________

(1)  Buyer must own and/or invest on a discretionary basis at least
$100,000,000 in securities unless Buyer is a dealer, and, in that
case, Buyer must own and/or invest on a discretionary basis at least
$10,000,000 in securities.


                                      D-4
<PAGE>   63

    ___     Savings and Loan.  The Buyer (a) is a savings and loan association,
            building and loan association, cooperative bank, homestead
            association or similar institution, which is supervised and
            examined by a State or Federal authority having supervision over
            any such institutions or is a foreign savings and loan association
            or equivalent institution and (b) has an audited net worth of at
            least $25,000,000 as demonstrated in its latest annual financial
            statements.

    ___     Broker-Dealer.  The Buyer is a dealer registered pursuant to
            Section 15 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

    ___     Insurance Company.  The Buyer is an insurance company whose primary
            and predominant business activity is the writing of insurance or
            the reinsuring of risks underwritten by insurance companies and
            which is subject to supervision by the insurance commissioner or a
            similar official or agency of a State or territory or the District
            of Columbia.

    ___     State or Local Plan.  The Buyer is a plan established and
            maintained by a State, its political subdivisions, or any agency or
            instrumentality of the State or its political subdivisions, for the
            benefit of its employees.

    ___     ERISA Plan.  The Buyer is an employee benefit plan within the
            meaning of Title I of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act
            of 1974.

    ___     Investment Adviser.   The Buyer is an investment adviser registered
            under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940.

    ___     SBIC.  The Buyer is a Small Business Investment Company licensed by
            the U.S. Small Business Administration under Section 301(c) or (d)
            of the Small Business Investment Act of 1958.

    ___     Business Development Company.  The Buyer is a business development
            company as defined in Section 202(a)(22) of the Investment Advisers
            Act of 1940.

    ___     Trust Fund.  The Buyer is a trust fund whose trustee is a bank or
            trust company and whose participants are exclusively (a) plans
            established and maintained by a State, its political subdivisions,
            or any agency or instrumentality of the State or its political
            subdivisions, for the benefit of its employees, or (b) employee
            benefit plans within the meaning of Title I of the Employee
            Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, but is not a trust fund
            that includes as participants individual retirement accounts or
            H.R. 10 plans.





                                      D-5
<PAGE>   64

            3.   The term "securities" as used herein does not include (i)
securities of issuers that are affiliated with the Buyer, (ii) securities that
are part of an unsold allotment to or subscription by the Buyer, if the Buyer
is a dealer, (iii) bank deposit notes and certificates of deposit, (iv) loan
participations, (v) repurchase agreements, (vi) securities owned but subject to
a repurchase agreement and (vii) currency, interest rate and commodity swaps.

            4.   For purposes of determining the aggregate amount of securities
owned and/or invested on a discretionary basis by the Buyer, the Buyer used the
cost of such securities to the Buyer and did not include any of the securities
referred to in the preceding paragraph.  Further, in determining such aggregate
amount, the Buyer may have included securities owned by subsidiaries of the
Buyer,  but only if such subsidiaries are consolidated with the Buyer in its
financial statements prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting
principles and if the investments of such subsidiaries are managed under the
Buyer's direction.  However, such securities were not included if the Buyer is
a majority-owned, consolidated subsidiary of another enterprise and the Buyer
is not itself a reporting company under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

            5.   The Buyer acknowledges that it is familiar with Rule 144A and
understands that the seller to it and other parties related to the Certificates
are relying and will continue to rely on the statements made herein because one
or more sales to the Buyer may be in reliance on Rule 144A.

  __        ___    Will the Buyer be purchasing the Rule 144A
  Yes        No    Securities only for the Buyer's own account?

            6.   If the answer to the foregoing question is "no", the Buyer
agrees that, in connection with any purchase of securities sold to the Buyer
for the account of a third party (including any separate account) in reliance
on Rule 144A, the Buyer will only purchase for the account of a third party
that at the time is a "qualified institutional buyer" within the meaning of
Rule 144A.  In addition, the Buyer agrees that the Buyer will not purchase
securities for a third party unless the Buyer has obtained a current
representation letter from such third party or taken other appropriate steps
contemplated by Rule 144A to conclude that such third party independently meets
the definition of "qualified institutional buyer" set forth in Rule 144A.

            7.   The Buyer will notify each of the parties to which this
certification is made of any changes in the information and conclusions herein.
Until such notice is given, the Buyer's





                                      D-6
<PAGE>   65

purchase of Rule 144A Securities will constitute a reaffirmation of this
certification as of the date of such purchase.

                                                                      
                                  ------------------------------------
                                  Print Name of Buyer                 
                                                                      
                                  By:                                 
                                     ---------------------------------
                                     Name:                            
                                     Title:                           
                                  Date:                               
                                       -------------------------------
                                                                      





                                      D-7
<PAGE>   66

                                                            ANNEX 2 TO EXHIBIT D


            QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER STATUS UNDER SEC RULE 144A

             [For Buyers That Are Registered Investment Companies]


                 The undersigned hereby certifies as follows in connection with
the Rule 144A Investment Representation to which this Certification is
attached:

                  1. As indicated below, the undersigned is the President,
Chief Financial Officer or Senior Vice President of the Buyer or, if the Buyer
is a "qualified institutional buyer" as that term is defined in Rule 144A under
the Securities Act of 1933 ("Rule 144A") because Buyer is part of a Family of
Investment Companies (as defined below), is such an officer of the Adviser.

                 2. In connection with purchases by Buyer, the Buyer is a
"qualified institutional buyer" as defined in SEC Rule 144A because (i) the
Buyer is an investment company registered under the Investment Company Act of
1940, and (ii) as marked below, the Buyer alone, or the Buyer's Family of
Investment Companies, owned at least $100,000,000 in securities (other than the
excluded securities referred to below) as of the end of the Buyer's most recent
fiscal year.  For purposes of determining the amount of securities owned by the
Buyer or the Buyer's Family of Investment Companies, the cost of such
securities was used.

____             The Buyer owned $___________________ in securities (other than
                 the excluded securities referred to below) as of the end of
                 the Buyer's most recent fiscal year (such amount being
                 calculated in accordance with Rule 144A).

____             The Buyer is part of a Family of Investment Companies which
                 owned in the aggregate $______________ in securities (other
                 than the excluded securities referred to below) as of the end
                 of the Buyer's most recent fiscal year (such amount being
                 calculated in accordance with Rule 144A).

                 3.       The term "Family of Investment Companies" as used
herein means two or more registered investment companies (or series thereof)
that have the same investment adviser or investment advisers that are
affiliated (by virtue of being majority owned subsidiaries of the same parent
or because one investment adviser is a majority owned subsidiary of the other).

                 4.       The term "securities" as used herein does not include
(i) securities of issuers that are affiliated with the





                                      D-8
<PAGE>   67

Buyer or are part of the Buyer's Family of Investment Companies, (ii) bank
deposit notes and certificates of deposit, (iii) loan participations, (iv)
repurchase agreements, (v) securities owned but subject to a repurchase
agreement and (vi) currency, interest rate and commodity swaps.

                 5.       The Buyer is familiar with Rule 144A and understands
that each of the parties to which this certification is made are relying and
will continue to rely on the statements made herein because one or more sales
to the Buyer will be in reliance on Rule 144A.  In addition, the Buyer will
only purchase for the Buyer's own account.

                 6.       The undersigned will notify each of the parties to
which this certification is made of any changes in the information and
conclusions herein.  Until such notice, the Buyer's purchase of Rule 144A
Securities will constitute a reaffirmation of this certification by the
undersigned as of the date of such purchase.


                                    
                                    ------------------------------------    
                                    Print Name of Buyer                     
                                                                            
                                                                            
                                    By:                                     
                                       ---------------------------------    
                                       Name:                                
                                            ----------------------------    
                                       Title:                               
                                             ---------------------------    
                                                                            
                                    IF AN ADVISER:                          
                                                                            
                                                                            
                                    -----------------------------------     
                                    Print Name of Buyer                     
                                                                            
                                                                            
                                    Date:                                   
                                         --------------------------------   






                                      D-9
<PAGE>   68

                                                                       EXHIBIT E

                                  DEFINITIONS


         The definitions contained herein are incorporated into and made a part
of the Trust Agreement and Indenture, each as defined below.

         Accelerated Principal Payment Amount:   With respect to any Payment
Date, the lesser of (i) the Excess Interest reduced by the amount of the Net
Charge-Off and (ii) one twelfth of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Invested Amount as of the beginning of the related Interest Period multiplied by
[0.25%].

         Act:  The meaning assigned to such term in Section 10.03 of the
Indenture.

         Adjusted Principal Balance:   With respect to the Class A-1 Notes,
Class A-2 Notes, Class A-3 Notes and Class B Notes, the Class A-1 Adjusted      
Principal Balance, Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance, Class A-3 Adjusted
Principal Balance and Class B Adjusted Principal Balance, respectively.

         Adjusted Security Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date,  the sum
of the Class A Adjusted Principal Balance, the Class B Adjusted Principal
Balance and the Certificate Adjusted Security Balance.

         Administration Agreement:  The Administration Agreement dated as of
August 1, 1996 among the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and HFC, as
Administrator, as it may be amended from time to time.

         Administrator:  HFC, as administrator under the Administration
Agreement or any successor Administrator appointed pursuant to the terms of the
Administration Agreement.

         Affiliate:   The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.

         Aggregate Security Balance:   With respect to any Payment Date, the
aggregate of the Principal Balances of all Securities as of such date.

         Amortization Event:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement.

         Authorized Newspaper:  A newspaper of general circulation in the
Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York, printed in the English language and
customarily published on each Business Day, whether or not published on
Saturdays, Sundays or holidays.





                                      E-1
<PAGE>   69

         Authorized Officer:  With respect to the Issuer, any officer of the
Owner Trustee who is authorized to act for the Owner Trustee in matters
relating to the Issuer and who is identified on the list of Authorized Officers
delivered by the Owner Trustee to the Indenture Trustee on the Closing Date (as
such list may be modified or supplemented from time to time thereafter) and, so
long as the Administration Agreement is in effect, any Responsible Officer of
the Administrator who is authorized to act for the Administrator in matters
relating to the Issuer and to be acted upon by the Administrator pursuant to
the Administration Agreement and who is identified on the list of Authorized
Officers delivered by the Administrator to the Indenture Trustee on the Closing
Date (as such list may be modified or supplemented from time to time
thereafter).

         Available Investor Principal Collections:  The meaning assigned to
such term in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Basic Documents:  The Trust Agreement, the Certificate of Trust, the
Indenture, Receivables Purchase Agreement, the Administration Agreement, the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement, and the other documents and certificates
delivered in connection with any of the above.

         Beneficial Owner:  With respect to any Note, the Person who is the
beneficial owner of such Note as reflected on the books of the Depositary or on
the books of a Person maintaining an account with such Depositary (directly as
a Depositary Participant or indirectly through a Depositary Participant, in
accordance with the rules of such Depositary).

         Book-Entry Notes:  Beneficial interests in the Notes, ownership and
transfers of which shall be made through book entries by the Seller as
described in Section 4.06 of the Indenture.

         Business Day:   Any day other than (i) a Saturday or a Sunday or (ii)
a day on which banking institutions in the State of New York or Illinois are
required or authorized by law to be closed.

         Business Trust Statute:  Chapter 38 of Title 12 of the Delaware Code,
12 Del. Code Section Section  3801 et seq., as the same may be amended from
time to time.

         Certificate Adjusted Security Balance:  With respect to any Payment
Date, the Certificate Balance after giving effect to any distributions thereon
pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(iii) and (vi) of the Indenture on all Payment Dates
including the current Payment Date less all Net Charge-Offs allocated to the
Certificates after giving effect to any such allocation to be made on such
Payment Date.





                                      E-2
<PAGE>   70

         Certificate Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date, the Initial
Certificate Balance, reduced by all distributions thereon other than
distributions in respect of the Certificate Yield, prior to such Payment Date.

         Certificate of Trust:  The Certificate of Trust filed for the Trust
pursuant to Section 3810(a) of the Business Trust Statute.

         Certificateholder:  The Person in whose name a Certificate is
registered in the Certificate Register except that, any Certificate registered
in the name of the Seller, the Owner Trustee or the Indenture Trustee or any
Affiliate of any of them shall be deemed not to be outstanding and the
registered holder will not be considered a Certificateholder or a holder for
purposes of giving any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice,
consent or waiver under the Indenture or the Trust Agreement provided that, in
determining whether the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee shall be
protected in relying upon any such request, demand, authorization, direction,
notice, consent or waiver, only Certificates that the Indenture Trustee or the
Owner Trustee knows to be so owned shall be so disregarded.  Owners of
Certificates that have been pledged in good faith may be regarded as Holders if
the pledgee establishes to the satisfaction of the Indenture Trustee or the
Owner Trustee, as the case may be, the pledgee's right so to act with respect
to such Certificates and that the pledgee is not the Seller, any other obligor
upon the Certificates or any Affiliate of any of the foregoing Persons.


         Certificate Minimum Adjusted Balance:   $[        ].

         Certificate Minimum Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount, after giving effect to
the distribution made on the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest on such
Payment Date, multiplied by [3.0304%].

         Certificate Paying Agent:   The meaning specified in Section 3.03 of
the Indenture.

         Certificate Rate:  With respect to any Interest Period, the per annum
rate equal to the sum of (i) LIBOR and (ii) []%, but in no event greater than
[]% per annum.

         Certificate Register:  The register maintained by the Certificate
Registrar in which the Certificate Registrar shall provide for the registration
of Certificates and of transfers and exchanges of Certificates.





                                      E-3
<PAGE>   71

         Certificate Registrar:  Initially, The Bank of New York, in its
capacity as Certificate Registrar, or any successor to the Indenture Trustee in
such capacity.

         Certificates:   The Consumer Loan Asset-Backed Certificates, Series
1996-2, each evidencing undivided beneficial interests in the Issuer and        
executed by the Owner Trustee in substantially the form set forth in Exhibit A
to the Trust Agreement.

         Certificate Targeted Balance:   An amount equal to (i) the Series
1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount multiplied by [ ]%, less (ii) the 
Class A Adjusted Principal Balance and the Class B Adjusted Principal Balance
immediately prior to such Payment Date and after giving effect to payments of
principal on the Class A Notes and Class B Notes pursuant to Section
3.05(a)(ii)(a) and (b) of the Indenture on such Payment Date.

         Certificate Yield:  The sum of (a) the amount accrued during the
related Interest Period at the Certificate Rate on the sum of (i) the
Certificate Balance immediately prior to such Payment Date and (ii) any
previously accrued and unpaid amount at the Certificate Rate for prior Payment
Dates, and (b) any previously accrued and unpaid amount at the Certificate Rate
for prior Payment Dates.

         Class:  Any of class of the Class A Notes and Class B Notes issued
pursuant to Article II of the Indenture.

         Class A Adjusted Principal Balance:  The sum of the Class A-1 Adjusted
Principal Balance, Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance and Class A-3 Adjusted
Principal Balance.

         Class A Notes:   Any of the Class A-1 Notes, Class A-2 Notes and Class
A-3 Notes issued pursuant to Article II of the Indenture.

         Class A Targeted Principal Balance:  The sum of the Class A-1 Targeted
Principal Balance, Class A-2 Targeted Principal Balance, and Class A-3 Targeted
Principal Balance.

         Class A-1 Adjusted Principal Balance:   With respect to any Payment
Date, the Principal Balance of the Class A-1 Notes after giving effect to any
distributions thereon pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii), (v) and (vi) of the
Indenture on all Payment Dates including the current Payment Date less any Net
Charge-Off allocated to the Class A-1 Notes after giving effect to any such
allocation to be made on such Payment Date.

         Class A-1 Notes:  The Class A-1 Notes issued pursuant to Article II of
the Indenture.





                                      E-4
<PAGE>   72

         Class A-1 Targeted Principal Balance:   The Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Invested Amount multiplied by []%.

         Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance:   With respect to any Payment
Date, the Principal Balance of the Class A-2 Notes after giving effect to any
distributions thereon pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii), (v) and (vi) of the
Indenture on all Payment Dates including the current Payment Date less any Net
Charge-Off allocated to the Class A-2 Notes after giving effect to any such
allocation to be made on such Payment Date.

         Class A-2 Notes:  The Class A-2 Notes issued pursuant to Article II of
the Indenture.

         Class A-2 Targeted Principal Balance:   With respect to any Payment
Date an amount equal to (i) the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested
Amount multiplied by [   ]%, less (ii) the Class A-1 Adjusted Principal
Balance immediately prior to such Payment Date and after giving effect to
payments of principal on the Class A-1 Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii)(a)
of the Indenture on such Payment Date.

         Class A-3 Adjusted Principal Balance:   With respect to any Payment
Date, the Principal Balance of the Class A-3 Notes after giving effect to any
distributions thereon pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii), (v) and (vi) of the
Indenture on all Payment Dates including the current Payment Date less any Net
Charge-Off allocated to the Class A-3 Notes after giving effect to any such
allocation to be made on such Payment Date.

         Class A-3 Notes:  The Class A-3 Notes issued pursuant to Article II of
the Indenture.

         Class A-3 Targeted Principal Balance:   With respect to any Payment
Date an amount equal to (i) the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested
Amount multiplied by [  ]%, less (ii) the sum of the Class A-1 Adjusted
Principal Balance and Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance immediately prior to
such Payment Date and after giving effect to payments of principal on the Class
A-1 Notes and Class A-2 Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii) of the Indenture
on such Payment Date.

         Class B Adjusted Principal Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date,
the Principal Balance of the Class B Notes, after giving effect to any
distributions thereon pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii), (v) and (vi) of the
Indenture on all Payments Dates including the current Payment Date less all Net
Charge-Off allocated to the Class B Notes after giving effect to any such
allocation to be made on such Payment Date.





                                      E-5
<PAGE>   73

         Class B Notes:   The Class B Notes issued pursuant to Article II of
the Indenture.

         Class B Targeted Principal Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date
an amount equal to (i) the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount
multiplied by []%, less (ii) the Class A Adjusted Principal Balance immediately
prior to such Payment Date and after giving effect to payments of principal on
the Class A Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii) of the Indenture on such
Payment Date.

         Class Interest Distribution:  With respect to any Payment Date and
Class of Notes, the sum of (a) the amount of interest accrued during the
Interest Period relating to such Payment Date at the related Note Rate for such
Class of Notes on the sum of (i) the Principal Balance of such Class of Notes
immediately prior to such Payment Date and (ii) any previously accrued and
unpaid interest on such Class of Notes for prior Payment Dates, and (b) any
previously accrued and unpaid interest on such Class of Notes for prior Payment
Dates.

         Class Percentage:  With respect to each Class of Notes and Payment
Date, the ratio, expressed as a percentage, of the aggregate Principal Balance
of such Class of Notes to the aggregate Principal Balance of the Notes, in each
case immediately prior to such Payment Date.

         Closing Date:  August [], 1996.

         Code:   The Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the rules
and regulations promulgated thereunder.

         Corporate Trust Office:  With respect to the Indenture Trustee,
Certificate Registrar, Certificate Paying Agent and Paying Agent, the principal
corporate trust office of the Indenture Trustee and Note Registrar at which at
any particular time its corporate trust business shall be principally
administered, which office at the date of the execution of this instrument is
located at 101 Barclay Street, Floor 12 East, New York, New York 10286,
Attention:  Corporate Trust Administration Asset-Backed Unit.  With respect to
the Owner Trustee, the principal corporate trust office of the Owner Trustee at
which at any particular time its corporate trust business shall be
administered, which office at the date of the execution of the Trust Agreement
is located at 1201 Market Street, Wilmington, Delaware 19801, Attention:
Corporate Trustee Administration.

         Default:   Any occurrence which is or with notice or the lapse of time
or both would become an Event of Default.





                                      E-6
<PAGE>   74

         Definitive Notes:  The meaning specified in Section 4.06 of the
Indenture.

         Deposit Trust:  The trust created pursuant to the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.

         Deposit Trustee:  Texas Commerce Bank National Association as
successor trustee to The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A. and any successor thereto
under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Depository or Depository Agency:  The Depository Trust Company or a
successor appointed by the Indenture Trustee with the approval of the Seller.
Any successor to the Depository shall be an organization registered as a
"clearing agency" pursuant to Section 17A of the Exchange Act and the
regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission thereunder.

         Depository Participant:  A Person for whom, from time to time, the
Depository effects book-entry transfers and pledges of securities deposited
with the Depository.

         Designated Certificate:  The meaning specified in Section 3.11 of the
Trust Agreement.

         Determination Date:  With respect to any Payment Date, the 5th
Business Day prior to such Payment Date occurs or if such day is not a Business
Day, the next succeeding Business Day.

         Distribution Date:  The meaning specified in the Supplement.

         Due Period:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.

         Eligible Deposit Account:   The meaning assigned to such term in the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Eligible Investments:  The meaning assigned to such term in the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         ERISA:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement.

         Event of Default:   With respect to the Indenture, any one of the
following events (whatever the reason for such Event of Default and whether it
shall be voluntary or involuntary or be effected by operation of law or pursuant
to any judgment, decree or order of any court or any order, rule or regulation
of any administrative or governmental body):

                 i.  a default in the payment on any related Payment Date of
         any interest accrued on any Note during the related





                                      E-7
<PAGE>   75

         Interest Period, and such default shall continue for a period of five
         days;

             ii.  a default in the payment of the principal of or any
         installment of the principal of any Note when the same becomes due and
         payable;

            iii.  default in the observance or performance of any covenant or
         agreement of the Issuer made in the Indenture, or any representation
         or warranty of the Issuer made in the Indenture or in any certificate
         or other writing delivered pursuant thereto or in connection therewith
         proving to have been incorrect in any material respect as of the time
         when the same shall have been made and shall have had a material
         adverse effect on any Noteholders, and such default shall continue or
         not be cured, or the circumstance or condition in respect of which
         such representation or warranty was incorrect shall not have been
         eliminated or otherwise cured, for a period of 30 days after there
         shall have been given, by registered or certified mail, to the Issuer
         by the Indenture Trustee or to the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee by
         the Holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the Notes then
         outstanding, a written notice specifying such default or incorrect
         representation or warranty and requiring it to be remedied and stating
         that such notice is a notice of default hereunder;

             iv.  the filing of a decree or order for relief by a court having
         jurisdiction in the premises in respect of the Issuer or any
         substantial part of the Indenture Trust Estate in an involuntary case
         under any applicable federal or state bankruptcy, insolvency or other
         similar law now or hereafter in effect, or appointing a receiver,
         liquidator, assignee, custodian, trustee, sequestrator or similar
         official of the Issuer or for any substantial part of the Indenture
         Trust Estate, or ordering the winding-up or liquidation of the
         Issuer's affairs, and such decree or order shall remain unstayed and
         in effect for a period of 60 consecutive days; or

              v.  the commencement by the Issuer of a voluntary case under
         any applicable federal or state bankruptcy, insolvency or other
         similar law now or hereafter in effect, or the consent by the Issuer
         to the entry of an order for relief in an involuntary case under any
         such law, or the consent by the Issuer to the appointment or taking
         possession by a receiver, liquidator, assignee, custodian, trustee,
         sequestrator or similar official of the Issuer or for any substantial
         part of the Indenture Trust Estate, or the making by the Issuer of any
         general assignment for the benefit of creditors, or the failure by the
         Issuer generally





                                      E-8
<PAGE>   76

         to pay its debts as such debts become due, or the taking of any action
         by the Issuer in furtherance of any of the foregoing.

         Excess Interest:  With respect to any Payment Date the amount if any
by which Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Monthly Interest exceeds the sum
of (a) the amount to be distributed pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(i) of the
Indenture on such Payment Date and (b) Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Charge-Offs for the related Due Period.

         Exchange Act:   The Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and
the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.

         Expenses:  The meaning specified in Section 8.02 of the Trust
Agreement.

         FASIT:  Financial Asset Securitization Investment Trust as passed by
Congress in the Small Business Tax Bill, H.R. 3448, in August 1996, and as
enacted and amended from time to time.

         FDIC:   The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation or any successor
thereto.

         Final Scheduled Payment Date:  To the extent not previously paid, the
principal balance of each Class of Notes will be due on the Payment Date in
August 2006.

         Grant:  Mortgage, pledge, bargain, sell, warrant, alienate, remise,
release, convey, assign, transfer, create, and grant a lien upon and a security
interest in and right of set-off against, deposit, set over and confirm
pursuant to the Indenture.  A Grant of the Indenture Collateral or of any other
agreement or instrument shall include all rights, powers and options (but none
of the obligations) of the granting party thereunder, including the immediate
and continuing right to claim for, collect, receive and give receipt for
principal and interest payments in respect of such collateral or other
agreement or instrument and all other moneys payable thereunder, to give and
receive notices and other communications, to make waivers or other agreements,
to exercise all rights and options, to bring proceedings in the name of the
granting party or otherwise, and generally to do and receive anything that the
granting party is or may be entitled to do or receive thereunder or with
respect thereto.

         HFC:  Household Finance Corporation, a subsidiary of Household
International, Inc., incorporated under the laws of Delaware.

         Holdback Amount:  An amount initially equal to the excess of (i) the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Initial Invested





                                      E-9
<PAGE>   77

Amount over (ii) the aggregate Initial Principal Balances of the Class A Notes,
the Class B Notes, and the Certificates.  Such amount will be reduced through
payments made pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(iv) and 3.05(a)(vi) of the Indenture
and will be reduced or increased through the allocation of Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Charge-Offs and Reversals pursuant to Section 3.05(c) of
the Indenture.

         Holder:  Any of the Noteholders or Certificateholders.

         Indemnified Party:  The meaning specified in Section 8.02 of the Trust
Agreement.

         Indenture:   The indenture dated as of August 1, 1996 between the
Issuer, as debtor, and the Indenture Trustee, as Indenture Trustee, as may be
amended from time to time.
        
         Indenture Collateral:  The meaning specified in the Granting Clause of
the Indenture.

         Indenture Trustee:  The Bank of New York, and its successors and
assigns or any successor indenture trustee appointed pursuant to the terms of
the Indenture.

         Indenture Trust Estate:  The meaning specified in the Granting Clause
of the Indenture.

         Independent:   When used with respect to any specified Person, the
Person (i) is in fact independent of the Issuer, any other obligor on the Notes,
the Seller, the Seller and any Affiliate of any of the foregoing Persons, (ii)  
does not have any direct financial interest or any material indirect financial
interest in the Issuer, any such other obligor, the Seller, the Seller or any
Affiliate of any of the foregoing Persons and (iii) is not connected with the
Issuer, any such other obligor, the Seller, the Seller or any Affiliate of any
of the foregoing Persons as an officer, employee, promoter, underwriter,
trustee, partner, director or person performing similar functions.

         Independent Certificate:  A certificate or opinion to be delivered to
the Indenture Trustee under the circumstances described in, and otherwise
complying with, the applicable requirements of Section 10.01 of the Indenture,
made by an Independent appraiser or other expert appointed by the Issuer and
approved by the Indenture Trustee in the exercise of reasonable care, and such
opinion or certificate shall state that the signer has read the definition of
"Independent" in this Indenture and that the signer is Independent within the
meaning thereof.

         Initial Certificate Balance:  $[           ].





                                        E-10                         
<PAGE>   78

         Initial Principal Balance:  With respect to the Class A-1 Notes, Class
A-2 Notes, Class A-3 Notes and Class B Notes, $[ ], $[            ], $[       ]
and $[                 ], respectively.

         Insolvency Event:  With respect to a specified Person, (a) the filing
of a decree or order for relief by a court having jurisdiction in the premises
in respect of such Person or any substantial part of its property in an
involuntary case under any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency or other similar
law now or hereafter in effect, or appointing a receiver, liquidator, assignee,
custodian, trustee, sequestrator or similar official for such Person or for any
substantial part of its property, or ordering the winding-up or liquidation of
such Person's affairs, and such decree or order shall remain unstayed and in
effect for a period of 60 consecutive days; or (b) the commencement by such
Person of a voluntary case under any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency or other
similar law now or hereafter in effect, or the consent by such Person to the
entry of an order for relief in an involuntary case under any such law, or the
consent by such Person to the appointment of or taking possession by a
receiver, liquidator, assignee, custodian, trustee, sequestrator or similar
official for such Person or for any substantial part of its property, or the
making by such Person of any general assignment for the benefit of creditors,
or the failure by such Person generally to pay its debts as such debts become
due or the admission by such Person in writing (as to which the Indenture
Trustee shall have notice) of its inability to pay its debts generally, or the
adoption by the Board of Directors or managing member of such Person of a
resolution which authorizes action by such Person in furtherance of any of the
foregoing.

         Interest Period:  With respect to any Payment Date other than the
first Payment Date, the period beginning on the preceding Payment Date and
ending on the day preceding such Payment Date, and in the case of the first
Payment Date, the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending on the day
preceding the first Payment Date.

         Issuer:  The Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2, a Delaware business
trust, or its successor in interest.

         Issuer Request:  A written order or request signed in the name of the
Issuer by any one of its Authorized Officers and delivered to the Indenture
Trustee.

         LIBOR:  For any Interest Period other than the first Interest Period,
the rate for United States dollar deposits for one month which appears on the
Telerate Screen Page 3750 as of 11:00 A.M., London time, on the second LIBOR
Business Day prior to the first day of such Interest Period.  With respect to
the





                                        E-11                         
<PAGE>   79

first Interest Period, the rate for United States dollar deposits for one month
which appears on the Telerate Screen Page 3750 as of 11:00 A.M., London time,
two LIBOR Business Days prior to the Closing Date.  If such rate does not
appear on such page (or such other page as may replace that page on that
service, or if such service is no longer offered, such other service for
displaying LIBOR or comparable rates as may be reasonably selected by the
Indenture Trustee after consultation with the Servicer), the rate will be the
Reference Bank Rate.  If no such quotations can be obtained and no Reference
Bank Rate is available, LIBOR will be LIBOR applicable to the preceding Payment
Date.

         LIBOR Business Day:   Any day other than (i) a Saturday or a Sunday or
(ii) a day on which banking institutions in the State of New York or Illinois,
or in the city of London, England are required or authorized by law to be
closed.

         Lien:   Any mortgage, deed of trust, pledge, conveyance,
hypothecation, assignment, participation, deposit arrangement, encumbrance, lien
(statutory or other), preference, priority right or interest or other security
agreement or preferential arrangement of any kind or nature whatsoever,
including, without limitation, any conditional sale or other title retention
agreement, any financing lease having substantially the same economic effect as
any of the foregoing and the filing of any financing statement under the UCC
(other than any such financing statement filed for informational purposes only)
or comparable law of any jurisdiction to evidence any of the foregoing;
provided, however, that any assignment pursuant to Section 6.02 of the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement shall not be deemed to constitute a Lien.

         Minimum Adjusted Principal Balance:  With respect to the Class A-2
Notes, Class A-3 Notes and Class B Notes, $[                 ], $[       ] and
$[                 ], respectively.

         Monthly Security Report:   The report attached as exhibit B to the
Indenture.

         Monthly Servicer's Certificate:   The Monthly Servicer's Certificate
attached to the Supplement for Series 1996-2 as Exhibit B.

         Moody's:   Moody's Investors Service, Inc. or its successor in
interest.

         Net Charge-Off:  With respect to any Payment Date, the aggregate
amount of Optimum Monthly Principal not distributed on such Payment Date and
all prior Payment Dates less the aggregate amount of Reversals allocated on
such Payment Date and prior Payment Dates.





                                        E-12                         
<PAGE>   80


         Note Depositary Agreement:  The DTC Letter of Representations dated as
of the Closing Date by and among, The Depository Trust Company, the Indenture
Trustee and the Issuer.

         Note Owner:  The Beneficial Owner of a Note.

         Note Rate:  With respect to any Interest Period, a per annum rate
equal to the sum of (a) LIBOR and (b) []% with respect to the Class A-1 Notes,
[]% with respect to the Class A-2 Notes, []% with respect to the Class A-3
Notes, and []% with respect to the Class B Notes but in no event greater than
[]%, []%, []% and []% per annum, respectively.

         Note Register:  The register maintained by the Note Registrar in which
the Note Registrar shall provide for the registration of Notes and of transfers
and exchanges of Notes.

         Note Registrar:  The Indenture Trustee, in its capacity as Note
Registrar.

         Noteholder:  The Person in whose name a Note is registered in the Note
Register, except that, any Note registered in the name of the Seller, the
Issuer or the Indenture Trustee or any Affiliate of any of them shall be deemed
not to be outstanding and the registered holder will not be considered a
Noteholder or holder for purposes of giving any request, demand, authorization,
direction, notice, consent or waiver under the Indenture or the Trust Agreement
provided that, in determining whether the Indenture Trustee shall be protected
in relying upon any such request, demand, authorization, direction, notice,
consent or waiver, only Notes that the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee
knows to be so owned shall be so disregarded.  Owners of Notes that have been
pledged in good faith may be regarded as Holders if the pledgee establishes to
the satisfaction of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee the pledgee's
right so to act with respect to such Notes and that the pledgee is not the
Issuer, any other obligor upon the Notes or any Affiliate of any of the
foregoing Persons.

         Notes:  Each of the Class A Notes and Class B Notes.

         Officer's Certificate:  With respect to the Servicer, a certificate
signed by the President, Treasurer or Assistant Treasurer, a Vice President or
an Assistant Vice President, of the Servicer and delivered to the Indenture
Trustee.  With respect to the Issuer, a certificate signed by any Authorized
Officer of the Issuer, under the circumstances described in, and otherwise
complying with, the applicable requirements of Section 10.01 of the Indenture,
and delivered to the Indenture Trustee.  Unless otherwise specified, any
reference in the Indenture to an





                                        E-13                         
<PAGE>   81

Officer's Certificate shall be to an Officer's Certificate of any Authorized
Officer of the Issuer.

         Opinion of Counsel:   A written opinion of counsel who may be in-house
counsel for the Servicer, Seller or Household International, Inc. if    
acceptable to the Indenture Trustee, and the Rating Agencies or counsel for the
Seller, as the case may be.

         Optimum Monthly Principal:  As to any Payment Date, the sum of
Available Investor Principal Collections, any Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest Charge-Offs during the preceding Due Period and the lesser of Excess
Interest and the Net Charge-Off as of the end of the preceding Payment Date.

         Outstanding:   With respect to the Notes, as of the date of
determination, all Notes theretofore executed, authenticated and delivered
under this Indenture except:

              (i)  Notes theretofore cancelled by the Note Registrar or
         delivered to the Indenture Trustee for cancellation; and

             (ii)  Notes in exchange for or in lieu of which other Notes have
         been executed, authenticated and delivered pursuant to the Indenture
         unless proof satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee is presented that
         any such Notes are held by a holder in due course.

         Overcollateralization Amount:  As to any Payment Date, the amount by
which the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount exceeds the
Aggregate Security Balances in each case after giving effect to distributions
on such Payment Date.

         Overcollateralization Minimum Amount:    $[           ].

         Owner Trust Estate:   The corpus of the Issuer created by the Trust
Agreement.

         Owner Trustee:  Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware and its successors and
assigns or any successor owner trustee appointed pursuant to the terms of the
Trust Agreement.

         Paying Agent:   Any paying agent or co-paying agent appointed pursuant
to Section 3.03 of the Indenture, which initially shall be the Indenture 
Trustee.

         Payment Account:  The account established by the Indenture Trustee
pursuant to Section 8.02 of the Indenture.  The Payment Account shall be an
Eligible Deposit Account.





                                        E-14                         
<PAGE>   82

         Payment Date:   The 15th day of each month, or if such day is not a
Business Day, then the next Business Day.

         Percentage Interest:  With respect to any Payment Date and any Note,
the percentage obtained by dividing the Security Balance of such Note prior to
distributions on such Payment Date by the aggregate of the Security Balances of
all Notes of the same Class.  With respect to any Certificate, the percentage
obtained by dividing the denomination specified on such Certificate by the
Initial Principal Balance of the Certificates.

         Person:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.

         Pooling and Servicing Agreement:   The Pooling and Servicing Agreement
dated as of September 1, 1995, as supplemented by the Supplement for Series
1995-1 dated as of September 1, 1995 and the Supplement for Series 1996-2 dated
as of August 1, 1996, by and among the Seller, Servicer and the Deposit Trustee,
as may be amended from time to time.

         Principal Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date and each Note,
the Initial Principal Balance thereof, reduced by all distributions of
principal thereon prior to such Payment Date.

         Proceeding:  Any suit in equity, action at law or other judicial or
administrative proceeding.

         Rating Agency:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.

         Receivables:   The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.

         Receivables Purchase Agreement:   The meaning assigned to such term in
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Record Date:  With respect to the Notes and any Payment Date, the
Business Day next preceding such Payment Date and with respect to the
Certificates and any Payment Date, the last Business Day of the month preceding
the month of such Payment Date.

         Reference Bank Rate:   With respect to any Interest Period, as
follows: the arithmetic mean (rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest one
sixteenth of a percent) of the offered rates for United States  dollar deposits
for one month which are offered by the Reference Banks as of 11:00 A.M., London
time, on the second LIBOR Business Day prior to the first day of such Interest
Period to prime banks in the London interbank market for a period of one month
in amounts approximately equal to the Aggregate





                                        E-15                         
<PAGE>   83

Security Balance; provided that at least two such Reference Banks provide such
rate.  If fewer than two offered rates appear, the Reference Bank Rate will be
the arithmetic mean of the rates quoted by one or more major banks in New York
City, selected by the Indenture Trustee after consultation with the Servicer,
as of 11:00 a.m., New York City time, on such date for loans in U.S. Dollars to
leading European Banks for a period of one month in amounts approximately equal
to the Aggregate Security Balance.  If no such quotations can be obtained, the
Reference Bank Rate shall be the Reference Bank Rate applicable to the
preceding Interest Period.

         Reference Banks:  Three money center banks as selected by the
Indenture Trustee after consultation with the Servicer.

         Registered Holder:  The Person in whose name a Note is registered in
the Note Register on the applicable Record Date.

         Responsible Officer:  With respect to the Indenture Trustee, any
officer of the Indenture Trustee with direct responsibility for the
administration of the Indenture and also, with respect to a particular matter,
any other officer to whom such matter is referred because of such officer's
knowledge of and familiarity with the particular subject.

         Reversals:   With respect to any Payment Date the sum of (i) the Net
Charge-Off previously allocated, to the extent of Excess Interest for such
Payment Date and (ii) the amounts treated as Available Investor Principal
Collections pursuant to Section 4.11(a)(iv) of the Supplement for the related
Distribution Date; provided however, in no event will such Reversals exceed the
Net Charge-Off.

         Sale:   The meaning assigned to such term in Section 5.15 of the
Indenture.

         Securities Act:  The Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the rules
and regulations promulgated thereunder.

         Security:  Any of the Certificates or Notes.

         Security Balance:  The Principal Balance of the Notes, or the
Certificate Balance, as the case may be.

         Security Collections:  With respect to any Payment Date the sum of
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Monthly Interest and Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Monthly Principal for such Payment Date.

         Securityholder or Holder:  Any Noteholder or a Certificateholder.





                                        E-16                         
<PAGE>   84


         Seller:  Household Consumer Loan Corporation, a Nevada corporation and
a wholly-owned, special purpose subsidiary of Household Finance Corporation, or
its successor in interest.

         Seller's Trust Amount:   The meaning assigned to such term in the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Series Participation Interest:   The meaning assigned to such term in
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest:   The Series 1996-2
Participation Interest issued pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement.

         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Charge-Offs:   The meaning
assigned to such term in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount:  The meaning
assigned to such term in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Monthly Interest:   The meaning
assigned to such term in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Monthly Principal:  The meaning
assigned to such term in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Servicer:  HFC and its successors and assigns.

         Servicer Default:  An event specified in Section 10.01 of the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement.

         Single Certificate:  A Certificate in the denomination of $1,000,000.

         Single Note:  A Note in the amount of $100,000.

         Standard & Poor's:  Standard & Poor's Ratings Services, a Division of
the McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., or its successor in interest.

         Successor Designated Certificateholder:   The meaning assigned to such
term in Section 9.02 of the Trust Agreement.

         Telerate Screen Page 3750:  The display designated as page 3750 on the
Telerate Service (or such other page as may replace page 3750 on that service
for the purpose of displaying London interbank offered rates of major banks).





                                        E-17                         
<PAGE>   85


         Treasury Regulations:  Regulations, including proposed or temporary
Regulations, promulgated under the Code.  References herein to specific
provisions of proposed or temporary regulations shall include analogous
provisions of final Treasury Regulations or other successor Treasury
Regulations.

         Trust Agreement:  The Trust Agreement dated as of August 1, 1996
between the Owner Trustee and the Seller, as amended from time to time.

         Trust Indenture Act or TIA:   The Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as
amended from time to time, as in effect on any relevant date.

         UCC:  The Uniform Commercial Code, as amended from time to time, as in
effect in any specified jurisdiction.





                                        E-18                         
<PAGE>   86

                                                                       EXHIBIT F

                       CERTIFICATE OF NON-FOREIGN STATUS

         This Certificate of Non-Foreign Status ("certificate") is delivered
pursuant to Section 3.03 of the Trust Agreement, dated as of ____________ 1,
1996 (the "Trust Agreement"), among the Household Consumer Loan Corporation, as
seller and the entity who is the general partner for tax purposes (the
"Designated Holder") and Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware, as Owner Trustee, in
connection with the acquisition of, transfer to or possession by the
undersigned, whether as beneficial owner (the "Beneficial Owner"), or nominee
on behalf of the Beneficial Owner of the Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed
Certificates, Series 1996-2 (the "Certificate").  Capitalized terms used but
not defined in this certificate have the respective meanings given them in the
Trust Agreement.

Each holder must complete Part I, Part II (if the holder is a nominee), and in
all cases sign and otherwise complete Part III.  In addition, each holder shall
submit with the Certificate an IRS Form W-9 relating to such holder.

To confirm to the Issuer that the provisions of Section 1446 of the Internal
Revenue Code (relating to withholding tax on foreign partners) do not apply in
respect of the Certificate held by the undersigned, the undersigned hereby
certifies:

Part I -                  Complete Either A or B

                 A.       Individual as Beneficial Owner

                          1.      I am (The Beneficial Owner is) not a
                                  non-resident alien for purposes of U.S.
                                  income taxation;

                          2.      My (The Beneficial Owner's) name and home
                                  address are:
                                  _________________________________________
                                  _________________________________________
                                  _________________________________________;
                                  and

                          3.      My (The Beneficial Owner's) U.S. taxpayer
                                  identification number (Social Security
                                  Number) is ___________________________.

                 B.       Corporate, Partnership or Other Entity as Beneficial
                 Owner





                                      F-1
<PAGE>   87

                          1.      ________________________ (Name of the
                                  Beneficial Owner) is not a foreign
                                  corporation, foreign partnership, foreign
                                  trust or foreign estate (as those terms are
                                  defined in the Code and Treasury
                                  Regulations);

                          2.      The Beneficial Owner's office address and
                                  place of incorporation (if applicable) is
                                  ______________________________________; and

                          3.      The Beneficial Owner's U.S. employer 
                                  identification number is __________________.


Part II -                 Nominees

         If the undersigned is the nominee for the Beneficial Owner, the
undersigned certifies that this certificate has been made in reliance upon
information contained in:

                 ______ an IRS Form W-9

                 ______ a form such as this or substantially similar

provided to the undersigned by an appropriate person and (i) the undersigned
agrees to notify the Issuer at least thirty (30) days prior to the date that
the form relied upon becomes obsolete, and (ii) in connection with change in
Beneficial Owners, the undersigned agrees to submit a new Certificate of
Non-Foreign Status to the Issuer promptly after such change.

Part III -       Declaration

         The undersigned, as the Beneficial Owner or a nominee thereof, agrees
to notify the Issuer within sixty (60) days of the date that the Beneficial
Owner becomes a foreign person.  The undersigned understands that this
certificate may be disclosed to the Internal Revenue Service by the Issuer and
any false statement contained therein could be punishable by fines,
imprisonment or both.





                                      F-2
<PAGE>   88


         Under penalties of perjury, I declare that I have examined this
certificate and to the best of my knowledge and belief it is true, correct and
complete and will further declare that I will inform the Issuer of any change
in the information provided above, and, if applicable, I further declare that I
have the authority* to sign this document.


                                    
- ------------------------------------
              Name

                                    
- ------------------------------------
      Title (if applicable)

                                   
- -----------------------------------
     Signature and Date




*NOTE:  If signed pursuant to a power of attorney, the power of attorney must
accompany this certificate.





                                      F-3
<PAGE>   89

                                                                       EXHIBIT G

                   FORM OF INVESTMENT LETTER [NON-RULE 144A]


                                     [DATE]

                            [Certificate Registrar]



         Re:  Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
              Consumer Loan Asset Backed Certificates,
              Series 1996-2 (the "Certificates")

Ladies and Gentlemen:

         In connection with our acquisition of the above-captioned
Certificates, we certify that (a) we understand that the Certificates are not
being registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Act"), or
any state securities laws and are being transferred to us in a transaction that
is exempt from the registration requirements of the Act and any such laws, (b)
we are an "accredited investor," as defined in Regulation D under the Act, and
have such knowledge and experience in financial and business matters that we
are capable of evaluating the merits and risks of investments in the
Certificates, (c) we have had the opportunity to review the Trust Agreement,
Indenture and Pooling and Servicing Agreement and we have had the opportunity
to ask questions of and receive answers from the Seller concerning the purchase
of the Certificates and all matters relating thereto or any additional
information deemed necessary to our decision to purchase the Certificates, (d)
we are not an employee benefit plan that is subject to the Employee Retirement
Income Security Act of 1974, as amended, or a plan that is subject to Section
4975 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, nor are we acting on
behalf of or using the assets of any such plan, [or if the Purchaser is an
insurance company, a representation that the Purchaser is an insurance company
which is purchasing such certificates with funds contained in an "insurance
company general account" (as such term is defined in section v(e) of prohibited
transaction class exemption 95-60 ("ptce 95-60")) and that the purchase and
holding of such certificates are covered under ptce 95-60,] or (iv) in the case
of any such proposed transferee which is a plan, an opinion of counsel
satisfactory to the Owner Trustee and the Seller to the effect set forth in the
agreement (e) we are acquiring the Certificates for investment for our own
account and not with a view to any distribution of such Certificates (but
without prejudice to our right at all times to sell or otherwise dispose of the
Certificates in accordance with clause (g) below), (f) we have not offered or





                                      G-1
<PAGE>   90

sold any Certificates to, or solicited offers to buy any Certificates from, any
person, or otherwise approached or negotiated with any person with respect
thereto, or taken any other action which would result in a violation of Section
5 of the Act, (g) we will not sell, transfer or otherwise dispose of any
Certificates unless (1) such sale, transfer or other disposition is made
pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Act or is exempt from
such registration requirements, and if such transfer is made pursuant to an
exemption other than Rule 144A, we will, if requested, at our expense provide
an opinion of counsel satisfactory to the addressees of this certificate that
such sale, transfer or other disposition may be made pursuant to an exemption
from the Act, (2) the purchaser or transferee of such Certificate has executed
and delivered to you a certificate to substantially the same effect as this
certificate, and (3) the purchaser or transferee has otherwise complied with
any conditions for transfer set forth in the Trust Agreement, and (h), either
(i) we are a "C Corporation" under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as
amended, or (ii) we have provided such disclosure concerning our status for
federal income tax purposes and the status and economic interest of our
beneficial owners, as the Issuer or its representatives have reasonably
requested to determine that our acquisition of the Certificates will not
subject the Issuer to an entity level tax.

                                                 Very truly yours,

                                                 [TRANSFEREE]


                                                 By:                           
                                                     --------------------------
                                                           Authorized Officer






                                     G-2

<PAGE>   1
                                                                    Exhibit 4.2





                     HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2,

                                   as Issuer


                                      AND


                             THE BANK OF NEW YORK,

                              as Indenture Trustee


                   _________________________________________



                              [FORM OF INDENTURE]

                       Dated as of [______________] 1996


                   __________________________________________



                   HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN ASSET BACKED NOTES

                                 SERIES 1996-2
<PAGE>   2

                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

Section                                                                                                               Page
- -------                                                                                                               ----
                                                            ARTICLE I

                                                           Definitions
                                                                                                                                    
         <S>          <C>                                                                                              <C>
         1.01.        Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
         1.02.        Incorporation by Reference of Trust Indenture Act   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
         1.03.        Rules of Construction.  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
   
                                                            ARTICLE II

                                                    Original Issuance of Notes
         2.01.        Form   . . . . . . . . . . . .  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   4
         2.02.        Execution, Authentication and Delivery  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   4
         2.03.        Opinions of Counsel   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   5

                                                           ARTICLE III

                                                            Covenants

         3.01.        Collection of Payments on the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest  . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   6
         3.02.        Maintenance of Office or Agency   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   6
         3.03.        Money for Payments To Be Held in Trust; Paying Agent; Certificate Paying Agent. . . . . . . . .   6
         3.04.        Existence   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   9
         3.05.        Payment of Principal and Interest; Defaulted Interest   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   9
         3.06.        Protection of Indenture Trust Estate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  13
         3.07.        Opinions as to Indenture Trust Estate   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  13
         3.08.        Performance of Obligations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  14
         3.09.        Negative Covenants  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
         3.10.        Annual Statement as to Compliance   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
         3.11.        Indenture Trust Estate; Related Documents   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
         3.12.        Amendments to Pooling and Servicing Agreement   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
         3.13.        Investment Company Act  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
         3.14.        Existence of Issuer; Issuer May Consolidate, etc., Only on Certain Terms  . . . . . . . . . . .  17
         3.15.        Successor or Transferee   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
         3.16.        No Other Business   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
         3.17.        No Borrowing  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
         3.18.        Guarantees, Loans, Advances and Other Liabilities   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
         3.19.        Capital Expenditures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
         3.20.        Restricted Payments   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
         3.21.        Notice of Events of Default   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
         3.22.        Further Instruments and Acts  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  20
                                                         

                       
</TABLE>


                                       i
<PAGE>   3
<TABLE>
         <S>       <C>                                                                                                        <C>
         3.23.     Statements to Noteholders   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   20
         3.24.     Determination of Note Rate and Certificate Rate.  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   20
         3.25.     Optional Repurchase of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   20

                                                                ARTICLE IV

                                            The Notes; Satisfaction and Discharge of Indenture

         4.01.     The Notes   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   21
         4.02.     Registration of and Limitations on Transfer and Exchange of Notes; 
                   Appointment of Certificate Registrar  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   21
         4.03.     Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen Notes  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   22
         4.04.     Persons Deemed Owners   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   24
         4.05.     Cancellation  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   24
         4.06.     Book-Entry Notes  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   24
         4.07.     Notices to Depository   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   25
         4.08.     Definitive Notes  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   . .   25
         4.09.     Tax Treatment   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   26
         4.10.     Satisfaction and Discharge of Indenture   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   26
         4.11.     Application of Trust Money  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   27
         4.12.     Repayment of Moneys Held by Paying Agent  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   27

                                                                 ARTICLE V

                                                                 Remedies

         5.01.     Event of Default; Acceleration of Maturity; Rescission and Annulment  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   28
         5.02.     Collection of Indebtedness and Suits for Enforcement by Indenture Trustee   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   29
         5.03.     Remedies; Priorities  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   31
         5.04.     Optional Preservation of the Indenture Trust Estate   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   33
         5.05.     Limitation of Suits   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   33
         5.06.     Unconditional Rights of Noteholders To Receive Principal and Interest   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   34
         5.07.     Restoration of Rights and Remedies  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   34
         5.08.     Rights and Remedies Cumulative  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   34
         5.09.     Delay or Omission Not a Waiver  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   34
         5.10.     Control by Noteholders  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   35
         5.11.     Waiver of Past Defaults   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   35
         5.12.     Undertaking for Costs   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   36
         5.13.     Waiver of Stay or Extension Laws  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   36
         5.14.     Sale of Indenture Trust Estate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   36
         5.15.     Action on Notes   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   38
         5.16.     Performance and Enforcement of Certain Obligations  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   39
</TABLE>





                                       ii
<PAGE>   4

<TABLE>
                                                                   ARTICLE VI

                                                              The Indenture Trustee
         <S>          <C>                                                                                                      <C>
         6.01.        Duties of Indenture Trustee   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   40
         6.02.        Rights of Indenture Trustee   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   41
         6.03.        Individual Rights of Indenture Trustee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   42
         6.04.        Indenture Trustee's Disclaimer  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   42
         6.05.        Notice of Event of Default  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   42
         6.06.        Reports by Indenture Trustee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   42
         6.07.        Compensation and Indemnity  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   42
         6.08.        Replacement of Indenture Trustee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   43
         6.09.        Successor Indenture Trustee by Merger   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   44
         6.10.        Appointment of Co-Indenture Trustee or Separate Indenture Trustee   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   45
         6.11.        Eligibility; Disqualification   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   46
         6.12.        Preferential Collection of Claims Against Issuer  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   46
         6.13.        Representation and Warranty   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   47
         6.14.        Directions to Indenture Trustee   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   47
         6.15.        No Consent to Certain Acts of Seller  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   47

                                                                   ARTICLE VII

                                                         Noteholders' Lists and Reports

         7.01.        Issuer To Furnish Indenture Trustee Names and Addresses of Noteholders  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   48
         7.02.        Preservation of Information; Communications to Noteholders  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   48
         7.03.        Reports by Issuer   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   48
         7.04.        Reports by Indenture Trustee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   49

                                                                  ARTICLE VIII

                                                      Accounts, Disbursements and Releases

         8.01.        Collection of Money   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   50
         8.02.        Trust Accounts  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   50
         8.03.        Opinion of Counsel  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   50
         8.04.        Termination Upon Distribution to Noteholders  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   51
         8.05.        Release of Indenture Trust Estate   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   51
         8.06.        Surrender of Notes Upon Final Payment   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   52

                                                                   ARTICLE IX

                                                             Supplemental Indentures

         9.01.        Supplemental Indentures Without Consent of Noteholders  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
</TABLE>





                                      iii
<PAGE>   5

<TABLE>
        <S>           <C>                                                                                                     <C>
         9.02.        Supplemental Indentures With Consent of Noteholders   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   54
         9.03.        Execution of Supplemental Indentures  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   56
         9.04.        Effect of Supplemental Indenture  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   56
         9.05.        Conformity with Trust Indenture Act   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   56
         9.06.        Reference in Notes to Supplemental Indentures   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   57

                                                                    ARTICLE X

                                                                  Miscellaneous

         10.01.       Compliance Certificates and Opinions, etc   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   58
         10.02.       Form of Documents Delivered to Indenture Trustee  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   60
         10.03.       Acts of Noteholders   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   60
         10.04.       Notices, etc., to Indenture Trustee, Issuer, and Rating Agencies  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   61
         10.05.       Notices to Noteholders; Waiver  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   62
         10.06.       Alternate Payment and Notice Provisions   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   63
         10.07.       Conflict with Trust Indenture Act   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   63
         10.08.       Effect of Headings  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   63
         10.09.       Successors and Assigns  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   63
         10.10.       Separability  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   63
         10.11.       Benefits of Indenture   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   63
         10.12.       GOVERNING LAW   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   63
         10.13.       Counterparts  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   64
         10.14.       Recording of Indenture  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   64
         10.15.       Issuer Obligation   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   64
         10.16.       No Petition   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   64
         10.17.       Inspection  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   65
         10.18.       Authority of the Administrator  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   65

Signatures and Seals  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   66
Acknowledgments   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   67

EXHIBITS

Exhibit A-1 - Form of Class A-1 Note
Exhibit A-2 - Form of Class A-2 Note
Exhibit A-3 - Form of Class A-3 Note
Exhibit A-4 - Form of Class B Note

Appendix A  - Definitions
</TABLE>





                                       iv
<PAGE>   6

                 This Indenture, dated as of [________________] 1996, between
HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2, a Delaware business trust, as Issuer (the
"Issuer"), and The Bank of New York, a New York banking corporation, as
Indenture Trustee (the "Indenture Trustee"),

                                WITNESSETH THAT:

                 Each party hereto agrees as follows for the benefit of the
other party and for the benefit of the Holders of the Household Consumer Loan
Asset Backed Notes, Series 1996-2, Class A and Class B Notes (collectively the
"Notes").


                                GRANTING CLAUSE

                 The Issuer hereby Grants to the Indenture Trustee at the
Closing Date, as Indenture Trustee for the benefit of the Holders of the Notes,
all of the Issuer's right, title and interest in and to whether now existing or
hereafter created (a)  the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest free and clear
of any Liens, and all monies and the collections and proceeds due thereon and
any part thereof which consists of general intangibles (as defined in the UCC),
(b) all rights of the Issuer as holder of the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest in and to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement including without
limitation, rights to consent, receive notices and vote thereunder; (c) all
funds on deposit from time to time in the Payment Account and all proceeds
thereof, and (d) all present and future claims, demands, causes and chooses in
action in respect of any or all of the foregoing and all payments on or under,
and all proceeds of every kind and nature whatsoever in respect of, any or all
of the foregoing and all payments on or under, and all proceeds of every kind
and nature whatsoever in the conversion thereof, voluntary or involuntary, into
cash or other liquid property, all cash proceeds, accounts, accounts
receivable, notes, drafts, acceptances, checks, deposit accounts, rights to
payment of any and every kind, and other forms of obligations and receivables,
instruments and other property which at any time constitute all or part of or
are included in the proceeds of any of the foregoing (collectively, the
"Indenture Trust Estate" or the "Indenture Collateral").

                 The foregoing Grant is made in trust to secure the payment of
principal of and interest on, and any other amounts owing in respect of, the
Notes, and to secure compliance with the provisions of this Indenture, all as
provided in this Indenture.

                 The Indenture Trustee, as Indenture Trustee on behalf of the
Holders of the Notes, acknowledges such Grant, accepts the trust under this
Indenture in accordance with the provisions





<PAGE>   7

hereof and agrees to perform its duties as Indenture Trustee as required
herein.


                                   ARTICLE I

                                  Definitions

          Section 1.01.  Definitions.  For all purposes of this Indenture,
except as otherwise expressly provided herein or unless the context otherwise
requires, capitalized terms not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings
assigned to such terms in the Definitions attached hereto as Appendix A which is
incorporated by reference herein.  All other capitalized terms used herein shall
have the meanings specified herein.

          Section 1.02.  Incorporation by Reference of Trust Indenture Act.
Whenever this Indenture refers to a provision of the TIA, the provision is
incorporated by reference in and made a part of this Indenture.  The following
TIA terms used in this Indenture have the following meanings:

                 "Commission" means the Securities and Exchange Commission.

                 "indenture securities" means the Notes.

                 "indenture security holder" means a Noteholder.

                 "indenture to be qualified" means this Indenture.

                 "indenture trustee" or "institutional trustee" means the
          Indenture Trustee.

                 "obligor" on the indenture securities means the Issuer and any 
          other obligor on the indenture securities.

          All other TIA terms used in this Indenture that are defined by the 
TIA, defined by TIA reference to another statute or defined by
Commission rule have the meaning assigned to them by such definitions.

         Section 1.03.  Rules of Construction.  Unless the context otherwise 
requires:

                 (i)   a term has the meaning assigned to it;

                (ii)  an accounting term not otherwise defined has the meaning
         assigned to it in accordance with generally accepted accounting
         principles as in effect from time to time;

               (iii)   "or" is not exclusive;





                                       2
<PAGE>   8


                      (iv)  "including" means including without limitation;

                       (v)  words in the singular include the plural and words
         in the plural include the singular; and

                      (vi)  any agreement, instrument or statute defined or
         referred to herein or in any instrument or certificate delivered in
         connection herewith means such agreement, instrument or statute as
         from time to time amended, modified or supplemented and includes (in
         the case of agreements or instruments) references to all attachments
         thereto and instruments incorporated therein; references to a Person
         are also to its permitted successors and assigns.





                                       3
<PAGE>   9

                                   ARTICLE II

                           Original Issuance of Notes

         Section 2.01.  Form.  The Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3 and Class B
Notes, together with the Indenture Trustee's certificate of authentication,
shall be in substantially the forms set forth in Exhibits A-1, A-2, A-3 and B,
respectively, with such appropriate insertions, omissions, substitutions and
other variations as are required or permitted by this Indenture and may have
such letters, numbers or other marks of identification and such legends or
endorsements placed thereon as may, consistently herewith, be determined by the
officers executing such Notes, as evidenced by their execution of the Notes.
Any portion of the text of any Note may be set forth on the reverse thereof,
with an appropriate reference thereto on the face of the Note.

         The Notes shall be typewritten, printed, lithographed or engraved or
produced by any combination of these methods (with or without steel engraved
borders), all as determined by the Authorized Officers executing such Notes, as
evidenced by their execution of such Notes.

         The terms of the Notes set forth in Exhibits A-1, A-2, A-3, and B are
part of the terms of this Indenture.

         Section 2.02.  Execution, Authentication and Delivery.  The Notes
shall be executed on behalf of the Issuer by any of its Authorized Officers.
The signature of any such Authorized Officer on the Notes may be manual or
facsimile.

         Notes bearing the manual or facsimile signature of individuals who
were at any time Authorized Officers of the Issuer shall bind the Issuer,
notwithstanding that such individuals or any of them have ceased to hold such
offices prior to the authentication and delivery of such Notes or did not hold
such offices at the date of such Notes.

         The Indenture Trustee shall upon Issuer Request authenticate and
deliver the Class A-1 Notes, Class A-2 Notes, Class A-3 Notes  and Class B
Notes for original issue in aggregate initial principal amounts of
$_____________, $_____________, $_____________, and $_____________,
respectively.

         Each Note shall be dated the date of its authentication.  The Notes
shall be issuable as registered Notes and the Notes shall be issuable in the
minimum initial Security Balances of $100,000 and in integral multiples of
$1,000 in excess thereof.

         No Note shall be entitled to any benefit under this Indenture or be
valid or obligatory for any purpose, unless there appears on such Note a
certificate of authentication substan-



                                       4

<PAGE>   10


tially in the form provided for herein executed by the Indenture Trustee by the
manual signature of one of its authorized signatories, and such certificate upon
any Note shall be conclusive evidence, and the only evidence, that such Note has
been duly authenticated and delivered hereunder.

         Section 2.03.  Opinions of Counsel.  On the Closing Date, the
Indenture Trustee shall have received:  (i) an Opinion of Counsel, in form and
substance reasonably satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee and its counsel,
with respect to securities law matters; (ii) an Opinion of Counsel, in form and
substance reasonably satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee and its counsel,
with respect to the tax status of the arrangement created by the Indenture;
(iii) an Opinion of Counsel to the Issuer, in form and substance reasonably
satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee and its counsel, with respect to the due
authorization, valid execution and delivery of this Indenture and with respect
to its binding effect on the Issuer; and (iv) an Opinion of Counsel to the
Issuer, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee
and its counsel, to the effect that the Indenture creates in favor of the
Indenture Trustee a first priority perfected security interest in the Series
1996-2 Participation Interest and the other assets of the Indenture Trust
Estate.





                                       5
<PAGE>   11

                                  ARTICLE III

                                   Covenants

         Section 3.01.  Collection of Payments on the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest.  The Indenture Trustee shall establish and maintain
with itself a trust account (the "Payment Account") in which the Indenture
Trustee shall, subject to the terms of this paragraph, deposit, on the same day
as it is received from the Deposit Trustee, each remittance received by the
Indenture Trustee with respect to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest.
The Indenture Trustee shall make all payments of principal of and interest on
the Notes, subject to Section 3.03 as provided in Section 3.05 herein from
moneys on deposit in the Payment Account.

         Section 3.02.  Maintenance of Office or Agency.  The Issuer will
maintain in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York, an office or agency
where, subject to satisfaction of conditions set forth herein, Notes may be
surrendered for registration of transfer or exchange, and where notices and
demands to or upon the Issuer in respect of the Notes and this Indenture may be
served.  The Issuer hereby initially appoints the Indenture Trustee to serve as
its agent for the foregoing purposes.  If at any time the Issuer shall fail to
maintain any such office or agency or shall fail to furnish the Indenture
Trustee with the address thereof, such surrenders, notices and demands may be
made or served at the Corporate Trust Office of the Indenture Trustee, and the
Issuer hereby appoints the Indenture Trustee as its agent to receive all such
surrenders, notices and demands.

         Section 3.03.  Money for Payments To Be Held in Trust; Paying Agent;
Certificate Paying Agent.  (a) As provided in Section 3.01, all payments of
amounts due and payable with respect to any Notes that are to be made from
amounts withdrawn from the Payment Account pursuant to Section 3.01 shall be
made on behalf of the Issuer by the Indenture Trustee or by the Paying Agent,
and no amounts so withdrawn from the Payment Account for payments of Notes
shall be paid over to the Issuer except as provided in this Section 3.03.

         The Issuer will cause each Paying Agent other than the Indenture
Trustee to execute and deliver to the Indenture Trustee an instrument in which
such Paying Agent shall agree with the Indenture Trustee (and if the Indenture
Trustee acts as Paying Agent it hereby so agrees), subject to the provisions of
this Section 3.03, that such Paying Agent will:

                      (i)   hold all sums held by it for the payment of amounts
         due with respect to the Notes in trust for the benefit of the Persons
         entitled thereto until such sums shall be paid to such Persons or
         otherwise disposed of as





                                       6
<PAGE>   12

         herein provided and pay such sums to such Persons as herein provided;

                     (ii)   give the Indenture Trustee notice of any default by
         the Issuer of which it has actual knowledge in the making of any
         payment required to be made with respect to the Notes;

                    (iii)   at any time during the continuance of any such
         default, upon the written request of the Indenture Trustee, forthwith
         pay to the Indenture Trustee all sums so held in trust by such Paying
         Agent;

                     (iv)   immediately resign as Paying Agent and forthwith
         pay to the Indenture Trustee all sums held by it in trust for the
         payment of Notes if at any time it ceases to meet the standards
         required to be met by a Paying Agent at the time of its appointment;
         and

                      (v)   comply with all requirements of the Code with
         respect to the withholding from any payments made by it on any Notes
         of any applicable withholding taxes imposed thereon and with respect
         to any applicable reporting requirements in connection therewith.

         The Issuer may at any time, for the purpose of obtaining the
satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture or for any other purpose, by
Issuer Request direct any Paying Agent to pay to the Indenture Trustee all sums
held in trust by such Paying Agent, such sums to be held by the Indenture
Trustee upon the same trusts as those upon which the sums were held by such
Paying Agent; and upon such payment by any Paying Agent to the Indenture
Trustee, such Paying Agent shall be released from all further liability with
respect to such money.

         Subject to applicable laws with respect to escheat of funds, any money
held by the Indenture Trustee or any Paying Agent in trust for the payment of
any amount due with respect to any Note and remaining unclaimed for two years
after such amount has become due and payable shall be discharged from such
trust and be paid to the Issuer on Issuer Request; and the Holder of such Note
shall thereafter, as an unsecured general creditor, look only to the Issuer for
payment thereof (but only to the extent of the amounts so paid to the Issuer),
and all liability of the Indenture Trustee or such Paying Agent with respect to
such trust money shall thereupon cease; provided, however, that the Indenture
Trustee or such Paying Agent, before being required to make any such repayment,
shall at the expense and direction of the Issuer cause to be published once, in
an Authorized Newspaper published in the English language, notice that such
money remains unclaimed and that, after a date specified therein, which shall
not be less than 30 days from the date of such publication, any





                                       7
<PAGE>   13

unclaimed balance of such money then remaining will be repaid to the Issuer.
The Indenture Trustee shall also adopt and employ, at the expense and direction
of the Issuer, any other reasonable means of notification of such repayment
(including, but not limited to, mailing notice of such repayment to Holders
whose Notes have been called but have not been surrendered for redemption or
whose right to or interest in moneys due and payable but not claimed is
determinable from the records of the Indenture Trustee or of any Paying Agent,
at the last address of record for each such Holder).

         The Issuer hereby appoints The Bank of New York as Certificate Paying
Agent to make payments to Certificateholders on behalf of the Issuer in
accordance with the provisions of the Certificates, Section 3.05 hereof and the
provisions of the Trust Agreement, and The Bank of New York hereby accepts such
appointment and further agrees that it will be bound by the provisions of the
Trust Agreement relating to the Certificate Paying Agent and will:

                      (i)   hold all sums held by it for the payment of amounts
         due with respect to the Certificates in trust for the benefit of the
         Persons entitled thereto until such sums shall be paid to such Persons
         or otherwise disposed of as herein provided and as provided in the
         Trust Agreement and pay such sums to such Persons as herein and
         therein provided;

                     (ii)   give the Owner Trustee notice of any default by the
         Issuer of which it has actual knowledge in the making of any payment
         required to be made with respect to the Certificates;

                    (iii)   at any time during the continuance of any such
         default, upon the written request of the Owner Trustee forthwith pay
         to the Owner Trustee on behalf of the Issuer all sums so held in Trust
         by such Certificate Paying Agent;

                     (iv)   immediately resign as Certificate Paying Agent and
         forthwith pay to the Owner Trustee on behalf of the Issuer all sums
         held by it in trust for the payment of Certificates if at any time it
         ceases to meet the standards required to be met by the Certificate
         Paying Agent at the time of its appointment;

                      (v)   comply with all requirements of the Code with
         respect to the withholding from any payments made by it on any
         Certificates of any applicable withholding taxes imposed thereon and
         with respect to any applicable reporting requirements in connection
         therewith; and





                                       8
<PAGE>   14

                      (vi)  deliver to the Owner Trustee a copy of the report
         to Certificateholders prepared with respect to each Payment Date by
         the Servicer pursuant to Article V of the Pooling and Servicing
         Agreement.

         Section 3.04.  Existence.  The Issuer will keep in full effect its
existence, rights and franchises as a business trust under the laws of the
State of Delaware (unless it becomes, or any successor Issuer hereunder is or
becomes, organized under the laws of any other state or of the United States of
America, in which case the Issuer will keep in full effect its existence,
rights and franchises under the laws of such other jurisdiction) and will
obtain and preserve its qualification to do business in each jurisdiction in
which such qualification is or shall be necessary to protect the validity and
enforceability of this Indenture, the Notes, the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest and each other instrument or agreement included in the Indenture Trust
Estate.

         Section 3.05.  Payment of Principal and Interest; Defaulted Interest.
(a)  On each Payment Date from amounts on deposit in the Payment Account, the
Paying Agent, on behalf of the Issuer, shall pay to the Noteholders and the
Certificate Paying Agent, on behalf of the Issuer shall pay to the
Certificateholders and the Indenture Trustee in its capacity as agent for the
Issuer shall pay to other Persons the amounts to which they are entitled as set
forth below:

                      (i)   sequentially (a) to the Holders of the Class A-1
         Notes, the related Class Interest Distribution, (b) to the Holders of
         the Class A-2 Notes, the related Class Interest Distribution, (c) to
         the Holders of the Class A-3 Notes, the related Class Interest
         Distribution, (d) to the Holders of the Class B Notes, the related
         Class Interest Distribution and (e) subject to the proviso set forth
         following clause (vii) below to the Holders of the Certificates, the
         Certificate Yield;

                      (ii)  sequentially, up to the Optimum Monthly Principal,

                          (a) to the Holders of the Class A-1 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance of the Class A-1 Notes would equal the Class
                 A- 1 Targeted Principal Balance,

                          (b) to the Holders of the Class A-2 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance of the Class A-2 Notes would equal the Class
                 A- 2 Targeted Principal Balance, so long as the related
                 Adjusted Principal Balance for the Class A-2 Notes would not
                 thereby be reduced below the related Minimum Adjusted
                 Principal Balance for such Class of Notes,





                                       9
<PAGE>   15


                          (c) to the Holders of the Class A-3 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance of the Class A-3 Notes would equal the Class
                 A- 3 Targeted Principal Balance, so long as the related
                 Adjusted Principal Balance for the Class A-3 Notes would not
                 thereby be reduced below the related Minimum Adjusted
                 Principal Balance for such Class of Notes, and

                          (d) to the Holders of the Class B Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance of the Class B Notes would equal the Class B
                 Targeted Principal Balance, so long as the related Adjusted
                 Principal Balance for the Class B Notes would not thereby be
                 reduced below the related Minimum Adjusted Principal Balance
                 for such Class of Notes;

                    (iii)   to the Holders of the Certificates, up to the
         balance of the Optimum Monthly Principal, until the Certificate
         Balance would equal the Certificate Targeted Balance so long as the
         Certificate Adjusted Security Balance would not thereby be reduced
         below the Certificate Minimum Adjusted Balance;

                      (iv)  HCLC, the initial Holder of the Designated
         Certificate or its transferee, up to the balance of the Optimum
         Monthly Principal, provided the Overcollateralization Amount is not
         less than the Overcollateralization Minimum Amount;

                      (v)   sequentially, up to the Accelerated Principal
         Payment Amount,

                          (a) to the Holders of the Class A-1 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance of the Class A-1 Notes would equal the Class
                 A- 1 Targeted Principal Balance,

                          (b) to the Holders of the Class A-2 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance of the Class A-2 Notes would equal the Class
                 A- 2 Targeted Principal Balance, so long as the related
                 Adjusted Principal Balance for the Class A-2 Notes would not
                 thereby be reduced below the related Minimum Adjusted
                 Principal Balance for such Class of Notes,

                          (c) to the Holders of the Class A-3 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance of the Class A-3 Notes would equal the Class
                 A- 3 Targeted Principal Balance, so long as the related
                 Adjusted Principal Balance for the Class A-3 Notes would not
                 thereby be reduced below the related Minimum Adjusted
                 Principal Balance for such Class of Notes, and





                                       10
<PAGE>   16

                          (d) to the Holders of the Class B Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance of the Class B Notes would equal the Class B
                 Targeted Principal Balance, so long as the related Adjusted
                 Principal Balance for the Class B Notes would not thereby be
                 reduced below the related Minimum Adjusted Principal Balance
                 for such Class of Notes,

                          (e) to the Holders of the Class A-1 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance on the Class A-1 Notes would equal zero,

                          (f) to the Holders of the Class A-2 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance on the Class A-2 Notes would equal zero,

                          (g) to the Holders of the Class A-3 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance on the Class A-3 Notes would equal zero, and

                          (h) to the Holders of the Class B Notes, until the 
                 Principal Balance on the Class B Notes would equal zero;

                 (vi)  sequentially, up to the balance of the Optimum
          Monthly Principal,

                          (a) to the Holders of the Class A-1 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance on the Class A-1 Notes would equal zero,

                          (b) to the Holders of the Class A-2 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance on the Class A-2 Notes would equal zero,

                          (c) to the Holders of the Class A-3 Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance on the Class A-3 Notes would equal zero,

                          (d) to the Holders of the Class B Notes, until the
                 Principal Balance on the Class B Notes would equal zero, and
                 
                          (e) to the Holders of the Certificates, until the
                 Certificate Balance would equal the Certificate Minimum
                 Balance, or if the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
                 Invested Amount is zero, then to the to the Holders of the
                 Certificates, until the Certificate Balance would equal zero,
                 and





                                       11
<PAGE>   17

                          (f) to HCLC, the initial Holder of the Designated
                 Certificate or its transferee provided the
                 Overcollateralization Amount is greater than zero; and

                    (vii)   any remaining amounts to HCLC, the initial Holder
of the Designated Certificate or its transferee.

provided that, in the event (a) an Event of Default shall have occurred and be
continuing, (b) immediately prior to any Distribution Date the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Invested Amount is less than the aggregate Security
Balance of the Class A and Class B Notes immediately prior to such related
Payment Date, or (c) the remittances on the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest for such Payment Date is less than the aggregate amount to be paid
pursuant to clauses (i) above, the amount to be paid pursuant to clause (i)(c)
above will be paid only after payments are made on the Notes pursuant to clause
(ii) for such Payment Date.

         Amounts distributed pursuant to clauses (iv) and (vi)(f) above shall
be paid in the following order in respect of the following amounts (a) first to
HCLC, the initial Holder of the Designated Certificate or its transferee to the
extent of Accelerated Principal Payments made on the Notes, and (b) second to
HCLC, the initial Holder of the Designated Certificate or its transferee in
reduction of the Holdback Amount and (c) third once the Holdback Amount is
reduced to zero, any remaining amount to HCLC, as the initial Holder of the
Designated Certificate or its transferee.

         The amounts paid to Noteholders shall be paid to each Class in
accordance with the Class Percentage as set forth in paragraph (b) below.
Interest will accrue on the Notes during an Interest Period on the basis of the
actual number of days in such Interest Period and a year assumed to consist of
360 days.

         Any installment of interest or principal, if any, payable on any Note
that is punctually paid or duly provided for by the Issuer on the applicable
Payment Date shall, if such Holder holds Notes of an aggregate initial
Principal Balance of at least $5,000,000 be paid to each Holder of record on
the preceding Record Date, by wire transfer to an account specified in writing
by such Holder reasonably satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee as of the
preceding Record Date or in all other cases or if no such instructions have
been delivered to the Indenture Trustee, by check to such Noteholder mailed to
such Holder's address as it appears in the Note Register the amount required to
be distributed to such Holder on such Payment Date pursuant to such Holder's
Securities.  Amounts to be paid to Certificateholders and the owner of the
Holdback Amount shall be paid by the Certificate Paying Agent in the manner
provided in the Trust Agreement.





                                       12
<PAGE>   18


         Neither the Indenture Trustee nor the Issuer shall pay to such Holders
any amount required to be withheld from a payment to such Holder by the Code
and any amounts so withheld shall be deemed to have been paid.

         (b)  The principal of each Note shall be due and payable in full on
the Final Scheduled Payment Date as provided in the related form of Note set
forth in Exhibits A-1, A-2, A-3 and A-4.  All principal payments on each Class
of Notes shall be made to the Noteholders of such Class entitled thereto in
accordance with the Percentage Interests represented by such Notes.  Upon
notice to the Indenture Trustee by the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee shall
notify the Person in whose name a Note is registered at the close of business
on the Record Date preceding the Final Scheduled Payment Date or other final
Payment Date.  Such notice shall be mailed no later than five Business Days
prior to such Final Scheduled Payment Date or other final Payment Date and
shall specify that payment of the principal amount and any interest due with
respect to such Note at the Final Scheduled Payment Date or other final Payment
Date will be payable only upon presentation and surrender of such Note and
shall specify the place where such Note may be presented and surrendered for
such final payment.

         (c)  On any Payment Date with respect to which Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Charge-Offs were incurred during the preceding Due
Period and less than the Optimum Monthly Principal is distributed in respect of
principal on such Payment Date, such amount that was not distributed shall be
allocated in the following order:

                      (i)   (A) to HCLC, the initial Holder of the Designated
         Certificate or its transferee to the extent of Accelerated Principal
         Payments made on the Notes, and (B) to HCLC, the initial Holder of the
         Designated Certificate or its transferee to the extent of the Holdback
         Amount until such amount equals zero.

                      (ii)  to the Certificate Adjusted Security Balance until
         the Certificate Adjusted Security Balance equals zero;

                    (iii)   to the Class B Adjusted Principal Balance until the
         Class B Adjusted Principal Balance equals zero; and

                     (iv)   to the Class A-3 Adjusted Principal Balance until
         the Class A-3 Adjusted Principal Balance equals zero;

                      (v)   to the Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance until
         the Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance equals zero; and





                                       13
<PAGE>   19

                      (vi)  to the Class A-1 Adjusted Principal Balance until
          the Class A-1 Adjusted Principal Balance equals zero.

         (d)  On to any Payment Date in which a Reversal exists, it shall be
allocated in the following order of priority:

                   (i)  to the Class A-1 Adjusted Principal Balance until the
         Class A-1 Adjusted Principal Balance equals the Principal Balance of
         the Class A-1 Notes;

                   (ii)  to the Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance until the
         Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance equals the Principal Balance of
         the Class A-2 Notes;

                   (iii)  to the Class A-3 Adjusted Principal Balance until the
         Class A-3 Adjusted Principal Balance equals the Principal Balance of
         the Class A-3 Notes;

                   (iv)  to the Class B Adjusted Principal Balance until the
         Class B Adjusted Principal Balance equals the Principal Balance of the
         Class B Notes;

 
                 (v)  to the Certificate Adjusted Security Balance until the
         Certificate Adjusted Security Balance equals the amount of the
         Security Balance of the Certificates; and

                 (vi)     (A) first to the Holdback Amount to the extent of any
         Series 1996-2 Participation Charge-Offs allocated to the Holdback
         Amount pursuant to Section 3.05(c)(i) on prior Payment Dates, and (B)
         second to HCLC, as the initial Holder of the Designated Certificates
         or its transferee to the extent of any Series 1996-2 Participation
         Charge-Offs allocated to the HCLC, the initial Holder of Designated
         Certificate or its transferee pursuant to Section 3.05(c)(i) on prior
         Payment Dates.

         Section 3.06.  Protection of Indenture Trust Estate.  (a) The Issuer
will from time to time execute and deliver all such supplements and amendments
hereto and all such financing statements, continuation statements, instruments
of further assurance and other instruments, and will take such other action
necessary or advisable to:

                      (i)   in the case of the Series 1996-2 Participation
         Interest, take physical delivery of the Series 1996-2 Participation
         Interest and cause it to be registered in the name of the Indenture
         Trustee for the benefit of the Holders of the Notes;

                      (ii)  maintain or preserve the lien and security interest
         (and the priority thereof) of this Indenture or carry out more
         effectively the purposes hereof;





                                       14
<PAGE>   20


                     (iii)   perfect, publish notice of or protect the validity
         of any Grant made or to be made by this Indenture;

                      (iv)  enforce Series 1996-2 Participation Interest in the
         manner contemplated by Section 5.16; and

                      (v)   preserve and defend title to the Indenture Trust
         Estate and the rights of the Indenture Trustee and the Noteholders in
         such Indenture Trust Estate against the claims of all persons and
         parties.

         (b)     Except as otherwise provided in this Indenture, the Indenture
Trustee shall not remove any portion of the Indenture Trust Estate that
consists of money or is evidenced by an instrument, certificate or other
writing from the jurisdiction in which it was held at the date of the most
recent Opinion of Counsel delivered pursuant to Section 3.07(b) (or from the
jurisdiction in which it was held as described in the Opinion of Counsel
delivered at the Closing Date pursuant to Section 3.07(a), if no Opinion of
Counsel has yet been delivered pursuant to Section 3.07(b)) unless the Trustee
shall have first received an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that the lien and
security interest created by this Indenture with respect to such property will
continue to be maintained after giving effect to such action or actions.

         The Issuer hereby designates the Indenture Trustee its agent and
attorney-in-fact to execute any financing statement, continuation statement or
other instrument required to be executed pursuant to this Section 3.06.

         Section 3.07.  Opinions as to Indenture Trust Estate.  (a)  On or
promptly following the Closing Date, the Issuer shall furnish to the Indenture
Trustee, the Owner Trustee and to the Administrator an Opinion of Counsel
either stating that, in the opinion of such counsel, such action has been taken
with respect to the delivery of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest, the
recording and filing of this Indenture, any indentures supplemental hereto, and
any other requisite documents, and with respect to the execution and filing of
any financing statements and continuation statements, as are necessary to
perfect and make effective the lien and security interest of this Indenture and
reciting the details of such action, or stating that, in the opinion of such
counsel, no such action is necessary to make such lien and security interest
effective.

         (b)  On or before December 31 in each calendar year, beginning in
[1997,] the Issuer shall furnish to the Indenture Trustee and to the
Administrator an Opinion of Counsel at the expense of Issuer either stating
that, in the opinion of such counsel, such action has been taken with respect
to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest, the recording, filing,
re-record-

                                       15


<PAGE>   21


ing and refiling of this Indenture, any indentures supplemental hereto
and any other requisite documents and with respect to the execution and filing
of any financing statements and continuation statements as is necessary to
maintain the lien and security interest created by this Indenture and reciting
the details of such action or stating that in the opinion of such counsel no
such action is necessary to maintain such lien and security interest.  Such
Opinion of Counsel shall also describe the recording, filing, re-recording and
refiling of this Indenture, any indentures supplemental hereto and any other
requisite documents and the execution and filing of any financing statements
and continuation statements that will, in the opinion of such counsel, be
required to maintain the lien and security interest of this Indenture until
December 31 in the following calendar year.

         Section 3.08.  Performance of Obligations.  (a)  The Issuer will
punctually perform and observe all of its obligations and agreements contained
in this Indenture, the Basic Documents and in the instruments and agreements
included in the Indenture Trust Estate.  Except as otherwise expressly provided
therein, the Issuer shall not waive, amend, modify, supplement or terminate any
Basic Document, without the consent of the Indenture Trustee or the Holders of
at least a majority of the Security Balances of the Notes.  Upon the taking of
any such action with respect to any Basic Document the Issuer shall give
written notice thereof to the Rating Agencies.

         (b)  The Issuer may contract with other Persons to assist it in
performing its duties under this Indenture, and any performance of such duties
by a Person identified to the Indenture Trustee in an Officer's Certificate of
the Issuer shall be deemed to be action taken by the Issuer.  Initially, the
Issuer has contracted with the Administrator to assist the Issuer in performing
its duties under this Indenture.

         (c)     The Issuer will not take any action or permit any action to be
taken by others which would release any Person from any of such Person's
covenants or obligations under any of the documents relating to the Series
1996-2 Participation Interest or under any instrument included in the Indenture
Trust Estate, or which would result in the amendment, hypothecation,
subordination, termination or discharge of, or impair the validity or
effectiveness of, any of the documents relating to the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest or any such instrument.

         (d)     The Issuer shall at all times retain an Administrator and may
enter into contracts with other Persons for the performance of the Issuer's
obligations hereunder, and performance of such obligations by such Persons
shall be deemed to be performance of such obligations by the Issuer.





                                       16
<PAGE>   22

         Section 3.09.  Negative Covenants.  So long as any Notes are
Outstanding, the Issuer shall not:

                      (i)   claim any credit on, or make any deduction from the
         principal or interest payable in respect of, the Notes (other than
         amounts properly withheld from such payments under the Code) or assert
         any claim against any present or former Noteholder by reason of the
         payment of the taxes levied or assessed upon any part of the Indenture
         Trust Estate; or

                      (ii)  (A)  permit the validity or effectiveness of this
         Indenture to be impaired, or permit the lien of this Indenture to be
         amended, hypothecated, subordinated, terminated or discharged, or
         permit any Person to be released from any covenants or obligations
         with respect to the Notes under this Indenture except as may be
         expressly permitted hereby, (B) permit any lien, charge, excise,
         claim, security interest, mortgage or other encumbrance (other than
         the lien of this Indenture) to be created on or extend to or otherwise
         arise upon or burden the Indenture Trust Estate or any part thereof or
         any interest therein or the proceeds thereof or (C) permit the lien of
         this Indenture not to constitute a valid first priority security
         interest in the Indenture Trust Estate.

         Section 3.10.  Annual Statement as to Compliance.  The Issuer will
deliver to the Indenture Trustee and the Rating Agencies within 120 days after
the end of each fiscal year of the Issuer (commencing with the fiscal year
1996), an Officer's Certificate stating, as to the Authorized Officer signing
such Officer's Certificate, that:

                      (i)   a review of the activities of the Issuer during
         such year and of its performance under this Indenture has been made
         under such Authorized Officer's supervision; and

                      (ii)  to the best of such Authorized Officer's knowledge,
         based on such review, the Issuer has complied with all conditions and
         covenants under this Indenture throughout such year, or, if there has
         been a default in its compliance with any such condition or covenant,
         specifying each such default known to such Authorized Officer and the
         nature and status thereof.

         Section 3.11.  Indenture Trust Estate; Related Documents.  (a)  When
required by the provisions of this Indenture, the Indenture Trustee shall
execute instruments to release property from the lien of this Indenture, or
convey the Indenture Trustee's interest in the same, in a manner and under
circumstances which are not inconsistent with the provisions of this Indenture.
No party relying upon an instrument executed by the





                                       17
<PAGE>   23

Indenture Trustee as provided in this Article III shall be bound to ascertain
the Indenture Trustee's authority, inquire into the satisfaction of any
conditions precedent or see to the application of any moneys.

         (b)     The Indenture Trustee shall, at such time as there are no
Notes Outstanding, release all of the Indenture Trust Estate to the Issuer
(other than any cash held for the payment of the Notes pursuant to Section 3.03
or 4.11), subject, however, to the rights of the Indenture Trustee under
Section 6.07.

         Section 3.12.  Amendments to Pooling and Servicing Agreement.  The
Indenture Trustee may consent to any amendment or supplement to the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement only in accordance with Section 13.01 of the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement if (i) it has received a letter from each Rating Agency to
the effect that such amendment will not result in the reduction or withdrawal
of the ratings then assigned to the Notes or (ii) a majority in interest of
Noteholders (by Security Balance of the Notes) have instructed the Indenture
Trustee to consent to such amendment and if an Opinion of Counsel is required
to be delivered pursuant to Section 13.01 of the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement, such opinion shall be delivered to the Indenture Trustee.  The
Indenture Trustee may, in its discretion, decline to enter into or consent to
any such supplement or amendment if its own rights, duties or immunities shall
be adversely affected.

         Section 3.13.  Investment Company Act.  The Issuer shall not become an
"investment company" or under the "control" of an "investment company" as such
terms are defined in the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (or any
successor or amendatory statute), and the rules and regulations thereunder
(taking into account not only the general definition of the term "investment
company" but also any available exceptions to such general definition);
provided, however, that the Issuer shall be in compliance with this Section
3.13 if it shall have obtained an order exempting it from regulation as an
"investment company" so long as it is in compliance with the conditions imposed
in such order.

         Section 3.14.  Existence of Issuer; Issuer May Consolidate, etc., Only
on Certain Terms.  (a)  The Issuer shall at all times while any Notes are
outstanding maintain its existence except as otherwise permitted by Subsections
(b) or (c) below.

         (b)  The Issuer shall not consolidate or merge with or into any other
Person, unless:

                      (i)   the Person (if other than the Issuer) formed by or
         surviving such consolidation or merger shall be a Person organized and
         existing under the laws of the United States





                                       18
<PAGE>   24

         of America or any state or the District of Columbia and shall
         expressly assume, by an indenture supplemental hereto, executed and
         delivered to the Indenture Trustee, in form reasonably satisfactory to
         the Indenture Trustee, the due and punctual payment of the principal
         of and interest on all Notes and the performance or observance of
         every agreement and covenant of this Indenture on the part of the
         Issuer to be performed or observed, all as provided herein;

                      (ii)  immediately after giving effect to such
         transaction, no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing;

                    (iii)   each Rating Agency shall have notified the Issuer
         that such transaction shall not cause the rating of the Notes to be
         reduced, suspended or withdrawn;

                      (iv)  the Issuer shall have received an Opinion of
         Counsel (and shall have delivered copies thereof to the Indenture
         Trustee) to the effect that such transaction will not have any
         material adverse tax consequence to the Issuer or any Noteholder;

                      (v)   any action that is necessary to maintain the lien
         and security interest created by this Indenture shall have been taken;
         and

                      (vi)  the Issuer shall have delivered to the Indenture
         Trustee an Officer's Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel each
         stating that such consolidation or merger and such supplemental
         indenture comply with this Article III and that all conditions
         precedent herein provided for relating to such transaction have been
         complied with (including any filing required by the Exchange Act).

         (c)     The Issuer shall not convey or transfer any of its properties
or assets, including those included in the Indenture Trust Estate, to any
Person, unless:

                      (i)   the Person that acquires by conveyance or transfer
         the properties and assets of the Issuer the conveyance or transfer of
         which is hereby restricted shall (A) be a United States citizen or a
         Person organized and existing under the laws of the United States of
         America or any state, (B) expressly assumes, by an indenture
         supplemental hereto, executed and delivered to the Indenture Trustee,
         in form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee, the due and punctual
         payment of the principal of and interest on all Notes and the
         performance or observance of every agreement and covenant of this
         Indenture on the part of the Issuer to be performed or observed, all
         as provided herein, (C) expressly agrees by means of such supplemental
         indenture





                                       19
<PAGE>   25

         that all right, title and interest so conveyed or transferred shall be
         subject and subordinate to the rights of Holders of the Notes, (D)
         unless otherwise provided in such supplemental indenture, expressly
         agrees to indemnify, defend and hold harmless the Issuer against and
         from any loss, liability or expense arising under or related to this
         Indenture and the Notes and (E) expressly agrees by means of such
         supplemental indenture that such Person (or if a group of Persons,
         then one specified Person) shall make all filings with the Commission
         (and any other appropriate Person) required by the Exchange Act in
         connection with the Notes;

                      (ii)  immediately after giving effect to such
         transaction, no Default or Event of Default shall have occurred and be
         continuing;

                    (iii)   each Rating Agency shall have notified the Issuer
         that such transaction shall not cause the rating of the Notes to be
         reduced, suspended or withdrawn;

                      (iv)  the Issuer shall have received an Opinion of
         Counsel (and shall have delivered copies thereof to the Indenture
         Trustee) to the effect that such transaction will not have any
         material adverse tax consequence to the Issuer or any Noteholder;

                      (v)   any action that is necessary to maintain the lien
         and security interest created by this Indenture shall have been taken;
         and

                      (vi)  the Issuer shall have delivered to the Indenture
         Trustee an Officer's Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel each
         stating that such conveyance or transfer and such supplemental
         indenture comply with this Article III and that all conditions
         precedent herein provided for relating to such transaction have been
         complied with (including any filing required by the Exchange Act).

         Section 3.15.  Successor or Transferee.  (a)  Upon any consolidation
or merger of the Issuer in accordance with Section 3.14(b), the Person formed
by or surviving such consolidation or merger (if other than the Issuer) shall
succeed to, and be substituted for, and may exercise every right and power of,
the Issuer under this Indenture with the same effect as if such Person had been
named as the Issuer herein.

         (b)     Upon a conveyance or transfer of all the assets and properties
of the Issuer pursuant to Section 3.14(c), the Issuer will be released from
every covenant and agreement of this Indenture to be observed or performed on
the part of the Issuer with respect to the Notes immediately upon the delivery
of written notice to the Indenture Trustee is to be so released.





                                       20
<PAGE>   26


         Section 3.16.  No Other Business.  The Issuer shall not engage in any
business other than financing, purchasing, owning and selling and managing the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest in the manner contemplated by this
Indenture and the Basic Documents and all activities incidental thereto.

         Section 3.17.  No Borrowing.  The Issuer shall not issue, incur,
assume, guarantee or otherwise become liable, directly or indirectly, for any
indebtedness except for the Notes.

         Section 3.18.  Guarantees, Loans, Advances and Other Liabilities.
Except as contemplated by this Indenture, the Issuer shall not make any loan or
advance or credit to, or guarantee (directly or indirectly or by an instrument
having the effect of assuring another's payment or performance on any
obligation or capability of so doing or otherwise), endorse or otherwise become
contingently liable, directly or indirectly, in connection with the
obligations, stocks or dividends of, or own, purchase, repurchase or acquire
(or agree contingently to do so) any stock, obligations, assets or securities
of, or any other interest in, or make any capital contribution to, any other
Person.

         Section 3.19.  Capital Expenditures.  The Issuer shall not make any
expenditure (by long-term or operating lease or otherwise) for capital assets
(either realty or personalty).

         Section 3.20.  Restricted Payments.  The Issuer shall not, directly or
indirectly, (i) pay any dividend or make any distribution (by reduction of
capital or otherwise), whether in cash, property, securities or a combination
thereof, to the Owner Trustee or any owner of a beneficial interest in the
Issuer or otherwise with respect to any ownership or equity interest or
security in or of the Issuer, (ii) redeem, purchase, retire or otherwise
acquire for value any such ownership or equity interest or security or (iii)
set aside or otherwise segregate any amounts for any such purpose; provided,
however, that the Issuer may make, or cause to be made, (x) distributions to
the Owner Trustee and the Certificateholders as contemplated by, and to the
extent funds are available for such purpose under the Trust Agreement, and (y)
payments to the Indenture Trustee.

         Section 3.21.  Notice of Events of Default.  The Issuer shall give the
Indenture Trustee and the Rating Agencies prompt written notice of each Event
of Default hereunder and under the Trust Agreement.

         Section 3.22.  Further Instruments and Acts.  Upon request of the
Indenture Trustee, the Issuer will execute and deliver such further instruments
and do such further acts as may be reasonably necessary or proper to carry out
more effectively the purpose of this Indenture.





                                       21
<PAGE>   27

         Section 3.23.  Statements to Noteholders.  The Indenture Trustee and
the Certificate Registrar shall forward by mail to each Noteholder and
Certificateholder, respectively, the Monthly Servicing Report and the Monthly
Security Statement delivered to them pursuant to Article V of the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement and Section 6.06(b) hereof, respectively.

         Section 3.24.  Determination of Note Rate and Certificate Rate.  On
the second LIBOR Business Day immediately preceding (i) the Closing Date in the
case of the first Interest Period and (ii) the first day of each succeeding
Interest Period, the Indenture Trustee after consultation with the Servicer
shall determine LIBOR and the Note Rate and the Certificate Rate for such
Interest Period and shall inform the Issuer and the Seller at their respective
facsimile numbers given to the Indenture Trustee in writing thereof.

         Section 3.25.  Optional Repurchase of the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest.  (a)  The Seller may, with 10 days prior written notice to the Owner
Trustee, Servicer and the Indenture Trustee, purchase the entire Series 1996-2
Participation Interest, on any Payment Date in which the Aggregate Security
Balance is equal to or less than ten percent of the initial Aggregate Security
Balance.  The Seller shall deposit into the Payment Account on the Business Day
prior to the Payment Date on which such purchase is to occur, an amount equal
to the principal balance of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest and the
amount of interest and Certificate Yield to be distributed to the Security
holders pursuant to Section 3.05(a) as of such Payment Date.





                                       22
<PAGE>   28

                                   ARTICLE IV

               The Notes; Satisfaction and Discharge of Indenture

         Section 4.01.  The Notes.  (a)  The Notes shall be registered in the
name of a nominee designated by the Depository.  Beneficial Owners will hold
interests in the Notes through the book-entry facilities of the Depository in
minimum initial Principal Balances of $100,000 and integral multiples of $1,000
in excess thereof.

         The Indenture Trustee may for all purposes (including the making of
payments due on the Notes) deal with the Depository as the authorized
representative of the Beneficial Owners with respect to the Notes for the
purposes of exercising the rights of Holders of Notes hereunder.  Except as
provided in the next succeeding paragraph of this Section 4.01, the rights of
Beneficial Owners with respect to the Notes shall be limited to those
established by law and agreements between such Beneficial Owners and the
Depository and Depository Participants.  Except as provided in Section 4.08,
Beneficial Owners shall not be entitled to definitive certificates for the
Notes as to which they are the Beneficial Owners.  Requests and directions
from, and votes of, the Depository as Holder of the Notes shall not be deemed
inconsistent if they are made with respect to different Beneficial Owners.  The
Indenture Trustee may establish a reasonable record date in connection with
solicitations of consents from or voting by Noteholders and give notice to the
Depository of such record date.  Without the consent of the Issuer and the
Indenture Trustee, no Note may be transferred by the Depository except to a
successor Depository that agrees to hold such Note for the account of the
Beneficial Owners.

         In the event the Depository Trust Company resigns or is removed as
Depository, the Indenture Trustee with the approval of the Issuer may appoint a
successor Depository.  If no successor Depository has been appointed within 30
days of the effective date of the Depository's resignation or removal, each
Beneficial Owner shall be entitled to certificates representing the Notes it
beneficially owns in the manner prescribed in Section 4.08.

         The Notes shall, on original issue, be executed on behalf of the
Issuer by the Owner Trustee, not in its individual capacity but solely as Owner
Trustee, authenticated by the Note Registrar and delivered by the Indenture
Trustee to or upon the order of the Issuer.

         Section 4.02.  Registration of and Limitations on Transfer and
Exchange of Notes; Appointment of Certificate Registrar.  The Note Registrar
shall cause to be kept at its Corporate Trust Office a Note Register in which,
subject to such reasonable regulations as it may prescribe, the Note Registrar
shall provide for





                                       23
<PAGE>   29

the registration of Notes and of transfers and exchanges of Notes as herein
provided.

         Subject to the restrictions and limitations set forth below, upon
surrender for registration of transfer of any Note at the Corporate Trust
Office, the Owner Trustee on behalf of the Issuer shall execute and the Note
Registrar shall authenticate and deliver, in the name of the designated
transferee or transferees, one or more new Notes in authorized initial Security
Balances evidencing the same aggregate Percentage Interests.

         Subject to the foregoing, at the option of the Noteholders, Notes may
be exchanged for other Notes of like tenor or, in each case in authorized
initial Principal Balances evidencing the same aggregate Percentage Interests
upon surrender of the Notes to be exchanged at the Corporate Trust Office of
the Note Registrar.  Whenever any Notes are so surrendered for exchange, the
Issuer shall execute and the Note Registrar shall authenticate and deliver the
Notes which the Noteholder making the exchange is entitled to receive.  Each
Note presented or surrendered for registration of transfer or exchange shall
(if so required by the Note Registrar) be duly endorsed by, or be accompanied
by a written instrument of transfer in form reasonably satisfactory to the Note
Registrar duly executed by, the Holder thereof or his attorney duly authorized
in writing.  Notes delivered upon any such transfer or exchange will evidence
the same obligations, and will be entitled to the same rights and privileges,
as the Notes surrendered.

         No service charge shall be made for any registration of transfer or
exchange of Notes, but the Note Registrar shall require payment of a sum
sufficient to cover any tax or governmental charge that may be imposed in
connection with any registration of transfer or exchange of Notes.

         All Notes surrendered for registration of transfer and exchange shall
be cancelled by the Note Registrar and delivered to the Indenture Trustee for
subsequent destruction without liability on the part of either.

         The Issuer hereby appoints The Bank of New York as Certificate
Registrar to keep at its Corporate Trust Office a Certificate Register pursuant
to Section 3.09 of the Trust Agreement in which, subject to such reasonable
regulations as it may prescribe, the Certificate Registrar shall provide for
the registration of Certificates, and of transfers and exchanges thereof
pursuant to Section 3.05 of the Trust Agreement.  The Bank of New York hereby
accepts such appointment.

         Section 4.03.  Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen Notes.  If (i) any
mutilated Note is surrendered to the Indenture Trustee, or the Indenture
Trustee receives evidence to its satis-


                                       24
<PAGE>   30


faction of the destruction, loss or theft of any Note, and (ii) there is
delivered to the Indenture Trustee such security or indemnity as may be required
by it to hold the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee harmless, then, in the
absence of notice to the Issuer, the Note Registrar or the Indenture Trustee
that such Note has been acquired by a bona fide purchaser, and provided that the
requirements of Section 8-405 of the UCC are met, the Issuer shall execute, and
upon its request the Indenture Trustee shall authenticate and deliver, in
exchange for or in lieu of any such mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Note, a
replacement Note of the same Class; provided, however, that if any such
destroyed, lost or stolen Note, but not a mutilated Note, shall have become or
within seven days shall be due and payable, instead of issuing a replacement
Note, the Issuer may pay such destroyed, lost or stolen Note when so due or
payable without surrender thereof.  If, after the delivery of such replacement
Note or payment of a destroyed, lost or stolen Note pursuant to the proviso to
the preceding sentence, a bona fide purchaser of the original Note in lieu of
which such replacement Note was issued presents for payment such original Note,
the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee shall be entitled to recover such
replacement Note (or such payment) from the Person to whom it was delivered or
any Person taking such replacement Note from such Person to whom such
replacement Note was delivered or any assignee of such Person, except a bona
fide purchaser, and shall be entitled to recover upon the security or indemnity
provided therefor to the extent of any loss, damage, cost or expense incurred by
the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee in connection therewith.

         Upon the issuance of any replacement Note under this Section 4.03, the
Issuer may require the payment by the Holder of such Note of a sum sufficient
to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in relation
thereto and any other reasonable expenses (including the fees and expenses of
the Indenture Trustee) connected therewith.

         Every replacement Note issued pursuant to this Section 4.03 in
replacement of any mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Note shall constitute
an original additional contractual obligation of the Issuer, whether or not the
mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Note shall be at any time enforceable by
anyone, and shall be entitled to all the benefits of this Indenture equally and
proportionately with any and all other Notes duly issued hereunder.

         The provisions of this Section 4.03 are exclusive and shall preclude
(to the extent lawful) all other rights and remedies with respect to the
replacement or payment of mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Notes.





                                       25
<PAGE>   31

         Section 4.04.  Persons Deemed Owners.  Prior to due presentment for
registration of transfer of any Note, the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and any
agent of the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee may treat the Person in whose name
any Note is registered (as of the day of determination) as the owner of such
Note for the purpose of receiving payments of principal of and interest, if
any, on such Note and for all other purposes whatsoever, whether or not such
Note be overdue, and neither the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee nor any agent of
the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee shall be affected by notice to the
contrary.

         Section 4.05.  Cancellation.  All Notes surrendered for payment,
registration of transfer, exchange or redemption shall, if surrendered to any
Person other than the Indenture Trustee, be delivered to the Indenture Trustee
and shall be promptly cancelled by the Indenture Trustee.  The Issuer may at
any time deliver to the Indenture Trustee for cancellation any Notes previously
authenticated and delivered hereunder which the Issuer may have acquired in any
manner whatsoever, and all Notes so delivered shall be promptly cancelled by
the Indenture Trustee.  No Notes shall be authenticated in lieu of or in
exchange for any Notes cancelled as provided in this Section 4.05, except as
expressly permitted by this Indenture.  All cancelled Notes may be held or
disposed of by the Indenture Trustee in accordance with its standard retention
or disposal policy as in effect at the time unless the Issuer shall direct by
an Issuer Request that they be returned to it; provided, that such Issuer
Request is timely and the Notes have not been previously disposed of by the
Indenture Trustee.

         Section 4.06.  Book-Entry Notes.  The Notes, upon original issuance,
will be issued in the form of typewritten Notes representing the Book-Entry
Notes, to be delivered to The Depository Trust Company, the initial Depository,
by, or on behalf of, the Issuer.  Such Notes shall initially be registered on
the Note Register in the name of Cede & Co., the nominee of the initial
Depository, and no Beneficial Owner will receive a definitive Note representing
such Beneficial Owner's interest in such Note, except as provided in Section
4.08.  Unless and until definitive, fully registered Notes (the "Definitive
Notes") have been issued to Beneficial Owners pursuant to Section 4.08:

                      (i)   the provisions of this Section 4.06 shall be in
         full force and effect;

                      (ii)  the Note Registrar and the Indenture Trustee shall
         be entitled to deal with the Depository for all purposes of this
         Indenture (including the payment of principal of and interest on the
         Notes and the giving of instructions or directions hereunder) as the
         sole holder of the Notes, and shall have no obligation to the
         Noteholders;





                                       26
<PAGE>   32

                    (iii)   to the extent that the provisions of this Section
         4.06 conflict with any other provisions of this Indenture, the
         provisions of this Section 4.06 shall control;

                      (iv)  the rights of Beneficial Owners shall be exercised
         only through the Depository and shall be limited to those established
         by law and agreements between such Beneficial Owners and the
         Depository and/or the Depository Participants pursuant to the Note
         Depository Agreement.  Unless and until Definitive Notes are issued
         pursuant to Section 4.08, the initial Depository will make book-entry
         transfers among the Depository Participants and receive and transmit
         payments of principal of and interest on the Notes to such Depository
         Participants; and

                      (v)   whenever this Indenture requires or permits actions
         to be taken based upon instructions or directions of Noteholders
         evidencing a specified percentage of the Security Balances of the
         Notes, the Depository shall be deemed to represent such percentage
         only to the extent that it has received instructions to such effect
         from Beneficial Owners and/or Depository Participants owning or
         representing, respectively, such required percentage of the beneficial
         interest in the Notes and has delivered such instructions to the
         Indenture Trustee.

         Section 4.07.  Notices to Depository.  Whenever a notice or other
communication to the Noteholders is required under this Indenture, unless and
until Definitive Notes shall have been issued to Beneficial Owners pursuant to
Section 4.08, the Indenture Trustee shall give all such notices and
communications specified herein to be given to Holders of the Notes to the
Depository, and shall have no obligation to the Beneficial Owners.

         Section 4.08.  Definitive Notes.  If (i) the Administrator advises the
Indenture Trustee in writing that the Depository is no longer willing or able
to properly discharge its responsibilities with respect to the Notes and the
Administrator is unable to locate a qualified successor, (ii) the Administrator
at its option advises the Indenture Trustee in writing that it elects to
terminate the book-entry system through the Depository or (iii) after the
occurrence of an Event of Default, Beneficial Owners representing beneficial
interests aggregating at least a majority of the Security Balances of the Notes
advise the Depository in writing that the continuation of a book-entry system
through the Depository is no longer in the best interests of the Beneficial
Owners, then the Depository shall notify all Beneficial Owners and the
Indenture Trustee of the occurrence of any such event and of the availability
of Definitive Notes to Beneficial Owners requesting the same.  Upon surrender
to the





                                       27
<PAGE>   33

Indenture Trustee of the typewritten Notes representing the Book-Entry Notes by
the Depository, accompanied by registration instructions, the Issuer shall
execute and the Indenture Trustee shall authenticate the Definitive Notes in
accordance with the instructions of the Depository.  None of the Issuer, the
Note Registrar or the Indenture Trustee shall be liable for any delay in
delivery of such instructions and may conclusively rely on, and shall be
protected in relying on, such instructions.  Upon the issuance of Definitive
Notes, the Indenture Trustee shall recognize the Holders of the Definitive
Notes as Noteholders.

         Section 4.09.  Tax Treatment.  The Issuer has entered into this
Indenture, and the Notes will be issued, with the intention that, for federal,
state and local income, single business and franchise tax purposes, the Notes
will qualify as indebtedness of the Issuer.  The Issuer, by entering into this
Indenture, and each Noteholder, by its acceptance of its Note (and each
Beneficial Owner by its acceptance of an interest in the applicable Book-Entry
Note), agree to treat the Notes for federal, state and local income, single
business and franchise tax purposes as indebtedness of the Issuer.

         Section 4.10.  Satisfaction and Discharge of Indenture.   This
Indenture shall cease to be of further effect with respect to the Notes except
as to (i) rights of registration of transfer and exchange, (ii) substitution of
mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Notes, (iii) rights of Noteholders to
receive payments of principal thereof and interest thereon, (iv) Sections 3.03,
3.04, 3.06, 3.09, 3.14, 3.16 and 3.17, (v) the rights, obligations and
immunities of the Indenture Trustee hereunder (including the rights of the
Indenture Trustee under Section 6.07 and the obligations of the Indenture
Trustee under Section 4.11) and (vi) the rights of Noteholders as beneficiaries
hereof with respect to the property so deposited with the Indenture Trustee
payable to all or any of them, and the Indenture Trustee, on demand of and at
the expense of the Issuer, shall execute proper instruments acknowledging
satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture with respect to the Notes, when

                 (A)      either

                 (1)      all Notes theretofore authenticated and delivered
         (other than (i) Notes that have been destroyed, lost or stolen and
         that have been replaced or paid as provided in Section 4.03 and (ii)
         Notes for whose payment money has theretofore been deposited in trust
         or segregated and held in trust by the Issuer and thereafter repaid to
         the Issuer or discharged from such trust, as provided in Section 3.03)
         have been delivered to the Indenture Trustee for cancellation; or





                                      28
<PAGE>   34

                 (2)      all Notes not theretofore delivered to the Indenture
          Trustee for cancellation

                          a.      have become due and payable, or

                          b.      will become due and payable at the Final
                 Scheduled Payment Date within one year,

         and the Issuer, in the case of a. or b. above, has irrevocably
         deposited or caused to be irrevocably deposited with the Indenture
         Trustee cash or direct obligations of or obligations guaranteed by the
         United States of America (which will mature prior to the date such
         amounts are payable), in trust for such purpose, in an amount
         sufficient to pay and discharge the entire indebtedness on such Notes
         then outstanding not theretofore delivered to the Indenture Trustee
         for cancellation when due on the Final Scheduled Payment Date;

                 (B)      the Issuer has paid or caused to be paid all other
         sums payable hereunder by the Issuer.

         Section 4.11.  Application of Trust Money.  All moneys deposited with
the Indenture Trustee pursuant to Section 4.10 hereof shall be held in trust
and applied by it, in accordance with the provisions of the Notes and this
Indenture, to the payment, either directly or through any Paying Agent, as the
Indenture Trustee may determine, to the Holders of Notes, of all sums due and
to become due thereon for principal and interest; but such moneys need not be
segregated from other funds except to the extent required herein or required by
law.

         Section 4.12.  Repayment of Moneys Held by Paying Agent.  In
connection with the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture with respect
to the Notes, all moneys then held by any Administrator other than the
Indenture Trustee under the provisions of this Indenture with respect to such
Notes shall, upon demand of the Issuer, be paid to the Indenture Trustee to be
held and applied according to Section 3.05 and thereupon such Paying Agent
shall be released from all further liability with respect to such moneys.





                                      29
<PAGE>   35

                                   ARTICLE V

                                    Remedies

         Section 5.01.  Event of Default; Acceleration of Maturity; Rescission
and Annulment.  The Issuer shall deliver to the Indenture Trustee, within five
days after the occurrence of any event, which with the giving of notice and the
lapse of time would become an Event of Default under clause (iii) of the
definition of "Event of Default", written notice in the form of an Officer's
Certificate of such event, its status and what action the Issuer is taking or
proposes to take with respect thereto.  If an Event of Default should occur and
be continuing, then and in every such case the Indenture Trustee or the Holders
of Notes representing not less than a majority of the Security Balances of all
Notes may declare the Notes to be immediately due and payable, by a notice in
writing to the Issuer (and to the Indenture Trustee if given by Noteholders),
and upon any such declaration the unpaid principal amount of such Notes,
together with accrued and unpaid interest thereon through the date of
acceleration, shall become immediately due and payable.

         At any time after such declaration of acceleration of maturity has
been made and before a judgment or decree for payment of the money due has been
obtained by the Indenture Trustee as hereinafter in this Article V provided,
the Holders of Notes representing a majority of the Security Balances of all
Notes, by written notice to the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, may rescind
and annul such declaration and its consequences if:

                      (i)   the Issuer has paid or deposited with the Indenture
         Trustee a sum sufficient to pay:

                          (A)     all payments of principal of and interest on
                 the Notes and all other amounts that would then be due
                 hereunder or upon the Notes if the Event of Default giving
                 rise to such acceleration had not occurred; and

                          (B)     all sums paid or advanced by the Indenture
                 Trustee hereunder and the reasonable compensation, expenses,
                 disbursements and advances of the Indenture Trustee and its
                 agents and outside counsel; and

                      (ii)  all Events of Default, other than the nonpayment of
         the principal of the Notes that has become due solely by such
         acceleration, have been cured or waived as provided in Section 5.11.

         No such rescission shall affect any subsequent default or impair any
right consequent thereto.





                                      30
<PAGE>   36

         Section 5.02.  Collection of Indebtedness and Suits for Enforcement by
Indenture Trustee.  (a)  The Issuer covenants that if (i) default is made in
the payment of any interest on any Note when the same becomes due and payable,
and such default continues for a period of five days, or (ii) default is made
in the payment of the principal of or any installment of the principal of any
Note when the same becomes due and payable, the Issuer will, upon demand of the
Indenture Trustee, pay to it, for the benefit of the Holders of Notes, the
whole amount then due and payable on the Notes for principal and interest, with
interest upon the overdue principal, and in addition thereto such further
amount as shall be sufficient to cover the costs and expenses of collection,
including the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of
the Indenture Trustee and its agents and outside counsel.

         (b)  In case the Issuer shall fail forthwith to pay such amounts upon
such demand, the Indenture Trustee, in its own name and as trustee of an
express trust, subject to the provisions of Section 10.16 hereof may institute
a Proceeding for the collection of the sums so due and unpaid, and may
prosecute such Proceeding to judgment or final decree, and may enforce the same
against the Issuer or other obligor upon the Notes and collect in the manner
provided by law out of the property of the Issuer or other obligor the Notes,
wherever situated, the moneys adjudged or decreed to be payable.

         (c)  If an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Indenture
Trustee, subject to the provisions of Section 10.16 hereof may, as more
particularly provided in Section 5.03, in its discretion, proceed to protect
and enforce its rights and the rights of the Noteholders, by such appropriate
Proceedings as the Indenture Trustee shall deem most effective to protect and
enforce any such rights, whether for the specific enforcement of any covenant
or agreement in this Indenture or in aid of the exercise of any power granted
herein, or to enforce any other proper remedy or legal or equitable right
vested in the Indenture Trustee by this Indenture or by law.

         (d)  In case there shall be pending, relative to the Issuer or any
other obligor upon the Notes or any Person having or claiming an ownership
interest in the Indenture Trust Estate, Proceedings under Title 11 of the
United States Code or any other applicable federal or state bankruptcy,
insolvency or other similar law, or in case a receiver, assignee or trustee in
bankruptcy or reorganization, liquidator, sequestrator or similar official
shall have been appointed for or taken possession of the Issuer or its property
or such other obligor or Person, or in case of any other comparable judicial
Proceedings relative to the Issuer or other obligor upon the Notes, or to the
creditors or property of the Issuer or such other obligor, the Indenture
Trustee, irrespective of whether the principal of any Notes shall





                                      31
<PAGE>   37

then be due and payable as therein expressed or by declaration or otherwise and
irrespective of whether the Indenture Trustee shall have made any demand
pursuant to the provisions of this Section, shall be entitled and empowered, by
intervention in such Proceedings or otherwise:

                      (i)   to file and prove a claim or claims for the whole
         amount of principal and interest owing and unpaid in respect of the
         Notes and to file such other papers or documents as may be necessary
         or advisable in order to have the claims of the Indenture Trustee
         (including any claim for reasonable compensation to the Indenture
         Trustee and each predecessor Indenture Trustee, and their respective
         agents, and outside counsel, and for reimbursement of all expenses and
         liabilities incurred, and all advances made, by the Indenture Trustee
         and each predecessor Indenture Trustee, except as a result of
         negligence or bad faith) and of the Noteholders allowed in such
         Proceedings;

                     (ii)   unless prohibited by applicable law and
         regulations, to vote on behalf of the Holders of Notes in any election
         of a trustee, a standby trustee or Person performing similar functions
         in any such Proceedings;

                    (iii)   to collect and receive any moneys or other property
         payable or deliverable on any such claims and to distribute all
         amounts received with respect to the claims of the Noteholders and of
         the Indenture Trustee on their behalf; and

                      (iv)  to file such proofs of claim and other papers or
         documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims
         of the Indenture Trustee or the Holders of Notes allowed in any
         judicial proceedings relative to the Issuer, its creditors and its
         property;

and any trustee, receiver, liquidator, custodian or other similar official in
any such Proceeding is hereby authorized by each of such Noteholders to make
payments to the Indenture Trustee, and, in the event that the Indenture Trustee
shall consent to the making of payments directly to such Noteholders, to pay to
the Indenture Trustee such amounts as shall be sufficient to cover reasonable
compensation to the Indenture Trustee, each predecessor Indenture Trustee and
their respective agents, and outside counsel, and all other expenses and
liabilities incurred, and all advances made, by the Indenture Trustee and each
predecessor Indenture Trustee except as a result of negligence or bad faith.

         (e)  Nothing herein contained shall be deemed to authorize the
Indenture Trustee to authorize or consent to or vote for or accept or adopt on
behalf of any Noteholder any plan of reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or
composition affecting the





                                      32
<PAGE>   38

Notes or the rights of any Holder thereof or to authorize the Indenture Trustee
to vote in respect of the claim of any Noteholder in any such proceeding
except, as aforesaid, to vote for the election of a trustee in bankruptcy or
similar Person.

         (f)  All rights of action and of asserting claims under this
Indenture, or under any of the Notes, may be enforced by the Indenture Trustee
without the possession of any of the Notes or the production thereof in any
trial or other Proceedings relative thereto, and any such action or proceedings
instituted by the Indenture Trustee shall be brought in its own name as trustee
of an express trust, and any recovery of judgment, subject to the payment of
the expenses, disbursements and compensation of the Indenture Trustee, each
predecessor Indenture Trustee and their respective agents and attorneys, shall
be for the ratable benefit of the Holders of the Notes.

         (g)  In any Proceedings brought by the Indenture Trustee (and also any
Proceedings involving the interpretation of any provision of this Indenture to
which the Indenture Trustee shall be a party), the Indenture Trustee shall be
held to represent all the Holders of the Notes, and it shall not be necessary
to make any Noteholder a party to any such Proceedings.

         Section 5.03.  Remedies; Priorities.  (a)  If an Event of Default
shall have occurred and be continuing, the Indenture Trustee, subject to the
provisions of Section 10.16 hereof, may do one or more of the following
(subject to Section 5.04):

                      (i)   institute Proceedings from time to time for the
         complete or partial foreclosure of this Indenture with respect to the
         Indenture Trust Estate;

                     (ii)   exercise any remedies of a secured party under the
         UCC and take any other appropriate action to protect and enforce the
         rights and remedies of the Indenture Trustee and the Holders of the
         Notes; and

                    (iii)   sell the Indenture Trust Estate or any portion
         thereof or rights or interest therein, at one or more public or
         private sales called and conducted in any manner permitted by law;

provided, however, that the Indenture Trustee may not sell or otherwise
liquidate the Indenture Trust Estate following an Event of Default, unless (A)
the Holders of 100% of the Security Balances of the Notes consent thereto, (B)
the proceeds of such sale or liquidation distributable to Holders of the Notes
are sufficient to discharge in full all amounts then due and unpaid upon the
Notes for principal and interest or (C) the Indenture Trustee determines that
the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest will not continue to provide
sufficient funds for the payment of





                                      33
<PAGE>   39

principal of and interest on the Notes, as they would have become due if the
Notes had not been declared due and payable, and the Indenture Trustee obtains
the consent of the Holders of not less than 66-2/3% of the Security Balances of
the Notes.  In determining such sufficiency or insufficiency with respect to
clause (B) and (C), the Indenture Trustee may, but need not, obtain and rely
upon an opinion of an Independent investment banking or accounting firm of
national reputation as to the feasibility of such proposed action and as to the
sufficiency of the Indenture Trust Estate for such purpose.

         (b)  If the Indenture Trustee collects any money or property pursuant
to this Article V, it shall deposit such money into the Payment Account and pay
out the money in the following order:

                 FIRST:  to the Indenture Trustee for amounts due hereunder;

                 SECOND:  to Holders of Class A-1 Notes for amounts due and
                 unpaid on such Class of Notes first for interest and then for
                 principal, and to each Noteholder of such Class in each case
                 ratably, without preference or priority of any kind, according
                 to the amounts due and payable on such Class of Notes for
                 interest and then for principal, until all amounts of interest
                 due have been paid and the Security Balance of such Class of
                 Notes is reduced to zero;

                 THIRD:  to Holders of Class A-2 Notes for amounts due and
                 unpaid on such Class of Notes first for interest and then for
                 principal, and to each Noteholder of such Class in each case
                 ratably, without preference or priority of any kind, according
                 to the amounts due and payable on such Class of Notes for
                 interest and then for principal, until all amounts of interest
                 due have been paid and the Security Balance of such Class of
                 Notes is reduced to zero;

                 FOURTH:  to Holders of Class A-3 Notes for amounts due and
                 unpaid on such Class of Notes first for interest and then for
                 principal, and to each Noteholder of such Class in each case
                 ratably, without preference or priority of any kind, according
                 to the amounts due and payable on such Class of Notes for
                 interest and then for principal, until all amounts of interest
                 due have been paid and the Security Balance of such Class of
                 Notes is reduced to zero;

                 FIFTH:  to Holders of Class B Notes for amounts due and unpaid
                 on such Class of Notes first for interest and then for
                 principal, and to each Noteholder of such Class in each case
                 ratably, without preference or





                                      34
<PAGE>   40

                 priority of any kind, according to the amounts due and payable
                 on such Class of Notes for interest and then for principal,
                 until all amounts of interest due have been paid and the
                 Security Balance of such Class of Notes is reduced to zero;

                 SIXTH:  to the Issuer for amounts required to be distributed
                 to the Certificateholders in respect of Certificate Yield and
                 reduction of the Certificate Balance pursuant to the Trust
                 Agreement;

                 SEVENTH:  to the Issuer for amounts due under Article VIII of
                 the Trust Agreement; and

                 EIGHTH:  to the payment of the remainder, if any to HCLC, the
                 initial Holder of the Designated Certificate or its transferee.

         The Indenture Trustee may fix a record date and payment date for any
payment to Noteholders pursuant to this Section 5.03.  At least 15 days before
such record date, the Issuer shall mail to each Noteholder and the Indenture
Trustee a notice that states the record date, the payment date and the amount
to be paid.

         Section 5.04.  Optional Preservation of the Indenture Trust Estate.
If the Notes have been declared to be due and payable under Section 5.01
following an Event of Default and such declaration and its consequences have
not been rescinded and annulled, the Indenture Trustee may, but need not, elect
to maintain possession of the Indenture Trust Estate.  It is the desire of the
parties hereto and the Noteholders that there be at all times sufficient funds
for the payment of principal of and interest on the Notes and other obligations
of the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee shall take such desire into account
when determining whether or not to maintain possession of the Indenture Trust
Estate.  In determining whether to maintain possession of the Indenture Trust
Estate, the Indenture Trustee may, but need not, obtain and rely upon an
opinion of an Independent investment banking or accounting firm of national
reputation as to the feasibility of such proposed action and as to the
sufficiency of the Indenture Trust Estate for such purpose.

         Section 5.05.  Limitation of Suits.  No Holder of any Note shall have
any right to institute any Proceeding, judicial or otherwise, with respect to
this Indenture, or for the appointment of a receiver or trustee, or for any
other remedy hereunder, unless and subject to the provisions of Section 10.16
hereof:

                      (i)   such Holder has previously given written notice to
         the Indenture Trustee of a continuing Event of Default;





                                      35
<PAGE>   41

                      (ii)  the Holders of not less than 25% of the Security
         Balances of the Notes have made written request to the Indenture
         Trustee to institute such Proceeding in respect of such Event of
         Default in its own name as Indenture Trustee hereunder;

                    (iii)   such Holder or Holders have offered to the
         Indenture Trustee reasonable indemnity against the costs, expenses and
         liabilities to be incurred in complying with such request;

                      (iv)  the Indenture Trustee for 60 days after its receipt
         of such notice, request and offer of indemnity has failed to institute
         such Proceedings; and

                      (v)   no direction inconsistent with such written request
         has been given to the Indenture Trustee during such 60-day period by
         the Holders of a majority of the Security Balances of the Notes.

It is understood and intended that no one or more Holders of Notes shall have
any right in any manner whatever by virtue of, or by availing of, any provision
of this Indenture to affect, disturb or prejudice the rights of any other
Holders of Notes or to obtain or to seek to obtain priority or preference over
any other Holders or to enforce any right under this Indenture, except in the
manner herein provided.

         In the event the Indenture Trustee shall receive conflicting or
inconsistent requests and indemnity from two or more groups of Holders of
Notes, each representing less than a majority of the Security Balances of the
Notes, the Indenture Trustee in its sole discretion may determine what action,
if any, shall be taken, notwithstanding any other provisions of this Indenture.

         Section 5.06.  Unconditional Rights of Noteholders To Receive
Principal and Interest.  Notwithstanding any other provisions in this
Indenture, the Holder of any Note shall have the right, which is absolute and
unconditional, to receive payment of the principal of and interest, if any, on
such Note on or after the respective due dates thereof expressed in such Note
or in this Indenture and to institute suit for the enforcement of any such
payment, and such right shall not be impaired without the consent of such
Holder.

         Section 5.07.  Restoration of Rights and Remedies.  If the Indenture
Trustee or any Noteholder has instituted any Proceeding to enforce any right or
remedy under this Indenture and such Proceeding has been discontinued or
abandoned for any reason or has been determined adversely to the Indenture
Trustee or to such Noteholder, then and in every such case the Issuer, the
Indenture Trustee and the Noteholders shall, subject to any determination





                                      36
<PAGE>   42

in such Proceeding, be restored severally and respectively to their former
positions hereunder, and thereafter all rights and remedies of the Indenture
Trustee and the Noteholders shall continue as though no such Proceeding had
been instituted.

         Section 5.08.  Rights and Remedies Cumulative.  No right or remedy
herein conferred upon or reserved to the Indenture Trustee or to the
Noteholders is intended to be exclusive of any other right or remedy, and every
right and remedy shall, to the extent permitted by law, be cumulative and in
addition to every other right and remedy given hereunder or now or hereafter
existing at law or in equity or otherwise.  The assertion or employment of any
right or remedy hereunder, or otherwise, shall not prevent the concurrent
assertion or employment of any other appropriate right or remedy.

         Section 5.09.  Delay or Omission Not a Waiver.  No delay or omission
of the Indenture Trustee or any Holder of any Note to exercise any right or
remedy accruing upon any Event of Default shall impair any such right or remedy
or constitute a waiver of any such Event of Default or an acquiescence therein.
Every right and remedy given by this Article V or by law to the Indenture
Trustee or to the Noteholders may be exercised from time to time, and as often
as may be deemed expedient, by the Indenture Trustee or by the Noteholders, as
the case may be.

         Section 5.10.  Control by Noteholders.  The Holders of a majority of
the Security Balances of Notes shall have the right to direct the time, method
and place of conducting any Proceeding for any remedy available to the
Indenture Trustee with respect to the Notes or exercising any trust or power
conferred on the Indenture Trustee; provided that:

                       (i)  such direction shall not be in conflict with any
         rule of law or with this Indenture;

                      (ii)  subject to the express terms of Section 5.03, any
         direction to the Indenture Trustee to sell or liquidate the Indenture
         Trust Estate shall be by Holders of Notes representing not less than
         100% of the Security Balances of Notes;

                     (iii)  if the conditions set forth in Section 5.04 have
         been satisfied and the Indenture Trustee elects to retain the
         Indenture Trust Estate pursuant to such Section, then any direction to
         the Indenture Trustee by Holders of Notes representing less than 100%
         of the Security Balances of Notes to sell or liquidate the Indenture
         Trust Estate shall be of no force and effect; and





                                      37
<PAGE>   43

                      (iv)  the Indenture Trustee may take any other action
         deemed proper by the Indenture Trustee that is not inconsistent with
         such direction.

Notwithstanding the rights of Noteholders set forth in this Section, subject to
Section 6.01, the Indenture Trustee need not take any action that it determines
might involve it in liability or might materially adversely affect the rights
of any Noteholders not consenting to such action.

         Section 5.11.  Waiver of Past Defaults.   Prior to the declaration of
the acceleration of the maturity of the Notes as provided in Section 5.01, the
Holders of Notes of not less than a majority of the Security Balances of the
Notes may waive any past Event of Default and its consequences except an Event
of Default (a) with respect to payment of principal of or interest on any of
the Notes or (b) in respect of a covenant or provision hereof which cannot be
modified or amended without the consent of the Holder of each Note.  In the
case of any such waiver, the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the Holders of
the Notes shall be restored to their former positions and rights hereunder,
respectively; but no such waiver shall extend to any subsequent or other Event
of Default or impair any right consequent thereto.

         Upon any such waiver, any Event of Default arising therefrom shall be
deemed to have been cured and not to have occurred, for every purpose of this
Indenture; but no such waiver shall extend to any subsequent or other Event of
Default or impair any right consequent thereto.  The Indenture Trustee shall
notify the Rating Agencies of any such waiver pursuant to this Section 5.11.

         Section 5.12.  Undertaking for Costs.   All parties to this Indenture
agree, and each Holder of any Note by such Holder's acceptance thereof shall be
deemed to have agreed, that any court may in its discretion require, in any
suit for the enforcement of any right or remedy under this Indenture, or in any
suit against the Indenture Trustee for any action taken, suffered or omitted by
it as Indenture Trustee, the filing by any party litigant in such suit of an
undertaking to pay the costs of such suit, and that such court may in its
discretion assess reasonable costs, including reasonable attorneys' fees,
against any party litigant in such suit, having due regard to the merits and
good faith of the claims or defenses made by such party litigant; but the
provisions of this Section 5.12 shall not apply to (a) any suit instituted by
the Indenture Trustee, (b) any suit instituted by any Noteholder, or group of
Noteholders, in each case holding in the aggregate more than 10% of the
Security Balances of the Notes or (c) any suit instituted by any Noteholder for
the enforcement of the payment of principal of or interest on any Note on or
after the respective due dates expressed in such Note and in this Indenture.





                                      38
<PAGE>   44

         Section 5.13.  Waiver of Stay or Extension Laws.  The Issuer covenants
(to the extent that it may lawfully do so) that it will not at any time insist
upon, or plead or in any manner whatsoever, claim or take the benefit or
advantage of, any stay or extension law wherever enacted, now or at any time
hereafter in force, that may affect the covenants or the performance of this
Indenture; and the Issuer (to the extent that it may lawfully do so) hereby
expressly waives all benefit or advantage of any such law, and covenants that
it will not hinder, delay or impede the execution of any power herein granted
to the Indenture Trustee, but will suffer and permit the execution of every
such power as though no such law had been enacted.

         Section 5.14.  Sale of Indenture Trust Estate.  (a)  The power to
effect any sale or other disposition (a "Sale") of any portion of the Indenture
Trust Estate pursuant to Section 5.03 is expressly subject to the provisions of
Section 5.04 and this Section 5.14.  The power to effect any such Sale shall
not be exhausted by any one or more Sales as to any portion of the Indenture
Trust Estate remaining unsold, but shall continue unimpaired until the entire
Indenture Trust Estate shall have been sold or all amounts payable on the Notes
and under this Indenture shall have been paid.  The Indenture Trustee may from
time to time postpone any public Sale by public announcement made at the time
and place of such Sale.  The Indenture Trustee hereby expressly waives its
right to any amount fixed by law as compensation for any Sale.

         (b)  The Indenture Trustee shall not in any private Sale sell the
Indenture Trust Estate, or any portion thereof, unless

                 (1)      the Holders of all Notes consent to or direct the
Indenture Trustee to make, such Sale, or

                 (2)      the proceeds of such Sale would be not less than the
entire amount which would be payable to the Noteholders under the Notes in full
payment thereof in accordance with Section 5.01, on the Payment Date next
succeeding the date of such Sale, or

                 (3)      The Indenture Trustee determines or is advised that
the conditions for retention of the Indenture Trust Estate set forth in Section
5.04 cannot be satisfied (in making any such determination, the Indenture
Trustee may rely upon an opinion of an Independent investment banking firm
obtained and delivered as provided in Section 5.04), and the Holders
representing at least 66-2/3% of the Note Balances of the Notes consent to such
Sale.

The purchase by the Indenture Trustee of all or any portion of the Indenture
Trust Estate at a private Sale shall not be deemed a Sale or other disposition
thereof for purposes of this Section 5.14(b).





                                      39
<PAGE>   45


         (c)  Unless the Holders of the Notes have otherwise consented or
directed the Indenture Trustee, at any public Sale of all or any portion of the
Indenture Trust Estate at which a minimum bid equal to or greater than the
amount described in paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this Section 5.14 has
not been established by the Indenture Trustee and no Person bids an amount
equal to or greater than such amount, the Indenture Trustee shall bid an amount
at least $1.00 more than the highest other bid.

         (d)  In connection with a Sale of all or any portion of the Indenture
Trust Estate

                 (1)      any Holder or Holders of Notes may bid for and
purchase the property offered for sale, and upon compliance with the terms of
sale may hold, retain and possess and dispose of such property, without further
accountability, and may, in paying the purchase money therefor, deliver any
Notes or claims for interest thereon in lieu of cash up to the amount which
shall, upon distribution of the net proceeds of such sale, be payable thereon,
and such Notes, in case the amounts so payable thereon shall be less than the
amount due thereon, shall be returned to the Holders thereof after being
appropriately stamped to show such partial payment;

                 (2)      the Indenture Trustee may bid for and acquire the
property offered for Sale in connection with any Sale thereof, and, subject to
any requirements of, and to the extent permitted by, applicable law in
connection therewith, may purchase all or any portion of the Indenture Trust
Estate in a private sale, and, in lieu of paying cash therefor, may make
settlement for the purchase price by crediting the gross Sale price against the
sum of (A) the amount which would be distributable to the Holders of the Notes
in accordance with Section 5.03 on the Payment Date next succeeding the date of
such Sale and (B) the expenses of the Sale and of any Proceedings in connection
therewith which are reimbursable to it, without being required to produce the
Notes in order to complete any such Sale or in order for the net Sale price to
be credited against such Notes, and any property so acquired by the Indenture
Trustee shall be held and dealt with by it in accordance with the provisions of
this Indenture;

                 (3)      the Indenture Trustee shall execute and deliver an
appropriate instrument of conveyance transferring its interest in any portion
of the Indenture Trust Estate in connection with a Sale thereof;

                 (4)      the Indenture Trustee is hereby irrevocably appointed
the agent and attorney-in-fact of the Issuer to transfer and convey its
interest in any portion of the Indenture Trust Estate in connection with a Sale
thereof, and to take all action necessary to effect such Sale; and





                                      40
<PAGE>   46

                 (5)      no purchaser or transferee at such a Sale shall be
bound to ascertain the Indenture Trustee's authority, inquire into the
satisfaction of any conditions precedent or see to the application of any
moneys.

         Section 5.15.  Action on Notes.  The Indenture Trustee's right to seek
and recover judgment on the Notes or under this Indenture shall not be affected
by the seeking, obtaining or application of any other relief under or with
respect to this Indenture.  Neither the lien of this Indenture nor any rights
or remedies of the Indenture Trustee or the Noteholders shall be impaired by
the recovery of any judgment by the Indenture Trustee against the Issuer or by
the levy of any execution under such judgment upon any portion of the Indenture
Trust Estate or upon any of the assets of the Issuer.  Any money or property
collected by the Indenture Trustee shall be applied in accordance with Section
5.03(b).

         Section 5.16.  Performance and Enforcement of Certain Obligations.
(a)  Promptly following a request from the Indenture Trustee to do so and at
the Administrator's expense, the Issuer shall take all such lawful action as
the Indenture Trustee may request to compel or secure the performance and
observance by the Deposit Trust in its obligations to the Issuer under or in
connection with the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, and upon the occurrence
and continuance of a "Servicer Default" under the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement to exercise any and all rights, remedies, powers and privileges
lawfully available to the Issuer under or in connection with the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement to the extent and in the manner directed by the Indenture
Trustee, including the transmission of notices of default on the part of the
Seller or the Servicer thereunder and the institution of legal or
administrative actions or proceedings to compel or secure performance by the
Seller or the Servicer of each of their obligations under the Receivables
Purchase Agreement and the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         (b)     If an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the
Indenture Trustee may, and at the direction (which direction shall be in
writing or by telephone (confirmed in writing promptly thereafter)) of the
Holders of 66-2/3% of the Security Balances of the Notes shall, exercise all
rights, remedies, powers, privileges and claims of the Issuer against the
Deposit Trust under or in connection with the Pooling and Servicing Agreement,
including the right or power to take any action to compel or secure performance
or observance by the Deposit Trustee, of its obligations to the Issuer
thereunder and to give any consent, request, notice, direction, approval,
extension or waiver under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and any right of
the Issuer to take such action shall not be suspended.





                                      41
<PAGE>   47

                                   ARTICLE VI

                             The Indenture Trustee

         Section 6.01.  Duties of Indenture Trustee.  (a)  If an Event of
Default has occurred and is continuing, the Indenture Trustee shall exercise
the rights and powers vested in it by this Indenture and use the same degree of
care and skill in their exercise as a prudent person would exercise or use
under the circumstances in the conduct of such person's own affairs.

         (b)  Except during the continuance of an Event of Default:

                      (i)   the Indenture Trustee undertakes to perform such
         duties and only such duties as are specifically set forth in this
         Indenture and no implied covenants or obligations shall be read into
         this Indenture against the Indenture Trustee; and

                     (ii)   in the absence of bad faith on its part, the
         Indenture Trustee may conclusively rely, as to the truth of the
         statements and the correctness of the opinions expressed therein, upon
         certificates or opinions furnished to the Indenture Trustee and
         conforming to the requirements of this Indenture; however, the
         Indenture Trustee shall examine the certificates and opinions to
         determine whether or not they conform to the requirements of this
         Indenture.

         (c)  The Indenture Trustee may not be relieved from liability for its
own negligent action, its own negligent failure to act or its own willful
misconduct, except that:

                      (i)   this paragraph does not limit the effect of
         paragraph (b) of this Section 6.01;

                     (ii)   the Indenture Trustee shall not be liable for any
         error of judgment made in good faith by a Responsible Officer unless
         it is proved that the Indenture Trustee was negligent in ascertaining
         the pertinent facts; and

                    (iii)   the Indenture Trustee shall not be liable with
         respect to any action it takes or omits to take in good faith in
         accordance with a direction received by it pursuant to Section 5.10.

         (d)  Every provision of this Indenture that in any way relates to the
Indenture Trustee is subject to paragraphs (a), (b), (c) and (g) of this
Section 6.01.

         (e)  The Indenture Trustee shall not be liable for interest on any
money received by it except as the Indenture Trustee may agree in writing with
the Issuer.





                                      42
<PAGE>   48


         (f)  Money held in trust by the Indenture Trustee need not be
segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law or the terms
of this Indenture.

         (g)  No provision of this Indenture shall require the Indenture
Trustee to expend or risk its own funds or otherwise incur financial liability
in the performance of any of its duties hereunder or in the exercise of any of
its rights or powers, if it shall have reasonable grounds to believe that
repayment of such funds or adequate indemnity against such risk or liability is
not reasonably assured to it.

         (h)  Every provision of this Indenture relating to the conduct or
affecting the liability of or affording protection to the Indenture Trustee
shall be subject to the provisions of this Section and to the provisions of the
TIA.

         Section 6.02.  Rights of Indenture Trustee.  (a)  The Indenture
Trustee may rely on any document believed by it to be genuine and to have been
signed or presented by the proper person.  The Indenture Trustee need not
investigate any fact or matter stated in the document.

         (b)  Before the Indenture Trustee acts or refrains from acting, it may
require an Officer's Certificate or an Opinion of Counsel.  The Indenture
Trustee shall not be liable for any action it takes or omits to take in good
faith in reliance on an Officer's Certificate or Opinion of Counsel.

         (c)  The Indenture Trustee may execute any of the trusts or powers
hereunder or perform any duties hereunder either directly or by or through
agents or attorneys or a custodian or nominee, and the Indenture Trustee shall
not be responsible for any misconduct or negligence on the part of, or for the
supervision of, any such agent, attorney, custodian or nominee appointed with
due care by it hereunder.

         (d)  The Indenture Trustee shall not be liable for any action it takes
or omits to take in good faith which it believes to be authorized or within its
rights or powers; provided, however, that the Indenture Trustee's conduct does
not constitute willful misconduct, negligence or bad faith.

         (e)  The Indenture Trustee may consult with counsel, and the advice or
opinion of counsel with respect to legal matters relating to this Indenture and
the Notes shall be full and complete authorization and protection from
liability in respect to any action taken, omitted or suffered by it hereunder
in good faith and in accordance with the advice or opinion of such counsel.





                                      43
<PAGE>   49

         Section 6.03.  Individual Rights of Indenture Trustee.  The Indenture
Trustee in its individual or any other capacity may become the owner or pledgee
of Notes and may otherwise deal with the Issuer or its Affiliates with the same
rights it would have if it were not Indenture Trustee.  Any Administrator, Note
Registrar, co-registrar or co-paying agent may do the same with like rights.
However, the Indenture Trustee must comply with Sections 6.11 and 6.12.

         Section 6.04.  Indenture Trustee's Disclaimer.  The Indenture Trustee
shall not be responsible for and makes no representation as to the validity or
adequacy of this Indenture or the Notes, it shall not be accountable for the
Issuer's use of the proceeds from the Notes, and it shall not be responsible
for any statement of the Issuer in the Indenture or in any document issued in
connection with the sale of the Notes or in the Notes other than the Indenture
Trustee's certificate of authentication.

         Section 6.05.  Notice of Event of Default.  If an Event of Default
occurs and is continuing and if it is known to a Responsible Officer of the
Indenture Trustee, the Indenture Trustee shall mail to each Noteholder notice
of the Event of Default within 90 days after it occurs.  Except in the case of
an Event of Default in payment of principal of or interest on any Note, the
Indenture Trustee may withhold the notice if and so long as a committee of its
Responsible Officers in good faith determines that withholding the notice is in
the interests of Noteholders.

         Section 6.06.  Reports by Indenture Trustee.  (a) The Indenture
Trustee shall deliver to each Noteholder such information as may be required to
enable such holder to prepare its federal and state income tax returns.  In
addition, upon the Issuer's written request, the Indenture Trustee shall
promptly furnish information reasonably requested by the Issuer that is
reasonably available to the Indenture Trustee to enable the Issuer to perform
its federal and state income tax reporting obligations.

         (b)  Within 10 days of each Payment Date, the Indenture Trustee will
prepare and forward to each Holder of the Notes and each Rating Agency, a
Monthly Security Report, a form of which is attached hereto as Exhibit B.

         Section 6.07.  Compensation and Indemnity.  The Issuer shall or shall
cause the Administrator to pay to the Indenture Trustee from time to time
compensation for its services as previously agreed to by the Administrator on
behalf of the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee.  The Indenture Trustee's
compensation shall not be limited by any law on compensation of a trustee of an
express trust.  The Issuer shall or shall cause the Administrator to reimburse
the Indenture Trustee for all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred or
made by it, including costs of





                                      44
<PAGE>   50

collection, in addition to the compensation for its services.  Such expenses
shall include the reasonable compensation and expenses, disbursements and
advances of the Indenture Trustee's agents, outside counsel, accountants and
experts.  The Issuer shall or shall cause the Administrator to indemnify the
Indenture Trustee against any and all loss, liability, damages or claims or
expense (including attorneys' fees) incurred by it in connection with the
administration of this trust and the performance of its duties hereunder.  The
Indenture Trustee shall notify the Issuer and the Administrator promptly of any
claim for which it may seek indemnity.  Failure by the Indenture Trustee to so
notify the Issuer and the Administrator shall not relieve the Issuer or the
Administrator of its obligations hereunder.  The Issuer shall or shall cause
the Administrator to defend any such claim, and the Indenture Trustee may have
separate counsel and the Issuer shall or shall cause the Administrator to pay
the fees and expenses of such counsel.  Neither the Issuer nor the
Administrator need reimburse any expense or indemnify against any loss,
liability or expense incurred by the Indenture Trustee through the Indenture
Trustee's own willful misconduct, negligence or bad faith.

         The Issuer's payment obligations to the Indenture Trustee pursuant to
this Section 6.07 shall survive the discharge of this Indenture and the
resignation or removal of the Indenture Trustee.  When the Indenture Trustee
incurs expenses after the occurrence of an Event of Default with respect to the
Issuer, the expenses are intended to constitute expenses of administration
under Title 11 of the United States Code or any other applicable federal or
state bankruptcy, insolvency or similar law.

         Section 6.08.  Replacement of Indenture Trustee.  No resignation or
removal of the Indenture Trustee and no appointment of a successor Indenture
Trustee shall become effective until the acceptance of appointment by the
successor Indenture Trustee pursuant to this Section 6.08.  The Indenture
Trustee may resign at any time by so notifying the Seller and the Issuer.  The
Holders of a majority of Security Balances of the Notes may remove the
Indenture Trustee by so notifying the Indenture Trustee and may appoint a
successor Indenture Trustee.  The Issuer shall remove the Indenture Trustee if:

                       (i)  the Indenture Trustee fails to comply with Section
          6.11;

                      (ii)  the Indenture Trustee is adjudged a bankrupt or
          insolvent;

                     (iii)  a receiver or other public officer takes charge of
          the Indenture Trustee or its property; or

                      (iv)  the Indenture Trustee otherwise becomes incapable
          of acting.





                                      45
<PAGE>   51


         If the Indenture Trustee resigns or is removed or if a vacancy exists
in the office of Indenture Trustee for any reason (the Indenture Trustee in
such event being referred to herein as the retiring Indenture Trustee), the
Issuer shall promptly appoint a successor Indenture Trustee by notice thereof
to the Noteholders.

         A successor Indenture Trustee shall deliver a written acceptance of
its appointment to the retiring Indenture Trustee and to the Issuer.  Thereupon
the resignation or removal of the retiring Indenture Trustee shall become
effective, and the successor Indenture Trustee shall have all the rights,
powers and duties of the Indenture Trustee under this Indenture.  The successor
Indenture Trustee shall mail a notice of its succession to Noteholders.  The
retiring Indenture Trustee shall promptly transfer all property held by it as
Indenture Trustee to the successor Indenture Trustee.

         If a successor Indenture Trustee does not take office within 30 days
after the retiring Indenture Trustee resigns or is removed, the retiring
Indenture Trustee, the Issuer or the Holders of a majority of Security Balances
of the Notes may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the
appointment of a successor Indenture Trustee.

         If the Indenture Trustee fails to comply with Section 6.11, any
Noteholder may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the removal of
the Indenture Trustee and the appointment of a successor Indenture Trustee.

         Notwithstanding the replacement of the Indenture Trustee pursuant to
this Section, the Issuer's and the Administrator's obligations under Section
6.07 shall continue for the benefit of the retiring Indenture Trustee.

         Section 6.09.  Successor Indenture Trustee by Merger.  If the
Indenture Trustee consolidates with, merges or converts into, or transfers all
or substantially all its corporate trust business or assets to, another
corporation or banking association, the resulting, surviving or transferee
corporation without any further act shall be the successor Indenture Trustee;
provided, that such corporation or banking association shall be otherwise
qualified and eligible under Section 6.11 and shall not be an Affiliate of the
Owner Trustee.  The Indenture Trustee shall provide the Rating Agencies prior
written notice of any such transaction.

         In case at the time such successor or successors by merger, conversion
or consolidation to the Indenture Trustee shall succeed to the trusts created
by this Indenture any of the Notes shall have been authenticated but not
delivered, any such successor to the Indenture Trustee may adopt the
certificate of





                                      46
<PAGE>   52

authentication of any predecessor trustee, and deliver such Notes so
authenticated; and in case at that time any of the Notes shall not have been
authenticated, any successor to the Indenture Trustee may authenticate such
Notes either in the name of any predecessor hereunder or in the name of the
successor to the Indenture Trustee; and in all such cases such certificates
shall have the full force which it is anywhere in the Notes or in this
Indenture provided that the certificate of the Indenture Trustee shall have.

         Section 6.10.  Appointment of Co-Indenture Trustee or Separate
Indenture Trustee.  (a)  Notwithstanding any other provisions of this
Indenture, at any time, for the purpose of meeting any legal requirement of any
jurisdiction in which any part of the Indenture Trust Estate may at the time be
located, the Indenture Trustee shall have the power and may execute and deliver
all instruments to appoint one or more Persons to act as a co-trustee or
co-trustees, or separate trustee or separate trustees, of all or any part of
the Trust, and to vest in such Person or Persons, in such capacity and for the
benefit of the Noteholders, such title to the Indenture Trust Estate, or any
part hereof, and, subject to the other provisions of this Section, such powers,
duties, obligations, rights and trusts as the Indenture Trustee may consider
necessary or desirable.  No co-trustee or separate trustee hereunder shall be
required to meet the terms of eligibility as a successor trustee under Section
6.11 and no notice to Noteholders of the appointment of any co-trustee or
separate trustee shall be required under Section 6.08 hereof.

         (b)  Every separate trustee and co-trustee shall, to the extent
permitted by law, be appointed and act subject to the following provisions and
conditions:

                      (i)   all rights, powers, duties and obligations
         conferred or imposed upon the Indenture Trustee shall be conferred or
         imposed upon and exercised or performed by the Indenture Trustee and
         such separate trustee or co-trustee jointly (it being understood that
         such separate trustee or co-trustee is not authorized to act
         separately without the Indenture Trustee joining in such act), except
         to the extent that under any law of any jurisdiction in which any
         particular act or acts are to be performed the Indenture Trustee shall
         be incompetent or unqualified to perform such act or acts, in which
         event such rights, powers, duties and obligations (including the
         holding of title to the Indenture Trust Estate or any portion thereof
         in any such jurisdiction) shall be exercised and performed singly by
         such separate trustee or co-trustee, but solely at the direction of
         the Indenture Trustee;





                                      47
<PAGE>   53

                      (ii)  no trustee hereunder shall be personally liable by
         reason of any act or omission of any other trustee hereunder; and

                    (iii)   the Indenture Trustee may at any time accept the
         resignation of or remove any separate trustee or co-trustee.

         (c)  Any notice, request or other writing given to the Indenture
Trustee shall be deemed to have been given to each of the then separate
trustees and co-trustees, as effectively as if given to each of them.  Every
instrument appointing any separate trustee or co-trustee shall refer to this
Agreement and the conditions of this Article VI.  Each separate trustee and
co-trustee, upon its acceptance of the trusts conferred, shall be vested with
the estates or property specified in its instrument of appointment, either
jointly with the Indenture Trustee or separately, as may be provided therein,
subject to all the provisions of this Indenture, specifically including every
provision of this Indenture relating to the conduct of, affecting the liability
of, or affording protection to, the Indenture Trustee.  Every such instrument
shall be filed with the Indenture Trustee.

         (d)  Any separate trustee or co-trustee may at any time constitute the
Indenture Trustee, its agent or attorney-in-fact with full power and authority,
to the extent not prohibited by law, to do any lawful act under or in respect
of this Agreement on its behalf and in its name.  If any separate trustee or
co-trustee shall die, become incapable of acting, resign or be removed, all of
its estates, properties, rights, remedies and trusts shall vest in and be
exercised by the Indenture Trustee, to the extent permitted by law, without the
appointment of a new or successor trustee.

         Section 6.11.  Eligibility; Disqualification.  The Indenture Trustee
shall at all times satisfy the requirements of TIA Section 310(a).  The
Indenture Trustee shall not be an affiliate of the Owner Trustee.  The
Indenture Trustee shall have a combined capital and surplus of at least
$50,000,000 as set forth in its most recent published annual report of
condition and it or its parent shall have a long- term debt rating of Baa3 or
better by Moody's.  The Indenture Trustee shall comply with TIA Section 
310(b), including the optional provision permitted by the second sentence of
TIA Section  310(b)(9); provided, however, that there shall be excluded from
the operation of TIA Section 310(b)(1) any indenture or indentures under which
other securities of the Issuer are outstanding if the requirements for such
exclusion set forth in TIA Section 310(b)(1) are met.
        
         Section 6.12.  Preferential Collection of Claims Against Issuer.  The
Indenture Trustee shall comply with TIA Section  311(a), excluding any creditor
relationship listed in TIA Section  311(b).  An





                                      48
<PAGE>   54

Indenture Trustee who has resigned or been removed shall be subject to TIA
Section  311(a) to the extent indicated.
        
         Section 6.13.  Representation and Warranty.  The Indenture Trustee
represents and warrants to the Issuer, for the benefit of the Noteholders, that
this Indenture has been executed and delivered by one of its Responsible
Officers who is duly authorized to execute and deliver such document in such
capacity on its behalf.

         Section 6.14.  Directions to Indenture Trustee.  The Indenture Trustee
is hereby directed:

         (a)  to accept assignment of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
and hold the assets of the Indenture Trust Estate in trust for the Noteholders;

         (b)  to authenticate the Notes on behalf of the Issuer substantially
in the form prescribed by Exhibit A in accordance with the terms of this
Indenture; and

         (c)  to take all other actions as shall be required to be taken by the
terms of this Indenture.

         Section 6.15.  No Consent to Certain Acts of Seller.  The Seller shall
not request that the Indenture Trustee consent to, nor shall the Indenture
Trustee consent to any action proposed to be taken by the Seller pursuant to
Article FOURTEENTH or Article FIFTEENTH of the Seller's Certificate of
Incorporation.





                                      49
<PAGE>   55

                                 ARTICLE VII

                        Noteholders' Lists and Reports

         Section 7.01.  Issuer To Furnish Indenture Trustee Names and Addresses
of Noteholders.  The Issuer will furnish or cause to be furnished to the
Indenture Trustee (a) not more than five days after each Record Date, a list,
in such form as the Indenture Trustee may reasonably require, of the names and
addresses of the Holders of Notes as of such Record Date, (b) at such other
times as the Indenture Trustee may request in writing, within 30 days after
receipt by the Issuer of any such request, a list of similar form and content
as of a date not more than 10 days prior to the time such list is furnished;
provided, however, that so long as the Indenture Trustee is the Note Registrar,
no such list shall be required to be furnished.

         Section 7.02.  Preservation of Information; Communications to
Noteholders.  (a)  The Indenture Trustee shall preserve, in as current a form
as is reasonably practicable, the names and addresses of the Holders of Notes
contained in the most recent list furnished to the Indenture Trustee as
provided in Section 7.01 and the names and addresses of Holders of Notes
received by the Indenture Trustee in its capacity as Note Registrar.  The
Indenture Trustee may destroy any list furnished to it as provided in such
Section 7.01 upon receipt of a new list so furnished.

         (b)  Noteholders may communicate pursuant to TIA Section  312(b) with
other Noteholders with respect to their rights under this Indenture or under
the Notes.

         (c)  The Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the Note Registrar shall
have the protection of TIA Section  312(c).

         Section 7.03.  Reports by Issuer.  (a)  The Issuer shall:

                      (i)   file with the Indenture Trustee, within 15 days
         after the Issuer is required to file the same with the Commission,
         copies of the annual reports and of the information, documents and
         other reports (or copies of such portions of any of the foregoing as
         the Commission may from time to time by rules and regulations
         prescribe) that the Issuer may be required to file with the Commission
         pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act;

                      (ii)  file with the Indenture Trustee, and the Commission
         in accordance with rules and regulations prescribed from time to time
         by the Commission such additional information, documents and reports
         with respect to compliance by the Issuer with the conditions and
         covenants of this Inden-



                                      50

<PAGE>   56


         ture as may be required from time to time by such rules and
         regulations; and

                    (iii)   supply to the Indenture Trustee (and the Indenture
         Trustee shall transmit by mail to all Noteholders described in TIA
         Section  313(c)) such summaries of any information, documents and
         reports required to be filed by the Issuer pursuant to clauses (i) and
         (ii) of this Section 7.03(a) and by rules and regulations prescribed
         from time to time by the Commission.

         (b)  Unless the Issuer otherwise determines, the fiscal year of the
Issuer shall end on December 31 of each year.

         Section 7.04.  Reports by Indenture Trustee.  If required by TIA
Section  313(a), within 60 days after each January 1 beginning with January 1,
1997, the Indenture Trustee shall mail to each Noteholder as required by TIA
Section  313(c) a brief report dated as of such date that complies with TIA
Section  313(a).  The Indenture Trustee also shall comply with TIA Section
313(b).

         A copy of each report at the time of its mailing to Noteholders shall
be filed by the Indenture Trustee with the Commission and each stock exchange,
if any, on which the Notes are listed.  The Issuer shall notify the Indenture
Trustee if and when the Notes are listed on any stock exchange.





                                      51
<PAGE>   57

                                 ARTICLE VIII

                     Accounts, Disbursements and Releases

         Section 8.01.  Collection of Money.  Except as otherwise expressly
provided herein, the Indenture Trustee may demand payment or delivery of, and
shall receive and collect, directly and without intervention or assistance of
any fiscal agent or other intermediary, all money and other property payable to
or receivable by the Indenture Trustee pursuant to this Indenture.  The
Indenture Trustee shall apply all such money received by it as provided in this
Indenture.  Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Indenture, if any
default occurs in the making of any payment or performance under any agreement
or instrument that is part of the Indenture Trust Estate, the Indenture Trustee
may take such action as may be appropriate to enforce such payment or
performance, including the institution and prosecution of appropriate
Proceedings.  Any such action shall be without prejudice to any right to claim
a Default or Event of Default under this Indenture and any right to proceed
thereafter as provided in Article V.

         Section 8.02.  Trust Accounts.  (a)  On or prior to the Closing Date,
the Issuer shall (i) cause the Indenture Trustee to establish and maintain, in
the name of the Indenture Trustee, for the benefit of the Noteholders, the
Payment Account as provided in Section 3.01 of this Indenture and (ii) pursuant
to Article V of the Supplement for Series 1996-2, irrevocably direct the
Deposit Trustee to make all payments in respect of the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest into the Payment Account for so long as the Notes are
outstanding.

         (b)  All moneys deposited from time to time in the Payment Account are
for the benefit of the Noteholders.

         On each Payment Date, the Indenture Trustee shall distribute all
amounts on deposit in the Payment Account (including any investment income
thereon) to Noteholders in respect of the Notes and in its capacity as
Certificate Paying Agent to Certificateholders in the order of priority set
forth in Section 3.05.

         The Designated Certificateholder may direct the Indenture Trustee to
invest any funds in the Payment Account in Eligible Investments maturing no
later than each Payment Date and such Eligible Investments shall not be sold or
disposed of prior to the maturity.

         Section 8.03.  Opinion of Counsel.  The Indenture Trustee shall
receive at least seven days notice when requested by the Issuer to take any
action pursuant to Section 8.05(a), accompanied by copies of any instruments to
be executed, and the





                                      52
<PAGE>   58

Indenture Trustee shall also require, as a condition to such action, an Opinion
of Counsel, in form and substance satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee,
stating the legal effect of any such action, outlining the steps required to
complete the same, and concluding that all conditions precedent to the taking
of such action have been complied with and such action will not materially and
adversely impair the security for the Notes or the rights of the Noteholders in
contravention of the provisions of this Indenture; provided, however, that such
Opinion of Counsel shall not be required to express an opinion as to the fair
value of the Indenture Trust Estate.  Counsel rendering any such opinion may
rely, without independent investigation, on the accuracy and validity of any
certificate or other instrument delivered to the Indenture Trustee in
connection with any such action.

         Section 8.04.  Termination Upon Distribution to Noteholders.  This
Indenture and the respective obligations and responsibilities of the Issuer and
the Indenture Trustee created hereby shall terminate upon the distribution to
Noteholders, Certificateholders, and the Indenture Trustee of all amounts
required to be distributed pursuant to Article III; provided, however, that in
no event shall the trust created hereby continue beyond the expiration of 21
years from the death of the survivor of the descendants of Joseph P. Kennedy,
the late ambassador of the United States to the Court of St. James, living on
the date hereof.

         Section 8.05.  Release of Indenture Trust Estate.  (a)  Subject to the
payment of its fees and expenses, the Indenture Trustee may, and when required
by the provisions of this Indenture shall, execute instruments to release
property from the lien of this Indenture, or convey the Indenture Trustee's
interest in the same, in a manner and under circumstances that are not
inconsistent with the provisions of this Indenture.  No party relying upon an
instrument executed by the Indenture Trustee as provided in Article IV
hereunder shall be bound to ascertain the Indenture Trustee's authority,
inquire into the satisfaction of any conditions precedent, or see to the
application of any moneys.

         (b)  The Indenture Trustee shall, at such time as (i) there are no
Notes Outstanding and (ii) all sums due the Indenture Trustee pursuant to this
Indenture have been paid, release any remaining portion of the Indenture Trust
Estate that secured the Notes from the lien of this Indenture.  The Indenture
Trustee shall release property from the lien of this Indenture pursuant to this
Section 8.05 only upon receipt of an request from the Issuer accompanied by an
Officers' Certificate, an Opinion of Counsel, and (if required by the TIA)
Independent Certificates in accordance with TIA Section  314(c) and 314(d)(1)
meeting the applicable requirements as described herein.





                                      53
<PAGE>   59

         Section 8.06.  Surrender of Notes Upon Final Payment.  By acceptance
of any Note, the Holder thereof agrees to surrender such Note to the Indenture
Trustee promptly, prior to such Noteholder's receipt of the final payment
thereon.





                                      54
<PAGE>   60

                                  ARTICLE IX

                           Supplemental Indentures

         Section 9.01.  Supplemental Indentures Without Consent of Noteholders.
(a)  Without the consent of the Holders of any Notes but with prior notice to
the Rating Agencies, the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, when authorized by
an Issuer Request, at any time and from time to time, may enter into one or
more indentures supplemental hereto (which shall conform to the provisions of
the Trust Indenture Act as in force at the date of the execution thereof), in
form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee, for any of the following purposes:

                      (i)   to correct or amplify the description of any
         property at any time subject to the lien of this Indenture, or better
         to assure, convey and confirm unto the Indenture Trustee any property
         subject or required to be subjected to the lien of this Indenture, or
         to subject to the lien of this Indenture additional property;

                      (ii)  to evidence the succession, in compliance with the
         applicable provisions hereof, of another person to the Issuer, and the
         assumption by any such successor of the covenants of the Issuer herein
         and in the Notes contained;

                      (iii)   to add to the covenants of the Issuer, for the
         benefit of the Holders of the Notes, or to surrender any right or
         power herein conferred upon the Issuer;

                      (iv)  to convey, transfer, assign, mortgage or pledge any 
         property to or with the Indenture Trustee;

                      (v)   to cure any ambiguity, to correct or supplement any
         provision herein or in any supplemental indenture that may be
         inconsistent with any other provision herein or in any supplemental
         indenture or to make any other provisions with respect to matters or
         questions arising under this Indenture or in any supplemental
         indenture; provided, that such action shall not adversely affect the
         interests of the Holders of the Notes;

                      (vi)  to evidence and provide for the acceptance of the
         appointment hereunder by a successor trustee with respect to the Notes
         and to add to or change any of the provisions of this Indenture as
         shall be necessary to facilitate the administration of the trusts
         hereunder by more than one trustee, pursuant to the requirements of
         Article VI; or

                      (vii)   to modify, eliminate or add to the provisions of
         this Indenture to such extent as shall be necessary to




                                      55
<PAGE>   61

         effect the qualification of this Indenture under the TIA or under any
         similar federal statute hereafter enacted and to add to this Indenture
         such other provisions as may be expressly required by the TIA;

provided, however, that no such indenture supplements shall be entered into
unless the Indenture Trustee shall have received an Opinion of Counsel that
entering into such indenture supplement will not have any material adverse tax
consequences to the Noteholders.

         The Indenture Trustee is hereby authorized to join in the execution of
any such supplemental indenture and to make any further appropriate agreements
and stipulations that may be therein contained.

         (b)  The Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, when authorized by an
Issuer Request, may, also without the consent of any of the Holders of the
Notes but with prior notice to the Rating Agencies, enter into an indenture or
indentures supplemental hereto for the purpose of adding any provisions to, or
changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of, this Indenture
or of modifying in any manner the rights of the Holders of the Notes under this
Indenture; provided, however, that such action shall not, as evidenced by an
Opinion of Counsel, (i) adversely affect in any material respect the interests
of any Noteholder or (ii) cause the Issuer to be subject to an entity level tax
or be classified as a taxable mortgage pool within the meaning of Section
7701(i) of the Code.

         Section 9.02.  Supplemental Indentures With Consent of Noteholders.
The Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, when authorized by an Issuer Request,
also may, with prior notice to the Rating Agencies and with the consent of the
Holders of not less than a majority of the Security Balances of each Class of
Notes affected thereby, or if all Classes are affected, by majority of the
aggregate of Security Balances of the Notes, by act of such Holders delivered
to the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, enter into an indenture or indentures
supplemental hereto for the purpose of adding any provisions to, or changing in
any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of, this Indenture or of
modifying in any manner the rights of the Holders of the Notes under this
Indenture; provided, however, that no such supplemental indenture shall,
without the consent of the Holder of each Note affected thereby:

                      (i)   change the date of payment of any installment of
         principal of or interest on any Note, or reduce the principal amount
         thereof or the interest rate thereon, change the provisions of this
         Indenture relating to the application of collections on, or the
         proceeds of the sale of, the Indenture Trust Estate to payment of
         principal of or




                                      56
<PAGE>   62

         interest on the Notes, or change any place of payment where, or the
         coin or currency in which, any Note or the interest thereon is
         payable, or impair the right to institute suit for the enforcement of
         the provisions of this Indenture requiring the application of funds
         available therefor, as provided in Article V, to the payment of any
         such amount due on the Notes on or after the respective due dates
         thereof;

                      (ii)  reduce the percentage of the Security Balances of
         the Notes, the consent of the Holders of which is required for any
         such supplemental indenture, or the consent of the Holders of which is
         required for any waiver of compliance with certain provisions of this
         Indenture or certain defaults hereunder and their consequences
         provided for in this Indenture;

                    (iii)   modify or alter the provisions of the proviso to
         the definition of the term "Outstanding" or modify or alter the
         exception in the definition of the term "Holder";

                      (iv)  reduce the percentage of the Security Balances of
         the Notes required to direct the Indenture Trustee to direct the
         Issuer to sell or liquidate the Indenture Trust Estate pursuant to
         Section 5.03;

                      (v)   modify any provision of this Section 9.02 except to
         increase any percentage specified herein or to provide that certain
         additional provisions of this Indenture or the Basic Documents cannot
         be modified or waived without the consent of the Holder of each Note
         affected thereby;

                      (vi)  modify any of the provisions of this Indenture in
         such manner as to affect the calculation of the amount of any payment
         of interest or principal due on any Note on any Payment Date
         (including the calculation of any of the individual components of such
         calculation); or

                    (vii)   permit the creation of any lien ranking prior to or
         on a parity with the lien of this Indenture with respect to any part
         of the Indenture Trust Estate or, except as otherwise permitted or
         contemplated herein, terminate the lien of this Indenture on any
         property at any time subject hereto or deprive the Holder of any Note
         of the security provided by the lien of this Indenture; and provided,
         further, that such action shall not, as evidenced by an Opinion of
         Counsel, cause the Issuer to be subject to an entity level tax or be
         classified as a taxable mortgage pool within the meaning of Section
         7701(i) of the Code.

         The Indenture Trustee may in its discretion determine whether or not
any Notes would be affected by any supplemental indenture and any such
determination shall be conclusive upon the




                                      57
<PAGE>   63

Holders of all Notes, whether theretofore or thereafter authenticated and
delivered hereunder.  The Indenture Trustee shall not be liable for any such
determination made in good faith.

         It shall not be necessary for any Act of Noteholders under this
Section 9.02 to approve the particular form of any proposed supplemental
indenture, but it shall be sufficient if such Act shall approve the substance
thereof.

         Promptly after the execution by the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee
of any supplemental indenture pursuant to this Section 9.02, the Indenture
Trustee shall mail to the Holders of the Notes to which such amendment or
supplemental indenture relates a notice setting forth in general terms the
substance of such supplemental indenture.  Any failure of the Indenture Trustee
to mail such notice, or any defect therein, shall not, however, in any way
impair or affect the validity of any such supplemental indenture.

         Section 9.03.  Execution of Supplemental Indentures.  In executing, or
permitting the additional trusts created by, any supplemental indenture
permitted by this Article IX or the modification thereby of the trusts created
by this Indenture, the Indenture Trustee shall be entitled to receive, and
subject to Sections 6.01 and 6.02, shall be fully protected in relying upon, an
Opinion of Counsel stating that the execution of such supplemental indenture is
authorized or permitted by this Indenture.  The Indenture Trustee may, but
shall not be obligated to, enter into any such supplemental indenture that
affects the Indenture Trustee's own rights, duties, liabilities or immunities
under this Indenture or otherwise.

         Section 9.04.  Effect of Supplemental Indenture.  Upon the execution
of any supplemental indenture pursuant to the provisions hereof, this Indenture
shall be and shall be deemed to be modified and amended in accordance therewith
with respect to the Notes affected thereby, and the respective rights,
limitations of rights, obligations, duties, liabilities and immunities under
this Indenture of the Indenture Trustee, the Issuer and the Holders of the
Notes shall thereafter be determined, exercised and enforced hereunder subject
in all respects to such modifications and amendments, and all the terms and
conditions of any such supplemental indenture shall be and be deemed to be part
of the terms and conditions of this Indenture for any and all purposes.

         Section 9.05.  Conformity with Trust Indenture Act.  Every amendment
of this Indenture and every supplemental indenture executed pursuant to this
Article IX shall conform to the requirements of the Trust Indenture Act as then
in effect so long as this Indenture shall then be qualified under the Trust
Indenture Act.




                                      58
<PAGE>   64


         Section 9.06.  Reference in Notes to Supplemental Indentures.  Notes
authenticated and delivered after the execution of any supplemental indenture
pursuant to this Article IX may, and if required by the Indenture Trustee
shall, bear a notation in form approved by the Indenture Trustee as to any
matter provided for in such supplemental indenture.  If the Issuer or the
Indenture Trustee shall so determine, new Notes so modified as to conform, in
the opinion of the Indenture Trustee and the Issuer, to any such supplemental
indenture may be prepared and executed by the Issuer and authenticated and
delivered by the Indenture Trustee in exchange for Outstanding Notes.




                                      59
<PAGE>   65

                                   ARTICLE X

                                 Miscellaneous

         Section 10.01.  Compliance Certificates and Opinions, etc.   (a)  Upon
any application or request by the Issuer to the Indenture Trustee to take any
action under any provision of this Indenture, the Issuer shall furnish to the
Indenture Trustee (i) an Officer's Certificate stating that all conditions
precedent, if any, provided for in this Indenture relating to the proposed
action have been complied with, (ii) an Opinion of Counsel stating that in the
opinion of such counsel all such conditions precedent, if any, have been
complied with and (iii) (if required by the TIA) an Independent Certificate
from a firm of certified public accountants meeting the applicable requirements
of this Section 10.01, except that, in the case of any such application or
request as to which the furnishing of such documents is specifically required
by any provision of this Indenture, no additional certificate or opinion need
be furnished.

         Every certificate or opinion with respect to compliance with a
condition or covenant provided for in this Indenture shall include:

                 (1)      a statement that each signatory of such certificate
         or opinion has read or has caused to be read such covenant or
         condition and the definitions herein relating thereto;

                 (2)      a brief statement as to the nature and scope of the
         examination or investigation upon which the statements or opinions
         contained in such certificate or opinion are based;

                 (3)      a statement that, in the opinion of each such
         signatory, such signatory has made such examination or investigation
         as is necessary to enable such signatory to express an informed
         opinion as to whether or not such covenant or condition has been
         complied with; and

                 (4)      a statement as to whether, in the opinion of each
         such signatory, such condition or covenant has been complied with; and

                 (5)      if the signer of such Certificate or Opinion is
         required to be Independent, the Statement required by the definition
         of the term "Independent".

         (b)  (i)  Prior to the deposit of any Indenture Collateral or other
property or securities with the Indenture Trustee that is to be made the basis
for the release of any property or




                                      60
<PAGE>   66

securities subject to the lien of this Indenture, the Issuer shall, in addition
to any obligation imposed in Section 10.01(a) or elsewhere in this Indenture,
furnish to the Indenture Trustee an Officer's Certificate certifying or stating
the opinion of each person signing such certificate as to the fair value
(within 90 days of such deposit) to the Issuer of the Indenture Collateral or
other property or securities to be so deposited.

                      (ii)  Whenever the Issuer is required to furnish to the
Indenture Trustee an Officer's Certificate certifying or stating the opinion of
any signer thereof as to the matters described in clause (i) above, the Issuer
shall also deliver to the Indenture Trustee an Independent Certificate as to
the same matters, if the fair value to the Issuer of the securities to be so
deposited and of all other such securities made the basis of any such
withdrawal or release since the commencement of the then-current fiscal year of
the Issuer, as set forth in the certificates delivered pursuant to clause (i)
above and this clause (ii), is 10% or more of the Security Balances of the
Notes, but such a certificate need not be furnished with respect to any
securities so deposited, if the fair value thereof to the Issuer as set forth
in the related Officer's Certificate is less than $25,000 or less than one
percent of the Security Balances of the Notes.

                    (iii)   Whenever any property or securities are to be
released from the lien of this Indenture, the Issuer shall also furnish to the
Indenture Trustee an Officer's Certificate certifying or stating the opinion of
each person signing such certificate as to the fair value (within 90 days of
such release) of the property or securities proposed to be released and stating
that in the opinion of such person the proposed release will not impair the
security under this Indenture in contravention of the provisions hereof.

                      (iv)  Whenever the Issuer is required to furnish to the
Indenture Trustee an Officer's Certificate certifying or stating the opinion of
any signer thereof as to the matters described in clause (iii) above, the
Issuer shall also furnish to the Indenture Trustee an Independent Certificate
as to the same matters if the fair value of the property or securities and of
all other property, other than property as contemplated by clause (v) below or
securities released from the lien of this Indenture since the commencement of
the then-current calendar year, as set forth in the certificates required by
clause (iii) above and this clause (iv), equals 10% or more of the Security
Balances of the Notes, but such certificate need not be furnished in the case
of any release of property or securities if the fair value thereof as set forth
in the related Officer's Certificate is less than $25,000 or less than one
percent of the then Security Balances of the Notes.





                                      61
<PAGE>   67

         Section 10.02.  Form of Documents Delivered to Indenture Trustee.  In
any case where several matters are required to be certified by, or covered by
an opinion of, any specified Person, it is not necessary that all such matters
be certified by, or covered by the opinion of, only one such Person, or that
they be so certified or covered by only one document, but one such Person may
certify or give an opinion with respect to some matters and one or more other
such Persons as to other matters, and any such Person may certify or give an
opinion as to such matters in one or several documents.

         Any certificate or opinion of an Authorized Officer of the Issuer may
be based, insofar as it relates to legal matters, upon a certificate or opinion
of, or representations by, counsel, unless such officer knows, or in the
exercise of reasonable care should know, that the certificate or opinion or
representations with respect to the matters upon which his certificate or
opinion is based are erroneous.  Any such certificate of an Authorized Officer
or Opinion of Counsel may be based, insofar as it relates to factual matters,
upon a certificate or opinion of, or representations by, an officer or officers
of the Seller, the Issuer or the Administrator, stating that the information
with respect to such factual matters is in the possession of the Seller, the
Issuer or the Administrator, unless such counsel knows, or in the exercise of
reasonable care should know, that the certificate or opinion or representations
with respect to such matters are erroneous.

         Where any Person is required to make, give or execute two or more
applications, requests, consents, certificates, statements, opinions or other
instruments under this Indenture, they may, but need not, be consolidated and
form one instrument.

         Whenever in this Indenture, in connection with any application or
certificate or report to the Indenture Trustee, it is provided that the Issuer
shall deliver any document as a condition of the granting of such application,
or as evidence of the Issuer's compliance with any term hereof, it is intended
that the truth and accuracy, at the time of the granting of such application or
at the effective date of such certificate or report (as the case may be), of
the facts and opinions stated in such document shall in such case be conditions
precedent to the right of the Issuer to have such application granted or to the
sufficiency of such certificate or report.  The foregoing shall not, however,
be construed to affect the Indenture Trustee's right to rely upon the truth and
accuracy of any statement or opinion contained in any such document as provided
in Article VI.

         Section 10.03.  Acts of Noteholders.  (a)  Any request, demand,
authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action provided by
this Indenture to be given or taken by Noteholders may be embodied in and
evidenced by one or more




                                      62
<PAGE>   68

instruments of substantially similar tenor signed by such Noteholders in person
or by agents duly appointed in writing; and except as herein otherwise
expressly provided such action shall become effective when such instrument or
instruments are delivered to the Indenture Trustee, and, where it is hereby
expressly required, to the Issuer.  Such instrument or instruments (and the
action embodied therein and evidenced thereby) are herein sometimes referred to
as the "Act" of the Noteholders signing such instrument or instruments.  Proof
of execution of any such instrument or of a writing appointing any such agent
shall be sufficient for any purpose of this Indenture and (subject to Section
6.01) conclusive in favor of the Indenture Trustee and the Issuer, if made in
the manner provided in this Section 10.03.

         (b)  The fact and date of the execution by any person of any such
instrument or writing may be proved in any manner that the Indenture Trustee
deems sufficient.

         (c)  The ownership of Notes shall be proved by the Note Register.

         (d)  Any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent,
waiver or other action by the Holder of any Notes shall bind the Holder of
every Note issued upon the registration thereof or in exchange therefor or in
lieu thereof, in respect of anything done, omitted or suffered to be done by
the Indenture Trustee or the Issuer in reliance thereon, whether or not
notation of such action is made upon such Note.

         Section 10.04.  Notices, etc., to Indenture Trustee, Issuer, and
Rating Agencies.  Any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice,
consent, waiver or Act of Noteholders or other documents provided or permitted
by this Indenture shall be in writing and if such request, demand,
authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or act of Noteholders is to
be made upon, given or furnished to or filed with:

                      (i)   the Indenture Trustee by any Noteholder or by the
         Issuer shall be sufficient for every purpose hereunder if made, given,
         furnished or filed in writing to or with the Indenture Trustee at the
         Corporate Trust Office, or

                      (ii)  the Issuer by the Indenture Trustee or by any
         Noteholder shall be sufficient for every purpose hereunder if in
         writing and mailed first-class, postage prepaid to the Issuer
         addressed to:  Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2, in care of the
         Administrator, Owner Trustee and the Seller, or at any other address
         previously furnished in writing to the Indenture Trustee by the Issuer
         or the Administrator.  The Issuer shall promptly transmit any notice
         received by it from the Noteholders to the Indenture Trustee.





                                      63
<PAGE>   69


         Notices required to be given to the Rating Agencies by the Issuer, the
Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee shall be in writing, personally
delivered or mailed by certified mail, return receipt requested, to (i) in the
case of Moody's, at the following address:  Moody's Investors Service, Inc.,
ABS Monitoring Department, 99 Church Street, New York, New York 10007, (ii) in
the case of Standard & Poor's, at the following address:  Standard & Poor's
Corporation, 26 Broadway (15th Floor), New York, New York 10004, Attention of
Asset Backed Surveillance Department, (iii) in the case of Duff & Phelps, at
the following address: Duff & Phelps Credit Rating Co., 17 State Street, New
York, New York, 10004, and (iv) in the case of Fitch at the following address:
Fitch Investors Service, Inc., One State Street Plaza, New York, New York
10004, Attention: Giovanni Pini or as to each of the foregoing, at such other
address as shall be designated by written notice to the other parties.

         Section 10.05.  Notices to Noteholders; Waiver.  Where this Indenture
provides for notice to Noteholders of any event, such notice shall be
sufficiently given (unless otherwise herein expressly provided) if in writing
and mailed, first-class, postage prepaid to each Noteholder affected by such
event, at his address as it appears on the Note Register, not later than the
latest date, and not earlier than the earliest date, prescribed for the giving
of such notice.  In any case where notice to Noteholders is given by mail,
neither the failure to mail such notice nor any defect in any notice so mailed
to any particular Noteholder shall affect the sufficiency of such notice with
respect to other Noteholders, and any notice that is mailed in the manner
herein provided shall conclusively be presumed to have been duly given.

         Where this Indenture provides for notice in any manner, such notice
may be waived in writing by any Person entitled to receive such notice, either
before or after the event, and such waiver shall be the equivalent of such
notice.  Waivers of notice by Noteholders shall be filed with the Indenture
Trustee but such filing shall not be a condition precedent to the validity of
any action taken in reliance upon such a waiver.

         In case, by reason of the suspension of regular mail service as a
result of a strike, work stoppage or similar activity, it shall be impractical
to mail notice of any event to Noteholders when such notice is required to be
given pursuant to any provision of this Indenture, then any manner of giving
such notice as shall be satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee shall be deemed
to be a sufficient giving of such notice.

         Where this Indenture provides for notice to the Rating Agencies,
failure to give such notice shall not affect any other rights or obligations
created hereunder, and shall not under any circumstance constitute an Event of
Default.





                                      64
<PAGE>   70


         Section 10.06.  Alternate Payment and Notice Provisions.
Notwithstanding any provision of this Indenture or any of the Notes to the
contrary, the Issuer may enter into any agreement with any Holder of a Note
providing for a method of payment, or notice by the Indenture Trustee or any
Administrator to such Holder, that is different from the methods provided for
in this Indenture for such payments or notices.  The Issuer will furnish to the
Indenture Trustee a copy of each such agreement and the Indenture Trustee will
cause payments to be made and notices to be given in accordance with such
agreements.

         Section 10.07.  Conflict with Trust Indenture Act.  If any provision
hereof limits, qualifies or conflicts with another provision hereof that is
required to be included in this Indenture by any of the provisions of the Trust
Indenture Act, such required provision shall control.

         The provisions of TIA Section Section  310 through 317 that impose
duties on any person (including the provisions automatically deemed included
herein unless expressly excluded by this Indenture) are a part of and govern
this Indenture, whether or not physically contained herein.

         Section 10.08.  Effect of Headings.  The Article and Section headings
herein are for convenience only and shall not affect the construction hereof.

         Section 10.09.  Successors and Assigns.  All covenants and agreements
in this Indenture and the Notes by the Issuer shall bind its successors and
assigns, whether so expressed or not.  All agreements of the Indenture Trustee
in this Indenture shall bind its successors, co- trustees and agents.

         Section 10.10.  Separability.  In case any provision in this Indenture
or in the Notes shall be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity,
legality, and enforceability of the remaining provisions shall not in any way
be affected or impaired thereby.

         Section 10.11.  Benefits of Indenture.  Nothing in this Indenture or
in the Notes, express or implied, shall give to any Person, other than the
parties hereto and their successors hereunder, and the Noteholders, and any
other party secured hereunder, and any other Person with an ownership interest
in any part of the Indenture Trust Estate, any benefit or any legal or
equitable right, remedy or claim under this Indenture.

         Section 10.12.  GOVERNING LAW.  THIS INDENTURE SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN
ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS
CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE
PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.





                                      65
<PAGE>   71

         Section 10.13.  Counterparts.  This Indenture may be executed in any
number of counterparts, each of which so executed shall be deemed to be an
original, but all such counterparts shall together constitute but one and the
same instrument.

         Section 10.14.  Recording of Indenture.  If this Indenture is subject
to recording in any appropriate public recording offices, such recording is to
be effected by the Issuer and at its expense accompanied by an Opinion of
Counsel (which may be counsel to the Indenture Trustee or any other counsel
reasonably acceptable to the Indenture Trustee) to the effect that such
recording is necessary either for the protection of the Noteholders or any
other Person secured hereunder or for the enforcement of any right or remedy
granted to the Indenture Trustee under this Indenture.

         Section 10.15.  Issuer Obligation.  No recourse may be taken, directly
or indirectly, with respect to the obligations of the Issuer, the Seller, the
Owner Trustee or the Indenture Trustee on the Notes or under this Indenture or
any certificate or other writing delivered in connection herewith or therewith,
against (i) the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual
capacity, (ii) the Seller or any other owner of a beneficial interest in the
Issuer or the Seller or (iii) any partner, owner, beneficiary, agent, officer,
director, employee or agent of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in
its individual capacity, any holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, the
Owner Trustee or the Indenture Trustee or of any successor or assign of the
Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, except as
any such Person may have expressly agreed (it being understood that the
Indenture Trustee and the Owner Trustee have no such obligations in their
individual capacity) and except that any such partner, owner or beneficiary
shall be fully liable, to the extent provided by applicable law, for any unpaid
consideration for stock, unpaid capital contribution or failure to pay any
installment or call owing to such entity.  For all purposes of this Indenture,
in the performance of any duties or obligations of the Issuer hereunder, the
Owner Trustee shall be subject to, and entitled to the benefits of, the terms
and provisions of Article VI, VII and VIII of the Trust Agreement.

         Section 10.16.  No Petition.  The Indenture Trustee, by entering into
this Indenture, and each Noteholder, by accepting a Note, hereby covenant and
agree that they will not at any time institute against the Seller, the Issuer,
the Administrator or the Servicer, or join in any institution against the
Seller or the Issuer of, any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement,
insolvency or liquidation proceedings, or other proceedings under any United
States federal or state bankruptcy or similar law in connection with any
obligations relating to the Notes, this Indenture or any of the Basic
Documents.





                                      66
<PAGE>   72


         Section 10.17.  Inspection.  The Issuer agrees that, on reasonable
prior notice, it will permit any representative of the Indenture Trustee,
during the Issuer's normal business hours, to examine all the books of account,
records, reports and other papers of the Issuer, to make copies and extracts
therefrom, to cause such books to be audited by Independent certified public
accountants, and to discuss the Issuer's affairs, finances and accounts with
the Issuer's officers, employees, and Independent certified public accountants,
all at such reasonable times and as often as may be reasonably requested.  The
Indenture Trustee shall and shall cause its representatives to hold in
confidence all such information except to the extent disclosure may be required
by law (and all reasonable applications for confidential treatment are
unavailing) and except to the extent that the Indenture Trustee may reasonably
determine that such disclosure is consistent with its obligations hereunder.

         Section 10.18.  Authority of the Administrator.  Each of the parties
to this Indenture acknowledges that the Issuer has appointed the Administrator
to act as its agent to perform the duties and obligations of the Issuer
hereunder.  Unless otherwise instructed by the Owner Trustee, copies of all
notices, requests, demands and other documents to be delivered to the Issuer or
the Owner Trustee pursuant to the terms hereof also shall be delivered to the
Administrator.  Unless otherwise instructed by the Owner Trustee, all notices,
requests, demands and other documents to be executed or delivered, and any
action to be taken, by the Issuer pursuant to the terms hereof may be executed,
delivered and/or taken by the Administrator pursuant to the Administration
Agreement.





                                      67
<PAGE>   73

         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee have caused
their names to be signed hereto by their respective officers thereunto duly
authorized, all as of the day and year first above written.

                                        HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2,
                                        as Issuer
 
                                        By:     CHASE MANHATTAN BANK DELAWARE,
                                                not in its individual capacity
                                                but solely as Owner Trustee

                                        By:___________________________________
                                           Name:
                                           Title:


                                        THE BANK OF NEW YORK,
                                        as Indenture Trustee, as Certificate 
                                        Paying Agent and as Certificate 
                                        Registrar


                                        By:___________________________________
                                           Name:
                                           Title:



 THE BANK OF NEW YORK,
 hereby accepts the  appointment as Certificate
 Paying Agent  pursuant to  Section 3.03 hereof
 and  as  Certificate   Registrar  pursuant  to
 Section 4.02 hereof.


By:______________________________
   Names:
   Title:

<PAGE>   74

STATE OF _______________  )
                          ) ss.:
COUNTY OF ______________  )


         On this ____ day of August, before me personally appeared John Mack,
to me known, who being by me duly sworn, did depose and say, that he resides at
___________________________________, _________________________, that  he is the
____________________ of Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware, as Owner Trustee, one of
the corporations described in and which executed the above instrument; that  he
knows the seal of said corporation; that the seal affixed to said instrument is
such corporate seal; that it was so affixed by order of the Board of Directors
of said corporation; and that  he signed his/her name thereto by like order.


                                                   ___________________________
                                                           Notary Public


[NOTARIAL SEAL]
<PAGE>   75

STATE OF NEW YORK         )
                          ) ss.:
COUNTY OF NEW YORK        )


         On this ____ day of August, before me personally appeared
____________________________________ to me known, who being by me duly sworn,
did depose and say, that  he resides at _____________________________, that  he
is the  ___________________________________ of The Bank of New York, as
Indenture Trustee, one of the corporations described in and which executed the
above instrument; that  he knows the seal of said corporation; that the seal
affixed to said instrument is such corporate seal; that it was so affixed by
order of the Board of Directors of said corporation; and that  he signed
his/her name thereto by like order.

                                                 ___________________________
                                                          Notary Public


[NOTARIAL SEAL]





STATE OF NEW YORK         )
                          ) ss.:
COUNTY OF NEW YORK        )

         On this ____ day of August, before me personally appeared
____________________________________ to me known, who being by me duly sworn,   
did depose and say, that he resides at  ____________________________, that  he
is the  ___________________________ of The Bank of New York, as Indenture
Trustee, one of the corporations described in and which executed the above
instrument; that  he knows the seal of said corporation; that the seal affixed
to said instrument is such corporate seal; that it was so affixed by order of
the Board of Directors of said corporation; and that  he signed his/her name
thereto by like order.

                                                 ___________________________
                                                         Notary Public

[NOTARIAL SEAL]
<PAGE>   76

                                                                     Exhibit A-1



Unless this Note is presented by an authorized representative of The Depository
Trust Company, a New York corporation ("DTC"), to the Issuer or its agent for
registration of transfer, exchange or payment, and any Note issued is
registered in the name of Cede & Co. or in such other name as is requested by
an authorized representative of DTC (and any payment is made to Cede & Co. or
to such other entity as is requested by an authorized representative of DTC),
ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY
PERSON IS WRONGFUL inasmuch as the registered owner hereof, Cede & Co., has an
interest herein.

THE PRINCIPAL OF THIS NOTE IS PAYABLE IN INSTALLMENTS AS SET FORTH HEREIN.
ACCORDINGLY, THE OUTSTANDING PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF THIS NOTE AT ANY TIME MAY BE
LESS THAN THE AMOUNT SHOWN ON THE FACE HEREOF.

                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2
           Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Notes, Series 1996-2

Class:  Class A-1
Registered Principal Amount:  $[           ]
Percentage Interest:  [  ]%
Note Rate:  Floating

No.
CUSIP No.

                 Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2, a business trust duly
organized and existing under the laws of the State of Delaware (herein referred
to as the "Issuer"), for value received, hereby promises to pay to Cede & Co.
or registered assigns, the principal sum of [
                                        ] DOLLARS, payable on each Payment Date
in an amount equal to the Percentage Interest specified above of the aggregate
amount, if any, payable from the Payment Account in respect of principal on the
Class A-1 Notes pursuant Section 3.05 of the Indenture dated as of August 1,
1996 (the "Indenture") between the Issuer and The Bank of New York, as
Indenture Trustee (the "Indenture Trustee"); provided, however, that the entire
unpaid principal amount of this Note shall be due and payable on the August
2006 Payment Date.  Capitalized terms used but not defined herein are defined
in Article 1 of the Indenture, which also contains rules as to construction
that shall be applicable herein.

                 The Issuer will pay interest on this Note on each Payment Date
at a rate per annum equal to LIBOR plus _____% on the principal amount of this
Class A-1 Note on the preceding Payment Date (after giving effect to all
payments of principal made on such preceding Payment Date); provided, however,
that in no event shall





                                     A-1-1
<PAGE>   77

the Note Rate with respect to any Interest Period exceed ___% for such Interest
Period.  LIBOR for each applicable Interest Period will be determined on the
second LIBOR Business Day prior to the first day of such Interest Period or in
the case of the first Interest Period, two days prior to the Closing Date as
set forth in the Indenture.  All determinations of LIBOR by the Indenture
Trustee shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive for all
purposes, and each holder of this Class A-1 Note, by accepting this Class A-1
Note, agrees to be bound by such determination.  Interest on this Class A-1
Note will accrue for each Payment Date from the most recent Payment Date on
which interest has been paid (in the case of the first Payment Date, from the
Closing Date) to but excluding such Payment Date.  Interest will be computed on
the basis of the actual number of days in each Interest Period and a year
assumed to consist of 360 days.  Principal of and interest on this Class A-1
Note shall be paid in the manner specified on the reverse hereof.

                 Principal of and interest on this Note are payable in such
coin or currency of the United States of America as at the time of payment is
legal tender for payment of public and private debts.  All payments made by the
Issuer with respect to this Note shall be applied first to interest due and
payable on this Note as provided above and then to the unpaid principal of this
Note.

                 Reference is made to the further provisions of this Note set
forth on the reverse hereof, which shall have the same effect as though fully
set forth on the face of this Note.

                 Unless the certificate of authentication hereon has been
executed by the Indenture Trustee whose name appears below by manual signature,
this Note shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture referred to
on the reverse hereof, or be valid or obligatory for any purpose.





                                     A-1-2
<PAGE>   78

                 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Owner Trustee, on behalf of the Issuer
and not in its individual capacity, has caused this Note to be duly executed.


                                  HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2

                                  By       CHASE MANHATTAN BANK DELAWARE,
                                           not in its individual
                                           capacity but solely as Owner
                                           Trustee



                                  By _________________________________
                                             Authorized Signatory



                         Certificate of Authentication

This is one of the Class A-1 Notes referred to in the within mentioned
Indenture.


                                        THE BANK OF NEW YORK,
                                          not in its individual capacity but
                                          solely as Indenture Trustee


Dated:  ____________ ___, 1996



                                  By _________________________________
                                             Authorized Signatory
<PAGE>   79

                               [REVERSE OF NOTE]


                 This Class A-1 Note is one of a duly authorized issue of Class
A-1 Notes of the Issuer, designated as its Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed
Notes, Series 1996-2 (herein called the "Class A-1 Notes"), all issued under
the Indenture, to which Indenture and all indentures supplemental thereto
reference is hereby made for a statement of the respective rights and
obligations thereunder of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the holders of
the Notes.  The Notes are subject to all terms of the Indenture.

                 The Class A-1 Notes and the Class A-2 Notes, the Class A-3
Notes and the Class B Notes, also issued under the Indenture (collectively, the
"Notes") are and will be secured by the collateral pledged as security therefor
as provided in the Indenture.

                 Principal of and interest on this Class A-1 Note will be
payable on each Payment Date, commencing on September 16, 1996, as described in
the Indenture.  "Payment Date" means the fifteenth day of each month, or, if
any such day is not a Business Day, then the next Business Day.

                 The entire unpaid principal amount of this Class A-1 Note
shall be due and payable in full on the Payment Date in August 2006 pursuant to
the Indenture.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, if an Event of Default shall
have occurred and be continuing, then the Indenture Trustee or the holders of
Notes representing not less than a majority of the Security Balances of all the
Notes may declare the Notes to be immediately due and payable in the manner
provided in Section 5.01 of the Indenture.  On each Payment Date, principal
payments on the Class A-1 Notes shall be payable in the amounts as provided in
Section 3.05 of the Indenture.

                 Payments of interest on this Class A-1 Note due and payable on
each Payment Date, together with the installment of principal, if any, to the
extent not in full payment of this Note, shall be made by check mailed to the
Person whose name appears as the Registered Holder of this Note on the Note
Register as of the close of business on each Record Date, except that with
respect to Notes registered on the Record Date in the name of the nominee of
the Depository Agency (initially, such nominee to be Cede & Co.), payments will
be made by wire transfer in immediately available funds to the account
designated by such nominee.  Such checks shall be mailed to the Person entitled
thereto at the address of such Person as it appears on the Note Register as of
the applicable Record Date without requiring that this Note be submitted for
notation of payment.  Any reduction in the principal amount of this Note
effected by any payments made on any Payment Date shall be binding upon all
future holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of
transfer hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof, whether or not noted
hereon.  If funds are expected to be available, as provided in the Indenture,
for payment in full




                                    A-1-4
<PAGE>   80

of the then remaining unpaid principal amount of this Note on a Payment Date,
then the Indenture Trustee, in the name of and on behalf of the Issuer, will
notify the Person who was the Registered Holder hereof as of the Record Date
preceding such Payment Date by notice mailed or transmitted by facsimile prior
to such Payment Date, and the amount then due and payable shall be payable only
upon presentation and surrender of this Note at the address specified in such
notice of final payment.

                 As provided in the Indenture and subject to certain
limitations set forth therein, the transfer of this Note may be registered on
the Note Register upon surrender of this Note for registration of transfer at
the Corporate Trust Office, duly endorsed by, or accompanied by a written
instrument of transfer in form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee duly
executed by, the holder hereof or such holder's attorney duly authorized in
writing, with such signature guaranteed by an "eligible guarantor institution"
meeting the requirements of the Note Registrar, which requirements include
membership or participation in the Securities Transfer Agent's Medallion
Program ("STAMP") or such other "signature guarantee program" as may be
determined by the Note Registrar in addition to, or in substitution for, STAMP,
all in accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and
thereupon one or more new Notes in authorized denominations and in the same
aggregate principal amount will be issued to the designated transferee or
transferees.  No service charge will be charged for any registration of
transfer or exchange of this Note, but the Note Registrar shall require payment
of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or governmental charge that may be imposed
in connection with any registration of transfer or exchange of this Note.

                 Each holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note, by acceptance of a
Note or, in the case of a Beneficial Owner of a Note, a beneficial interest in
a Note, covenants and agrees that no recourse may be taken, directly or
indirectly, with respect to the obligations of the Issuer, the Owner Trustee,
the Administrator, the Seller, the Servicer or the Indenture Trustee on the
Notes or under the Indenture or any certificate or other writing delivered in
connection therewith, against (i) the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in
its individual capacity, (ii) any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer
or (iii) any partner, owner, beneficiary, agent, officer, director or employee
of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, any
holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, the Owner Trustee, the
Administrator or the Indenture Trustee or of any successor or assign of the
Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, except as
any such Person may have expressly agreed (it being understood that the
Indenture Trustee and the Owner Trustee have no such obligations in their
individual capacity) and except that any such partner, owner or beneficiary
shall be fully liable, to the extent provided by applicable law, for any unpaid
consideration for stock, unpaid capital contribution or failure to pay any
installment or call owing to such entity.





                                    A-1-5
<PAGE>   81


                  Each holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note, by acceptance of a
Note or, in the case of a Beneficial Owner of a Note, a beneficial interest in
a Note, covenants and agrees by accepting the benefits of the Indenture that
such holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note will not at any time institute
against the Seller, the Administrator, the Servicer or the Issuer, or join in
any institution against the Seller, the Administrator, the Servicer or the
Issuer of, any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or
liquidation proceedings under any United States federal or state bankruptcy or
similar law in connection with any obligations relating to the Notes, the
Indenture or the Basic Documents.

                 The Issuer has entered into the Indenture and this Note is
issued with the intention that, for federal, state and local income, single
business and franchise tax purposes, the Notes will qualify as indebtedness of
the Issuer.  Each holder of a Note, by acceptance of a Note (and each
Beneficial Owner of a Note by acceptance of a beneficial interest in a Note),
agrees to treat the Notes for federal, state and local income, single business
and franchise tax purposes as indebtedness of the Issuer.

                 Prior to the due presentment for registration of transfer of
this Note, the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and any agent of the Issuer or the
Indenture Trustee may treat the Person in whose name this Note (as of the day
of determination or as of such other date as may be specified in the Indenture)
is registered as the owner hereof for all purposes, whether or not this Note be
overdue, and none of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee or any such agent shall
be affected by notice to the contrary.

                 The Indenture permits, with certain exceptions as therein
provided, the amendment thereof and the modification of the rights and
obligations of the Issuer and the rights of the holders of the Notes under the
Indenture at any time by the Issuer with the consent of the holders of Notes
representing a majority of the Security Balances of all Notes at the time
Outstanding.  The Indenture also contains provisions permitting the holders of
Notes representing specified percentages of the Security Balances of all Notes,
on behalf of the holders of all the Notes, to waive compliance by the Issuer
with certain provisions of the Indenture and certain past defaults under the
Indenture and their consequences.  Any such consent or waiver by the holder of
this Note shall be conclusive and binding upon such holder and upon all future
holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of transfer
hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof whether or not notation of such
consent or waiver is made upon this Note.  The Indenture also permits the
Indenture Trustee to amend or waive certain terms and conditions set forth in
the Indenture without the consent of holders of the Notes issued thereunder.

                 The term "Issuer" as used in this Note includes any successor
to the Issuer under the Indenture.





                                    A-1-6
<PAGE>   82

                 The Issuer is permitted by the Indenture, under certain
circumstances, to merge or consolidate, subject to the rights of the Indenture
Trustee and the holders of Notes under the Indenture.

                 The Notes are issuable only in registered form in
denominations as provided in the Indenture, subject to certain limitations
therein set forth.

                 This Note and the Indenture shall be construed in accordance
with the laws of the State of New York, without reference to its conflict of
law provisions, and the obligations, rights and remedies of the parties
hereunder and thereunder shall be determined in accordance with such laws.

                 No reference herein to the Indenture and no provision of this
Note or of the Indenture shall alter or impair the obligation of the Issuer,
which is absolute and unconditional, to pay the principal of and interest on
this Note at the times, place and rate, and in the coin or currency herein
prescribed.

                 Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, except as
expressly provided in the Basic Documents, none of Chase Manhattan Bank
Delaware in its individual capacity, The Bank of New York in its individual
capacity, any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, or any of their
respective partners, beneficiaries, agents, officers, directors, employees or
successors or assigns shall be personally liable for, nor shall recourse be had
to any of them for, the payment of principal of or interest on this Note or
performance of, or omission to perform, any of the covenants, obligations or
indemnifications contained in the Indenture.  The holder of this Note by its
acceptance hereof agrees that, except as expressly provided in the Basic
Documents, in the case of an Event of Default under the Indenture, the holder
shall have no claim against any of the foregoing for any deficiency, loss or
claim therefrom; provided, however, that nothing contained herein shall be
taken to prevent recourse to, and enforcement against, the assets of the Issuer
for any and all liabilities, obligations and undertakings contained in the
Indenture or in this Note.





                                    A-1-7
<PAGE>   83

                                              ASSIGNMENT



Social Security or taxpayer I.D. or other identifying number of assignee:
_____________________________________________________


                 FOR VALUE RECEIVED, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and
transfers unto __________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
                         (name and address of assignee)

the within Note and all rights thereunder, and hereby irrevocably constitutes
and appoints _____________________________________________________
____________________, attorney, to transfer said Note on the books kept for
registration thereof, with full power of substitution in the premises.


Dated: ______________      __________________________________________*/
                             Signature Guaranteed:


                           _____________________________*/





________________________

  */     NOTICE:  The signature to this assignment must correspond with the
         name of the registered owner as it appears on the face of the within
         Note in every particular, without alteration, enlargement or any
         change whatever.  Such signature must be guaranteed by an "eligible
         guarantor institution" meeting the requirements of the Note Registrar,
         which requirements include membership or participation in STAMP or
         such other "signature guarantee program" as may be determined by the
         Note Registrar in addition to, or in substitution for, STAMP, all in
         accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.





                                    A-1-8
<PAGE>   84

                                                                     Exhibit A-2



Unless this Note is presented by an authorized representative of The Depository
Trust Company, a New York corporation ("DTC"), to the Issuer or its agent for
registration of transfer, exchange or payment, and any Note issued is
registered in the name of Cede & Co. or in such other name as is requested by
an authorized representative of DTC (and any payment is made to Cede & Co. or
to such other entity as is requested by an authorized representative of DTC),
ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY
PERSON IS WRONGFUL inasmuch as the registered owner hereof, Cede & Co., has an
interest herein.

THE PRINCIPAL OF THIS NOTE IS PAYABLE IN INSTALLMENTS AS SET FORTH HEREIN.
ACCORDINGLY, THE OUTSTANDING PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF THIS NOTE AT ANY TIME MAY BE
LESS THAN THE AMOUNT SHOWN ON THE FACE HEREOF.

THIS CLASS A-2 NOTE IS SUBORDINATED IN RIGHT OF PAYMENT TO THE CLASS A-1 NOTES
AS DESCRIBED IN THE INDENTURE REFERRED TO BELOW.

                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2
           Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Notes, Series 1996-2

Class:  Class A-2
Registered Principal Amount:  $[           ]
Percentage Interest:  [  ]%
Note Rate:  Floating

No.
CUSIP No.

                 Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2, a business trust duly
organized and existing under the laws of the State of Delaware (herein referred
to as the "Issuer"), for value received, hereby promises to pay to Cede & Co.
or registered assigns, the principal sum of [                                ] 
DOLLARS, payable on each Payment Date in an amount equal to the Percentage 
Interest specified above of the aggregate amount, if any, payable from
the Payment Account in respect of principal on the Class A-2 Notes pursuant
Section 3.05 of the Indenture dated as of August 1, 1996 (the "Indenture")
between the Issuer and The Bank of New York, as Indenture Trustee (the
"Indenture Trustee"); provided, however, that the entire unpaid principal
amount of this Note shall be due and payable on the August 2006 Payment Date. 
Capitalized terms used but not defined herein are defined in Article 1 of the
Indenture, which also contains rules as to construction that shall be
applicable herein.

                 The Issuer will pay interest on this Note on each Payment Date
at a rate per annum equal to LIBOR plus _____% on the principal amount of this
Class A-2 Note on the preceding Payment Date (after giving effect to all
payments of principal made on such





                                    A-2-1
<PAGE>   85

preceding Payment Date); provided, however, that in no event shall the Note
Rate with respect to any Interest Period exceed ___% for such Interest Period.
LIBOR for each applicable Interest Period will be determined on the second
LIBOR Business Day prior to the first day of such Interest Period or in the
case of the first Interest Period, two days prior to the Closing Date as set
forth in the Indenture.  All determinations of LIBOR by the Indenture Trustee
shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive for all purposes, and
each holder of this Class A-2 Note, by accepting this Class A-2 Note, agrees to
be bound by such determination.  Interest on this Class A-2 Note will accrue
for each Payment Date from the most recent Payment Date on which interest has
been paid (in the case of the first Payment Date, from the Closing Date) to but
excluding such Payment Date.  Interest will be computed on the basis of the
actual number of days in each Interest Period and a year assumed to consist of
360 days.  Principal of and interest on this Class A-2 Note shall be paid in
the manner specified on the reverse hereof.

                 Principal of and interest on this Note are payable in such
coin or currency of the United States of America as at the time of payment is
legal tender for payment of public and private debts.  All payments made by the
Issuer with respect to this Note shall be applied first to interest due and
payable on this Note as provided above and then to the unpaid principal of this
Note.

                 Reference is made to the further provisions of this Note set
forth on the reverse hereof, which shall have the same effect as though fully
set forth on the face of this Note.

                 Unless the certificate of authentication hereon has been
executed by the Indenture Trustee whose name appears below by manual signature,
this Note shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture referred to
on the reverse hereof, or be valid or obligatory for any purpose.





                                    A-2-2
<PAGE>   86

                 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Owner Trustee, on behalf of the Issuer
and not in its individual capacity, has caused this Note to be duly executed.


                                        HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2

                                        By       CHASE MANHATTAN BANK DELAWARE,
                                                 not in its individual
                                                 capacity but solely as Owner
                                                 Trustee





                                        By 
                                           -------------------------------------
                                                    Authorized Signatory



                         Certificate of Authentication

This is one of the Class A-2 Notes referred to in the within mentioned
Indenture.


                                        THE BANK OF NEW YORK,
                                         not in its individual capacity but
                                         solely as Indenture Trustee


Dated:                     , 1996
      ---------------------


                                        By
                                           -------------------------------------
                                                  Authorized Signatory
<PAGE>   87

                               [REVERSE OF NOTE]


                 This Class A-2 Note is one of a duly authorized issue of Class
A-2 Notes of the Issuer, designated as its Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed
Notes, Series 1996-2 (herein called the "Class A-2 Notes"), all issued under
the Indenture, to which Indenture and all indentures supplemental thereto
reference is hereby made for a statement of the respective rights and
obligations thereunder of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the holders of
the Notes.  The Notes are subject to all terms of the Indenture.

                 The Class A-2 Notes and the Class A-1 Notes, the Class A-3
Notes and the Class B Notes, also issued under the Indenture (collectively, the
"Notes") are and will be secured by the collateral pledged as security therefor
as provided in the Indenture.

                 Principal of and interest on this Class A-2 Note will be
payable on each Payment Date, commencing on September 16, 1996, as described in
the Indenture.  "Payment Date" means the fifteenth day of each month, or, if
any such day is not a Business Day, then the next Business Day.

                 The entire unpaid principal amount of this Class A-2 Note
shall be due and payable in full on the Payment Date in August 2006 pursuant to
the Indenture.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, if an Event of Default shall
have occurred and be continuing, then the Indenture Trustee or the holders of
Notes representing not less than a majority of the Security Balances of all the
Notes may declare the Notes to be immediately due and payable in the manner
provided in Section 5.01 of the Indenture.  On each Payment Date, principal
payments on the Class A-2 Notes shall be payable in the amounts as provided in
Section 3.05 of the Indenture.

                 Payments of interest on this Class A-2 Note due and payable on
each Payment Date, together with the installment of principal, if any, to the
extent not in full payment of this Note, shall be made by check mailed to the
Person whose name appears as the Registered Holder of this Note on the Note
Register as of the close of business on each Record Date, except that with
respect to Notes registered on the Record Date in the name of the nominee of
the Depository Agency (initially, such nominee to be Cede & Co.), payments will
be made by wire transfer in immediately available funds to the account
designated by such nominee.  Such checks shall be mailed to the Person entitled
thereto at the address of such Person as it appears on the Note Register as of
the applicable Record Date without requiring that this Note be submitted for
notation of payment.  Any reduction in the principal amount of this Note
effected by any payments made on any Payment Date shall be binding upon all
future holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of
transfer hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof, whether or not noted
hereon.  If funds are expected to be available, as provided in the Indenture,
for payment in full





                                    A-2-4
<PAGE>   88

of the then remaining unpaid principal amount of this Note on a Payment Date,
then the Indenture Trustee, in the name of and on behalf of the Issuer, will
notify the Person who was the Registered Holder hereof as of the Record Date
preceding such Payment Date by notice mailed or transmitted by facsimile prior
to such Payment Date, and the amount then due and payable shall be payable only
upon presentation and surrender of this Note at the address specified in such
notice of final payment.

                 As provided in the Indenture and subject to certain
limitations set forth therein, the transfer of this Note may be registered on
the Note Register upon surrender of this Note for registration of transfer at
the Corporate Trust Office, duly endorsed by, or accompanied by a written
instrument of transfer in form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee duly
executed by, the holder hereof or such holder's attorney duly authorized in
writing, with such signature guaranteed by an "eligible guarantor institution"
meeting the requirements of the Note Registrar, which requirements include
membership or participation in the Securities Transfer Agent's Medallion
Program ("STAMP") or such other "signature guarantee program" as may be
determined by the Note Registrar in addition to, or in substitution for, STAMP,
all in accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and
thereupon one or more new Notes in authorized denominations and in the same
aggregate principal amount will be issued to the designated transferee or
transferees.  No service charge will be charged for any registration of
transfer or exchange of this Note, but the Note Registrar shall require payment
of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or governmental charge that may be imposed
in connection with any registration of transfer or exchange of this Note.

                 Each holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note, by acceptance of a
Note or, in the case of a Beneficial Owner of a Note, a beneficial interest in
a Note, covenants and agrees that no recourse may be taken, directly or
indirectly, with respect to the obligations of the Issuer, the Owner Trustee,
the Administrator, the Seller, the Servicer or the Indenture Trustee on the
Notes or under the Indenture or any certificate or other writing delivered in
connection therewith, against (i) the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in
its individual capacity, (ii) any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer
or (iii) any partner, owner, beneficiary, agent, officer, director or employee
of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, any
holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, the Owner Trustee, the
Administrator or the Indenture Trustee or of any successor or assign of the
Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, except as
any such Person may have expressly agreed (it being understood that the
Indenture Trustee and the Owner Trustee have no such obligations in their
individual capacity) and except that any such partner, owner or beneficiary
shall be fully liable, to the extent provided by applicable law, for any unpaid
consideration for stock, unpaid capital contribution or failure to pay any
installment or call owing to such entity.





                                    A-2-5
<PAGE>   89


                  Each holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note, by acceptance of a
Note or, in the case of a Beneficial Owner of a Note, a beneficial interest in
a Note, covenants and agrees by accepting the benefits of the Indenture that
such holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note will not at any time institute
against the Seller, the Administrator, the Servicer or the Issuer, or join in
any institution against the Seller, the Administrator, the Servicer or the
Issuer of, any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or
liquidation proceedings under any United States federal or state bankruptcy or
similar law in connection with any obligations relating to the Notes, the
Indenture or the Basic Documents.

                 The Issuer has entered into the Indenture and this Note is
issued with the intention that, for federal, state and local income, single
business and franchise tax purposes, the Notes will qualify as indebtedness of
the Issuer.  Each holder of a Note, by acceptance of a Note (and each
Beneficial Owner of a Note by acceptance of a beneficial interest in a Note),
agrees to treat the Notes for federal, state and local income, single business
and franchise tax purposes as indebtedness of the Issuer.

                 Prior to the due presentment for registration of transfer of
this Note, the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and any agent of the Issuer or the
Indenture Trustee may treat the Person in whose name this Note (as of the day
of determination or as of such other date as may be specified in the Indenture)
is registered as the owner hereof for all purposes, whether or not this Note be
overdue, and none of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee or any such agent shall
be affected by notice to the contrary.

                 The Indenture permits, with certain exceptions as therein
provided, the amendment thereof and the modification of the rights and
obligations of the Issuer and the rights of the holders of the Notes under the
Indenture at any time by the Issuer with the consent of the holders of Notes
representing a majority of the Security Balances of all Notes at the time
Outstanding.  The Indenture also contains provisions permitting the holders of
Notes representing specified percentages of the Security Balances of all Notes,
on behalf of the holders of all the Notes, to waive compliance by the Issuer
with certain provisions of the Indenture and certain past defaults under the
Indenture and their consequences.  Any such consent or waiver by the holder of
this Note shall be conclusive and binding upon such holder and upon all future
holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of transfer
hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof whether or not notation of such
consent or waiver is made upon this Note.  The Indenture also permits the
Indenture Trustee to amend or waive certain terms and conditions set forth in
the Indenture without the consent of holders of the Notes issued thereunder.

                 The term "Issuer" as used in this Note includes any successor
to the Issuer under the Indenture.





                                    A-2-6
<PAGE>   90

                 The Issuer is permitted by the Indenture, under certain
circumstances, to merge or consolidate, subject to the rights of the Indenture
Trustee and the holders of Notes under the Indenture.

                 The Notes are issuable only in registered form in
denominations as provided in the Indenture, subject to certain limitations
therein set forth.

                 This Note and the Indenture shall be construed in accordance
with the laws of the State of New York, without reference to its conflict of
law provisions, and the obligations, rights and remedies of the parties
hereunder and thereunder shall be determined in accordance with such laws.

                 No reference herein to the Indenture and no provision of this
Note or of the Indenture shall alter or impair the obligation of the Issuer,
which is absolute and unconditional, to pay the principal of and interest on
this Note at the times, place and rate, and in the coin or currency herein
prescribed.

                 Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, except as
expressly provided in the Basic Documents, none of Chase Manhattan Bank
Delaware in its individual capacity, The Bank of New York in its individual
capacity, any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, or any of their
respective partners, beneficiaries, agents, officers, directors, employees or
successors or assigns shall be personally liable for, nor shall recourse be had
to any of them for, the payment of principal of or interest on this Note or
performance of, or omission to perform, any of the covenants, obligations or
indemnifications contained in the Indenture.  The holder of this Note by its
acceptance hereof agrees that, except as expressly provided in the Basic
Documents, in the case of an Event of Default under the Indenture, the holder
shall have no claim against any of the foregoing for any deficiency, loss or
claim therefrom; provided, however, that nothing contained herein shall be
taken to prevent recourse to, and enforcement against, the assets of the Issuer
for any and all liabilities, obligations and undertakings contained in the
Indenture or in this Note.





                                    A-2-7
<PAGE>   91

                                              ASSIGNMENT



Social Security or taxpayer I.D. or other identifying number of assignee:
_________________________________________________________________


                 FOR VALUE RECEIVED, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and
transfers unto __________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
                         (name and address of assignee)

the within Note and all rights thereunder, and hereby irrevocably constitutes
and appoints ____________________________________________________
____________________, attorney, to transfer said Note on the books kept for
registration thereof, with full power of substitution in the premises.


Dated: ______________     ___________________________________________*/
                             Signature Guaranteed:


                          ______________________________*/
                          




________________________

  */     NOTICE:  The signature to this assignment must correspond with the
         name of the registered owner as it appears on the face of the within
         Note in every particular, without alteration, enlargement or any
         change whatever.  Such signature must be guaranteed by an "eligible
         guarantor institution" meeting the requirements of the Note Registrar,
         which requirements include membership or participation in STAMP or
         such other "signature guarantee program" as may be determined by the
         Note Registrar in addition to, or in substitution for, STAMP, all in
         accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.





                                    A-2-8
<PAGE>   92

                                                                     Exhibit A-3



Unless this Note is presented by an authorized representative of The Depository
Trust Company, a New York corporation ("DTC"), to the Issuer or its agent for
registration of transfer, exchange or payment, and any Note issued is
registered in the name of Cede & Co. or in such other name as is requested by
an authorized representative of DTC (and any payment is made to Cede & Co. or
to such other entity as is requested by an authorized representative of DTC),
ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY
PERSON IS WRONGFUL inasmuch as the registered owner hereof, Cede & Co., has an
interest herein.

THE PRINCIPAL OF THIS NOTE IS PAYABLE IN INSTALLMENTS AS SET FORTH HEREIN.
ACCORDINGLY, THE OUTSTANDING PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF THIS NOTE AT ANY TIME MAY BE
LESS THAN THE AMOUNT SHOWN ON THE FACE HEREOF.

THIS CLASS A-3 NOTE IS SUBORDINATED IN RIGHT OF PAYMENT TO THE CLASS A-1 AND
CLASS A-2 NOTES AS DESCRIBED IN THE INDENTURE REFERRED TO BELOW.

                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2
           Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Notes, Series 1996-2

Class:  Class A-3
Registered Principal Amount:  $[           ]
Percentage Interest:  [  ]%
Note Rate:  Floating

No.
CUSIP No.

                 Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2, a business trust duly
organized and existing under the laws of the State of Delaware (herein referred
to as the "Issuer"), for value received, hereby promises to pay to Cede & Co.
or registered assigns, the principal sum of [                              ] 
DOLLARS, payable on each Payment Date in an amount equal to the
Percentage Interest specified above of the aggregate amount, if any, payable
from the Payment Account in respect of principal on the Class A-3 Notes
pursuant Section 3.05 of the Indenture dated as of August 1, 1996 (the
"Indenture") between the Issuer and The Bank of New York, as Indenture Trustee
(the "Indenture Trustee"); provided, however, that the entire unpaid principal
amount of this Note shall be due and payable on the August 2006 Payment Date. 
Capitalized terms used but not defined herein are defined in Article 1 of the
Indenture, which also contains rules as to construction that shall be
applicable herein.

                 The Issuer will pay interest on this Note on each Payment Date
at a rate per annum equal to LIBOR plus _____% on the principal amount of this
Class A-3 Note on the preceding Payment





                                    A-3-1
<PAGE>   93

Date (after giving effect to all payments of principal made on such preceding
Payment Date); provided, however, that in no event shall the Note Rate with
respect to any Interest Period exceed ___% for such Interest Period.  LIBOR for
each applicable Interest Period will be determined on the second LIBOR Business
Day prior to the first day of such Interest Period or in the case of the first
Interest Period, two days prior to the Closing Date as set forth in the
Indenture.  All determinations of LIBOR by the Indenture Trustee shall, in the
absence of manifest error, be conclusive for all purposes, and each holder of
this Class A-3 Note, by accepting this Class A-3 Note, agrees to be bound by
such determination.  Interest on this Class A-3 Note will accrue for each
Payment Date from the most recent Payment Date on which interest has been paid
(in the case of the first Payment Date, from the Closing Date) to but excluding
such Payment Date.  Interest will be computed on the basis of the actual number
of days in each Interest Period and a year assumed to consist of 360 days.
Principal of and interest on this Class A-3 Note shall be paid in the manner
specified on the reverse hereof.

                 Principal of and interest on this Note are payable in such
coin or currency of the United States of America as at the time of payment is
legal tender for payment of public and private debts.  All payments made by the
Issuer with respect to this Note shall be applied first to interest due and
payable on this Note as provided above and then to the unpaid principal of this
Note.

                 Reference is made to the further provisions of this Note set
forth on the reverse hereof, which shall have the same effect as though fully
set forth on the face of this Note.

                 Unless the certificate of authentication hereon has been
executed by the Indenture Trustee whose name appears below by manual signature,
this Note shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture referred to
on the reverse hereof, or be valid or obligatory for any purpose.





                                    A-3-2
<PAGE>   94

                 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Owner Trustee, on behalf of the Issuer
and not in its individual capacity, has caused this Note to be duly executed.


                                        HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2

                                        By       CHASE MANHATTAN BANK DELAWARE,
                                                  not in its individual
                                                  capacity but solely as Owner
                                                  Trustee





                                        By 
                                           -------------------------------------
                                                   Authorized Signatory



                         Certificate of Authentication

This is one of the Class A-3 Notes referred to in the within mentioned
Indenture.


                                        THE BANK OF NEW YORK,
                                         not in its individual capacity but
                                         solely as Indenture Trustee


Dated:                  , 1996
      ------------ -----


                                        By 
                                           -------------------------------------
                                                  Authorized Signatory
<PAGE>   95

                               [REVERSE OF NOTE]


                 This Class A-3 Note is one of a duly authorized issue of Class
A-3 Notes of the Issuer, designated as its Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed
Notes, Series 1996-2 (herein called the "Class A-3 Notes"), all issued under
the Indenture, to which Indenture and all indentures supplemental thereto
reference is hereby made for a statement of the respective rights and
obligations thereunder of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the holders of
the Notes.  The Notes are subject to all terms of the Indenture.

                 The Class A-3 Notes and the Class A-1 Notes, the Class A-2
Notes and the Class B Notes, also issued under the Indenture (collectively, the
"Notes") are and will be secured by the collateral pledged as security therefor
as provided in the Indenture.

                 Principal of and interest on this Class A-3 Note will be
payable on each Payment Date, commencing on September 16, 1996, as described in
the Indenture.  "Payment Date" means the fifteenth day of each month, or, if
any such day is not a Business Day, then the next Business Day.

                 The entire unpaid principal amount of this Class A-3 Note
shall be due and payable in full on the Payment Date in August 2006 pursuant to
the Indenture.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, if an Event of Default shall
have occurred and be continuing, then the Indenture Trustee or the holders of
Notes representing not less than a majority of the Security Balances of all the
Notes may declare the Notes to be immediately due and payable in the manner
provided in Section 5.01 of the Indenture.  On each Payment Date, principal
payments on the Class A-3 Notes shall be payable in the amounts as provided in
Section 3.05 of the Indenture.

                 Payments of interest on this Class A-3 Note due and payable on
each Payment Date, together with the installment of principal, if any, to the
extent not in full payment of this Note, shall be made by check mailed to the
Person whose name appears as the Registered Holder of this Note on the Note
Register as of the close of business on each Record Date, except that with
respect to Notes registered on the Record Date in the name of the nominee of
the Depository Agency (initially, such nominee to be Cede & Co.), payments will
be made by wire transfer in immediately available funds to the account
designated by such nominee.  Such checks shall be mailed to the Person entitled
thereto at the address of such Person as it appears on the Note Register as of
the applicable Record Date without requiring that this Note be submitted for
notation of payment.  Any reduction in the principal amount of this Note
effected by any payments made on any Payment Date shall be binding upon all
future holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of
transfer hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof, whether or not noted
hereon.  If funds are expected to be available, as provided in the Indenture,
for payment in full





                                    A-3-4
<PAGE>   96

of the then remaining unpaid principal amount of this Note on a Payment Date,
then the Indenture Trustee, in the name of and on behalf of the Issuer, will
notify the Person who was the Registered Holder hereof as of the Record Date
preceding such Payment Date by notice mailed or transmitted by facsimile prior
to such Payment Date, and the amount then due and payable shall be payable only
upon presentation and surrender of this Note at the address specified in such
notice of final payment.

                 As provided in the Indenture and subject to certain
limitations set forth therein, the transfer of this Note may be registered on
the Note Register upon surrender of this Note for registration of transfer at
the Corporate Trust Office, duly endorsed by, or accompanied by a written
instrument of transfer in form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee duly
executed by, the holder hereof or such holder's attorney duly authorized in
writing, with such signature guaranteed by an "eligible guarantor institution"
meeting the requirements of the Note Registrar, which requirements include
membership or participation in the Securities Transfer Agent's Medallion
Program ("STAMP") or such other "signature guarantee program" as may be
determined by the Note Registrar in addition to, or in substitution for, STAMP,
all in accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and
thereupon one or more new Notes in authorized denominations and in the same
aggregate principal amount will be issued to the designated transferee or
transferees.  No service charge will be charged for any registration of
transfer or exchange of this Note, but the Note Registrar shall require payment
of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or governmental charge that may be imposed
in connection with any registration of transfer or exchange of this Note.

                 Each holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note, by acceptance of a
Note or, in the case of a Beneficial Owner of a Note, a beneficial interest in
a Note, covenants and agrees that no recourse may be taken, directly or
indirectly, with respect to the obligations of the Issuer, the Owner Trustee,
the Administrator, the Seller, the Servicer or the Indenture Trustee on the
Notes or under the Indenture or any certificate or other writing delivered in
connection therewith, against (i) the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in
its individual capacity, (ii) any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer
or (iii) any partner, owner, beneficiary, agent, officer, director or employee
of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, any
holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, the Owner Trustee, the
Administrator or the Indenture Trustee or of any successor or assign of the
Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, except as
any such Person may have expressly agreed (it being understood that the
Indenture Trustee and the Owner Trustee have no such obligations in their
individual capacity) and except that any such partner, owner or beneficiary
shall be fully liable, to the extent provided by applicable law, for any unpaid
consideration for stock, unpaid capital contribution or failure to pay any
installment or call owing to such entity.





                                    A-3-5
<PAGE>   97


                  Each holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note, by acceptance of a
Note or, in the case of a Beneficial Owner of a Note, a beneficial interest in
a Note, covenants and agrees by accepting the benefits of the Indenture that
such holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note will not at any time institute
against the Seller, the Administrator, the Servicer or the Issuer, or join in
any institution against the Seller, the Administrator, the Servicer or the
Issuer of, any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or
liquidation proceedings under any United States federal or state bankruptcy or
similar law in connection with any obligations relating to the Notes, the
Indenture or the Basic Documents.

                 The Issuer has entered into the Indenture and this Note is
issued with the intention that, for federal, state and local income, single
business and franchise tax purposes, the Notes will qualify as indebtedness of
the Issuer.  Each holder of a Note, by acceptance of a Note (and each
Beneficial Owner of a Note by acceptance of a beneficial interest in a Note),
agrees to treat the Notes for federal, state and local income, single business
and franchise tax purposes as indebtedness of the Issuer.

                 Prior to the due presentment for registration of transfer of
this Note, the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and any agent of the Issuer or the
Indenture Trustee may treat the Person in whose name this Note (as of the day
of determination or as of such other date as may be specified in the Indenture)
is registered as the owner hereof for all purposes, whether or not this Note be
overdue, and none of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee or any such agent shall
be affected by notice to the contrary.

                 The Indenture permits, with certain exceptions as therein
provided, the amendment thereof and the modification of the rights and
obligations of the Issuer and the rights of the holders of the Notes under the
Indenture at any time by the Issuer with the consent of the holders of Notes
representing a majority of the Security Balances of all Notes at the time
Outstanding.  The Indenture also contains provisions permitting the holders of
Notes representing specified percentages of the Security Balances of all Notes,
on behalf of the holders of all the Notes, to waive compliance by the Issuer
with certain provisions of the Indenture and certain past defaults under the
Indenture and their consequences.  Any such consent or waiver by the holder of
this Note shall be conclusive and binding upon such holder and upon all future
holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of transfer
hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof whether or not notation of such
consent or waiver is made upon this Note.  The Indenture also permits the
Indenture Trustee to amend or waive certain terms and conditions set forth in
the Indenture without the consent of holders of the Notes issued thereunder.

                 The term "Issuer" as used in this Note includes any successor 
to the Issuer under the Indenture.





                                    A-3-6
<PAGE>   98

                 The Issuer is permitted by the Indenture, under certain
circumstances, to merge or consolidate, subject to the rights of the Indenture
Trustee and the holders of Notes under the Indenture.

                 The Notes are issuable only in registered form in
denominations as provided in the Indenture, subject to certain limitations
therein set forth.

                 This Note and the Indenture shall be construed in accordance
with the laws of the State of New York, without reference to its conflict of
law provisions, and the obligations, rights and remedies of the parties
hereunder and thereunder shall be determined in accordance with such laws.

                 No reference herein to the Indenture and no provision of this
Note or of the Indenture shall alter or impair the obligation of the Issuer,
which is absolute and unconditional, to pay the principal of and interest on
this Note at the times, place and rate, and in the coin or currency herein
prescribed.

                 Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, except as
expressly provided in the Basic Documents, none of Chase Manhattan Bank
Delaware in its individual capacity, The Bank of New York in its individual
capacity, any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, or any of their
respective partners, beneficiaries, agents, officers, directors, employees or
successors or assigns shall be personally liable for, nor shall recourse be had
to any of them for, the payment of principal of or interest on this Note or
performance of, or omission to perform, any of the covenants, obligations or
indemnifications contained in the Indenture.  The holder of this Note by its
acceptance hereof agrees that, except as expressly provided in the Basic
Documents, in the case of an Event of Default under the Indenture, the holder
shall have no claim against any of the foregoing for any deficiency, loss or
claim therefrom; provided, however, that nothing contained herein shall be
taken to prevent recourse to, and enforcement against, the assets of the Issuer
for any and all liabilities, obligations and undertakings contained in the
Indenture or in this Note.





                                    A-3-7
<PAGE>   99

                                              ASSIGNMENT



Social Security or taxpayer I.D. or other identifying number of assignee:
_________________________________________________________________


                 FOR VALUE RECEIVED, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and
transfers unto __________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
                         (name and address of assignee)

the within Note and all rights thereunder, and hereby irrevocably constitutes
and appoints ____________________________________________________
____________________, attorney, to transfer said Note on the books kept for
registration thereof, with full power of substitution in the premises.


Dated: ______________      __________________________________________*/
                             Signature Guaranteed:


                           __________________________________________*/





________________________

  */     NOTICE:  The signature to this assignment must correspond with the
         name of the registered owner as it appears on the face of the within
         Note in every particular, without alteration, enlargement or any
         change whatever.  Such signature must be guaranteed by an "eligible
         guarantor institution" meeting the requirements of the Note Registrar,
         which requirements include membership or participation in STAMP or
         such other "signature guarantee program" as may be determined by the
         Note Registrar in addition to, or in substitution for, STAMP, all in
         accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.





                                    A-3-8
<PAGE>   100

                                                                       Exhibit B



Unless this Note is presented by an authorized representative of The Depository
Trust Company, a New York corporation ("DTC"), to the Issuer or its agent for
registration of transfer, exchange or payment, and any Note issued is
registered in the name of Cede & Co. or in such other name as is requested by
an authorized representative of DTC (and any payment is made to Cede & Co. or
to such other entity as is requested by an authorized representative of DTC),
ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY
PERSON IS WRONGFUL inasmuch as the registered owner hereof, Cede & Co., has an
interest herein.

THE PRINCIPAL OF THIS NOTE IS PAYABLE IN INSTALLMENTS AS SET FORTH HEREIN.
ACCORDINGLY, THE OUTSTANDING PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF THIS NOTE AT ANY TIME MAY BE
LESS THAN THE AMOUNT SHOWN ON THE FACE HEREOF.

THIS CLASS B NOTE IS SUBORDINATED IN RIGHT OF PAYMENT TO THE CLASS A-1, CLASS
A-2 AND CLASS A-3 NOTES AS DESCRIBED IN THE INDENTURE REFERRED TO BELOW.

                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2
           Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Notes, Series 1996-2

Class:  Class B
Registered Principal Amount:  $[           ]
Percentage Interest:  [  ]%
Note Rate:  Floating

No.
CUSIP No.

                 Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2, a business trust duly
organized and existing under the laws of the State of Delaware (herein referred
to as the "Issuer"), for value received, hereby promises to pay to Cede & Co.
or registered assigns, the principal sum of [                                ] 
DOLLARS, payable on each Payment Date in an amount equal to the
Percentage Interest specified above of the aggregate amount, if any, payable
from the Payment Account in respect of principal on the Class B Notes pursuant
Section 3.05 of the Indenture dated as of August 1, 1996 (the "Indenture")
between the Issuer and The Bank of New York, as Indenture Trustee (the
"Indenture Trustee"); provided, however, that the entire unpaid principal
amount of this Note shall be due and payable on the August 2006 Payment Date. 
Capitalized terms used but not defined herein are defined in Article 1 of the
Indenture, which also contains rules as to construction that shall be
applicable herein.

                 The Issuer will pay interest on this Note on each Payment Date
at a rate per annum equal to LIBOR plus ___% on the principal amount of this
Class B Note on the preceding Payment Date (after





                                     B-1
<PAGE>   101

giving effect to all payments of principal made on such preceding Payment
Date); provided, however, that in no event shall the Note Rate with respect to
any Interest Period exceed ___% for such Interest Period.  LIBOR for each
applicable Interest Period will be determined on the second LIBOR Business Day
prior to the first day of such Interest Period or in the case of the first
Interest Period, two days prior to the Closing Date as set forth in the
Indenture.  All determinations of LIBOR by the Indenture Trustee shall, in the
absence of manifest error, be conclusive for all purposes, and each holder of
this Class B Note, by accepting this Class B Note, agrees to be bound by such
determination.  Interest on this Class B Note will accrue for each Payment Date
from the most recent Payment Date on which interest has been paid (in the case
of the first Payment Date, from the Closing Date) to but excluding such Payment
Date.  Interest will be computed on the basis of the actual number of days in
each Interest Period and a year assumed to consist of 360 days.  Principal of
and interest on this Class B Note shall be paid in the manner specified on the
reverse hereof.

                 Principal of and interest on this Note are payable in such
coin or currency of the United States of America as at the time of payment is
legal tender for payment of public and private debts.  All payments made by the
Issuer with respect to this Note shall be applied first to interest due and
payable on this Note as provided above and then to the unpaid principal of this
Note.

                 Reference is made to the further provisions of this Note set
forth on the reverse hereof, which shall have the same effect as though fully
set forth on the face of this Note.

                 Unless the certificate of authentication hereon has been
executed by the Indenture Trustee whose name appears below by manual signature,
this Note shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture referred to
on the reverse hereof, or be valid or obligatory for any purpose.





                                     B-2
<PAGE>   102

                 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Owner Trustee, on behalf of the Issuer
and not in its individual capacity, has caused this Note to be duly executed.


                                        HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2

                                        By       CHASE MANHATTAN BANK DELAWARE,
                                                  not in its individual
                                                  capacity but solely as Owner
                                                  Trustee





                                        By 
                                           -------------------------------------
                                                   Authorized Signatory



                         Certificate of Authentication

This is one of the Class B Notes referred to in the within mentioned Indenture.


                                        THE BANK OF NEW YORK,
                                         not in its individual capacity but
                                         solely as Indenture Trustee


Dated:                   , 1996
        ------------- ---


                                        By 
                                           -------------------------------------
                                                   Authorized Signatory
<PAGE>   103

                               [REVERSE OF NOTE]


                 This Class B Note is one of a duly authorized issue of Class B
Notes of the Issuer, designated as its Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed
Notes, Series 1996-2 (herein called the "Class B Notes"), all issued under the
Indenture, to which Indenture and all indentures supplemental thereto reference
is hereby made for a statement of the respective rights and obligations
thereunder of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the holders of the Notes.
The Notes are subject to all terms of the Indenture.

                 The Class B Notes and the Class A-1 Notes, Class A-2 Notes and
Class A-3 Notes, also issued under the Indenture (collectively, the "Notes")
are and will be secured by the collateral pledged as security therefor as
provided in the Indenture.

                 Principal of and interest on this Class B Note will be payable
on each Payment Date, commencing on September 16, 1996, as described in the
Indenture.  "Payment Date" means the fifteenth day of each month, or, if any
such day is not a Business Day, then the next Business Day.

                 The entire unpaid principal amount of this Class B Note shall
be due and payable in full on the Payment Date in August 2006 pursuant to the
Indenture.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, if an Event of Default shall have
occurred and be continuing, then the Indenture Trustee or the holders of Notes
representing not less than a majority of the Security Balances of all the Notes
may declare the Notes to be immediately due and payable in the manner provided
in Section 5.01 of the Indenture.  On each Payment Date, principal payments on
the Class B Notes shall be payable in the amounts as provided in Section 3.05
of the Indenture.

                 Payments of interest on this Class B Note due and payable on
each Payment Date, together with the installment of principal, if any, to the
extent not in full payment of this Note, shall be made by check mailed to the
Person whose name appears as the Registered Holder of this Note on the Note
Register as of the close of business on each Record Date, except that with
respect to Notes registered on the Record Date in the name of the nominee of
the Depository Agency (initially, such nominee to be Cede & Co.), payments will
be made by wire transfer in immediately available funds to the account
designated by such nominee.  Such checks shall be mailed to the Person entitled
thereto at the address of such Person as it appears on the Note Register as of
the applicable Record Date without requiring that this Note be submitted for
notation of payment.  Any reduction in the principal amount of this Note
effected by any payments made on any Payment Date shall be binding upon all
future holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of
transfer hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof, whether or not noted
hereon.  If funds are expected to be available, as provided in the Indenture,
for payment in full





                                     B-4
<PAGE>   104

of the then remaining unpaid principal amount of this Note on a Payment Date,
then the Indenture Trustee, in the name of and on behalf of the Issuer, will
notify the Person who was the Registered Holder hereof as of the Record Date
preceding such Payment Date by notice mailed or transmitted by facsimile prior
to such Payment Date, and the amount then due and payable shall be payable only
upon presentation and surrender of this Note at the address specified in such
notice of final payment.

                 As provided in the Indenture and subject to certain
limitations set forth therein, the transfer of this Note may be registered on
the Note Register upon surrender of this Note for registration of transfer at
the Corporate Trust Office, duly endorsed by, or accompanied by a written
instrument of transfer in form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee duly
executed by, the holder hereof or such holder's attorney duly authorized in
writing, with such signature guaranteed by an "eligible guarantor institution"
meeting the requirements of the Note Registrar, which requirements include
membership or participation in the Securities Transfer Agent's Medallion
Program ("STAMP") or such other "signature guarantee program" as may be
determined by the Note Registrar in addition to, or in substitution for, STAMP,
all in accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and
thereupon one or more new Notes in authorized denominations and in the same
aggregate principal amount will be issued to the designated transferee or
transferees.  No service charge will be charged for any registration of
transfer or exchange of this Note, but the Note Registrar shall require payment
of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or governmental charge that may be imposed
in connection with any registration of transfer or exchange of this Note.

                 Each holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note, by acceptance of a
Note or, in the case of a Beneficial Owner of a Note, a beneficial interest in
a Note, covenants and agrees that no recourse may be taken, directly or
indirectly, with respect to the obligations of the Issuer, the Owner Trustee,
the Administrator, the Seller, the Servicer or the Indenture Trustee on the
Notes or under the Indenture or any certificate or other writing delivered in
connection therewith, against (i) the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in
its individual capacity, (ii) any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer
or (iii) any partner, owner, beneficiary, agent, officer, director or employee
of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, any
holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, the Owner Trustee, the
Administrator or the Indenture Trustee or of any successor or assign of the
Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, except as
any such Person may have expressly agreed (it being understood that the
Indenture Trustee and the Owner Trustee have no such obligations in their
individual capacity) and except that any such partner, owner or beneficiary
shall be fully liable, to the extent provided by applicable law, for any unpaid
consideration for stock, unpaid capital contribution or failure to pay any
installment or call owing to such entity.





                                     B-5
<PAGE>   105


                  Each holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note, by acceptance of a
Note or, in the case of a Beneficial Owner of a Note, a beneficial interest in
a Note, covenants and agrees by accepting the benefits of the Indenture that
such holder or Beneficial Owner of a Note will not at any time institute
against the Seller, the Administrator, the Servicer or the Issuer, or join in
any institution against the Seller, the Administrator, the Servicer or the
Issuer of, any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or
liquidation proceedings under any United States federal or state bankruptcy or
similar law in connection with any obligations relating to the Notes, the
Indenture or the Basic Documents.

                 The Issuer has entered into the Indenture and this Note is
issued with the intention that, for federal, state and local income, single
business and franchise tax purposes, the Notes will qualify as indebtedness of
the Issuer.  Each holder of a Note, by acceptance of a Note (and each
Beneficial Owner of a Note by acceptance of a beneficial interest in a Note),
agrees to treat the Notes for federal, state and local income, single business
and franchise tax purposes as indebtedness of the Issuer.

                 Prior to the due presentment for registration of transfer of
this Note, the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and any agent of the Issuer or the
Indenture Trustee may treat the Person in whose name this Note (as of the day
of determination or as of such other date as may be specified in the Indenture)
is registered as the owner hereof for all purposes, whether or not this Note be
overdue, and none of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee or any such agent shall
be affected by notice to the contrary.

                 The Indenture permits, with certain exceptions as therein
provided, the amendment thereof and the modification of the rights and
obligations of the Issuer and the rights of the holders of the Notes under the
Indenture at any time by the Issuer with the consent of the holders of Notes
representing a majority of the Security Balances of all Notes at the time
Outstanding.  The Indenture also contains provisions permitting the holders of
Notes representing specified percentages of the Security Balances of all Notes,
on behalf of the holders of all the Notes, to waive compliance by the Issuer
with certain provisions of the Indenture and certain past defaults under the
Indenture and their consequences.  Any such consent or waiver by the holder of
this Note shall be conclusive and binding upon such holder and upon all future
holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of transfer
hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof whether or not notation of such
consent or waiver is made upon this Note.  The Indenture also permits the
Indenture Trustee to amend or waive certain terms and conditions set forth in
the Indenture without the consent of holders of the Notes issued thereunder.

                 The term "Issuer" as used in this Note includes any successor 
to the Issuer under the Indenture.





                                     B-6
<PAGE>   106

                 The Issuer is permitted by the Indenture, under certain
circumstances, to merge or consolidate, subject to the rights of the Indenture
Trustee and the holders of Notes under the Indenture.

                 The Notes are issuable only in registered form in
denominations as provided in the Indenture, subject to certain limitations
therein set forth.

                 This Note and the Indenture shall be construed in accordance
with the laws of the State of New York, without reference to its conflict of
law provisions, and the obligations, rights and remedies of the parties
hereunder and thereunder shall be determined in accordance with such laws.

                 No reference herein to the Indenture and no provision of this
Note or of the Indenture shall alter or impair the obligation of the Issuer,
which is absolute and unconditional, to pay the principal of and interest on
this Note at the times, place and rate, and in the coin or currency herein
prescribed.

                 Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, except as
expressly provided in the Basic Documents, none of Chase Manhattan Bank
Delaware, in its individual capacity, The Bank of New York in its individual
capacity, any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, or any of their
respective partners, beneficiaries, agents, officers, directors, employees or
successors or assigns shall be personally liable for, nor shall recourse be had
to any of them for, the payment of principal of or interest on this Note or
performance of, or omission to perform, any of the covenants, obligations or
indemnifications contained in the Indenture.  The holder of this Note by its
acceptance hereof agrees that, except as expressly provided in the Basic
Documents, in the case of an Event of Default under the Indenture, the holder
shall have no claim against any of the foregoing for any deficiency, loss or
claim therefrom; provided, however, that nothing contained herein shall be
taken to prevent recourse to, and enforcement against, the assets of the Issuer
for any and all liabilities, obligations and undertakings contained in the
Indenture or in this Note.





                                     B-7
<PAGE>   107

                                              ASSIGNMENT



Social Security or taxpayer I.D. or other identifying number of assignee:
_________________________________________________________________


                 FOR VALUE RECEIVED, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and
transfers unto __________________________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
                         (name and address of assignee)

the within Note and all rights thereunder, and hereby irrevocably constitutes
and appoints ____________________________________________________
____________________, attorney, to transfer said Note on the books kept for
registration thereof, with full power of substitution in the premises.


Dated: ______________      __________________________________________*/
                             Signature Guaranteed:


                           __________________________________________*/ 





________________________

  */     NOTICE:  The signature to this assignment must correspond with the
         name of the registered owner as it appears on the face of the within
         Note in every particular, without alteration, enlargement or any
         change whatever.  Such signature must be guaranteed by an "eligible
         guarantor institution" meeting the requirements of the Note Registrar,
         which requirements include membership or participation in STAMP or
         such other "signature guarantee program" as may be determined by the
         Note Registrar in addition to, or in substitution for, STAMP, all in
         accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.





                                     B-8
<PAGE>   108

                                                                       EXHIBIT C


                        FORM OF MONTHLY SECURITY REPORT


Date:
To:
From:  [INDENTURE TRUSTEE]

Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Balance:
                                                                       $

Prime - 150:                                                                 %
                                                                             

Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Distribution Amount:                                                   $
                                                                       

Securities Interest Distribution Amount
- - Class A-1                                                            $
- - Class A-2                                                            $
- - Class A-3                                                            $
- - Class B                                                              $
- - Certificates                                                         $
                                                                       

Amounts per $1,000

Accelerated Principal Distribution Amount                              $
                                                                       

Series 1996-2 Principal Distribution Amount                            $
                                                                       

Optimal principal distribution amount                                  $
                                                                        
                                                                        
Class A-1 principal distribution                                       $
                                                                        
                                                                        
Class A-2 principal distribution                                       $
                                                                        
                                                                        
Class A-3 principal distribution                                       $
                                                                        
                                                                        
Class B principal distribution                                         $
                                                                        
                                                                        
Certificate distribution                                               $
                                                                        
                                                                        
OC Distribution:                                                       $
                                                                        
                                                                        
Balance of Class A-1                                                   $
                                                                        
                                                                        
Balance of Class A-2                                                   $
                                                                        
                                                                        
Balance of Class A-3                                                   $
                                                                        
                                                                        
Balance of Class B                                                     $
                                                                        
                                                                        
Balance of Certificates                                                $
                                                                        
                                                                       




                                     C-1
<PAGE>   109


Balance of OC                                                          $

Net Charge-Offs applied to each class

Reversals applied to each class                                        $

Excess to Issuer                                                       $

Subordination available to each class                                  $

Overcollateralization as %
of Participation Interest:                                             $
Invested Amount





                                     C-2


<PAGE>   110

                                                                      Appendix A

                                  DEFINITIONS


         The definitions contained herein are incorporated into and made a part
of the Trust Agreement and Indenture, each as defined below.

         Accelerated Principal Payment Amount:  With respect to any Payment
Date, the lesser of (i) the Excess Interest reduced by the amount of the Net
Charge-Off and (ii) one twelfth of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Invested Amount as of the beginning of the related Interest Period multiplied
by [0.25%].

         Act:  The meaning assigned to such term in Section 10.03 of the
Indenture.

         Adjusted Principal Balance:  With respect to the Class A-1 Notes,
Class A-2 Notes, Class A-3 Notes and Class B Notes, the Class A-1 Adjusted
Principal Balance, Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance, Class A-3 Adjusted
Principal Balance and Class B Adjusted Principal Balance, respectively.

         Adjusted Security Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date,  the sum
of the Class A Adjusted Principal Balance, the Class B Adjusted Principal
Balance and the Certificate Adjusted Security Balance.

         Administration Agreement:  The Administration Agreement dated as of
August 1, 1996 among the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and HFC, as
Administrator, as it may be amended from time to time.

         Administrator:  HFC, as administrator under the Administration
Agreement or any successor Administrator appointed pursuant to the terms of the
Administration Agreement.

         Affiliate:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.

         Aggregate Security Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date, the
aggregate of the Principal Balances of all Securities as of such date.

         Amortization Event:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement.

         Authorized Newspaper:  A newspaper of general circulation in the
Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York, printed in the English language and
customarily published on each Business Day, whether or not published on
Saturdays, Sundays or holidays.





                                  Appendix-1
<PAGE>   111

         Authorized Officer:  With respect to the Issuer, any officer of the
Owner Trustee who is authorized to act for the Owner Trustee in matters
relating to the Issuer and who is identified on the list of Authorized Officers
delivered by the Owner Trustee to the Indenture Trustee on the Closing Date (as
such list may be modified or supplemented from time to time thereafter) and, so
long as the Administration Agreement is in effect, any Responsible Officer of
the Administrator who is authorized to act for the Administrator in matters
relating to the Issuer and to be acted upon by the Administrator pursuant to
the Administration Agreement and who is identified on the list of Authorized
Officers delivered by the Administrator to the Indenture Trustee on the Closing
Date (as such list may be modified or supplemented from time to time
thereafter).

         Available Investor Principal Collections:  The meaning assigned to
such term in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Basic Documents:  The Trust Agreement, the Certificate of Trust, the
Indenture, Receivables Purchase Agreement, the Administration Agreement, the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement, and the other documents and certificates
delivered in connection with any of the above.

         Beneficial Owner:  With respect to any Note, the Person who is the
beneficial owner of such Note as reflected on the books of the Depositary or on
the books of a Person maintaining an account with such Depositary (directly as
a Depositary Participant or indirectly through a Depositary Participant, in
accordance with the rules of such Depositary).

         Book-Entry Notes:  Beneficial interests in the Notes, ownership and
transfers of which shall be made through book entries by the Seller as
described in Section 4.06 of the Indenture.

         Business Day:  Any day other than (i) a Saturday or a Sunday or (ii) a
day on which banking institutions in the State of New York or Illinois are
required or authorized by law to be closed.

         Business Trust Statute:  Chapter 38 of Title 12 of the Delaware Code,
12 Del. Code Section Section  3801 et seq., as the same may be amended from
time to time.

         Certificate Adjusted Security Balance:  With respect to any Payment
Date, the Certificate Balance after giving effect to any distributions thereon
pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(iii) and (vi) of the Indenture on all Payment Dates
including the current Payment Date less all Net Charge-Offs allocated to the
Certificates after giving effect to any such allocation to be made on such
Payment Date.

         Certificate Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date, the Initial
Certificate Balance, reduced by all distributions thereon





                                  Appendix-2
<PAGE>   112

other than distributions in respect of the Certificate Yield, prior to such
Payment Date.

         Certificate of Trust:  The Certificate of Trust filed for the Trust
pursuant to Section 3810(a) of the Business Trust Statute.

         Certificateholder:  The Person in whose name a Certificate is
registered in the Certificate Register except that, any Certificate registered
in the name of the Seller, the Owner Trustee or the Indenture Trustee or any
Affiliate of any of them shall be deemed not to be outstanding and the
registered holder will not be considered a Certificateholder or a holder for
purposes of giving any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice,
consent or waiver under the Indenture or the Trust Agreement provided that, in
determining whether the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee shall be
protected in relying upon any such request, demand, authorization, direction,
notice, consent or waiver, only Certificates that the Indenture Trustee or the
Owner Trustee knows to be so owned shall be so disregarded.  Owners of
Certificates that have been pledged in good faith may be regarded as Holders if
the pledgee establishes to the satisfaction of the Indenture Trustee or the
Owner Trustee, as the case may be, the pledgee's right so to act with respect
to such Certificates and that the pledgee is not the Seller, any other obligor
upon the Certificates or any Affiliate of any of the foregoing Persons.


         Certificate Minimum Adjusted Balance:  $[        ].

         Certificate Minimum Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount, after giving effect to
the distribution made on the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest on such
Payment Date, multiplied by [3.0304%].

         Certificate Paying Agent:  The meaning specified in Section 3.03 of the
Indenture.

         Certificate Rate:  With respect to any Interest Period, the per annum
rate equal to the sum of (i) LIBOR and (ii) []%, but in no event greater than
[]% per annum.

         Certificate Register:  The register maintained by the Certificate
Registrar in which the Certificate Registrar shall provide for the registration
of Certificates and of transfers and exchanges of Certificates.

         Certificate Registrar:  Initially, The Bank of New York, in its
capacity as Certificate Registrar, or any successor to the Indenture Trustee in
such capacity.





                                  Appendix-3
<PAGE>   113

         Certificates:  The Consumer Loan Asset-Backed Certificates, Series
1996-2, each evidencing undivided beneficial interests in the Issuer and
executed by the Owner Trustee in substantially the form set forth in Exhibit A
to the Trust Agreement.

         Certificate Targeted Balance:  An amount equal to (i) the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Invested Amount multiplied by []%, less (ii) the Class A
Adjusted Principal Balance and the Class B Adjusted Principal Balance
immediately prior to such Payment Date and after giving effect to payments of
principal on the Class A Notes and Class B Notes pursuant to Section
3.05(a)(ii)(a) and (b) of the Indenture on such Payment Date.

         Certificate Yield:  The sum of (a) the amount accrued during the
related Interest Period at the Certificate Rate on the sum of (i) the
Certificate Balance immediately prior to such Payment Date and (ii) any
previously accrued and unpaid amount at the Certificate Rate for prior Payment
Dates, and (b) any previously accrued and unpaid amount at the Certificate Rate
for prior Payment Dates.

         Class:  Any of class of the Class A Notes and Class B Notes
issued pursuant to Article II of the Indenture.

         Class A Adjusted Principal Balance:  The sum of the Class A-1 Adjusted
Principal Balance, Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance and Class A-3 Adjusted
Principal Balance.

         Class A Notes:  Any of the Class A-1 Notes, Class A-2 Notes and Class
A-3 Notes issued pursuant to Article II of the Indenture.

         Class A Targeted Principal Balance:  The sum of the Class A-1 Targeted
Principal Balance, Class A-2 Targeted Principal Balance, and Class A-3 Targeted
Principal Balance.

         Class A-1 Adjusted Principal Balance:  With respect to any Payment 
Date, the Principal Balance of the Class A-1 Notes after giving effect to any
distributions thereon pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii), (v) and (vi) of the
Indenture on all Payment Dates including the current Payment Date less any Net
Charge-Off allocated to the Class A-1 Notes after giving effect to any such
allocation to be made on such Payment Date.

         Class A-1 Notes:  The Class A-1 Notes issued pursuant to Article II of
the Indenture.

         Class A-1 Targeted Principal Balance:  The Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Invested Amount multiplied by []%.

         Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance:  With respect to any Payment 
Date, the Principal Balance of the Class A-2 Notes after giving effect to any
distributions thereon pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii), (v) and (vi) of the
Indenture on all Payment Dates





                                  Appendix-4
<PAGE>   114

including the current Payment Date less any Net Charge-Off allocated to the
Class A-2 Notes after giving effect to any such allocation to be made on such
Payment Date.

         Class A-2 Notes:  The Class A-2 Notes issued pursuant to Article II of
the Indenture.

         Class A-2 Targeted Principal Balance:  With respect to any Payment 
Date an amount equal to (i) the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested 
Amount multiplied by []%, less (ii) the Class A-1 Adjusted Principal Balance
immediately prior to such Payment Date and after giving effect to payments of
principal on the Class A-1 Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii)(a) of the
Indenture on such Payment Date.

         Class A-3 Adjusted Principal Balance:  With respect to any Payment 
Date, the Principal Balance of the Class A-3 Notes after giving effect to any
distributions thereon pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii), (v) and (vi) of the
Indenture on all Payment Dates including the current Payment Date less any Net
Charge-Off allocated to the Class A-3 Notes after giving effect to any such
allocation to be made on such Payment Date.

         Class A-3 Notes:  The Class A-3 Notes issued pursuant to Article II of
the Indenture.

         Class A-3 Targeted Principal Balance:  With respect to any Payment 
Date an amount equal to (i) the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested 
Amount multiplied by []%, less (ii) the sum of the Class A-1 Adjusted Principal
Balance and Class A-2 Adjusted Principal Balance immediately prior to such
Payment Date and after giving effect to payments of principal on the Class A-1
Notes and Class A-2 Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii) of the Indenture on
such Payment Date.

         Class B Adjusted Principal Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date,
the Principal Balance of the Class B Notes, after giving effect to any
distributions thereon pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii), (v) and (vi) of the
Indenture on all Payments Dates including the current Payment Date less all Net
Charge-Off allocated to the Class B Notes after giving effect to any such
allocation to be made on such Payment Date.

         Class B Notes:  The Class B Notes issued pursuant to Article II of the
Indenture.

         Class B Targeted Principal Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date
an amount equal to (i) the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount
multiplied by []%, less (ii) the Class A Adjusted Principal Balance immediately
prior to such Payment Date and after giving effect to payments of principal on
the Class A





                                  Appendix-5
<PAGE>   115

Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(ii) of the Indenture on such Payment Date.

         Class Interest Distribution:  With respect to any Payment Date and
Class of Notes, the sum of (a) the amount of interest accrued during the
Interest Period relating to such Payment Date at the related Note Rate for such
Class of Notes on the sum of (i) the Principal Balance of such Class of Notes
immediately prior to such Payment Date and (ii) any previously accrued and
unpaid interest on such Class of Notes for prior Payment Dates, and (b) any
previously accrued and unpaid interest on such Class of Notes for prior Payment
Dates.

         Class Percentage:  With respect to each Class of Notes and Payment
Date, the ratio, expressed as a percentage, of the aggregate Principal Balance
of such Class of Notes to the aggregate Principal Balance of the Notes, in each
case immediately prior to such Payment Date.

         Closing Date:  August [], 1996.

         Code:  The Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the rules and
regulations promulgated thereunder.

         Corporate Trust Office:  With respect to the Indenture Trustee,
Certificate Registrar, Certificate Paying Agent and Paying Agent, the principal
corporate trust office of the Indenture Trustee and Note Registrar at which at
any particular time its corporate trust business shall be principally
administered, which office at the date of the execution of this instrument is
located at 101 Barclay Street, Floor 12 East, New York, New York 10286,
Attention:  Corporate Trust Administration Asset-Backed Unit.  With respect to
the Owner Trustee, the principal corporate trust office of the Owner Trustee at
which at any particular time its corporate trust business shall be
administered, which office at the date of the execution of the Trust Agreement
is located at 1201 Market Street, Wilmington, Delaware 19801, Attention:
Corporate Trustee Administration.

         Default:  Any occurrence which is or with notice or the lapse of time
or both would become an Event of Default.

         Definitive Notes:  The meaning specified in Section 4.06 of the
Indenture.

         Deposit Trust:  The trust created pursuant to the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.

         Deposit Trustee:  Texas Commerce Bank National Association as
successor trustee to The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A. and any successor thereto
under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.





                                  Appendix-6
<PAGE>   116

         Depository or Depository Agency:  The Depository Trust Company or a
successor appointed by the Indenture Trustee with the approval of the Seller.
Any successor to the Depository shall be an organization registered as a
"clearing agency" pursuant to Section 17A of the Exchange Act and the
regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission thereunder.

         Depository Participant:  A Person for whom, from time to time, the
Depository effects book-entry transfers and pledges of securities deposited
with the Depository.

         Designated Certificate:  The meaning specified in Section 3.11 of the
Trust Agreement.

         Determination Date:  With respect to any Payment Date, the 5th
Business Day prior to such Payment Date occurs or if such day is not a Business
Day, the next succeeding Business Day.

         Distribution Date:  The meaning specified in the Supplement.

         Due Period:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.

         Eligible Deposit Account:  The meaning assigned to such term in the 
Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Eligible Investments:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement.

         ERISA:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement.

         Event of Default:  With respect to the Indenture, any one of the
following events (whatever the reason for such Event of Default and whether it
shall be voluntary or involuntary or be effected by operation of law or
pursuant to any judgment, decree or order of any court or any order, rule or
regulation of any administrative or governmental body):

                 (i)  a default in the payment on any related Payment Date of
         any interest accrued on any Note during the related Interest Period,
         and such default shall continue for a period of five days;

                (ii)  a default in the payment of the principal of or any
         installment of the principal of any Note when the same becomes due and
         payable;

               (iii)  default in the observance or performance of any covenant
         or agreement of the Issuer made in the Indenture, or any representation
         or warranty of the Issuer made in the Indenture or in any certificate
         or other writing delivered





                                  Appendix-7
<PAGE>   117

         pursuant thereto or in connection therewith proving to have been
         incorrect in any material respect as of the time when the same shall
         have been made and shall have had a material adverse effect on any
         Noteholders, and such default shall continue or not be cured, or the
         circumstance or condition in respect of which such representation or
         warranty was incorrect shall not have been eliminated or otherwise
         cured, for a period of 30 days after there shall have been given, by
         registered or certified mail, to the Issuer by the Indenture Trustee
         or to the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee by the Holders of at least
         25% in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding, a written
         notice specifying such default or incorrect representation or warranty
         and requiring it to be remedied and stating that such notice is a
         notice of default hereunder;

                (iv)  the filing of a decree or order for relief by a court 
         having jurisdiction in the premises in respect of the Issuer or any
         substantial part of the Indenture Trust Estate in an involuntary case
         under any applicable federal or state bankruptcy, insolvency or other
         similar law now or hereafter in effect, or appointing a receiver,
         liquidator, assignee, custodian, trustee, sequestrator or similar
         official of the Issuer or for any substantial part of the Indenture
         Trust Estate, or ordering the winding-up or liquidation of the
         Issuer's affairs, and such decree or order shall remain unstayed and
         in effect for a period of 60 consecutive days; or

                 (v)  the commencement by the Issuer of a voluntary case under
         any applicable federal or state bankruptcy, insolvency or other
         similar law now or hereafter in effect, or the consent by the Issuer
         to the entry of an order for relief in an involuntary case under any
         such law, or the consent by the Issuer to the appointment or taking
         possession by a receiver, liquidator, assignee, custodian, trustee,
         sequestrator or similar official of the Issuer or for any substantial
         part of the Indenture Trust Estate, or the making by the Issuer of any
         general assignment for the benefit of creditors, or the failure by the
         Issuer generally to pay its debts as such debts become due, or the
         taking of any action by the Issuer in furtherance of any of the
         foregoing.

         Excess Interest:  With respect to any Payment Date the amount if any
by which Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Monthly Interest exceeds the sum
of (a) the amount to be distributed pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(i) of the
Indenture on such Payment Date and (b) Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Charge-Offs for the related Due Period.

         Exchange Act:  The Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and the
rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.





                                  Appendix-8
<PAGE>   118

         Expenses:  The meaning specified in Section 8.02 of the Trust
Agreement.

         FASIT:  Financial Asset Securitization Investment Trust as passed by
Congress in the Small Business Tax Bill, H.R. 3448 in August 1996, and as
enacted and amended from time to time.

         FDIC:  The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation or any successor
thereto.

         Final Scheduled Payment Date:  To the extent not previously paid, the
principal balance of each Class of Notes will be due on the Payment Date in
August 2006.

         Grant:  Mortgage, pledge, bargain, sell, warrant, alienate, remise,
release, convey, assign, transfer, create, and grant a lien upon and a security
interest in and right of set-off against, deposit, set over and confirm
pursuant to the Indenture.  A Grant of the Indenture Collateral or of any other
agreement or instrument shall include all rights, powers and options (but none
of the obligations) of the granting party thereunder, including the immediate
and continuing right to claim for, collect, receive and give receipt for
principal and interest payments in respect of such collateral or other
agreement or instrument and all other moneys payable thereunder, to give and
receive notices and other communications, to make waivers or other agreements,
to exercise all rights and options, to bring proceedings in the name of the
granting party or otherwise, and generally to do and receive anything that the
granting party is or may be entitled to do or receive thereunder or with
respect thereto.

         HFC:  Household Finance Corporation, a subsidiary of Household
International, Inc., incorporated under the laws of Delaware.

         Holdback Amount:  An amount initially equal to the excess of (i) the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Initial Invested Amount over (ii) the
aggregate Initial Principal Balances of the Class A Notes, the Class B Notes,
and the Certificates.  Such amount will be reduced through payments made
pursuant to Section 3.05(a)(iv) and 3.05(a)(vi) of the Indenture and will be
reduced or increased through the allocation of Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest Charge-Offs and Reversals pursuant to Section 3.05(c) of the
Indenture.

         Holder:  Any of the Noteholders or Certificateholders.

         Indemnified Party:  The meaning specified in Section 8.02 of the Trust
Agreement.

         Indenture:  The indenture dated as of August 1, 1996 between the
Issuer, as debtor, and the Indenture Trustee, as Indenture Trustee, as may be
amended from time to time.





                                  Appendix-9
<PAGE>   119


         Indenture Collateral:  The meaning specified in the Granting Clause of
the Indenture.

         Indenture Trustee:  The Bank of New York, and its successors and
assigns or any successor indenture trustee appointed pursuant to the terms of
the Indenture.

         Indenture Trust Estate:  The meaning specified in the Granting Clause
of the Indenture.

         Independent:  When used with respect to any specified Person, the
Person (i) is in fact independent of the Issuer, any other obligor on the
Notes, the Seller, the Seller and any Affiliate of any of the foregoing
Persons, (ii) does not have any direct financial interest or any material
indirect financial interest in the Issuer, any such other obligor, the Seller,
the Seller or any Affiliate of any of the foregoing Persons and (iii) is not
connected with the Issuer, any such other obligor, the Seller, the Seller or
any Affiliate of any of the foregoing Persons as an officer, employee,
promoter, underwriter, trustee, partner, director or person performing similar
functions.

         Independent Certificate:  A certificate or opinion to be delivered to
the Indenture Trustee under the circumstances described in, and otherwise
complying with, the applicable requirements of Section 10.01 of the Indenture,
made by an Independent appraiser or other expert appointed by the Issuer and
approved by the Indenture Trustee in the exercise of reasonable care, and such
opinion or certificate shall state that the signer has read the definition of
"Independent" in this Indenture and that the signer is Independent within the
meaning thereof.

         Initial Certificate Balance:  $[           ].

         Initial Principal Balance:  With respect to the Class A-1 Notes, Class
A-2 Notes, Class A-3 Notes and Class B Notes, $[ ], $[                 ], $[
] and $[                 ], respectively.

         Insolvency Event:  With respect to a specified Person, (a) the filing
of a decree or order for relief by a court having jurisdiction in the premises
in respect of such Person or any substantial part of its property in an
involuntary case under any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency or other similar
law now or hereafter in effect, or appointing a receiver, liquidator, assignee,
custodian, trustee, sequestrator or similar official for such Person or for any
substantial part of its property, or ordering the winding-up or liquidation of
such Person's affairs, and such decree or order shall remain unstayed and in
effect for a period of 60 consecutive days; or (b) the commencement by such
Person of a voluntary case under any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency or other
similar law now or hereafter in effect, or the consent by such





                                 Appendix-10
<PAGE>   120

Person to the entry of an order for relief in an involuntary case under any
such law, or the consent by such Person to the appointment of or taking
possession by a receiver, liquidator, assignee, custodian, trustee,
sequestrator or similar official for such Person or for any substantial part of
its property, or the making by such Person of any general assignment for the
benefit of creditors, or the failure by such Person generally to pay its debts
as such debts become due or the admission by such Person in writing (as to
which the Indenture Trustee shall have notice) of its inability to pay its
debts generally, or the adoption by the Board of Directors or managing member
of such Person of a resolution which authorizes action by such Person in
furtherance of any of the foregoing.

         Interest Period:  With respect to any Payment Date other than the
first Payment Date, the period beginning on the preceding Payment Date and
ending on the day preceding such Payment Date, and in the case of the first
Payment Date, the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending on the day
preceding the first Payment Date.

         Issuer:  The Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2, a Delaware business
trust, or its successor in interest.

         Issuer Request:  A written order or request signed in the name of the
Issuer by any one of its Authorized Officers and delivered to the Indenture
Trustee.

         LIBOR:  For any Interest Period other than the first Interest Period,
the rate for United States dollar deposits for one month which appears on the
Telerate Screen Page 3750 as of 11:00 A.M., London time, on the second LIBOR
Business Day prior to the first day of such Interest Period.  With respect to
the first Interest Period, the rate for United States dollar deposits for one
month which appears on the Telerate Screen Page 3750 as of 11:00 A.M., London
time, two LIBOR Business Days prior to the Closing Date.  If such rate does not
appear on such page (or such other page as may replace that page on that
service, or if such service is no longer offered, such other service for
displaying LIBOR or comparable rates as may be reasonably selected by the
Indenture Trustee after consultation with the Servicer), the rate will be the
Reference Bank Rate.  If no such quotations can be obtained and no Reference
Bank Rate is available, LIBOR will be LIBOR applicable to the preceding Payment
Date.

         LIBOR Business Day:  Any day other than (i) a Saturday or a Sunday or
(ii) a day on which banking institutions in the State of New York or Illinois,
or in the city of London, England are required or authorized by law to be
closed.

         Lien:  Any mortgage, deed of trust, pledge, conveyance, hypothecation,
assignment, participation, deposit arrangement,





                                 Appendix-11
<PAGE>   121

encumbrance, lien (statutory or other), preference, priority right or interest
or other security agreement or preferential  arrangement of any kind or nature
whatsoever, including, without limitation, any conditional sale or other title
retention agreement, any financing lease having substantially the same economic
effect as any of the foregoing and the filing of any financing statement under
the UCC (other than any such financing statement filed for informational
purposes only) or comparable law of any jurisdiction to evidence any of the
foregoing; provided, however, that any assignment pursuant to Section 6.02 of
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement shall not be deemed to constitute a Lien.

         Minimum Adjusted Principal Balance:  With respect to the Class A-2
Notes, Class A-3 Notes and Class B Notes, $[                 ], $[ ] and 
$[                     ], respectively.

         Monthly Security Report:  The report attached as exhibit B to the 
Indenture.

         Monthly Servicer's Certificate:  The Monthly Servicer's Certificate 
attached to the Supplement for Series 1996-2 as Exhibit B.

         Moody's:  Moody's Investors Service, Inc. or its successor in interest.

         Net Charge-Off:  With respect to any Payment Date, the aggregate
amount of Optimum Monthly Principal not distributed on such Payment Date and
all prior Payment Dates less the aggregate amount of Reversals allocated on
such Payment Date and prior Payment Dates.

         Note Depositary Agreement:  The DTC Letter of Representations dated as
of the Closing Date by and among, The Depository Trust Company, the Indenture
Trustee and the Issuer.

         Note Owner:  The Beneficial Owner of a Note.

         Note Rate:  With respect to any Interest Period, a per annum rate
equal to the sum of (a) LIBOR and (b) []% with respect to the Class A-1 Notes,
[]% with respect to the Class A-2 Notes, []% with respect to the Class A-3
Notes, and []% with respect to the Class B Notes but in no event greater than
[]%, []%, []% and []% per annum, respectively.

         Note Register:  The register maintained by the Note Registrar in which
the Note Registrar shall provide for the registration of Notes and of transfers
and exchanges of Notes.

         Note Registrar:  The Indenture Trustee, in its capacity as Note
Registrar.





                                 Appendix-12
<PAGE>   122

         Noteholder:  The Person in whose name a Note is registered in the Note
Register, except that, any Note registered in the name of the Seller, the
Issuer or the Indenture Trustee or any Affiliate of any of them shall be deemed
not to be outstanding and the registered holder will not be considered a
Noteholder or holder for purposes of giving any request, demand, authorization,
direction, notice, consent or waiver under the Indenture or the Trust Agreement
provided that, in determining whether the Indenture Trustee shall be protected
in relying upon any such request, demand, authorization, direction, notice,
consent or waiver, only Notes that the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee
knows to be so owned shall be so disregarded.  Owners of Notes that have been
pledged in good faith may be regarded as Holders if the pledgee establishes to
the satisfaction of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee the pledgee's
right so to act with respect to such Notes and that the pledgee is not the
Issuer, any other obligor upon the Notes or any Affiliate of any of the
foregoing Persons.

         Notes:  Each of the Class A Notes and Class B Notes.

         Officer's Certificate:  With respect to the Servicer, a certificate
signed by the President, Treasurer or Assistant Treasurer, a Vice President or
an Assistant Vice President, of the Servicer and delivered to the Indenture
Trustee.  With respect to the Issuer, a certificate signed by any Authorized
Officer of the Issuer, under the circumstances described in, and otherwise
complying with, the applicable requirements of Section 10.01 of the Indenture,
and delivered to the Indenture Trustee.  Unless otherwise specified, any
reference in the Indenture to an Officer's Certificate shall be to an Officer's
Certificate of any Authorized Officer of the Issuer.

         Opinion of Counsel:  A written opinion of counsel who may be in-house
counsel for the Servicer, Seller or Household International, Inc.  if
acceptable to the Indenture Trustee, and the Rating Agencies or counsel for the
Seller, as the case may be.

         Optimum Monthly Principal:  As to any Payment Date, the sum of
Available Investor Principal Collections, any Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest Charge-Offs during the preceding Due Period and the lesser of Excess
Interest and the Net Charge-Off as of the end of the preceding Payment Date.

         Outstanding:  With respect to the Notes, as of the date of
determination, all Notes theretofore executed, authenticated and delivered
under this Indenture except:

                 (i)  Notes theretofore cancelled by the Note Registrar or
         delivered to the Indenture Trustee for cancellation; and

                (ii)  Notes in exchange for or in lieu of which other Notes have
         been executed, authenticated and delivered pursuant





                                 Appendix-13
<PAGE>   123

         to the Indenture unless proof satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee is
         presented that any such Notes are held by a holder in due course.

         Overcollateralization Amount:  As to any Payment Date, the amount by
which the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount exceeds the
Aggregate Security Balances in each case after giving effect to distributions
on such Payment Date.

         Overcollateralization Minimum Amount:   $[           ].

         Owner Trust Estate:  The corpus of the Issuer created by the Trust 
Agreement.

         Owner Trustee:  Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware and its successors and
assigns or any successor owner trustee appointed pursuant to the terms of the
Trust Agreement.

         Paying Agent:  Any paying agent or co-paying agent appointed pursuant
to Section 3.03 of the Indenture, which initially shall be the Indenture
Trustee.

         Payment Account:  The account established by the Indenture Trustee
pursuant to Section 8.02 of the Indenture.  The Payment Account shall be an
Eligible Deposit Account.

         Payment Date:  The 15th day of each month, or if such day is not a
Business Day, then the next Business Day.

         Percentage Interest:  With respect to any Payment Date and any Note,
the percentage obtained by dividing the Security Balance of such Note prior to
distributions on such Payment Date by the aggregate of the Security Balances of
all Notes of the same Class.  With respect to any Certificate, the percentage
obtained by dividing the denomination specified on such Certificate by the
Initial Principal Balance of the Certificates.

         Person:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.

         Pooling and Servicing Agreement:  The Pooling and Servicing Agreement
dated as of September 1, 1995, as supplemented by the Supplement for Series
1995-1 dated as of September 1, 1995 and the Supplement for Series 1996-2 dated
as of August 1, 1996, by and among the Seller, Servicer and the Deposit
Trustee, as may be amended from time to time.

         Principal Balance:  With respect to any Payment Date and each Note,
the Initial Principal Balance thereof, reduced by all distributions of
principal thereon prior to such Payment Date.




                                 Appendix-14
<PAGE>   124

         Proceeding:  Any suit in equity, action at law or other judicial or
administrative proceeding.

         Rating Agency:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement.

         Receivables:  The meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling and 
Servicing Agreement.

         Receivables Purchase Agreement:  The meaning assigned to such term in
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Record Date:  With respect to the Notes and any Payment Date, the
Business Day next preceding such Payment Date and with respect to the
Certificates and any Payment Date, the last Business Day of the month preceding
the month of such Payment Date.

         Reference Bank Rate:  With respect to any Interest Period, as follows:
the arithmetic mean (rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest one
sixteenth of a percent) of the offered rates for United States dollar deposits
for one month which are offered by the Reference Banks as of 11:00 A.M., London
time, on the second LIBOR Business Day prior to the first day of such Interest
Period to prime banks in the London interbank market for a period of one month
in amounts approximately equal to the Aggregate Security Balance; provided that
at least two such Reference Banks provide such rate.  If fewer than two offered
rates appear, the Reference Bank Rate will be the arithmetic mean of the rates
quoted by one or more major banks in New York City, selected by the Indenture
Trustee after consultation with the Servicer, as of 11:00 a.m., New York City
time, on such date for loans in U.S. Dollars to leading European Banks for a
period of one month in amounts approximately equal to the Aggregate Security
Balance.  If no such quotations can be obtained, the Reference Bank Rate shall
be the Reference Bank Rate applicable to the preceding Interest Period.

         Reference Banks:  Three money center banks as selected by the
Indenture Trustee after consultation with the Servicer.

         Registered Holder:  The Person in whose name a Note is registered in
the Note Register on the applicable Record Date.

         Responsible Officer:  With respect to the Indenture Trustee, any
officer of the Indenture Trustee with direct responsibility for the
administration of the Indenture and also, with respect to a particular matter,
any other officer to whom such matter is referred because of such officer's
knowledge of and familiarity with the particular subject.

         Reversals:  With respect to any Payment Date the sum of (i) the Net
Charge-Off previously allocated, to the extent of Excess Interest for such
Payment Date and (ii) the amounts treated as





                                 Appendix-15
<PAGE>   125

Available Investor Principal Collections pursuant to Section 4.11(a)(iv) of the
Supplement for the related Distribution Date; provided however, in no event
will such Reversals exceed the Net Charge-Off.

         Sale:  The meaning assigned to such term in Section 5.15 of the
Indenture.

         Securities Act:  The Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the rules
and regulations promulgated thereunder.

         Security:  Any of the Certificates or Notes.

         Security Balance:  The Principal Balance of the Notes, or the
Certificate Balance, as the case may be.

         Security Collections:  With respect to any Payment Date the sum of
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Monthly Interest and Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Monthly Principal for such Payment Date.

         Securityholder or Holder:  Any Noteholder or a Certificateholder.

         Seller:  Household Consumer Loan Corporation, a Nevada corporation and
a wholly-owned, special purpose subsidiary of Household Finance Corporation, or
its successor in interest.

         Seller's Trust Amount:  The meaning assigned to such term in the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Series Participation Interest:  The meaning assigned to such term in 
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest:  The Series 1996-2 
Participation Interest issued pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Charge-Offs:  The meaning 
assigned to such term in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount:  The meaning
assigned to such term in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Monthly Interest:  The meaning 
assigned to such term in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

         Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Monthly Principal:  The meaning
assigned to such term in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.





                                 Appendix-16
<PAGE>   126

         Servicer:  HFC and its successors and assigns.

         Servicer Default:  An event specified in Section 10.01 of the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement.

         Single Certificate:  A Certificate in the denomination of $1,000,000.

         Single Note:  A Note in the amount of $100,000.

         Standard & Poor's:  Standard & Poor's Ratings Services, a Division of
the McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., or its successor in interest.

         Successor Designated Certificateholder:  The meaning assigned to such
term in Section 9.02 of the Trust Agreement.

         Telerate Screen Page 3750:  The display designated as page 3750 on the
Telerate Service (or such other page as may replace page 3750 on that service
for the purpose of displaying London interbank offered rates of major banks).

         Treasury Regulations:  Regulations, including proposed or temporary
Regulations, promulgated under the Code.  References herein to specific
provisions of proposed or temporary regulations shall include analogous
provisions of final Treasury Regulations or other successor Treasury
Regulations.

         Trust Agreement:  The Trust Agreement dated as of August 1, 1996
between the Owner Trustee and the Seller, as amended from time to time.

         Trust Indenture Act or TIA:  The Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as 
amended from time to time, as in effect on any relevant date.

         UCC:  The Uniform Commercial Code, as amended from time to time, as in
effect in any specified jurisdiction.





                                 Appendix-17

<PAGE>   1


                                                                       Exhibit 5



August 14, 1996


Household Consumer Loan Corporation
1111 Town Center Drive
Las Vegas, Nevada  89134

Gentlemen:

I am the Vice President-Corporate Law of Household International, Inc., which
is indirectly the owner of all of the issued and outstanding common stock of
Household Consumer Loan Corporation, the originator of the Household Consumer
Loan Deposit Trust I (the "Deposit Trust").  I refer to the combined
Registration Statement, as amended, on Form S-1 (File No. 333-6047) and Form
S-3, (File Nos. 333-6047-01 and 333-6047-02) (the "Registration Statement")
filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") pursuant
to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Act"), pertaining to the Notes
(as herein defined) and the Series 1996-2 Participation (as herein defined).
Terms used herein that are not defined herein shall have the meanings ascribed
thereto in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement (as defined below).

The Registration Statement relates to a financing program which involves the
sale by the Subservicers to Household Consumer Loan Corporation and the
transfer by Household Consumer Loan Corporation (the "Seller") to the Deposit
Trust of revolving consumer credit line receivables (the "Receivables")
originated or acquired by the Subservicers.  The transfer to the Deposit Trust
of the Receivables will be made in exchange for participation interests
representing an undivided interest in the assets of the Deposit Trust,
including the Receivables.  One of these participation interests (the "Series
1996-2 Participation") will, at the direction of the Seller, be conveyed by the
Deposit Trust to the Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2 (the "Issuer"), a
statutory business trust established under
<PAGE>   2

Household Consumer Loan Corporation
August 14, 1996
Page 2




the laws of the State of Delaware pursuant to a Trust Agreement to be dated as
of August 1, 1996 (the "Trust Agreement") between the Seller and The Chase
Manhattan Bank Delaware, as trustee (the "Owner Trustee").  The Trust Agreement
is filed as an Exhibit to the Registration Statement.  The Series 1996-2
Participation will serve as collateral for the Notes to be issued pursuant to
an Indenture to be dated as of August 1, 1996 between the Issuer and The Bank
of New York, as trustee (the "Indenture Trustee").  The Indenture is also filed
as an Exhibit to the Registration Statement.  The Notes will be debt of the
Issuer and will be offered pursuant to the Registration Statement.  The Notes
shall be issued in four classes under the Indenture and shall be the Class A-1,
Class A-2 and Class A-3 Consumer Loan Asset-Backed Notes, Series 1996-2 (the
"Class A Notes") and the Class B Consumer Loan Asset-Backed Notes, Series
1996-2 (the "Class B Notes").  The Deposit Trust was created pursuant to the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 1, 1995, (as it may be
amended from time to time, the "Pooling and Servicing Agreement") among the
Seller, Household Finance Corporation ("HFC"), as Servicer, and The Chase
Manhattan Bank, N.A.  The Texas Commerce Bank National Association has
succeeded The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A., as Deposit Trustee under the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement.  The Pooling and Servicing Agreement is incorporated
by reference as an Exhibit to the Registration Statement.  The Series 1996-2
Participation will be issued pursuant to the Series 1996-2 Supplement to the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement, a form of which is filed as an Exhibit to the
Registration Statement.

I am, or attorneys under my supervision are, familiar with the proceedings to
date with respect to the proposed offering and sale to the public of the Notes
and have examined such records, documents and matters of law and satisfied
myself as to such matters of fact as I have considered relevant for the
purposes of this opinion.

Based on the foregoing, it is my opinion that when:
<PAGE>   3

Household Consumer Loan Corporation
August 14, 1996
Page 3





                 1)       the Registration Statement shall have been declared
         effective by the Commission under the Act,

                 2)       the Indenture, the Trust Agreement, the Pooling and
         Servicing Agreement and the Series 1996-2 Supplement pertaining to the
         Series 1996-2 Participation (the "Series 1996-2 Supplement") each
         shall be duly executed and delivered by the parties thereto,

                 3)       the Series 1996-2 Participation shall have been duly
         issued by the Deposit Trust and authenticated by the Deposit Trustee
         in accordance with the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Series
         1996-2 Supplement, and delivered by the Seller in accordance with the
         Trust Agreement,

                 4)       the Notes shall have been duly issued by the Issuer
         and authenticated by the Indenture Trustee in accordance with the
         Indenture, and delivered by the Seller in accordance with the
         Underwriting Agreement among HFC, the Seller, the Subservicers and the
         Underwriters named therein (the "Underwriting Agreement"), and

                 5)  the Seller shall have received the agreed purchase price
         for the Notes in accordance with the Underwriting Agreement,

the Series 1996-2 Participation will be fully paid and non-assessable, validly
issued and will be entitled to the benefits of the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement and the Series 1996-2 Supplement, and each Class of Notes will be
fully paid and non-assessable, validly issued and outstanding and will be
entitled to the benefits of the Indenture and will be the binding obligations
of the Issuer.

I do not find it necessary for the purposes of this opinion, and accordingly do
not purport to cover herein, the application of the

<PAGE>   4

Household Consumer Loan Corporation
August 14, 1996
Page 4




"Blue Sky" or securities laws of the various states to sales of the Series
1996-2 Participation or the Notes.

I hereby consent to the use of my name and my opinion in the Prospectus filed
pursuant to Rule 430A or 424 of Regulation C of the Act, in connection with the
Registration Statement, including any references to my opinions set forth in
the documents incorporated by reference therein, and to the filing of this
consent as an exhibit to the Registration Statement.  In giving such consent I
do not admit that I am in the category of persons whose consent is required
under Section 7 of the Act or the rules and regulations of the Commission
thereunder.

Very truly yours,




John W. Blenke
Vice President-Corporate Law

PDS:jh

<PAGE>   1





                                                                       EXHIBIT 8




                                August 14, 1996


Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
c/o Household Finance Corporation
2700 Sanders Road
Prospects Heights, IL  60070


     Re:  Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Notes, Series 1996-2,  Class A-1,
          A-2 and A-3 Notes (the "CLASS A NOTES") and Class B Notes (the "CLASS
          B NOTES") (collectively, the "NOTES").

Ladies and Gentlemen:

     We have acted as special counsel to Household Finance Corporation, a
Delaware corporation (the "SERVICER"), Household Consumer Loan Corporation, a
Nevada corporation (the "SELLER"), and Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2, a
Delaware business trust (the "ISSUER") for the purpose of rendering various
opinions on matters related to the Notes and Certificates to be issued by the
Issuer.  The certificates represent undivided beneficial interests in the Issuer
(the "CERTIFICATES").  This opinion (this "OPINION") is delivered in connection
with the preparation and filing of a registration statement on Form S-1
(Registration No. 333-6047) and Form S-3 (Registration No. 333-6047-01 and 333-
6047-02), as amended (the "REGISTRATION STATEMENT") with the Securities and
Exchange Commission under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, relating to
the Notes.

     You have asked for our opinion under the United States Federal income tax
laws and the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended
("ERISA") as to the characterization of the Notes, and whether the Deposit Trust
or the Issuer will be characterized as an association (or publicly-traded
partnership) taxable as a corporation.  Based upon our review of the Reviewed
Documents (defined herein) and certain assumptions and representations of the
parties to this transaction described in this Opinion and for the reasons
hereinafter set forth, it is our opinion (i) that the Notes will be
characterized as indebtedness for Federal income tax purposes, (ii) that neither
the Deposit Trust nor the Issuer will be characterized as an association taxable
as a corporation, or as a publicly-traded partnership taxable as a
<PAGE>   2



Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
August 14, 1996
Page 2



corporation, for Federal income tax purposes, and (iii) that the Notes will be
classified as indebtedness without substantial equity features for purposes of
ERISA.

     This Opinion is for the benefit of and may be relied upon by (a) Merrill
Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and its counsel, Brown & Wood, in
connection with respective transactions contemplated by the Underwriting
Agreement for the sale of the Notes, (b) Moody's Investors Service, Inc.,
Standard & Poor's Ratings Group, Duff & Phelps Credit Rating Co., and Fitch
Investors Service, Inc., in connection with the rating of the Notes, (c) Texas
Commerce Bank National Association, in its respective capacity as Trustee for
the Deposit Trust (the "DEPOSIT TRUSTEE"), (d) The Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware
in its respective capacity as Trustee for the Issuer (the "OWNER TRUSTEE"), and
(e) The Bank of New York as Trustee under the Trust Indenture for the Notes (the
"INDENTURE TRUSTEE" and the "INDENTURE" respectively), (f) our clients named
above, and (g) prospective investors in and purchasers of the Notes.  (The
persons listed in the foregoing sentence are hereinafter referred collectively
as the "RELIANCE PARTIES").  We also consent to the filing of this Opinion as an
exhibit to the Registration Statement.  This Opinion may not be relied upon by,
nor may copies be filed with or delivered to, any other person or used for any
other purpose without our prior written consent.

     Capitalized terms for which meanings are provided in the Indenture, unless
otherwise defined herein, are used herein with such meanings.  The opinions
expressed herein are based solely upon and limited to the United States Federal
income tax laws, and the laws under ERISA.  We do not express any opinion herein
concerning any other law.

DOCUMENTS REVIEWED; INVESTIGATION; ASSUMPTIONS

     In connection with this Opinion, we have examined the Registration
Statement of the Issuer and the exhibits thereto, as such exhibits have been
amended through the date of this letter  (the "REVIEWED DOCUMENTS").  These
include, in particular, the following documents:

     a)  The Trust Agreement (the "TRUST AGREEMENT") between the Seller and the
         Owner Trustee;

     b)  The Indenture;

     c)  The Administration Agreement among the Seller, the Servicer and the
         Owner Trustee;

     d)  The Pooling and Servicing Agreement (the "POOLING AND SERVICING
         AGREEMENT") dated as of September 1, 1995, among the Seller, the
         Servicer and the Deposit Trustee, including exhibits thereto;
<PAGE>   3




Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
August 14, 1996
Page 3



     e) The Series 1996-2 Supplement, pursuant to which a participation interest
        in consumer receivables and participation interests (the "SERIES
        1996-2 PARTICIPATION") will be issued to the Seller for conveyance to
        the Issuer; and

     f) The Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of September 1, 1995,
        between the Seller as purchaser and various subsidiaries of the
        Servicer for the purchase of consumer loan receivables by the Seller.

In our examination of the Reviewed Documents, we have assumed the genuineness
of all documents submitted to us as originals, the conformity to originals of
all documents submitted to us as copies and the authenticity of the originals
from which any such copies were made, none of which assumptions have we
independently confirmed.

     In our examination, we have further assumed, without independent
investigation, the following:

     a) The due execution and delivery of the Reviewed Documents without
        material change by the parties thereto;

     b) The full legal power and authority of the parties thereto to execute,
        deliver and perform their obligations under the Reviewed Documents;

     c) The fulfillment of and material compliance by the parties thereto with
        all the terms and conditions of the Reviewed Documents, the accuracy
        of all representations and warranties contained therein, and the
        binding effect and enforceability of the Reviewed Documents against
        the parties thereto;

     d) That the conduct of the parties to the Reviewed Documents with respect
        to the transactions contemplated thereby complies with any requirement
        of good faith, fair dealing, and conscionability, and that there will
        not be any mutual mistake of fact or misunderstanding, fraud, duress, or
        undue influence that would serve as a basis for non-performance of any
        of the terms and conditions of the Reviewed Documents.

We are also relying upon certain representations of the officers of the
Servicer and the Seller, as referred to herein.
<PAGE>   4




Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
August 14, 1996
Page 4



     This Opinion is expressly subject to there being no material change in the
law after the date of this Opinion, and assumes without further investigation
that all assumptions and facts set forth herein are and remain true and valid.
However, with respect to the assumptions we have made herein, nothing has come
to our attention which conflicts with such assumptions.  This Opinion is given
as of the date hereof, and we expressly disclaim any obligation to update this
Opinion or to give notice to any Reliance Party of any future change in facts or
law that might affect the opinions set forth herein.  Captions used in this
Opinion are for convenience only, and should not be regarded as having any
independent meaning.

     1. CHARACTERIZATION OF THE NOTES.  The question of whether a financial
instrument qualifies as "indebtedness" for Federal income tax purposes is
determined under relevant case law, rather than by any statute or regulations.
The multitude of cases addressing this issue rely on numerous and varying
factors in reaching their conclusions, many of which are subjective in nature,
and no case or ruling addresses the income tax consequences of a transaction on
the precise facts of the issuance of the Notes.  However, we have arrived at our
conclusion that the Notes will be treated as "indebtedness" for Federal income
tax purposes based upon an application of the factors commonly used in this
analysis, as follows:

          (a)   The Form of the Instrument.  The Notes are in the form of debt
                instruments, administered under a collateral trust indenture
                having an independent institutional trustee.  The Notes
                constitute a written unconditional promise to pay on a
                specified date a sum certain in money in return for an
                adequate consideration in money.

          (b)   Fixed Maturity Date.  The Notes have a fixed maturity date of
                approximately 10 years from issuance, within the range of
                commonly found forms of indebtedness.

          (c)   Fixed Interest Rate.  The Notes will bear interest at a stated,
                fixed rate, reset periodically based upon changes in an
                objective index, and the calculation of interest due will not be
                contingent upon the income or profits of the Issuer.

          (d)   Relative Assurance of Repayment.  The Notes will be rated AAA
                for the Class A-1 Notes, AA for the Class A-2 Notes, A for the
                Class A-3 Notes, and BBB for the Class B Notes or their
                equivalent by two or more of the Rating Agencies upon issuance.
                The Notes are secured upon issuance by a first perfected
                security interest in the Series 1996-2 Participation, the
                principal amount of which exceeds the Security Balance of the
                Notes by the amount of the Security Balance of the Certificates
                and the
<PAGE>   5




Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
August 14, 1996
Page 5



               Overcollateralization Amount, and the Pass-Through Rate of which
               exceeds the weighted average interest rate of the Notes.  By the
               terms of the Indenture, principal payments are to be made on the
               Notes in proportion to reductions in the principal balance of the
               Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount, with certain
               additional payments, so that the Notes remain fully secured at
               all times.

          (e)  Remedies to Enforce Payment of Principal and Interest.  Pursuant
               to the Indenture, Noteholders will have the right to exercise
               remedies in the event of a default in the payment of principal
               and interest in a full and timely manner, which remedies are
               typical of the remedies afforded to secured lenders.  We expect
               the Indenture Trustee and the Noteholders would exercise such
               remedies, and there is nothing to indicate they would not.
               Similarly, the Issuer and the Certificateholders should expect
               that if the debt to the Noteholders is not repaid in accordance
               with its terms, such remedies will be exercised against the
               Issuer and its assets.

         (f)   Convertibility.  The Notes are not convertible into Certificates
               of the Issuer or other forms of equity in the Issuer.

         (g)   Participation in Management.  Noteholders will acquire no right
               to participate in management of the Issuer as a result of
               purchasing Notes, absent default.  As stated above, the default
               remedies in the Notes are customary.

                                                
         (h)   Relative Seniority of the Notes.  The Notes will be senior debt 
               of the Issuer (the Notes being subordinated only inter se), and
               are in fact expected to be the only debt of the Issuer other 
               than its obligations to service providers and certain 
               governmental fees and assessments.

         (i)   Intent of the Parties.  By the terms of the Indenture, the
               Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the Noteholders each agree to
               treat the Notes as indebtedness for Federal, state and local
               income and franchise tax purposes.
<PAGE>   6




Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
August 14, 1996
Page 6




         (j)   Commonality of Lenders and Owners.  The Notes will not be paired
               with the Certificates, and are being sold in a separate offering.
               There will be no necessary relationship between the Noteholders
               and the Certificateholders or the Seller.  Because of differences
               in interest indicies and certain accelerated principal payments
               on the Notes, there is not precise matching, as a contractual
               matter, of the payment terms on the Issuer's assets and the terms
               of the Notes.

         (k)   Adequate Capitalization of the Issuer.  The Notes will be senior
               in right of payment to the Certificates and to the payment of 
               the Holdback to the Seller.  The Certificates themselves are 
               expected to be rated at least BBB- or its equivalent by two of 
               the Rating Agencies, and will be offered to investors unrelated
               to the Seller. In light of the fact there will be no third-party
               guaranties or insurance providing credit enhancement for the
               Notes, the credit rating of the Notes and of the Certificates and
               the collateralization provisions for the Notes indicate that the
               Issuer will have sufficient equity to avoid recharacterization of
               the Notes as equity.

         (l)   Ability to Borrow from Third Parties.  The Issuer's activities
               are restricted by the terms of the Trust Agreement, and forbid
               its borrowing other than through issuing the Notes.  The purchase
               of the Notes by third parties pursuant to the offering by the
               Underwriter is indicative of the Notes qualifying as debt.

See  R.A. Hardman, 87-2 USTC Paragraph  9523, 827 F.2d 1409 (9th Cir. 1987)
(applying factors to purchase note between shareholder and corporation); Fin 
Hay Realty Co. v. U.S., 68-2 USTC Paragraph 9438, 398 F.2d 694 (3rd Cir. 1968)
(applying factors to shareholder loans to corporation); Nassau Lens Co. v.  
CIR, 62-2 USTC Paragraph 9723, 308 F.2d 39 (2d Cir. 1962)(discussing relative 
importance of subjective intent and objective standards in related-party
transaction); Willis L. Wright, 63 TCM 1965 (1992)(parties must have good 
faith intent to act as borrower and lender); RACAL Electronics, Inc., 60 TCM 
756 (1990)(applying factors to intercompany loan).  See generally Mertens Law 
of Federal Income Taxation, Section 26.16 (Clark Boardman Callaghan); Plumb, 
"The Federal Income Tax Significance of Corporate Debt: A Critical Analysis and
a Proposal", 26 Tax Law Review 369 (1972).

     The IRS has announced its intent to scrutinize financial instruments
designed as debt for Federal income tax purposes, but as equity for regulatory,
rating agency or financial accounting purposes, to see if their purported debt
status for tax purposes is appropriate.  Such instruments include those having a
variety of equity features, including an unreasonably long maturity or an
<PAGE>   7




Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
August 14, 1996
Page 7



inability to repay the instrument's principal with the Issuer's equity.  Notice
94-47, I.R.B. 1994-19, 9.  The Notes have none of the characteristics described
in the Notice.  It should be noted that under Section 385 of the Internal
Revenue Code (the "CODE"), the Treasury is authorized to prescribe such
regulations as may be necessary or appropriate to determine whether an interest
in a corporation is to be treated for purposes of the Code as stock or
indebtedness, or as part stock and part indebtedness.  Such regulations were
proposed in 1980 and withdrawn in 1983.  While those regulations, as proposed,
did not squarely address the treatment of noncorporate asset-backed securities
such as the Notes, and gave the IRS substantial discretion in their
application, it is our belief the Notes would have qualified as indebtedness
for Federal income tax purposes under the principles of those regulations.
However, there can be no assurance that in the future, the Treasury will not
issue regulations under Code Section 385, or issue other rulings, which call
into question the income tax characterization of the Notes.  If the Notes were
recharacterized as equity, such could have the result of causing the Issuer to
be treated as a "publicly-traded partnership", with the consequences described
below.

     2. CHARACTERIZATION OF THE DEPOSIT TRUST AND THE ISSUER.  In form, the
Deposit Trust is a common-law trust, and the Issuer is organized as a trust
under the Delaware Business Trust Statute.  However, an arrangement for the
conveyance to trustees of legal title to property for the benefit of
beneficiaries will not be classified as trusts for purposes of the Code if they
are more than arrangements simply to protect or conserve the property for the
beneficiaries.  Trusts created by or on behalf of the beneficiaries simply as a
device to carry on a profit-making business which normally would have been
carried on through business organizations classified as corporations or
partnerships will not qualify as trusts under the Code if the organization more
nearly resembles an association or a partnership rather than a trust.  In
particular, an investment trust will not be classified as a trust if there is a
power under the trust agreement to vary the investment of the
certificateholders.  Treas. Regs. Section 301.7701-4(b), (c).  We have been
asked to opine as to whether either the Deposit Trust or the Issuer would be
characterized as an association taxable as a corporation.

          The Pooling and Servicing Agreement provides that the Seller is to
maintain a Seller Participation Interest representing an investment in the
Deposit Trust of at least 1.01% of the Series Participation Interests, which
comprise the remaining ownership interests in the Deposit Trust that are to be
treated as equity for Federal income tax purposes.  It is also provided that the
Seller and any additional Seller under that Agreement is to be liable for the
entire amount of any losses, claims, damages or liabilities arising out of or
based upon the arrangement created by the Agreement, to the extent the assets of
the Deposit Trust remaining after Investor Certificateholders, Series
Participants and Series Enhancers have been paid in full are insufficient to pay
such obligations.  The Seller has represented to us that it will have on the
Closing Date and maintain a net worth, independent of its investment in the
Deposit Trust, at least equal to the lesser of (i) 10% of the excess of the
aggregate Principal Balance of all Receivables and Participation Interests in
the Deposit Trust over the aggregate principal balance
<PAGE>   8




Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
August 14, 1996
Page 8



of any interests in and obligations of the Deposit Trust treated as
indebtedness for federal income tax purposes as of the date of determination
("Deposit Trust Net Equity"), and (ii) the sum of (x) $5 million and (y) 1% of
the excess of Deposit Trust Net Equity over $500 million.  Upon an Insolvency
Event affecting the Seller, the Deposit Trustee is to liquidate the assets of
the Deposit Trust, distribute such proceeds and dissolve the Deposit Trust
unless, within 90 days after such event, a majority in interest of all Series
Participation Interests issued by the Deposit Trust elect to reconstitute the
Deposit Trust and elect a new person to assume the rights and obligations of
the "Designated Certificateholder" meeting the requisite conditions set forth
in an opinion of counsel for maintaining the tax treatment of the Deposit
Trust.  Furthermore, the Series 1996-2 Participation will be conveyed to the
Issuer, and substantially all of the beneficial interests in the Issuer will be
offered for sale to persons unrelated to the Seller.

          The Trust Agreement for the creation of the Issuer provides that the
Seller is to maintain an investment in the Certificates equal to a minimum of
1.01% of the Securities Balance of the remaining Certificates.  Under the Trust
Agreement, the Seller has liability for all the obligations of the Issuer that
are not satisfied from the assets of the Issuer, other than the Notes.  The
Seller has represented to us that it will have on the Closing Date and maintain
a net worth, independent of its investment in the Issuer, at least equal to the
lesser of (i) 10% of the amount by which the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest Invested Amount exceeds the aggregate Security Balance of the Class A
and Class B Notes as of the date of determination ("Issuer Net Equity"), and
(ii) the sum of (x) $5 million and (y) 1% of the excess of Issuer Net Equity
over $500 million.  In addition, upon the bankruptcy or dissolution of the
Seller, the Issuer is to dissolve and liquidate its assets unless, within 90
days after such event, a majority of the remaining Certificateholders elect a
new person to assume the rights and obligations of the Seller under the Trust
Agreement meeting the requisite conditions set forth in an opinion of counsel
for maintaining the tax treatment of the Issuer.1/  We note further that there
is no necessary relationship under the arrangements for the offering of the
Certificates for the sale of such Certificates to persons related to the Seller.



____________________

1/   The representations here  and in the  preceding paragraph are being given
solely to support this tax opinion.  In the event the "check-the-box"
regulations are adopted under Code  Section 7701, (i) the Seller will not be
required to maintain this net worth or be liable for  any debts of the Deposit
Trust  or the Issuer, and (ii) the Deposit  Trust and the Issuer need not
dissolve upon an insolvency event affecting the Seller, for the Deposit Trust
and the Issuer to each avoid being treated as an association taxable as a
corporation.  In such circumstances, the Trust Agreement and the Pooling and
Servicing  Agreement may be amended,  without the consent of Noteholders or
Certificateholders, to eliminate these liability and insolvency provisions.
<PAGE>   9




Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
August 14, 1996
Page 9



          Under these terms and conditions, it is our opinion that neither the
Deposit Trust nor the Issuer will be an association taxable as a corporation,
because it lacks the corporate characteristics of continuity of life and limited
liability.  See Treas. Regs. Section 301.7701- 2(b), (d).

          Opinions of counsel are not binding upon the IRS.  It should be noted
that no ruling is being sought from the IRS as to the characterization of the
Issuer or the Deposit Trust, and neither would meet the conditions prescribed by
the IRS for its issuance of a ruling that it is not an association taxable as a
corporation.  See Rev. Proc. 89-12 (1989-1) C.B. 798, amplified by Rev. Proc.
91-13, 1991-1 C.B.  477, and Rev. Proc. 94-46, 1994-2 C.B. 688.

     3. PUBLICLY-TRADED PARTNERSHIPS.  We have been asked to opine as to whether
the Deposit Trust or the Issuer would be deemed a "publicly-traded partnership"
taxable as a corporation under Code Section 7704.  It is our opinion, based upon
the assumptions and caveats set forth herein, that neither the Deposit Trust nor
the Issuer will be a publicly-traded partnership taxable as a corporation for
such purposes.  In this respect, we note that in 1988, the IRS issued guidelines
for determining when it would refrain from characterizing a partnership as being
"publicly-traded".  These guidelines, set forth in Notice 88-75, are
incorporated within the restrictions on the transfer of interests in the Deposit
Trust and on the transfer of Certificates in the Trust Agreement, as well as in
the Placement Agreement for the offering and remarketing of the Certificates.

          Notice 88-75 merely provides a "safe harbor", compliance with which
assures a partnership that it will not be challenged by the IRS as being
"publicly-traded".  Noncompliance with such guidelines does not mean that the
partnership will be successfully characterized as publicly-traded, only that
the IRS need not refrain from challenging its status as such.  Near the end of
1995, the Treasury promulgated regulations under Section 7704 which supersede
Notice 88-75 with respect to the Issuer immediately, and with respect to the
Deposit Trust after 2005.  Both the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the
Trust Agreement include restrictions on transferability of interests and
Certificates, respectively, that meet the applicable guidelines and regulations.
These agreements further empower the Seller to impose such additional
restrictions as may be required by subsequent changes in law, judicial rulings
or administrative pronouncements, to avoid having the Deposit Trust and the
Issuer treated as a publicly-traded partnership.

          The Issuer's ability to avoid being characterized as a publicly-traded
partnership depends upon the Notes being characterized as indebtedness for
Federal income tax purposes, in that no restrictions are being placed on the
transferability of Notes for this purpose.  If either class of Notes was
characterized as an equity interest in the Issuer, and the Issuer qualified as a
partnership for Federal income tax purposes, then there would be nothing to
prevent the Issuer from being characterized as a publicly-traded partnership.
<PAGE>   10




Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
August 14, 1996
Page 10




          Even if the Deposit Trust or the Issuer were characterized as a
publicly-traded partnership, it could avoid being taxed as a corporation if its
income met certain tests and it was not otherwise considered to have derived
such income "in the conduct of a financial business."  It is possible the
Deposit Trust or the Issuer could meet this test, but no assurance can be given
in this regard, due to a lack of applicable authority interpreting the meaning
of "financial business" for purposes of Code Section 7704.

     4. TAXABLE MORTGAGE POOL RULES.  When asset-backed securities (such as the
Notes) are issued in two or more classes by any entity substantially all of
whose assets consist of direct and indirect interests in debt obligations (such
as the Issuer), the entity will be classified as a "taxable mortgage pool" under
the rules of Code Section 7701(i) if, among other factors, more than 50% of the
debt obligations it holds at the time of issuance of the asset-backed securities
(a "testing date") consist of loans secured by interests in real estate.  A
taxable mortgage pool is taxable as a corporation which may not be included
within a consolidated return.  The Seller has represented that upon the Closing
Date, no more than 45% of the Receivables by aggregate Balance will be secured
by interests in real estate.  Based upon such representation and our review of
the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, it is our opinion that the Issuer is not a
"taxable mortgage pool" as of that "testing date".  We express no opinion
concerning the effect of new issuances of asset-backed securities by the Deposit
Trust or the Issuer.  We note, however, that to avoid having the Issuer or the
Deposit Trust classified as a taxable mortgage pool in the future, the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement prohibits the Seller from acquiring Principal
Receivables secured by liens on real estate if such acquisition would cause such
Principal Receivables to amount to 45% or more of the cost of all Principal
Receivables held by the Deposit Trust, and to obtain an opinion of counsel prior
to the issuance of any new Series Participation Interests or Investor
Certificates that such action will not cause the Deposit Trust, the Issuer, or
any portion of either to be a taxable mortgage pool.

     5. ERISA OPINION.  You have asked our opinion as to the treatment of the
Notes under United States Department of Labor ("Labor") regulations concerning
the definition of what constitutes the assets of an employee benefit plan
subject to ERISA or plans or arrangements subject to Code Section 4975 (a
"PLAN") and the prohibited transaction provisions governing Plans (the "PLAN
ASSETS REGULATION") codified in 29 C.F.R. 2510.3-101.  The Plan Assets
Regulation provides that, if a Plan acquires an "equity interest" in an entity
that is neither a "publicly-offered security" (as defined therein) nor a
security issued by an investment company registered under the Investment Company
Act of 1940, the assets of the entity will be treated as assets of the Plan and
thus as "Plan Assets" unless certain exceptions apply.  Under the Plan Assets
Regulation, the term "equity interest" is defined as any interest in an entity
other than an instrument that is treated as indebtedness under "applicable local
law" and which has no "substantial equity features."  Labor Regs. Section
2510.3-101(b)(1).  Although the Plan Assets Regulation is silent with respect to
the question of what law constitutes "applicable local law" for this purpose,
Labor has stated that these determinations should be made under the state law
<PAGE>   11




Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
August 14, 1996
Page 11




governing interpretation of the instrument in question.  Preamble to the Plan
Assets Regulation, 51 FR 41262 (Nov. 13, 1986), III.B.(1).  We assume for these
purposes that the applicable local law will be the laws of the State of New
York, as provided in the Indenture.  In the preamble to the Plan Assets
Regulation, Labor declined to provide a precise definition to what features are
equity features or the circumstances under which such features would be
considered "substantial", noting that the question of whether a Plan's interest
has substantial equity features is an inherently factual one, but that in
making a determination it would be appropriate to take into account whether the
equity features are such that a Plan's investment would be a practical vehicle
for the indirect provision of investment management services.  Id., at
III.B.(2).  Based upon our review of the Reviewed Documents, the credit ratings
which will be assigned to the Notes, the collateral securing the Notes, our
opinion as to the treatment of the Notes for Federal income tax purposes, and
the plain language of the Plan Assets Regulation, it is our opinion that the
Notes will be classified as indebtedness under the applicable local law without
substantial equity features for ERISA purposes.  Please be aware that this
opinion is not binding upon Labor and if, contrary to this opinion, the Notes
are not deemed to be indebtedness without substantial equity features and no
statutory, regulatory or administrative exemption applies, the Issuer could be
considered to hold Plan Assets by reason of a Plan's investment in the Notes.

     6. PROSPECTUS DISCUSSION.  We have reviewed the discussion in the section
of the Prospectus forming a part of the Registration Statement (the
"Prospectus") entitled "CERTAIN FEDERAL AND STATE INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES", and
it is our opinion that the contents thereof are materially correct as to matters
of law. In rendering this opinion, we have relied upon representations of
officers of Household Finance Corporation as to matters of fact.

     7. CONSENT TO USE OF NAME.   We hereby consent to the use of our name under
the heading "CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF THE RECEIVABLES - Certain Matters Relating
to Insolvency", "CERTAIN FEDERAL AND STATE INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES", "ERISA
CONSIDERATIONS", and "LEGAL MATTERS" in the Prospectus forming a part of the
Registration Statement.

                                        Very truly yours,

                                        KATTEN MUCHIN & ZAVIS


<PAGE>   12





Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
August 14, 1996
Page 12

<PAGE>   1
                                                                    EXHIBIT 10.3


================================================================================



                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORPORATION,
                                    Seller,


                         HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION,
                                   Servicer,


                                      and


                   TEXAS COMMERCE BANK NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
                                Deposit Trustee




                                ________________


                                    [FORM OF
                         SUPPLEMENT FOR SERIES 1996-2]

                        Dated as of ______________, 1996

                                     to the

                        POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT

                         Dated as of September 1, 1995


                                ________________


                    HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN DEPOSIT TRUST I

                                 Series 1996-2




================================================================================
<PAGE>   2

                               TABLE OF CONTENTS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                        Page
                                                                                                        ----
<S>                                                                                                       <C>
SECTION 1.    Designation and Covenant to Exclude                                    
              Participation Interests.  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    1
                                                                                     
SECTION 2.    Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    2
                                                                                     
SECTION 3.    Servicing Compensation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   10
                                                                                     
SECTION 4.    Article IV of Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   11
                                                                                     
SECTION 5.    Distributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   14
                                                                                     
SECTION 6.    Statements to Series Participants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   14
                                                                                     
SECTION 7.    Additional Amortization Events  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   15
                                                                                     
SECTION 8.    Optional Repurchase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   16
                                                                                     
SECTION 9.    Sale of Series 1996-2 Participants' Interest pursuant to               
              Section 2.06 or 10.01 of the Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  17
                                                                                                        
SECTION 10.   Distributions pursuant to Section 8                                                       
              or 9 of this Series Supplement and Section 2.06,                                          
              10.01 or 12.02(c) of the Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  17
                                                                                                        
SECTION 11.   Distribution of Proceeds of Sale,                                                         
              Disposition or Liquidation of the                                                         
              Receivables pursuant to Section 9.02 of the                                               
              Agreement  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18
                                                                                                        
SECTION 12.   Rating Agency Notice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18
                                                                                                        
SECTION 13.   [RESERVED] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
                                                                                                        
SECTION 14.   [RESERVED] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
                                                                                                        
SECTION 15.   Delivery  of the Series 1996-2                                                            
              Participation Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
                                                                                                        
SECTION 16.   Ratification of Agreement  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
                                                                                                        
SECTION 17.   Counterparts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
                                                                                                        
SECTION 18.   Governing Law  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19

</TABLE> 



                                      i
<PAGE>   3

<TABLE>
<S>                                                                                                              <C>
SECTION 19.   Forms of Certificates and Monthly 
              Servicer's Certificate  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   19

SECTION 20.   Transfer Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   19

                                                                    EXHIBITS

Exhibit A-1 Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Exhibit B Monthly Servicing Report
Exhibit C Investment Letter


</TABLE>




                                      ii
<PAGE>   4

   SERIES 1996-2 SUPPLEMENT, dated as of ______________, 1996 (the "Series
Supplement") by and among Household Consumer Loan Corporation, a Nevada
corporation, as seller (the "Seller"), Household Finance Corporation, a
Delaware corporation, as servicer (the "Servicer"), and Texas Commerce Bank
National Association, a national banking association, as successor trustee to
The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A. (together with successors in trust thereunder as
provided in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement referred to below, the "Deposit
Trustee"), under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, by and among the Seller,
the Servicer and the Deposit Trustee dated as of September 1, 1995.

                                    RECITALS

   Section 6.03 of the Agreement provides, among other things, that the Seller
and the Deposit Trustee may at any time and from time to time enter into a
supplement to the Agreement for the purpose of authorizing the issuance by the
Deposit Trustee to the Seller for execution and redelivery to the Deposit
Trustee for authentication one or more Series of Series Participation
Interests.  The Seller has tendered the notice of issuance required by Section
6.03(b)(i) of the Agreement and hereby enters into this Series Supplement with
the Servicer and the Deposit Trustee as required by such Section 6.03 to
provide for the issuance, authentication and delivery of the Series
Participation Interest, Series 1996-2 (the "Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest") and to specify the Principal Terms thereof.

   In the event that any term or provision contained herein shall conflict with
or be inconsistent with any term or provision contained in the Agreement, the
terms and provisions of this Series Supplement shall govern.


SECTION 1.  Designation and Covenant to Exclude Participation Interests.

  Section 1.01 Designation.  The Series 1996-2 Participation Interest shall be
deemed to be a "Series Participation Interest" for all purposes under the
Agreement and this Series Supplement.  Notwithstanding any provision in the
Agreement or in this Series Supplement, the first Distribution Date with
respect to Series 1996-2 shall be the September 13, 1996 Distribution Date.

  Section 1.02   Covenant to Exclude Participation Interests.  Notwithstanding
any provisions to the contrary in the Agreement, for so long as the Series
1996-2 Participation Interest is outstanding, each of the Seller and the
Servicer covenant and agree not to enter into a Participation Interest
Agreement, and




<PAGE>   5

the Trust shall not acquire or hold any interest in a Participation Interest
and the entering into of any such Participation Interest Agreement in violation
of this provision will be deemed to have an "Adverse Effect".

SECTION 2.  Definitions.

   (a)   Whenever used in this Series Supplement and when used in the Agreement
with respect to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest, the following words
and phrases shall have the following meanings, and the definitions of such
terms are applicable to the singular as well as the plural forms of such terms
and to the masculine as well as to the feminine and neuter genders of such
terms.

   "Accelerated Amortization Date" shall mean [        ].

   "Additional Balances" shall mean, with respect to any Credit Line, amounts
drawn under such Credit Line subsequent to the date such Credit Line is
designated to the Deposit Trust.

   "Additional Interest" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.08(a)
hereof.

   "Adverse Effect" shall have the meaning assigned to such term in the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement as supplemented by the Section 1.02 hereof.

   "Agreement" shall mean, for purposes of this Series Supplement, the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 1, 1995 as such agreement may be
amended from time to time, by and among the Seller, the Servicer and the
Deposit Trustee (without regard to this Series Supplement or supplements for
other Series).

   "Amortization Event" shall mean any of the events enumerated in Section 9.01
of the Agreement or in Section 7 of this Series Supplement.

   "Available Investor Principal Collections" shall mean, with respect to any
Distribution Date, the sum of (a) Investor Principal Collections, (b) the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Net Default Payment Amount, and (c) the
portion paid by the Seller pursuant to Section 9 hereof that is included in
clause (i) of the definition of Reassignment Amount.

   "Calculation Date" shall mean the first day of the Interest Period.

   "Closing Date" shall mean August [28], 1996.





                                      2
<PAGE>   6


   "Distribution Date" shall mean, with respect to Series 1996-2, the 14th day
of each calendar month, or if such day is not a Business Day, the next
preceding Business Day, provided that the first Distribution Date shall be
September 13, 1996.

   "Due Period" shall mean, with respect to the first Due Period, the period
from [August 1, 1996 through August 31, 1996], and thereinafter the meaning
specified in the Agreement.

   "Early Amortization Period" shall mean the period commencing with an
Amortization Event pursuant to Section 7 hereof (after giving effect to any
grace periods) and terminating upon termination of the Trust pursuant to
Section 12.01 of the Agreement.

   "Eligible Investments" shall mean with respect to funds allocable to the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest in the Collection Account, "Eligible
Investments" as defined in the Agreement, except that all references in such
definition to "rating satisfactory to the Rating Agency" shall mean ratings of
not less than A-1+ by Standard & Poor's, P-1 by Moody's, F-1 by Fitch (if rated
by Fitch) and [____] by Duff & Phelps (if rated by Duff & Phelps).

   "Eligible Institution" shall mean any "Eligible Institution" as defined in
the Agreement, except that all references in such definition to "rating
satisfactory to the Rating Agency" shall mean long-term ratings of not less
than AAA by Standard and Poor's or Aaa by Moody's, respectively or short-term
unsecured debt ratings of at least A-1+ by Standard and Poor's and P-1 by
Moody's, respectively, except that no such rating shall be required of an
institution which maintains such Account or such funds as a fully segregated
trust account or subaccount with the corporate trust department of such
institution as long as such institution maintains the credit rating of each
Rating Agency in one of its generic credit rating categories which signifies
investment grade.

   "Final Scheduled Payment Date" shall mean the Payment Date on August 15,
2006.

   "Fixed Allocation Percentage" shall mean, with respect to any Distribution
Date, the percentage equivalent of a fraction, the numerator of which is the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount as of the last day
immediately preceding the commencement of an Early Amortization Period that is
continuing or preceding the Accelerated Amortization Date, as applicable and
the denominator of which is the greater of (x) the





                                      3
<PAGE>   7

aggregate Principal Receivables as of the first day of the related Due Period
and the then outstanding amount of any Participation Interests in the Deposit
Trust as of the first day of the related Due Period and (y) the sum of the
numerators used to calculate the Allocation Percentage for allocations with
respect to Principal Receivables or Finance Charge and Administrative
Receivables, as applicable, for all outstanding Series for such Distribution
Date; provided, however, that, with respect to the first Due Period, the Fixed
Allocation Percentage shall mean the percentage equivalent of a fraction, the
numerator of which is the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Initial Invested
Amount and the denominator of which is the total amount of Principal
Receivables in the Deposit Trust as of the Closing Date; provided further that,
with respect to any Due Period in which Aggregate Additional Credit Lines or
Participation Interest are added to the Trust or a removal of Credit Lines
pursuant to Section 2.10 of the Agreement occurs, the amount of Principal
Receivables and Participation Interests referred to in clause (x) above shall
be the average amount of Principal Receivables and Participation Interests in
the Deposit Trust on each Business Day during such Due Period based upon the
assumptions that (1) the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables in the
Deposit Trust at the end of the day on the last day of the prior Due Period is
the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables and Participation Interests in
the Deposit Trust on each Business Day of the period from and including the
first day of such Due Period to but excluding the related Addition Date or
Removal Date and (2) the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables in the
Deposit Trust at the end of the day on the related Addition Date or Removal
Date is the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables and Participation
Interests in the Deposit Trust on each Business Day of the period from and
including the related Addition Date or Removal Date to and including the last
day of such Due Period.

   "Floating Allocation Percentage" shall mean with respect to any Distribution
Date the percentage equivalent of a fraction, the numerator of which is the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount as of the last day of the
related Due Period and the denominator of which is the greater of (x) the
aggregate Principal Receivables as of the first day of the related Due Period
and the then outstanding amount of any Participation Interests in the Deposit
Trust as of the first day of the related Due Period and (y) the sum of the
numerators used to calculate the Allocation Percentage for allocations with
respect to Principal Receivables, Default Amounts, or Finance Charge and
Administrative Receivables, as applicable, for all outstanding Series for such
Distribution Date; provided, however, that, with respect to the first Due
Period, the Floating Allocation Percentage shall mean the percentage equivalent
of a fraction, the numerator of which is the Series 1996-2





                                      4
<PAGE>   8

Participation Interest Initial Invested Amount and the denominator of which is
the total amount of Principal Receivables in the Deposit Trust as of the
Closing Date; provided further that, with respect to any Due Period in which
Aggregate Additional Credit Lines or Participation Interest are added to the
Trust or a removal of Credit Lines pursuant to Section 2.10 of the Agreement
occurs, the amount of Principal Receivables and Participation Interests
referred to in clause (x) above shall be the average amount of Principal
Receivables and Participation Interests in the Deposit Trust on each Business
Day during such Due Period based upon the assumptions that (1) the aggregate
amount of Principal Receivables in the Deposit Trust at the end of the day on
the last day of the prior Due Period is the aggregate amount of Principal
Receivables and Participation Interests in the Deposit Trust on each Business
Day of the period from and including the first day of such Due Period to but
excluding the related Addition Date or Removal Date and (2) the aggregate
amount of Principal Receivables in the Deposit Trust at the end of the day on
the related Addition Date or Removal Date is the aggregate amount of Principal
Receivables and Participation Interests in the Deposit Trust on each Business
Day of the period from and including the related Addition Date or Removal Date
to and including the last day of such Due Period.

   "HCLC" shall mean Household Consumer Loan Corporation, a Nevada corporation.

   "Indenture" shall mean the indenture dated as of August 1, 1996 between the
Issuer, as debtor, and The Bank of New York, as Indenture Trustee, as may be
amended from time to time.

   "Interest Period" shall mean, with respect to any Distribution Date, the
period from and including the Distribution Date immediately preceding such
Distribution Date (or, in the case of the first Distribution Date, from and
including the Closing Date) to but excluding such Distribution Date.

   "Invested Amount" as defined in the Agreement shall mean the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Invested Amount as defined herein.

   "Investor Finance Charge and Administrative Collections" shall mean with
respect to any Distribution Date an amount equal to the sum of (a) (i) if such
Distribution Date is not during an Early Amortization Period, the product of
(x) the Floating Allocation Percentage for the related Due Period and (y)
Finance Charge and Administrative Collections during the related Due Period and
(ii) if such Distribution Date is during an Early Amortization Period the
product of (x) the Fixed Allocation Percentage for the related Due Period and
(y) Finance Charge and





                                      5
<PAGE>   9

Administrative Collections during the related Due Period and (b) the portion
paid by the Seller pursuant to Section 9 hereof that is included in clauses
(ii) and (iii) of the definition of Reassignment Amount.

   "Investor Principal Collections" shall mean, with respect to any Due Period
prior to the Accelerated Amortization Date and not during an Early Amortization
Period, the Floating Allocation Percentage of Net Principal Collections for the
related Due Period (or any partial Due Period which occurs as the first Due
Period during the Early Amortization Period); provided that if Net Principal
Collections for such Due Period is less than the Minimum Principal Amount, then
Investor Principal Collections shall mean the Minimum Principal Amount.  On and
after the Accelerated Amortization Date and during an Early Amortization
Period, Investor Principal Collections shall mean the Fixed Allocation
Percentage of Collections in respect of Principal Receivables for the related
Due Period.

   "Issuer" shall mean the Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2, a Delaware
business trust, or its successor in interest.

   "Minimum Principal Amount" shall mean, with respect to any Distribution
Date, the lesser of (a) the Floating Allocation Percentage of Principal
Collections for such Distribution Date and (b) the amount by which []% of the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount exceeds the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Net Default Payment Amount for such Distribution Date to
the extent of the amount of Investor Finance Charge and Administrative
Collections treated as principal pursuant to Section 4.11(a)(iii) for such
Distribution Date.

   "Net Principal Collections" shall mean, with respect to any Due Period prior
to the Accelerated Amortization Date and not during an Early Amortization
Period, Collections in respect of Principal Receivables during the related Due
Period reduced by Additional Balances created during such Due Period.

   "Optional Repurchase Amount" shall mean, with respect to any Distribution
Date, after giving effect to any deposits and distributions otherwise to be
made on such Distribution Date, the sum of (i) the unpaid principal balance of
the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest, plus (ii) accrued and unpaid interest
on the unpaid principal balance of the Series 1996-2 Series Participation
Interest through the day preceding such Distribution Date, plus (iii) the
amount of Additional Interest, if any, for such Distribution Date and any
Additional Interest previously due but not distributed to Series 1996-2
Participants, as applicable, on a prior Distribution Date.





                                      6
<PAGE>   10

   "Overcollateralization Amount" shall have the meaning set forth in the
Indenture.

   "Performance Amortization Event" shall mean any of an Additional
Amortization Event pursuant to Section 7(a), (b) or (d) hereof.

   "Prime" shall mean the rate set forth in H.15(519) opposite the caption
"Bank Prime Loan" for such day; provided, however, that the Prime Rate with
respect to any day which in the period beginning on the Calculation Date
through and including the calendar day first preceding a Distribution Date,
shall be the rate as described above in effect on such Calculation Date.  The
Prime Rate is also available on Telerate, currently at page 125.  If any
discrepancy arises between Telerate and the printed version of H.15 (519), the
printed version of H.15 (519) will take precedence.

If, by the Calculation Date, the Prime Rate is not yet published in H.15 (519),
then the Prime Rate will be determined by calculating the arithmetic mean of
the rates of interest publicly announced by each bank named on Telerate under
the heading "Prime Rate Top 30 U.S. Banks," currently at page 38, as such
bank's U.S. dollar prime rate or base lending rate as in effect on such day at
3:30 p.m. (New York City time).  If fewer than four such rates appear on
Telerate for such Reset Date, then the Prime Rate shall be the arithmetic mean
of the rate of interest publicly announced by three major banks in New York
City, selected by the Servicer, as their U.S. dollar prime rate or base lending
rate as in effect for such day.

   "Rating Agency" shall mean Duff & Phelps, Fitch, Moody's, and Standard &
Poor's.

   "Reassignment Amount" shall mean, with respect to any Distribution Date,
after giving effect to any deposits and distributions otherwise to be made on
such Distribution Date, the sum of (i) the unpaid principal balance of the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest on such Distribution Date, plus (ii)
amounts accrued and unpaid at the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Pass-Through Rate on the unpaid principal balance of the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest through the day preceding such Distribution Date, plus
(iii) the amount of Additional Interest, if any, for such Distribution Date and
any Additional Interest previously due but not distributed to Series 1996-2
Participants on a prior Distribution Date.

   "Required Seller Amount" shall mean an amount equal to [1.01%] of the Series
1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount.





                                      7
<PAGE>   11


   "Securities" shall have the meaning assigned to such term in the Indenture.

   "Security Balance" shall have the meaning assigned to such term in the
Indenture.

   "Series Cut-Off Date" shall mean the close of business on July 31, 1996.

   "Series 1996-2 Participant" shall mean the Issuer.

   "Series 1996-2 Participants' Interest" shall mean 100% of the interest
evidenced by the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest.

   "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest" shall be a Series Participation
Interest for the purposes of the Agreement and shall mean the Series
Participation Interest executed by the Seller and authenticated by or on behalf
of the Deposit Trustee, substantially in the form of Exhibit A-1.

   "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Charge-Offs" shall have the meaning
specified in Section 4.12(a) hereof.

   "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Default Amount" shall mean, with
respect to each Distribution Date, an amount equal to the product of the
Defaulted Amount for the related Due Period and the Floating Allocation
Percentage for such Distribution Date.

   "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Initial Invested Amount" shall mean
the initial principal amount represented by the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest on the Issuance Date, which is $[        ].

   "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Interest Shortfall" shall have the
meaning specified in Section 4.08(a) hereof.

   "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount" shall mean, when used
with respect to any date, an amount equal to (a) the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Initial Invested Amount, minus (b) the amount of
principal payments made to the Series 1996-2 Series Participant prior to and
including such date minus (c) the excess, if any, of the aggregate amount of
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Charge-Offs over Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Charge-Offs reimbursed pursuant to Section 4.12(a)
hereof prior to and including such date.





                                      8
<PAGE>   12

   "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Monthly Interest" shall mean the
monthly interest distributable in respect of the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest as calculated in accordance with Section 4.08(a) hereof.

   "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Monthly Principal" shall mean the
monthly principal distributable in respect of the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest as calculated in accordance with Section 4.09(a) hereof.

   "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Net Default Payment Amount" shall mean
with respect to any Distribution Date the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Default Amount for such Distribution Date to the extent of the amount of
Investor Finance Charge and Administrative Collections treated as principal
pursuant to Sections 4.11(a)(iii) and (iv) for such Distribution Date.

   "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Pass-Through Rate" shall mean as to
each Interest Period the Prime Rate minus 1.50%; provided that the Series
1996-2 Participation Interest Pass-Through Rate for any Interest Period shall
not be less than the sum of (i) a per annum rate which will result in an amount
of Series 1996-2 Monthly Interest for such Interest Period which will be
sufficient to pay the amount of interest due on the Notes and to make a full
distribution on the Trust Certificates in respect of the Certificate Rate on
the related Payment Date and (ii) 0.25% per annum of the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest Invested Amount.

   "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Pool Factor" shall mean, with respect
to any Record Date, a number carried out to eight decimals representing the
ratio of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount as of such
Record Date (determined after taking into account any increases or decreases in
the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount which will occur on
the following Distribution Date) to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Initial Invested Amount.

   "Series 1996-2 Servicing Fee" shall have the meaning specified in Section 3
hereof.

   "Series 1996-2 Termination Date" shall mean the earlier of the date the
Securities are paid in full and the date the Deposit Trust is terminated
pursuant to Section 12.01 of the Agreement.

   "Servicing Fee Rate" shall mean [2%] per annum.





                                      9
<PAGE>   13

   "Telerate Page 3750" shall mean the display page so designated on the Dow
Jones Telerate Service (or such other page as may replace that page on that
service for the purpose of displaying comparable rates or prices).

   "Termination Proceeds" shall mean any Termination Proceeds arising out of a
sale of Receivables (or interests therein) pursuant to Section 12.02(c) of the
Agreement with respect to Series 1996-2.

   "Trust Agreement" shall mean the trust agreement dated as of August 1, 1996
between HCLC, as Seller and holder of the Designated Certificate, and Chase
Manhattan Bank Delaware, as Owner Trustee.

   "Trust Certificates" shall mean the certificates, issued pursuant to the
Trust Agreement.

   (b)  All capitalized terms used herein and not otherwise defined herein have
  the meanings ascribed to them in the Agreement.

   (c)  The words "hereof", "herein" and "hereunder" and words of similar
  import when used in this Series Supplement shall refer to this Series
  Supplement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Series
  Supplement; references herein to any Article, Section or Exhibit are
  references to Articles, Sections and Exhibits in or to this Series Supplement
  unless otherwise specified; and the term "including" means "including without
  limitation".

   (d)   The following defined terms used herein are used with meaning assigned
  thereto in Trust Agreement or the Indenture, as applicable: "Notes", "Note
  Rate", "Security Balance", "Owner Trustee", "Overcollateralization Amount",
  "Initial Overcollateralization Percentage", "Indenture Trustee".


SECTION 3.  Servicing Compensation.

   The monthly servicing fee (the "Series 1996-2 Servicing Fee") shall be
payable to the Servicer, in arrears, on each Distribution Date in respect of
any Due Period (or portion thereof) occurring prior to the first Distribution
Date on which the Series 1996-2 Series Participation Interest Invested Amount
is zero, in an amount equal to 1/12th of or with respect to the first Due
Period, [17/360th] of the product of (i) the Servicing Fee Rate and (ii) the
Series 1996-2 Invested Amount on the last





                                      10
<PAGE>   14

day of the related Due Period or with respect to the first Due Period, the
Closing Date.


SECTION 4.  Article IV of Agreement.

   Sections 4.01 through 4.06 of the Agreement shall be read in their entirety
as provided in the Agreement.  Article IV of the Agreement (except for Sections
4.01 through 4.06 thereof) shall, with respect to the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest, be read in its entirety as follows:

                                   ARTICLE IV

                    RIGHTS OF SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPANTS AND
                   ALLOCATION AND APPLICATION OF COLLECTIONS

   Section 4.07.  Allocations.

   Collections of Finance Charge and Administrative Receivables, Principal
Receivables and Defaulted Receivables allocated to the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest pursuant to Article IV of the Agreement shall be
allocated and distributed as set forth in this Article.

   Section 4.08.  Determination of Monthly Interest.

   (a)  The amount of collections of Finance Charge and Administrative
Receivables distributable from the Collection Account with respect to the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest on any Distribution Date shall be an
amount equal to the product of (i) the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Pass-Through Rate and (ii) the unpaid principal balance of the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest on the first day of the related Interest Period
determined on the basis of the actual number of days in such Interest Period
and a 360-day year ("Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Monthly Interest").

   On the Determination Date preceding each Distribution Date, the Servicer
shall determine an amount (the "Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Interest
Shortfall") equal to the sum of (a) (x) the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest Monthly Interest for the Interest Period applicable to such
Distribution Date minus (y) the amount of collections of Finance Charge and
Administrative Receivables which will be on deposit in the Collection Account
and allocable to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest on such Distribution
Date and (b) the sum of the amounts calculated pursuant to clause (a) on each
preceding Distribution Date.  If the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Interest Shortfall with respect to any Distribution Date





                                      11
<PAGE>   15

is greater than zero, on each subsequent Distribution Date until such Series
1996-2 Participation Interest Interest Shortfall is fully paid, pursuant to
Section 4.11(a), an additional amount ("Additional Interest") shall be payable
as provided herein with respect to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
Monthly Interest on each Distribution Date following such Distribution Date,
excluding the Distribution Date on which the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest Interest Shortfall is paid to the Series 1996-2 Participants equal to
the product of (i) the Series 1996-2 Series Participation Interest Interest
Pass-Through Rate and (ii) such Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Interest
Shortfall (or the portion thereof which has not been paid to Series 1996-2
Participants) determined on the basis of the actual number of days in the
related Interest Period and a 360-day year.  Notwithstanding anything to the
contrary herein, Additional Interest shall be payable or distributed to Series
1996-2 Participants.

   Section 4.09.  Determination of Monthly Principal.

   (a)  The amount of monthly principal ("Series 1996-2 Series Participation
Interest Monthly Principal") distributable from the Collection Account with
respect to the Series 1996-2 Series Participation Interest shall be an amount
equal to the Available Investor Principal Collections on deposit in the
Collection Account with respect to such Distribution Date.

   Section 4.10.  [RESERVED]

   Section 4.11.  Application of Investor Finance Charge and Administrative
Collections on Deposit in the Collection Account.  With respect to the Series
1996-2 Series Participation Interest, prior to 12:00 noon in New York City on
each Distribution Date the Servicer shall provide written directions to the
Deposit Trustee to apply Investor Finance Charge and Administrative Collections
on deposit in the Collection Account with respect to such Distribution Date in
the following manner:

   (a)  An amount equal to Investor Finance Charge and Administrative
  Collections with respect to such Distribution Date plus any other funds
  available to the Deposit Trust for application pursuant to this clause will
  be distributed in the following priority:

     (i)  if HFC is not the Servicer under this Agreement an amount equal to
   the Series 1996-2 Servicing Fee for such date (to the extent such amount has
   not been netted from deposits made in the related Due Period) plus any
   unpaid Series 1996-2 Servicing Fee





                                      12
<PAGE>   16

   (but only with respect to the then current Servicer) shall be paid to the    
   Servicer.

       (ii)   an amount equal to Series 1996-2 Series Participation Interest
   Monthly Interest for such Distribution Date, plus the amount of any Series
   1996-2 Series Participation Interest Interest Shortfall, plus the amount of
   any Additional Interest for such Distribution Date;

      (iii)  an amount equal to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
   Default Amount for such Distribution Date shall be treated as a portion of
   Available Investor Principal Collections for such Distribution Date;

       (iv)   an amount equal to the aggregate amount of Series 1996-2
   Participation Interest Charge-Offs which have not been previously reimbursed
   shall be treated as a portion of Available Investor Principal Collections
   with respect to such Distribution Date.

     (v)  so long as HFC is the Servicer under the Agreement an amount equal to
   the Series 1996-2 Servicing Fee for such date (to the extent such amount has
   not been netted from deposits to cover losses in the related Due Period)
   plus any previously unpaid Series 1996-2 Servicing Fee (but only with
   respect to the then current Servicer) shall be paid to the Servicer; and

       (vi)  the balance, if any, shall be paid to the Seller with respect to
   the HCLC Seller Participation Interest and the Designated HCLC Seller
   Participation Interest, pro rata.

   Section 4.12.  Investor Charge-Offs.  (a)  If on any Distribution Date the
amount to be distributed on the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest pursuant
to Section 4.11(a)(iii) exceeds the amount of Investor Finance Charge and
Administrative Collections for the related Due Period (net of any portion
thereof to be paid pursuant to Section 4.11(a)(i) and (ii)), then the Series
1996-2 Series Participation Interest Invested Amount shall be reduced by the
amount of such excess ("Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Charge-Offs"), but
not more than the Series 1996-2 Series Participation Interest Default Amount
for such Distribution Date.





                                      13
<PAGE>   17

   (b)   Notwithstanding any other provision of this Series Supplement, the
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount shall never be reduced
below zero.

   Section 4.13.  [RESERVED]


SECTION 5.  Distributions.

   (a)   On each Distribution Date, the Paying Agent shall distribute to each
Series 1996-2 Participant of record on the Record Date for such Distribution
Date (other than as provided in Section 12.02 of the Agreement respecting a
final distribution) such Series 1996-2 Participant's pro rata share (based on
the aggregate fractional undivided interests represented by Series 1996-2
Participation Interests held by such Series 1996-2 Participant) of the amounts
on deposit in the Collection Account pursuant to Section 4.11(a)(ii).

   (b)   On each Distribution Date, the Paying Agent shall distribute to each
Series 1996-2 Participant of record on the Record Date for such Distribution
Date (other than as provided in Section 12.02 of the Agreement respecting a
final distribution) such Series 1996-2 Participant's pro rata share (based on
the aggregate fractional undivided interests represented by Series 1996-2
Participation Interests held by such Series 1996-2 Participant) of the amounts
on deposit in the Collection Account with respect to Available Investor
Principal Collections.

   (c)   Except as provided in Section 12.02 of the Agreement with respect to a
final distribution, distributions to Series Participants hereunder shall be
made in immediately available funds by wire transfer to the account designated
by such Series 1996-2 Participant.


SECTION 6.  Statements to Series Participants.

   (a)   On each Distribution Date, the Paying Agent, on behalf of the Deposit
Trustee, shall forward to each Series 1996-2 Participant a statement
substantially in the form of Exhibit B prepared by the Servicer setting forth
certain information relating to the Deposit Trust and the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest.

   (b)   On or before January 31 of each calendar year, beginning January 31,
1997, the Paying Agent, on behalf of the Deposit Trustee, shall furnish or
cause to be furnished to each Person who at any time during the preceding
calendar year was a Series 1996-2 Participant, a statement prepared by the
Servicer





                                      14
<PAGE>   18

containing the information which is required to be contained in the statement
to Series 1996-2 Participants, as set forth in subsection (a) above, as the
case may be, aggregated for such preceding calendar year or the applicable
portion thereof (the initial statement shall cover the period beginning on the
Closing Date and ending on [December 31, 1996]) during which such Person was a
Series 1996-2 Participant, together with such other customary information as is
necessary to enable the Series 1996-2 Participants to prepare their tax
returns.  Such obligation of the Servicer shall be deemed to have been
satisfied to the extent that substantially comparable information shall be
provided by the Paying Agent pursuant to any requirements of the Internal
Revenue Code as from time to time in effect.

   (c)    The form of 1996-2 Monthly Servicer's Report set forth at Exhibit B
hereto may be modified as the Servicer may determine to be necessary or
desirable; provided, however, that no such modification shall serve to exclude
information required by this Section 6.  The Servicer shall, upon making such
determination, deliver to the Deposit Trustee an Officer's Certificate to which
shall be annexed the form of Exhibit B, as so changed.  Upon the delivery of
such Officer's Certificate to the Deposit Trustee, Exhibit B, as so changed,
shall for all purposes of this Agreement constitute Exhibit B.  The Deposit
Trustee may conclusively rely upon such Officer's Certificate as to such change
conforming to the requirements of this Agreement.


SECTION 7.  Additional Amortization Events.  If any one of the following shall
occur:

            (a)   failure on the part of the Seller (i) to make any payment or 
  deposit required under the Agreement within five Business Days after the
  date such payment or deposit is required to be made; or (ii) to observe or
  perform in any material respect any other covenants or agreements of the
  Seller set forth in the Agreement, which failure has a material adverse effect
  on the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest and which continues unremedied for
  a period of 60 days after written notice;

            (b)   any representation or warranty made by the Seller in the 
  Agreement proves to have been incorrect in any material respect when
  made, as a result of which the interests of holders of interest in the Deposit
  Trust are materially and adversely affected, and which continues to be
  incorrect in any material respect and continues to materially and adversely
  affect the interests of holders of interest in the Deposit Trust for a period
  of 60 days after written notice; provided, however, that an Amortization





                                      15
<PAGE>   19

  Event shall not be deemed to occur if the Seller has repurchased the related
  Receivables, during such period (or within an additional 60 days with the
  consent of the Deposit Trustee) in accordance with the provisions of the
  Agreement;

            (c)   the Deposit Trust or the Issuer becomes subject to 
  regulation by the Commission as an investment company within the meaning
  of the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended;

            (d)   a Servicer Default shall occur which has a material adverse 

  effect on the Series 1996-2 Series Participants;

            (e)   the average, for any three consecutive Payment Dates (after 
  making all distributions on such Payment Dates), of the percentage
  equivalent of (i) the Overcollateralization Amount divided by (ii) the unpaid
  principal balance of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest, is less than
  [4.75%]; and

            (f)  the Seller's Trust Amount owned by HCLC is reduced below the 
  Aggregate Required Seller Amount.

            then in the case of any event described in (a), (b) or (d) an 
Amortization Event will be deemed to have occurred only if, after any
applicable grace period described in such clauses, either the Deposit Trustee,
or, holders of Series Participation Interests evidencing more than 50% of unpaid
principal balance of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest, by written notice
to the Seller and the Servicer (and to the Deposit Trustee, if given by the
Series 1996-2 Participants) declare that an Amortization Event has occurred as
of the date of such notice.  In the case of any event described in clauses (c),
(e) or (f), an Amortization Event will be deemed to have occurred and an Early
Amortization Period will occur without any notice or other action on the part of
the Deposit Trustee, the Series 1996-2 Participants immediately upon the
occurrence of such event.


SECTION 8.  Optional Repurchase.

  On the Distribution Date occurring on or after the date on which the
aggregate of the Security Balances is reduced to $[           ] (10% of the
aggregate of the Security Balances on the Closing Date) or less, the Seller
shall have the option to purchase the Series 1996-2 Participant's Interest at a
purchase price equal to the Optional Repurchase Amount.  The Seller shall give
the Servicer, the Rating Agency and the Deposit Trustee at least 10 days prior
written notice of the date on which the





                                      16
<PAGE>   20

Seller intends to exercise such option to purchase.  Not later than 10:00 A.M.,
New York City time, on such Distribution Date the Seller shall deposit the
Optional Repurchase Amount into the Collection Account in immediately available
funds.  Such purchase option is subject to payment in full of the Optional
Repurchase Amount.  The Optional Repurchase Amount shall be distributed as set
forth in section 10 hereof.


SECTION 9.  Sale of Series 1996-2 Participants' Interest pursuant to Section
2.06 or 10.01 of the Agreement.

   (a)   The amount to be paid by the Seller with respect to Series 1996-2
Participants' Interest in connection with a repurchase of the Series 1996-2
Participants' Interest pursuant to Section 2.06 of the Agreement shall equal
the Reassignment Amount for the first Distribution Date following the Due
Period in which the reassignment obligation arises under the Agreement.

   (b)   The amount to be paid by the Seller with respect to Series 1996-2
Participation Interest in connection with a repurchase of the Series 1996-2
Participant's Interest pursuant to Section 10.01 of the Agreement shall equal
the sum of (x) the Reassignment Amount for the Distribution Date of such
repurchase and (y) the excess, if any, of (I) a price equivalent to the average
of bids quoted on the Record Date preceding the date of repurchase or, if not a
Business Day, on the next succeeding Business Day by at least two recognized
dealers selected by the Deposit Trustee (which may be selected from the list
attached as Schedule 1), for the purchase by such dealers of a security which
is similar to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest with a remaining
maturity approximately equal to the remaining maturity of the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest over (II) the portion of the Reassignment Amount
attributable to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest.


SECTION 10.  Distributions pursuant to Section 8 or 9 of this Series Supplement
and Section 2.06, 10.01 or 12.02(c) of the Agreement.

   (a)   With respect to the Optional Repurchase Amount deposited into the
Collection Account pursuant to Section 8, the Reassignment Amount deposited
into the Collection Account pursuant to Section 9 or any Termination Proceeds
deposited into the Collection Account pursuant to Section 12.02(c) of the
Agreement, the Deposit Trustee shall, not later than 1:00 P.M., New York City
time, on the date of deposit, make deposits of the following amounts (in the
priority set forth below and, in each case, after giving effect to any deposits
and distributions





                                      17
<PAGE>   21

otherwise to be made on such date) in immediately available funds as follows:
the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Invested Amount on such date and the
amount of accrued and unpaid interest on the unpaid balance of the Series
1996-2 Participation Interest, plus the amount of Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest Additional Interest previously due but not paid on any prior
Distribution Date, for distribution to Series 1996-2 Participants.

   (b)   Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Series Supplement or
the Agreement, the entire amount deposited in the Collection Account pursuant
to Section 8 or Sections 9(a) or (b) and 10(a) hereof and all other amounts on
deposit therein for distribution to the Series 1996-2 Participants shall be
distributed in full to the Series 1996-2 Participants on such date and shall be
deemed to be a final distribution pursuant to Section 12.02 of the Agreement.


SECTION 11.  Distribution of Proceeds of Sale, Disposition or Liquidation of
the Receivables pursuant to Section 9.02 of the Agreement.

   (a)   Not later than 1:00 P.M., New York City time, on the Distribution Date
following the date on which the Insolvency Proceeds are received, such proceeds
shall be deposited into the Collection Account pursuant to Section 9.02(b) of
the Agreement.

   (b)   [RESERVED]

   (c)   Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Series Supplement or
the Agreement, the entire amount deposited in the Collection Account pursuant
to this Section 11 and all other amounts on deposit therein for distribution
for the Series 1996-2 Participants shall be distributed in full to the Series
1996-2 Participants on the Distribution Date on which funds are deposited
pursuant to this Section (or, if not so deposited on a Distribution Date, on
the immediately following Distribution Date) and shall be deemed to be a final
distribution pursuant to Section 12.02 of the Agreement.


SECTION 12.  Rating Agency Notice.

  In the event a Tax Opinion is delivered pursuant to Section 2.09(e)(vi) of
the Agreement and the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest is outstanding, such
opinion shall be also delivered to Moody's.





                                      18
<PAGE>   22

SECTION 13.  [RESERVED]


SECTION 14.  [RESERVED]


SECTION 15.  Delivery  of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest.

   The Deposit Trustee shall deliver the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
to the Seller when authenticated in accordance with Section 6.02 of the
Agreement.


SECTION 16.  Ratification of Agreement.

   As supplemented by this Series Supplement, the Agreement is in all respects
ratified and confirmed and the Agreement, as so supplemented by this Series
Supplement shall be read, taken and construed as one and the same instrument.


SECTION 17.  Counterparts.

   This Series Supplement may be executed in two or more counterparts, each of
which when so executed shall be deemed to be an original, but all of which
shall together constitute but one and the same instrument.


SECTION 18.  Governing Law.

   THIS SERIES SUPPLEMENT SHALL BE CONSTRUED AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND
REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE
LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT PREFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW
PROVISIONS.


SECTION 19.  Forms of Certificates and Monthly Servicer's Certificate.

   The Series 1996-2 Participation Interest and Monthly Servicer's Certificate
with respect to Series 1996-2 shall be in substantially the respective forms
attached as exhibits hereto.


SECTION 20.  Transfer Restrictions.

   Registration of transfer of any Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
containing the legend set forth on the





                                      19
<PAGE>   23

Series 1996-2 Participation Interest attached hereto as Exhibit A-1 shall be
effected only if such transfer is made to a Person that certifies to the
Transfer Agent in writing that it is not an employee benefit plan, trust or
account, including an individual retirement account, that is subject to ERISA
or that is described in Section 4975(e)(1) of the Code or an entity whose
underlying assets include plan assets by reason of a plan's investment in such
entity (each a "Benefit Plan").  By accepting and holding a Series 1996-2
Participation Interest, a Series 1996-2 Participant shall be deemed to have
represented and warranted that it is not a Benefit Plan and is not purchasing a
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest on behalf of a Benefit Plan.  By acquiring
any interest in a Book-Entry Certificate representing a Series 1996-2
Participation Interest, a Certificate Owner shall be deemed to have represented
and warranted that it is not a Benefit Plan and is not purchasing a Series
1996-2 Participation Interest on behalf of a Benefit Plan.

   No transfer of a Series 1996-2 Participation Interest shall be made unless a
Tax Opinion is delivered and such transfer is exempt from the registration
requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and any applicable
state securities laws or is made in accordance with said Act and laws.  In the
event of any such transfer, (i) unless such transfer is made in reliance upon
Rule 144A under the 1933 Act, the Deposit Trustee or the Seller may require a
written Opinion of Counsel (which may be in-house counsel) acceptable to and in
form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Deposit Trustee and the
Seller that such transfer may be made pursuant to an exemption, describing the
applicable exemption and the basis therefor, from said Act and laws or is being
made pursuant to said Act and laws, which Opinion of Counsel shall not be an
expense of the Deposit Trustee or the Seller and (ii) the Deposit Trustee shall
require the transferee to execute an investment letter (in substantially the
form attached hereto as Exhibit C) acceptable to and in form and substance
reasonably satisfactory to the Seller and the Deposit Trustee certifying to the
Seller and the Deposit Trustee the facts surrounding such transfer, which
investment letter shall not be an expense of the Deposit Trustee or the Seller.
A Series 1996-2 Participant desiring to effect such transfer shall, and does
hereby agree to indemnify the Deposit Trustee and the Seller against any
liability that may result if the transfer is not so exempt or is not made in
accordance with such federal and state laws.





                                      20
<PAGE>   24

   IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Seller, the Servicer and the Deposit Trustee have
caused this Series Supplement to be fully executed by their respective officers
as of the day and year first above written.

                                             HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN           
                                             CORPORATION, Seller               
                                                                               
                                                                               
                                             By                                
                                               ----------------------------    
                                               Name:  Steve H. Smith           
                                               Title:  VP & Asst. Treasurer    
                                                                               
                                                                               
                                             HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION,    
                                             Servicer                          
                                                                               
                                                                               
                                             By                                
                                               ----------------------------    
                                               Name:                           
                                               Title:                          
                                                                               
                                                                               
                                             TEXAS COMMERCE BANK NATIONAL      
                                             ASSOCIATION, Deposit Trustee      
                                                                               
                                                                               
                                             By                                
                                               ------------------------------  
                                               Name:                           
                                               Title:                          
                                                                               


<PAGE>   25

                                                                     EXHIBIT A-1

                  FORM OF SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION INTEREST

   THIS SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION INTEREST HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE
SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED.  NEITHER THIS SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION
INTEREST NOR ANY PORTION HEREOF MAY BE OFFERED OR SOLD EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE
WITH THE REGISTRATION PROVISIONS OF SUCH ACT OR PURSUANT TO AN AVAILABLE
EXEMPTION FROM SUCH REGISTRATION PROVISIONS.

   THIS SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION INTEREST IS NOT PERMITTED TO BE
TRANSFERRED, ASSIGNED, EXCHANGED OR OTHERWISE PLEDGED OR CONVEYED EXCEPT IN
COMPLIANCE WITH THE TERMS OF THE POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT AND THE SERIES
1996-2 SUPPLEMENT THERETO REFERRED TO HEREIN.

No. R-__                                                                One Unit

                    HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN DEPOSIT TRUST I
                      SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION INTEREST

                    THIS CERTIFICATE REPRESENTS AN INTEREST
                            IN CERTAIN ASSETS OF THE
                    HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN DEPOSIT TRUST I

Evidencing an interest in a trust, the corpus of which consists primarily of
participation interests and receivables generated from time to time in the
ordinary course of business in a portfolio of credit lines provided by
Household Consumer Loan Corporation.

   (Not an interest in or obligation of Household Consumer
Loan Corporation or any affiliate thereof)

   This certifies that _______________, is the registered owner of a fractional
interest in the assets of a trust (the "Trust") pursuant to the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement dated as of September 1, 1995 (the "Agreement"), by and
among the Household Consumer Loan Corporation (the "Seller"), Household Finance
Corporation, as servicer (the "Servicer"), and Texas Commerce Bank National
Association, the successor to The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A., as deposit
trustee (the "Trustee"), as supplemented by the Supplement for Series 1996-2
dated as of ____________ 1, 1996 (the "Supplement"), by and among the Seller,
the Servicer and the Trustee.  The corpus of the Trust consists of (a)
receivables originated under certain fixed and variable rate revolving
unsecured consumer credit lines (the "Credit






<PAGE>   26

Lines") and (b) certain other participation interests, certain amounts payable
with respect thereto, and certain monies constituting Recoveries allocated to
the Trust pursuant to the Agreement and any Supplement.  Although a summary of
certain provisions of the Agreement and the Supplement is set forth below, this
Series 1996-2 Participation Interest does not purport to summarize the
Agreement or the Supplement and reference is made to the Agreement and the
Supplement for information with respect to the interests, rights, benefits,
obligations, proceeds and duties evidenced hereby and the rights, duties and
obligations of the Trustee.  A copy of the Agreement and the Supplement may be
requested from the Trustee by writing to the Trustee at the Corporate Trust
Office.  To the extent not defined herein, the capitalized terms used herein
have the meanings ascribed to them in the Agreement or the Supplement, as
applicable.

  This Series 1996-2 Participation Interest is issued under and is subject to
the terms, provisions and conditions of the Agreement and the Supplement, to
which the holder of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest by virtue of the
acceptance hereof assents and is bound.

  The Receivables consist of amounts payable by obligors on the Credit Lines
from time to time, including amounts payable for Principal Receivables and
Finance Charge and Administrative Receivables.

   This Certificate is the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest which
represents an interest in certain assets of the Trust, which includes the right
to receive a portion of the Collections and other amounts at the times and in
the amounts specified in the Agreement and Supplement.  The aggregate interest
represented by the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest at any time in the
Receivables in the Trust shall not exceed the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest Invested Amount at such time.  In addition to the Series 1996-2
Participation Interest (i) Investor Certificates and additional Series
Participation Interests may be issued to investors pursuant to the Agreement,
which will represent the Certificateholders' Interest and (ii) Supplemental
Seller Participation Interests may be issued pursuant to the Agreement, which
will represent that portion of the Seller's Interest not allocated to the
Seller.

  In general, this Series 1996-2 Participation Interest is entitled to receive
distributions in respect of the collections of the Trust in accordance with the
terms of the Agreement and Supplement on the 14th day of each calendar month or
if such day is not a business day then on the next preceding business day,
commencing in April, 1996.





                                    A-1-2
<PAGE>   27


  Unless the certificate of authentication hereon has been executed by or on
behalf of the Trustee, by manual or facsimile signature, this Series 1996-2
Participation Interest shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Agreement
or the Supplement, or be valid for any purpose.





                                    A-1-3
<PAGE>   28

  IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Seller has caused this Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest to be duly executed.

                                           HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORPORATION 
                                                                               
                                                                               
                                           By:                                 
                                              --------------------------       
                                              Name:                            
                                              Title:                           
                                                                               


Dated:                 , 1996
        ---------------




                                    A-1-4
<PAGE>   29

                     TRUSTEE'S CERTIFICATE OF AUTHORIZATION

            This is one of the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest
                       described in the within-mentioned
                Pooling and Servicing Agreement and Supplement.



TEXAS COMMERCE BANK NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
as Trustee


By:___________________________________________
   Authorized Signatory





<PAGE>   30

                    HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN DEPOSIT TRUST I
                      SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION INTEREST

                        Summary of Terms and Conditions


  The Series 1996-2 Participation constitutes an undivided beneficial interest
in the Receivables held in the Trust.  The holder of the Series 1996-2
Participation, shares on the basis of a specified percentage of the
principal balance of the Receivables and the principal portion of any
Participation Interest held as assets of the Trust.  The Series 1996-2
Participation initially represents a principal balance of $[              ]. 
Thereafter, the Series 1996-2 Participation Invested Amount with respect to any
date will be an amount equal to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest Initial
Invested Amount minus the sum of the Series 1996-2 Participation Principal
Distribution Amount paid for all Distribution Dates and the Defaulted Amounts
allocated to the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest during the related and all
prior Due Periods that have not been included in the Series 1996-2 Participation
Principal Distribution Amount on the current or any prior Distribution Date.

  On each Distribution Date, the Paying Agent shall distribute to each Series
1996-2 Participant of record on the Record Date for such Distribution Date
(other than as provided in Section 12.02 of the Agreement respecting a final
distribution) such Series 1996-2 Participant's pro rata share (based on the
aggregate fractional undivided interests represented by Series 1996-2
Participation Interests held by such Series 1996-2 Participant) of the amounts
on deposit in the Collection Account pursuant to the Agreement and the
Supplement.

  Except as provided in the Agreement with respect to a final distribution,
distributions to Series Participants shall be made in immediately available
funds by wire transfer to the account designated by such Series 1996-2
Participant.

  The Seller shall have the option to purchase the Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest at a purchase price equal to the Optional Repurchase Amount in
accordance with the provisions of Section 8 of the Supplement.  Such purchase
option is subject to payment in full of the Optional Repurchase Amount.  The
Optional Repurchase Amount shall be distributed as set forth in the Agreement
and Supplement.

  This Series 1996-2 Participation Interest does not represent an obligation
of, or an interest in, the Seller, the Servicer or any affiliate of any of them
and is not insured or guaranteed by





                                    A-1-6
<PAGE>   31

any other governmental agency or instrumentality.  This Series 1996-2
Participation Interest is limited in right of payment to certain collections
representing the Receivables and any Participation Interests (and certain other
amounts) all as more specifically set forth herein above and in the Agreement
and the Supplement.

  The Agreement and the Supplement may be amended by the Seller, the Servicer
and the Trustee, without the Series 1996-2 Participants' consent.  The Trustee
may, but shall not be obligated to, enter into any such amendment which affects
the Trustee's rights, duties or immunities under the Agreement or otherwise.

  The Agreement and the Series Supplement may be amended by the Seller, the
Servicer and the Trustee with the consent of the Holders of Investor
Certificates evidencing not less than 66-2/3% of the aggregate unpaid principal
amount of the Investor Certificates and Series Participants of all adversely
affected Series for which the Seller has not delivered an Officer's Certificate
stating that there is no Adverse Effect, for the purpose of adding any
provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of
the Agreement or any Supplement or of modifying in any manner the rights of
Investor Certificateholders or Series Participants; provided, however, that no
such amendment shall (a) reduce in any manner the amount of, or delay the
timing of, distributions to Investor Certificateholders or holder of any Series
Participation Interest without the consent of each such Holder (b)(i) change
the definition of or the manner of calculating the interest of any Investor
Certificateholder or Series Participant without the consent of each affected
Investor Certificateholder or Series Participant or (ii) reduce the aforesaid
percentage required to consent to any such amendment, in either case without
the consent of each Investor Certificateholder or Series Participant.  Any such
amendment and any such consent by the holder of the Series 1996-2 Participants
shall be conclusive and binding on such Series 1996-2 Participants and upon all
future holders of this Series 1996-2 Participation Interest and of any Series
1996-2 Participation Interests issued in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof
whether or not notation thereof is made upon this Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest.

  As set forth in Section 6.05 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the
transfer of this Series 1996-2 Participation Interest shall be registered in
the Certificate Register upon surrender of this Series 1996-2 Participation
Interest for registration of transfer at any office or agency maintained by the
Transfer Agent and Registrar accompanied by a written instrument of transfer,
in a form satisfactory to the Trustee or





                                    A-1-7
<PAGE>   32

the Transfer Agent and Registrar, duly executed by the Series 1996-2
Participant or such Series 1996-2 Participant's attorney, and duly authorized
in writing with such signature guaranteed, and thereupon one or more new Series
1996-2 Participation Interests of authorized denominations and for the same
aggregate Fractional Undivided Interest will be issued to the designated
transferee or transferees.

  As provided in the Agreement and subject to certain limitations therein set
forth, Series 1996-2 Participation Interests are exchangeable for new Series
1996-2 Participation Interests evidencing like aggregate fractional undivided
interests as requested by the Series 1996-2 Participation Interest holder
surrendering such Series 1996-2 Participation Interest.  No service charge may
be imposed for any such exchange but the Servicer or Transfer Agent and
Registrar may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other
governmental charge that may be imposed in connection therewith.

  The Seller, the Servicer, the Trustee, the Paying Agent and the Transfer
Agent and Registrar and any agent of any of them, may treat the person in whose
name this Series 1996-2 Participation Interest is registered as the owner
hereof for all purposes, and neither the Servicer nor the Seller, the Trustee,
the Paying Agent, the Transfer Agent and Registrar, nor any agent of any of
them, shall be affected by notice to the contrary except in certain
circumstances described in the Agreement.

THIS SERIES 1996-2 PARTICIPATION INTEREST SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH
AND GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.





                                    A-1-8
<PAGE>   33

                                   ASSIGNMENT


Social Security or other identifying number of assignee

________________________________________________________________________________

  FOR VALUE RECEIVED, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and transfers unto
________________________________________________________________________________
(name and address of assignee)

the within certificate and all rights thereunder, and hereby irrevocably
constitutes and appoints __________________ attorney, to transfer said
certificate on the books kept for registration thereof, with full power of
substitution in the premises.

Dated:_______________

<TABLE>
<S>                                             <C>
(1)   A Non U.S. Person as defined in the        Note: The signature(s) to this Assignment      
      Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as                must correspond with the name(s) as      
      amended, must certify to the Deposit             written on the face of the within        
      Trustee in writing as to its Non U.S.            certificate in every particular without  
      Person status and such further                   alteration or enlargement or any change  
      information as may be required under             whatsoever.                              
      the Code or reasonably requested by the                 
      Deposit Trustee.

</TABLE>

 
 
 
 
 
 



                                    A-1-9
<PAGE>   34

                                                                       EXHIBIT B

                     FORM OF MONTHLY SERVICER'S CERTIFICATE
                (To be delivered pursuant to subsection 3.04(b)
               of the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing
                  Agreement not later than the second Business
                     Day preceding each Distribution Date)


                         HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION

                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORPORATION

                      HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2

                Consumer Loan Asset Backed Notes, Series 1996-2,
                  Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3 and Class B

                              ___________________

   The undersigned, a duly authorized representative of Household Finance
Corporation, as servicer (the "Servicer"), pursuant to the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 1, 1995 (the "Pooling and Servicing
Agreement"), by and among Household Consumer Loan Corporation, as seller (the
"Seller"), the Servicer, and Texas Commerce Bank National Association, the
successor to The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A., as deposit trustee (the "Deposit
Trustee"), does hereby certify with respect to the information set forth below
as follows:

  1. Capitalized terms used in this Certificate shall have the respective
     meanings set forth in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

  2. Household Finance Corporation is, as of the date hereof, the Servicer
     under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

  3. The undersigned is a Servicing Officer.

  4. This Certificate relates to the Distribution Date occurring on
     ________________.

  5.   Deposit Trust Information.

      (a)   The total Pool Balance of Receivables for the 
            Due Period preceding such Distribution Date 
            was equal to   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $_______






<PAGE>   35

<TABLE>
   <S>   <C>                                                                                         <C>
   (b)   The Sub-total Unsecured Consumer 
         Loans for the Due Period preceding 
         such Distribution Date was equal to   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  . . . . . . $
                                                                                                       -------

   (c)   The Sub-total Personal Homeowner 
         Lines for the Due Period preceding 
         such Distribution Date was equal to   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------

   (d)   The Series 1996-2 Principal Collections 
         for the preceding Due Period is  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------

   (e)   The Series 1996-2 Finance Charge & 
         Administrative Collections as of the 
         last day of the immediately preceding Due Period is. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $         
                                                                                                       -------

   (f)   The Additional Balances for such 
         Distribution Date is . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .             %
                                                                                                       ------- 

   (g)   The New Credit Lines is equal to   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------

   (h)   The Additional Credit Lines is equal to  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------

   (i)   The Removed Credit Lines is  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------

   (j)   The Defaulted Amount is equal to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------

   (k)   The Repurchased Credit Lines pursuant 
         to section 2.10 was equal to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------

   (l)   The applicable allocation percentages 
         for principal and interest for such Distribution Date is . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------

   (m)   The Series 1996-2 Participation 
         Interest Distribution Amount is . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------

   (n)   Accelerated Principal Distribution 
         Amount is . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------

   (o)   Series 1996-2 Principal Distribution 
         Amount is . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------

   (p)   Net Charge-Off Amounts (monthly and 
         cumulative) is. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                                       -------
                                                                                                     $        
                                                                                                       -------
</TABLE>





                                     B-2
<PAGE>   36

<TABLE>
   <S>  <C>                                                                                   
   (q)   Reversals (monthly and cumulative) is  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                   --------
                                                                                  $ 
                                                                                   -------- 
   (r)  Servicing Fee   . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . $       
                                                                                   --------
</TABLE>                                                              





                                     B-3
<PAGE>   37

   IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has duly executed and delivered this
Certificate this ____ day of _________, 199_.

                                           HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION,      
                                             as Servicer                       
                                                                               
                                                                               
                                           By:                                 
                                              _________________________________ 
                                              Name:                            
                                              Title:                           
                                                                               




<PAGE>   38

                                                                       EXHIBIT C

                 [FORM OF RULE 144A INVESTMENT REPRESENTATION]


            Description of Rule 144A Securities, including numbers:
                _______________________________________________
                _______________________________________________
                _______________________________________________
                _______________________________________________


   The undersigned seller, as registered holder (the "Seller"), intends to
transfer the Rule 144A Securities described above to the undersigned buyer (the
"Buyer").

   1.  In connection with such transfer and in accordance with the agreements
pursuant to which the Rule 144A Securities were issued, the Seller hereby
certifies the following facts:  Neither the Seller nor anyone acting on its
behalf has offered, transferred, pledged, sold or otherwise disposed of the
Rule 144A Securities, any interest in the Rule 144A Securities or any other
similar security to, or solicited any offer to buy or accept a transfer, pledge
or other disposition of the Rule 144A Securities, any interest in the Rule 144A
Securities or any other similar security from, or otherwise approached or
negotiated with respect to the Rule 144A Securities, any interest in the Rule
144A Securities or any other similar security with, any person in any manner,
or made any general solicitation by means of general advertising or in any
other manner, or taken any other action, that would constitute a distribution
of the Rule 144A Securities under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the
"1933 Act"), or that would render the disposition of the Rule 144A Securities a
violation of Section 5 of the 1933 Act or require registration pursuant
thereto, and that the Seller has not offered the Rule 144A Securities to any
person other than the Buyer or another "qualified institutional buyer" as
defined in Rule 144A under the 1933 Act.

   2.  The Buyer warrants and represents to, and covenants with, the Deposit
Trustee, and the Seller (as defined in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement (the
"Agreement") dated as of September 1, 1995 among Household Consumer Loan
Corporation, as Seller and as Holder of the Designated Certificate, and Texas
Commerce Bank National Association, the successor to The Chase Manhattan Bank,
N.A., as Deposit Trustee) as follows:

       a.  The Buyer understands that the Rule 144A Securities have not been
registered under the 1933 Act or the securities laws of any state.





<PAGE>   39

     b.  The Buyer considers itself a substantial, sophisticated institutional
  investor having such knowledge and experience in financial and business
  matters that it is capable of evaluating the merits and risks of investment
  in the Rule 144A Securities.

     c.  The Buyer has been furnished with all information regarding the Rule
  144A Securities that it has requested from the Seller and the Deposit Trustee
  or the Servicer.

     d.  Neither the Buyer nor anyone acting on its behalf has offered,
  transferred, pledged, sold or otherwise disposed of the Rule 144A Securities,
  any interest in the Rule 144A Securities or any other similar security to, or
  solicited any offer to buy or accept a transfer, pledge or other disposition
  of the Rule 144A Securities, any interest in the Rule 144A Securities or any
  other similar security from, or otherwise approached or negotiated with
  respect to the Rule 144A Securities, any interest in the Rule 144A Securities
  or any other similar security with, any person in any manner, or made any
  general solicitation by means of general advertising or in any other manner,
  or taken any other action, that would constitute a distribution of the Rule
  144A Securities under the 1933 Act or that would render the disposition of
  the Rule 144A Securities a violation of Section 5 of the 1933 Act or require
  registration pursuant thereto, nor will it act, nor has it authorized or will
  it authorize any person to act, in such manner with respect to the Rule 144A
  Securities.

     e.  The Buyer is a "qualified institutional buyer" as that term is defined
  in Rule 144A under the 1933 Act and has completed either of the forms of
  certification to that effect attached hereto as Annex 1 or Annex 2.  The
  Buyer is aware that the sale to it is being made in reliance on Rule 144A.
  The Buyer is acquiring the Rule 144A Securities for its own account or the
  accounts of other qualified institutional buyers, understands that such Rule
  144A Securities may be resold, pledged or transferred only (i) to a person
  reasonably believed to be a qualified institutional buyer that purchases for
  its own account or for the account of a qualified institutional buyer to whom
  notice is given that the resale, pledge or transfer is being made in reliance
  on Rule 144A, or (ii) pursuant to another exemption from registration under
  the 1933 Act.

   [3.  The Buyer warrants and represents to, and covenants with, the Seller,
the Deposit Trustee, Servicer and the Seller that either (1) the Buyer is (A)
not an employee benefit plan (within the meaning of Section 3(3) of the
Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA")), or a
plan (within the meaning of Section 4975(e)(1) of the Internal Revenue Code of
1986 ("Code")), which (in either case) is subject





                                     C-2
<PAGE>   40

to ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code (both a "Plan"), and (B) is not directly
or indirectly purchasing the Rule 144A Securities on behalf of, as investment
manager of, as named fiduciary of, as trustee of, or with "plan assets" of a
Plan, or (2) the Buyer understands that registration of transfer of any Rule
144A Securities to any Plan, or to any Person acting on behalf of any Plan,
will not be made unless such Plan delivers an opinion of its counsel, addressed
and satisfactory to the Certificate Registrar and the Seller, to the effect
that the purchase and holding of the Rule 144A Securities by, on behalf of or
with "plan assets" of any Plan would not constitute or result in a prohibited
transaction under Section 406 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code, and would
not subject the Seller, the Servicer, the Indenture Trustee or the Issuer to
any obligation or liability (including liabilities under ERISA or Section 4975
of the Code) in addition to those undertaken in the Agreement or any other
liability.]

   4.  The Buyer has otherwise complied with any conditions for transfer set
forth in the Trust Agreement, and (h), either (i) is a "C Corporation" under
the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or (ii) has provided such
disclosure concerning our status for federal income tax purposes and the status
and economic interest of our beneficial owners, as the Issuer or its
representatives have reasonably requested to determine that the Buyer's
acquisition of the Certificates will not subject the Issuer to an entity level
tax.

   5.  This document may be executed in one or more counterparts and by the
different parties hereto on separate counterparts, each of which, when so
executed, shall be deemed to be an original; such counterparts, together, shall
constitute one and the same document.

   IN WITNESS WHEREOF, each of the parties has executed this document as of the
date set forth below.

                                                                           
- -------------------------------------      ------------------------------------
Print Name of Seller                       Print Name of Buyer             
                                                                           
By:                                        By:                                 
   ----------------------------------         ---------------------------------
    Name:                                  Name:                           
    Title:                                 Title:                          
                                                                           
Taxpayer Identification:                   Taxpayer Identification:        
                                                                           
No.                                        No.                                 
   ----------------------------------          --------------------------------
                                                                           
Date:                                      Date:                               
     --------------------------------           -------------------------------
                                                                           




                                     C-3
<PAGE>   41

                                                            ANNEX 1 TO EXHIBIT C





            QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER STATUS UNDER SEC RULE 144A

            [For Buyers Other Than Registered Investment Companies]

           The undersigned hereby certifies as follows in connection with the
Rule 144A Investment Representation to which this Certification is attached:

            1. As indicated below, the undersigned is the President, Chief
Financial Officer, Senior Vice President or other executive officer of the
Buyer.

            2. In connection with purchases by the Buyer, the Buyer is a
"qualified institutional buyer" as that term is defined in Rule 144A under the
Securities Act of 1933 ("Rule 144A") because (i) the Buyer owned and/or
invested on a discretionary basis $______________________1 in securities
(except for the excluded securities referred to below) as of the end of the
Buyer's most recent fiscal year (such amount being calculated in accordance
with Rule 144A) and (ii) the Buyer satisfies the criteria in the category
marked below.

    ___     Corporation, etc.  The Buyer is a corporation (other than a bank,
            savings and loan association or similar institution), Massachusetts
            or similar business trust, partnership, or charitable organization
            described in Section 501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code.

    ___     Bank.  The Buyer (a) is a national bank or banking institution
            organized under the laws of any State, territory or the District of
            Columbia, the business of which is substantially confined to
            banking and is supervised by the State or territorial banking
            commission or similar official or is a foreign bank or equivalent
            institution, and (b) has an audited net worth of at least
            $25,000,000 as demonstrated in its latest annual financial
            statements, a copy of which is attached hereto.





____________________

1  
 Buyer must own and/or invest on a discretionary basis at least
$100,000,000 in securities unless Buyer is a dealer, and, in that
case, Buyer must own and/or invest on a discretionary basis at least
$10,000,000 in securities.




                                    C-1-1
<PAGE>   42

    ___     Savings and Loan.  The Buyer (a) is a savings and loan association,
            building and loan association, cooperative bank, homestead
            association or similar institution, which is supervised and
            examined by a State or Federal authority having supervision over
            any such institutions or is a foreign savings and loan association
            or equivalent institution and (b) has an audited net worth of at
            least $25,000,000 as demonstrated in its latest annual financial
            statements.

    ___     Broker-Dealer.  The Buyer is a dealer registered pursuant to
            Section 15 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

    ___     Insurance Company.  The Buyer is an insurance company whose primary
            and predominant business activity is the writing of insurance or
            the reinsuring of risks underwritten by insurance companies and
            which is subject to supervision by the insurance commissioner or a
            similar official or agency of a State or territory or the District
            of Columbia.

    ___     State or Local Plan.  The Buyer is a plan established and
            maintained by a State, its political subdivisions, or any agency or
            instrumentality of the State or its political subdivisions, for the
            benefit of its employees.

    ___     ERISA Plan.  The Buyer is an employee benefit plan within the
            meaning of Title I of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act
            of 1974.

    ___     Investment Adviser.   The Buyer is an investment adviser registered
            under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940.

    ___     SBIC.  The Buyer is a Small Business Investment Company licensed by
            the U.S. Small Business Administration under Section 301(c) or (d)
            of the Small Business Investment Act of 1958.

    ___     Business Development Company.  The Buyer is a business development
            company as defined in Section 202(a)(22) of the Investment Advisers
            Act of 1940.

    ___     Trust Fund.  The Buyer is a trust fund whose trustee is a bank or
            trust company and whose participants are exclusively (a) plans
            established and maintained by a State, its political subdivisions,
            or any agency or instrumentality of the State or its political
            subdivisions, for the benefit of its employees, or (b) employee
            benefit plans within the meaning of Title I of the Employee
            Retirement Income Security Act of 1974,





                                    C-1-2
<PAGE>   43

            but is not a trust fund that includes as participants individual
            retirement  accounts or H.R. 10 plans.

            3.   The term "securities" as used herein does not include (i)
securities of issuers that are affiliated with the Buyer, (ii) securities that
are part of an unsold allotment to or subscription by the Buyer, if the Buyer
is a dealer, (iii) bank deposit notes and certificates of deposit, (iv) loan
participations, (v) repurchase agreements, (vi) securities owned but subject to
a repurchase agreement and (vii) currency, interest rate and commodity swaps.

            4.   For purposes of determining the aggregate amount of securities
owned and/or invested on a discretionary basis by the Buyer, the Buyer used the
cost of such securities to the Buyer and did not include any of the securities
referred to in the preceding paragraph.  Further, in determining such aggregate
amount, the Buyer may have included securities owned by subsidiaries of the
Buyer,  but only if such subsidiaries are consolidated with the Buyer in its
financial statements prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting
principles and if the investments of such subsidiaries are managed under the
Buyer's direction.  However, such securities were not included if the Buyer is
a majority-owned, consolidated subsidiary of another enterprise and the Buyer
is not itself a reporting company under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

            5.   The Buyer acknowledges that it is familiar with Rule 144A and
understands that the seller to it and other parties related to the Certificates
are relying and will continue to rely on the statements made herein because one
or more sales to the Buyer may be in reliance on Rule 144A.

  ___        ___          Will the Buyer be purchasing the Rule 144A
  Yes        No  Securities only for the Buyer's own account?

            6.   If the answer to the foregoing question is "no", the Buyer
agrees that, in connection with any purchase of securities sold to the Buyer
for the account of a third party (including any separate account) in reliance
on Rule 144A, the Buyer will only purchase for the account of a third party
that at the time is a "qualified institutional buyer" within the meaning of
Rule 144A.  In addition, the Buyer agrees that the Buyer will not purchase
securities for a third party unless the Buyer has obtained a current
representation letter from such third party or taken other appropriate steps
contemplated by Rule 144A to conclude that such third party independently meets
the definition of "qualified institutional buyer" set forth in Rule 144A.





                                    C-1-3
<PAGE>   44

            7.   The Buyer will notify each of the parties to which this
certification is made of any changes in the information and conclusions herein.
Until such notice is given, the Buyer's purchase of Rule 144A Securities will
constitute a reaffirmation of this certification as of the date of such
purchase.

            8.   The Buyer has otherwise complied with any conditions for
transfer set forth in the Trust Agreement, and (h), either (i) is a "C
Corporation" under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or (ii) has
provided such disclosure concerning our status for federal income tax purposes
and the status and economic interest of our beneficial owners, as the Issuer or
its representatives have reasonably requested to determine that the Buyer's
acquisition of the Certificates will not subject the Issuer to an entity level
tax.



                                                                               
                                           ------------------------------------
                                           Print Name of Buyer

                                           By:                                 
                                              ---------------------------------
                                              Name:
                                              Title:

                                           Date:                               
                                                -------------------------------





                                    C-1-4
<PAGE>   45

                                                            ANNEX 2 TO EXHIBIT C


            QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER STATUS UNDER SEC RULE 144A

             [For Buyers That Are Registered Investment Companies]


                 The undersigned hereby certifies as follows in connection with
the Rule 144A Investment Representation to which this Certification is
attached:

                  1. As indicated below, the undersigned is the President,
Chief Financial Officer or Senior Vice President of the Buyer or, if the Buyer
is a "qualified institutional buyer" as that term is defined in Rule 144A under
the Securities Act of 1933 ("Rule 144A") because Buyer is part of a Family of
Investment Companies (as defined below), is such an officer of the Adviser.

                 2. In connection with purchases by Buyer, the Buyer is a
"qualified institutional buyer" as defined in SEC Rule 144A because (i) the
Buyer is an investment company registered under the Investment Company Act of
1940, and (ii) as marked below, the Buyer alone, or the Buyer's Family of
Investment Companies, owned at least $100,000,000 in securities (other than the
excluded securities referred to below) as of the end of the Buyer's most recent
fiscal year.  For purposes of determining the amount of securities owned by the
Buyer or the Buyer's Family of Investment Companies, the cost of such
securities was used.

____             The Buyer owned $___________________ in securities (other than
                 the excluded securities referred to below) as of the end of
                 the Buyer's most recent fiscal year (such amount being
                 calculated in accordance with Rule 144A).

____             The Buyer is part of a Family of Investment Companies which
                 owned in the aggregate $______________ in securities (other
                 than the excluded securities referred to below) as of the end
                 of the Buyer's most recent fiscal year (such amount being
                 calculated in accordance with Rule 144A).

                 3.       The term "Family of Investment Companies" as used
herein means two or more registered investment companies (or series thereof)
that have the same investment adviser or investment advisers that are
affiliated (by virtue of being majority owned subsidiaries of the same parent
or because one investment adviser is a majority owned subsidiary of the other).





                                    C-2-1
<PAGE>   46

                 4.       The term "securities" as used herein does not include
(i) securities of issuers that are affiliated with the Buyer or are part of the
Buyer's Family of Investment Companies, (ii) bank deposit notes and
certificates of deposit, (iii) loan participations, (iv) repurchase agreements,
(v) securities owned but subject to a repurchase agreement and (vi) currency,
interest rate and commodity swaps.

                 5.       The Buyer is familiar with Rule 144A and understands
that each of the parties to which this certification is made are relying and
will continue to rely on the statements made herein because one or more sales
to the Buyer will be in reliance on Rule 144A.  In addition, the Buyer will
only purchase for the Buyer's own account.

                 6.       The undersigned will notify each of the parties to
which this certification is made of any changes in the information and
conclusions herein.  Until such notice, the Buyer's purchase of Rule 144A
Securities will constitute a reaffirmation of this certification by the
undersigned as of the date of such purchase.

                 7.       The Buyer has otherwise complied with any conditions
for transfer set forth in the Trust Agreement, and (h), either (i) is a "C
Corporation" under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or (ii) has
provided such disclosure concerning our status for federal income tax purposes
and the status and economic interest of our beneficial owners, as the Issuer or
its representatives have reasonably requested to determine that the Buyer's
acquisition of the Certificates will not subject the Issuer to an entity level
tax.



                                                               
                           ------------------------------------
                                   Print Name of Buyer


                                   By:                                
                                      --------------------------------

                                      Name:                           
                                           ---------------------------
                                      Title:                          
                                            --------------------------

                                   IF AN ADVISER:

                                                                      
                                   -----------------------------------
                                   Print Name of Buyer

                                   Date:                               
                                        -------------------------------






                                    C-2-2

<PAGE>   1
                                                                    EXHIBIT 10.4



                       [FORM OF ADMINISTRATION AGREEMENT]


                 This ADMINISTRATION AGREEMENT dated as of _____________, 1996
(as amended from time to time, this "Agreement"), among HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN
CORPORATION, a Nevada corporation ("HCLC"), HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST
1996-2, a Delaware business trust (the "Issuer"), CHASE MANHATTAN BANK
DELAWARE, a Delaware banking corporation, as owner trustee (the "Owner
Trustee"), and HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION, a Delaware corporation, as
administrator (the "Administrator"),

                             W I T N E S S E T H :

                 WHEREAS, the Issuer is issuing the Household Consumer Loan
Asset Backed Notes, Series 1996-2, Class A-1 Notes, Class A-2 Notes, Class A-3
Notes and Class B Notes (collectively, the "Notes") pursuant to the Indenture
dated as of August 1, 1996 (as amended and supplemented from time to time, the
"Indenture"), between the Issuer and The Bank of New York, a New York banking
corporation, as indenture trustee (the "Indenture Trustee") and the Household
Consumer Loan Asset Backed Certificates, Series 1996-2 (the "Certificates" and
together with the Notes, the "Securities") pursuant to the Trust Agreement
dated as of August 1, 1996 (the "Trust Agreement") among HCLC, as Seller and as
Holder of the Designated Certificate (with any successor Holder of the
Designated Certificate, the "Seller"), and the Owner Trustee.  (Capitalized
terms used and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned
such terms in the Trust Agreement); and

                 WHEREAS, pursuant to the Basic Documents, the Seller, the
Issuer and the Owner Trustee are required to perform certain duties in
connection with (a) the Notes and the collateral therefor pledged pursuant to
the Indenture (the "Collateral") and (b) the Certificates (the registered
holders of such interests being referred to herein as the
"Certificateholders"); and

                 WHEREAS, the Seller, the Issuer and the Owner Trustee desire
to have the Administrator perform certain of the duties of the Seller under the
Trust Agreement and of the Issuer under the Trust Agreement and the Indenture,
(collectively, the "Related Agreements"), and to provide such additional
services consistent with the terms of this Agreement and the Related Agreements
as the Seller, the Issuer and the Owner Trustee may from time to time request
(and the Indenture Trustee is executing this Agreement to acknowledge its
consent to the Administrator's performance of those duties and services); and
<PAGE>   2

                 WHEREAS, the Administrator has the capacity to provide the
services required hereby and is willing to perform such services for the
Seller, the Issuer and the Owner Trustee on the terms set forth herein;

                 NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants
contained herein, and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and
adequacy of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties agree as follows:

         1.      Duties of the Administrator.

                 a.       Duties with Respect to the Related Agreements.

                          (i)     The Administrator agrees to perform all its
         duties as Administrator and the duties of the Issuer under the Related
         Agreements and the Seller under the Trust Agreement.  In addition, the
         Administrator shall consult with the Owner Trustee regarding the
         duties of the Issuer under the Related Agreements.  The Administrator
         shall monitor the performance of the Issuer and shall advise the Owner
         Trustee when action is necessary to comply with the Issuer's duties
         under the Related Agreements.  The Administrator shall prepare for
         execution by the Issuer or the Seller, as the case may be, or shall
         cause the preparation by other appropriate persons or entities of, all
         such documents, reports, filings, instruments, certificates and
         opinions that it shall be the duty of the Issuer or the Seller to
         prepare, file or deliver pursuant to the Related Agreements.  In
         furtherance of the foregoing, the Administrator shall take all
         appropriate action that is the duty of the Issuer to take pursuant to
         the Indenture including, without limitation, such of the foregoing as
         are required with respect to the following matters under the Indenture
         (references are to sections of the Indenture):

                                        the duty to cause newly appointed
                 Paying Agents, if any, to deliver to the Indenture Trustee the
                 instrument specified in the Indenture regarding funds held in
                 trust (Section 3.03);

                                        the direction to the Indenture Trustee
                 to deposit moneys with Paying Agents, if any, other than the
                 Indenture Trustee (Section 3.03);

                                        the preparation and delivery to the
                 Owner Trustee for execution, and to the authenticating agent
                 for authentication and delivery, of new Certificates for
                 transfers and replacements of Certificates (Sections 3.05 and
                 3.06);





                                       2
<PAGE>   3

                                        the preparation of the Issuer's annual
                 statement as to compliance with the Indenture (Section 3.10);

                                        the preparation and obtaining of
                 documents and instruments required for the release of the
                 Issuer from its obligations under the Indenture (Section
                 3.15);

                                        the delivery of written notice to the
                 Indenture Trustee and the Rating Agencies of each Event of
                 Default under the Indenture (Section 3.21);

                                        the administration of the Issuer's
                 obligations as to the satisfaction and discharge of the
                 Indenture and the preparation of an Officer's Certificate and
                 the obtaining of the Opinion of Counsel and the Independent
                 Certificate relating thereto (Section 10.01);

                                        the preparation and delivery of notice
                 to Noteholders and each Rating Agency of the removal of the
                 Indenture Trustee and the appointment of a successor Indenture
                 Trustee (Section 6.08);

                                        subject to Section 1(b)(i) hereof, the
                 preparation and, after execution by the Seller on behalf of
                 the Issuer, the filing with the Commission, any applicable
                 state agencies and the Indenture Trustee of documents required
                 to be filed on a periodic basis with, and summaries thereof as
                 may be required by rules and regulations prescribed by, the
                 Commission and any applicable state agencies and the
                 transmission of such summaries, as necessary, to the
                 Noteholders (Section 7.03);

                                        the preparation of an Issuer Request
                 and Officer's Certificate and the obtaining of an Opinion of
                 Counsel and Independent Certificates, if necessary, for the
                 release of the Trust Estate (Sections 8.05 and 8.03);

                                        the preparation of Issuer Requests and
                 the obtaining of Opinions of Counsel with respect to the
                 execution of supplemental indentures and the mailing to the
                 Noteholders of notices with respect to such supplemental
                 indentures (Sections 9.01, 9.02 and 9.03);

                                        the execution and delivery of new Notes
                 conforming to any supplemental indenture (Section 9.06);





                                       3
<PAGE>   4

                                        the preparation and delivery of
                 Officer's Certificates and the obtaining of Independent
                 Certificates, if necessary, for the release of property from
                 the lien of the Indenture (Section 10.01(b));

                                        the recording of the Indenture, if
                 applicable (Section 10.14); and

                                    the obtaining of the opinion referred to in
                 Section 3.07(b) of the Indenture.

                          (ii)    The Administrator will:

                                        indemnify the Indenture Trustee and its
                 agents for, and hold them harmless against, any losses,
                 liability or expense, including reasonable attorneys fees and
                 expenses, incurred without willful misconduct, negligence or
                 bad faith on their part, arising out of the willful
                 misconduct, gross negligence or bad faith of the Administrator
                 in the performance of the transactions contemplated by this
                 Agreement;

                                        indemnify the Owner Trustee and its
                 agents for, and hold them harmless against, any losses,
                 liability or expense, including reasonable attorneys fees and
                 expenses, incurred without willful misconduct, negligence or
                 bad faith on their part, arising out of the willful
                 misconduct, gross negligence or bad faith of the Administrator
                 in the performance of the transactions contemplated by this
                 Agreement;

                                        indemnify the Seller and its agents
                 for, and hold them harmless against, any losses, liability or
                 expense, including reasonable attorneys fees and expenses,
                 incurred without willful misconduct, gross negligence or bad
                 faith on their part, arising out of the willful misconduct,
                 gross negligence or bad faith of the Administrator in the
                 performance of the transactions contemplated by this
                 Agreement;

                                        pay the Owner Trustee, as compensation
                 for its services, such fees as have been separately agreed
                 upon before the date hereof, and the Administrator will
                 reimburse the Owner Trustee for its reasonable expenses under
                 the Basic Documents, including the reasonable compensation,
                 expenses and disbursements of such agents, representatives,
                 experts and outside counsel as the Owner Trustee may
                 reasonably employ in connection with the exercise and
                 performance of its rights and its duties under the Basic
                 Documents; and





                                       4
<PAGE>   5

                                        be liable as primary obligor for, and
                 will indemnify the Owner Trustee and its successors, assigns,
                 agents and servants (collectively, the "Indemnified Parties")
                 from and against, any and all liabilities, obligations,
                 losses, damages, taxes, claims, actions and suits, and any and
                 all reasonable costs, expenses and disbursements (including
                 reasonable legal fees and expenses) of any kind and nature
                 whatsoever (collectively, "Expenses") which may at any time be
                 imposed on, incurred by, or asserted against the Owner Trustee
                 or any Indemnified Party in any way relating to or arising out
                 of the Trust Agreement, the Basic Documents, the Owner Trust
                 Estate, the administration of the Owner Trust Estate or the
                 action or inaction of the Owner Trustee thereunder, provided,
                 that:

                                        the Administrator shall not be liable
                          for or required to indemnify an Indemnified Party
                          from and against Expenses arising or resulting from
                          the Owner Trustee's willful misconduct, negligence or
                          bad faith or as a result of any inaccuracy of a
                          representation or warranty contained in Section 7.03
                          expressly made by the Owner Trustee;

                                        with respect to any such claim, the
                          Indemnified Party shall have given the Administrator
                          written notice thereof promptly after the Indemnified
                          Party shall have actual knowledge thereof;

                                        while maintaining control over its own
                          defense, the Administrator shall consult with the
                          Indemnified Party in preparing such defense; and

                                        notwithstanding anything in this
                          Agreement to the contrary, the Administrator shall
                          not be liable for settlement of any claim by an
                          Indemnified Party entered into without the prior
                          consent of the Administrator, which consent shall not
                          be unreasonably withheld.

                          The indemnities contained in this Section shall
         survive the resignation or termination of the Owner Trustee, of the
         Seller, as Holder of the Designated Certificate, and of the Indenture
         Trustee, and the termination of this Agreement.  In the event of any
         claim, action or proceeding for which indemnity will be sought
         pursuant to this Section, the indemnitee's choice of legal counsel, if
         other than the legal counsel retained by such indemnitee in connection
         with the execution and delivery of the Related Agreements, shall





                                       5
<PAGE>   6

         be subject to the approval of the Administrator, which approval shall
         not be unreasonably withheld.  In addition, upon written notice to the
         indemnitee and with the consent of the indemnitee, which consent shall
         not be unreasonably withheld, the Administrator has the right to
         assume the defense of any claim, action or proceeding against the
         Indemnitee.

                 b.       Additional Duties.

                          (i)     In addition to the duties of the
         Administrator set forth above, the Administrator shall perform, or
         cause to be performed, the duties and obligations of the Seller,
         Designated Certificateholder and the Issuer under the Trust Agreement.
         These duties and obligations include, without limitation, the
         following (references are to sections of the Trust Agreement):

                                        preparing, filing or delivering tax
                 returns, reports and forms and performing the other duties of
                 the Issuer under Sections 2.06 and 5.05;

                                        removing the Certificate Paying Agent
                 under Section 3.10 and appointing a successor, subject to
                 compliance with Section 4.01;

                                        directing the Owner Trustee to take
                 action under the Basic Documents pursuant to Section 6.01;

                                        furnishing documents to the
                 Certificateholders under Section 7.02;

                                        delivering notice of termination of the
                 Issuer under Section 9.01 and notices of such termination or
                 of any Insolvency Event with respect to the Holder of the
                 Designated Certificate under Section 9.02;

                                        appointing a successor Owner Trustee,
                 removing the Owner Trustee and providing notices regarding
                 such action under Section 10.02 and executing instruments and
                 providing notices in connection with such appointment under
                 Section 10.03;

                                        appointing co-trustees or separate
                 trustees under Section 10.05, and removing same thereunder; and

                                        obtaining any opinion of counsel
                 required by Section 11.01 and furnishing notice or any





                                       6
<PAGE>   7

                 obtaining execution by Certificateholders of any amendment to
         the Trust Agreement thereunder.

                          In furtherance thereof, the Seller and the Issuer
         shall execute and deliver to the Administrator and to each successor
         Administrator appointed pursuant to the terms hereof, one or more
         powers of attorney substantially in the form of Exhibit A hereto,
         appointing the Administrator the attorney-in-fact of the Issuer for
         the purpose of executing on behalf of the Issuer all such documents,
         reports, filings, instruments, certificates and opinions.  Subject to
         Section 4 of this Agreement, and in accordance with the directions of
         the Issuer, the Administrator shall administer, perform or supervise
         the performance of such other activities in connection with the
         Collateral (including the Related Agreements) as are not covered by
         any of the foregoing provisions and as are expressly requested by the
         Seller or the Owner Trustee and are reasonably within the capability
         of the Administrator.  The Administrator shall be responsible for any
         filings required by the Issuer under the Securities Exchange Act of
         1934, as amended.

                          (ii)    In carrying out the foregoing duties or any
         of its other obligations under this Agreement, the Administrator may
         enter into transactions or otherwise deal with any of its affiliates;
         provided, however, that the terms of any such transactions or dealings
         shall be in accordance with any directions received from the Seller
         and the Owner Trustee and shall be, in the Administrator's opinion, no
         less favorable to the Seller and the Issuer than would be available
         from unaffiliated parties.

                         (iii)    In carrying out any of its obligations under
         this Agreement, the Administrator may act either directly or through
         agents, attorneys, accountants, independent contractors and auditors
         and enter into agreements with any of them.

                 c.       Non-Ministerial Matters.

                          (i)     With respect to matters that in the
         reasonable judgment of the Administrator are non-ministerial, the
         Administrator shall not be under any obligation to take any action,
         and in any event shall not take any action unless the Administrator
         shall have received instructions from the Seller or the Owner Trustee
         or the Certificateholders in accordance with the Trust Agreement.  For
         the purpose of the preceding sentence, "non-ministerial matters" shall
         include, without limitation:

                                        the amendment of or any supplement to
         the Related Agreements;





                                       7
<PAGE>   8

                                        the initiation of any claim or lawsuit
                 by the Issuer and the compromise of any action, claim or
                 lawsuit brought by or against the Issuer;

                                        the appointment of successor Note
                 Registrars, successor Administrators and successor Indenture
                 Trustees pursuant to the Indenture, or the consent to the
                 assignment by the Note Registrar, Administrator or Indenture
                 Trustee of its obligations under the Indenture; and

                                        the removal of the Indenture Trustee.

                          (ii)  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in
         this Agreement, the Administrator shall not be obligated to, and shall
         not (x) make any payments to the Noteholders under the Related
         Agreements, (y) sell the Trust Estate pursuant to the Indenture or (z)
         take any action that either the Seller or the Owner Trustee directs
         the Administrator not to take on its behalf or on the behalf of the
         Issuer.

         2.      Records.  The Administrator shall maintain appropriate books
of account and records relating to services performed hereunder, which books of
account and records shall be accessible for inspection by the Seller and the
Owner Trustee at any time, after reasonable notice to the Administrator of such
inspection, during normal business hours.

         3.      Compensation.  As compensation for the performance of the
Administrator's obligations under this Agreement, the Administrator shall be
entitled to a fee of not more than $500.00 per month which shall be paid by the
Holder of the Designated Certificate pursuant to Section 2.07(a) of the Trust
Agreement; provided however the Administrator may with prior written notice to
the Seller, Servicer, Issuer, Owner Trustee and Indenture Trustee, waive its
rights to compensation hereunder and Household Finance Corporation as the
initial Administrator hereby gives written notice to the Seller, Servicer,
Issuer, Owner Trustee and Indenture Trustee that until further written notice
to the contrary, Household Finance Corporation waives its right to receive such
fee.  As reimbursement for its expenses related to the performance of the
Administrator's obligations hereunder, the Administrator shall receive payment
from the Seller.

         4.      Additional Information To Be Furnished.  The Administrator
shall furnish to the Seller and the Owner Trustee from time to time such
additional information regarding the Collateral as the Seller and the Owner
Trustee shall reasonably request.





                                       8
<PAGE>   9

         5.      Independence of the Administrator.  For all purposes of this
Agreement, the Administrator shall be an independent contractor and shall not
be subject to the supervision of the Seller or the Owner Trustee with respect
to the manner in which it accomplishes the performance of its obligations
hereunder.  Unless expressly authorized by this Agreement, the Administrator
shall have no authority to act for or represent the Seller, the Issuer or the
Owner Trustee in any way and shall not otherwise be deemed an agent of the
Seller, the Issuer or the Owner Trustee.

         6.      No Joint Venture.  Nothing contained in this Agreement (i)
shall constitute the Administrator and either of the Issuer or the Owner
Trustee or the Seller as members of any partnership, joint venture,
association, syndicate, unincorporated business or other separate entity, (ii)
shall be construed to impose any liability as such on any of them or (iii)
shall be deemed to confer on any of them any express, implied or apparent
authority to incur any obligation or liability on behalf of the others.

         7.      Other Activities of the Administrator.  Nothing herein shall
prevent the Administrator or its Affiliates from engaging in other businesses
or, in its sole discretion, from acting in a similar capacity as an
administrator for any other person or entity even though such person or entity
may engage in business activities similar to those of the Issuer, the Owner
Trustee or the Indenture Trustee.

         8.      Term of Agreement; Resignation and Removal of Administrator.
a.  This Agreement shall continue in force until the dissolution of the Issuer,
upon which event this Agreement shall automatically terminate.

                 b.       Subject to Section 8(e) of this Agreement, the
Administrator may resign its duties hereunder by providing the Issuer with at
least 60 days' prior written notice.

                 c.       Subject to Section 8(e) of this Agreement, the Seller
may remove the Administrator without cause by providing the Administrator with
at least 60 days' prior written notice.

                 d.       Subject to Section 8(e) of this Agreement, at the
sole option of the Owner Trustee, the Administrator may be removed immediately
upon written notice of termination from the Owner Trustee to the Administrator
and each Rating Agency if any of the following events shall occur:

                          (i)     the Administrator shall default in the
         performance of any of its duties under this Agreement in any material
         respect and, after notice of such default, shall not cure such default
         within ten days (or, if such default cannot be cured in such time,
         shall not give within ten days





                                       9
<PAGE>   10

         such assurance of cure as shall be reasonably satisfactory to the
         Owner Trustee);

                     (ii)         a court having jurisdiction in the premises
         shall enter a decree or order for relief, and such decree or order
         shall not have been vacated within 60 days, in respect of the
         Administrator in any involuntary case under any applicable bankruptcy,
         insolvency or other similar law now or hereafter in effect or appoint
         a receiver, liquidator, assignee, custodian, trustee, sequestrator or
         similar official for the Administrator or any substantial part of its
         property or order the winding-up or liquidation of its affairs;

                     (iii)        the Administrator shall commence a voluntary
         case under any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency or other similar law
         now or hereafter in effect, shall consent to the entry of an order for
         relief in an involuntary case under any such law, or shall consent to
         the appointment of a receiver, liquidator, assignee, trustee,
         custodian, sequestrator or similar official for the Administrator or
         any substantial part of its property, shall consent to the taking of
         possession by any such official of any substantial part of its
         property, shall make any general assignment for the benefit of
         creditors or shall fail generally to pay its debts as they become due;
         or

                    (iv)  HCLC or an Affiliate ceases to be the Holder of the
         Designated Certificate under the Trust Agreement.

                 The Administrator agrees that if any of the events specified
in clauses (ii) or (iii) of this Section shall occur, it shall give written
notice thereof to the Owner Trustee and the Indenture Trustee within seven days
after the happening of such event.

                 e.       No resignation or removal of the Administrator
pursuant to this Section shall be effective until (i) a successor Administrator
shall have been appointed by the Seller (with the consent of the Owner Trustee
and the Indenture Trustee) and (ii) such successor Administrator shall have
agreed in writing to be bound by the terms of this Agreement in the same manner
as the Administrator is bound hereunder.

                 f.       The appointment of any successor Administrator shall
be effective only after each Rating Agency, after having been given 10 days
prior notice of such proposed appointment, shall have declared in writing that
such appointment will not result in a reduction or withdrawal of the then
current rating of the Notes or Certificates.





                                       10
<PAGE>   11

         9.      Action upon Termination, Resignation or Removal.  Promptly
upon the effective date of termination of this Agreement pursuant to Section
8(a) of this Agreement or the resignation or removal of the Administrator
pursuant to Section 8(b) or (c) of this Agreement, respectively, the
Administrator shall be entitled to be paid all fees and reimbursable expenses
accruing to it to the date of such termination, resignation or removal.  The
Administrator shall forthwith upon such termination pursuant to Section 8(a) of
this Agreement deliver to the Seller, Owner Trustee or Indenture Trustee, as
appropriate, all property and documents of or relating to the Collateral then
in the custody of the Administrator.  In the event of the resignation or
removal of the Administrator pursuant to Section 8(b) or (c) of this Agreement,
respectively, the Administrator shall cooperate with the Seller, the Owner
Trustee and the Indenture Trustee and take all reasonable steps requested to
assist them in making an orderly transfer of the duties of the Administrator.

         10.     Notices.  Any notice, report or other communication given
hereunder shall be in writing and addressed as follows:

                 a.       if to the Issuer, to:

                          Household Consumer Loan Trust 1996-2
                          c/o Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware
                          1201 Market Street
                          Wilmington, DE  19801
                          Attention:  Corporate Trust Administration

                          with a copy to:

                          The Chase Manhattan Bank
                          450 West 33rd Street, 15th Floor
                          New York, NY  10001
                          Attention:  Global Trust Services

                 b.       If to the Administrator, to:

                          Household Finance Corporation
                          2700 Sanders Road
                          Prospect Heights, Illinois 60070
                          Attention:  Treasurer

                 c.       If to the Indenture Trustee, to:

                          The Bank of New York
                          101 Barclay Street, Floor 12 East
                          New York, New York 10286
                          Attn:  Corporate Trust Asset-Backed Unit





                                       11
<PAGE>   12

                 d.       If to the Owner Trustee, to:

                          Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware
                          1201 Market Street
                          Wilmington, DE  19801
                          Attention:  Corporate Trust Administration

                          with a copy to:

                          The Chase Manhattan Bank
                          450 West 33rd Street, 15th Floor
                          New York, NY  10001
                          Attention:  Global Trust Services

                 (e)      If to the Seller, to:

                          Household Consumer Loan Corporation
                          111 Town Center Drive
                          Las Vegas, Nevada 89134
                          Attention:  Compliance Officer

                          with a copy to,
                          Household Finance Corporation
                          2700 Sanders Road
                          Prospect Heights, Illinois 60070
                          Attention:  Treasurer

or to such other address as any party shall have provided to the other parties
in writing.  Any notice required to be in writing hereunder shall be deemed
given if such notice is mailed by certified mail, postage prepaid, or
hand-delivered to the address of such party as provided above.

         11.     Amendments.  a. This Agreement may be amended from time to
time by the parties hereto, with written notice and acknowledgment by the
Indenture Trustee, by a written instrument signed by each of them, without the
consent of any of the Securityholders, provided that an Opinion of Counsel for
the Seller (which Opinion of Counsel may, as to factual matters, rely upon
Officer's Certificates of the Seller) is addressed and delivered to the Owner
Trustee, the Indenture Trustee and each Rating Agency, dated the date of any
such amendment, to the effect that the conditions precedent to any such
amendment have been satisfied and the Seller shall have delivered to the Owner
Trustee and the Indenture Trustee an Officer's Certificate, dated the date of
any such Amendment, stating that the Seller reasonably believes that such
amendment will not have a material adverse effect on the Securityholders.

                 b.       This Agreement may also be amended from time to time
with the consent of the Holders of the Certificates evidencing not less than
66-2/3% of the aggregate unpaid





                                       12
<PAGE>   13

principal amount of the Securities of all affected Certificateholders for which
the Seller has not delivered an Officer's Certificate stating that there is no
material adverse effect, for the purpose of adding any provisions to or
changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of this Agreement
or of modifying in any manner the rights of the Certificateholders; provided,
however, that no such amendment shall (i) reduce in any manner the amount of,
or delay the timing of, payments received that are required to be distributed
on any Certificate without the consent of the related Certificateholder, or
(ii) reduce the aforesaid percentage of Certificates the Holders of which are
required to consent to any such amendment, without the consent of the Holders
of all such Certificates then outstanding or cause any material adverse tax
consequences to any Certificateholders or Noteholders.

                 c.  Promptly after the execution of any such amendment or
consent (other than an amendment pursuant to paragraph (a)), the Administrator
shall direct the Certificate Registrar to furnish notification of the substance
of such amendment to each Certificateholder, and to each Rating Agency.

                 d.  It shall not be necessary for the consent of
Certificateholders under this Section to approve the particular form of any
proposed amendment, but it shall be sufficient if such consent shall approve
the substance thereof.  The manner of obtaining such consents and of evidencing
the authorization of the execution thereof by Certificateholders shall be
subject to such reasonable requirements as the Owner Trustee may prescribe.

         12.     Successors and Assigns.  This Agreement may not be assigned by
the Administrator (except to a Person who also becomes the successor Servicer
in accordance with the Pooling and Servicing Agreement) unless such assignment
is previously consented to in writing by the Seller, the Owner Trustee and the
Indenture Trustee and unless each Rating Agency, after having been given 10
days prior notice of such assignment, shall have declared in writing that such
assignment will not result in a reduction or withdrawal of the then current
rating of the Notes or Certificates.  An assignment with such consent and
satisfaction, if accepted by the assignee, shall bind the assignee hereunder in
the same manner as the Administrator is bound hereunder.  Notwithstanding the
foregoing, this Agreement may be assigned by the Administrator without the
consent of the Seller, the Owner Trustee and the Indenture Trustee if the
assignment is to (i) a corporation or other organization that is a successor
(by merger, consolidation or purchase of assets) to the Administrator or (ii)
to an Affiliate of the Administrator; provided that (x) the obligations of the
Administrator under Section 1(a)(ii) are not assignable and (y) such successor
organization executes and delivers to the Seller, the Owner Trustee and the
Indenture Trustee an agreement in which such





                                       13
<PAGE>   14

corporation or other organization agrees to be bound hereunder by the terms of
said assignment in the same manner as the Administrator is bound hereunder.
Subject to the foregoing, this Agreement shall bind any successors or assigns
of the parties hereto.

         13.     GOVERNING LAW.  THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN
ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS
CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE
PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

         14.     Headings.  The section headings hereof have been inserted for
convenience of reference only and shall not be construed to affect the meaning,
construction or effect of this Agreement.

         15.     Counterparts.  This Agreement may be executed in counterparts,
each of which when so executed shall together constitute but one and the same
agreement.

         16.     Severability.  Any provision of this Agreement that is
prohibited or unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall be ineffective to the
extent of such prohibition or unenforceability without invalidating the
remaining provisions hereof and any such prohibition or unenforceability in any
jurisdiction shall not invalidate or render unenforceable such provision in any
other jurisdiction.

         17.     Limitation of Liability of the Owner Trustee.  Notwithstanding
anything contained herein to the contrary, this instrument has been executed by
Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware, not in its individual capacity but solely in its
capacity as Owner Trustee of the Issuer, and in no event shall Chase Manhattan
Bank Delaware in its individual capacity or any beneficial owner of the Issuer
have any liability for the representations, warranties, covenants, agreements
or other obligations of the Issuer hereunder, as to all of which recourse shall
be had solely to the assets of the Issuer.  For all purposes of this Agreement,
in the performance of any duties or obligations of the Issuer hereunder, the
Owner Trustee shall be subject to, and entitled to the benefits of, the terms
and provisions of Articles VI, VII and VIII of the Trust Agreement.

         18.     Third-Party Beneficiary.  The Indenture Trustee is a
third-party beneficiary to this Agreement and is entitled to the rights and
benefits hereunder and may enforce the provisions hereof as if it were a party
hereto.





                                       14
<PAGE>   15

                 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have caused this Agreement to
be duly executed and delivered as of the day and year first above written.

                                 HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2

                                 By:  CHASE MANHATTAN BANK DELAWARE, not 
                                      in its individual capacity but
                                      solely as Owner Trustee


                                 By:  
                                     -----------------------------------------
                                       Name:
                                       Title:

                                
                                 HOUSEHOLD FINANCE CORPORATION
                                 in its individual capacity, as
                                 Administrator
                                 

                                 By:  
                                     -----------------------------------------
                                       Name:
                                       Title:


                                 HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN
                                 CORPORATION


                                 By:      
                                     -----------------------------------------
                                     Name:  Steve H. Smith
                                     Title:  VP & Asst. Treasurer


CONSENTED TO BY:

THE BANK OF NEW YORK,
as Indenture Trustee


By:      
    -------------------------------
    Name:
    Title:
<PAGE>   16

                                                                       EXHIBIT A

                               POWER OF ATTORNEY

STATE OF NEW YORK   )
                    )
COUNTY OF NEW YORK  )

         KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that Household Consumer Loan Trust
1996-2 (the "Issuer"), does hereby make, constitute and appoint Household
Finance Corporation, as administrator (the "Administrator") under the
Administration Agreement dated as of ____________ 1, 1996 (the "Administration
Agreement"), among the Issuer, Chase Manhattan Bank Delaware, as the Owner
Trustee, Household Consumer Loan Corporation, as the Seller, and Household
Finance Corporation, as the Administrator, as the same may be amended from time
to time, and its agents and attorneys, as Attorneys-in-Fact to execute on
behalf of the Issuer all such documents, reports, filings, instruments,
certificates and opinions as it shall be the duty of the Issuer to prepare,
file or deliver pursuant to the Related Agreements, including, without
limitation, to appear for and represent the Issuer in connection with the
preparation, filing and audit of federal, state and local tax returns
pertaining to the Issuer, and with full power to perform any and all acts
associated with such returns and audits that the Issuer could perform,
including without limitation, the right to distribute and receive confidential
information, defend and assert positions in response to audits, initiate and
defend litigation, and to execute waivers of restrictions on assessments of
deficiencies, consents to the extension of any statutory or regulatory time
limit, and settlements.

         All powers of attorney for this purpose heretofore filed or executed
by the Issuer are hereby revoked.

         Capitalized terms that are used and not otherwise defined herein shall
have the meanings ascribed thereto in the Administration Agreement.





                                      A-1
<PAGE>   17


         EXECUTED this ___ day of ____________, 1996.


                                  HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2

                                  By:  CHASE MANHATTAN BANK DELAWARE,
                                       not in its individual capacity but 
                                       solely as Owner Trustee


                                  By:  
                                       _________________________________________
                                       Name:
                                       Title:

                                  HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORPORATION,
                                  as Seller


                                  By:  
                                       _________________________________________
                                       Name:
                                       Title:





                                      A-2

<PAGE>   1
                                                           EXHIBIT 25.1

                                                           CONFORMED COPY





================================================================================

                                     FORM T-1

                        SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             Washington, D.C.  20549

                             STATEMENT OF ELIGIBILITY
                    UNDER THE TRUST INDENTURE ACT OF 1939 OF A
                     CORPORATION DESIGNATED TO ACT AS TRUSTEE

                       CHECK IF AN APPLICATION TO DETERMINE
                       ELIGIBILITY OF A TRUSTEE PURSUANT TO
                         SECTION 305(b)(2)           |__|

                              ______________________

                               THE BANK OF NEW YORK
               (Exact name of trustee as specified in its charter)

New York                                               13-5160382
(State of incorporation                                (I.R.S. employer
if not a U.S. national bank)                           identification no.)

48 Wall Street, New York, N.Y.                         10286
(Address of principal executive offices)               (Zip code)

                              ______________________

                     HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN DEPOSIT TRUST I
               (Exact name of obligor as specified in its charter)

New York                                               88-0345950
(State or other jurisdiction of                        (I.R.S. employer
incorporation or organization)                         identification no.)

1111 Town Center Drive
Las Vegas, Nevada                                      89134
(Address of principal executive offices)               (Zip code)

                              ______________________

                       HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN TRUST 1996-2
               (Exact name of obligor as specified in its charter)


Delaware                                               To Be Applied For
(State or other jurisdiction of                        (I.R.S. employer
incorporation or organization)                         identification no.)

1111 Town Center Drive
Las Vegas, Nevada                                      89134
(Address of principal executive offices)               (Zip code)



                                                 (cover continued on next page)
<PAGE>   2



                              ______________________

                       HOUSEHOLD CONSUMER LOAN CORPORATION
               (Exact name of obligor as specified in its charter)

Nevada                                                 36-4038996
(State or other jurisdiction of                        (I.R.S. employer
incorporation or organization)                         identification no.)

1111 Town Center Drive
Las Vegas, Nevada                                      89134
(Address of principal executive offices)               (Zip code)
          
                              ______________________

               Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Class A-1 Notes
               Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Class A-2 Notes
               Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Class A-3 Notes
                Household Consumer Loan Asset Backed Class B Notes
                       (Title of the indenture securities)

<PAGE>   3


1.   General information.  Furnish the following information as to the Trustee:

     (a)  Name and address of each examining or supervising authority to which 
          it is subject.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                  Name                                        Address
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

     Superintendent of Banks of the State of      2 Rector Street, New York,
     New York                                     N.Y.  10006, and Albany, N.Y.
                                                  12203

     Federal Reserve Bank of New York             33 Liberty Plaza, New York,
                                                  N.Y.  10045

     Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation        Washington, D.C.  20549

     New York Clearing House Association          New York, New York

     (b)  Whether it is authorized to exercise corporate trust powers.

     Yes.

2.   Affiliations with Obligor.

     If the obligor is an affiliate of the trustee, describe each such affilia-
     tion. 

     None.  (See Note on page 3.)

16.  List of Exhibits. 

     Exhibits identified in parentheses below, on file with the Commission, are
     incorporated herein by reference as an exhibit hereto, pursuant to Rule
     7a-29 under the Trust Indenture Act of 1939 (the "Act") and Rule 24 of the
     Commission's Rules of Practice.

     1.   A copy of the Organization Certificate of The Bank of New York (for-
          merly Irving Trust Company) as now in effect, which contains the au-
          thority to commence business and a grant of powers to exercise corpo-
          rate trust powers.  (Exhibit 1 to Amendment No. 1 to Form T-1 filed
          with Registration Statement No. 33-6215, Exhibits 1a and 1b to Form 
          T-1 filed with Registration Statement No. 33-21672 and Exhibit 1 to 
          Form T-1 filed with Registration Statement No. 33-29637.)

     4.   A copy of the existing By-laws of the Trustee.  (Exhibit 4 to Form T-1
          filed with Registration Statement No. 33-31019.)

     6.   The consent of the Trustee required by Section 321(b) of the Act.  
          (Exhibit 6 to Form T-1 filed with Registration Statement No. 
          33-44051.)

     7.   A copy of the latest report of condition of the Trustee published pur-
          suant to law or to the requirements of its supervising or examining
          authority.




                                      - 2 -

<PAGE>   4


                                       NOTE


     Inasmuch as this Form T-1 is filed prior to the ascertainment by the 
Trustee of all facts on which to base a responsive answer to Item 2, the answer
to said Item is based on incomplete information.

     Item 2 may, however, be considered as correct unless amended by an 
amendment to this Form T-1.


















































                                      - 3 -
<PAGE>   5






                                    SIGNATURE



     Pursuant to the requirements of the Act, the Trustee, The Bank of New York,
a corporation organized and existing under the laws of the State of New York,
has duly caused this statement of eligibility to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, all in The City of New York, and State
of New York, on the 12th day of August, 1996.



                                        THE BANK OF NEW YORK



                                        By:     /s/Vivian Georges          
                                            ---------------------------------
                                            Name:  Vivian Georges
                                            Title: Assistant Vice President






























                                      - 4 -
<PAGE>   6
                                                                       Exhibit 7




                      Consolidated Report of Condition of

                              THE BANK OF NEW YORK

              of 48 Wall Street, New York, N.Y. 10286 
              And Foreign and Domestic Subsidiaries, 
a member of the Federal Reserve System, at the close of business March 31,
1996,  published in accordance with a call made by the Federal Reserve Bank of
this District pursuant to  the  provisions of the Federal Reserve Act.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                Dollar Amounts
ASSETS                                            in Thousands
<S>                                                <C>
Cash and balances due from depos-
  itory institutions:
  Noninterest-bearing balances and
  currency and coin .....................          $ 2,461,550
  Interest-bearing balances .............              835,563
Securities:
  Held-to-maturity securities ...........              802,064
  Available-for-sale securities .........            2,051,263
Federal funds sold in domestic offices 
of the bank:
Federal funds sold ......................            3,885,475
Loans and lease financing
  receivables:
  Loans and leases, net of unearned
    income .................27,820,159
  LESS: Allowance for loan and
    lease losses ..............509,817
  LESS: Allocated transfer risk
    reserve......................1,000
    Loans and leases, net of unearned
    income, allowance, and reserve                  27,309,342
Assets held in trading accounts .........              837,118
Premises and fixed assets (including
  capitalized leases) ...................              614,567
Other real estate owned .................               51,631
Investments in unconsolidated
  subsidiaries and associated
  companies .............................              225,158
Customers' liability to this bank on
  acceptances outstanding ...............              800,375
Intangible assets .......................              436,668
Other assets ............................            1,247,908
                                                   -----------
Total assets ............................          $41,558,682
                                                   ===========

LIABILITIES
Deposits:
  In domestic offices ...................          $18,851,327
  Noninterest-bearing .......7,102,645
  Interest-bearing .........11,748,682
  In foreign offices, Edge and
  Agreement subsidiaries, and IBFs ......           10,965,604
  Noninterest-bearing ..........37,855
</TABLE>


<PAGE>   7


<TABLE>
<S>                                                <C>
  Interest-bearing .........10,927,749
Federal funds purchased and secu-
  rities sold under agreements to re-
  purchase in domestic offices of
  the bank and of its Edge and
  Agreement subsidiaries, and in
  IBFs:
  Federal funds purchased ...............            1,224,886
  Securities sold under agreements
    to repurchase .......................               29,728
Demand notes issued to the U.S.
  Treasury ..............................              118,870
Trading liabilities .....................              673,944
Other borrowed money:
  With original maturity of one year
    or less .............................            2,713,248
  With original maturity of more than
    one year ............................               20,780
Bank's liability on acceptances exe-
  cuted and outstanding .................              803,292
Subordinated notes and debentures .......            1,022,860
Other liabilities .......................            1,590,564
                                                   -----------
Total liabilities .......................           38,015,103
                                                   -----------


EQUITY CAPITAL
Common stock ............................              942,284
Surplus .................................              525,666
Undivided profits and capital
  reserves ..............................            2,078,197
Net unrealized holding gains
  (losses) on available-for-sale
  securities ............................                3,197
Cumulative foreign currency transla-
  tion adjustments ......................          (     5,765)
                                                   -----------
Total equity capital ....................            3,543,579
                                                   -----------
Total liabilities and equity
  capital ...............................          $41,558,682
                                                   ===========
</TABLE>


   I,  Robert  E. Keilman, Senior Vice President and Comptroller of the
above-named  bank  do  hereby  declare  that  this  Report  of Condition  has
been  prepared in conformance with the instructions issued by the Board of
Governors of the Federal Reserve System  and is true to the best of my
knowledge and belief.

                                                               Robert E. Keilman

   We, the undersigned directors, attest to the correctness of this Report of
Condition and declare that it has been examined by us and to  the  best  of
our  knowledge  and  belief has been prepared in conformance with the
instructions issued by the Board of  Governors of the Federal Reserve System
and is true and correct.


   J. Carter Bacot    ]
   Thomas A. Renyi    |      Directors
   Alan R. Griffith   ]




© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission